diff options
Diffstat (limited to 'doc/src')
342 files changed, 4221 insertions, 4435 deletions
diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/Makefile b/doc/src/sgml/Makefile index df77a142e4d..f122b4187f4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/Makefile +++ b/doc/src/sgml/Makefile @@ -37,15 +37,7 @@ ifndef FOP FOP = $(missing) fop endif -SGMLINCLUDE = -D . -D $(srcdir) - -ifndef NSGMLS -NSGMLS = $(missing) nsgmls -endif - -ifndef OSX -OSX = $(missing) osx -endif +XMLINCLUDE = --path . ifndef XMLLINT XMLLINT = $(missing) xmllint @@ -63,19 +55,6 @@ GENERATED_SGML = version.sgml \ ALLSGML := $(wildcard $(srcdir)/*.sgml $(srcdir)/ref/*.sgml) $(GENERATED_SGML) -# Enable some extra warnings -# -wfully-tagged needed to throw a warning on missing tags -# for older tool chains, 2007-08-31 -# -wnet catches XML-style empty-element tags like <xref linkend="abc"/>. -override SPFLAGS += -wall -wno-unused-param -wfully-tagged -wnet -# Additional warnings for XML compatibility. The conditional is meant -# to detect whether we are using OpenSP rather than the ancient -# original SP. -override SPFLAGS += -wempty -ifneq (,$(filter o%,$(notdir $(OSX)))) -override SPFLAGS += -wdata-delim -winstance-ignore-ms -winstance-include-ms -winstance-param-entity -endif - ## ## Man pages @@ -83,9 +62,9 @@ endif man distprep-man: man-stamp -man-stamp: stylesheet-man.xsl postgres.xml - $(XMLLINT) --noout --valid postgres.xml - $(XSLTPROC) $(XSLTPROCFLAGS) $(XSLTPROC_MAN_FLAGS) $^ +man-stamp: stylesheet-man.xsl postgres.sgml $(ALLSGML) + $(XMLLINT) $(XMLINCLUDE) --noout --valid $(word 2,$^) + $(XSLTPROC) $(XMLINCLUDE) $(XSLTPROCFLAGS) $(XSLTPROC_MAN_FLAGS) $(wordlist 1,2,$^) touch $@ @@ -136,27 +115,8 @@ INSTALL.html: %.html : stylesheet-text.xsl %.xml $(XMLLINT) --noout --valid $*.xml $(XSLTPROC) $(XSLTPROCFLAGS) $(XSLTPROC_HTML_FLAGS) $^ >$@ -INSTALL.xml: standalone-profile.xsl standalone-install.xml postgres.xml - $(XSLTPROC) $(XSLTPROCFLAGS) --xinclude $(wordlist 1,2,$^) >$@ - - -## -## SGML->XML conversion -## - -# For obscure reasons, GNU make 3.81 complains about circular dependencies -# if we try to do "make all" in a VPATH build without the explicit -# $(srcdir) on the postgres.sgml dependency in this rule. GNU make bug? -postgres.xml: $(srcdir)/postgres.sgml $(ALLSGML) - $(OSX) $(SPFLAGS) $(SGMLINCLUDE) -x lower $< >$@.tmp - $(call mangle-xml,book) - -define mangle-xml -$(PERL) -p -e 's/\[(aacute|acirc|aelig|agrave|amp|aring|atilde|auml|bull|copy|eacute|egrave|gt|iacute|lt|mdash|nbsp|ntilde|oacute|ocirc|oslash|ouml|pi|quot|scaron|uuml) *\]/\&\1;/gi;' \ - -e '$$_ .= qq{<!DOCTYPE $(1) PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook XML V4.2//EN" "http://www.oasis-open.org/docbook/xml/4.2/docbookx.dtd">\n} if $$. == 1;' \ - <$@.tmp > $@ -rm $@.tmp -endef +INSTALL.xml: standalone-profile.xsl standalone-install.xml postgres.sgml $(ALLSGML) + $(XSLTPROC) $(XMLINCLUDE) $(XSLTPROCFLAGS) --xinclude $(wordlist 1,2,$^) >$@ ## @@ -169,20 +129,20 @@ endif html: html-stamp -html-stamp: stylesheet.xsl postgres.xml - $(XMLLINT) --noout --valid postgres.xml - $(XSLTPROC) $(XSLTPROCFLAGS) $(XSLTPROC_HTML_FLAGS) $^ +html-stamp: stylesheet.xsl postgres.sgml $(ALLSGML) + $(XMLLINT) $(XMLINCLUDE) --noout --valid $(word 2,$^) + $(XSLTPROC) $(XMLINCLUDE) $(XSLTPROCFLAGS) $(XSLTPROC_HTML_FLAGS) $(wordlist 1,2,$^) cp $(srcdir)/stylesheet.css html/ touch $@ -htmlhelp: stylesheet-hh.xsl postgres.xml - $(XMLLINT) --noout --valid postgres.xml - $(XSLTPROC) $(XSLTPROCFLAGS) $^ +htmlhelp: stylesheet-hh.xsl postgres.sgml $(ALLSGML) + $(XMLLINT) $(XMLINCLUDE) --noout --valid $(word 2,$^) + $(XSLTPROC) $(XMLINCLUDE) $(XSLTPROCFLAGS) $(wordlist 1,2,$^) # single-page HTML -postgres.html: stylesheet-html-nochunk.xsl postgres.xml - $(XMLLINT) --noout --valid postgres.xml - $(XSLTPROC) $(XSLTPROCFLAGS) $(XSLTPROC_HTML_FLAGS) -o $@ $^ +postgres.html: stylesheet-html-nochunk.xsl postgres.sgml $(ALLSGML) + $(XMLLINT) $(XMLINCLUDE) --noout --valid $(word 2,$^) + $(XSLTPROC) $(XMLINCLUDE) $(XSLTPROCFLAGS) $(XSLTPROC_HTML_FLAGS) -o $@ $(wordlist 1,2,$^) # single-page text postgres.txt: postgres.html @@ -196,13 +156,13 @@ postgres.txt: postgres.html postgres.pdf: $(error Invalid target; use postgres-A4.pdf or postgres-US.pdf as targets) -%-A4.fo: stylesheet-fo.xsl %.xml - $(XMLLINT) --noout --valid $*.xml - $(XSLTPROC) $(XSLTPROCFLAGS) --stringparam paper.type A4 -o $@ $^ +%-A4.fo: stylesheet-fo.xsl %.sgml $(ALLSGML) + $(XMLLINT) $(XMLINCLUDE) --noout --valid $(word 2,$^) + $(XSLTPROC) $(XMLINCLUDE) $(XSLTPROCFLAGS) --stringparam paper.type A4 -o $@ $(wordlist 1,2,$^) -%-US.fo: stylesheet-fo.xsl %.xml - $(XMLLINT) --noout --valid $*.xml - $(XSLTPROC) $(XSLTPROCFLAGS) --stringparam paper.type USletter -o $@ $^ +%-US.fo: stylesheet-fo.xsl %.sgml $(ALLSGML) + $(XMLLINT) $(XMLINCLUDE) --noout --valid $(word 2,$^) + $(XSLTPROC) $(XMLINCLUDE) $(XSLTPROCFLAGS) --stringparam paper.type USletter -o $@ $(wordlist 1,2,$^) %.pdf: %.fo $(FOP) -fo $< -pdf $@ @@ -213,7 +173,7 @@ postgres.pdf: ## epub: postgres.epub -postgres.epub: postgres.xml +postgres.epub: postgres.sgml $(ALLSGML) $(XMLLINT) --noout --valid $< $(DBTOEPUB) $< @@ -226,7 +186,8 @@ DB2X_TEXIXML = db2x_texixml DB2X_XSLTPROC = db2x_xsltproc MAKEINFO = makeinfo -%.texixml: %.xml +%.texixml: %.sgml $(ALLSGML) + $(XMLLINT) --noout --valid $< $(DB2X_XSLTPROC) -s texi -g output-file=$(basename $@) $< -o $@ %.texi: %.texixml @@ -242,7 +203,7 @@ MAKEINFO = makeinfo # Quick syntax check without style processing check: postgres.sgml $(ALLSGML) check-tabs - $(NSGMLS) $(SPFLAGS) $(SGMLINCLUDE) -s $< + $(XMLLINT) $(XMLINCLUDE) --noout --valid $< ## @@ -312,7 +273,7 @@ check-tabs: # This allows removing some files from the distribution tarballs while # keeping the dependencies satisfied. -.SECONDARY: postgres.xml $(GENERATED_SGML) +.SECONDARY: $(GENERATED_SGML) .SECONDARY: INSTALL.html INSTALL.xml .SECONDARY: postgres-A4.fo postgres-US.fo @@ -326,8 +287,6 @@ clean: rm -f *.fo *.pdf # generated SGML files rm -f $(GENERATED_SGML) -# SGML->XML conversion - rm -f postgres.xml *.tmp # HTML Help rm -f htmlhelp.hhp toc.hhc index.hhk # EPUB diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/adminpack.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/adminpack.sgml index b27a4a325d9..1197eefbf31 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/adminpack.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/adminpack.sgml @@ -16,9 +16,9 @@ </para> <para> - The functions shown in <xref linkend="functions-adminpack-table"> provide + The functions shown in <xref linkend="functions-adminpack-table"/> provide write access to files on the machine hosting the server. (See also the - functions in <xref linkend="functions-admin-genfile-table">, which + functions in <xref linkend="functions-admin-genfile-table"/>, which provide read-only access.) Only files within the database cluster directory can be accessed, but either a relative or absolute path is allowable. @@ -107,18 +107,18 @@ </indexterm> <para> <function>pg_logdir_ls</function> returns the start timestamps and path - names of all the log files in the <xref linkend="guc-log-directory"> - directory. The <xref linkend="guc-log-filename"> parameter must have its + names of all the log files in the <xref linkend="guc-log-directory"/> + directory. The <xref linkend="guc-log-filename"/> parameter must have its default setting (<literal>postgresql-%Y-%m-%d_%H%M%S.log</literal>) to use this function. </para> <para> The functions shown - in <xref linkend="functions-adminpack-deprecated-table"> are deprecated + in <xref linkend="functions-adminpack-deprecated-table"/> are deprecated and should not be used in new applications; instead use those shown - in <xref linkend="functions-admin-signal-table"> - and <xref linkend="functions-admin-genfile-table">. These functions are + in <xref linkend="functions-admin-signal-table"/> + and <xref linkend="functions-admin-genfile-table"/>. These functions are provided in <filename>adminpack</filename> only for compatibility with old versions of <application>pgAdmin</application>. </para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/advanced.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/advanced.sgml index bf87df4dcb1..ae5f3fac75e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/advanced.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/advanced.sgml @@ -18,12 +18,12 @@ <para> This chapter will on occasion refer to examples found in <xref - linkend="tutorial-sql"> to change or improve them, so it will be + linkend="tutorial-sql"/> to change or improve them, so it will be useful to have read that chapter. Some examples from this chapter can also be found in <filename>advanced.sql</filename> in the tutorial directory. This file also contains some sample data to load, which is not - repeated here. (Refer to <xref linkend="tutorial-sql-intro"> for + repeated here. (Refer to <xref linkend="tutorial-sql-intro"/> for how to use the file.) </para> </sect1> @@ -37,7 +37,7 @@ </indexterm> <para> - Refer back to the queries in <xref linkend="tutorial-join">. + Refer back to the queries in <xref linkend="tutorial-join"/>. Suppose the combined listing of weather records and city location is of particular interest to your application, but you do not want to type the query each time you need it. You can create a @@ -82,7 +82,7 @@ SELECT * FROM myview; <para> Recall the <classname>weather</classname> and <classname>cities</classname> tables from <xref - linkend="tutorial-sql">. Consider the following problem: You + linkend="tutorial-sql"/>. Consider the following problem: You want to make sure that no one can insert rows in the <classname>weather</classname> table that do not have a matching entry in the <classname>cities</classname> table. This is called @@ -129,7 +129,7 @@ DETAIL: Key (city)=(Berkeley) is not present in table "cities". <para> The behavior of foreign keys can be finely tuned to your application. We will not go beyond this simple example in this - tutorial, but just refer you to <xref linkend="ddl"> + tutorial, but just refer you to <xref linkend="ddl"/> for more information. Making correct use of foreign keys will definitely improve the quality of your database applications, so you are strongly encouraged to learn about them. @@ -447,7 +447,7 @@ FROM empsalary; <para> There are options to define the window frame in other ways, but this tutorial does not cover them. See - <xref linkend="syntax-window-functions"> for details. + <xref linkend="syntax-window-functions"/> for details. </para> </footnote> Here is an example using <function>sum</function>: @@ -554,10 +554,10 @@ SELECT sum(salary) OVER w, avg(salary) OVER w <para> More details about window functions can be found in - <xref linkend="syntax-window-functions">, - <xref linkend="functions-window">, - <xref linkend="queries-window">, and the - <xref linkend="sql-select"> reference page. + <xref linkend="syntax-window-functions"/>, + <xref linkend="functions-window"/>, + <xref linkend="queries-window"/>, and the + <xref linkend="sql-select"/> reference page. </para> </sect1> @@ -692,7 +692,7 @@ SELECT name, altitude <para> Although inheritance is frequently useful, it has not been integrated with unique constraints or foreign keys, which limits its usefulness. - See <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> for more detail. + See <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"/> for more detail. </para> </note> </sect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/amcheck.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/amcheck.sgml index 0dd68f0ba14..852e260c098 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/amcheck.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/amcheck.sgml @@ -31,7 +31,7 @@ index scans themselves, which may be user-defined operator class code. For example, B-Tree index verification relies on comparisons made with one or more B-Tree support function 1 routines. See <xref - linkend="xindex-support"> for details of operator class support + linkend="xindex-support"/> for details of operator class support functions. </para> <para> @@ -192,7 +192,7 @@ ORDER BY c.relpages DESC LIMIT 10; index that is ordered using an affected collation, simply because <emphasis>indexed</emphasis> values might happen to have the same absolute ordering regardless of the behavioral inconsistency. See - <xref linkend="locale"> and <xref linkend="collation"> for + <xref linkend="locale"/> and <xref linkend="collation"/> for further details about how <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> uses operating system locales and collations. </para> @@ -210,7 +210,7 @@ ORDER BY c.relpages DESC LIMIT 10; logical inconsistency to be introduced. One obvious testing strategy is to call <filename>amcheck</filename> functions continuously when running the standard regression tests. See <xref - linkend="regress-run"> for details on running the tests. + linkend="regress-run"/> for details on running the tests. </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -263,7 +263,7 @@ ORDER BY c.relpages DESC LIMIT 10; There is no general method of repairing problems that <filename>amcheck</filename> detects. An explanation for the root cause of an invariant violation should be sought. <xref - linkend="pageinspect"> may play a useful role in diagnosing + linkend="pageinspect"/> may play a useful role in diagnosing corruption that <filename>amcheck</filename> detects. A <command>REINDEX</command> may not be effective in repairing corruption. </para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/arch-dev.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/arch-dev.sgml index d49901c6900..53f8049df38 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/arch-dev.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/arch-dev.sgml @@ -7,7 +7,7 @@ <title>Author</title> <para> This chapter originated as part of - <xref linkend="sim98">, Stefan Simkovics' + <xref linkend="sim98"/>, Stefan Simkovics' Master's Thesis prepared at Vienna University of Technology under the direction of O.Univ.Prof.Dr. Georg Gottlob and Univ.Ass. Mag. Katrin Seyr. </para> @@ -136,7 +136,7 @@ <para> The client process can be any program that understands the <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> protocol described in - <xref linkend="protocol">. Many clients are based on the + <xref linkend="protocol"/>. Many clients are based on the C-language library <application>libpq</application>, but several independent implementations of the protocol exist, such as the Java <application>JDBC</application> driver. @@ -317,7 +317,7 @@ <para> The query rewriter is discussed in some detail in - <xref linkend="rules">, so there is no need to cover it here. + <xref linkend="rules"/>, so there is no need to cover it here. We will only point out that both the input and the output of the rewriter are query trees, that is, there is no change in the representation or level of semantic detail in the trees. Rewriting @@ -347,8 +347,8 @@ involving large numbers of join operations. In order to determine a reasonable (not necessarily optimal) query plan in a reasonable amount of time, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> uses a <firstterm>Genetic - Query Optimizer</firstterm> (see <xref linkend="geqo">) when the number of joins - exceeds a threshold (see <xref linkend="guc-geqo-threshold">). + Query Optimizer</firstterm> (see <xref linkend="geqo"/>) when the number of joins + exceeds a threshold (see <xref linkend="guc-geqo-threshold"/>). </para> </note> @@ -438,7 +438,7 @@ </para> <para> - If the query uses fewer than <xref linkend="guc-geqo-threshold"> + If the query uses fewer than <xref linkend="guc-geqo-threshold"/> relations, a near-exhaustive search is conducted to find the best join sequence. The planner preferentially considers joins between any two relations for which there exist a corresponding join clause in the @@ -454,7 +454,7 @@ <para> When <varname>geqo_threshold</varname> is exceeded, the join sequences considered are determined by heuristics, as described - in <xref linkend="geqo">. Otherwise the process is the same. + in <xref linkend="geqo"/>. Otherwise the process is the same. </para> <para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/array.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/array.sgml index 9187f6e02e7..f4d4a610ef3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/array.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/array.sgml @@ -128,7 +128,7 @@ CREATE TABLE tictactoe ( <para> (These kinds of array constants are actually only a special case of the generic type constants discussed in <xref - linkend="sql-syntax-constants-generic">. The constant is initially + linkend="sql-syntax-constants-generic"/>. The constant is initially treated as a string and passed to the array input conversion routine. An explicit type specification might be necessary.) </para> @@ -192,7 +192,7 @@ INSERT INTO sal_emp expressions; for instance, string literals are single quoted, instead of double quoted as they would be in an array literal. The <literal>ARRAY</literal> constructor syntax is discussed in more detail in - <xref linkend="sql-syntax-array-constructors">. + <xref linkend="sql-syntax-array-constructors"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -616,7 +616,7 @@ SELECT * FROM sal_emp WHERE pay_by_quarter[1] = 10000 OR However, this quickly becomes tedious for large arrays, and is not helpful if the size of the array is unknown. An alternative method is - described in <xref linkend="functions-comparisons">. The above + described in <xref linkend="functions-comparisons"/>. The above query could be replaced by: <programlisting> @@ -644,7 +644,7 @@ SELECT * FROM WHERE pay_by_quarter[s] = 10000; </programlisting> - This function is described in <xref linkend="functions-srf-subscripts">. + This function is described in <xref linkend="functions-srf-subscripts"/>. </para> <para> @@ -657,8 +657,8 @@ SELECT * FROM sal_emp WHERE pay_by_quarter && ARRAY[10000]; </programlisting> This and other array operators are further described in - <xref linkend="functions-array">. It can be accelerated by an appropriate - index, as described in <xref linkend="indexes-types">. + <xref linkend="functions-array"/>. It can be accelerated by an appropriate + index, as described in <xref linkend="indexes-types"/>. </para> <para> @@ -755,7 +755,7 @@ SELECT f1[1][-2][3] AS e1, f1[1][-1][5] AS e2 or backslashes disables this and allows the literal string value <quote>NULL</quote> to be entered. Also, for backward compatibility with pre-8.2 versions of <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>, the <xref - linkend="guc-array-nulls"> configuration parameter can be turned + linkend="guc-array-nulls"/> configuration parameter can be turned <literal>off</literal> to suppress recognition of <literal>NULL</literal> as a NULL. </para> @@ -797,7 +797,7 @@ INSERT ... VALUES (E'{"\\\\","\\""}'); with a data type whose input routine also treated backslashes specially, <type>bytea</type> for example, we might need as many as eight backslashes in the command to get one backslash into the stored array element.) - Dollar quoting (see <xref linkend="sql-syntax-dollar-quoting">) can be + Dollar quoting (see <xref linkend="sql-syntax-dollar-quoting"/>) can be used to avoid the need to double backslashes. </para> </note> @@ -805,7 +805,7 @@ INSERT ... VALUES (E'{"\\\\","\\""}'); <tip> <para> The <literal>ARRAY</literal> constructor syntax (see - <xref linkend="sql-syntax-array-constructors">) is often easier to work + <xref linkend="sql-syntax-array-constructors"/>) is often easier to work with than the array-literal syntax when writing array values in SQL commands. In <literal>ARRAY</literal>, individual element values are written the same way they would be written when not members of an array. diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/auth-delay.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/auth-delay.sgml index 9221d2dfb65..bd3ef7128d5 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/auth-delay.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/auth-delay.sgml @@ -18,7 +18,7 @@ <para> In order to function, this module must be loaded via - <xref linkend="guc-shared-preload-libraries"> in <filename>postgresql.conf</filename>. + <xref linkend="guc-shared-preload-libraries"/> in <filename>postgresql.conf</filename>. </para> <sect2> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/auto-explain.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/auto-explain.sgml index 240098c82f7..08b67f2600b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/auto-explain.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/auto-explain.sgml @@ -10,7 +10,7 @@ <para> The <filename>auto_explain</filename> module provides a means for logging execution plans of slow statements automatically, without - having to run <xref linkend="sql-explain"> + having to run <xref linkend="sql-explain"/> by hand. This is especially helpful for tracking down un-optimized queries in large applications. </para> @@ -25,8 +25,8 @@ LOAD 'auto_explain'; (You must be superuser to do that.) More typical usage is to preload it into some or all sessions by including <literal>auto_explain</literal> in - <xref linkend="guc-session-preload-libraries"> or - <xref linkend="guc-shared-preload-libraries"> in + <xref linkend="guc-session-preload-libraries"/> or + <xref linkend="guc-shared-preload-libraries"/> in <filename>postgresql.conf</filename>. Then you can track unexpectedly slow queries no matter when they happen. Of course there is a price in overhead for that. diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml index 39bb25c8e24..9d8e69056f7 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml @@ -32,7 +32,7 @@ commands that, when fed back to the server, will recreate the database in the same state as it was at the time of the dump. <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> provides the utility program - <xref linkend="app-pgdump"> for this purpose. The basic usage of this + <xref linkend="app-pgdump"/> for this purpose. The basic usage of this command is: <synopsis> pg_dump <replaceable class="parameter">dbname</replaceable> > <replaceable class="parameter">outfile</replaceable> @@ -79,7 +79,7 @@ pg_dump <replaceable class="parameter">dbname</replaceable> > <replaceable cl environment variable <envar>PGUSER</envar>. Remember that <application>pg_dump</application> connections are subject to the normal client authentication mechanisms (which are described in <xref - linkend="client-authentication">). + linkend="client-authentication"/>). </para> <para> @@ -120,9 +120,9 @@ psql <replaceable class="parameter">dbname</replaceable> < <replaceable class class="parameter">dbname</replaceable></literal>). <application>psql</application> supports options similar to <application>pg_dump</application> for specifying the database server to connect to and the user name to use. See - the <xref linkend="app-psql"> reference page for more information. + the <xref linkend="app-psql"/> reference page for more information. Non-text file dumps are restored using the <xref - linkend="app-pgrestore"> utility. + linkend="app-pgrestore"/> utility. </para> <para> @@ -178,13 +178,13 @@ pg_dump -h <replaceable>host1</replaceable> <replaceable>dbname</replaceable> | <para> After restoring a backup, it is wise to run <xref - linkend="sql-analyze"> on each + linkend="sql-analyze"/> on each database so the query optimizer has useful statistics; - see <xref linkend="vacuum-for-statistics"> - and <xref linkend="autovacuum"> for more information. + see <xref linkend="vacuum-for-statistics"/> + and <xref linkend="autovacuum"/> for more information. For more advice on how to load large amounts of data into <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> efficiently, refer to <xref - linkend="populate">. + linkend="populate"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -196,7 +196,7 @@ pg_dump -h <replaceable>host1</replaceable> <replaceable>dbname</replaceable> | and it does not dump information about roles or tablespaces (because those are cluster-wide rather than per-database). To support convenient dumping of the entire contents of a database - cluster, the <xref linkend="app-pg-dumpall"> program is provided. + cluster, the <xref linkend="app-pg-dumpall"/> program is provided. <application>pg_dumpall</application> backs up each database in a given cluster, and also preserves cluster-wide data such as role and tablespace definitions. The basic usage of this command is: @@ -308,8 +308,8 @@ pg_dump -Fc <replaceable class="parameter">dbname</replaceable> > <replaceabl pg_restore -d <replaceable class="parameter">dbname</replaceable> <replaceable class="parameter">filename</replaceable> </programlisting> - See the <xref linkend="app-pgdump"> and <xref - linkend="app-pgrestore"> reference pages for details. + See the <xref linkend="app-pgdump"/> and <xref + linkend="app-pgrestore"/> reference pages for details. </para> </formalpara> @@ -345,7 +345,7 @@ pg_dump -j <replaceable class="parameter">num</replaceable> -F d -f <replaceable <para> An alternative backup strategy is to directly copy the files that <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> uses to store the data in the database; - <xref linkend="creating-cluster"> explains where these files + <xref linkend="creating-cluster"/> explains where these files are located. You can use whatever method you prefer for doing file system backups; for example: @@ -369,7 +369,7 @@ tar -cf backup.tar /usr/local/pgsql/data an atomic snapshot of the state of the file system, but also because of internal buffering within the server). Information about stopping the server can be found in - <xref linkend="server-shutdown">. Needless to say, you + <xref linkend="server-shutdown"/>. Needless to say, you also need to shut down the server before restoring the data. </para> </listitem> @@ -428,10 +428,10 @@ tar -cf backup.tar /usr/local/pgsql/data If simultaneous snapshots are not possible, one option is to shut down the database server long enough to establish all the frozen snapshots. Another option is to perform a continuous archiving base backup (<xref - linkend="backup-base-backup">) because such backups are immune to file + linkend="backup-base-backup"/>) because such backups are immune to file system changes during the backup. This requires enabling continuous archiving just during the backup process; restore is done using - continuous archive recovery (<xref linkend="backup-pitr-recovery">). + continuous archive recovery (<xref linkend="backup-pitr-recovery"/>). </para> <para> @@ -591,11 +591,11 @@ tar -cf backup.tar /usr/local/pgsql/data </para> <para> - To enable WAL archiving, set the <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"> + To enable WAL archiving, set the <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"/> configuration parameter to <literal>replica</literal> or higher, - <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"> to <literal>on</literal>, + <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"/> to <literal>on</literal>, and specify the shell command to use in the <xref - linkend="guc-archive-command"> configuration parameter. In practice + linkend="guc-archive-command"/> configuration parameter. In practice these settings will always be placed in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> file. In <varname>archive_command</varname>, @@ -705,7 +705,7 @@ test ! -f /mnt/server/archivedir/00000001000000A900000065 && cp pg_wal/0 than through SQL operations. You might wish to keep the configuration files in a location that will be backed up by your regular file system backup procedures. See - <xref linkend="runtime-config-file-locations"> for how to relocate the + <xref linkend="runtime-config-file-locations"/> for how to relocate the configuration files. </para> @@ -715,7 +715,7 @@ test ! -f /mnt/server/archivedir/00000001000000A900000065 && cp pg_wal/0 where it does so), there could be a long delay between the completion of a transaction and its safe recording in archive storage. To put a limit on how old unarchived data can be, you can set - <xref linkend="guc-archive-timeout"> to force the server to switch + <xref linkend="guc-archive-timeout"/> to force the server to switch to a new WAL segment file at least that often. Note that archived files that are archived early due to a forced switch are still the same length as completely full files. It is therefore unwise to set a very @@ -729,13 +729,13 @@ test ! -f /mnt/server/archivedir/00000001000000A900000065 && cp pg_wal/0 <function>pg_switch_wal</function> if you want to ensure that a just-finished transaction is archived as soon as possible. Other utility functions related to WAL management are listed in <xref - linkend="functions-admin-backup-table">. + linkend="functions-admin-backup-table"/>. </para> <para> When <varname>wal_level</varname> is <literal>minimal</literal> some SQL commands are optimized to avoid WAL logging, as described in <xref - linkend="populate-pitr">. If archiving or streaming replication were + linkend="populate-pitr"/>. If archiving or streaming replication were turned on during execution of one of these statements, WAL would not contain enough information for archive recovery. (Crash recovery is unaffected.) For this reason, <varname>wal_level</varname> can only be changed at @@ -753,11 +753,11 @@ test ! -f /mnt/server/archivedir/00000001000000A900000065 && cp pg_wal/0 <para> The easiest way to perform a base backup is to use the - <xref linkend="app-pgbasebackup"> tool. It can create + <xref linkend="app-pgbasebackup"/> tool. It can create a base backup either as regular files or as a tar archive. If more - flexibility than <xref linkend="app-pgbasebackup"> can provide is + flexibility than <xref linkend="app-pgbasebackup"/> can provide is required, you can also make a base backup using the low level API - (see <xref linkend="backup-lowlevel-base-backup">). + (see <xref linkend="backup-lowlevel-base-backup"/>). </para> <para> @@ -791,7 +791,7 @@ test ! -f /mnt/server/archivedir/00000001000000A900000065 && cp pg_wal/0 <para> The backup history file is just a small text file. It contains the - label string you gave to <xref linkend="app-pgbasebackup">, as well as + label string you gave to <xref linkend="app-pgbasebackup"/>, as well as the starting and ending times and WAL segments of the backup. If you used the label to identify the associated dump file, then the archived history file is enough to tell you which dump file to @@ -814,7 +814,7 @@ test ! -f /mnt/server/archivedir/00000001000000A900000065 && cp pg_wal/0 <para> The procedure for making a base backup using the low level APIs contains a few more steps than - the <xref linkend="app-pgbasebackup"> method, but is relatively + the <xref linkend="app-pgbasebackup"/> method, but is relatively simple. It is very important that these steps are executed in sequence, and that the success of a step is verified before proceeding to the next step. @@ -830,7 +830,7 @@ test ! -f /mnt/server/archivedir/00000001000000A900000065 && cp pg_wal/0 A non-exclusive low level backup is one that allows other concurrent backups to be running (both those started using the same backup API and those started using - <xref linkend="app-pgbasebackup">). + <xref linkend="app-pgbasebackup"/>). </para> <para> <orderedlist> @@ -859,7 +859,7 @@ SELECT pg_start_backup('label', false, false); required for the checkpoint will be spread out over a significant period of time, by default half your inter-checkpoint interval (see the configuration parameter - <xref linkend="guc-checkpoint-completion-target">). This is + <xref linkend="guc-checkpoint-completion-target"/>). This is usually what you want, because it minimizes the impact on query processing. If you want to start the backup as soon as possible, change the second parameter to <literal>true</literal>, which will @@ -879,7 +879,7 @@ SELECT pg_start_backup('label', false, false); <application>pg_dumpall</application>). It is neither necessary nor desirable to stop normal operation of the database while you do this. See - <xref linkend="backup-lowlevel-base-backup-data"> for things to + <xref linkend="backup-lowlevel-base-backup-data"/> for things to consider during this backup. </para> </listitem> @@ -989,7 +989,7 @@ SELECT pg_start_backup('label'); required for the checkpoint will be spread out over a significant period of time, by default half your inter-checkpoint interval (see the configuration parameter - <xref linkend="guc-checkpoint-completion-target">). This is + <xref linkend="guc-checkpoint-completion-target"/>). This is usually what you want, because it minimizes the impact on query processing. If you want to start the backup as soon as possible, use: @@ -1007,7 +1007,7 @@ SELECT pg_start_backup('label', true); <application>pg_dumpall</application>). It is neither necessary nor desirable to stop normal operation of the database while you do this. See - <xref linkend="backup-lowlevel-base-backup-data"> for things to + <xref linkend="backup-lowlevel-base-backup-data"/> for things to consider during this backup. </para> <para> @@ -1119,7 +1119,7 @@ SELECT pg_stop_backup(); <filename>pg_snapshots/</filename>, <filename>pg_stat_tmp/</filename>, and <filename>pg_subtrans/</filename> (but not the directories themselves) can be omitted from the backup as they will be initialized on postmaster startup. - If <xref linkend="guc-stats-temp-directory"> is set and is under the data + If <xref linkend="guc-stats-temp-directory"/> is set and is under the data directory then the contents of that directory can also be omitted. </para> @@ -1221,7 +1221,7 @@ SELECT pg_stop_backup(); <listitem> <para> Create a recovery command file <filename>recovery.conf</filename> in the cluster - data directory (see <xref linkend="recovery-config">). You might + data directory (see <xref linkend="recovery-config"/>). You might also want to temporarily modify <filename>pg_hba.conf</filename> to prevent ordinary users from connecting until you are sure the recovery was successful. </para> @@ -1310,7 +1310,7 @@ restore_command = 'cp /mnt/server/archivedir/%f %p' at the start of recovery for a file named something like <filename>00000001.history</filename>. This is also normal and does not indicate a problem in simple recovery situations; see - <xref linkend="backup-timelines"> for discussion. + <xref linkend="backup-timelines"/> for discussion. </para> <para> @@ -1440,7 +1440,7 @@ restore_command = 'cp /mnt/server/archivedir/%f %p' <para> As with base backups, the easiest way to produce a standalone - hot backup is to use the <xref linkend="app-pgbasebackup"> + hot backup is to use the <xref linkend="app-pgbasebackup"/> tool. If you include the <literal>-X</literal> parameter when calling it, all the write-ahead log required to use the backup will be included in the backup automatically, and no special action is @@ -1548,7 +1548,7 @@ archive_command = 'local_backup_script.sh "%p" "%f"' <tip> <para> When using an <varname>archive_command</varname> script, it's desirable - to enable <xref linkend="guc-logging-collector">. + to enable <xref linkend="guc-logging-collector"/>. Any messages written to <systemitem>stderr</systemitem> from the script will then appear in the database server log, allowing complex configurations to be diagnosed easily if they fail. @@ -1567,7 +1567,7 @@ archive_command = 'local_backup_script.sh "%p" "%f"' <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> - If a <xref linkend="sql-createdatabase"> + If a <xref linkend="sql-createdatabase"/> command is executed while a base backup is being taken, and then the template database that the <command>CREATE DATABASE</command> copied is modified while the base backup is still in progress, it is @@ -1580,7 +1580,7 @@ archive_command = 'local_backup_script.sh "%p" "%f"' <listitem> <para> - <xref linkend="sql-createtablespace"> + <xref linkend="sql-createtablespace"/> commands are WAL-logged with the literal absolute path, and will therefore be replayed as tablespace creations with the same absolute path. This might be undesirable if the log is being @@ -1603,8 +1603,8 @@ archive_command = 'local_backup_script.sh "%p" "%f"' your system hardware and software, the risk of partial writes might be small enough to ignore, in which case you can significantly reduce the total volume of archived logs by turning off page - snapshots using the <xref linkend="guc-full-page-writes"> - parameter. (Read the notes and warnings in <xref linkend="wal"> + snapshots using the <xref linkend="guc-full-page-writes"/> + parameter. (Read the notes and warnings in <xref linkend="wal"/> before you do so.) Turning off page snapshots does not prevent use of the logs for PITR operations. An area for future development is to compress archived WAL data by removing diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/bgworker.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/bgworker.sgml index 0b092f6e492..4bc2b696b3f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/bgworker.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/bgworker.sgml @@ -286,6 +286,6 @@ typedef struct BackgroundWorker <para> The maximum number of registered background workers is limited by - <xref linkend="guc-max-worker-processes">. + <xref linkend="guc-max-worker-processes"/>. </para> </chapter> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/brin.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/brin.sgml index b7483df4c08..23c0e05ed6c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/brin.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/brin.sgml @@ -95,7 +95,7 @@ <para> The core <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> distribution includes the <acronym>BRIN</acronym> operator classes shown in - <xref linkend="brin-builtin-opclasses-table">. + <xref linkend="brin-builtin-opclasses-table"/>. </para> <para> @@ -590,7 +590,7 @@ typedef struct BrinOpcInfo To write an operator class for a data type that implements a totally ordered set, it is possible to use the minmax support procedures alongside the corresponding operators, as shown in - <xref linkend="brin-extensibility-minmax-table">. + <xref linkend="brin-extensibility-minmax-table"/>. All operator class members (procedures and operators) are mandatory. </para> @@ -648,7 +648,7 @@ typedef struct BrinOpcInfo To write an operator class for a complex data type which has values included within another type, it's possible to use the inclusion support procedures alongside the corresponding operators, as shown - in <xref linkend="brin-extensibility-inclusion-table">. It requires + in <xref linkend="brin-extensibility-inclusion-table"/>. It requires only a single additional function, which can be written in any language. More functions can be defined for additional functionality. All operators are optional. Some operators require other operators, as shown as @@ -821,7 +821,7 @@ typedef struct BrinOpcInfo additional data types to be supported by defining extra sets of operators. Inclusion operator class operator strategies are dependent on another operator strategy as shown in - <xref linkend="brin-extensibility-inclusion-table">, or the same + <xref linkend="brin-extensibility-inclusion-table"/>, or the same operator strategy as themselves. They require the dependency operator to be defined with the <literal>STORAGE</literal> data type as the left-hand-side argument and the other supported data type to be the diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/catalogs.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/catalogs.sgml index ef60a58631a..da881a77371 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/catalogs.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/catalogs.sgml @@ -27,7 +27,7 @@ <title>Overview</title> <para> - <xref linkend="catalog-table"> lists the system catalogs. + <xref linkend="catalog-table"/> lists the system catalogs. More detailed documentation of each catalog follows below. </para> @@ -567,8 +567,8 @@ <para> New aggregate functions are registered with the <xref - linkend="sql-createaggregate"> - command. See <xref linkend="xaggr"> for more information about + linkend="sql-createaggregate"/> + command. See <xref linkend="xaggr"/> for more information about writing aggregate functions and the meaning of the transition functions, etc. </para> @@ -588,7 +588,7 @@ relation access methods. There is one row for each access method supported by the system. Currently, only indexes have access methods. The requirements for index - access methods are discussed in detail in <xref linkend="indexam">. + access methods are discussed in detail in <xref linkend="indexam"/>. </para> <table> @@ -649,7 +649,7 @@ methods. That data is now only directly visible at the C code level. However, <function>pg_index_column_has_property()</function> and related functions have been added to allow SQL queries to inspect index access - method properties; see <xref linkend="functions-info-catalog-table">. + method properties; see <xref linkend="functions-info-catalog-table"/>. </para> </note> @@ -1034,7 +1034,7 @@ <entry> <structfield>attstattarget</structfield> controls the level of detail of statistics accumulated for this column by - <xref linkend="sql-analyze">. + <xref linkend="sql-analyze"/>. A zero value indicates that no statistics should be collected. A negative value says to use the system default statistics target. The exact meaning of positive values is data type-dependent. @@ -1270,7 +1270,7 @@ </para> <para> - <xref linkend="user-manag"> contains detailed information about user and + <xref linkend="user-manag"/> contains detailed information about user and privilege management. </para> @@ -1356,7 +1356,7 @@ <entry><type>bool</type></entry> <entry> Role bypasses every row level security policy, see - <xref linkend="ddl-rowsecurity"> for more information. + <xref linkend="ddl-rowsecurity"/> for more information. </entry> </row> @@ -1964,8 +1964,8 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <entry></entry> <entry> Access privileges; see - <xref linkend="sql-grant"> and - <xref linkend="sql-revoke"> + <xref linkend="sql-grant"/> and + <xref linkend="sql-revoke"/> for details </entry> </row> @@ -2015,7 +2015,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l The catalog <structname>pg_collation</structname> describes the available collations, which are essentially mappings from an SQL name to operating system locale categories. - See <xref linkend="collation"> for more information. + See <xref linkend="collation"/> for more information. </para> <table> @@ -2424,7 +2424,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <para> The catalog <structname>pg_conversion</structname> describes - encoding conversion procedures. See <xref linkend="sql-createconversion"> + encoding conversion procedures. See <xref linkend="sql-createconversion"/> for more information. </para> @@ -2516,8 +2516,8 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <para> The catalog <structname>pg_database</structname> stores information about the available databases. Databases are created with the <xref - linkend="sql-createdatabase"> command. - Consult <xref linkend="managing-databases"> for details about the meaning + linkend="sql-createdatabase"/> command. + Consult <xref linkend="managing-databases"/> for details about the meaning of some of the parameters. </para> @@ -2675,8 +2675,8 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <entry></entry> <entry> Access privileges; see - <xref linkend="sql-grant"> and - <xref linkend="sql-revoke"> + <xref linkend="sql-grant"/> and + <xref linkend="sql-revoke"/> for details </entry> </row> @@ -3053,7 +3053,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <para> The catalog <structname>pg_description</structname> stores optional descriptions (comments) for each database object. Descriptions can be manipulated - with the <xref linkend="sql-comment"> command and viewed with + with the <xref linkend="sql-comment"/> command and viewed with <application>psql</application>'s <literal>\d</literal> commands. Descriptions of many built-in system objects are provided in the initial contents of <structname>pg_description</structname>. @@ -3208,7 +3208,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <para> The catalog <structname>pg_event_trigger</structname> stores event triggers. - See <xref linkend="event-triggers"> for more information. + See <xref linkend="event-triggers"/> for more information. </para> <table> @@ -3258,7 +3258,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <entry><type>char</type></entry> <entry></entry> <entry> - Controls in which <xref linkend="guc-session-replication-role"> modes + Controls in which <xref linkend="guc-session-replication-role"/> modes the event trigger fires. <literal>O</literal> = trigger fires in <quote>origin</quote> and <quote>local</quote> modes, <literal>D</literal> = trigger is disabled, @@ -3291,7 +3291,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <para> The catalog <structname>pg_extension</structname> stores information - about the installed extensions. See <xref linkend="extend-extensions"> + about the installed extensions. See <xref linkend="extend-extensions"/> for details about extensions. </para> @@ -3463,8 +3463,8 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <entry></entry> <entry> Access privileges; see - <xref linkend="sql-grant"> and - <xref linkend="sql-revoke"> + <xref linkend="sql-grant"/> and + <xref linkend="sql-revoke"/> for details </entry> </row> @@ -3559,8 +3559,8 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <entry></entry> <entry> Access privileges; see - <xref linkend="sql-grant"> and - <xref linkend="sql-revoke"> + <xref linkend="sql-grant"/> and + <xref linkend="sql-revoke"/> for details </entry> </row> @@ -4011,8 +4011,8 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <entry></entry> <entry> The initial access privileges; see - <xref linkend="sql-grant"> and - <xref linkend="sql-revoke"> + <xref linkend="sql-grant"/> and + <xref linkend="sql-revoke"/> for details </entry> </row> @@ -4034,8 +4034,8 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <para> The catalog <structname>pg_language</structname> registers languages in which you can write functions or stored procedures. - See <xref linkend="sql-createlanguage"> - and <xref linkend="xplang"> for more information about language handlers. + See <xref linkend="sql-createlanguage"/> + and <xref linkend="xplang"/> for more information about language handlers. </para> <table> @@ -4117,7 +4117,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <entry> This references a function that is responsible for executing <quote>inline</quote> anonymous code blocks - (<xref linkend="sql-do"> blocks). + (<xref linkend="sql-do"/> blocks). Zero if inline blocks are not supported. </entry> </row> @@ -4139,8 +4139,8 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <entry></entry> <entry> Access privileges; see - <xref linkend="sql-grant"> and - <xref linkend="sql-revoke"> + <xref linkend="sql-grant"/> and + <xref linkend="sql-revoke"/> for details </entry> </row> @@ -4279,8 +4279,8 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <entry></entry> <entry> Access privileges; see - <xref linkend="sql-grant"> and - <xref linkend="sql-revoke"> + <xref linkend="sql-grant"/> and + <xref linkend="sql-revoke"/> for details </entry> </row> @@ -4346,8 +4346,8 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <entry></entry> <entry> Access privileges; see - <xref linkend="sql-grant"> and - <xref linkend="sql-revoke"> + <xref linkend="sql-grant"/> and + <xref linkend="sql-revoke"/> for details </entry> </row> @@ -4377,7 +4377,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l </para> <para> - Operator classes are described at length in <xref linkend="xindex">. + Operator classes are described at length in <xref linkend="xindex"/>. </para> <table> @@ -4481,8 +4481,8 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <para> The catalog <structname>pg_operator</structname> stores information about operators. - See <xref linkend="sql-createoperator"> - and <xref linkend="xoper"> for more information. + See <xref linkend="sql-createoperator"/> + and <xref linkend="xoper"/> for more information. </para> <table> @@ -4639,7 +4639,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l </para> <para> - Operator families are described at length in <xref linkend="xindex">. + Operator families are described at length in <xref linkend="xindex"/>. </para> <table> @@ -5040,8 +5040,8 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <para> The catalog <structname>pg_proc</structname> stores information about functions (or procedures). - See <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"> - and <xref linkend="xfunc"> for more information. + See <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"/> + and <xref linkend="xfunc"/> for more information. </para> <para> @@ -5106,7 +5106,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <entry><type>float4</type></entry> <entry></entry> <entry>Estimated execution cost (in units of - <xref linkend="guc-cpu-operator-cost">); if <structfield>proretset</structfield>, + <xref linkend="guc-cpu-operator-cost"/>); if <structfield>proretset</structfield>, this is cost per row returned</entry> </row> @@ -5130,7 +5130,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <entry><type>regproc</type></entry> <entry><literal><link linkend="catalog-pg-proc"><structname>pg_proc</structname></link>.oid</literal></entry> <entry>Calls to this function can be simplified by this other function - (see <xref linkend="xfunc-transform-functions">)</entry> + (see <xref linkend="xfunc-transform-functions"/>)</entry> </row> <row> @@ -5359,8 +5359,8 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <entry></entry> <entry> Access privileges; see - <xref linkend="sql-grant"> and - <xref linkend="sql-revoke"> + <xref linkend="sql-grant"/> and + <xref linkend="sql-revoke"/> for details </entry> </row> @@ -5390,7 +5390,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <para> The catalog <structname>pg_publication</structname> contains all publications created in the database. For more on publications see - <xref linkend="logical-replication-publication">. + <xref linkend="logical-replication-publication"/>. </para> <table> @@ -5475,7 +5475,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <para> The catalog <structname>pg_publication_rel</structname> contains the mapping between relations and publications in the database. This is a - many-to-many mapping. See also <xref linkend="view-pg-publication-tables"> + many-to-many mapping. See also <xref linkend="view-pg-publication-tables"/> for a more user-friendly view of this information. </para> @@ -5605,7 +5605,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <para> The <structname>pg_replication_origin</structname> catalog contains all replication origins created. For more on replication origins - see <xref linkend="replication-origins">. + see <xref linkend="replication-origins"/>. </para> <table> @@ -5705,7 +5705,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <entry><type>char</type></entry> <entry></entry> <entry> - Controls in which <xref linkend="guc-session-replication-role"> modes + Controls in which <xref linkend="guc-session-replication-role"/> modes the rule fires. <literal>O</literal> = rule fires in <quote>origin</quote> and <quote>local</quote> modes, <literal>D</literal> = rule is disabled, @@ -5765,8 +5765,8 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <para> The catalog <structname>pg_seclabel</structname> stores security labels on database objects. Security labels can be manipulated - with the <xref linkend="sql-security-label"> command. For an easier - way to view security labels, see <xref linkend="view-pg-seclabels">. + with the <xref linkend="sql-security-label"/> command. For an easier + way to view security labels, see <xref linkend="view-pg-seclabels"/>. </para> <para> @@ -6093,7 +6093,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <para> The catalog <structname>pg_shdescription</structname> stores optional descriptions (comments) for shared database objects. Descriptions can be - manipulated with the <xref linkend="sql-comment"> command and viewed with + manipulated with the <xref linkend="sql-comment"/> command and viewed with <application>psql</application>'s <literal>\d</literal> commands. </para> @@ -6160,8 +6160,8 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <para> The catalog <structname>pg_shseclabel</structname> stores security labels on shared database objects. Security labels can be manipulated - with the <xref linkend="sql-security-label"> command. For an easier - way to view security labels, see <xref linkend="view-pg-seclabels">. + with the <xref linkend="sql-security-label"/> command. For an easier + way to view security labels, see <xref linkend="view-pg-seclabels"/>. </para> <para> @@ -6228,7 +6228,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <para> The catalog <structname>pg_statistic</structname> stores statistical data about the contents of the database. Entries are - created by <xref linkend="sql-analyze"> + created by <xref linkend="sql-analyze"/> and subsequently used by the query planner. Note that all the statistical data is inherently approximate, even assuming that it is up-to-date. @@ -6408,7 +6408,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l The catalog <structname>pg_statistic_ext</structname> holds extended planner statistics. Each row in this catalog corresponds to a <firstterm>statistics object</firstterm> - created with <xref linkend="sql-createstatistics">. + created with <xref linkend="sql-createstatistics"/>. </para> <table> @@ -6521,7 +6521,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <para> The catalog <structname>pg_subscription</structname> contains all existing logical replication subscriptions. For more information about logical - replication see <xref linkend="logical-replication">. + replication see <xref linkend="logical-replication"/>. </para> <para> @@ -6616,7 +6616,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <entry></entry> <entry>Array of subscribed publication names. These reference the publications on the publisher server. For more on publications - see <xref linkend="logical-replication-publication">. + see <xref linkend="logical-replication-publication"/>. </entry> </row> </tbody> @@ -6758,8 +6758,8 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <entry></entry> <entry> Access privileges; see - <xref linkend="sql-grant"> and - <xref linkend="sql-revoke"> + <xref linkend="sql-grant"/> and + <xref linkend="sql-revoke"/> for details </entry> </row> @@ -6788,7 +6788,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <para> The catalog <structname>pg_transform</structname> stores information about transforms, which are a mechanism to adapt data types to procedural - languages. See <xref linkend="sql-createtransform"> for more information. + languages. See <xref linkend="sql-createtransform"/> for more information. </para> <table> @@ -6856,7 +6856,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <para> The catalog <structname>pg_trigger</structname> stores triggers on tables and views. - See <xref linkend="sql-createtrigger"> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtrigger"/> for more information. </para> @@ -6914,7 +6914,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <entry><type>char</type></entry> <entry></entry> <entry> - Controls in which <xref linkend="guc-session-replication-role"> modes + Controls in which <xref linkend="guc-session-replication-role"/> modes the trigger fires. <literal>O</literal> = trigger fires in <quote>origin</quote> and <quote>local</quote> modes, <literal>D</literal> = trigger is disabled, @@ -7066,7 +7066,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <para> <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>'s text search features are - described at length in <xref linkend="textsearch">. + described at length in <xref linkend="textsearch"/>. </para> <table> @@ -7141,7 +7141,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <para> <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>'s text search features are - described at length in <xref linkend="textsearch">. + described at length in <xref linkend="textsearch"/>. </para> <table> @@ -7212,7 +7212,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <para> <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>'s text search features are - described at length in <xref linkend="textsearch">. + described at length in <xref linkend="textsearch"/>. </para> <table> @@ -7295,7 +7295,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <para> <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>'s text search features are - described at length in <xref linkend="textsearch">. + described at length in <xref linkend="textsearch"/>. </para> <table> @@ -7392,7 +7392,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <para> <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>'s text search features are - described at length in <xref linkend="textsearch">. + described at length in <xref linkend="textsearch"/>. </para> <table> @@ -7461,9 +7461,9 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <para> The catalog <structname>pg_type</structname> stores information about data types. Base types and enum types (scalar types) are created with - <xref linkend="sql-createtype">, and + <xref linkend="sql-createtype"/>, and domains with - <xref linkend="sql-createdomain">. + <xref linkend="sql-createdomain"/>. A composite type is automatically created for each table in the database, to represent the row structure of the table. It is also possible to create composite types with <command>CREATE TYPE AS</command>. @@ -7567,7 +7567,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <structfield>typcategory</structfield> is an arbitrary classification of data types that is used by the parser to determine which implicit casts should be <quote>preferred</quote>. - See <xref linkend="catalog-typcategory-table">. + See <xref linkend="catalog-typcategory-table"/>. </entry> </row> @@ -7871,8 +7871,8 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <entry></entry> <entry> Access privileges; see - <xref linkend="sql-grant"> and - <xref linkend="sql-revoke"> + <xref linkend="sql-grant"/> and + <xref linkend="sql-revoke"/> for details </entry> </row> @@ -7881,7 +7881,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l </table> <para> - <xref linkend="catalog-typcategory-table"> lists the system-defined values + <xref linkend="catalog-typcategory-table"/> lists the system-defined values of <structfield>typcategory</structfield>. Any future additions to this list will also be upper-case ASCII letters. All other ASCII characters are reserved for user-defined categories. @@ -8043,7 +8043,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l </para> <para> - The information schema (<xref linkend="information-schema">) provides + The information schema (<xref linkend="information-schema"/>) provides an alternative set of views which overlap the functionality of the system views. Since the information schema is SQL-standard whereas the views described here are <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>-specific, @@ -8052,11 +8052,11 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l </para> <para> - <xref linkend="view-table"> lists the system views described here. + <xref linkend="view-table"/> lists the system views described here. More detailed documentation of each view follows below. There are some additional views that provide access to the results of the statistics collector; they are described in <xref - linkend="monitoring-stats-views-table">. + linkend="monitoring-stats-views-table"/>. </para> <para> @@ -8389,7 +8389,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l be used by software packages that want to interface to <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> to facilitate finding the required header files and libraries. It provides the same basic information as the - <xref linkend="app-pgconfig"> <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> client + <xref linkend="app-pgconfig"/> <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> client application. </para> @@ -8440,7 +8440,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> - via the <xref linkend="sql-declare"> + via the <xref linkend="sql-declare"/> statement in SQL </para> </listitem> @@ -8448,14 +8448,14 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <listitem> <para> via the Bind message in the frontend/backend protocol, as - described in <xref linkend="protocol-flow-ext-query"> + described in <xref linkend="protocol-flow-ext-query"/> </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> via the Server Programming Interface (SPI), as described in - <xref linkend="spi-interface"> + <xref linkend="spi-interface"/> </para> </listitem> </itemizedlist> @@ -8648,7 +8648,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l </para> <para> - See <xref linkend="config-setting"> for more information about the various + See <xref linkend="config-setting"/> for more information about the various ways to change run-time parameters. </para> @@ -8813,7 +8813,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l </para> <para> - See <xref linkend="client-authentication"> for more information about + See <xref linkend="client-authentication"/> for more information about client authentication configuration. </para> </sect1> @@ -8890,7 +8890,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <para> The view <structname>pg_locks</structname> provides access to information about the locks held by active processes within the - database server. See <xref linkend="mvcc"> for more discussion + database server. See <xref linkend="mvcc"/> for more discussion of locking. </para> @@ -9053,7 +9053,7 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<replaceable><iteration count></replaceable>:<replaceable>&l <entry><type>text</type></entry> <entry></entry> <entry>Name of the lock mode held or desired by this process (see <xref - linkend="locking-tables"> and <xref linkend="xact-serializable">)</entry> + linkend="locking-tables"/> and <xref linkend="xact-serializable"/>)</entry> </row> <row> <entry><structfield>granted</structfield></entry> @@ -9164,7 +9164,7 @@ SELECT * FROM pg_locks pl LEFT JOIN pg_prepared_xacts ppx queues, nor information about which processes are parallel workers running on behalf of which other client sessions. It is better to use the <function>pg_blocking_pids()</function> function - (see <xref linkend="functions-info-session-table">) to identify which + (see <xref linkend="functions-info-session-table"/>) to identify which process(es) a waiting process is blocked behind. </para> @@ -9369,7 +9369,7 @@ SELECT * FROM pg_locks pl LEFT JOIN pg_prepared_xacts ppx <para> The <structname>pg_prepared_statements</structname> view displays all the prepared statements that are available in the current - session. See <xref linkend="sql-prepare"> for more information about prepared + session. See <xref linkend="sql-prepare"/> for more information about prepared statements. </para> @@ -9377,7 +9377,7 @@ SELECT * FROM pg_locks pl LEFT JOIN pg_prepared_xacts ppx <structname>pg_prepared_statements</structname> contains one row for each prepared statement. Rows are added to the view when a new prepared statement is created and removed when a prepared statement - is released (for example, via the <xref linkend="sql-deallocate"> command). + is released (for example, via the <xref linkend="sql-deallocate"/> command). </para> <table> @@ -9457,7 +9457,7 @@ SELECT * FROM pg_locks pl LEFT JOIN pg_prepared_xacts ppx <para> The view <structname>pg_prepared_xacts</structname> displays information about transactions that are currently prepared for two-phase - commit (see <xref linkend="sql-prepare-transaction"> for details). + commit (see <xref linkend="sql-prepare-transaction"/> for details). </para> <para> @@ -9601,7 +9601,7 @@ SELECT * FROM pg_locks pl LEFT JOIN pg_prepared_xacts ppx The <structname>pg_replication_origin_status</structname> view contains information about how far replay for a certain origin has progressed. For more on replication origins - see <xref linkend="replication-origins">. + see <xref linkend="replication-origins"/>. </para> <table> @@ -9670,7 +9670,7 @@ SELECT * FROM pg_locks pl LEFT JOIN pg_prepared_xacts ppx <para> For more on replication slots, - see <xref linkend="streaming-replication-slots"> and <xref linkend="logicaldecoding">. + see <xref linkend="streaming-replication-slots"/> and <xref linkend="logicaldecoding"/>. </para> <table> @@ -9917,7 +9917,7 @@ SELECT * FROM pg_locks pl LEFT JOIN pg_prepared_xacts ppx <entry></entry> <entry> Role bypasses every row level security policy, see - <xref linkend="ddl-rowsecurity"> for more information. + <xref linkend="ddl-rowsecurity"/> for more information. </entry> </row> @@ -10203,8 +10203,8 @@ SELECT * FROM pg_locks pl LEFT JOIN pg_prepared_xacts ppx <para> The view <structname>pg_settings</structname> provides access to run-time parameters of the server. It is essentially an alternative - interface to the <xref linkend="sql-show"> - and <xref linkend="sql-set"> commands. + interface to the <xref linkend="sql-show"/> + and <xref linkend="sql-set"/> commands. It also provides access to some facts about each parameter that are not directly available from <command>SHOW</command>, such as minimum and maximum values. @@ -10441,7 +10441,7 @@ SELECT * FROM pg_locks pl LEFT JOIN pg_prepared_xacts ppx </variablelist> <para> - See <xref linkend="config-setting"> for more information about the various + See <xref linkend="config-setting"/> for more information about the various ways to change these parameters. </para> @@ -10449,7 +10449,7 @@ SELECT * FROM pg_locks pl LEFT JOIN pg_prepared_xacts ppx The <structname>pg_settings</structname> view cannot be inserted into or deleted from, but it can be updated. An <command>UPDATE</command> applied to a row of <structname>pg_settings</structname> is equivalent to executing - the <xref linkend="sql-set"> command on that named + the <xref linkend="sql-set"/> command on that named parameter. The change only affects the value used by the current session. If an <command>UPDATE</command> is issued within a transaction that is later aborted, the effects of the <command>UPDATE</command> command @@ -10543,7 +10543,7 @@ SELECT * FROM pg_locks pl LEFT JOIN pg_prepared_xacts ppx <entry></entry> <entry> User bypasses every row level security policy, see - <xref linkend="ddl-rowsecurity"> for more information. + <xref linkend="ddl-rowsecurity"/> for more information. </entry> </row> @@ -10763,7 +10763,7 @@ SELECT * FROM pg_locks pl LEFT JOIN pg_prepared_xacts ppx The maximum number of entries in the array fields can be controlled on a column-by-column basis using the <command>ALTER TABLE SET STATISTICS</command> command, or globally by setting the - <xref linkend="guc-default-statistics-target"> run-time parameter. + <xref linkend="guc-default-statistics-target"/> run-time parameter. </para> </sect1> @@ -10858,7 +10858,7 @@ SELECT * FROM pg_locks pl LEFT JOIN pg_prepared_xacts ppx The view <structname>pg_timezone_abbrevs</structname> provides a list of time zone abbreviations that are currently recognized by the datetime input routines. The contents of this view change when the - <xref linkend="guc-timezone-abbreviations"> run-time parameter is modified. + <xref linkend="guc-timezone-abbreviations"/> run-time parameter is modified. </para> <table> @@ -10895,7 +10895,7 @@ SELECT * FROM pg_locks pl LEFT JOIN pg_prepared_xacts ppx <para> While most timezone abbreviations represent fixed offsets from UTC, there are some that have historically varied in value - (see <xref linkend="datetime-config-files"> for more information). + (see <xref linkend="datetime-config-files"/> for more information). In such cases this view presents their current meaning. </para> @@ -11025,7 +11025,7 @@ SELECT * FROM pg_locks pl LEFT JOIN pg_prepared_xacts ppx <entry><type>bool</type></entry> <entry> User bypasses every row level security policy, see - <xref linkend="ddl-rowsecurity"> for more information. + <xref linkend="ddl-rowsecurity"/> for more information. </entry> </row> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/charset.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/charset.sgml index ce395e115a3..dc3fd34a624 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/charset.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/charset.sgml @@ -15,8 +15,8 @@ Using the locale features of the operating system to provide locale-specific collation order, number formatting, translated messages, and other aspects. - This is covered in <xref linkend="locale"> and - <xref linkend="collation">. + This is covered in <xref linkend="locale"/> and + <xref linkend="collation"/>. </para> </listitem> @@ -25,7 +25,7 @@ Providing a number of different character sets to support storing text in all kinds of languages, and providing character set translation between client and server. - This is covered in <xref linkend="multibyte">. + This is covered in <xref linkend="multibyte"/>. </para> </listitem> </itemizedlist> @@ -146,7 +146,7 @@ initdb --locale=sv_SE the sort order of indexes, so they must be kept fixed, or indexes on text columns would become corrupt. (But you can alleviate this restriction using collations, as discussed - in <xref linkend="collation">.) + in <xref linkend="collation"/>.) The default values for these categories are determined when <command>initdb</command> is run, and those values are used when new databases are created, unless @@ -157,7 +157,7 @@ initdb --locale=sv_SE The other locale categories can be changed whenever desired by setting the server configuration parameters that have the same name as the locale categories (see <xref - linkend="runtime-config-client-format"> for details). The values + linkend="runtime-config-client-format"/> for details). The values that are chosen by <command>initdb</command> are actually only written into the configuration file <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> to serve as defaults when the server is started. If you remove these @@ -267,10 +267,10 @@ initdb --locale=sv_SE with <literal>LIKE</literal> clauses under a non-C locale, several custom operator classes exist. These allow the creation of an index that performs a strict character-by-character comparison, ignoring - locale comparison rules. Refer to <xref linkend="indexes-opclass"> + locale comparison rules. Refer to <xref linkend="indexes-opclass"/> for more information. Another approach is to create indexes using the <literal>C</literal> collation, as discussed in - <xref linkend="collation">. + <xref linkend="collation"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -316,7 +316,7 @@ initdb --locale=sv_SE <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> speak their preferred language well. If messages in your language are currently not available or not fully translated, your assistance would be appreciated. If you want to - help, refer to <xref linkend="nls"> or write to the developers' + help, refer to <xref linkend="nls"/> or write to the developers' mailing list. </para> </sect2> @@ -524,7 +524,7 @@ SELECT * FROM test1 ORDER BY a || b COLLATE "fr_FR"; these under one concept than to create another infrastructure for setting <symbol>LC_CTYPE</symbol> per expression.) Also, a <literal>libc</literal> collation - is tied to a character set encoding (see <xref linkend="multibyte">). + is tied to a character set encoding (see <xref linkend="multibyte"/>). The same collation name may exist for different encodings. </para> @@ -605,7 +605,7 @@ SELECT * FROM test1 ORDER BY a || b COLLATE "fr_FR"; for <symbol>LC_COLLATE</symbol> and <symbol>LC_CTYPE</symbol>, or if new locales are installed in the operating system after the database system was initialized, then a new collation may be created using - the <xref linkend="sql-createcollation"> command. + the <xref linkend="sql-createcollation"/> command. New operating system locales can also be imported en masse using the <link linkend="functions-admin-collation"><function>pg_import_system_collations()</function></link> function. </para> @@ -702,7 +702,7 @@ SELECT a COLLATE "C" < b COLLATE "POSIX" FROM test1; <para> If the standard and predefined collations are not sufficient, users can create their own collation objects using the SQL - command <xref linkend="sql-createcollation">. + command <xref linkend="sql-createcollation"/>. </para> <para> @@ -730,7 +730,7 @@ CREATE COLLATION german (provider = libc, locale = 'de_DE'); defined in the operating system when the database instance is initialized, it is not often necessary to manually create new ones. Reasons might be if a different naming system is desired (in which case - see also <xref linkend="collation-copy">) or if the operating system has + see also <xref linkend="collation-copy"/>) or if the operating system has been upgraded to provide new locale definitions (in which case see also <link linkend="functions-admin-collation"><function>pg_import_system_collations()</function></link>). </para> @@ -871,7 +871,7 @@ CREATE COLLATION german (provider = libc, locale = 'de_DE'); <title>Copying Collations</title> <para> - The command <xref linkend="sql-createcollation"> can also be used to + The command <xref linkend="sql-createcollation"/> can also be used to create a new collation from an existing collation, which can be useful to be able to use operating-system-independent collation names in applications, create compatibility names, or use an ICU-provided collation @@ -924,7 +924,7 @@ CREATE COLLATION french FROM "fr-x-icu"; <title>Supported Character Sets</title> <para> - <xref linkend="charset-table"> shows the character sets available + <xref linkend="charset-table"/> shows the character sets available for use in <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>. </para> @@ -1392,7 +1392,7 @@ CREATE DATABASE korean WITH ENCODING 'EUC_KR' LC_COLLATE='ko_KR.euckr' LC_CTYPE= database. When copying any other database, the encoding and locale settings cannot be changed from those of the source database, because that might result in corrupt data. For more information see - <xref linkend="manage-ag-templatedbs">. + <xref linkend="manage-ag-templatedbs"/>. </para> <para> @@ -1449,7 +1449,7 @@ $ <userinput>psql -l</userinput> character set combinations. The conversion information is stored in the <literal>pg_conversion</literal> system catalog. <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> comes with some predefined conversions, as shown in <xref - linkend="multibyte-translation-table">. You can create a new + linkend="multibyte-translation-table"/>. You can create a new conversion using the SQL command <command>CREATE CONVERSION</command>. </para> @@ -1763,7 +1763,7 @@ $ <userinput>psql -l</userinput> <listitem> <para> - <application>libpq</application> (<xref linkend="libpq-control">) has functions to control the client encoding. + <application>libpq</application> (<xref linkend="libpq-control"/>) has functions to control the client encoding. </para> </listitem> @@ -1812,7 +1812,7 @@ RESET client_encoding; <listitem> <para> Using the configuration variable <xref - linkend="guc-client-encoding">. If the + linkend="guc-client-encoding"/>. If the <varname>client_encoding</varname> variable is set, that client encoding is automatically selected when a connection to the server is made. (This can subsequently be overridden using any diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/client-auth.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/client-auth.sgml index 99921ba0793..c8a1bc79aa6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/client-auth.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/client-auth.sgml @@ -13,13 +13,13 @@ wants to connect as, much the same way one logs into a Unix computer as a particular user. Within the SQL environment the active database user name determines access privileges to database objects — see - <xref linkend="user-manag"> for more information. Therefore, it is + <xref linkend="user-manag"/> for more information. Therefore, it is essential to restrict which database users can connect. </para> <note> <para> - As explained in <xref linkend="user-manag">, + As explained in <xref linkend="user-manag"/>, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> actually does privilege management in terms of <quote>roles</quote>. In this chapter, we consistently use <firstterm>database user</firstterm> to mean <quote>role with the @@ -70,7 +70,7 @@ <filename>pg_hba.conf</filename> file is installed when the data directory is initialized by <command>initdb</command>. It is possible to place the authentication configuration file elsewhere, - however; see the <xref linkend="guc-hba-file"> configuration parameter. + however; see the <xref linkend="guc-hba-file"/> configuration parameter. </para> <para> @@ -136,7 +136,7 @@ hostnossl <replaceable>database</replaceable> <replaceable>user</replaceable> <para> Remote TCP/IP connections will not be possible unless the server is started with an appropriate value for the - <xref linkend="guc-listen-addresses"> configuration parameter, + <xref linkend="guc-listen-addresses"/> configuration parameter, since the default behavior is to listen for TCP/IP connections only on the local loopback address <literal>localhost</literal>. </para> @@ -157,8 +157,8 @@ hostnossl <replaceable>database</replaceable> <replaceable>user</replaceable> To make use of this option the server must be built with <acronym>SSL</acronym> support. Furthermore, <acronym>SSL</acronym> must be enabled - by setting the <xref linkend="guc-ssl"> configuration parameter (see - <xref linkend="ssl-tcp"> for more information). + by setting the <xref linkend="guc-ssl"/> configuration parameter (see + <xref linkend="ssl-tcp"/> for more information). Otherwise, the <literal>hostssl</literal> record is ignored except for logging a warning that it cannot match any connections. </para> @@ -381,7 +381,7 @@ hostnossl <replaceable>database</replaceable> <replaceable>user</replaceable> <para> Specifies the authentication method to use when a connection matches this record. The possible choices are summarized here; details - are in <xref linkend="auth-methods">. + are in <xref linkend="auth-methods"/>. <variablelist> <varlistentry> @@ -393,7 +393,7 @@ hostnossl <replaceable>database</replaceable> <replaceable>user</replaceable> <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> database server to login as any <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> user they wish, without the need for a password or any other authentication. See <xref - linkend="auth-trust"> for details. + linkend="auth-trust"/> for details. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -416,7 +416,7 @@ hostnossl <replaceable>database</replaceable> <replaceable>user</replaceable> <listitem> <para> Perform SCRAM-SHA-256 authentication to verify the user's - password. See <xref linkend="auth-password"> for details. + password. See <xref linkend="auth-password"/> for details. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -426,7 +426,7 @@ hostnossl <replaceable>database</replaceable> <replaceable>user</replaceable> <listitem> <para> Perform SCRAM-SHA-256 or MD5 authentication to verify the - user's password. See <xref linkend="auth-password"> + user's password. See <xref linkend="auth-password"/> for details. </para> </listitem> @@ -440,7 +440,7 @@ hostnossl <replaceable>database</replaceable> <replaceable>user</replaceable> authentication. Since the password is sent in clear text over the network, this should not be used on untrusted networks. - See <xref linkend="auth-password"> for details. + See <xref linkend="auth-password"/> for details. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -451,7 +451,7 @@ hostnossl <replaceable>database</replaceable> <replaceable>user</replaceable> <para> Use GSSAPI to authenticate the user. This is only available for TCP/IP connections. See <xref - linkend="gssapi-auth"> for details. + linkend="gssapi-auth"/> for details. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -462,7 +462,7 @@ hostnossl <replaceable>database</replaceable> <replaceable>user</replaceable> <para> Use SSPI to authenticate the user. This is only available on Windows. See <xref - linkend="sspi-auth"> for details. + linkend="sspi-auth"/> for details. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -477,7 +477,7 @@ hostnossl <replaceable>database</replaceable> <replaceable>user</replaceable> Ident authentication can only be used on TCP/IP connections. When specified for local connections, peer authentication will be used instead. - See <xref linkend="auth-ident"> for details. + See <xref linkend="auth-ident"/> for details. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -489,7 +489,7 @@ hostnossl <replaceable>database</replaceable> <replaceable>user</replaceable> Obtain the client's operating system user name from the operating system and check if it matches the requested database user name. This is only available for local connections. - See <xref linkend="auth-peer"> for details. + See <xref linkend="auth-peer"/> for details. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -499,7 +499,7 @@ hostnossl <replaceable>database</replaceable> <replaceable>user</replaceable> <listitem> <para> Authenticate using an <acronym>LDAP</acronym> server. See <xref - linkend="auth-ldap"> for details. + linkend="auth-ldap"/> for details. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -509,7 +509,7 @@ hostnossl <replaceable>database</replaceable> <replaceable>user</replaceable> <listitem> <para> Authenticate using a RADIUS server. See <xref - linkend="auth-radius"> for details. + linkend="auth-radius"/> for details. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -519,7 +519,7 @@ hostnossl <replaceable>database</replaceable> <replaceable>user</replaceable> <listitem> <para> Authenticate using SSL client certificates. See - <xref linkend="auth-cert"> for details. + <xref linkend="auth-cert"/> for details. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -530,7 +530,7 @@ hostnossl <replaceable>database</replaceable> <replaceable>user</replaceable> <para> Authenticate using the Pluggable Authentication Modules (PAM) service provided by the operating system. See <xref - linkend="auth-pam"> for details. + linkend="auth-pam"/> for details. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -540,7 +540,7 @@ hostnossl <replaceable>database</replaceable> <replaceable>user</replaceable> <listitem> <para> Authenticate using the BSD Authentication service provided by the - operating system. See <xref linkend="auth-bsd"> for details. + operating system. See <xref linkend="auth-bsd"/> for details. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -638,7 +638,7 @@ hostnossl <replaceable>database</replaceable> <replaceable>user</replaceable> <para> Some examples of <filename>pg_hba.conf</filename> entries are shown in - <xref linkend="example-pg-hba.conf">. See the next section for details on the + <xref linkend="example-pg-hba.conf"/>. See the next section for details on the different authentication methods. </para> @@ -763,7 +763,7 @@ local db1,db2,@demodbs all md5 <filename>pg_ident.conf</filename><indexterm><primary>pg_ident.conf</primary></indexterm> and is stored in the cluster's data directory. (It is possible to place the map file - elsewhere, however; see the <xref linkend="guc-ident-file"> + elsewhere, however; see the <xref linkend="guc-ident-file"/> configuration parameter.) The ident map file contains lines of the general form: <synopsis> @@ -790,7 +790,7 @@ local db1,db2,@demodbs all md5 <para> If the <replaceable>system-username</replaceable> field starts with a slash (<literal>/</literal>), the remainder of the field is treated as a regular expression. - (See <xref linkend="posix-syntax-details"> for details of + (See <xref linkend="posix-syntax-details"/> for details of <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>'s regular expression syntax.) The regular expression can include a single capture, or parenthesized subexpression, which can then be referenced in the <replaceable>database-username</replaceable> @@ -828,8 +828,8 @@ mymap /^(.*)@otherdomain\.com$ guest <para> A <filename>pg_ident.conf</filename> file that could be used in conjunction with the <filename>pg_hba.conf</filename> file in <xref - linkend="example-pg-hba.conf"> is shown in <xref - linkend="example-pg-ident.conf">. In this example, anyone + linkend="example-pg-hba.conf"/> is shown in <xref + linkend="example-pg-ident.conf"/>. In this example, anyone logged in to a machine on the 192.168 network that does not have the operating system user name <literal>bryanh</literal>, <literal>ann</literal>, or <literal>robert</literal> would not be granted access. Unix user @@ -885,7 +885,7 @@ omicron bryanh guest1 Unix-domain socket file using file-system permissions. To do this, set the <varname>unix_socket_permissions</varname> (and possibly <varname>unix_socket_group</varname>) configuration parameters as - described in <xref linkend="runtime-config-connection">. Or you + described in <xref linkend="runtime-config-connection"/>. Or you could set the <varname>unix_socket_directories</varname> configuration parameter to place the socket file in a suitably restricted directory. @@ -965,7 +965,7 @@ omicron bryanh guest1 <para> The <literal>md5</literal> method cannot be used with - the <xref linkend="guc-db-user-namespace"> feature. + the <xref linkend="guc-db-user-namespace"/> feature. </para> <para> @@ -998,8 +998,8 @@ omicron bryanh guest1 separate from operating system user passwords. The password for each database user is stored in the <literal>pg_authid</literal> system catalog. Passwords can be managed with the SQL commands - <xref linkend="sql-createrole"> and - <xref linkend="sql-alterrole">, + <xref linkend="sql-createrole"/> and + <xref linkend="sql-alterrole"/>, e.g., <userinput>CREATE ROLE foo WITH LOGIN PASSWORD 'secret'</userinput>, or the <application>psql</application> command <literal>\password</literal>. @@ -1011,7 +1011,7 @@ omicron bryanh guest1 The availability of the different password-based authentication methods depends on how a user's password on the server is encrypted (or hashed, more accurately). This is controlled by the configuration - parameter <xref linkend="guc-password-encryption"> at the time the + parameter <xref linkend="guc-password-encryption"/> at the time the password is set. If a password was encrypted using the <literal>scram-sha-256</literal> setting, then it can be used for the authentication methods <literal>scram-sha-256</literal> @@ -1061,7 +1061,7 @@ omicron bryanh guest1 <para> GSSAPI support has to be enabled when <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> is built; - see <xref linkend="installation"> for more information. + see <xref linkend="installation"/> for more information. </para> <para> @@ -1072,7 +1072,7 @@ omicron bryanh guest1 The PostgreSQL server will accept any principal that is included in the keytab used by the server, but care needs to be taken to specify the correct principal details when making the connection from the client using the <literal>krbsrvname</literal> connection parameter. (See - also <xref linkend="libpq-paramkeywords">.) The installation default can be + also <xref linkend="libpq-paramkeywords"/>.) The installation default can be changed from the default <literal>postgres</literal> at build time using <literal>./configure --with-krb-srvnam=</literal><replaceable>whatever</replaceable>. In most environments, @@ -1112,9 +1112,9 @@ omicron bryanh guest1 <para> Make sure that your server keytab file is readable (and preferably only readable, not writable) by the <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> - server account. (See also <xref linkend="postgres-user">.) The location + server account. (See also <xref linkend="postgres-user"/>.) The location of the key file is specified by the <xref - linkend="guc-krb-server-keyfile"> configuration + linkend="guc-krb-server-keyfile"/> configuration parameter. The default is <filename>/usr/local/pgsql/etc/krb5.keytab</filename> (or whatever directory was specified as <varname>sysconfdir</varname> at build time). @@ -1138,7 +1138,7 @@ omicron bryanh guest1 database user name <literal>fred</literal>, principal <literal>fred@EXAMPLE.COM</literal> would be able to connect. To also allow principal <literal>fred/users.example.com@EXAMPLE.COM</literal>, use a user name - map, as described in <xref linkend="auth-username-maps">. + map, as described in <xref linkend="auth-username-maps"/>. </para> <para> @@ -1150,7 +1150,7 @@ omicron bryanh guest1 <para> If set to 0, the realm name from the authenticated user principal is stripped off before being passed through the user name mapping - (<xref linkend="auth-username-maps">). This is discouraged and is + (<xref linkend="auth-username-maps"/>). This is discouraged and is primarily available for backwards compatibility, as it is not secure in multi-realm environments unless <literal>krb_realm</literal> is also used. It is recommended to @@ -1166,7 +1166,7 @@ omicron bryanh guest1 <listitem> <para> Allows for mapping between system and database user names. See - <xref linkend="auth-username-maps"> for details. For a GSSAPI/Kerberos + <xref linkend="auth-username-maps"/> for details. For a GSSAPI/Kerberos principal, such as <literal>username@EXAMPLE.COM</literal> (or, less commonly, <literal>username/hostbased@EXAMPLE.COM</literal>), the user name used for mapping is @@ -1217,7 +1217,7 @@ omicron bryanh guest1 <para> When using <productname>Kerberos</productname> authentication, <productname>SSPI</productname> works the same way - <productname>GSSAPI</productname> does; see <xref linkend="gssapi-auth"> + <productname>GSSAPI</productname> does; see <xref linkend="gssapi-auth"/> for details. </para> @@ -1231,7 +1231,7 @@ omicron bryanh guest1 <para> If set to 0, the realm name from the authenticated user principal is stripped off before being passed through the user name mapping - (<xref linkend="auth-username-maps">). This is discouraged and is + (<xref linkend="auth-username-maps"/>). This is discouraged and is primarily available for backwards compatibility, as it is not secure in multi-realm environments unless <literal>krb_realm</literal> is also used. It is recommended to @@ -1284,7 +1284,7 @@ omicron bryanh guest1 <listitem> <para> Allows for mapping between system and database user names. See - <xref linkend="auth-username-maps"> for details. For a SSPI/Kerberos + <xref linkend="auth-username-maps"/> for details. For a SSPI/Kerberos principal, such as <literal>username@EXAMPLE.COM</literal> (or, less commonly, <literal>username/hostbased@EXAMPLE.COM</literal>), the user name used for mapping is @@ -1329,7 +1329,7 @@ omicron bryanh guest1 <note> <para> When ident is specified for a local (non-TCP/IP) connection, - peer authentication (see <xref linkend="auth-peer">) will be + peer authentication (see <xref linkend="auth-peer"/>) will be used instead. </para> </note> @@ -1342,7 +1342,7 @@ omicron bryanh guest1 <listitem> <para> Allows for mapping between system and database user names. See - <xref linkend="auth-username-maps"> for details. + <xref linkend="auth-username-maps"/> for details. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -1415,7 +1415,7 @@ omicron bryanh guest1 <listitem> <para> Allows for mapping between system and database user names. See - <xref linkend="auth-username-maps"> for details. + <xref linkend="auth-username-maps"/> for details. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -1828,7 +1828,7 @@ host ... ldap ldapserver=ldap.example.net ldapbasedn="dc=example, dc=net" ldapse <listitem> <para> Allows for mapping between system and database user names. See - <xref linkend="auth-username-maps"> for details. + <xref linkend="auth-username-maps"/> for details. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml index 7059dd4e5f5..3060597011d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml @@ -170,7 +170,7 @@ shared_buffers = 128MB <filename>postgresql.auto.conf</filename><indexterm><primary>postgresql.auto.conf</primary></indexterm>, which has the same format as <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> but should never be edited manually. This file holds settings provided through - the <xref linkend="sql-altersystem"> command. This file is automatically + the <xref linkend="sql-altersystem"/> command. This file is automatically read whenever <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> is, and its settings take effect in the same way. Settings in <filename>postgresql.auto.conf</filename> override those in <filename>postgresql.conf</filename>. @@ -191,7 +191,7 @@ shared_buffers = 128MB <para> <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> provides three SQL commands to establish configuration defaults. - The already-mentioned <xref linkend="sql-altersystem"> command + The already-mentioned <xref linkend="sql-altersystem"/> command provides a SQL-accessible means of changing global defaults; it is functionally equivalent to editing <filename>postgresql.conf</filename>. In addition, there are two commands that allow setting of defaults @@ -201,14 +201,14 @@ shared_buffers = 128MB <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> - The <xref linkend="sql-alterdatabase"> command allows global + The <xref linkend="sql-alterdatabase"/> command allows global settings to be overridden on a per-database basis. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - The <xref linkend="sql-alterrole"> command allows both global and + The <xref linkend="sql-alterrole"/> command allows both global and per-database settings to be overridden with user-specific values. </para> </listitem> @@ -232,7 +232,7 @@ shared_buffers = 128MB <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> - The <xref linkend="sql-show"> command allows inspection of the + The <xref linkend="sql-show"/> command allows inspection of the current value of all parameters. The corresponding function is <function>current_setting(setting_name text)</function>. </para> @@ -240,7 +240,7 @@ shared_buffers = 128MB <listitem> <para> - The <xref linkend="sql-set"> command allows modification of the + The <xref linkend="sql-set"/> command allows modification of the current value of those parameters that can be set locally to a session; it has no effect on other sessions. The corresponding function is @@ -266,7 +266,7 @@ shared_buffers = 128MB <listitem> <para> - Using <xref linkend="sql-update"> on this view, specifically + Using <xref linkend="sql-update"/> on this view, specifically updating the <structname>setting</structname> column, is the equivalent of issuing <command>SET</command> commands. For example, the equivalent of <programlisting> @@ -470,7 +470,7 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' already mentioned, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> uses two other manually-edited configuration files, which control client authentication (their use is discussed in <xref - linkend="client-authentication">). By default, all three + linkend="client-authentication"/>). By default, all three configuration files are stored in the database cluster's data directory. The parameters described in this section allow the configuration files to be placed elsewhere. (Doing so can ease @@ -535,7 +535,7 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' Specifies the configuration file for user name mapping (customarily called <filename>pg_ident.conf</filename>). This parameter can only be set at server start. - See also <xref linkend="auth-username-maps">. + See also <xref linkend="auth-username-maps"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -625,7 +625,7 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' The default value is <systemitem class="systemname">localhost</systemitem>, which allows only local TCP/IP <quote>loopback</quote> connections to be made. While client authentication (<xref - linkend="client-authentication">) allows fine-grained control + linkend="client-authentication"/>) allows fine-grained control over who can access the server, <varname>listen_addresses</varname> controls which interfaces accept connection attempts, which can help prevent repeated malicious connection requests on @@ -685,7 +685,7 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' <para> Determines the number of connection <quote>slots</quote> that are reserved for connections by <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> - superusers. At most <xref linkend="guc-max-connections"> + superusers. At most <xref linkend="guc-max-connections"/> connections can ever be active simultaneously. Whenever the number of active concurrent connections is at least <varname>max_connections</varname> minus @@ -794,7 +794,7 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' <para> This access control mechanism is independent of the one - described in <xref linkend="client-authentication">. + described in <xref linkend="client-authentication"/>. </para> <para> @@ -959,7 +959,7 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' <listitem> <para> Enables <acronym>SSL</acronym> connections. Please read - <xref linkend="ssl-tcp"> before using this. + <xref linkend="ssl-tcp"/> before using this. This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> file or on the server command line. The default is <literal>off</literal>. @@ -1180,8 +1180,8 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' </term> <listitem> <para> - When a password is specified in <xref linkend="sql-createrole"> or - <xref linkend="sql-alterrole">, this parameter determines the algorithm + When a password is specified in <xref linkend="sql-createrole"/> or + <xref linkend="sql-alterrole"/>, this parameter determines the algorithm to use to encrypt the password. The default value is <literal>md5</literal>, which stores the password as an MD5 hash (<literal>on</literal> is also accepted, as alias for <literal>md5</literal>). Setting this parameter to @@ -1190,7 +1190,7 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' <para> Note that older clients might lack support for the SCRAM authentication mechanism, and hence not work with passwords encrypted with - SCRAM-SHA-256. See <xref linkend="auth-password"> for more details. + SCRAM-SHA-256. See <xref linkend="auth-password"/> for more details. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -1228,7 +1228,7 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' <listitem> <para> Sets the location of the Kerberos server key file. See - <xref linkend="gssapi-auth"> + <xref linkend="gssapi-auth"/> for details. This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> file or on the server command line. </para> @@ -1376,7 +1376,7 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' <para> The use of huge pages results in smaller page tables and less CPU time spent on memory management, increasing performance. For more details, - see <xref linkend="linux-huge-pages">. + see <xref linkend="linux-huge-pages"/>. </para> <para> @@ -1428,7 +1428,7 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' <para> Sets the maximum number of transactions that can be in the <quote>prepared</quote> state simultaneously (see <xref - linkend="sql-prepare-transaction">). + linkend="sql-prepare-transaction"/>). Setting this parameter to zero (which is the default) disables the prepared-transaction feature. This parameter can only be set at server start. @@ -1439,7 +1439,7 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' should be set to zero to prevent accidental creation of prepared transactions. If you are using prepared transactions, you will probably want <varname>max_prepared_transactions</varname> to be at - least as large as <xref linkend="guc-max-connections">, so that every + least as large as <xref linkend="guc-max-connections"/>, so that every session can have a prepared transaction pending. </para> @@ -1497,10 +1497,10 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' </para> <para> Note that when autovacuum runs, up to - <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-max-workers"> times this memory + <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-max-workers"/> times this memory may be allocated, so be careful not to set the default value too high. It may be useful to control for this by separately - setting <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-work-mem">. + setting <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-work-mem"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -1515,7 +1515,7 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' <para> Specifies the maximum amount of memory to be used by each autovacuum worker process. It defaults to -1, indicating that - the value of <xref linkend="guc-maintenance-work-mem"> should + the value of <xref linkend="guc-maintenance-work-mem"/> should be used instead. The setting has no effect on the behavior of <command>VACUUM</command> when run in other contexts. </para> @@ -1649,8 +1649,8 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' <title>Cost-based Vacuum Delay</title> <para> - During the execution of <xref linkend="sql-vacuum"> - and <xref linkend="sql-analyze"> + During the execution of <xref linkend="sql-vacuum"/> + and <xref linkend="sql-analyze"/> commands, the system maintains an internal counter that keeps track of the estimated cost of the various I/O operations that are performed. When the accumulated @@ -1893,7 +1893,7 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' the OS writes data back in larger batches in the background. Often that will result in greatly reduced transaction latency, but there also are some cases, especially with workloads that are bigger than - <xref linkend="guc-shared-buffers">, but smaller than the OS's page + <xref linkend="guc-shared-buffers"/>, but smaller than the OS's page cache, where performance might degrade. This setting may have no effect on some platforms. The valid range is between <literal>0</literal>, which disables forced writeback, and @@ -1962,7 +1962,7 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' The default is 1 on supported systems, otherwise 0. This value can be overridden for tables in a particular tablespace by setting the tablespace parameter of the same name (see - <xref linkend="sql-altertablespace">). + <xref linkend="sql-altertablespace"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -1988,8 +1988,8 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' <para> When changing this value, consider also adjusting - <xref linkend="guc-max-parallel-workers"> and - <xref linkend="guc-max-parallel-workers-per-gather">. + <xref linkend="guc-max-parallel-workers"/> and + <xref linkend="guc-max-parallel-workers-per-gather"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -2005,8 +2005,8 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' Sets the maximum number of workers that can be started by a single <literal>Gather</literal> or <literal>Gather Merge</literal> node. Parallel workers are taken from the pool of processes established by - <xref linkend="guc-max-worker-processes">, limited by - <xref linkend="guc-max-parallel-workers">. Note that the requested + <xref linkend="guc-max-worker-processes"/>, limited by + <xref linkend="guc-max-parallel-workers"/>. Note that the requested number of workers may not actually be available at run time. If this occurs, the plan will run with fewer workers than expected, which may be inefficient. The default value is 2. Setting this value to 0 @@ -2020,7 +2020,7 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' system as an additional user session. This should be taken into account when choosing a value for this setting, as well as when configuring other settings that control resource utilization, such - as <xref linkend="guc-work-mem">. Resource limits such as + as <xref linkend="guc-work-mem"/>. Resource limits such as <varname>work_mem</varname> are applied individually to each worker, which means the total utilization may be much higher across all processes than it would normally be for any single process. @@ -2031,7 +2031,7 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' <para> For more information on parallel query, see - <xref linkend="parallel-query">. + <xref linkend="parallel-query"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -2047,9 +2047,9 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' Sets the maximum number of workers that the system can support for parallel queries. The default value is 8. When increasing or decreasing this value, consider also adjusting - <xref linkend="guc-max-parallel-workers-per-gather">. + <xref linkend="guc-max-parallel-workers-per-gather"/>. Also, note that a setting for this value which is higher than - <xref linkend="guc-max-worker-processes"> will have no effect, + <xref linkend="guc-max-worker-processes"/> will have no effect, since parallel workers are taken from the pool of worker processes established by that setting. </para> @@ -2072,7 +2072,7 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' checkpoint, or when the OS writes data back in larger batches in the background. Often that will result in greatly reduced transaction latency, but there also are some cases, especially with workloads - that are bigger than <xref linkend="guc-shared-buffers">, but smaller + that are bigger than <xref linkend="guc-shared-buffers"/>, but smaller than the OS's page cache, where performance might degrade. This setting may have no effect on some platforms. The valid range is between <literal>0</literal>, which disables forced writeback, @@ -2148,7 +2148,7 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' <para> For additional information on tuning these settings, - see <xref linkend="wal-configuration">. + see <xref linkend="wal-configuration"/>. </para> <sect2 id="runtime-config-wal-settings"> @@ -2176,7 +2176,7 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' <para> In <literal>minimal</literal> level, WAL-logging of some bulk operations can be safely skipped, which can make those - operations much faster (see <xref linkend="populate-pitr">). + operations much faster (see <xref linkend="populate-pitr"/>). Operations in which this optimization can be applied include: <simplelist> <member><command>CREATE TABLE AS</command></member> @@ -2188,7 +2188,7 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' But minimal WAL does not contain enough information to reconstruct the data from a base backup and the WAL logs, so <literal>replica</literal> or higher must be used to enable WAL archiving - (<xref linkend="guc-archive-mode">) and streaming replication. + (<xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"/>) and streaming replication. </para> <para> In <literal>logical</literal> level, the same information is logged as @@ -2218,7 +2218,7 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' If this parameter is on, the <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> server will try to make sure that updates are physically written to disk, by issuing <function>fsync()</function> system calls or various - equivalent methods (see <xref linkend="guc-wal-sync-method">). + equivalent methods (see <xref linkend="guc-wal-sync-method"/>). This ensures that the database cluster can recover to a consistent state after an operating system or hardware crash. </para> @@ -2254,7 +2254,7 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' </para> <para> - In many situations, turning off <xref linkend="guc-synchronous-commit"> + In many situations, turning off <xref linkend="guc-synchronous-commit"/> for noncritical transactions can provide much of the potential performance benefit of turning off <varname>fsync</varname>, without the attendant risks of data corruption. @@ -2264,7 +2264,7 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' <varname>fsync</varname> can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> file or on the server command line. If you turn this parameter off, also consider turning off - <xref linkend="guc-full-page-writes">. + <xref linkend="guc-full-page-writes"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -2285,8 +2285,8 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' is <literal>on</literal>. When <literal>off</literal>, there can be a delay between when success is reported to the client and when the transaction is really guaranteed to be safe against a server crash. (The maximum - delay is three times <xref linkend="guc-wal-writer-delay">.) Unlike - <xref linkend="guc-fsync">, setting this parameter to <literal>off</literal> + delay is three times <xref linkend="guc-wal-writer-delay"/>.) Unlike + <xref linkend="guc-fsync"/>, setting this parameter to <literal>off</literal> does not create any risk of database inconsistency: an operating system or database crash might result in some recent allegedly-committed transactions being lost, but @@ -2294,10 +2294,10 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' been aborted cleanly. So, turning <varname>synchronous_commit</varname> off can be a useful alternative when performance is more important than exact certainty about the durability of a transaction. For more - discussion see <xref linkend="wal-async-commit">. + discussion see <xref linkend="wal-async-commit"/>. </para> <para> - If <xref linkend="guc-synchronous-standby-names"> is non-empty, this + If <xref linkend="guc-synchronous-standby-names"/> is non-empty, this parameter also controls whether or not transaction commits will wait for their WAL records to be replicated to the standby server(s). When set to <literal>on</literal>, commits will wait until replies @@ -2389,7 +2389,7 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' necessary to change this setting or other aspects of your system configuration in order to create a crash-safe configuration or achieve optimal performance. - These aspects are discussed in <xref linkend="wal-reliability">. + These aspects are discussed in <xref linkend="wal-reliability"/>. This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> file or on the server command line. </para> @@ -2432,7 +2432,7 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' <para> Turning off this parameter does not affect use of WAL archiving for point-in-time recovery (PITR) - (see <xref linkend="continuous-archiving">). + (see <xref linkend="continuous-archiving"/>). </para> <para> @@ -2480,7 +2480,7 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' <para> When this parameter is <literal>on</literal>, the <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> server compresses a full page image written to WAL when - <xref linkend="guc-full-page-writes"> is on or during a base backup. + <xref linkend="guc-full-page-writes"/> is on or during a base backup. A compressed page image will be decompressed during WAL replay. The default value is <literal>off</literal>. Only superusers can change this setting. @@ -2505,7 +2505,7 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' <para> The amount of shared memory used for WAL data that has not yet been written to disk. The default setting of -1 selects a size equal to - 1/32nd (about 3%) of <xref linkend="guc-shared-buffers">, but not less + 1/32nd (about 3%) of <xref linkend="guc-shared-buffers"/>, but not less than <literal>64kB</literal> nor more than the size of one WAL segment, typically <literal>16MB</literal>. This value can be set manually if the automatic choice is too large or too small, @@ -2682,7 +2682,7 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' checkpoint, or when the OS writes data back in larger batches in the background. Often that will result in greatly reduced transaction latency, but there also are some cases, especially with workloads - that are bigger than <xref linkend="guc-shared-buffers">, but smaller + that are bigger than <xref linkend="guc-shared-buffers"/>, but smaller than the OS's page cache, where performance might degrade. This setting may have no effect on some platforms. The valid range is between <literal>0</literal>, which disables forced writeback, @@ -2772,14 +2772,14 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' <para> When <varname>archive_mode</varname> is enabled, completed WAL segments are sent to archive storage by setting - <xref linkend="guc-archive-command">. In addition to <literal>off</literal>, + <xref linkend="guc-archive-command"/>. In addition to <literal>off</literal>, to disable, there are two modes: <literal>on</literal>, and <literal>always</literal>. During normal operation, there is no difference between the two modes, but when set to <literal>always</literal> the WAL archiver is enabled also during archive recovery or standby mode. In <literal>always</literal> mode, all files restored from the archive or streamed with streaming replication will be archived (again). See - <xref linkend="continuous-archiving-in-standby"> for details. + <xref linkend="continuous-archiving-in-standby"/> for details. </para> <para> <varname>archive_mode</varname> and <varname>archive_command</varname> are @@ -2809,7 +2809,7 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' Use <literal>%%</literal> to embed an actual <literal>%</literal> character in the command. It is important for the command to return a zero exit status only if it succeeds. For more information see - <xref linkend="backup-archiving-wal">. + <xref linkend="backup-archiving-wal"/>. </para> <para> This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> @@ -2836,7 +2836,7 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' </term> <listitem> <para> - The <xref linkend="guc-archive-command"> is only invoked for + The <xref linkend="guc-archive-command"/> is only invoked for completed WAL segments. Hence, if your server generates little WAL traffic (or has slack periods where it does so), there could be a long delay between the completion of a transaction and its safe @@ -2872,10 +2872,10 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' <para> These settings control the behavior of the built-in <firstterm>streaming replication</firstterm> feature (see - <xref linkend="streaming-replication">). Servers will be either a + <xref linkend="streaming-replication"/>). Servers will be either a Master or a Standby server. Masters can send data, while Standby(s) are always receivers of replicated data. When cascading replication - (see <xref linkend="cascading-replication">) is used, Standby server(s) + (see <xref linkend="cascading-replication"/>) is used, Standby server(s) can also be senders, as well as receivers. Parameters are mainly for Sending and Standby servers, though some parameters have meaning only on the Master server. Settings may vary @@ -2909,7 +2909,7 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' processes). The default is 10. The value 0 means replication is disabled. WAL sender processes count towards the total number of connections, so the parameter cannot be set higher than - <xref linkend="guc-max-connections">. Abrupt streaming client + <xref linkend="guc-max-connections"/>. Abrupt streaming client disconnection might cause an orphaned connection slot until a timeout is reached, so this parameter should be set slightly higher than the maximum number of expected clients so disconnected @@ -2930,7 +2930,7 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' <listitem> <para> Specifies the maximum number of replication slots - (see <xref linkend="streaming-replication-slots">) that the server + (see <xref linkend="streaming-replication-slots"/>) that the server can support. The default is 10. This parameter can only be set at server start. <varname>wal_level</varname> must be set @@ -3021,9 +3021,9 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' These parameters can be set on the master/primary server that is to send replication data to one or more standby servers. Note that in addition to these parameters, - <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"> must be set appropriately on the master + <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"/> must be set appropriately on the master server, and optionally WAL archiving can be enabled as - well (see <xref linkend="runtime-config-wal-archiving">). + well (see <xref linkend="runtime-config-wal-archiving"/>). The values of these parameters on standby servers are irrelevant, although you may wish to set them there in preparation for the possibility of a standby becoming the master. @@ -3041,7 +3041,7 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' <para> Specifies a list of standby servers that can support <firstterm>synchronous replication</firstterm>, as described in - <xref linkend="synchronous-replication">. + <xref linkend="synchronous-replication"/>. There will be one or more active synchronous standbys; transactions waiting for commit will be allowed to proceed after these standby servers confirm receipt of their data. @@ -3148,7 +3148,7 @@ ANY <replaceable class="parameter">num_sync</replaceable> ( <replaceable class=" replication. This is the default configuration. Even when synchronous replication is enabled, individual transactions can be configured not to wait for replication by setting the - <xref linkend="guc-synchronous-commit"> parameter to + <xref linkend="guc-synchronous-commit"/> parameter to <literal>local</literal> or <literal>off</literal>. </para> <para> @@ -3172,7 +3172,7 @@ ANY <replaceable class="parameter">num_sync</replaceable> ( <replaceable class=" removed as soon as possible, that is, as soon as they are no longer visible to any open transaction. You may wish to set this to a non-zero value on a primary server that is supporting hot standby - servers, as described in <xref linkend="hot-standby">. This allows + servers, as described in <xref linkend="hot-standby"/>. This allows more time for queries on the standby to complete without incurring conflicts due to early cleanup of rows. However, since the value is measured in terms of number of write transactions occurring on the @@ -3215,7 +3215,7 @@ ANY <replaceable class="parameter">num_sync</replaceable> ( <replaceable class=" <listitem> <para> Specifies whether or not you can connect and run queries during - recovery, as described in <xref linkend="hot-standby">. + recovery, as described in <xref linkend="hot-standby"/>. The default value is <literal>on</literal>. This parameter can only be set at server start. It only has effect during archive recovery or in standby mode. @@ -3234,7 +3234,7 @@ ANY <replaceable class="parameter">num_sync</replaceable> ( <replaceable class=" When Hot Standby is active, this parameter determines how long the standby server should wait before canceling standby queries that conflict with about-to-be-applied WAL entries, as described in - <xref linkend="hot-standby-conflict">. + <xref linkend="hot-standby-conflict"/>. <varname>max_standby_archive_delay</varname> applies when WAL data is being read from WAL archive (and is therefore not current). The default is 30 seconds. Units are milliseconds if not specified. @@ -3265,7 +3265,7 @@ ANY <replaceable class="parameter">num_sync</replaceable> ( <replaceable class=" When Hot Standby is active, this parameter determines how long the standby server should wait before canceling standby queries that conflict with about-to-be-applied WAL entries, as described in - <xref linkend="hot-standby-conflict">. + <xref linkend="hot-standby-conflict"/>. <varname>max_standby_streaming_delay</varname> applies when WAL data is being received via streaming replication. The default is 30 seconds. Units are milliseconds if not specified. @@ -3484,10 +3484,10 @@ ANY <replaceable class="parameter">num_sync</replaceable> ( <replaceable class=" choose a different plan. Better ways to improve the quality of the plans chosen by the optimizer include adjusting the planner cost - constants (see <xref linkend="runtime-config-query-constants">), - running <xref linkend="sql-analyze"> manually, increasing + constants (see <xref linkend="runtime-config-query-constants"/>), + running <xref linkend="sql-analyze"/> manually, increasing the value of the <xref - linkend="guc-default-statistics-target"> configuration parameter, + linkend="guc-default-statistics-target"/> configuration parameter, and increasing the amount of statistics collected for specific columns using <command>ALTER TABLE SET STATISTICS</command>. @@ -3579,7 +3579,7 @@ ANY <replaceable class="parameter">num_sync</replaceable> ( <replaceable class=" <listitem> <para> Enables or disables the query planner's use of index-only-scan plan - types (see <xref linkend="indexes-index-only-scans">). + types (see <xref linkend="indexes-index-only-scans"/>). The default is <literal>on</literal>. </para> </listitem> @@ -3745,7 +3745,7 @@ ANY <replaceable class="parameter">num_sync</replaceable> ( <replaceable class=" that is part of a series of sequential fetches. The default is 1.0. This value can be overridden for tables and indexes in a particular tablespace by setting the tablespace parameter of the same name - (see <xref linkend="sql-altertablespace">). + (see <xref linkend="sql-altertablespace"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -3762,7 +3762,7 @@ ANY <replaceable class="parameter">num_sync</replaceable> ( <replaceable class=" non-sequentially-fetched disk page. The default is 4.0. This value can be overridden for tables and indexes in a particular tablespace by setting the tablespace parameter of the same name - (see <xref linkend="sql-altertablespace">). + (see <xref linkend="sql-altertablespace"/>). </para> <para> @@ -3960,7 +3960,7 @@ ANY <replaceable class="parameter">num_sync</replaceable> ( <replaceable class=" complex queries (those joining many relations), at the cost of producing plans that are sometimes inferior to those found by the normal exhaustive-search algorithm. - For more information see <xref linkend="geqo">. + For more information see <xref linkend="geqo"/>. </para> <variablelist> @@ -4124,7 +4124,7 @@ ANY <replaceable class="parameter">num_sync</replaceable> ( <replaceable class=" do <command>ANALYZE</command>, but might improve the quality of the planner's estimates. The default is 100. For more information on the use of statistics by the <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> - query planner, refer to <xref linkend="planner-stats">. + query planner, refer to <xref linkend="planner-stats"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -4180,7 +4180,7 @@ SELECT * FROM parent WHERE key = 2400; </para> <para> - Refer to <xref linkend="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> for + Refer to <xref linkend="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"/> for more information on using constraint exclusion and partitioning. </para> </listitem> @@ -4219,13 +4219,13 @@ SELECT * FROM parent WHERE key = 2400; resulting <literal>FROM</literal> list would have no more than this many items. Smaller values reduce planning time but might yield inferior query plans. The default is eight. - For more information see <xref linkend="explicit-joins">. + For more information see <xref linkend="explicit-joins"/>. </para> <para> - Setting this value to <xref linkend="guc-geqo-threshold"> or more + Setting this value to <xref linkend="guc-geqo-threshold"/> or more may trigger use of the GEQO planner, resulting in non-optimal - plans. See <xref linkend="runtime-config-query-geqo">. + plans. See <xref linkend="runtime-config-query-geqo"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -4255,13 +4255,13 @@ SELECT * FROM parent WHERE key = 2400; the optimal join order, advanced users can elect to temporarily set this variable to 1, and then specify the join order they desire explicitly. - For more information see <xref linkend="explicit-joins">. + For more information see <xref linkend="explicit-joins"/>. </para> <para> - Setting this value to <xref linkend="guc-geqo-threshold"> or more + Setting this value to <xref linkend="guc-geqo-threshold"/> or more may trigger use of the GEQO planner, resulting in non-optimal - plans. See <xref linkend="runtime-config-query-geqo">. + plans. See <xref linkend="runtime-config-query-geqo"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -4386,8 +4386,8 @@ SELECT * FROM parent WHERE key = 2400; log entries are output in <quote>comma separated value</quote> (<acronym>CSV</acronym>) format, which is convenient for loading logs into programs. - See <xref linkend="runtime-config-logging-csvlog"> for details. - <xref linkend="guc-logging-collector"> must be enabled to generate + See <xref linkend="runtime-config-logging-csvlog"/> for details. + <xref linkend="guc-logging-collector"/> must be enabled to generate CSV-format log output. </para> <para> @@ -4420,7 +4420,7 @@ csvlog log/postgresql.csv <varname>log_destination</varname>. <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> can log to <application>syslog</application> facilities <literal>LOCAL0</literal> through <literal>LOCAL7</literal> (see <xref - linkend="guc-syslog-facility">), but the default + linkend="guc-syslog-facility"/>), but the default <application>syslog</application> configuration on most platforms will discard all such messages. You will need to add something like: <programlisting> @@ -4435,7 +4435,7 @@ local0.* /var/log/postgresql register an event source and its library with the operating system so that the Windows Event Viewer can display event log messages cleanly. - See <xref linkend="event-log-registration"> for details. + See <xref linkend="event-log-registration"/> for details. </para> </note> </listitem> @@ -4522,7 +4522,7 @@ local0.* /var/log/postgresql file names. (Note that if there are any time-zone-dependent <literal>%</literal>-escapes, the computation is done in the zone specified - by <xref linkend="guc-log-timezone">.) + by <xref linkend="guc-log-timezone"/>.) The supported <literal>%</literal>-escapes are similar to those listed in the Open Group's <ulink url="http://pubs.opengroup.org/onlinepubs/009695399/functions/strftime.html">strftime @@ -4576,7 +4576,7 @@ local0.* /var/log/postgresql server owner can read or write the log files. The other commonly useful setting is <literal>0640</literal>, allowing members of the owner's group to read the files. Note however that to make use of such a - setting, you'll need to alter <xref linkend="guc-log-directory"> to + setting, you'll need to alter <xref linkend="guc-log-directory"/> to store the files somewhere outside the cluster data directory. In any case, it's unwise to make the log files world-readable, since they might contain sensitive data. @@ -4897,13 +4897,13 @@ local0.* /var/log/postgresql <note> <para> When using this option together with - <xref linkend="guc-log-statement">, + <xref linkend="guc-log-statement"/>, the text of statements that are logged because of <varname>log_statement</varname> will not be repeated in the duration log message. If you are not using <application>syslog</application>, it is recommended that you log the PID or session ID using - <xref linkend="guc-log-line-prefix"> + <xref linkend="guc-log-line-prefix"/> so that you can link the statement message to the later duration message using the process ID or session ID. </para> @@ -4914,7 +4914,7 @@ local0.* /var/log/postgresql </variablelist> <para> - <xref linkend="runtime-config-severity-levels"> explains the message + <xref linkend="runtime-config-severity-levels"/> explains the message severity levels used by <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>. If logging output is sent to <systemitem>syslog</systemitem> or Windows' <systemitem>eventlog</systemitem>, the severity levels are translated @@ -5019,7 +5019,7 @@ local0.* /var/log/postgresql It is typically set by an application upon connection to the server. The name will be displayed in the <structname>pg_stat_activity</structname> view and included in CSV log entries. It can also be included in regular - log entries via the <xref linkend="guc-log-line-prefix"> parameter. + log entries via the <xref linkend="guc-log-line-prefix"/> parameter. Only printable ASCII characters may be used in the <varname>application_name</varname> value. Other characters will be replaced with question marks (<literal>?</literal>). @@ -5051,8 +5051,8 @@ local0.* /var/log/postgresql These messages are emitted at <literal>LOG</literal> message level, so by default they will appear in the server log but will not be sent to the client. You can change that by adjusting - <xref linkend="guc-client-min-messages"> and/or - <xref linkend="guc-log-min-messages">. + <xref linkend="guc-client-min-messages"/> and/or + <xref linkend="guc-log-min-messages"/>. These parameters are off by default. </para> </listitem> @@ -5159,7 +5159,7 @@ local0.* /var/log/postgresql <note> <para> The difference between setting this option and setting - <xref linkend="guc-log-min-duration-statement"> to zero is that + <xref linkend="guc-log-min-duration-statement"/> to zero is that exceeding <varname>log_min_duration_statement</varname> forces the text of the query to be logged, but this option doesn't. Thus, if <varname>log_duration</varname> is <literal>on</literal> and @@ -5187,7 +5187,7 @@ local0.* /var/log/postgresql the logging of <literal>DETAIL</literal>, <literal>HINT</literal>, <literal>QUERY</literal>, and <literal>CONTEXT</literal> error information. <literal>VERBOSE</literal> output includes the <symbol>SQLSTATE</symbol> error - code (see also <xref linkend="errcodes-appendix">) and the source code file name, function name, + code (see also <xref linkend="errcodes-appendix"/>) and the source code file name, function name, and line number that generated the error. Only superusers can change this setting. </para> @@ -5397,7 +5397,7 @@ log_line_prefix = '%m [%p] %q%u@%d/%a ' <listitem> <para> Controls whether a log message is produced when a session waits - longer than <xref linkend="guc-deadlock-timeout"> to acquire a + longer than <xref linkend="guc-deadlock-timeout"/> to acquire a lock. This is useful in determining if lock waits are causing poor performance. The default is <literal>off</literal>. Only superusers can change this setting. @@ -5459,7 +5459,7 @@ log_line_prefix = '%m [%p] %q%u@%d/%a ' <listitem> <para> Causes each replication command to be logged in the server log. - See <xref linkend="protocol-replication"> for more information about + See <xref linkend="protocol-replication"/> for more information about replication command. The default value is <literal>off</literal>. Only superusers can change this setting. </para> @@ -5496,12 +5496,12 @@ log_line_prefix = '%m [%p] %q%u@%d/%a ' <listitem> <para> Sets the time zone used for timestamps written in the server log. - Unlike <xref linkend="guc-timezone">, this value is cluster-wide, + Unlike <xref linkend="guc-timezone"/>, this value is cluster-wide, so that all sessions will report timestamps consistently. The built-in default is <literal>GMT</literal>, but that is typically overridden in <filename>postgresql.conf</filename>; <application>initdb</application> will install a setting there corresponding to its system environment. - See <xref linkend="datatype-timezones"> for more information. + See <xref linkend="datatype-timezones"/> for more information. This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> file or on the server command line. </para> @@ -5641,7 +5641,7 @@ COPY postgres_log FROM '/full/path/to/logfile.csv' WITH csv; These settings control how process titles of server processes are modified. Process titles are typically viewed using programs like <application>ps</application> or, on Windows, <application>Process Explorer</application>. - See <xref linkend="monitoring-ps"> for details. + See <xref linkend="monitoring-ps"/> for details. </para> <variablelist> @@ -5697,7 +5697,7 @@ COPY postgres_log FROM '/full/path/to/logfile.csv' WITH csv; When statistics collection is enabled, the data that is produced can be accessed via the <structname>pg_stat</structname> and <structname>pg_statio</structname> family of system views. - Refer to <xref linkend="monitoring"> for more information. + Refer to <xref linkend="monitoring"/> for more information. </para> <variablelist> @@ -5766,12 +5766,12 @@ COPY postgres_log FROM '/full/path/to/logfile.csv' WITH csv; Enables timing of database I/O calls. This parameter is off by default, because it will repeatedly query the operating system for the current time, which may cause significant overhead on some - platforms. You can use the <xref linkend="pgtesttiming"> tool to + platforms. You can use the <xref linkend="pgtesttiming"/> tool to measure the overhead of timing on your system. I/O timing information is - displayed in <xref linkend="pg-stat-database-view">, in the output of - <xref linkend="sql-explain"> when the <literal>BUFFERS</literal> option is - used, and by <xref linkend="pgstatstatements">. Only superusers can + displayed in <xref linkend="pg-stat-database-view"/>, in the output of + <xref linkend="sql-explain"/> when the <literal>BUFFERS</literal> option is + used, and by <xref linkend="pgstatstatements"/>. Only superusers can change this setting. </para> </listitem> @@ -5878,10 +5878,10 @@ COPY postgres_log FROM '/full/path/to/logfile.csv' WITH csv; <para> These settings control the behavior of the <firstterm>autovacuum</firstterm> - feature. Refer to <xref linkend="autovacuum"> for more information. + feature. Refer to <xref linkend="autovacuum"/> for more information. Note that many of these settings can be overridden on a per-table basis; see <xref linkend="sql-createtable-storage-parameters" - endterm="sql-createtable-storage-parameters-title">. + endterm="sql-createtable-storage-parameters-title"/>. </para> <variablelist> @@ -5896,7 +5896,7 @@ COPY postgres_log FROM '/full/path/to/logfile.csv' WITH csv; <para> Controls whether the server should run the autovacuum launcher daemon. This is on by default; however, - <xref linkend="guc-track-counts"> must also be enabled for + <xref linkend="guc-track-counts"/> must also be enabled for autovacuum to work. This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> file or on the server command line; however, autovacuuming can be @@ -5906,7 +5906,7 @@ COPY postgres_log FROM '/full/path/to/logfile.csv' WITH csv; Note that even when this parameter is disabled, the system will launch autovacuum processes if necessary to prevent transaction ID wraparound. See <xref - linkend="vacuum-for-wraparound"> for more information. + linkend="vacuum-for-wraparound"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -6071,7 +6071,7 @@ COPY postgres_log FROM '/full/path/to/logfile.csv' WITH csv; This parameter can only be set at server start, but the setting can be reduced for individual tables by changing table storage parameters. - For more information see <xref linkend="vacuum-for-wraparound">. + For more information see <xref linkend="vacuum-for-wraparound"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -6099,7 +6099,7 @@ COPY postgres_log FROM '/full/path/to/logfile.csv' WITH csv; 400 million multixacts. This parameter can only be set at server start, but the setting can be reduced for individual tables by changing table storage parameters. - For more information see <xref linkend="vacuum-for-multixact-wraparound">. + For more information see <xref linkend="vacuum-for-multixact-wraparound"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -6114,7 +6114,7 @@ COPY postgres_log FROM '/full/path/to/logfile.csv' WITH csv; <para> Specifies the cost delay value that will be used in automatic <command>VACUUM</command> operations. If -1 is specified, the regular - <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-cost-delay"> value will be used. + <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-cost-delay"/> value will be used. The default value is 20 milliseconds. This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> file or on the server command line; @@ -6135,7 +6135,7 @@ COPY postgres_log FROM '/full/path/to/logfile.csv' WITH csv; Specifies the cost limit value that will be used in automatic <command>VACUUM</command> operations. If -1 is specified (which is the default), the regular - <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-cost-limit"> value will be used. Note that + <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-cost-limit"/> value will be used. Note that the value is distributed proportionally among the running autovacuum workers, if there is more than one, so that the sum of the limits for each worker does not exceed the value of this variable. @@ -6230,7 +6230,7 @@ COPY postgres_log FROM '/full/path/to/logfile.csv' WITH csv; The current effective value of the search path can be examined via the <acronym>SQL</acronym> function <function>current_schemas</function> - (see <xref linkend="functions-info">). + (see <xref linkend="functions-info"/>). This is not quite the same as examining the value of <varname>search_path</varname>, since <function>current_schemas</function> shows how the items @@ -6238,7 +6238,7 @@ COPY postgres_log FROM '/full/path/to/logfile.csv' WITH csv; </para> <para> - For more information on schema handling, see <xref linkend="ddl-schemas">. + For more information on schema handling, see <xref linkend="ddl-schemas"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -6264,7 +6264,7 @@ COPY postgres_log FROM '/full/path/to/logfile.csv' WITH csv; <para> For more information on row security policies, - see <xref linkend="sql-createpolicy">. + see <xref linkend="sql-createpolicy"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -6295,7 +6295,7 @@ COPY postgres_log FROM '/full/path/to/logfile.csv' WITH csv; <para> This variable is not used for temporary tables; for them, - <xref linkend="guc-temp-tablespaces"> is consulted instead. + <xref linkend="guc-temp-tablespaces"/> is consulted instead. </para> <para> @@ -6306,7 +6306,7 @@ COPY postgres_log FROM '/full/path/to/logfile.csv' WITH csv; <para> For more information on tablespaces, - see <xref linkend="manage-ag-tablespaces">. + see <xref linkend="manage-ag-tablespaces"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -6355,7 +6355,7 @@ COPY postgres_log FROM '/full/path/to/logfile.csv' WITH csv; </para> <para> - See also <xref linkend="guc-default-tablespace">. + See also <xref linkend="guc-default-tablespace"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -6370,7 +6370,7 @@ COPY postgres_log FROM '/full/path/to/logfile.csv' WITH csv; <para> This parameter is normally on. When set to <literal>off</literal>, it disables validation of the function body string during <xref - linkend="sql-createfunction">. Disabling validation avoids side + linkend="sql-createfunction"/>. Disabling validation avoids side effects of the validation process and avoids false positives due to problems such as forward references. Set this parameter to <literal>off</literal> before loading functions on behalf of other @@ -6400,8 +6400,8 @@ COPY postgres_log FROM '/full/path/to/logfile.csv' WITH csv; </para> <para> - Consult <xref linkend="mvcc"> and <xref - linkend="sql-set-transaction"> for more information. + Consult <xref linkend="mvcc"/> and <xref + linkend="sql-set-transaction"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -6424,7 +6424,7 @@ COPY postgres_log FROM '/full/path/to/logfile.csv' WITH csv; </para> <para> - Consult <xref linkend="sql-set-transaction"> for more information. + Consult <xref linkend="sql-set-transaction"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -6458,7 +6458,7 @@ COPY postgres_log FROM '/full/path/to/logfile.csv' WITH csv; </para> <para> - Consult <xref linkend="sql-set-transaction"> for more information. + Consult <xref linkend="sql-set-transaction"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -6477,7 +6477,7 @@ COPY postgres_log FROM '/full/path/to/logfile.csv' WITH csv; superuser privilege and results in discarding any previously cached query plans. Possible values are <literal>origin</literal> (the default), <literal>replica</literal> and <literal>local</literal>. - See <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> for + See <xref linkend="sql-altertable"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> @@ -6553,7 +6553,7 @@ COPY postgres_log FROM '/full/path/to/logfile.csv' WITH csv; longer than the specified duration in milliseconds. This allows any locks held by that session to be released and the connection slot to be reused; it also allows tuples visible only to this transaction to be vacuumed. See - <xref linkend="routine-vacuuming"> for more details about this. + <xref linkend="routine-vacuuming"/> for more details about this. </para> <para> The default value of 0 disables this feature. @@ -6577,11 +6577,11 @@ COPY postgres_log FROM '/full/path/to/logfile.csv' WITH csv; tuples. The default is 150 million transactions. Although users can set this value anywhere from zero to two billions, <command>VACUUM</command> will silently limit the effective value to 95% of - <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-freeze-max-age">, so that a + <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-freeze-max-age"/>, so that a periodical manual <command>VACUUM</command> has a chance to run before an anti-wraparound autovacuum is launched for the table. For more information see - <xref linkend="vacuum-for-wraparound">. + <xref linkend="vacuum-for-wraparound"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -6600,10 +6600,10 @@ COPY postgres_log FROM '/full/path/to/logfile.csv' WITH csv; The default is 50 million transactions. Although users can set this value anywhere from zero to one billion, <command>VACUUM</command> will silently limit the effective value to half - the value of <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-freeze-max-age">, so + the value of <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-freeze-max-age"/>, so that there is not an unreasonably short time between forced autovacuums. For more information see <xref - linkend="vacuum-for-wraparound">. + linkend="vacuum-for-wraparound"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -6624,10 +6624,10 @@ COPY postgres_log FROM '/full/path/to/logfile.csv' WITH csv; tuples. The default is 150 million multixacts. Although users can set this value anywhere from zero to two billions, <command>VACUUM</command> will silently limit the effective value to 95% of - <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-multixact-freeze-max-age">, so that a + <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-multixact-freeze-max-age"/>, so that a periodical manual <command>VACUUM</command> has a chance to run before an anti-wraparound is launched for the table. - For more information see <xref linkend="vacuum-for-multixact-wraparound">. + For more information see <xref linkend="vacuum-for-multixact-wraparound"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -6646,10 +6646,10 @@ COPY postgres_log FROM '/full/path/to/logfile.csv' WITH csv; is 5 million multixacts. Although users can set this value anywhere from zero to one billion, <command>VACUUM</command> will silently limit the effective value to half - the value of <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-multixact-freeze-max-age">, + the value of <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-multixact-freeze-max-age"/>, so that there is not an unreasonably short time between forced autovacuums. - For more information see <xref linkend="vacuum-for-multixact-wraparound">. + For more information see <xref linkend="vacuum-for-multixact-wraparound"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -6665,7 +6665,7 @@ COPY postgres_log FROM '/full/path/to/logfile.csv' WITH csv; Sets the output format for values of type <type>bytea</type>. Valid values are <literal>hex</literal> (the default) and <literal>escape</literal> (the traditional PostgreSQL - format). See <xref linkend="datatype-binary"> for more + format). See <xref linkend="datatype-binary"/> for more information. The <type>bytea</type> type always accepts both formats on input, regardless of this setting. </para> @@ -6687,7 +6687,7 @@ COPY postgres_log FROM '/full/path/to/logfile.csv' WITH csv; <literal>base64</literal> and <literal>hex</literal>, which are both defined in the XML Schema standard. The default is <literal>base64</literal>. For further information about - XML-related functions, see <xref linkend="functions-xml">. + XML-related functions, see <xref linkend="functions-xml"/>. </para> <para> @@ -6717,7 +6717,7 @@ COPY postgres_log FROM '/full/path/to/logfile.csv' WITH csv; Sets whether <literal>DOCUMENT</literal> or <literal>CONTENT</literal> is implicit when converting between XML and character string values. See <xref - linkend="datatype-xml"> for a description of this. Valid + linkend="datatype-xml"/> for a description of this. Valid values are <literal>DOCUMENT</literal> and <literal>CONTENT</literal>. The default is <literal>CONTENT</literal>. @@ -6748,7 +6748,7 @@ SET XML OPTION { DOCUMENT | CONTENT }; The default is four megabytes (<literal>4MB</literal>). This setting can be overridden for individual GIN indexes by changing index storage parameters. - See <xref linkend="gin-fast-update"> and <xref linkend="gin-tips"> + See <xref linkend="gin-fast-update"/> and <xref linkend="gin-tips"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> @@ -6780,7 +6780,7 @@ SET XML OPTION { DOCUMENT | CONTENT }; and <literal>European</literal> are synonyms for <literal>DMY</literal>; the keywords <literal>US</literal>, <literal>NonEuro</literal>, and <literal>NonEuropean</literal> are synonyms for <literal>MDY</literal>. See - <xref linkend="datatype-datetime"> for more information. The + <xref linkend="datatype-datetime"/> for more information. The built-in default is <literal>ISO, MDY</literal>, but <application>initdb</application> will initialize the configuration file with a setting that corresponds to the @@ -6802,7 +6802,7 @@ SET XML OPTION { DOCUMENT | CONTENT }; output matching <acronym>SQL</acronym> standard interval literals. The value <literal>postgres</literal> (which is the default) will produce output matching <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> releases prior to 8.4 - when the <xref linkend="guc-datestyle"> + when the <xref linkend="guc-datestyle"/> parameter was set to <literal>ISO</literal>. The value <literal>postgres_verbose</literal> will produce output matching <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> releases prior to 8.4 @@ -6815,7 +6815,7 @@ SET XML OPTION { DOCUMENT | CONTENT }; <para> The <varname>IntervalStyle</varname> parameter also affects the interpretation of ambiguous interval input. See - <xref linkend="datatype-interval-input"> for more information. + <xref linkend="datatype-interval-input"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -6833,7 +6833,7 @@ SET XML OPTION { DOCUMENT | CONTENT }; The built-in default is <literal>GMT</literal>, but that is typically overridden in <filename>postgresql.conf</filename>; <application>initdb</application> will install a setting there corresponding to its system environment. - See <xref linkend="datatype-timezones"> for more information. + See <xref linkend="datatype-timezones"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -6852,7 +6852,7 @@ SET XML OPTION { DOCUMENT | CONTENT }; which is a collection that works in most of the world; there are also <literal>'Australia'</literal> and <literal>'India'</literal>, and other collections can be defined for a particular installation. - See <xref linkend="datetime-config-files"> for more information. + See <xref linkend="datetime-config-files"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -6880,7 +6880,7 @@ SET XML OPTION { DOCUMENT | CONTENT }; partially-significant digits; this is especially useful for dumping float data that needs to be restored exactly. Or it can be set negative to suppress unwanted digits. - See also <xref linkend="datatype-float">. + See also <xref linkend="datatype-float"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -6897,7 +6897,7 @@ SET XML OPTION { DOCUMENT | CONTENT }; Sets the client-side encoding (character set). The default is to use the database encoding. The character sets supported by the <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> - server are described in <xref linkend="multibyte-charset-supported">. + server are described in <xref linkend="multibyte-charset-supported"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -6911,7 +6911,7 @@ SET XML OPTION { DOCUMENT | CONTENT }; <listitem> <para> Sets the language in which messages are displayed. Acceptable - values are system-dependent; see <xref linkend="locale"> for + values are system-dependent; see <xref linkend="locale"/> for more information. If this variable is set to the empty string (which is the default) then the value is inherited from the execution environment of the server in a system-dependent way. @@ -6945,7 +6945,7 @@ SET XML OPTION { DOCUMENT | CONTENT }; Sets the locale to use for formatting monetary amounts, for example with the <function>to_char</function> family of functions. Acceptable values are system-dependent; see <xref - linkend="locale"> for more information. If this variable is + linkend="locale"/> for more information. If this variable is set to the empty string (which is the default) then the value is inherited from the execution environment of the server in a system-dependent way. @@ -6964,7 +6964,7 @@ SET XML OPTION { DOCUMENT | CONTENT }; Sets the locale to use for formatting numbers, for example with the <function>to_char</function> family of functions. Acceptable values are system-dependent; see <xref - linkend="locale"> for more information. If this variable is + linkend="locale"/> for more information. If this variable is set to the empty string (which is the default) then the value is inherited from the execution environment of the server in a system-dependent way. @@ -6983,7 +6983,7 @@ SET XML OPTION { DOCUMENT | CONTENT }; Sets the locale to use for formatting dates and times, for example with the <function>to_char</function> family of functions. Acceptable values are system-dependent; see <xref - linkend="locale"> for more information. If this variable is + linkend="locale"/> for more information. If this variable is set to the empty string (which is the default) then the value is inherited from the execution environment of the server in a system-dependent way. @@ -7002,7 +7002,7 @@ SET XML OPTION { DOCUMENT | CONTENT }; Selects the text search configuration that is used by those variants of the text search functions that do not have an explicit argument specifying the configuration. - See <xref linkend="textsearch"> for further information. + See <xref linkend="textsearch"/> for further information. The built-in default is <literal>pg_catalog.simple</literal>, but <application>initdb</application> will initialize the configuration file with a setting that corresponds to the @@ -7067,7 +7067,7 @@ SET XML OPTION { DOCUMENT | CONTENT }; This variable specifies one or more shared libraries that are to be preloaded at connection start. It contains a comma-separated list of library names, where each name - is interpreted as for the <xref linkend="sql-load"> command. + is interpreted as for the <xref linkend="sql-load"/> command. Whitespace between entries is ignored; surround a library name with double quotes if you need to include whitespace or commas in the name. The parameter value only takes effect at the start of the connection. @@ -7101,7 +7101,7 @@ SET XML OPTION { DOCUMENT | CONTENT }; <para> However, unless a module is specifically designed to be used in this way by non-superusers, this is usually not the right setting to use. Look - at <xref linkend="guc-session-preload-libraries"> instead. + at <xref linkend="guc-session-preload-libraries"/> instead. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -7118,7 +7118,7 @@ SET XML OPTION { DOCUMENT | CONTENT }; This variable specifies one or more shared libraries that are to be preloaded at connection start. It contains a comma-separated list of library names, where each name - is interpreted as for the <xref linkend="sql-load"> command. + is interpreted as for the <xref linkend="sql-load"/> command. Whitespace between entries is ignored; surround a library name with double quotes if you need to include whitespace or commas in the name. The parameter value only takes effect at the start of the connection. @@ -7132,7 +7132,7 @@ SET XML OPTION { DOCUMENT | CONTENT }; performance-measurement libraries to be loaded into specific sessions without an explicit <command>LOAD</command> command being given. For - example, <xref linkend="auto-explain"> could be enabled for all + example, <xref linkend="auto-explain"/> could be enabled for all sessions under a given user name by setting this parameter with <command>ALTER ROLE SET</command>. Also, this parameter can be changed without restarting the server (but changes only take effect when a new @@ -7141,7 +7141,7 @@ SET XML OPTION { DOCUMENT | CONTENT }; </para> <para> - Unlike <xref linkend="guc-shared-preload-libraries">, there is no large + Unlike <xref linkend="guc-shared-preload-libraries"/>, there is no large performance advantage to loading a library at session start rather than when it is first used. There is some advantage, however, when connection pooling is used. @@ -7160,7 +7160,7 @@ SET XML OPTION { DOCUMENT | CONTENT }; This variable specifies one or more shared libraries to be preloaded at server start. It contains a comma-separated list of library names, where each name - is interpreted as for the <xref linkend="sql-load"> command. + is interpreted as for the <xref linkend="sql-load"/> command. Whitespace between entries is ignored; surround a library name with double quotes if you need to include whitespace or commas in the name. This parameter can only be set at server start. If a specified @@ -7183,7 +7183,7 @@ SET XML OPTION { DOCUMENT | CONTENT }; parameter is recommended only for libraries that will be used in most sessions. Also, changing this parameter requires a server restart, so this is not the right setting to use for short-term debugging tasks, - say. Use <xref linkend="guc-session-preload-libraries"> for that + say. Use <xref linkend="guc-session-preload-libraries"/> for that instead. </para> @@ -7269,7 +7269,7 @@ dynamic_library_path = 'C:\tools\postgresql;H:\my_project\lib;$libdir' <listitem> <para> Soft upper limit of the size of the set returned by GIN index scans. For more - information see <xref linkend="gin-tips">. + information see <xref linkend="gin-tips"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -7317,7 +7317,7 @@ dynamic_library_path = 'C:\tools\postgresql;H:\my_project\lib;$libdir' </para> <para> - When <xref linkend="guc-log-lock-waits"> is set, + When <xref linkend="guc-log-lock-waits"/> is set, this parameter also determines the length of time to wait before a log message is issued about the lock wait. If you are trying to investigate locking delays you might want to set a shorter than @@ -7336,8 +7336,8 @@ dynamic_library_path = 'C:\tools\postgresql;H:\my_project\lib;$libdir' <para> The shared lock table tracks locks on <varname>max_locks_per_transaction</varname> * (<xref - linkend="guc-max-connections"> + <xref - linkend="guc-max-prepared-transactions">) objects (e.g., tables); + linkend="guc-max-connections"/> + <xref + linkend="guc-max-prepared-transactions"/>) objects (e.g., tables); hence, no more than this many distinct objects can be locked at any one time. This parameter controls the average number of object locks allocated for each transaction; individual transactions @@ -7368,8 +7368,8 @@ dynamic_library_path = 'C:\tools\postgresql;H:\my_project\lib;$libdir' <para> The shared predicate lock table tracks locks on <varname>max_pred_locks_per_transaction</varname> * (<xref - linkend="guc-max-connections"> + <xref - linkend="guc-max-prepared-transactions">) objects (e.g., tables); + linkend="guc-max-connections"/> + <xref + linkend="guc-max-prepared-transactions"/>) objects (e.g., tables); hence, no more than this many distinct objects can be locked at any one time. This parameter controls the average number of object locks allocated for each transaction; individual transactions @@ -7396,7 +7396,7 @@ dynamic_library_path = 'C:\tools\postgresql;H:\my_project\lib;$libdir' predicate-locked before the lock is promoted to covering the whole relation. Values greater than or equal to zero mean an absolute limit, while negative values - mean <xref linkend="guc-max-pred-locks-per-transaction"> divided by + mean <xref linkend="guc-max-pred-locks-per-transaction"/> divided by the absolute value of this setting. The default is -2, which keeps the behavior from previous versions of <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>. This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> @@ -7589,7 +7589,7 @@ dynamic_library_path = 'C:\tools\postgresql;H:\my_project\lib;$libdir' </para> <para> - See <xref linkend="sql-precedence"> for more information. + See <xref linkend="sql-precedence"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -7607,7 +7607,7 @@ dynamic_library_path = 'C:\tools\postgresql;H:\my_project\lib;$libdir' output of <command>EXPLAIN</command> as well as the results of functions like <function>pg_get_viewdef</function>. See also the <option>--quote-all-identifiers</option> option of - <xref linkend="app-pgdump"> and <xref linkend="app-pg-dumpall">. + <xref linkend="app-pgdump"/> and <xref linkend="app-pg-dumpall"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -7630,7 +7630,7 @@ dynamic_library_path = 'C:\tools\postgresql;H:\my_project\lib;$libdir' parameter to determine how string literals will be processed. The presence of this parameter can also be taken as an indication that the escape string syntax (<literal>E'...'</literal>) is supported. - Escape string syntax (<xref linkend="sql-syntax-strings-escape">) + Escape string syntax (<xref linkend="sql-syntax-strings-escape"/>) should be used if an application desires backslashes to be treated as escape characters. </para> @@ -7710,7 +7710,7 @@ dynamic_library_path = 'C:\tools\postgresql;H:\my_project\lib;$libdir' </para> <para> - Refer to <xref linkend="functions-comparison"> for related information. + Refer to <xref linkend="functions-comparison"/> for related information. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -7788,9 +7788,9 @@ dynamic_library_path = 'C:\tools\postgresql;H:\my_project\lib;$libdir' Reports the size of a disk block. It is determined by the value of <literal>BLCKSZ</literal> when building the server. The default value is 8192 bytes. The meaning of some configuration - variables (such as <xref linkend="guc-shared-buffers">) is + variables (such as <xref linkend="guc-shared-buffers"/>) is influenced by <varname>block_size</varname>. See <xref - linkend="runtime-config-resource"> for information. + linkend="runtime-config-resource"/> for information. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -7804,7 +7804,7 @@ dynamic_library_path = 'C:\tools\postgresql;H:\my_project\lib;$libdir' <listitem> <para> Reports whether data checksums are enabled for this cluster. - See <xref linkend="app-initdb-data-checksums"> for more information. + See <xref linkend="app-initdb-data-checksums"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -7853,7 +7853,7 @@ dynamic_library_path = 'C:\tools\postgresql;H:\my_project\lib;$libdir' <listitem> <para> Reports the locale in which sorting of textual data is done. - See <xref linkend="locale"> for more information. + See <xref linkend="locale"/> for more information. This value is determined when a database is created. </para> </listitem> @@ -7868,7 +7868,7 @@ dynamic_library_path = 'C:\tools\postgresql;H:\my_project\lib;$libdir' <listitem> <para> Reports the locale that determines character classifications. - See <xref linkend="locale"> for more information. + See <xref linkend="locale"/> for more information. This value is determined when a database is created. Ordinarily this will be the same as <varname>lc_collate</varname>, but for special applications it might be set differently. @@ -7953,7 +7953,7 @@ dynamic_library_path = 'C:\tools\postgresql;H:\my_project\lib;$libdir' Reports the database encoding (character set). It is determined when the database is created. Ordinarily, clients need only be concerned with the value of <xref - linkend="guc-client-encoding">. + linkend="guc-client-encoding"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -8012,7 +8012,7 @@ dynamic_library_path = 'C:\tools\postgresql;H:\my_project\lib;$libdir' Reports the number of blocks (pages) in a WAL segment file. The total size of a WAL segment file in bytes is equal to <varname>wal_segment_size</varname> multiplied by <varname>wal_block_size</varname>; - by default this is 16MB. See <xref linkend="wal-configuration"> for + by default this is 16MB. See <xref linkend="wal-configuration"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> @@ -8140,8 +8140,8 @@ dynamic_library_path = 'C:\tools\postgresql;H:\my_project\lib;$libdir' <para> Generates a great amount of debugging output for the <command>LISTEN</command> and <command>NOTIFY</command> - commands. <xref linkend="guc-client-min-messages"> or - <xref linkend="guc-log-min-messages"> must be + commands. <xref linkend="guc-client-min-messages"/> or + <xref linkend="guc-log-min-messages"/> must be <literal>DEBUG1</literal> or lower to send this output to the client or server logs, respectively. </para> @@ -8158,7 +8158,7 @@ dynamic_library_path = 'C:\tools\postgresql;H:\my_project\lib;$libdir' <para> Enables logging of recovery-related debugging output that otherwise would not be logged. This parameter allows the user to override the - normal setting of <xref linkend="guc-log-min-messages">, but only for + normal setting of <xref linkend="guc-log-min-messages"/>, but only for specific messages. This is intended for use in debugging Hot Standby. Valid values are <literal>DEBUG5</literal>, <literal>DEBUG4</literal>, <literal>DEBUG3</literal>, <literal>DEBUG2</literal>, <literal>DEBUG1</literal>, and @@ -8401,7 +8401,7 @@ LOG: CleanUpLock: deleting: lock(0xb7acd844) id(24688,24696,0,0,0,1) </term> <listitem> <para> - Only has effect if <xref linkend="app-initdb-data-checksums"> are enabled. + Only has effect if <xref linkend="app-initdb-data-checksums"/> are enabled. </para> <para> Detection of a checksum failure during a read normally causes @@ -8452,7 +8452,7 @@ LOG: CleanUpLock: deleting: lock(0xb7acd844) id(24688,24696,0,0,0,1) <para> For convenience there are also single letter command-line option switches available for some parameters. They are described in - <xref linkend="runtime-config-short-table">. Some of these + <xref linkend="runtime-config-short-table"/>. Some of these options exist for historical reasons, and their presence as a single-letter option does not necessarily indicate an endorsement to use the option heavily. diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/contrib.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/contrib.sgml index 7dd203e9cdc..0622227bee0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/contrib.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/contrib.sgml @@ -16,14 +16,14 @@ <para> This appendix covers extensions and other server plug-in modules found in - <literal>contrib</literal>. <xref linkend="contrib-prog"> covers utility + <literal>contrib</literal>. <xref linkend="contrib-prog"/> covers utility programs. </para> <para> When building from the source distribution, these components are not built automatically, unless you build the "world" target - (see <xref linkend="build">). + (see <xref linkend="build"/>). You can build and install all of them by running: <screen> <userinput>make</userinput> @@ -55,7 +55,7 @@ To make use of one of these modules, after you have installed the code you need to register the new SQL objects in the database system. In <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> 9.1 and later, this is done by executing - a <xref linkend="sql-createextension"> command. In a fresh database, + a <xref linkend="sql-createextension"/> command. In a fresh database, you can simply do <programlisting> @@ -89,16 +89,16 @@ CREATE EXTENSION <replaceable>module_name</replaceable> FROM unpackaged; This will update the pre-9.1 objects of the module into a proper <firstterm>extension</firstterm> object. Future updates to the module will be - managed by <xref linkend="sql-alterextension">. + managed by <xref linkend="sql-alterextension"/>. For more information about extension updates, see - <xref linkend="extend-extensions">. + <xref linkend="extend-extensions"/>. </para> <para> Note, however, that some of these modules are not <quote>extensions</quote> in this sense, but are loaded into the server in some other way, for instance by way of - <xref linkend="guc-shared-preload-libraries">. See the documentation of each + <xref linkend="guc-shared-preload-libraries"/>. See the documentation of each module for details. </para> @@ -163,7 +163,7 @@ pages. <para> This appendix and the previous one contain information regarding the modules that can be found in the <literal>contrib</literal> directory of the - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> distribution. See <xref linkend="contrib"> for + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> distribution. See <xref linkend="contrib"/> for more information about the <literal>contrib</literal> section in general and server extensions and plug-ins found in <literal>contrib</literal> specifically. @@ -184,7 +184,7 @@ pages. This section covers <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> client applications in <literal>contrib</literal>. They can be run from anywhere, independent of where the database server resides. See - also <xref linkend="reference-client"> for information about client + also <xref linkend="reference-client"/> for information about client applications that part of the core <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> distribution. </para> @@ -200,7 +200,7 @@ pages. This section covers <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> server-related applications in <literal>contrib</literal>. They are typically run on the host where the database server resides. See also <xref - linkend="reference-server"> for information about server applications that + linkend="reference-server"/> for information about server applications that part of the core <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> distribution. </para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/cube.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/cube.sgml index 46d8e4eb8fe..b995dc7e2ad 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/cube.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/cube.sgml @@ -16,7 +16,7 @@ <title>Syntax</title> <para> - <xref linkend="cube-repr-table"> shows the valid external + <xref linkend="cube-repr-table"/> shows the valid external representations for the <type>cube</type> type. <replaceable>x</replaceable>, <replaceable>y</replaceable>, etc. denote floating-point numbers. @@ -106,7 +106,7 @@ <title>Usage</title> <para> - <xref linkend="cube-operators-table"> shows the operators provided for + <xref linkend="cube-operators-table"/> shows the operators provided for type <type>cube</type>. </para> @@ -268,7 +268,7 @@ SELECT c FROM test ORDER BY c ~> 3 DESC LIMIT 5; </para> <para> - <xref linkend="cube-functions-table"> shows the available functions. + <xref linkend="cube-functions-table"/> shows the available functions. </para> <table id="cube-functions-table"> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/custom-scan.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/custom-scan.sgml index a46641674fa..24631f5f404 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/custom-scan.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/custom-scan.sgml @@ -123,7 +123,7 @@ Plan *(*PlanCustomPath) (PlannerInfo *root, </programlisting> Convert a custom path to a finished plan. The return value will generally be a <literal>CustomScan</literal> object, which the callback must allocate and - initialize. See <xref linkend="custom-scan-plan"> for more details. + initialize. See <xref linkend="custom-scan-plan"/> for more details. </para> </sect2> </sect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/datatype.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/datatype.sgml index 3d46098263d..9aa9b28f3e2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/datatype.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/datatype.sgml @@ -16,11 +16,11 @@ <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> has a rich set of native data types available to users. Users can add new types to <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using the <xref - linkend="sql-createtype"> command. + linkend="sql-createtype"/> command. </para> <para> - <xref linkend="datatype-table"> shows all the built-in general-purpose data + <xref linkend="datatype-table"/> shows all the built-in general-purpose data types. Most of the alternative names listed in the <quote>Aliases</quote> column are the names used internally by <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> for historical reasons. In @@ -336,7 +336,7 @@ <para> Numeric types consist of two-, four-, and eight-byte integers, four- and eight-byte floating-point numbers, and selectable-precision - decimals. <xref linkend="datatype-numeric-table"> lists the + decimals. <xref linkend="datatype-numeric-table"/> lists the available types. </para> @@ -424,9 +424,9 @@ <para> The syntax of constants for the numeric types is described in - <xref linkend="sql-syntax-constants">. The numeric types have a + <xref linkend="sql-syntax-constants"/>. The numeric types have a full set of corresponding arithmetic operators and - functions. Refer to <xref linkend="functions"> for more + functions. Refer to <xref linkend="functions"/> for more information. The following sections describe the types in detail. </para> @@ -559,7 +559,7 @@ NUMERIC The maximum allowed precision when explicitly specified in the type declaration is 1000; <type>NUMERIC</type> without a specified precision is subject to the limits described in <xref - linkend="datatype-numeric-table">. + linkend="datatype-numeric-table"/>. </para> </note> @@ -728,7 +728,7 @@ FROM generate_series(-3.5, 3.5, 1) as x; <note> <para> - The <xref linkend="guc-extra-float-digits"> setting controls the + The <xref linkend="guc-extra-float-digits"/> setting controls the number of extra significant digits included when a floating point value is converted to text for output. With the default value of <literal>0</literal>, the output is the same on every platform @@ -841,7 +841,7 @@ FROM generate_series(-3.5, 3.5, 1) as x; <para> This section describes a PostgreSQL-specific way to create an autoincrementing column. Another way is to use the SQL-standard - identity column feature, described at <xref linkend="sql-createtable">. + identity column feature, described at <xref linkend="sql-createtable"/>. </para> </note> @@ -888,7 +888,7 @@ ALTER SEQUENCE <replaceable class="parameter">tablename</replaceable>_<replaceab from the sequence is still "used up" even if a row containing that value is never successfully inserted into the table column. This may happen, for example, if the inserting transaction rolls back. - See <literal>nextval()</literal> in <xref linkend="functions-sequence"> + See <literal>nextval()</literal> in <xref linkend="functions-sequence"/> for details. </para> </note> @@ -929,8 +929,8 @@ ALTER SEQUENCE <replaceable class="parameter">tablename</replaceable>_<replaceab <para> The <type>money</type> type stores a currency amount with a fixed fractional precision; see <xref - linkend="datatype-money-table">. The fractional precision is - determined by the database's <xref linkend="guc-lc-monetary"> setting. + linkend="datatype-money-table"/>. The fractional precision is + determined by the database's <xref linkend="guc-lc-monetary"/> setting. The range shown in the table assumes there are two fractional digits. Input is accepted in a variety of formats, including integer and floating-point literals, as well as typical @@ -1063,7 +1063,7 @@ SELECT '52093.89'::money::numeric::float8; </table> <para> - <xref linkend="datatype-character-table"> shows the + <xref linkend="datatype-character-table"/> shows the general-purpose character types available in <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>. </para> @@ -1166,12 +1166,12 @@ SELECT '52093.89'::money::numeric::float8; </tip> <para> - Refer to <xref linkend="sql-syntax-strings"> for information about - the syntax of string literals, and to <xref linkend="functions"> + Refer to <xref linkend="sql-syntax-strings"/> for information about + the syntax of string literals, and to <xref linkend="functions"/> for information about available operators and functions. The database character set determines the character set used to store textual values; for more information on character set support, - refer to <xref linkend="multibyte">. + refer to <xref linkend="multibyte"/>. </para> <example> @@ -1180,7 +1180,7 @@ SELECT '52093.89'::money::numeric::float8; <programlisting> CREATE TABLE test1 (a character(4)); INSERT INTO test1 VALUES ('ok'); -SELECT a, char_length(a) FROM test1; -- <co id="co.datatype-char"> +SELECT a, char_length(a) FROM test1; -- <co id="co.datatype-char"/> <computeroutput> a | char_length ------+------------- @@ -1206,7 +1206,7 @@ SELECT b, char_length(b) FROM test2; <callout arearefs="co.datatype-char"> <para> The <function>char_length</function> function is discussed in - <xref linkend="functions-string">. + <xref linkend="functions-string"/>. </para> </callout> </calloutlist> @@ -1215,7 +1215,7 @@ SELECT b, char_length(b) FROM test2; <para> There are two other fixed-length character types in <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>, shown in <xref - linkend="datatype-character-special-table">. The <type>name</type> + linkend="datatype-character-special-table"/>. The <type>name</type> type exists <emphasis>only</emphasis> for the storage of identifiers in the internal system catalogs and is not intended for use by the general user. Its length is currently defined as 64 bytes (63 usable characters plus @@ -1269,7 +1269,7 @@ SELECT b, char_length(b) FROM test2; <para> The <type>bytea</type> data type allows storage of binary strings; - see <xref linkend="datatype-binary-table">. + see <xref linkend="datatype-binary-table"/>. </para> <table id="datatype-binary-table"> @@ -1313,7 +1313,7 @@ SELECT b, char_length(b) FROM test2; input and output: <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>'s historical <quote>escape</quote> format, and <quote>hex</quote> format. Both of these are always accepted on input. The output format depends - on the configuration parameter <xref linkend="guc-bytea-output">; + on the configuration parameter <xref linkend="guc-bytea-output"/>; the default is hex. (Note that the hex format was introduced in <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> 9.0; earlier versions and some tools don't understand it.) @@ -1384,7 +1384,7 @@ SELECT E'\\xDEADBEEF'; literal using escape string syntax). Backslash itself (octet value 92) can alternatively be represented by double backslashes. - <xref linkend="datatype-binary-sqlesc"> + <xref linkend="datatype-binary-sqlesc"/> shows the characters that must be escaped, and gives the alternative escape sequences where applicable. </para> @@ -1443,14 +1443,14 @@ SELECT E'\\xDEADBEEF'; The requirement to escape <emphasis>non-printable</emphasis> octets varies depending on locale settings. In some instances you can get away with leaving them unescaped. Note that the result in each of the examples - in <xref linkend="datatype-binary-sqlesc"> was exactly one octet in + in <xref linkend="datatype-binary-sqlesc"/> was exactly one octet in length, even though the output representation is sometimes more than one character. </para> <para> The reason multiple backslashes are required, as shown - in <xref linkend="datatype-binary-sqlesc">, is that an input + in <xref linkend="datatype-binary-sqlesc"/>, is that an input string written as a string literal must pass through two parse phases in the <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> server. The first backslash of each pair is interpreted as an escape @@ -1467,7 +1467,7 @@ SELECT E'\\xDEADBEEF'; to a single octet with a decimal value of 1. Note that the single-quote character is not treated specially by <type>bytea</type>, so it follows the normal rules for string literals. (See also - <xref linkend="sql-syntax-strings">.) + <xref linkend="sql-syntax-strings"/>.) </para> <para> @@ -1477,7 +1477,7 @@ SELECT E'\\xDEADBEEF'; Most <quote>printable</quote> octets are represented by their standard representation in the client character set. The octet with decimal value 92 (backslash) is doubled in the output. - Details are in <xref linkend="datatype-binary-resesc">. + Details are in <xref linkend="datatype-binary-resesc"/>. </para> <table id="datatype-binary-resesc"> @@ -1571,12 +1571,12 @@ SELECT E'\\xDEADBEEF'; <para> <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports the full set of <acronym>SQL</acronym> date and time types, shown in <xref - linkend="datatype-datetime-table">. The operations available + linkend="datatype-datetime-table"/>. The operations available on these data types are described in - <xref linkend="functions-datetime">. + <xref linkend="functions-datetime"/>. Dates are counted according to the Gregorian calendar, even in years before that calendar was introduced (see <xref - linkend="datetime-units-history"> for more information). + linkend="datetime-units-history"/> for more information). </para> <table id="datatype-datetime-table"> @@ -1716,7 +1716,7 @@ MINUTE TO SECOND traditional <productname>POSTGRES</productname>, and others. For some formats, ordering of day, month, and year in date input is ambiguous and there is support for specifying the expected - ordering of these fields. Set the <xref linkend="guc-datestyle"> parameter + ordering of these fields. Set the <xref linkend="guc-datestyle"/> parameter to <literal>MDY</literal> to select month-day-year interpretation, <literal>DMY</literal> to select day-month-year interpretation, or <literal>YMD</literal> to select year-month-day interpretation. @@ -1726,7 +1726,7 @@ MINUTE TO SECOND <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> is more flexible in handling date/time input than the <acronym>SQL</acronym> standard requires. - See <xref linkend="datetime-appendix"> + See <xref linkend="datetime-appendix"/> for the exact parsing rules of date/time input and for the recognized text fields including months, days of the week, and time zones. @@ -1735,7 +1735,7 @@ MINUTE TO SECOND <para> Remember that any date or time literal input needs to be enclosed in single quotes, like text strings. Refer to - <xref linkend="sql-syntax-constants-generic"> for more + <xref linkend="sql-syntax-constants-generic"/> for more information. <acronym>SQL</acronym> requires the following syntax <synopsis> @@ -1759,7 +1759,7 @@ MINUTE TO SECOND </indexterm> <para> - <xref linkend="datatype-datetime-date-table"> shows some possible + <xref linkend="datatype-datetime-date-table"/> shows some possible inputs for the <type>date</type> type. </para> @@ -1872,8 +1872,8 @@ MINUTE TO SECOND <para> Valid input for these types consists of a time of day followed by an optional time zone. (See <xref - linkend="datatype-datetime-time-table"> - and <xref linkend="datatype-timezone-table">.) If a time zone is + linkend="datatype-datetime-time-table"/> + and <xref linkend="datatype-timezone-table"/>.) If a time zone is specified in the input for <type>time without time zone</type>, it is silently ignored. You can also specify a date but it will be ignored, except when you use a time zone name that involves a @@ -1993,7 +1993,7 @@ MINUTE TO SECOND </table> <para> - Refer to <xref linkend="datatype-timezones"> for more information on how + Refer to <xref linkend="datatype-timezones"/> for more information on how to specify time zones. </para> </sect3> @@ -2074,7 +2074,7 @@ January 8 04:05:06 1999 PST time zone specified is converted to UTC using the appropriate offset for that time zone. If no time zone is stated in the input string, then it is assumed to be in the time zone indicated by the system's - <xref linkend="guc-timezone"> parameter, and is converted to UTC using the + <xref linkend="guc-timezone"/> parameter, and is converted to UTC using the offset for the <varname>timezone</varname> zone. </para> @@ -2084,7 +2084,7 @@ January 8 04:05:06 1999 PST current <varname>timezone</varname> zone, and displayed as local time in that zone. To see the time in another time zone, either change <varname>timezone</varname> or use the <literal>AT TIME ZONE</literal> construct - (see <xref linkend="functions-datetime-zoneconvert">). + (see <xref linkend="functions-datetime-zoneconvert"/>). </para> <para> @@ -2112,7 +2112,7 @@ January 8 04:05:06 1999 PST <para> <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports several special date/time input values for convenience, as shown in <xref - linkend="datatype-datetime-special-table">. The values + linkend="datatype-datetime-special-table"/>. The values <literal>infinity</literal> and <literal>-infinity</literal> are specially represented inside the system and will be displayed unchanged; but the others are simply notational shorthands @@ -2186,7 +2186,7 @@ January 8 04:05:06 1999 PST <literal>CURRENT_TIMESTAMP</literal>, <literal>LOCALTIME</literal>, <literal>LOCALTIMESTAMP</literal>. The latter four accept an optional subsecond precision specification. (See <xref - linkend="functions-datetime-current">.) Note that these are + linkend="functions-datetime-current"/>.) Note that these are SQL functions and are <emphasis>not</emphasis> recognized in data input strings. </para> @@ -2218,7 +2218,7 @@ January 8 04:05:06 1999 PST <acronym>SQL</acronym> standard requires the use of the ISO 8601 format. The name of the <quote>SQL</quote> output format is a historical accident.) <xref - linkend="datatype-datetime-output-table"> shows examples of each + linkend="datatype-datetime-output-table"/> shows examples of each output style. The output of the <type>date</type> and <type>time</type> types is generally only the date or time part in accordance with the given examples. However, the @@ -2275,9 +2275,9 @@ January 8 04:05:06 1999 PST In the <acronym>SQL</acronym> and POSTGRES styles, day appears before month if DMY field ordering has been specified, otherwise month appears before day. - (See <xref linkend="datatype-datetime-input"> + (See <xref linkend="datatype-datetime-input"/> for how this setting also affects interpretation of input values.) - <xref linkend="datatype-datetime-output2-table"> shows examples. + <xref linkend="datatype-datetime-output2-table"/> shows examples. </para> <table id="datatype-datetime-output2-table"> @@ -2313,7 +2313,7 @@ January 8 04:05:06 1999 PST <para> The date/time style can be selected by the user using the <command>SET datestyle</command> command, the <xref - linkend="guc-datestyle"> parameter in the + linkend="guc-datestyle"/> parameter in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> configuration file, or the <envar>PGDATESTYLE</envar> environment variable on the server or client. @@ -2321,7 +2321,7 @@ January 8 04:05:06 1999 PST <para> The formatting function <function>to_char</function> - (see <xref linkend="functions-formatting">) is also available as + (see <xref linkend="functions-formatting"/>) is also available as a more flexible way to format date/time output. </para> </sect2> @@ -2391,7 +2391,7 @@ January 8 04:05:06 1999 PST <para> All timezone-aware dates and times are stored internally in <acronym>UTC</acronym>. They are converted to local time - in the zone specified by the <xref linkend="guc-timezone"> configuration + in the zone specified by the <xref linkend="guc-timezone"/> configuration parameter before being displayed to the client. </para> @@ -2404,7 +2404,7 @@ January 8 04:05:06 1999 PST A full time zone name, for example <literal>America/New_York</literal>. The recognized time zone names are listed in the <literal>pg_timezone_names</literal> view (see <xref - linkend="view-pg-timezone-names">). + linkend="view-pg-timezone-names"/>). <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> uses the widely-used IANA time zone data for this purpose, so the same time zone names are also recognized by much other software. @@ -2417,9 +2417,9 @@ January 8 04:05:06 1999 PST contrast to full time zone names which can imply a set of daylight savings transition-date rules as well. The recognized abbreviations are listed in the <literal>pg_timezone_abbrevs</literal> view (see <xref - linkend="view-pg-timezone-abbrevs">). You cannot set the - configuration parameters <xref linkend="guc-timezone"> or - <xref linkend="guc-log-timezone"> to a time + linkend="view-pg-timezone-abbrevs"/>). You cannot set the + configuration parameters <xref linkend="guc-timezone"/> or + <xref linkend="guc-log-timezone"/> to a time zone abbreviation, but you can use abbreviations in date/time input values and with the <literal>AT TIME ZONE</literal> operator. @@ -2499,13 +2499,13 @@ January 8 04:05:06 1999 PST they are obtained from configuration files stored under <filename>.../share/timezone/</filename> and <filename>.../share/timezonesets/</filename> of the installation directory - (see <xref linkend="datetime-config-files">). + (see <xref linkend="datetime-config-files"/>). </para> <para> - The <xref linkend="guc-timezone"> configuration parameter can + The <xref linkend="guc-timezone"/> configuration parameter can be set in the file <filename>postgresql.conf</filename>, or in any of the - other standard ways described in <xref linkend="runtime-config">. + other standard ways described in <xref linkend="runtime-config"/>. There are also some special ways to set it: <itemizedlist> @@ -2556,7 +2556,7 @@ January 8 04:05:06 1999 PST of the different units are implicitly added with appropriate sign accounting. <literal>ago</literal> negates all the fields. This syntax is also used for interval output, if - <xref linkend="guc-intervalstyle"> is set to + <xref linkend="guc-intervalstyle"/> is set to <literal>postgres_verbose</literal>. </para> @@ -2582,7 +2582,7 @@ P <replaceable>quantity</replaceable> <replaceable>unit</replaceable> <optional> The string must start with a <literal>P</literal>, and may include a <literal>T</literal> that introduces the time-of-day units. The available unit abbreviations are given in <xref - linkend="datatype-interval-iso8601-units">. Units may be + linkend="datatype-interval-iso8601-units"/>. Units may be omitted, and may be specified in any order, but units smaller than a day must appear after <literal>T</literal>. In particular, the meaning of <literal>M</literal> depends on whether it is before or after @@ -2696,7 +2696,7 @@ P <optional> <replaceable>years</replaceable>-<replaceable>months</replaceable>- </para> <para> - <xref linkend="datatype-interval-input-examples"> shows some examples + <xref linkend="datatype-interval-input-examples"/> shows some examples of valid <type>interval</type> input. </para> @@ -2751,7 +2751,7 @@ P <optional> <replaceable>years</replaceable>-<replaceable>months</replaceable>- <literal>postgres_verbose</literal>, or <literal>iso_8601</literal>, using the command <literal>SET intervalstyle</literal>. The default is the <literal>postgres</literal> format. - <xref linkend="interval-style-output-table"> shows examples of each + <xref linkend="interval-style-output-table"/> shows examples of each output style. </para> @@ -2768,7 +2768,7 @@ P <optional> <replaceable>years</replaceable>-<replaceable>months</replaceable>- <para> The output of the <literal>postgres</literal> style matches the output of <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> releases prior to 8.4 when the - <xref linkend="guc-datestyle"> parameter was set to <literal>ISO</literal>. + <xref linkend="guc-datestyle"/> parameter was set to <literal>ISO</literal>. </para> <para> @@ -2846,7 +2846,7 @@ P <optional> <replaceable>years</replaceable>-<replaceable>months</replaceable>- <para> <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> provides the standard <acronym>SQL</acronym> type <type>boolean</type>; - see <xref linkend="datatype-boolean-table">. + see <xref linkend="datatype-boolean-table"/>. The <type>boolean</type> type can have several states: <quote>true</quote>, <quote>false</quote>, and a third state, <quote>unknown</quote>, which is represented by the @@ -2902,7 +2902,7 @@ P <optional> <replaceable>years</replaceable>-<replaceable>months</replaceable>- </para> <para> - <xref linkend="datatype-boolean-example"> shows that + <xref linkend="datatype-boolean-example"/> shows that <type>boolean</type> values are output using the letters <literal>t</literal> and <literal>f</literal>. </para> @@ -2954,7 +2954,7 @@ SELECT * FROM test1 WHERE a; <para> Enum types are created using the <xref - linkend="sql-createtype"> command, + linkend="sql-createtype"/> command, for example: <programlisting> @@ -3087,7 +3087,7 @@ SELECT person.name, holidays.num_weeks FROM person, holidays <para> Geometric data types represent two-dimensional spatial - objects. <xref linkend="datatype-geo-table"> shows the geometric + objects. <xref linkend="datatype-geo-table"/> shows the geometric types available in <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>. </para> @@ -3158,7 +3158,7 @@ SELECT person.name, holidays.num_weeks FROM person, holidays <para> A rich set of functions and operators is available to perform various geometric operations such as scaling, translation, rotation, and determining - intersections. They are explained in <xref linkend="functions-geometry">. + intersections. They are explained in <xref linkend="functions-geometry"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -3410,11 +3410,11 @@ SELECT person.name, holidays.num_weeks FROM person, holidays <para> <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> offers data types to store IPv4, IPv6, and MAC - addresses, as shown in <xref linkend="datatype-net-types-table">. It + addresses, as shown in <xref linkend="datatype-net-types-table"/>. It is better to use these types instead of plain text types to store network addresses, because these types offer input error checking and specialized - operators and functions (see <xref linkend="functions-net">). + operators and functions (see <xref linkend="functions-net"/>). </para> <table tocentry="1" id="datatype-net-types-table"> @@ -3526,7 +3526,7 @@ SELECT person.name, holidays.num_weeks FROM person, holidays </para> <para> - <xref linkend="datatype-net-cidr-table"> shows some examples. + <xref linkend="datatype-net-cidr-table"/> shows some examples. </para> <table id="datatype-net-cidr-table"> @@ -3809,10 +3809,10 @@ SELECT macaddr8_set7bit('08:00:2b:01:02:03'); <para> Refer to <xref - linkend="sql-syntax-bit-strings"> for information about the syntax + linkend="sql-syntax-bit-strings"/> for information about the syntax of bit string constants. Bit-logical operators and string manipulation functions are available; see <xref - linkend="functions-bitstring">. + linkend="functions-bitstring"/>. </para> <example> @@ -3840,7 +3840,7 @@ SELECT * FROM test; A bit string value requires 1 byte for each group of 8 bits, plus 5 or 8 bytes overhead depending on the length of the string (but long values may be compressed or moved out-of-line, as explained - in <xref linkend="datatype-character"> for character strings). + in <xref linkend="datatype-character"/> for character strings). </para> </sect1> @@ -3865,8 +3865,8 @@ SELECT * FROM test; The <type>tsvector</type> type represents a document in a form optimized for text search; the <type>tsquery</type> type similarly represents a text query. - <xref linkend="textsearch"> provides a detailed explanation of this - facility, and <xref linkend="functions-textsearch"> summarizes the + <xref linkend="textsearch"/> provides a detailed explanation of this + facility, and <xref linkend="functions-textsearch"/> summarizes the related functions and operators. </para> @@ -3881,7 +3881,7 @@ SELECT * FROM test; A <type>tsvector</type> value is a sorted list of distinct <firstterm>lexemes</firstterm>, which are words that have been <firstterm>normalized</firstterm> to merge different variants of the same word - (see <xref linkend="textsearch"> for details). Sorting and + (see <xref linkend="textsearch"/> for details). Sorting and duplicate-elimination are done automatically during input, as shown in this example: @@ -3975,7 +3975,7 @@ SELECT to_tsvector('english', 'The Fat Rats'); 'fat':2 'rat':3 </programlisting> - Again, see <xref linkend="textsearch"> for more detail. + Again, see <xref linkend="textsearch"/> for more detail. </para> </sect2> @@ -4140,9 +4140,9 @@ a0ee-bc99-9c0b-4ef8-bb6d-6bb9-bd38-0a11 functions for UUIDs, but the core database does not include any function for generating UUIDs, because no single algorithm is well suited for every application. The <xref - linkend="uuid-ossp"> module + linkend="uuid-ossp"/> module provides functions that implement several standard algorithms. - The <xref linkend="pgcrypto"> module also provides a generation + The <xref linkend="pgcrypto"/> module also provides a generation function for random UUIDs. Alternatively, UUIDs could be generated by client applications or other libraries invoked through a server-side function. @@ -4161,7 +4161,7 @@ a0ee-bc99-9c0b-4ef8-bb6d-6bb9-bd38-0a11 advantage over storing XML data in a <type>text</type> field is that it checks the input values for well-formedness, and there are support functions to perform type-safe operations on it; see <xref - linkend="functions-xml">. Use of this data type requires the + linkend="functions-xml"/>. Use of this data type requires the installation to have been built with <command>configure --with-libxml</command>. </para> @@ -4267,7 +4267,7 @@ SET xmloption TO { DOCUMENT | CONTENT }; results to the client (which is the normal mode), PostgreSQL converts all character data passed between the client and the server and vice versa to the character encoding of the respective - end; see <xref linkend="multibyte">. This includes string + end; see <xref linkend="multibyte"/>. This includes string representations of XML values, such as in the above examples. This would ordinarily mean that encoding declarations contained in XML data can become invalid as the character data is converted @@ -4408,7 +4408,7 @@ INSERT INTO mytable VALUES(-1); -- fails </para> <para> - For additional information see <xref linkend="sql-createdomain">. + For additional information see <xref linkend="sql-createdomain"/>. </para> </sect1> @@ -4473,14 +4473,14 @@ INSERT INTO mytable VALUES(-1); -- fails <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> as primary keys for various system tables. OIDs are not added to user-created tables, unless <literal>WITH OIDS</literal> is specified when the table is - created, or the <xref linkend="guc-default-with-oids"> + created, or the <xref linkend="guc-default-with-oids"/> configuration variable is enabled. Type <type>oid</type> represents an object identifier. There are also several alias types for <type>oid</type>: <type>regproc</type>, <type>regprocedure</type>, <type>regoper</type>, <type>regoperator</type>, <type>regclass</type>, <type>regtype</type>, <type>regrole</type>, <type>regnamespace</type>, <type>regconfig</type>, and <type>regdictionary</type>. - <xref linkend="datatype-oid-table"> shows an overview. + <xref linkend="datatype-oid-table"/> shows an overview. </para> <para> @@ -4677,7 +4677,7 @@ SELECT * FROM pg_attribute <para> (The system columns are further explained in <xref - linkend="ddl-system-columns">.) + linkend="ddl-system-columns"/>.) </para> </sect1> @@ -4795,7 +4795,7 @@ SELECT * FROM pg_attribute useful in situations where a function's behavior does not correspond to simply taking or returning a value of a specific <acronym>SQL</acronym> data type. <xref - linkend="datatype-pseudotypes-table"> lists the existing + linkend="datatype-pseudotypes-table"/> lists the existing pseudo-types. </para> @@ -4818,33 +4818,33 @@ SELECT * FROM pg_attribute <row> <entry><type>anyelement</type></entry> <entry>Indicates that a function accepts any data type - (see <xref linkend="extend-types-polymorphic">).</entry> + (see <xref linkend="extend-types-polymorphic"/>).</entry> </row> <row> <entry><type>anyarray</type></entry> <entry>Indicates that a function accepts any array data type - (see <xref linkend="extend-types-polymorphic">).</entry> + (see <xref linkend="extend-types-polymorphic"/>).</entry> </row> <row> <entry><type>anynonarray</type></entry> <entry>Indicates that a function accepts any non-array data type - (see <xref linkend="extend-types-polymorphic">).</entry> + (see <xref linkend="extend-types-polymorphic"/>).</entry> </row> <row> <entry><type>anyenum</type></entry> <entry>Indicates that a function accepts any enum data type - (see <xref linkend="extend-types-polymorphic"> and - <xref linkend="datatype-enum">).</entry> + (see <xref linkend="extend-types-polymorphic"/> and + <xref linkend="datatype-enum"/>).</entry> </row> <row> <entry><type>anyrange</type></entry> <entry>Indicates that a function accepts any range data type - (see <xref linkend="extend-types-polymorphic"> and - <xref linkend="rangetypes">).</entry> + (see <xref linkend="extend-types-polymorphic"/> and + <xref linkend="rangetypes"/>).</entry> </row> <row> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/datetime.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/datetime.sgml index a533bbf8d2e..d269aa4cc55 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/datetime.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/datetime.sgml @@ -180,7 +180,7 @@ <title>Date/Time Key Words</title> <para> - <xref linkend="datetime-month-table"> shows the tokens that are + <xref linkend="datetime-month-table"/> shows the tokens that are recognized as names of months. </para> @@ -247,7 +247,7 @@ </table> <para> - <xref linkend="datetime-dow-table"> shows the tokens that are + <xref linkend="datetime-dow-table"/> shows the tokens that are recognized as names of days of the week. </para> @@ -294,7 +294,7 @@ </table> <para> - <xref linkend="datetime-mod-table"> shows the tokens that serve + <xref linkend="datetime-mod-table"/> shows the tokens that serve various modifier purposes. </para> @@ -349,7 +349,7 @@ Since timezone abbreviations are not well standardized, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> provides a means to customize the set of abbreviations accepted by the server. The - <xref linkend="guc-timezone-abbreviations"> run-time parameter + <xref linkend="guc-timezone-abbreviations"/> run-time parameter determines the active set of abbreviations. While this parameter can be altered by any database user, the possible values for it are under the control of the database administrator — they diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/dblink.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/dblink.sgml index 12928e8bd38..4c07f886aa7 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/dblink.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/dblink.sgml @@ -14,7 +14,7 @@ </para> <para> - See also <xref linkend="postgres-fdw">, which provides roughly the same + See also <xref linkend="postgres-fdw"/>, which provides roughly the same functionality using a more modern and standards-compliant infrastructure. </para> @@ -58,8 +58,8 @@ dblink_connect(text connname, text connstr) returns text server. It is recommended to use the foreign-data wrapper <literal>dblink_fdw</literal> when defining the foreign server. See the example below, as well as - <xref linkend="sql-createserver"> and - <xref linkend="sql-createusermapping">. + <xref linkend="sql-createserver"/> and + <xref linkend="sql-createusermapping"/>. </para> </refsect1> @@ -84,7 +84,7 @@ dblink_connect(text connname, text connstr) returns text <para><application>libpq</application>-style connection info string, for example <literal>hostaddr=127.0.0.1 port=5432 dbname=mydb user=postgres password=mypasswd</literal>. - For details see <xref linkend="libpq-connstring">. + For details see <xref linkend="libpq-connstring"/>. Alternatively, the name of a foreign server. </para> </listitem> @@ -1340,7 +1340,7 @@ dblink_get_notify(text connname) returns setof (notify_name text, be_pid int, ex the unnamed connection, or on a named connection if specified. To receive notifications via dblink, <function>LISTEN</function> must first be issued, using <function>dblink_exec</function>. - For details see <xref linkend="sql-listen"> and <xref linkend="sql-notify">. + For details see <xref linkend="sql-listen"/> and <xref linkend="sql-notify"/>. </para> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index daba66c187d..e6f50ec819b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -39,7 +39,7 @@ SQL does not make any guarantees about the order of the rows in a table. When a table is read, the rows will appear in an unspecified order, unless sorting is explicitly requested. This is covered in <xref - linkend="queries">. Furthermore, SQL does not assign unique + linkend="queries"/>. Furthermore, SQL does not assign unique identifiers to rows, so it is possible to have several completely identical rows in a table. This is a consequence of the mathematical model that underlies SQL but is usually not desirable. @@ -64,7 +64,7 @@ built-in data types that fit many applications. Users can also define their own data types. Most built-in data types have obvious names and semantics, so we defer a detailed explanation to <xref - linkend="datatype">. Some of the frequently used data types are + linkend="datatype"/>. Some of the frequently used data types are <type>integer</type> for whole numbers, <type>numeric</type> for possibly fractional numbers, <type>text</type> for character strings, <type>date</type> for dates, <type>time</type> for @@ -79,7 +79,7 @@ <para> To create a table, you use the aptly named <xref - linkend="sql-createtable"> command. + linkend="sql-createtable"/> command. In this command you specify at least a name for the new table, the names of the columns and the data type of each column. For example: @@ -95,7 +95,7 @@ CREATE TABLE my_first_table ( <type>text</type>; the second column has the name <literal>second_column</literal> and the type <type>integer</type>. The table and column names follow the identifier syntax explained - in <xref linkend="sql-syntax-identifiers">. The type names are + in <xref linkend="sql-syntax-identifiers"/>. The type names are usually also identifiers, but there are some exceptions. Note that the column list is comma-separated and surrounded by parentheses. </para> @@ -139,7 +139,7 @@ CREATE TABLE products ( <para> If you no longer need a table, you can remove it using the <xref - linkend="sql-droptable"> command. + linkend="sql-droptable"/> command. For example: <programlisting> DROP TABLE my_first_table; @@ -155,7 +155,7 @@ DROP TABLE products; <para> If you need to modify a table that already exists, see <xref - linkend="ddl-alter"> later in this chapter. + linkend="ddl-alter"/> later in this chapter. </para> <para> @@ -163,7 +163,7 @@ DROP TABLE products; tables. The remainder of this chapter is concerned with adding features to the table definition to ensure data integrity, security, or convenience. If you are eager to fill your tables with - data now you can skip ahead to <xref linkend="dml"> and read the + data now you can skip ahead to <xref linkend="dml"/> and read the rest of this chapter later. </para> </sect1> @@ -181,7 +181,7 @@ DROP TABLE products; columns will be filled with their respective default values. A data manipulation command can also request explicitly that a column be set to its default value, without having to know what that value is. - (Details about data manipulation commands are in <xref linkend="dml">.) + (Details about data manipulation commands are in <xref linkend="dml"/>.) </para> <para> @@ -220,7 +220,7 @@ CREATE TABLE products ( </programlisting> where the <literal>nextval()</literal> function supplies successive values from a <firstterm>sequence object</firstterm> (see <xref - linkend="functions-sequence">). This arrangement is sufficiently common + linkend="functions-sequence"/>). This arrangement is sufficiently common that there's a special shorthand for it: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE products ( @@ -229,7 +229,7 @@ CREATE TABLE products ( ); </programlisting> The <literal>SERIAL</literal> shorthand is discussed further in <xref - linkend="datatype-serial">. + linkend="datatype-serial"/>. </para> </sect1> @@ -876,9 +876,9 @@ CREATE TABLE order_items ( <para> More information about updating and deleting data is in <xref - linkend="dml">. Also see the description of foreign key constraint + linkend="dml"/>. Also see the description of foreign key constraint syntax in the reference documentation for - <xref linkend="sql-createtable">. + <xref linkend="sql-createtable"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -948,10 +948,10 @@ CREATE TABLE circles ( </indexterm> The object identifier (object ID) of a row. This column is only present if the table was created using <literal>WITH - OIDS</literal>, or if the <xref linkend="guc-default-with-oids"> + OIDS</literal>, or if the <xref linkend="guc-default-with-oids"/> configuration variable was set at the time. This column is of type <type>oid</type> (same name as the column); see <xref - linkend="datatype-oid"> for more information about the type. + linkend="datatype-oid"/> for more information about the type. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -966,7 +966,7 @@ CREATE TABLE circles ( <para> The OID of the table containing this row. This column is particularly handy for queries that select from inheritance - hierarchies (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">), since without it, + hierarchies (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"/>), since without it, it's difficult to tell which individual table a row came from. The <structfield>tableoid</structfield> can be joined against the <structfield>oid</structfield> column of @@ -1100,7 +1100,7 @@ CREATE TABLE circles ( Transaction identifiers are also 32-bit quantities. In a long-lived database it is possible for transaction IDs to wrap around. This is not a fatal problem given appropriate maintenance - procedures; see <xref linkend="maintenance"> for details. It is + procedures; see <xref linkend="maintenance"/> for details. It is unwise, however, to depend on the uniqueness of transaction IDs over the long term (more than one billion transactions). </para> @@ -1167,7 +1167,7 @@ CREATE TABLE circles ( </itemizedlist> All these actions are performed using the - <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> + <xref linkend="sql-altertable"/> command, whose reference page contains details beyond those given here. </para> @@ -1238,7 +1238,7 @@ ALTER TABLE products DROP COLUMN description; <programlisting> ALTER TABLE products DROP COLUMN description CASCADE; </programlisting> - See <xref linkend="ddl-depend"> for a description of the general + See <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/> for a description of the general mechanism behind this. </para> </sect2> @@ -1446,7 +1446,7 @@ ALTER TABLE products RENAME TO items; object vary depending on the object's type (table, function, etc). For complete information on the different types of privileges supported by <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>, refer to the - <xref linkend="sql-grant"> reference + <xref linkend="sql-grant"/> reference page. The following sections and chapters will also show you how those privileges are used. </para> @@ -1459,7 +1459,7 @@ ALTER TABLE products RENAME TO items; <para> An object can be assigned to a new owner with an <command>ALTER</command> command of the appropriate kind for the object, e.g. <xref - linkend="sql-altertable">. Superusers can always do + linkend="sql-altertable"/>. Superusers can always do this; ordinary roles can only do it if they are both the current owner of the object (or a member of the owning role) and a member of the new owning role. @@ -1482,7 +1482,7 @@ GRANT UPDATE ON accounts TO joe; be used to grant a privilege to every role on the system. Also, <quote>group</quote> roles can be set up to help manage privileges when there are many users of a database — for details see - <xref linkend="user-manag">. + <xref linkend="user-manag"/>. </para> <para> @@ -1506,8 +1506,8 @@ REVOKE ALL ON accounts FROM PUBLIC; the right to grant it in turn to others. If the grant option is subsequently revoked then all who received the privilege from that recipient (directly or through a chain of grants) will lose the - privilege. For details see the <xref linkend="sql-grant"> and - <xref linkend="sql-revoke"> reference pages. + privilege. For details see the <xref linkend="sql-grant"/> and + <xref linkend="sql-revoke"/> reference pages. </para> </sect1> @@ -1524,7 +1524,7 @@ REVOKE ALL ON accounts FROM PUBLIC; <para> In addition to the SQL-standard <link linkend="ddl-priv">privilege - system</link> available through <xref linkend="sql-grant">, + system</link> available through <xref linkend="sql-grant"/>, tables can have <firstterm>row security policies</firstterm> that restrict, on a per-user basis, which rows can be returned by normal queries or inserted, updated, or deleted by data modification commands. @@ -1584,11 +1584,11 @@ REVOKE ALL ON accounts FROM PUBLIC; </para> <para> - Policies are created using the <xref linkend="sql-createpolicy"> - command, altered using the <xref linkend="sql-alterpolicy"> command, - and dropped using the <xref linkend="sql-droppolicy"> command. To + Policies are created using the <xref linkend="sql-createpolicy"/> + command, altered using the <xref linkend="sql-alterpolicy"/> command, + and dropped using the <xref linkend="sql-droppolicy"/> command. To enable and disable row security for a given table, use the - <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> command. + <xref linkend="sql-altertable"/> command. </para> <para> @@ -1829,7 +1829,7 @@ UPDATE 0 not being applied. For example, when taking a backup, it could be disastrous if row security silently caused some rows to be omitted from the backup. In such a situation, you can set the - <xref linkend="guc-row-security"> configuration parameter + <xref linkend="guc-row-security"/> configuration parameter to <literal>off</literal>. This does not in itself bypass row security; what it does is throw an error if any query's results would get filtered by a policy. The reason for the error can then be investigated and @@ -1951,8 +1951,8 @@ SELECT * FROM information WHERE group_id = 2 FOR UPDATE; </para> <para> - For additional details see <xref linkend="sql-createpolicy"> - and <xref linkend="sql-altertable">. + For additional details see <xref linkend="sql-createpolicy"/> + and <xref linkend="sql-altertable"/>. </para> </sect1> @@ -2034,7 +2034,7 @@ SELECT * FROM information WHERE group_id = 2 FOR UPDATE; </indexterm> <para> - To create a schema, use the <xref linkend="sql-createschema"> + To create a schema, use the <xref linkend="sql-createschema"/> command. Give the schema a name of your choice. For example: <programlisting> @@ -2099,7 +2099,7 @@ DROP SCHEMA myschema; <programlisting> DROP SCHEMA myschema CASCADE; </programlisting> - See <xref linkend="ddl-depend"> for a description of the general + See <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/> for a description of the general mechanism behind this. </para> @@ -2112,7 +2112,7 @@ CREATE SCHEMA <replaceable>schema_name</replaceable> AUTHORIZATION <replaceable> </programlisting> You can even omit the schema name, in which case the schema name will be the same as the user name. See <xref - linkend="ddl-schemas-patterns"> for how this can be useful. + linkend="ddl-schemas-patterns"/> for how this can be useful. </para> <para> @@ -2242,7 +2242,7 @@ SET search_path TO myschema; </para> <para> - See also <xref linkend="functions-info"> for other ways to manipulate + See also <xref linkend="functions-info"/> for other ways to manipulate the schema search path. </para> @@ -2297,7 +2297,7 @@ REVOKE CREATE ON SCHEMA public FROM PUBLIC; <quote>public</quote> means <quote>every user</quote>. In the first sense it is an identifier, in the second sense it is a key word, hence the different capitalization; recall the - guidelines from <xref linkend="sql-syntax-identifiers">.) + guidelines from <xref linkend="sql-syntax-identifiers"/>.) </para> </sect2> @@ -2483,7 +2483,7 @@ SELECT name, altitude </programlisting> Given the sample data from the <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> - tutorial (see <xref linkend="tutorial-sql-intro">), this returns: + tutorial (see <xref linkend="tutorial-sql-intro"/>), this returns: <programlisting> name | altitude @@ -2602,7 +2602,7 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <structname>capitals</structname> table, but this does not happen: <command>INSERT</command> always inserts into exactly the table specified. In some cases it is possible to redirect the insertion - using a rule (see <xref linkend="rules">). However that does not + using a rule (see <xref linkend="rules"/>). However that does not help for the above case because the <structname>cities</structname> table does not contain the column <structfield>state</structfield>, and so the command will be rejected before the rule can be applied. @@ -2633,11 +2633,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> Table inheritance is typically established when the child table is created, using the <literal>INHERITS</literal> clause of the - <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> + <xref linkend="sql-createtable"/> statement. Alternatively, a table which is already defined in a compatible way can have a new parent relationship added, using the <literal>INHERIT</literal> - variant of <xref linkend="sql-altertable">. + variant of <xref linkend="sql-altertable"/>. To do this the new child table must already include columns with the same names and types as the columns of the parent. It must also include check constraints with the same names and check expressions as those of the @@ -2645,7 +2645,7 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <literal>NO INHERIT</literal> variant of <command>ALTER TABLE</command>. Dynamically adding and removing inheritance links like this can be useful when the inheritance relationship is being used for table - partitioning (see <xref linkend="ddl-partitioning">). + partitioning (see <xref linkend="ddl-partitioning"/>). </para> <para> @@ -2665,11 +2665,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); if they are inherited from any parent tables. If you wish to remove a table and all of its descendants, one easy way is to drop the parent table with the - <literal>CASCADE</literal> option (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend">). + <literal>CASCADE</literal> option (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/>). </para> <para> - <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> will + <xref linkend="sql-altertable"/> will propagate any changes in column data definitions and check constraints down the inheritance hierarchy. Again, dropping columns that are depended on by other tables is only possible when using @@ -2687,7 +2687,7 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); that the data is (also) in the parent table. But the <structname>capitals</structname> table could not be updated directly without an additional grant. In a similar way, the parent table's row - security policies (see <xref linkend="ddl-rowsecurity">) are applied to + security policies (see <xref linkend="ddl-rowsecurity"/>) are applied to rows coming from child tables during an inherited query. A child table's policies, if any, are applied only when it is the table explicitly named in the query; and in that case, any policies attached to its parent(s) are @@ -2695,7 +2695,7 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">) can also + Foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data"/>) can also be part of inheritance hierarchies, either as parent or child tables, just as regular tables can be. If a foreign table is part of an inheritance hierarchy then any operations not supported by @@ -2719,7 +2719,7 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); typically only work on individual, physical tables and do not support recursing over inheritance hierarchies. The respective behavior of each individual command is documented in its reference - page (<xref linkend="sql-commands">). + page (<xref linkend="sql-commands"/>). </para> <para> @@ -2923,7 +2923,7 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); called <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, distinct from those of other partitions. Indexes must be created separately for each partition. See - <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details on creating partitioned + <xref linkend="sql-createtable"/> for more details on creating partitioned tables and partitions. </para> @@ -2932,7 +2932,7 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data as a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition from a partitioned table turning it into a standalone table; - see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the + see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"/> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</command> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</command> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2948,7 +2948,7 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in - <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"/> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2999,7 +2999,7 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> Partitions can also be foreign tables - (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), + (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable"/>), although these have some limitations that normal tables do not. For example, data inserted into the partitioned table is not routed to foreign table partitions. @@ -3158,7 +3158,7 @@ CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); <listitem> <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"/> configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</filename>. If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> @@ -3595,7 +3595,7 @@ DO INSTEAD <listitem> <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"/> configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</filename>. If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. @@ -3806,7 +3806,7 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; <para> The default (and recommended) setting of - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> is actually neither + <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"/> is actually neither <literal>on</literal> nor <literal>off</literal>, but an intermediate setting called <literal>partition</literal>, which causes the technique to be applied only to queries that are likely to be working on partitioned @@ -3889,10 +3889,10 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; library that can communicate with an external data source, hiding the details of connecting to the data source and obtaining data from it. There are some foreign data wrappers available as <filename>contrib</filename> - modules; see <xref linkend="contrib">. Other kinds of foreign data + modules; see <xref linkend="contrib"/>. Other kinds of foreign data wrappers might be found as third party products. If none of the existing foreign data wrappers suit your needs, you can write your own; see <xref - linkend="fdwhandler">. + linkend="fdwhandler"/>. </para> <para> @@ -3918,11 +3918,11 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; <para> For additional information, see - <xref linkend="sql-createforeigndatawrapper">, - <xref linkend="sql-createserver">, - <xref linkend="sql-createusermapping">, - <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">, and - <xref linkend="sql-importforeignschema">. + <xref linkend="sql-createforeigndatawrapper"/>, + <xref linkend="sql-createserver"/>, + <xref linkend="sql-createusermapping"/>, + <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable"/>, and + <xref linkend="sql-importforeignschema"/>. </para> </sect1> @@ -3966,7 +3966,7 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; <para> Detailed information on - these topics appears in <xref linkend="server-programming">. + these topics appears in <xref linkend="server-programming"/>. </para> </sect1> @@ -3996,7 +3996,7 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> makes sure that you cannot drop objects that other objects still depend on. For example, attempting to drop the products table we considered in <xref - linkend="ddl-constraints-fk">, with the orders table depending on + linkend="ddl-constraints-fk"/>, with the orders table depending on it, would result in an error message like this: <screen> DROP TABLE products; @@ -4066,7 +4066,7 @@ CREATE FUNCTION get_color_note (rainbow) RETURNS text AS LANGUAGE SQL; </programlisting> - (See <xref linkend="xfunc-sql"> for an explanation of SQL-language + (See <xref linkend="xfunc-sql"/> for an explanation of SQL-language functions.) <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> will be aware that the <function>get_color_note</function> function depends on the <type>rainbow</type> type: dropping the type would force dropping the function, because its diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/dfunc.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/dfunc.sgml index 7ef996b51f7..dfefa9e686c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/dfunc.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/dfunc.sgml @@ -226,7 +226,7 @@ gcc -G -o foo.so foo.o </para> <para> - Refer back to <xref linkend="xfunc-c-dynload"> about where the + Refer back to <xref linkend="xfunc-c-dynload"/> about where the server expects to find the shared library files. </para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/dict-int.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/dict-int.sgml index 04cf14a73d9..c15cbd0e4d1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/dict-int.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/dict-int.sgml @@ -71,7 +71,7 @@ mydb# select ts_lexize('intdict', '12345678'); </programlisting> but real-world usage will involve including it in a text search - configuration as described in <xref linkend="textsearch">. + configuration as described in <xref linkend="textsearch"/>. That might look like this: <programlisting> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/dict-xsyn.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/dict-xsyn.sgml index bf4965c36fd..256aff7c58c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/dict-xsyn.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/dict-xsyn.sgml @@ -135,7 +135,7 @@ mydb=# SELECT ts_lexize('xsyn', 'syn1'); </programlisting> Real-world usage will involve including it in a text search - configuration as described in <xref linkend="textsearch">. + configuration as described in <xref linkend="textsearch"/>. That might look like this: <programlisting> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/diskusage.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/diskusage.sgml index ba230843549..3708e5f3d8b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/diskusage.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/diskusage.sgml @@ -20,18 +20,18 @@ stored. If the table has any columns with potentially-wide values, there also might be a <acronym>TOAST</acronym> file associated with the table, which is used to store values too wide to fit comfortably in the main - table (see <xref linkend="storage-toast">). There will be one valid index + table (see <xref linkend="storage-toast"/>). There will be one valid index on the <acronym>TOAST</acronym> table, if present. There also might be indexes associated with the base table. Each table and index is stored in a separate disk file — possibly more than one file, if the file would exceed one gigabyte. Naming conventions for these files are described - in <xref linkend="storage-file-layout">. + in <xref linkend="storage-file-layout"/>. </para> <para> You can monitor disk space in three ways: - using the SQL functions listed in <xref linkend="functions-admin-dbsize">, - using the <xref linkend="oid2name"> module, or + using the SQL functions listed in <xref linkend="functions-admin-dbsize"/>, + using the <xref linkend="oid2name"/> module, or using manual inspection of the system catalogs. The SQL functions are the easiest to use and are generally recommended. The remainder of this section shows how to do it by inspection of the @@ -124,7 +124,7 @@ ORDER BY relpages DESC; If you cannot free up additional space on the disk by deleting other things, you can move some of the database files to other file systems by making use of tablespaces. See <xref - linkend="manage-ag-tablespaces"> for more information about that. + linkend="manage-ag-tablespaces"/> for more information about that. </para> <tip> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/dml.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/dml.sgml index bc016d3cae6..1e05c84fd17 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/dml.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/dml.sgml @@ -33,10 +33,10 @@ </para> <para> - To create a new row, use the <xref linkend="sql-insert"> + To create a new row, use the <xref linkend="sql-insert"/> command. The command requires the table name and column values. For - example, consider the products table from <xref linkend="ddl">: + example, consider the products table from <xref linkend="ddl"/>: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE products ( product_no integer, @@ -107,16 +107,16 @@ INSERT INTO products (product_no, name, price) WHERE release_date = 'today'; </programlisting> This provides the full power of the SQL query mechanism (<xref - linkend="queries">) for computing the rows to be inserted. + linkend="queries"/>) for computing the rows to be inserted. </para> <tip> <para> When inserting a lot of data at the same time, considering using - the <xref linkend="sql-copy"> command. - It is not as flexible as the <xref linkend="sql-insert"> + the <xref linkend="sql-copy"/> command. + It is not as flexible as the <xref linkend="sql-insert"/> command, but is more efficient. Refer - to <xref linkend="populate"> for more information on improving + to <xref linkend="populate"/> for more information on improving bulk loading performance. </para> </tip> @@ -141,7 +141,7 @@ INSERT INTO products (product_no, name, price) </para> <para> - To update existing rows, use the <xref linkend="sql-update"> + To update existing rows, use the <xref linkend="sql-update"/> command. This requires three pieces of information: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> @@ -160,7 +160,7 @@ INSERT INTO products (product_no, name, price) </para> <para> - Recall from <xref linkend="ddl"> that SQL does not, in general, + Recall from <xref linkend="ddl"/> that SQL does not, in general, provide a unique identifier for rows. Therefore it is not always possible to directly specify which row to update. Instead, you specify which conditions a row must meet in order to @@ -203,7 +203,7 @@ UPDATE products SET price = price * 1.10; this does not create any ambiguity. Of course, the <literal>WHERE</literal> condition does not have to be an equality test. Many other operators are - available (see <xref linkend="functions">). But the expression + available (see <xref linkend="functions"/>). But the expression needs to evaluate to a Boolean result. </para> @@ -243,7 +243,7 @@ UPDATE mytable SET a = 5, b = 3, c = 1 WHERE a > 0; </para> <para> - You use the <xref linkend="sql-delete"> + You use the <xref linkend="sql-delete"/> command to remove rows; the syntax is very similar to the <command>UPDATE</command> command. For instance, to remove all rows from the products table that have a price of 10, use: @@ -296,7 +296,7 @@ DELETE FROM products; <para> The allowed contents of a <literal>RETURNING</literal> clause are the same as a <command>SELECT</command> command's output list - (see <xref linkend="queries-select-lists">). It can contain column + (see <xref linkend="queries-select-lists"/>). It can contain column names of the command's target table, or value expressions using those columns. A common shorthand is <literal>RETURNING *</literal>, which selects all columns of the target table in order. @@ -340,7 +340,7 @@ DELETE FROM products </para> <para> - If there are triggers (<xref linkend="triggers">) on the target table, + If there are triggers (<xref linkend="triggers"/>) on the target table, the data available to <literal>RETURNING</literal> is the row as modified by the triggers. Thus, inspecting columns computed by triggers is another common use-case for <literal>RETURNING</literal>. diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/docguide.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/docguide.sgml index 3a5b88ca1ca..090ca958350 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/docguide.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/docguide.sgml @@ -47,23 +47,11 @@ <para> The documentation sources are written in <firstterm>DocBook</firstterm>, which is a markup language - superficially similar to <acronym>HTML</acronym>. Both of these - languages are applications of the <firstterm>Standard Generalized - Markup Language</firstterm>, <acronym>SGML</acronym>, which is - essentially a language for describing other languages. In what - follows, the terms DocBook and <acronym>SGML</acronym> are both + defined in <acronym>XML</acronym>. In what + follows, the terms DocBook and <acronym>XML</acronym> are both used, but technically they are not interchangeable. </para> - <note> - <para> - The PostgreSQL documentation is currently being transitioned from DocBook - SGML and DSSSL style sheets to DocBook XML and XSLT style sheets. Be - careful to look at the instructions relating to the PostgreSQL version you - are dealing with, as the procedures and required tools will change. - </para> - </note> - <para> <productname>DocBook</productname> allows an author to specify the structure and content of a technical document without worrying @@ -97,19 +85,8 @@ <para> This is the definition of DocBook itself. We currently use version 4.2; you cannot use later or earlier versions. You need - the <acronym>SGML</acronym> and the <acronym>XML</acronym> variant of - the DocBook DTD of the same version. These will usually be in separate - packages. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - - <varlistentry> - <term><ulink url="http://www.oasis-open.org/cover/ISOEnts.zip">ISO 8879 character entities</ulink></term> - <listitem> - <para> - These are required by DocBook SGML but are distributed separately - because they are maintained by ISO. + the <acronym>XML</acronym> variant of the DocBook DTD, not + the <acronym>SGML</acronym> variant. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -131,17 +108,6 @@ </varlistentry> <varlistentry> - <term><ulink url="http://openjade.sourceforge.net">OpenSP</ulink></term> - <listitem> - <para> - This is the base package of <acronym>SGML</acronym> processing. Note - that we no longer need OpenJade, the <acronym>DSSSL</acronym> - processor, only the OpenSP package for converting SGML to XML. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - - <varlistentry> <term><ulink url="http://xmlsoft.org/">Libxml2</ulink> for <command>xmllint</command></term> <listitem> <para> @@ -201,7 +167,7 @@ <para> To install the required packages, use: <programlisting> -yum install docbook-dtds docbook-style-xsl fop libxslt opensp +yum install docbook-dtds docbook-style-xsl fop libxslt </programlisting> </para> </sect2> @@ -210,40 +176,9 @@ yum install docbook-dtds docbook-style-xsl fop libxslt opensp <title>Installation on FreeBSD</title> <para> - The FreeBSD Documentation Project is itself a heavy user of - DocBook, so it comes as no surprise that there is a full set of - <quote>ports</quote> of the documentation tools available on - FreeBSD. The following ports need to be installed to build the - documentation on FreeBSD. - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para><filename>textproc/docbook-sgml</filename></para> - </listitem> - <listitem> - <para><filename>textproc/docbook-xml</filename></para> - </listitem> - <listitem> - <para><filename>textproc/docbook-xsl</filename></para> - </listitem> - <listitem> - <para><filename>textproc/dsssl-docbook-modular</filename></para> - </listitem> - <listitem> - <para><filename>textproc/libxslt</filename></para> - </listitem> - <listitem> - <para><filename>textproc/fop</filename></para> - </listitem> - <listitem> - <para><filename>textproc/opensp</filename></para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> To install the required packages with <command>pkg</command>, use: <programlisting> -pkg install docbook-sgml docbook-xml docbook-xsl fop libxslt opensp +pkg install docbook-xml docbook-xsl fop libxslt </programlisting> </para> @@ -268,7 +203,7 @@ pkg install docbook-sgml docbook-xml docbook-xsl fop libxslt opensp available for <productname>Debian GNU/Linux</productname>. To install, simply use: <programlisting> -apt-get install docbook docbook-xml docbook-xsl fop libxml2-utils opensp xsltproc +apt-get install docbook-xml docbook-xsl fop libxml2-utils xsltproc </programlisting> </para> </sect2> @@ -277,117 +212,21 @@ apt-get install docbook docbook-xml docbook-xsl fop libxml2-utils opensp xsltpro <title>macOS</title> <para> - If you use MacPorts, the following will get you set up: -<programlisting> -sudo port install docbook-sgml-4.2 docbook-xml-4.2 docbook-xsl fop libxslt opensp -</programlisting> + On macOS, you can build the HTML and man documentation without installing + anything extra. If you want to build PDFs or want to install a local copy + of DocBook, you can get those from your preferred package manager. </para> - </sect2> - - <sect2> - <title>Manual Installation from Source</title> <para> - The manual installation process of the DocBook tools is somewhat - complex, so if you have pre-built packages available, use them. - We describe here only a standard setup, with reasonably standard - installation paths, and no <quote>fancy</quote> features. For - details, you should study the documentation of the respective - package, and read <acronym>SGML</acronym> introductory material. - </para> - - <sect3> - <title>Installing OpenSP</title> - - <para> - The installation of OpenSP offers a GNU-style - <literal>./configure; make; make install</literal> build process. - Details can be found in the OpenSP source distribution. In a nutshell: -<synopsis> -./configure --enable-default-catalog=/usr/local/etc/sgml/catalog -make -make install -</synopsis> - Be sure to remember where you put the <quote>default catalog</quote>; you - will need it below. You can also leave it off, but then you will have to - set the environment variable <envar>SGML_CATALOG_FILES</envar> to point - to the file whenever you use any programs from OpenSP later on. (This - method is also an option if OpenSP is already installed and you want to - install the rest of the toolchain locally.) - </para> - </sect3> - - <sect3> - <title>Installing the <productname>DocBook</productname> <acronym>DTD</acronym> Kit</title> - - <procedure> - <step> - <para> - Obtain the <ulink url="http://www.docbook.org/sgml/4.2/docbook-4.2.zip"> - DocBook V4.2 distribution</ulink>. - </para> - </step> - - <step> - <para> - Create the directory - <filename>/usr/local/share/sgml/docbook-4.2</filename> and change - to it. (The exact location is irrelevant, but this one is - reasonable within the layout we are following here.) -<screen> -<prompt>$ </prompt><userinput>mkdir /usr/local/share/sgml/docbook-4.2</userinput> -<prompt>$ </prompt><userinput>cd /usr/local/share/sgml/docbook-4.2</userinput> -</screen> - </para> - </step> - - <step> - <para> - Unpack the archive: -<screen> -<prompt>$ </prompt><userinput>unzip -a ...../docbook-4.2.zip</userinput> -</screen> - (The archive will unpack its files into the current directory.) - </para> - </step> - - <step> - <para> - Edit the file - <filename>/usr/local/share/sgml/catalog</filename> (or whatever - you told jade during installation) and put a line like this - into it: + If you use MacPorts, the following will get you set up: <programlisting> -CATALOG "docbook-4.2/docbook.cat" +sudo port install docbook-xml-4.2 docbook-xsl fop </programlisting> - </para> - </step> - - <step> - <para> - Download the <ulink url="http://www.oasis-open.org/cover/ISOEnts.zip"> - ISO 8879 character entities archive</ulink>, unpack it, and put the - files in the same directory you put the DocBook files in: -<screen> -<prompt>$ </prompt><userinput>cd /usr/local/share/sgml/docbook-4.2</userinput> -<prompt>$ </prompt><userinput>unzip ...../ISOEnts.zip</userinput> -</screen> - </para> - </step> - - <step> - <para> - Run the following command in the directory with the DocBook and ISO files: + If you use Homebrew, use this: <programlisting> -perl -pi -e 's/iso-(.*).gml/ISO\1/g' docbook.cat +brew install docbook docbook-xsl fop </programlisting> - (This fixes a mixup between the names used in the DocBook - catalog file and the actual names of the ISO character entity - files.) - </para> - </step> - </procedure> - </sect3> + </para> </sect2> <sect2 id="docguide-toolsets-configure"> @@ -400,26 +239,14 @@ perl -pi -e 's/iso-(.*).gml/ISO\1/g' docbook.cat Check the output near the end of the run, it should look something like this: <screen> -<computeroutput> -checking for onsgmls... onsgmls -checking for DocBook V4.2... yes -checking for dbtoepub... dbtoepub checking for xmllint... xmllint +checking for DocBook XML V4.2... yes +checking for dbtoepub... dbtoepub checking for xsltproc... xsltproc -checking for osx... osx checking for fop... fop -</computeroutput> </screen> - If neither <filename>onsgmls</filename> nor - <filename>nsgmls</filename> were found then some of the following tests - will be skipped. <filename>nsgmls</filename> is part of the OpenSP - package. You can pass the environment variable - <envar>NSGMLS</envar> to configure to point - to the programs if they are not found automatically. If - <quote>DocBook V4.2</quote> was not found then you did not install - the DocBook DTD kit in a place where OpenSP can find it, or you have - not set up the catalog files correctly. See the installation hints - above. + If <filename>xmllint</filename> was not found then some of the following + tests will be skipped. </para> </sect2> @@ -464,9 +291,7 @@ checking for fop... fop We use the DocBook XSL stylesheets to convert <productname>DocBook</productname> <sgmltag>refentry</sgmltag> pages to *roff output suitable for man - pages. The man pages are also distributed as a tar archive, - similar to the <acronym>HTML</acronym> version. To create the man - pages, use the commands: + pages. To create the man pages, use the command: <screen> <prompt>doc/src/sgml$ </prompt><userinput>make man</userinput> </screen> @@ -536,7 +361,7 @@ ADDITIONAL_FLAGS='-Xmx1000m' The installation instructions are also distributed as plain text, in case they are needed in a situation where better reading tools are not available. The <filename>INSTALL</filename> file - corresponds to <xref linkend="installation">, with some minor + corresponds to <xref linkend="installation"/>, with some minor changes to account for the different context. To recreate the file, change to the directory <filename>doc/src/sgml</filename> and enter <userinput>make INSTALL</userinput>. diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/earthdistance.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/earthdistance.sgml index 1bdcf64629f..1f3ea6aa6e2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/earthdistance.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/earthdistance.sgml @@ -56,7 +56,7 @@ <para> The provided functions are shown - in <xref linkend="earthdistance-cube-functions">. + in <xref linkend="earthdistance-cube-functions"/>. </para> <table id="earthdistance-cube-functions"> @@ -150,7 +150,7 @@ <para> A single operator is provided, shown - in <xref linkend="earthdistance-point-operators">. + in <xref linkend="earthdistance-point-operators"/>. </para> <table id="earthdistance-point-operators"> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ecpg.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ecpg.sgml index bc3d080774d..d1872c1a5c6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ecpg.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ecpg.sgml @@ -31,7 +31,7 @@ specially marked sections. To build the program, the source code (<filename>*.pgc</filename>) is first passed through the embedded SQL preprocessor, which converts it to an ordinary C program (<filename>*.c</filename>), and afterwards it can be processed by a C - compiler. (For details about the compiling and linking see <xref linkend="ecpg-process">). + compiler. (For details about the compiling and linking see <xref linkend="ecpg-process"/>). Converted ECPG applications call functions in the libpq library through the embedded SQL library (ecpglib), and communicate with the PostgreSQL server using the normal frontend-backend protocol. @@ -397,9 +397,9 @@ EXEC SQL COMMIT; row can also be executed using <literal>EXEC SQL</literal> directly. To handle result sets with multiple rows, an application has to use a cursor; - see <xref linkend="ecpg-cursors"> below. (As a special case, an + see <xref linkend="ecpg-cursors"/> below. (As a special case, an application can fetch multiple rows at once into an array host - variable; see <xref linkend="ecpg-variables-arrays">.) + variable; see <xref linkend="ecpg-variables-arrays"/>.) </para> <para> @@ -422,7 +422,7 @@ EXEC SQL SHOW search_path INTO :var; <literal>:<replaceable>something</replaceable></literal> are <firstterm>host variables</firstterm>, that is, they refer to variables in the C program. They are explained in <xref - linkend="ecpg-variables">. + linkend="ecpg-variables"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -452,8 +452,8 @@ EXEC SQL COMMIT; <para> For more details about declaration of the cursor, - see <xref linkend="ecpg-sql-declare">, and - see <xref linkend="sql-fetch"> for <literal>FETCH</literal> command + see <xref linkend="ecpg-sql-declare"/>, and + see <xref linkend="sql-fetch"/> for <literal>FETCH</literal> command details. </para> @@ -477,7 +477,7 @@ EXEC SQL COMMIT; interface also supports autocommit of transactions (similar to <application>psql</application>'s default behavior) via the <option>-t</option> command-line option to <command>ecpg</command> (see <xref - linkend="app-ecpg">) or via the <literal>EXEC SQL SET AUTOCOMMIT TO + linkend="app-ecpg"/>) or via the <literal>EXEC SQL SET AUTOCOMMIT TO ON</literal> statement. In autocommit mode, each command is automatically committed unless it is inside an explicit transaction block. This mode can be explicitly turned off using <literal>EXEC @@ -617,8 +617,8 @@ EXEC SQL DEALLOCATE PREPARE <replaceable>name</replaceable>; <para> For more details about <literal>PREPARE</literal>, - see <xref linkend="ecpg-sql-prepare">. Also - see <xref linkend="ecpg-dynamic"> for more details about using + see <xref linkend="ecpg-sql-prepare"/>. Also + see <xref linkend="ecpg-dynamic"/> for more details about using placeholders and input parameters. </para> </sect2> @@ -628,7 +628,7 @@ EXEC SQL DEALLOCATE PREPARE <replaceable>name</replaceable>; <title>Using Host Variables</title> <para> - In <xref linkend="ecpg-commands"> you saw how you can execute SQL + In <xref linkend="ecpg-commands"/> you saw how you can execute SQL statements from an embedded SQL program. Some of those statements only used fixed values and did not provide a way to insert user-supplied values into statements or have the program process @@ -646,7 +646,7 @@ EXEC SQL DEALLOCATE PREPARE <replaceable>name</replaceable>; <para> Another way to exchange values between PostgreSQL backends and ECPG applications is the use of SQL descriptors, described - in <xref linkend="ecpg-descriptors">. + in <xref linkend="ecpg-descriptors"/>. </para> <sect2 id="ecpg-variables-overview"> @@ -812,11 +812,11 @@ do directly. Other PostgreSQL data types, such as <type>timestamp</type> and <type>numeric</type> can only be accessed through special library functions; see - <xref linkend="ecpg-special-types">. + <xref linkend="ecpg-special-types"/>. </para> <para> - <xref linkend="ecpg-datatype-hostvars-table"> shows which PostgreSQL + <xref linkend="ecpg-datatype-hostvars-table"/> shows which PostgreSQL data types correspond to which C data types. When you wish to send or receive a value of a given PostgreSQL data type, you should declare a C variable of the corresponding C data type in @@ -851,12 +851,12 @@ do <row> <entry><type>decimal</type></entry> - <entry><type>decimal</type><footnote id="ecpg-datatype-table-fn"><para>This type can only be accessed through special library functions; see <xref linkend="ecpg-special-types">.</para></footnote></entry> + <entry><type>decimal</type><footnote id="ecpg-datatype-table-fn"><para>This type can only be accessed through special library functions; see <xref linkend="ecpg-special-types"/>.</para></footnote></entry> </row> <row> <entry><type>numeric</type></entry> - <entry><type>numeric</type><footnoteref linkend="ecpg-datatype-table-fn"></entry> + <entry><type>numeric</type><footnoteref linkend="ecpg-datatype-table-fn"/></entry> </row> <row> @@ -901,17 +901,17 @@ do <row> <entry><type>timestamp</type></entry> - <entry><type>timestamp</type><footnoteref linkend="ecpg-datatype-table-fn"></entry> + <entry><type>timestamp</type><footnoteref linkend="ecpg-datatype-table-fn"/></entry> </row> <row> <entry><type>interval</type></entry> - <entry><type>interval</type><footnoteref linkend="ecpg-datatype-table-fn"></entry> + <entry><type>interval</type><footnoteref linkend="ecpg-datatype-table-fn"/></entry> </row> <row> <entry><type>date</type></entry> - <entry><type>date</type><footnoteref linkend="ecpg-datatype-table-fn"></entry> + <entry><type>date</type><footnoteref linkend="ecpg-datatype-table-fn"/></entry> </row> <row> @@ -1002,7 +1002,7 @@ struct varchar_var { int len; char arr[180]; } var; structure. Applications deal with these types by declaring host variables in special types and accessing them using functions in the pgtypes library. The pgtypes library, described in detail - in <xref linkend="ecpg-pgtypes"> contains basic functions to deal + in <xref linkend="ecpg-pgtypes"/> contains basic functions to deal with those types, such that you do not need to send a query to the SQL server just for adding an interval to a time stamp for example. @@ -1011,7 +1011,7 @@ struct varchar_var { int len; char arr[180]; } var; <para> The follow subsections describe these special data types. For more details about pgtypes library functions, - see <xref linkend="ecpg-pgtypes">. + see <xref linkend="ecpg-pgtypes"/>. </para> <sect4> @@ -1062,7 +1062,7 @@ ts = 2010-06-27 18:03:56.949343 program has to include <filename>pgtypes_date.h</filename>, declare a host variable as the date type and convert a DATE value into a text form using <function>PGTYPESdate_to_asc()</function> function. For more details about the - pgtypes library functions, see <xref linkend="ecpg-pgtypes">. + pgtypes library functions, see <xref linkend="ecpg-pgtypes"/>. </para> </sect4> @@ -1117,7 +1117,7 @@ EXEC SQL END DECLARE SECTION; allocating some memory space on the heap, and accessing the variable using the pgtypes library functions. For more details about the pgtypes library functions, - see <xref linkend="ecpg-pgtypes">. + see <xref linkend="ecpg-pgtypes"/>. </para> <para> @@ -1193,7 +1193,7 @@ EXEC SQL END DECLARE SECTION; There are two use cases for arrays as host variables. The first is a way to store some text string in <type>char[]</type> or <type>VARCHAR[]</type>, as - explained in <xref linkend="ecpg-char">. The second use case is to + explained in <xref linkend="ecpg-char"/>. The second use case is to retrieve multiple rows from a query result without using a cursor. Without an array, to process a query result consisting of multiple rows, it is required to use a cursor and @@ -1378,7 +1378,7 @@ EXEC SQL TYPE serial_t IS long; <para> You can declare pointers to the most common types. Note however that you cannot use pointers as target variables of queries - without auto-allocation. See <xref linkend="ecpg-descriptors"> + without auto-allocation. See <xref linkend="ecpg-descriptors"/> for more information on auto-allocation. </para> @@ -1520,7 +1520,7 @@ while (1) Another workaround is to store arrays in their external string representation in host variables of type <type>char[]</type> or <type>VARCHAR[]</type>. For more details about this - representation, see <xref linkend="arrays-input">. Note that + representation, see <xref linkend="arrays-input"/>. Note that this means that the array cannot be accessed naturally as an array in the host program (without further processing that parses the text representation). @@ -1578,7 +1578,7 @@ EXEC SQL CLOSE cur1; To enhance this example, the host variables to store values in the <command>FETCH</command> command can be gathered into one structure. For more details about the host variable in the - structure form, see <xref linkend="ecpg-variables-struct">. + structure form, see <xref linkend="ecpg-variables-struct"/>. To switch to the structure, the example can be modified as below. The two host variables, <varname>intval</varname> and <varname>textval</varname>, become members of @@ -1659,12 +1659,12 @@ while (1) <para> Here is an example using the data type <type>complex</type> from - the example in <xref linkend="xtypes">. The external string + the example in <xref linkend="xtypes"/>. The external string representation of that type is <literal>(%lf,%lf)</literal>, which is defined in the functions <function>complex_in()</function> and <function>complex_out()</function> functions - in <xref linkend="xtypes">. The following example inserts the + in <xref linkend="xtypes"/>. The following example inserts the complex type values <literal>(1,1)</literal> and <literal>(3,3)</literal> into the columns <literal>a</literal> and <literal>b</literal>, and select @@ -1875,7 +1875,7 @@ EXEC SQL EXECUTE mystmt INTO :v1, :v2, :v3 USING 37; <para> If a query is expected to return more than one result row, a cursor should be used, as in the following example. - (See <xref linkend="ecpg-cursors"> for more details about the + (See <xref linkend="ecpg-cursors"/> for more details about the cursor.) <programlisting> EXEC SQL BEGIN DECLARE SECTION; @@ -1941,7 +1941,7 @@ free(out); <title>The numeric Type</title> <para> The numeric type offers to do calculations with arbitrary precision. See - <xref linkend="datatype-numeric"> for the equivalent type in the + <xref linkend="datatype-numeric"/> for the equivalent type in the <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> server. Because of the arbitrary precision this variable needs to be able to expand and shrink dynamically. That's why you can only create numeric variables on the heap, by means of the @@ -2264,7 +2264,7 @@ int PGTYPESnumeric_from_decimal(decimal *src, numeric *dst); <title>The date Type</title> <para> The date type in C enables your programs to deal with data of the SQL type - date. See <xref linkend="datatype-datetime"> for the equivalent type in the + date. See <xref linkend="datatype-datetime"/> for the equivalent type in the <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> server. </para> <para> @@ -2303,7 +2303,7 @@ date PGTYPESdate_from_asc(char *str, char **endptr); currently no variable to change that within ECPG. </para> <para> - <xref linkend="ecpg-pgtypesdate-from-asc-table"> shows the allowed input formats. + <xref linkend="ecpg-pgtypesdate-from-asc-table"/> shows the allowed input formats. </para> <table id="ecpg-pgtypesdate-from-asc-table"> <title>Valid Input Formats for <function>PGTYPESdate_from_asc</function></title> @@ -2558,7 +2558,7 @@ int PGTYPESdate_fmt_asc(date dDate, char *fmtstring, char *outbuf); All other characters are copied 1:1 to the output string. </para> <para> - <xref linkend="ecpg-pgtypesdate-fmt-asc-example-table"> indicates a few possible formats. This will give + <xref linkend="ecpg-pgtypesdate-fmt-asc-example-table"/> indicates a few possible formats. This will give you an idea of how to use this function. All output lines are based on the same date: November 23, 1959. </para> @@ -2649,7 +2649,7 @@ int PGTYPESdate_defmt_asc(date *d, char *fmt, char *str); day. </para> <para> - <xref linkend="ecpg-rdefmtdate-example-table"> indicates a few possible formats. This will give + <xref linkend="ecpg-rdefmtdate-example-table"/> indicates a few possible formats. This will give you an idea of how to use this function. </para> <table id="ecpg-rdefmtdate-example-table"> @@ -2741,7 +2741,7 @@ int PGTYPESdate_defmt_asc(date *d, char *fmt, char *str); <title>The timestamp Type</title> <para> The timestamp type in C enables your programs to deal with data of the SQL - type timestamp. See <xref linkend="datatype-datetime"> for the equivalent + type timestamp. See <xref linkend="datatype-datetime"/> for the equivalent type in the <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> server. </para> <para> @@ -2766,7 +2766,7 @@ timestamp PGTYPEStimestamp_from_asc(char *str, char **endptr); <para> The function returns the parsed timestamp on success. On error, <literal>PGTYPESInvalidTimestamp</literal> is returned and <varname>errno</varname> is - set to <literal>PGTYPES_TS_BAD_TIMESTAMP</literal>. See <xref linkend="pgtypesinvalidtimestamp"> for important notes on this value. + set to <literal>PGTYPES_TS_BAD_TIMESTAMP</literal>. See <xref linkend="pgtypesinvalidtimestamp"/> for important notes on this value. </para> <para> In general, the input string can contain any combination of an allowed @@ -2777,7 +2777,7 @@ timestamp PGTYPEStimestamp_from_asc(char *str, char **endptr); specifiers are silently discarded. </para> <para> - <xref linkend="ecpg-pgtypestimestamp-from-asc-example-table"> contains a few examples for input strings. + <xref linkend="ecpg-pgtypestimestamp-from-asc-example-table"/> contains a few examples for input strings. </para> <table id="ecpg-pgtypestimestamp-from-asc-example-table"> <title>Valid Input Formats for <function>PGTYPEStimestamp_from_asc</function></title> @@ -3217,7 +3217,7 @@ int PGTYPEStimestamp_defmt_asc(char *str, char *fmt, timestamp *d); </para> <para> This is the reverse function to <xref - linkend="pgtypestimestampfmtasc">. See the documentation there in + linkend="pgtypestimestampfmtasc"/>. See the documentation there in order to find out about the possible formatting mask entries. </para> </listitem> @@ -3270,7 +3270,7 @@ int PGTYPEStimestamp_sub_interval(timestamp *tin, interval *span, timestamp *tou <title>The interval Type</title> <para> The interval type in C enables your programs to deal with data of the SQL - type interval. See <xref linkend="datatype-datetime"> for the equivalent + type interval. See <xref linkend="datatype-datetime"/> for the equivalent type in the <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> server. </para> <para> @@ -3364,7 +3364,7 @@ int PGTYPESinterval_copy(interval *intvlsrc, interval *intvldest); <function>PGTYPESdecimal_free</function>). There are a lot of other functions that deal with the decimal type in the <productname>Informix</productname> compatibility mode described in <xref - linkend="ecpg-informix-compat">. + linkend="ecpg-informix-compat"/>. </para> <para> The following functions can be used to work with the decimal type and are @@ -3632,7 +3632,7 @@ EXEC SQL DESCRIBE stmt1 INTO SQL DESCRIPTOR mydesc; so using <literal>DESCRIPTOR</literal> and <literal>SQL DESCRIPTOR</literal> produced named SQL Descriptor Areas. Now it is mandatory, omitting the <literal>SQL</literal> keyword produces SQLDA Descriptor Areas, - see <xref linkend="ecpg-sqlda-descriptors">. + see <xref linkend="ecpg-sqlda-descriptors"/>. </para> <para> @@ -3853,7 +3853,7 @@ EXEC SQL FETCH 3 FROM mycursor INTO DESCRIPTOR mysqlda; </programlisting> Note that the <literal>SQL</literal> keyword is omitted. The paragraphs about the use cases of the <literal>INTO</literal> and <literal>USING</literal> - keywords in <xref linkend="ecpg-named-descriptors"> also apply here with an addition. + keywords in <xref linkend="ecpg-named-descriptors"/> also apply here with an addition. In a <command>DESCRIBE</command> statement the <literal>DESCRIPTOR</literal> keyword can be completely omitted if the <literal>INTO</literal> keyword is used: <programlisting> @@ -4038,7 +4038,7 @@ typedef struct sqlvar_struct sqlvar_t; <listitem> <para> Points to the data. The format of the data is described - in <xref linkend="ecpg-variables-type-mapping">. + in <xref linkend="ecpg-variables-type-mapping"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -4447,7 +4447,7 @@ main(void) <para> The whole program is shown - in <xref linkend="ecpg-sqlda-example-example">. + in <xref linkend="ecpg-sqlda-example-example"/>. </para> <example id="ecpg-sqlda-example-example"> @@ -5016,7 +5016,7 @@ sqlstate: 42P01 <literal>SQLSTATE</literal> error codes; therefore a high degree of consistency can be achieved by using this error code scheme throughout all applications. For further information see - <xref linkend="errcodes-appendix">. + <xref linkend="errcodes-appendix"/>. </para> <para> @@ -5037,7 +5037,7 @@ sqlstate: 42P01 <literal>SQLSTATE</literal> is also listed. There is, however, no one-to-one or one-to-many mapping between the two schemes (indeed it is many-to-many), so you should consult the global - <literal>SQLSTATE</literal> listing in <xref linkend="errcodes-appendix"> + <literal>SQLSTATE</literal> listing in <xref linkend="errcodes-appendix"/> in each case. </para> @@ -5767,7 +5767,7 @@ ECPG = ecpg <para> The complete syntax of the <command>ecpg</command> command is - detailed in <xref linkend="app-ecpg">. + detailed in <xref linkend="app-ecpg"/>. </para> <para> @@ -5835,7 +5835,7 @@ ECPG = ecpg <para> <function>ECPGtransactionStatus(const char *<replaceable>connection_name</replaceable>)</function> returns the current transaction status of the given connection identified by <replaceable>connection_name</replaceable>. - See <xref linkend="libpq-status"> and libpq's <function>PQtransactionStatus()</function> for details about the returned status codes. + See <xref linkend="libpq-status"/> and libpq's <function>PQtransactionStatus()</function> for details about the returned status codes. </para> </listitem> @@ -5867,8 +5867,8 @@ ECPG = ecpg <para> For more details about the <function>ECPGget_PGconn()</function>, see - <xref linkend="ecpg-library">. For information about the large - object function interface, see <xref linkend="largeobjects">. + <xref linkend="ecpg-library"/>. For information about the large + object function interface, see <xref linkend="largeobjects"/>. </para> <para> @@ -5878,7 +5878,7 @@ ECPG = ecpg </para> <para> - <xref linkend="ecpg-lo-example"> shows an example program that + <xref linkend="ecpg-lo-example"/> shows an example program that illustrates how to create, write, and read a large object in an ECPG application. </para> @@ -5997,7 +5997,7 @@ main(void) A safe way to use the embedded SQL code in a C++ application is hiding the ECPG calls in a C module, which the C++ application code calls into to access the database, and linking that together with - the rest of the C++ code. See <xref linkend="ecpg-cpp-and-c"> + the rest of the C++ code. See <xref linkend="ecpg-cpp-and-c"/> about that. </para> @@ -6252,7 +6252,7 @@ c++ test_cpp.o test_mod.o -lecpg -o test_cpp <para> This section describes all SQL commands that are specific to embedded SQL. Also refer to the SQL commands listed - in <xref linkend="sql-commands">, which can also be used in + in <xref linkend="sql-commands"/>, which can also be used in embedded SQL, unless stated otherwise. </para> @@ -6320,9 +6320,9 @@ EXEC SQL ALLOCATE DESCRIPTOR mydesc; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-deallocate-descriptor"></member> - <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-get-descriptor"></member> - <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-set-descriptor"></member> + <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-deallocate-descriptor"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-get-descriptor"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-set-descriptor"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> @@ -6539,8 +6539,8 @@ EXEC SQL END DECLARE SECTION; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-disconnect"></member> - <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-set-connection"></member> + <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-disconnect"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-set-connection"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> @@ -6604,9 +6604,9 @@ EXEC SQL DEALLOCATE DESCRIPTOR mydesc; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-allocate-descriptor"></member> - <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-get-descriptor"></member> - <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-set-descriptor"></member> + <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-allocate-descriptor"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-get-descriptor"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-set-descriptor"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> @@ -6668,8 +6668,8 @@ DECLARE <replaceable class="parameter">cursor_name</replaceable> [ BINARY ] [ IN <term><replaceable class="parameter">query</replaceable></term> <listitem> <para> - A <xref linkend="sql-select"> or - <xref linkend="sql-values"> command which will provide the + A <xref linkend="sql-select"/> or + <xref linkend="sql-values"/> command which will provide the rows to be returned by the cursor. </para> </listitem> @@ -6678,7 +6678,7 @@ DECLARE <replaceable class="parameter">cursor_name</replaceable> [ BINARY ] [ IN <para> For the meaning of the cursor options, - see <xref linkend="sql-declare">. + see <xref linkend="sql-declare"/>. </para> </refsect1> @@ -6715,9 +6715,9 @@ EXEC SQL DECLARE cur1 CURSOR FOR stmt1; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-open"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-close"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-declare"></member> + <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-open"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-close"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-declare"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> @@ -6805,8 +6805,8 @@ EXEC SQL DEALLOCATE DESCRIPTOR mydesc; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-allocate-descriptor"></member> - <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-get-descriptor"></member> + <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-allocate-descriptor"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-get-descriptor"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> @@ -6915,8 +6915,8 @@ main(void) <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-connect"></member> - <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-set-connection"></member> + <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-connect"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-set-connection"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> @@ -7056,7 +7056,7 @@ GET DESCRIPTOR <replaceable class="parameter">descriptor_name</replaceable> VALU <listitem> <para> A token identifying which item of information about a column - to retrieve. See <xref linkend="ecpg-named-descriptors"> for + to retrieve. See <xref linkend="ecpg-named-descriptors"/> for a list of supported items. </para> </listitem> @@ -7164,8 +7164,8 @@ d_data = testdb <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-allocate-descriptor"></member> - <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-set-descriptor"></member> + <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-allocate-descriptor"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-set-descriptor"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> @@ -7258,8 +7258,8 @@ EXEC SQL OPEN :curname1; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-declare"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-close"></member> + <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-declare"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-close"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> @@ -7282,8 +7282,8 @@ PREPARE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> FROM <replaceable clas <para> <command>PREPARE</command> prepares a statement dynamically specified as a string for execution. This is different from the - direct SQL statement <xref linkend="sql-prepare">, which can also - be used in embedded programs. The <xref linkend="sql-execute"> + direct SQL statement <xref linkend="sql-prepare"/>, which can also + be used in embedded programs. The <xref linkend="sql-execute"/> command is used to execute either kind of prepared statement. </para> </refsect1> @@ -7338,7 +7338,7 @@ EXEC SQL EXECUTE foo USING SQL DESCRIPTOR indesc INTO SQL DESCRIPTOR outdesc; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-execute"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-execute"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> @@ -7445,8 +7445,8 @@ EXEC SQL SET CONNECTION = con1; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-connect"></member> - <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-disconnect"></member> + <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-connect"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-disconnect"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> @@ -7520,7 +7520,7 @@ SET DESCRIPTOR <replaceable class="parameter">descriptor_name</replaceable> VALU <listitem> <para> A token identifying which item of information to set in the - descriptor. See <xref linkend="ecpg-named-descriptors"> for a + descriptor. See <xref linkend="ecpg-named-descriptors"/> for a list of supported items. </para> </listitem> @@ -7561,8 +7561,8 @@ EXEC SQL SET DESCRIPTOR indesc VALUE 2 INDICATOR = :val2null, DATA = :val2; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-allocate-descriptor"></member> - <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-get-descriptor"></member> + <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-allocate-descriptor"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="ecpg-sql-get-descriptor"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> @@ -7796,7 +7796,7 @@ WHENEVER { NOT FOUND | SQLERROR | SQLWARNING } <replaceable class="parameter">ac <title>Parameters</title> <para> - See <xref linkend="ecpg-whenever"> for a description of the + See <xref linkend="ecpg-whenever"/> for a description of the parameters. </para> </refsect1> @@ -7979,7 +7979,7 @@ EXEC SQL CLOSE DATABASE; <title>Informix-compatible SQLDA Descriptor Areas</title> <para> Informix-compatible mode supports a different structure than the one described in - <xref linkend="ecpg-sqlda-descriptors">. See below: + <xref linkend="ecpg-sqlda-descriptors"/>. See below: <programlisting> struct sqlvar_compat { @@ -8653,7 +8653,7 @@ void rtoday(date *d); that it sets to the current date. </para> <para> - Internally this function uses the <xref linkend="pgtypesdatetoday"> + Internally this function uses the <xref linkend="pgtypesdatetoday"/> function. </para> </listitem> @@ -8678,7 +8678,7 @@ int rjulmdy(date d, short mdy[3]); The function always returns 0 at the moment. </para> <para> - Internally the function uses the <xref linkend="pgtypesdatejulmdy"> + Internally the function uses the <xref linkend="pgtypesdatejulmdy"/> function. </para> </listitem> @@ -8748,7 +8748,7 @@ int rdefmtdate(date *d, char *fmt, char *str); </para> <para> Internally this function is implemented to use the <xref - linkend="pgtypesdatedefmtasc"> function. See the reference there for a + linkend="pgtypesdatedefmtasc"/> function. See the reference there for a table of example input. </para> </listitem> @@ -8771,7 +8771,7 @@ int rfmtdate(date d, char *fmt, char *str); On success, 0 is returned and a negative value if an error occurred. </para> <para> - Internally this function uses the <xref linkend="pgtypesdatefmtasc"> + Internally this function uses the <xref linkend="pgtypesdatefmtasc"/> function, see the reference there for examples. </para> </listitem> @@ -8795,7 +8795,7 @@ int rmdyjul(short mdy[3], date *d); </para> <para> Internally the function is implemented to use the function <xref - linkend="pgtypesdatemdyjul">. + linkend="pgtypesdatemdyjul"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -8851,7 +8851,7 @@ int rdayofweek(date d); </para> <para> Internally the function is implemented to use the function <xref - linkend="pgtypesdatedayofweek">. + linkend="pgtypesdatedayofweek"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -8889,7 +8889,7 @@ int dtcvasc(char *str, timestamp *ts); </para> <para> Internally this function uses the <xref - linkend="pgtypestimestampfromasc"> function. See the reference there + linkend="pgtypestimestampfromasc"/> function. See the reference there for a table with example inputs. </para> </listitem> @@ -8911,7 +8911,7 @@ dtcvfmtasc(char *inbuf, char *fmtstr, timestamp *dtvalue) </para> <para> This function is implemented by means of the <xref - linkend="pgtypestimestampdefmtasc"> function. See the documentation + linkend="pgtypestimestampdefmtasc"/> function. See the documentation there for a list of format specifiers that can be used. </para> <para> @@ -8983,7 +8983,7 @@ int dttofmtasc(timestamp *ts, char *output, int str_len, char *fmtstr); </para> <para> Internally, this function uses the <xref - linkend="pgtypestimestampfmtasc"> function. See the reference there for + linkend="pgtypestimestampfmtasc"/> function. See the reference there for information on what format mask specifiers can be used. </para> </listitem> @@ -9289,7 +9289,7 @@ int risnull(int t, char *ptr); The function receives the type of the variable to test (<literal>t</literal>) as well a pointer to this variable (<literal>ptr</literal>). Note that the latter needs to be cast to a char*. See the function <xref - linkend="rsetnull"> for a list of possible variable types. + linkend="rsetnull"/> for a list of possible variable types. </para> <para> Here is an example of how to use this function: diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/errcodes.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/errcodes.sgml index 61ad3e00e91..6fd16f643ea 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/errcodes.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/errcodes.sgml @@ -32,7 +32,7 @@ </para> <para> - <xref linkend="errcodes-table"> lists all the error codes defined in + <xref linkend="errcodes-table"/> lists all the error codes defined in <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> &version;. (Some are not actually used at present, but are defined by the SQL standard.) The error classes are also shown. For each error class there is a @@ -66,9 +66,9 @@ <title><productname>PostgreSQL</productname> Error Codes</title> <tgroup cols="2"> - <colspec colnum="1" colname="errorcode"> - <colspec colnum="2" colname="condname"> - <spanspec namest="errorcode" nameend="condname" spanname="span12"> + <colspec colnum="1" colname="errorcode"/> + <colspec colnum="2" colname="condname"/> + <spanspec namest="errorcode" nameend="condname" spanname="span12"/> <thead> <row> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/event-trigger.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/event-trigger.sgml index c16ff338a3b..0a8860490ad 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/event-trigger.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/event-trigger.sgml @@ -8,7 +8,7 @@ </indexterm> <para> - To supplement the trigger mechanism discussed in <xref linkend="triggers">, + To supplement the trigger mechanism discussed in <xref linkend="triggers"/>, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> also provides event triggers. Unlike regular triggers, which are attached to a single table and capture only DML events, event triggers are global to a particular database and are capable of @@ -57,7 +57,7 @@ operations that took place, use the set-returning function <literal>pg_event_trigger_ddl_commands()</literal> from the <literal>ddl_command_end</literal> event trigger code (see - <xref linkend="functions-event-triggers">). Note that the trigger fires + <xref linkend="functions-event-triggers"/>). Note that the trigger fires after the actions have taken place (but before the transaction commits), and thus the system catalogs can be read as already changed. </para> @@ -68,7 +68,7 @@ database objects. To list the objects that have been dropped, use the set-returning function <literal>pg_event_trigger_dropped_objects()</literal> from the <literal>sql_drop</literal> event trigger code (see - <xref linkend="functions-event-triggers">). Note that + <xref linkend="functions-event-triggers"/>). Note that the trigger is executed after the objects have been deleted from the system catalogs, so it's not possible to look them up anymore. </para> @@ -96,11 +96,11 @@ <para> For a complete list of commands supported by the event trigger mechanism, - see <xref linkend="event-trigger-matrix">. + see <xref linkend="event-trigger-matrix"/>. </para> <para> - Event triggers are created using the command <xref linkend="sql-createeventtrigger">. + Event triggers are created using the command <xref linkend="sql-createeventtrigger"/>. In order to create an event trigger, you must first create a function with the special return type <literal>event_trigger</literal>. This function need not (and may not) return a value; the return type serves merely as @@ -125,7 +125,7 @@ <title>Event Trigger Firing Matrix</title> <para> - <xref linkend="event-trigger-by-command-tag"> lists all commands + <xref linkend="event-trigger-by-command-tag"/> lists all commands for which event triggers are supported. </para> @@ -953,7 +953,7 @@ typedef struct EventTriggerData Describes the event for which the function is called, one of <literal>"ddl_command_start"</literal>, <literal>"ddl_command_end"</literal>, <literal>"sql_drop"</literal>, <literal>"table_rewrite"</literal>. - See <xref linkend="event-trigger-definition"> for the meaning of these + See <xref linkend="event-trigger-definition"/> for the meaning of these events. </para> </listitem> @@ -1003,7 +1003,7 @@ typedef struct EventTriggerData The event trigger definition associated the function with the <literal>ddl_command_start</literal> event. The effect is that all DDL commands (with the exceptions mentioned - in <xref linkend="event-trigger-definition">) are prevented from running. + in <xref linkend="event-trigger-definition"/>) are prevented from running. </para> <para> @@ -1037,7 +1037,7 @@ noddl(PG_FUNCTION_ARGS) </para> <para> - After you have compiled the source code (see <xref linkend="dfunc">), + After you have compiled the source code (see <xref linkend="dfunc"/>), declare the function and the triggers: <programlisting> CREATE FUNCTION noddl() RETURNS event_trigger diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/extend.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/extend.sgml index e8190108754..5f1bb70e97a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/extend.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/extend.sgml @@ -15,32 +15,32 @@ <itemizedlist spacing="compact" mark="bullet"> <listitem> <para> - functions (starting in <xref linkend="xfunc">) + functions (starting in <xref linkend="xfunc"/>) </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - aggregates (starting in <xref linkend="xaggr">) + aggregates (starting in <xref linkend="xaggr"/>) </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - data types (starting in <xref linkend="xtypes">) + data types (starting in <xref linkend="xtypes"/>) </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - operators (starting in <xref linkend="xoper">) + operators (starting in <xref linkend="xoper"/>) </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - operator classes for indexes (starting in <xref linkend="xindex">) + operator classes for indexes (starting in <xref linkend="xindex"/>) </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - packages of related objects (starting in <xref linkend="extend-extensions">) + packages of related objects (starting in <xref linkend="extend-extensions"/>) </para> </listitem> </itemizedlist> @@ -132,14 +132,14 @@ types through functions provided by the user and only understands the behavior of such types to the extent that the user describes them. - The built-in base types are described in <xref linkend="datatype">. + The built-in base types are described in <xref linkend="datatype"/>. </para> <para> Enumerated (enum) types can be considered as a subcategory of base types. The main difference is that they can be created using just <acronym>SQL</acronym> commands, without any low-level programming. - Refer to <xref linkend="datatype-enum"> for more information. + Refer to <xref linkend="datatype-enum"/> for more information. </para> </sect2> @@ -157,25 +157,25 @@ type is automatically created for each base type, composite type, range type, and domain type. But there are no arrays of arrays. So far as the type system is concerned, multi-dimensional arrays are the same as - one-dimensional arrays. Refer to <xref linkend="arrays"> for more + one-dimensional arrays. Refer to <xref linkend="arrays"/> for more information. </para> <para> Composite types, or row types, are created whenever the user creates a table. It is also possible to use <xref - linkend="sql-createtype"> to + linkend="sql-createtype"/> to define a <quote>stand-alone</quote> composite type with no associated table. A composite type is simply a list of types with associated field names. A value of a composite type is a row or - record of field values. Refer to <xref linkend="rowtypes"> + record of field values. Refer to <xref linkend="rowtypes"/> for more information. </para> <para> A range type can hold two values of the same type, which are the lower and upper bounds of the range. Range types are user-created, although - a few built-in ones exist. Refer to <xref linkend="rangetypes"> + a few built-in ones exist. Refer to <xref linkend="rangetypes"/> for more information. </para> </sect2> @@ -188,8 +188,8 @@ is interchangeable with its underlying type. However, a domain can have constraints that restrict its valid values to a subset of what the underlying type would allow. Domains are created using - the <acronym>SQL</acronym> command <xref linkend="sql-createdomain">. - Refer to <xref linkend="domains"> for more information. + the <acronym>SQL</acronym> command <xref linkend="sql-createdomain"/>. + Refer to <xref linkend="domains"/> for more information. </para> </sect2> @@ -202,7 +202,7 @@ container types, but they can be used to declare the argument and result types of functions. This provides a mechanism within the type system to identify special classes of functions. <xref - linkend="datatype-pseudotypes-table"> lists the existing + linkend="datatype-pseudotypes-table"/> lists the existing pseudo-types. </para> </sect2> @@ -300,7 +300,7 @@ <para> A variadic function (one taking a variable number of arguments, as in - <xref linkend="xfunc-sql-variadic-functions">) can be + <xref linkend="xfunc-sql-variadic-functions"/>) can be polymorphic: this is accomplished by declaring its last parameter as <literal>VARIADIC</literal> <type>anyarray</type>. For purposes of argument matching and determining the actual result type, such a function behaves @@ -337,7 +337,7 @@ of the extension itself. If the extension includes C code, there will typically also be a shared library file into which the C code has been built. Once you have these files, a simple - <xref linkend="sql-createextension"> command loads the objects into + <xref linkend="sql-createextension"/> command loads the objects into your database. </para> @@ -346,7 +346,7 @@ <acronym>SQL</acronym> script to load a bunch of <quote>loose</quote> objects into your database, is that <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> will then understand that the objects of the extension go together. You can - drop all the objects with a single <xref linkend="sql-dropextension"> + drop all the objects with a single <xref linkend="sql-dropextension"/> command (no need to maintain a separate <quote>uninstall</quote> script). Even more useful, <application>pg_dump</application> knows that it should not dump the individual member objects of the extension — it will @@ -366,7 +366,7 @@ by <application>pg_dump</application>. Such a change is usually only sensible if you concurrently make the same change in the extension's script file. (But there are special provisions for tables containing configuration - data; see <xref linkend="extend-extensions-config-tables">.) + data; see <xref linkend="extend-extensions-config-tables"/>.) In production situations, it's generally better to create an extension update script to perform changes to extension member objects. </para> @@ -405,7 +405,7 @@ <para> The kinds of SQL objects that can be members of an extension are shown in - the description of <xref linkend="sql-alterextension">. Notably, objects + the description of <xref linkend="sql-alterextension"/>. Notably, objects that are database-cluster-wide, such as databases, roles, and tablespaces, cannot be extension members since an extension is only known within one database. (Although an extension script is not prohibited from creating @@ -438,7 +438,7 @@ </indexterm> <para> - The <xref linkend="sql-createextension"> command relies on a control + The <xref linkend="sql-createextension"/> command relies on a control file for each extension, which must be named the same as the extension with a suffix of <literal>.control</literal>, and must be placed in the installation's <literal>SHAREDIR/extension</literal> directory. There @@ -499,7 +499,7 @@ when initially creating an extension, but not during extension updates (since that might override user-added comments). Alternatively, the extension's comment can be set by writing - a <xref linkend="sql-comment"> command in the script file. + a <xref linkend="sql-comment"/> command in the script file. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -562,7 +562,7 @@ its contained objects into a different schema after initial creation of the extension. The default is <literal>false</literal>, i.e. the extension is not relocatable. - See <xref linkend="extend-extensions-relocation"> for more information. + See <xref linkend="extend-extensions-relocation"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -576,7 +576,7 @@ and not any other. The <varname>schema</varname> parameter is consulted only when initially creating an extension, not during extension updates. - See <xref linkend="extend-extensions-relocation"> for more information. + See <xref linkend="extend-extensions-relocation"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -609,7 +609,7 @@ comments) by the extension mechanism. This provision is commonly used to throw an error if the script file is fed to <application>psql</application> rather than being loaded via <command>CREATE EXTENSION</command> (see example - script in <xref linkend="extend-extensions-example">). + script in <xref linkend="extend-extensions-example"/>). Without that, users might accidentally load the extension's contents as <quote>loose</quote> objects rather than as an extension, a state of affairs that's a bit tedious to recover from. @@ -687,7 +687,7 @@ <para> In all cases, the script file will be executed with - <xref linkend="guc-search-path"> initially set to point to the target + <xref linkend="guc-search-path"/> initially set to point to the target schema; that is, <command>CREATE EXTENSION</command> does the equivalent of this: <programlisting> @@ -1031,14 +1031,14 @@ include $(PGXS) </programlisting> This makefile relies on <acronym>PGXS</acronym>, which is described - in <xref linkend="extend-pgxs">. The command <literal>make install</literal> + in <xref linkend="extend-pgxs"/>. The command <literal>make install</literal> will install the control and script files into the correct directory as reported by <application>pg_config</application>. </para> <para> Once the files are installed, use the - <xref linkend="sql-createextension"> command to load the objects into + <xref linkend="sql-createextension"/> command to load the objects into any particular database. </para> </sect2> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/external-projects.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/external-projects.sgml index 03fd18aeb80..89147817ec1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/external-projects.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/external-projects.sgml @@ -40,7 +40,7 @@ </itemizedlist> All other language interfaces are external projects and are distributed - separately. <xref linkend="language-interface-table"> includes a list of + separately. <xref linkend="language-interface-table"/> includes a list of some of these projects. Note that some of these packages might not be released under the same license as <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>. For more information on each language interface, including licensing terms, refer to @@ -170,7 +170,7 @@ <para> In addition, there are a number of procedural languages that are developed and maintained outside the core <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> - distribution. <xref linkend="pl-language-table"> lists some of these + distribution. <xref linkend="pl-language-table"/> lists some of these packages. Note that some of these projects might not be released under the same license as <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>. For more information on each procedural language, including licensing information, refer to its website @@ -238,7 +238,7 @@ just like features that are built in. The <filename>contrib/</filename> directory shipped with the source code contains several extensions, which are described in - <xref linkend="contrib">. Other extensions are developed + <xref linkend="contrib"/>. Other extensions are developed independently, like <application><ulink url="http://postgis.net/">PostGIS</ulink></application>. Even <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> replication solutions can be developed diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/fdwhandler.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/fdwhandler.sgml index 4250a03f16e..a2f8137713e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/fdwhandler.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/fdwhandler.sgml @@ -22,7 +22,7 @@ The foreign data wrappers included in the standard distribution are good references when trying to write your own. Look into the <filename>contrib</filename> subdirectory of the source tree. - The <xref linkend="sql-createforeigndatawrapper"> reference page also has + The <xref linkend="sql-createforeigndatawrapper"/> reference page also has some useful details. </para> @@ -43,7 +43,7 @@ a validator function. Both functions must be written in a compiled language such as C, using the version-1 interface. For details on C language calling conventions and dynamic loading, - see <xref linkend="xfunc-c">. + see <xref linkend="xfunc-c"/>. </para> <para> @@ -57,7 +57,7 @@ returning the special pseudo-type <type>fdw_handler</type>. The callback functions are plain C functions and are not visible or callable at the SQL level. The callback functions are described in - <xref linkend="fdw-callbacks">. + <xref linkend="fdw-callbacks"/>. </para> <para> @@ -126,7 +126,7 @@ GetForeignRelSize(PlannerInfo *root, </para> <para> - See <xref linkend="fdw-planning"> for additional information. + See <xref linkend="fdw-planning"/> for additional information. </para> <para> @@ -157,7 +157,7 @@ GetForeignPaths(PlannerInfo *root, </para> <para> - See <xref linkend="fdw-planning"> for additional information. + See <xref linkend="fdw-planning"/> for additional information. </para> <para> @@ -193,7 +193,7 @@ GetForeignPlan(PlannerInfo *root, </para> <para> - See <xref linkend="fdw-planning"> for additional information. + See <xref linkend="fdw-planning"/> for additional information. </para> <para> @@ -341,7 +341,7 @@ GetForeignJoinPaths(PlannerInfo *root, </para> <para> - See <xref linkend="fdw-planning"> for additional information. + See <xref linkend="fdw-planning"/> for additional information. </para> </sect2> @@ -388,7 +388,7 @@ GetForeignUpperPaths(PlannerInfo *root, </para> <para> - See <xref linkend="fdw-planning"> for additional information. + See <xref linkend="fdw-planning"/> for additional information. </para> </sect2> @@ -477,7 +477,7 @@ PlanForeignModify(PlannerInfo *root, </para> <para> - See <xref linkend="fdw-planning"> for additional information. + See <xref linkend="fdw-planning"/> for additional information. </para> <para> @@ -759,7 +759,7 @@ PlanDirectModify(PlannerInfo *root, </para> <para> - See <xref linkend="fdw-planning"> for additional information. + See <xref linkend="fdw-planning"/> for additional information. </para> <para> @@ -872,7 +872,7 @@ EndDirectModify(ForeignScanState *node); <para> If an FDW wishes to support <firstterm>late row locking</firstterm> (as described - in <xref linkend="fdw-row-locking">), it must provide the following + in <xref linkend="fdw-row-locking"/>), it must provide the following callback functions: </para> @@ -905,7 +905,7 @@ GetForeignRowMarkType(RangeTblEntry *rte, </para> <para> - See <xref linkend="fdw-row-locking"> for more information. + See <xref linkend="fdw-row-locking"/> for more information. </para> <para> @@ -964,7 +964,7 @@ RefetchForeignRow(EState *estate, </para> <para> - See <xref linkend="fdw-row-locking"> for more information. + See <xref linkend="fdw-row-locking"/> for more information. </para> <para> @@ -1093,7 +1093,7 @@ AnalyzeForeignTable(Relation relation, BlockNumber *totalpages); </programlisting> - This function is called when <xref linkend="sql-analyze"> is executed on + This function is called when <xref linkend="sql-analyze"/> is executed on a foreign table. If the FDW can collect statistics for this foreign table, it should return <literal>true</literal>, and provide a pointer to a function that will collect sample rows from the table in @@ -1139,10 +1139,10 @@ ImportForeignSchema(ImportForeignSchemaStmt *stmt, Oid serverOid); </programlisting> Obtain a list of foreign table creation commands. This function is - called when executing <xref linkend="sql-importforeignschema">, and is + called when executing <xref linkend="sql-importforeignschema"/>, and is passed the parse tree for that statement, as well as the OID of the foreign server to use. It should return a list of C strings, each of - which must contain a <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable"> command. + which must contain a <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable"/> command. These strings will be parsed and executed by the core server. </para> @@ -1605,7 +1605,7 @@ GetForeignServerByName(const char *name, bool missing_ok); <para> <function>PlanForeignModify</function> and the other callbacks described in - <xref linkend="fdw-callbacks-update"> are designed around the assumption + <xref linkend="fdw-callbacks-update"/> are designed around the assumption that the foreign relation will be scanned in the usual way and then individual row updates will be driven by a local <literal>ModifyTable</literal> plan node. This approach is necessary for the general case where an @@ -1616,7 +1616,7 @@ GetForeignServerByName(const char *name, bool missing_ok); compete against the <literal>ModifyTable</literal> approach. This approach could also be used to implement remote <literal>SELECT FOR UPDATE</literal>, rather than using the row locking callbacks described in - <xref linkend="fdw-callbacks-row-locking">. Keep in mind that a path + <xref linkend="fdw-callbacks-row-locking"/>. Keep in mind that a path inserted into <literal>UPPERREL_FINAL</literal> is responsible for implementing <emphasis>all</emphasis> behavior of the query. </para> @@ -1676,7 +1676,7 @@ GetForeignServerByName(const char *name, bool missing_ok); By default, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> ignores locking considerations when interfacing to FDWs, but an FDW can perform early locking without any explicit support from the core code. The API functions described - in <xref linkend="fdw-callbacks-row-locking">, which were added + in <xref linkend="fdw-callbacks-row-locking"/>, which were added in <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> 9.5, allow an FDW to use late locking if it wishes. </para> @@ -1720,7 +1720,7 @@ GetForeignServerByName(const char *name, bool missing_ok); again perform early locking by fetching tuples with the equivalent of <command>SELECT FOR UPDATE/SHARE</command>. To perform late locking instead, provide the callback functions defined - in <xref linkend="fdw-callbacks-row-locking">. + in <xref linkend="fdw-callbacks-row-locking"/>. In <function>GetForeignRowMarkType</function>, select rowmark option <literal>ROW_MARK_EXCLUSIVE</literal>, <literal>ROW_MARK_NOKEYEXCLUSIVE</literal>, <literal>ROW_MARK_SHARE</literal>, or <literal>ROW_MARK_KEYSHARE</literal> depending diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/file-fdw.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/file-fdw.sgml index 88aefb8ef07..e2598a07da1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/file-fdw.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/file-fdw.sgml @@ -13,7 +13,7 @@ files in the server's file system, or to execute programs on the server and read their output. The data file or program output must be in a format that can be read by <command>COPY FROM</command>; - see <xref linkend="sql-copy"> for details. + see <xref linkend="sql-copy"/> for details. Access to data files is currently read-only. </para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/func.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/func.sgml index 698daf69ea6..4dd9d029e69 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/func.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/func.sgml @@ -15,7 +15,7 @@ <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> provides a large number of functions and operators for the built-in data types. Users can also define their own functions and operators, as described in - <xref linkend="server-programming">. The + <xref linkend="server-programming"/>. The <application>psql</application> commands <command>\df</command> and <command>\do</command> can be used to list all available functions and operators, respectively. @@ -176,7 +176,7 @@ The operators <literal>AND</literal> and <literal>OR</literal> are commutative, that is, you can switch the left and right operand without affecting the result. But see <xref - linkend="syntax-express-eval"> for more information about the + linkend="syntax-express-eval"/> for more information about the order of evaluation of subexpressions. </para> </sect1> @@ -191,7 +191,7 @@ <para> The usual comparison operators are available, as shown in <xref - linkend="functions-comparison-op-table">. + linkend="functions-comparison-op-table"/>. </para> <table id="functions-comparison-op-table"> @@ -258,7 +258,7 @@ <para> There are also some comparison predicates, as shown in <xref - linkend="functions-comparison-pred-table">. These behave much like + linkend="functions-comparison-pred-table"/>. These behave much like operators, but have special syntax mandated by the SQL standard. </para> @@ -455,7 +455,7 @@ returns true if <replaceable>expression</replaceable> evaluates to the null value. It is highly recommended that these applications be modified to comply with the SQL standard. However, if that - cannot be done the <xref linkend="guc-transform-null-equals"> + cannot be done the <xref linkend="guc-transform-null-equals"/> configuration variable is available. If it is enabled, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> will convert <literal>x = NULL</literal> clauses to <literal>x IS NULL</literal>. @@ -536,7 +536,7 @@ <para> Some comparison-related functions are also available, as shown in <xref - linkend="functions-comparison-func-table">. + linkend="functions-comparison-func-table"/>. </para> <table id="functions-comparison-func-table"> @@ -591,7 +591,7 @@ </para> <para> - <xref linkend="functions-math-op-table"> shows the available mathematical operators. + <xref linkend="functions-math-op-table"/> shows the available mathematical operators. </para> <table id="functions-math-op-table"> @@ -736,11 +736,11 @@ the others are available for all numeric data types. The bitwise operators are also available for the bit string types <type>bit</type> and <type>bit varying</type>, as - shown in <xref linkend="functions-bit-string-op-table">. + shown in <xref linkend="functions-bit-string-op-table"/>. </para> <para> - <xref linkend="functions-math-func-table"> shows the available + <xref linkend="functions-math-func-table"/> shows the available mathematical functions. In the table, <literal>dp</literal> indicates <type>double precision</type>. Many of these functions are provided in multiple forms with different argument types. @@ -1093,7 +1093,7 @@ </table> <para> - <xref linkend="functions-math-random-table"> shows functions for + <xref linkend="functions-math-random-table"/> shows functions for generating random numbers. </para> @@ -1139,11 +1139,11 @@ The characteristics of the values returned by <literal><function>random()</function></literal> depend on the system implementation. It is not suitable for cryptographic - applications; see <xref linkend="pgcrypto"> module for an alternative. + applications; see <xref linkend="pgcrypto"/> module for an alternative. </para> <para> - Finally, <xref linkend="functions-math-trig-table"> shows the + Finally, <xref linkend="functions-math-trig-table"/> shows the available trigonometric functions. All trigonometric functions take arguments and return values of type <type>double precision</type>. Each of the trigonometric functions comes in @@ -1328,10 +1328,10 @@ <acronym>SQL</acronym> defines some string functions that use key words, rather than commas, to separate arguments. Details are in - <xref linkend="functions-string-sql">. + <xref linkend="functions-string-sql"/>. <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> also provides versions of these functions that use the regular function invocation syntax - (see <xref linkend="functions-string-other">). + (see <xref linkend="functions-string-other"/>). </para> <note> @@ -1343,7 +1343,7 @@ caused surprising behaviors. However, the string concatenation operator (<literal>||</literal>) still accepts non-string input, so long as at least one input is of a string type, as shown in <xref - linkend="functions-string-sql">. For other cases, insert an explicit + linkend="functions-string-sql"/>. For other cases, insert an explicit coercion to <type>text</type> if you need to duplicate the previous behavior. </para> </note> @@ -1504,7 +1504,7 @@ <entry><type>text</type></entry> <entry> Extract substring matching POSIX regular expression. See - <xref linkend="functions-matching"> for more information on pattern + <xref linkend="functions-matching"/> for more information on pattern matching. </entry> <entry><literal>substring('Thomas' from '...$')</literal></entry> @@ -1516,7 +1516,7 @@ <entry><type>text</type></entry> <entry> Extract substring matching <acronym>SQL</acronym> regular expression. - See <xref linkend="functions-matching"> for more information on + See <xref linkend="functions-matching"/> for more information on pattern matching. </entry> <entry><literal>substring('Thomas' from '%#"o_a#"_' for '#')</literal></entry> @@ -1577,8 +1577,8 @@ <para> Additional string manipulation functions are available and are - listed in <xref linkend="functions-string-other">. Some of them are used internally to implement the - <acronym>SQL</acronym>-standard string functions listed in <xref linkend="functions-string-sql">. + listed in <xref linkend="functions-string-other"/>. Some of them are used internally to implement the + <acronym>SQL</acronym>-standard string functions listed in <xref linkend="functions-string-sql"/>. </para> <table id="functions-string-other"> @@ -1702,7 +1702,7 @@ <parameter>string</parameter> must be valid in this encoding. Conversions can be defined by <command>CREATE CONVERSION</command>. Also there are some predefined conversions. See <xref - linkend="conversion-names"> for available conversions. + linkend="conversion-names"/> for available conversions. </entry> <entry><literal>convert('text_in_utf8', 'UTF8', 'LATIN1')</literal></entry> <entry><literal>text_in_utf8</literal> represented in Latin-1 @@ -1792,7 +1792,7 @@ <entry> Format arguments according to a format string. This function is similar to the C function <function>sprintf</function>. - See <xref linkend="functions-string-format">. + See <xref linkend="functions-string-format"/>. </entry> <entry><literal>format('Hello %s, %1$s', 'World')</literal></entry> <entry><literal>Hello World, World</literal></entry> @@ -1968,7 +1968,7 @@ Quotes are added only if necessary (i.e., if the string contains non-identifier characters or would be case-folded). Embedded quotes are properly doubled. - See also <xref linkend="plpgsql-quote-literal-example">. + See also <xref linkend="plpgsql-quote-literal-example"/>. </entry> <entry><literal>quote_ident('Foo bar')</literal></entry> <entry><literal>"Foo bar"</literal></entry> @@ -1989,7 +1989,7 @@ Note that <function>quote_literal</function> returns null on null input; if the argument might be null, <function>quote_nullable</function> is often more suitable. - See also <xref linkend="plpgsql-quote-literal-example">. + See also <xref linkend="plpgsql-quote-literal-example"/>. </entry> <entry><literal>quote_literal(E'O\'Reilly')</literal></entry> <entry><literal>'O''Reilly'</literal></entry> @@ -2019,7 +2019,7 @@ in an <acronym>SQL</acronym> statement string; or, if the argument is null, return <literal>NULL</literal>. Embedded single-quotes and backslashes are properly doubled. - See also <xref linkend="plpgsql-quote-literal-example">. + See also <xref linkend="plpgsql-quote-literal-example"/>. </entry> <entry><literal>quote_nullable(NULL)</literal></entry> <entry><literal>NULL</literal></entry> @@ -2048,7 +2048,7 @@ <entry> Return captured substring(s) resulting from the first match of a POSIX regular expression to the <parameter>string</parameter>. See - <xref linkend="functions-posix-regexp"> for more information. + <xref linkend="functions-posix-regexp"/> for more information. </entry> <entry><literal>regexp_match('foobarbequebaz', '(bar)(beque)')</literal></entry> <entry><literal>{bar,beque}</literal></entry> @@ -2065,7 +2065,7 @@ <entry> Return captured substring(s) resulting from matching a POSIX regular expression to the <parameter>string</parameter>. See - <xref linkend="functions-posix-regexp"> for more information. + <xref linkend="functions-posix-regexp"/> for more information. </entry> <entry><literal>regexp_matches('foobarbequebaz', 'ba.', 'g')</literal></entry> <entry><literal>{bar}</literal><para><literal>{baz}</literal></para> (2 rows)</entry> @@ -2081,7 +2081,7 @@ <entry><type>text</type></entry> <entry> Replace substring(s) matching a POSIX regular expression. See - <xref linkend="functions-posix-regexp"> for more information. + <xref linkend="functions-posix-regexp"/> for more information. </entry> <entry><literal>regexp_replace('Thomas', '.[mN]a.', 'M')</literal></entry> <entry><literal>ThM</literal></entry> @@ -2097,7 +2097,7 @@ <entry><type>text[]</type></entry> <entry> Split <parameter>string</parameter> using a POSIX regular expression as - the delimiter. See <xref linkend="functions-posix-regexp"> for more + the delimiter. See <xref linkend="functions-posix-regexp"/> for more information. </entry> <entry><literal>regexp_split_to_array('hello world', E'\\s+')</literal></entry> @@ -2114,7 +2114,7 @@ <entry><type>setof text</type></entry> <entry> Split <parameter>string</parameter> using a POSIX regular expression as - the delimiter. See <xref linkend="functions-posix-regexp"> for more + the delimiter. See <xref linkend="functions-posix-regexp"/> for more information. </entry> <entry><literal>regexp_split_to_table('hello world', E'\\s+')</literal></entry> @@ -2339,7 +2339,7 @@ <function>format</function> functions are variadic, so it is possible to pass the values to be concatenated or formatted as an array marked with the <literal>VARIADIC</literal> keyword (see <xref - linkend="xfunc-sql-variadic-functions">). The array's elements are + linkend="xfunc-sql-variadic-functions"/>). The array's elements are treated as if they were separate ordinary arguments to the function. If the variadic array argument is NULL, <function>concat</function> and <function>concat_ws</function> return NULL, but @@ -2348,7 +2348,7 @@ <para> See also the aggregate function <function>string_agg</function> in - <xref linkend="functions-aggregate">. + <xref linkend="functions-aggregate"/>. </para> <table id="conversion-names"> @@ -3351,7 +3351,7 @@ SELECT format('Testing %3$s, %2$s, %s', 'one', 'two', 'three'); <para> The <literal>%I</literal> and <literal>%L</literal> format specifiers are particularly useful for safely constructing dynamic SQL statements. See - <xref linkend="plpgsql-quote-literal-example">. + <xref linkend="plpgsql-quote-literal-example"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -3375,10 +3375,10 @@ SELECT format('Testing %3$s, %2$s, %s', 'one', 'two', 'three'); <acronym>SQL</acronym> defines some string functions that use key words, rather than commas, to separate arguments. Details are in - <xref linkend="functions-binarystring-sql">. + <xref linkend="functions-binarystring-sql"/>. <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> also provides versions of these functions that use the regular function invocation syntax - (see <xref linkend="functions-binarystring-other">). + (see <xref linkend="functions-binarystring-other"/>). </para> <note> @@ -3498,10 +3498,10 @@ SELECT format('Testing %3$s, %2$s, %s', 'one', 'two', 'three'); <para> Additional binary string manipulation functions are available and - are listed in <xref linkend="functions-binarystring-other">. Some + are listed in <xref linkend="functions-binarystring-other"/>. Some of them are used internally to implement the <acronym>SQL</acronym>-standard string functions listed in <xref - linkend="functions-binarystring-sql">. + linkend="functions-binarystring-sql"/>. </para> <table id="functions-binarystring-other"> @@ -3688,8 +3688,8 @@ SELECT format('Testing %3$s, %2$s, %s', 'one', 'two', 'three'); <para> See also the aggregate function <function>string_agg</function> in - <xref linkend="functions-aggregate"> and the large object functions - in <xref linkend="lo-funcs">. + <xref linkend="functions-aggregate"/> and the large object functions + in <xref linkend="lo-funcs"/>. </para> </sect1> @@ -3707,7 +3707,7 @@ SELECT format('Testing %3$s, %2$s, %s', 'one', 'two', 'three'); manipulating bit strings, that is values of the types <type>bit</type> and <type>bit varying</type>. Aside from the usual comparison operators, the operators - shown in <xref linkend="functions-bit-string-op-table"> can be used. + shown in <xref linkend="functions-bit-string-op-table"/> can be used. Bit string operands of <literal>&</literal>, <literal>|</literal>, and <literal>#</literal> must be of equal length. When bit shifting, the original length of the string is preserved, as shown @@ -3935,9 +3935,9 @@ cast(-44 as bit(12)) <lineannotation>111111010100</lineannotation> <note> <para> - If you have <xref linkend="guc-standard-conforming-strings"> turned off, + If you have <xref linkend="guc-standard-conforming-strings"/> turned off, any backslashes you write in literal string constants will need to be - doubled. See <xref linkend="sql-syntax-strings"> for more information. + doubled. See <xref linkend="sql-syntax-strings"/> for more information. </para> </note> @@ -4144,7 +4144,7 @@ substring('foobar' from '#"o_b#"%' for '#') <lineannotation>NULL</lineannotat </indexterm> <para> - <xref linkend="functions-posix-table"> lists the available + <xref linkend="functions-posix-table"/> lists the available operators for pattern matching using POSIX regular expressions. </para> @@ -4277,7 +4277,7 @@ substring('foobar' from 'o(.)b') <lineannotation>o</lineannotation> matching, while flag <literal>g</literal> specifies replacement of each matching substring rather than only the first one. Supported flags (though not <literal>g</literal>) are - described in <xref linkend="posix-embedded-options-table">. + described in <xref linkend="posix-embedded-options-table"/>. </para> <para> @@ -4311,7 +4311,7 @@ regexp_replace('foobarbaz', 'b(..)', E'X\\1Y', 'g') The <replaceable>flags</replaceable> parameter is an optional text string containing zero or more single-letter flags that change the function's behavior. Supported flags are described - in <xref linkend="posix-embedded-options-table">. + in <xref linkend="posix-embedded-options-table"/>. </para> <para> @@ -4353,7 +4353,7 @@ SELECT (regexp_match('foobarbequebaz', 'bar.*que'))[1]; subexpressions of the <replaceable>pattern</replaceable>, just as described above for <function>regexp_match</function>. <function>regexp_matches</function> accepts all the flags shown - in <xref linkend="posix-embedded-options-table">, plus + in <xref linkend="posix-embedded-options-table"/>, plus the <literal>g</literal> flag which commands it to return all matches, not just the first one. </para> @@ -4407,7 +4407,7 @@ SELECT col1, (SELECT regexp_matches(col2, '(bar)(beque)')) FROM tab; The <replaceable>flags</replaceable> parameter is an optional text string containing zero or more single-letter flags that change the function's behavior. <function>regexp_split_to_table</function> supports the flags described in - <xref linkend="posix-embedded-options-table">. + <xref linkend="posix-embedded-options-table"/>. </para> <para> @@ -4513,7 +4513,7 @@ SELECT foo FROM regexp_split_to_table('the quick brown fox', E'\\s*') AS foo; <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> always initially presumes that a regular expression follows the ARE rules. However, the more limited ERE or BRE rules can be chosen by prepending an <firstterm>embedded option</firstterm> - to the RE pattern, as described in <xref linkend="posix-metasyntax">. + to the RE pattern, as described in <xref linkend="posix-metasyntax"/>. This can be useful for compatibility with applications that expect exactly the <acronym>POSIX</acronym> 1003.2 rules. </para> @@ -4539,9 +4539,9 @@ SELECT foo FROM regexp_split_to_table('the quick brown fox', E'\\s*') AS foo; Without a quantifier, it matches a match for the atom. With a quantifier, it can match some number of matches of the atom. An <firstterm>atom</firstterm> can be any of the possibilities - shown in <xref linkend="posix-atoms-table">. + shown in <xref linkend="posix-atoms-table"/>. The possible quantifiers and their meanings are shown in - <xref linkend="posix-quantifiers-table">. + <xref linkend="posix-quantifiers-table"/>. </para> <para> @@ -4549,7 +4549,7 @@ SELECT foo FROM regexp_split_to_table('the quick brown fox', E'\\s*') AS foo; specific conditions are met. A constraint can be used where an atom could be used, except it cannot be followed by a quantifier. The simple constraints are shown in - <xref linkend="posix-constraints-table">; + <xref linkend="posix-constraints-table"/>; some more constraints are described later. </para> @@ -4589,7 +4589,7 @@ SELECT foo FROM regexp_split_to_table('the quick brown fox', E'\\s*') AS foo; <entry> <literal>[</literal><replaceable>chars</replaceable><literal>]</literal> </entry> <entry> a <firstterm>bracket expression</firstterm>, matching any one of the <replaceable>chars</replaceable> (see - <xref linkend="posix-bracket-expressions"> for more detail) </entry> + <xref linkend="posix-bracket-expressions"/> for more detail) </entry> </row> <row> @@ -4603,7 +4603,7 @@ SELECT foo FROM regexp_split_to_table('the quick brown fox', E'\\s*') AS foo; <entry> <literal>\</literal><replaceable>c</replaceable> </entry> <entry> where <replaceable>c</replaceable> is alphanumeric (possibly followed by other characters) - is an <firstterm>escape</firstterm>, see <xref linkend="posix-escape-sequences"> + is an <firstterm>escape</firstterm>, see <xref linkend="posix-escape-sequences"/> (AREs only; in EREs and BREs, this matches <replaceable>c</replaceable>) </entry> </row> @@ -4630,9 +4630,9 @@ SELECT foo FROM regexp_split_to_table('the quick brown fox', E'\\s*') AS foo; <note> <para> - If you have <xref linkend="guc-standard-conforming-strings"> turned off, + If you have <xref linkend="guc-standard-conforming-strings"/> turned off, any backslashes you write in literal string constants will need to be - doubled. See <xref linkend="sql-syntax-strings"> for more information. + doubled. See <xref linkend="sql-syntax-strings"/> for more information. </para> </note> @@ -4727,7 +4727,7 @@ SELECT foo FROM regexp_split_to_table('the quick brown fox', E'\\s*') AS foo; same possibilities as their corresponding normal (<firstterm>greedy</firstterm>) counterparts, but prefer the smallest number rather than the largest number of matches. - See <xref linkend="posix-matching-rules"> for more detail. + See <xref linkend="posix-matching-rules"/> for more detail. </para> <note> @@ -4795,7 +4795,7 @@ SELECT foo FROM regexp_split_to_table('the quick brown fox', E'\\s*') AS foo; <para> Lookahead and lookbehind constraints cannot contain <firstterm>back - references</firstterm> (see <xref linkend="posix-escape-sequences">), + references</firstterm> (see <xref linkend="posix-escape-sequences"/>), and all parentheses within them are considered non-capturing. </para> </sect3> @@ -4926,27 +4926,27 @@ SELECT foo FROM regexp_split_to_table('the quick brown fox', E'\\s*') AS foo; <para> <firstterm>Character-entry escapes</firstterm> exist to make it easier to specify non-printing and other inconvenient characters in REs. They are - shown in <xref linkend="posix-character-entry-escapes-table">. + shown in <xref linkend="posix-character-entry-escapes-table"/>. </para> <para> <firstterm>Class-shorthand escapes</firstterm> provide shorthands for certain commonly-used character classes. They are - shown in <xref linkend="posix-class-shorthand-escapes-table">. + shown in <xref linkend="posix-class-shorthand-escapes-table"/>. </para> <para> A <firstterm>constraint escape</firstterm> is a constraint, matching the empty string if specific conditions are met, written as an escape. They are - shown in <xref linkend="posix-constraint-escapes-table">. + shown in <xref linkend="posix-constraint-escapes-table"/>. </para> <para> A <firstterm>back reference</firstterm> (<literal>\</literal><replaceable>n</replaceable>) matches the same string matched by the previous parenthesized subexpression specified by the number <replaceable>n</replaceable> - (see <xref linkend="posix-constraint-backref-table">). For example, + (see <xref linkend="posix-constraint-backref-table"/>). For example, <literal>([bc])\1</literal> matches <literal>bb</literal> or <literal>cc</literal> but not <literal>bc</literal> or <literal>cb</literal>. The subexpression must entirely precede the back reference in the RE. @@ -5167,7 +5167,7 @@ SELECT foo FROM regexp_split_to_table('the quick brown fox', E'\\s*') AS foo; <row> <entry> <literal>\A</literal> </entry> <entry> matches only at the beginning of the string - (see <xref linkend="posix-matching-rules"> for how this differs from + (see <xref linkend="posix-matching-rules"/> for how this differs from <literal>^</literal>) </entry> </row> @@ -5195,7 +5195,7 @@ SELECT foo FROM regexp_split_to_table('the quick brown fox', E'\\s*') AS foo; <row> <entry> <literal>\Z</literal> </entry> <entry> matches only at the end of the string - (see <xref linkend="posix-matching-rules"> for how this differs from + (see <xref linkend="posix-matching-rules"/> for how this differs from <literal>$</literal>) </entry> </row> </tbody> @@ -5284,7 +5284,7 @@ SELECT foo FROM regexp_split_to_table('the quick brown fox', E'\\s*') AS foo; a regex operator, or the <replaceable>flags</replaceable> parameter to a regex function. The available option letters are - shown in <xref linkend="posix-embedded-options-table">. + shown in <xref linkend="posix-embedded-options-table"/>. Note that these same option letters are used in the <replaceable>flags</replaceable> parameters of regex functions. </para> @@ -5319,7 +5319,7 @@ SELECT foo FROM regexp_split_to_table('the quick brown fox', E'\\s*') AS foo; <row> <entry> <literal>i</literal> </entry> <entry> case-insensitive matching (see - <xref linkend="posix-matching-rules">) (overrides operator type) </entry> + <xref linkend="posix-matching-rules"/>) (overrides operator type) </entry> </row> <row> @@ -5330,13 +5330,13 @@ SELECT foo FROM regexp_split_to_table('the quick brown fox', E'\\s*') AS foo; <row> <entry> <literal>n</literal> </entry> <entry> newline-sensitive matching (see - <xref linkend="posix-matching-rules">) </entry> + <xref linkend="posix-matching-rules"/>) </entry> </row> <row> <entry> <literal>p</literal> </entry> <entry> partial newline-sensitive matching (see - <xref linkend="posix-matching-rules">) </entry> + <xref linkend="posix-matching-rules"/>) </entry> </row> <row> @@ -5358,7 +5358,7 @@ SELECT foo FROM regexp_split_to_table('the quick brown fox', E'\\s*') AS foo; <row> <entry> <literal>w</literal> </entry> <entry> inverse partial newline-sensitive (<quote>weird</quote>) matching - (see <xref linkend="posix-matching-rules">) </entry> + (see <xref linkend="posix-matching-rules"/>) </entry> </row> <row> @@ -5735,7 +5735,7 @@ SELECT regexp_match('abc01234xyz', '(?:(.*?)(\d+)(.*)){1,1}'); provide a powerful set of tools for converting various data types (date/time, integer, floating point, numeric) to formatted strings and for converting from formatted strings to specific data types. - <xref linkend="functions-formatting-table"> lists them. + <xref linkend="functions-formatting-table"/> lists them. These functions all follow a common calling convention: the first argument is the value to be formatted and the second argument is a template that defines the output or input format. @@ -5829,7 +5829,7 @@ SELECT regexp_match('abc01234xyz', '(?:(.*?)(\d+)(.*)){1,1}'); <note> <para> There is also a single-argument <function>to_timestamp</function> - function; see <xref linkend="functions-datetime-table">. + function; see <xref linkend="functions-datetime-table"/>. </para> </note> @@ -5857,7 +5857,7 @@ SELECT regexp_match('abc01234xyz', '(?:(.*?)(\d+)(.*)){1,1}'); </para> <para> - <xref linkend="functions-formatting-datetime-table"> shows the + <xref linkend="functions-formatting-datetime-table"/> shows the template patterns available for formatting date and time values. </para> @@ -6087,7 +6087,7 @@ SELECT regexp_match('abc01234xyz', '(?:(.*?)(\d+)(.*)){1,1}'); behavior. For example, <literal>FMMonth</literal> is the <literal>Month</literal> pattern with the <literal>FM</literal> modifier. - <xref linkend="functions-formatting-datetimemod-table"> shows the + <xref linkend="functions-formatting-datetimemod-table"/> shows the modifier patterns for date/time formatting. </para> @@ -6125,7 +6125,7 @@ SELECT regexp_match('abc01234xyz', '(?:(.*?)(\d+)(.*)){1,1}'); <row> <entry><literal>TM</literal> prefix</entry> <entry>translation mode (print localized day and month names based on - <xref linkend="guc-lc-time">)</entry> + <xref linkend="guc-lc-time"/>)</entry> <entry><literal>TMMonth</literal></entry> </row> <row> @@ -6291,7 +6291,7 @@ SELECT regexp_match('abc01234xyz', '(?:(.*?)(\d+)(.*)){1,1}'); specifications like <literal>YYYY-MM-DD (IYYY-IDDD)</literal> can be useful. But avoid writing something like <literal>IYYY-MM-DD</literal>; that would yield surprising results near the start of the year. - (See <xref linkend="functions-datetime-extract"> for more + (See <xref linkend="functions-datetime-extract"/> for more information.) </para> </caution> @@ -6345,7 +6345,7 @@ SELECT regexp_match('abc01234xyz', '(?:(.*?)(\d+)(.*)){1,1}'); </para> <para> - <xref linkend="functions-formatting-numeric-table"> shows the + <xref linkend="functions-formatting-numeric-table"/> shows the template patterns available for formatting numeric values. </para> @@ -6447,8 +6447,8 @@ SELECT regexp_match('abc01234xyz', '(?:(.*?)(\d+)(.*)){1,1}'); The pattern characters <literal>S</literal>, <literal>L</literal>, <literal>D</literal>, and <literal>G</literal> represent the sign, currency symbol, decimal point, and thousands separator characters defined by the current locale - (see <xref linkend="guc-lc-monetary"> - and <xref linkend="guc-lc-numeric">). The pattern characters period + (see <xref linkend="guc-lc-monetary"/> + and <xref linkend="guc-lc-numeric"/>). The pattern characters period and comma represent those exact characters, with the meanings of decimal point and thousands separator, regardless of locale. </para> @@ -6535,7 +6535,7 @@ SELECT regexp_match('abc01234xyz', '(?:(.*?)(\d+)(.*)){1,1}'); behavior. For example, <literal>FM99.99</literal> is the <literal>99.99</literal> pattern with the <literal>FM</literal> modifier. - <xref linkend="functions-formatting-numericmod-table"> shows the + <xref linkend="functions-formatting-numericmod-table"/> shows the modifier patterns for numeric formatting. </para> @@ -6570,7 +6570,7 @@ SELECT regexp_match('abc01234xyz', '(?:(.*?)(\d+)(.*)){1,1}'); </table> <para> - <xref linkend="functions-formatting-examples-table"> shows some + <xref linkend="functions-formatting-examples-table"/> shows some examples of the use of the <function>to_char</function> function. </para> @@ -6747,15 +6747,15 @@ SELECT regexp_match('abc01234xyz', '(?:(.*?)(\d+)(.*)){1,1}'); <title>Date/Time Functions and Operators</title> <para> - <xref linkend="functions-datetime-table"> shows the available + <xref linkend="functions-datetime-table"/> shows the available functions for date/time value processing, with details appearing in the following subsections. <xref - linkend="operators-datetime-table"> illustrates the behaviors of + linkend="operators-datetime-table"/> illustrates the behaviors of the basic arithmetic operators (<literal>+</literal>, <literal>*</literal>, etc.). For formatting functions, refer to - <xref linkend="functions-formatting">. You should be familiar with + <xref linkend="functions-formatting"/>. You should be familiar with the background information on date/time data types from <xref - linkend="datatype-datetime">. + linkend="datatype-datetime"/>. </para> <para> @@ -6943,7 +6943,7 @@ SELECT regexp_match('abc01234xyz', '(?:(.*?)(\d+)(.*)){1,1}'); </entry> <entry><type>timestamp with time zone</type></entry> <entry>Current date and time (changes during statement execution); - see <xref linkend="functions-datetime-current"> + see <xref linkend="functions-datetime-current"/> </entry> <entry></entry> <entry></entry> @@ -6958,7 +6958,7 @@ SELECT regexp_match('abc01234xyz', '(?:(.*?)(\d+)(.*)){1,1}'); </entry> <entry><type>date</type></entry> <entry>Current date; - see <xref linkend="functions-datetime-current"> + see <xref linkend="functions-datetime-current"/> </entry> <entry></entry> <entry></entry> @@ -6973,7 +6973,7 @@ SELECT regexp_match('abc01234xyz', '(?:(.*?)(\d+)(.*)){1,1}'); </entry> <entry><type>time with time zone</type></entry> <entry>Current time of day; - see <xref linkend="functions-datetime-current"> + see <xref linkend="functions-datetime-current"/> </entry> <entry></entry> <entry></entry> @@ -6988,7 +6988,7 @@ SELECT regexp_match('abc01234xyz', '(?:(.*?)(\d+)(.*)){1,1}'); </entry> <entry><type>timestamp with time zone</type></entry> <entry>Current date and time (start of current transaction); - see <xref linkend="functions-datetime-current"> + see <xref linkend="functions-datetime-current"/> </entry> <entry></entry> <entry></entry> @@ -7003,7 +7003,7 @@ SELECT regexp_match('abc01234xyz', '(?:(.*?)(\d+)(.*)){1,1}'); </entry> <entry><type>double precision</type></entry> <entry>Get subfield (equivalent to <function>extract</function>); - see <xref linkend="functions-datetime-extract"> + see <xref linkend="functions-datetime-extract"/> </entry> <entry><literal>date_part('hour', timestamp '2001-02-16 20:38:40')</literal></entry> <entry><literal>20</literal></entry> @@ -7013,7 +7013,7 @@ SELECT regexp_match('abc01234xyz', '(?:(.*?)(\d+)(.*)){1,1}'); <entry><literal><function>date_part(<type>text</type>, <type>interval</type>)</function></literal></entry> <entry><type>double precision</type></entry> <entry>Get subfield (equivalent to - <function>extract</function>); see <xref linkend="functions-datetime-extract"> + <function>extract</function>); see <xref linkend="functions-datetime-extract"/> </entry> <entry><literal>date_part('month', interval '2 years 3 months')</literal></entry> <entry><literal>3</literal></entry> @@ -7027,7 +7027,7 @@ SELECT regexp_match('abc01234xyz', '(?:(.*?)(\d+)(.*)){1,1}'); <literal><function>date_trunc(<type>text</type>, <type>timestamp</type>)</function></literal> </entry> <entry><type>timestamp</type></entry> - <entry>Truncate to specified precision; see also <xref linkend="functions-datetime-trunc"> + <entry>Truncate to specified precision; see also <xref linkend="functions-datetime-trunc"/> </entry> <entry><literal>date_trunc('hour', timestamp '2001-02-16 20:38:40')</literal></entry> <entry><literal>2001-02-16 20:00:00</literal></entry> @@ -7036,7 +7036,7 @@ SELECT regexp_match('abc01234xyz', '(?:(.*?)(\d+)(.*)){1,1}'); <row> <entry><literal><function>date_trunc(<type>text</type>, <type>interval</type>)</function></literal></entry> <entry><type>interval</type></entry> - <entry>Truncate to specified precision; see also <xref linkend="functions-datetime-trunc"> + <entry>Truncate to specified precision; see also <xref linkend="functions-datetime-trunc"/> </entry> <entry><literal>date_trunc('hour', interval '2 days 3 hours 40 minutes')</literal></entry> <entry><literal>2 days 03:00:00</literal></entry> @@ -7051,7 +7051,7 @@ SELECT regexp_match('abc01234xyz', '(?:(.*?)(\d+)(.*)){1,1}'); <type>timestamp</type>)</literal> </entry> <entry><type>double precision</type></entry> - <entry>Get subfield; see <xref linkend="functions-datetime-extract"> + <entry>Get subfield; see <xref linkend="functions-datetime-extract"/> </entry> <entry><literal>extract(hour from timestamp '2001-02-16 20:38:40')</literal></entry> <entry><literal>20</literal></entry> @@ -7061,7 +7061,7 @@ SELECT regexp_match('abc01234xyz', '(?:(.*?)(\d+)(.*)){1,1}'); <entry><literal><function>extract</function>(<parameter>field</parameter> from <type>interval</type>)</literal></entry> <entry><type>double precision</type></entry> - <entry>Get subfield; see <xref linkend="functions-datetime-extract"> + <entry>Get subfield; see <xref linkend="functions-datetime-extract"/> </entry> <entry><literal>extract(month from interval '2 years 3 months')</literal></entry> <entry><literal>3</literal></entry> @@ -7144,7 +7144,7 @@ SELECT regexp_match('abc01234xyz', '(?:(.*?)(\d+)(.*)){1,1}'); </entry> <entry><type>time</type></entry> <entry>Current time of day; - see <xref linkend="functions-datetime-current"> + see <xref linkend="functions-datetime-current"/> </entry> <entry></entry> <entry></entry> @@ -7159,7 +7159,7 @@ SELECT regexp_match('abc01234xyz', '(?:(.*?)(\d+)(.*)){1,1}'); </entry> <entry><type>timestamp</type></entry> <entry>Current date and time (start of current transaction); - see <xref linkend="functions-datetime-current"> + see <xref linkend="functions-datetime-current"/> </entry> <entry></entry> <entry></entry> @@ -7293,7 +7293,7 @@ SELECT regexp_match('abc01234xyz', '(?:(.*?)(\d+)(.*)){1,1}'); </entry> <entry><type>timestamp with time zone</type></entry> <entry>Current date and time (start of current transaction); - see <xref linkend="functions-datetime-current"> + see <xref linkend="functions-datetime-current"/> </entry> <entry></entry> <entry></entry> @@ -7308,7 +7308,7 @@ SELECT regexp_match('abc01234xyz', '(?:(.*?)(\d+)(.*)){1,1}'); </entry> <entry><type>timestamp with time zone</type></entry> <entry>Current date and time (start of current statement); - see <xref linkend="functions-datetime-current"> + see <xref linkend="functions-datetime-current"/> </entry> <entry></entry> <entry></entry> @@ -7324,7 +7324,7 @@ SELECT regexp_match('abc01234xyz', '(?:(.*?)(\d+)(.*)){1,1}'); <entry><type>text</type></entry> <entry>Current date and time (like <function>clock_timestamp</function>, but as a <type>text</type> string); - see <xref linkend="functions-datetime-current"> + see <xref linkend="functions-datetime-current"/> </entry> <entry></entry> <entry></entry> @@ -7339,7 +7339,7 @@ SELECT regexp_match('abc01234xyz', '(?:(.*?)(\d+)(.*)){1,1}'); </entry> <entry><type>timestamp with time zone</type></entry> <entry>Current date and time (start of current transaction); - see <xref linkend="functions-datetime-current"> + see <xref linkend="functions-datetime-current"/> </entry> <entry></entry> <entry></entry> @@ -7886,7 +7886,7 @@ SELECT EXTRACT(YEAR FROM TIMESTAMP '2001-02-16 20:38:40'); <para> The <function>extract</function> function is primarily intended for computational processing. For formatting date/time values for - display, see <xref linkend="functions-formatting">. + display, see <xref linkend="functions-formatting"/>. </para> <para> @@ -7986,7 +7986,7 @@ SELECT date_trunc('year', TIMESTAMP '2001-02-16 20:38:40'); <para> The <literal>AT TIME ZONE</literal> construct allows conversions of time stamps to different time zones. <xref - linkend="functions-datetime-zoneconvert-table"> shows its + linkend="functions-datetime-zoneconvert-table"/> shows its variants. </para> @@ -8035,7 +8035,7 @@ SELECT date_trunc('year', TIMESTAMP '2001-02-16 20:38:40'); specified either as a text string (e.g., <literal>'PST'</literal>) or as an interval (e.g., <literal>INTERVAL '-08:00'</literal>). In the text case, a time zone name can be specified in any of the ways - described in <xref linkend="datatype-timezones">. + described in <xref linkend="datatype-timezones"/>. </para> <para> @@ -8279,10 +8279,10 @@ SELECT pg_sleep_until('tomorrow 03:00'); <title>Enum Support Functions</title> <para> - For enum types (described in <xref linkend="datatype-enum">), + For enum types (described in <xref linkend="datatype-enum"/>), there are several functions that allow cleaner programming without hard-coding particular values of an enum type. - These are listed in <xref linkend="functions-enum-table">. The examples + These are listed in <xref linkend="functions-enum-table"/>. The examples assume an enum type created as: <programlisting> @@ -8379,9 +8379,9 @@ CREATE TYPE rainbow AS ENUM ('red', 'orange', 'yellow', 'green', 'blue', 'purple <type>lseg</type>, <type>line</type>, <type>path</type>, <type>polygon</type>, and <type>circle</type> have a large set of native support functions and operators, shown in <xref - linkend="functions-geometry-op-table">, <xref - linkend="functions-geometry-func-table">, and <xref - linkend="functions-geometry-conv-table">. + linkend="functions-geometry-op-table"/>, <xref + linkend="functions-geometry-func-table"/>, and <xref + linkend="functions-geometry-conv-table"/>. </para> <caution> @@ -8912,7 +8912,7 @@ CREATE TYPE rainbow AS ENUM ('red', 'orange', 'yellow', 'green', 'blue', 'purple <title>Network Address Functions and Operators</title> <para> - <xref linkend="cidr-inet-operators-table"> shows the operators + <xref linkend="cidr-inet-operators-table"/> shows the operators available for the <type>cidr</type> and <type>inet</type> types. The operators <literal><<</literal>, <literal><<=</literal>, <literal>>></literal>, @@ -9024,7 +9024,7 @@ CREATE TYPE rainbow AS ENUM ('red', 'orange', 'yellow', 'green', 'blue', 'purple </table> <para> - <xref linkend="cidr-inet-functions-table"> shows the functions + <xref linkend="cidr-inet-functions-table"/> shows the functions available for use with the <type>cidr</type> and <type>inet</type> types. The <function>abbrev</function>, <function>host</function>, and <function>text</function> @@ -9225,7 +9225,7 @@ CREATE TYPE rainbow AS ENUM ('red', 'orange', 'yellow', 'green', 'blue', 'purple </para> <para> - <xref linkend="macaddr-functions-table"> shows the functions + <xref linkend="macaddr-functions-table"/> shows the functions available for use with the <type>macaddr</type> type. The function <literal><function>trunc(<type>macaddr</type>)</function></literal> returns a MAC address with the last 3 bytes set to zero. This can be used to @@ -9270,7 +9270,7 @@ CREATE TYPE rainbow AS ENUM ('red', 'orange', 'yellow', 'green', 'blue', 'purple </para> <para> - <xref linkend="macaddr8-functions-table"> shows the functions + <xref linkend="macaddr8-functions-table"/> shows the functions available for use with the <type>macaddr8</type> type. The function <literal><function>trunc(<type>macaddr8</type>)</function></literal> returns a MAC address with the last 5 bytes set to zero. This can be used to @@ -9342,11 +9342,11 @@ CREATE TYPE rainbow AS ENUM ('red', 'orange', 'yellow', 'green', 'blue', 'purple </indexterm> <para> - <xref linkend="textsearch-operators-table">, - <xref linkend="textsearch-functions-table"> and - <xref linkend="textsearch-functions-debug-table"> + <xref linkend="textsearch-operators-table"/>, + <xref linkend="textsearch-functions-table"/> and + <xref linkend="textsearch-functions-debug-table"/> summarize the functions and operators that are provided - for full text searching. See <xref linkend="textsearch"> for a detailed + for full text searching. See <xref linkend="textsearch"/> for a detailed explanation of <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>'s text search facility. </para> @@ -9797,14 +9797,14 @@ CREATE TYPE rainbow AS ENUM ('red', 'orange', 'yellow', 'green', 'blue', 'purple <para> All the text search functions that accept an optional <type>regconfig</type> argument will use the configuration specified by - <xref linkend="guc-default-text-search-config"> + <xref linkend="guc-default-text-search-config"/> when that argument is omitted. </para> </note> <para> The functions in - <xref linkend="textsearch-functions-debug-table"> + <xref linkend="textsearch-functions-debug-table"/> are listed separately because they are not usually used in everyday text searching operations. They are helpful for development and debugging of new text search configurations. @@ -9910,7 +9910,7 @@ CREATE TYPE rainbow AS ENUM ('red', 'orange', 'yellow', 'green', 'blue', 'purple <para> The functions and function-like expressions described in this section operate on values of type <type>xml</type>. Check <xref - linkend="datatype-xml"> for information about the <type>xml</type> + linkend="datatype-xml"/> for information about the <type>xml</type> type. The function-like expressions <function>xmlparse</function> and <function>xmlserialize</function> for converting to and from type <type>xml</type> are not repeated here. Use of most of these @@ -10107,7 +10107,7 @@ SELECT xmlelement(name foo, xmlattributes('xyz' as bar), and & will be converted to entities. Binary data (data type <type>bytea</type>) will be represented in base64 or hex encoding, depending on the setting of the configuration parameter - <xref linkend="guc-xmlbinary">. The particular behavior for + <xref linkend="guc-xmlbinary"/>. The particular behavior for individual data types is expected to evolve in order to align the SQL and PostgreSQL data types with the XML Schema specification, at which point a more precise description will appear. @@ -10249,7 +10249,7 @@ SELECT xmlroot(xmlparse(document '<?xml version="1.1"?><content>abc</content>'), input values to the aggregate function call, much like <function>xmlconcat</function> does, except that concatenation occurs across rows rather than across expressions in a single row. - See <xref linkend="functions-aggregate"> for additional information + See <xref linkend="functions-aggregate"/> for additional information about aggregate functions. </para> @@ -10269,7 +10269,7 @@ SELECT xmlagg(x) FROM test; <para> To determine the order of the concatenation, an <literal>ORDER BY</literal> clause may be added to the aggregate call as described in - <xref linkend="syntax-aggregates">. For example: + <xref linkend="syntax-aggregates"/>. For example: <screen><![CDATA[ SELECT xmlagg(x ORDER BY y DESC) FROM test; @@ -10317,7 +10317,7 @@ SELECT xmlagg(x) FROM (SELECT * FROM test ORDER BY y DESC) AS tab; The expression <literal>IS DOCUMENT</literal> returns true if the argument XML value is a proper XML document, false if it is not (that is, it is a content fragment), or null if the argument is - null. See <xref linkend="datatype-xml"> about the difference + null. See <xref linkend="datatype-xml"/> about the difference between documents and content fragments. </para> </sect3> @@ -10391,7 +10391,7 @@ SELECT xmlexists('//town[text() = ''Toronto'']' PASSING BY REF '<towns><town>Tor <function>xml_is_well_formed_document</function> checks for a well-formed document, while <function>xml_is_well_formed_content</function> checks for well-formed content. <function>xml_is_well_formed</function> does - the former if the <xref linkend="guc-xmloption"> configuration + the former if the <xref linkend="guc-xmloption"/> configuration parameter is set to <literal>DOCUMENT</literal>, or the latter if it is set to <literal>CONTENT</literal>. This means that <function>xml_is_well_formed</function> is useful for seeing whether @@ -10975,7 +10975,7 @@ table2-mapping <para> As an example of using the output produced by these functions, - <xref linkend="xslt-xml-html"> shows an XSLT stylesheet that + <xref linkend="xslt-xml-html"/> shows an XSLT stylesheet that converts the output of <function>table_to_xml_and_xmlschema</function> to an HTML document containing a tabular rendition of the table data. In a @@ -11044,9 +11044,9 @@ table2-mapping </indexterm> <para> - <xref linkend="functions-json-op-table"> shows the operators that + <xref linkend="functions-json-op-table"/> shows the operators that are available for use with the two JSON data types (see <xref - linkend="datatype-json">). + linkend="datatype-json"/>). </para> <table id="functions-json-op-table"> @@ -11127,18 +11127,18 @@ table2-mapping </note> <para> The standard comparison operators shown in <xref - linkend="functions-comparison-op-table"> are available for + linkend="functions-comparison-op-table"/> are available for <type>jsonb</type>, but not for <type>json</type>. They follow the ordering rules for B-tree operations outlined at <xref - linkend="json-indexing">. + linkend="json-indexing"/>. </para> <para> Some further operators also exist only for <type>jsonb</type>, as shown - in <xref linkend="functions-jsonb-op-table">. + in <xref linkend="functions-jsonb-op-table"/>. Many of these operators can be indexed by <type>jsonb</type> operator classes. For a full description of <type>jsonb</type> containment and existence semantics, see <xref - linkend="json-containment">. <xref linkend="json-indexing"> + linkend="json-containment"/>. <xref linkend="json-indexing"/> describes how these operators can be used to effectively index <type>jsonb</type> data. </para> @@ -11240,7 +11240,7 @@ table2-mapping </note> <para> - <xref linkend="functions-json-creation-table"> shows the functions that are + <xref linkend="functions-json-creation-table"/> shows the functions that are available for creating <type>json</type> and <type>jsonb</type> values. (There are no equivalent functions for <type>jsonb</type>, of the <literal>row_to_json</literal> and <literal>array_to_json</literal> functions. However, the <literal>to_jsonb</literal> @@ -11394,7 +11394,7 @@ table2-mapping <note> <para> - The <xref linkend="hstore"> extension has a cast + The <xref linkend="hstore"/> extension has a cast from <type>hstore</type> to <type>json</type>, so that <type>hstore</type> values converted via the JSON creation functions will be represented as JSON objects, not as primitive string values. @@ -11402,7 +11402,7 @@ table2-mapping </note> <para> - <xref linkend="functions-json-processing-table"> shows the functions that + <xref linkend="functions-json-processing-table"/> shows the functions that are available for processing <type>json</type> and <type>jsonb</type> values. </para> @@ -11843,7 +11843,7 @@ table2-mapping JSON strings to the appropriate single character. This is a non-issue if the input is type <type>jsonb</type>, because the conversion was already done; but for <type>json</type> input, this may result in throwing an error, - as noted in <xref linkend="datatype-json">. + as noted in <xref linkend="datatype-json"/>. </para> </note> @@ -11902,7 +11902,7 @@ table2-mapping </note> <para> - See also <xref linkend="functions-aggregate"> for the aggregate + See also <xref linkend="functions-aggregate"/> for the aggregate function <function>json_agg</function> which aggregates record values as JSON, and the aggregate function <function>json_object_agg</function> which aggregates pairs of values @@ -11935,10 +11935,10 @@ table2-mapping This section describes functions for operating on <firstterm>sequence objects</firstterm>, also called sequence generators or just sequences. Sequence objects are special single-row tables created with <xref - linkend="sql-createsequence">. + linkend="sql-createsequence"/>. Sequence objects are commonly used to generate unique identifiers for rows of a table. The sequence functions, listed in <xref - linkend="functions-sequence-table">, provide simple, multiuser-safe + linkend="functions-sequence-table"/>, provide simple, multiuser-safe methods for obtaining successive sequence values from sequence objects. </para> @@ -12003,7 +12003,7 @@ nextval('myschema.foo') <lineannotation>operates on <literal>myschema.foo</l nextval('"myschema".foo') <lineannotation>same as above</lineannotation> nextval('foo') <lineannotation>searches search path for <literal>foo</literal></lineannotation> </programlisting> - See <xref linkend="datatype-oid"> for more information about + See <xref linkend="datatype-oid"/> for more information about <type>regclass</type>. </para> @@ -12061,7 +12061,7 @@ nextval('foo'::text) <lineannotation><literal>foo</literal> is looked up at If a sequence object has been created with default parameters, successive <function>nextval</function> calls will return successive values beginning with 1. Other behaviors can be obtained by using - special parameters in the <xref linkend="sql-createsequence"> command; + special parameters in the <xref linkend="sql-createsequence"/> command; see its command reference page for more information. </para> @@ -12262,7 +12262,7 @@ SELECT a, <para> The data types of all the <replaceable>result</replaceable> expressions must be convertible to a single output type. - See <xref linkend="typeconv-union-case"> for more details. + See <xref linkend="typeconv-union-case"/> for more details. </para> <para> @@ -12316,7 +12316,7 @@ SELECT ... WHERE CASE WHEN x <> 0 THEN y/x > 1.5 ELSE false END; <note> <para> - As described in <xref linkend="syntax-express-eval">, there are various + As described in <xref linkend="syntax-express-eval"/>, there are various situations in which subexpressions of an expression are evaluated at different times, so that the principle that <quote><token>CASE</token> evaluates only necessary subexpressions</quote> is not ironclad. For @@ -12419,7 +12419,7 @@ SELECT NULLIF(value, '(none)') ... largest or smallest value from a list of any number of expressions. The expressions must all be convertible to a common data type, which will be the type of the result - (see <xref linkend="typeconv-union-case"> for details). NULL values + (see <xref linkend="typeconv-union-case"/> for details). NULL values in the list are ignored. The result will be NULL only if all the expressions evaluate to NULL. </para> @@ -12437,7 +12437,7 @@ SELECT NULLIF(value, '(none)') ... <title>Array Functions and Operators</title> <para> - <xref linkend="array-operators-table"> shows the operators + <xref linkend="array-operators-table"/> shows the operators available for array types. </para> @@ -12561,14 +12561,14 @@ SELECT NULLIF(value, '(none)') ... </para> <para> - See <xref linkend="arrays"> for more details about array operator - behavior. See <xref linkend="indexes-types"> for more details about + See <xref linkend="arrays"/> for more details about array operator + behavior. See <xref linkend="indexes-types"/> for more details about which operators support indexed operations. </para> <para> - <xref linkend="array-functions-table"> shows the functions - available for use with array types. See <xref linkend="arrays"> + <xref linkend="array-functions-table"/> shows the functions + available for use with array types. See <xref linkend="arrays"/> for more information and examples of the use of these functions. </para> @@ -12843,7 +12843,7 @@ SELECT NULLIF(value, '(none)') ... <entry><type>setof anyelement, anyelement [, ...]</type></entry> <entry>expand multiple arrays (possibly of different types) to a set of rows. This is only allowed in the FROM clause; see - <xref linkend="queries-tablefunctions"></entry> + <xref linkend="queries-tablefunctions"/></entry> <entry><literal>unnest(ARRAY[1,2],ARRAY['foo','bar','baz'])</literal></entry> <entry><literallayout class="monospaced">1 foo 2 bar @@ -12899,7 +12899,7 @@ NULL baz</literallayout>(3 rows)</entry> </note> <para> - See also <xref linkend="functions-aggregate"> about the aggregate + See also <xref linkend="functions-aggregate"/> about the aggregate function <function>array_agg</function> for use with arrays. </para> </sect1> @@ -12908,11 +12908,11 @@ NULL baz</literallayout>(3 rows)</entry> <title>Range Functions and Operators</title> <para> - See <xref linkend="rangetypes"> for an overview of range types. + See <xref linkend="rangetypes"/> for an overview of range types. </para> <para> - <xref linkend="range-operators-table"> shows the operators + <xref linkend="range-operators-table"/> shows the operators available for range types. </para> @@ -13087,7 +13087,7 @@ NULL baz</literallayout>(3 rows)</entry> </para> <para> - <xref linkend="range-functions-table"> shows the functions + <xref linkend="range-functions-table"/> shows the functions available for use with range types. </para> @@ -13238,18 +13238,18 @@ NULL baz</literallayout>(3 rows)</entry> <para> <firstterm>Aggregate functions</firstterm> compute a single result from a set of input values. The built-in general-purpose aggregate - functions are listed in <xref linkend="functions-aggregate-table"> + functions are listed in <xref linkend="functions-aggregate-table"/> and statistical aggregates in <xref - linkend="functions-aggregate-statistics-table">. + linkend="functions-aggregate-statistics-table"/>. The built-in within-group ordered-set aggregate functions - are listed in <xref linkend="functions-orderedset-table"> + are listed in <xref linkend="functions-orderedset-table"/> while the built-in within-group hypothetical-set ones are in <xref - linkend="functions-hypothetical-table">. Grouping operations, + linkend="functions-hypothetical-table"/>. Grouping operations, which are closely related to aggregate functions, are listed in - <xref linkend="functions-grouping-table">. + <xref linkend="functions-grouping-table"/>. The special syntax considerations for aggregate - functions are explained in <xref linkend="syntax-aggregates">. - Consult <xref linkend="tutorial-agg"> for additional introductory + functions are explained in <xref linkend="syntax-aggregates"/>. + Consult <xref linkend="tutorial-agg"/> for additional introductory information. </para> @@ -13597,7 +13597,7 @@ NULL baz</literallayout>(3 rows)</entry> <type>xml</type> </entry> <entry>No</entry> - <entry>concatenation of XML values (see also <xref linkend="functions-xml-xmlagg">)</entry> + <entry>concatenation of XML values (see also <xref linkend="functions-xml-xmlagg"/>)</entry> </row> </tbody> </tgroup> @@ -13669,7 +13669,7 @@ SELECT count(*) FROM sometable; depending on the order of the input values. This ordering is unspecified by default, but can be controlled by writing an <literal>ORDER BY</literal> clause within the aggregate call, as shown in - <xref linkend="syntax-aggregates">. + <xref linkend="syntax-aggregates"/>. Alternatively, supplying the input values from a sorted subquery will usually work. For example: @@ -13683,7 +13683,7 @@ SELECT xmlagg(x) FROM (SELECT x FROM test ORDER BY y DESC) AS tab; </para> <para> - <xref linkend="functions-aggregate-statistics-table"> shows + <xref linkend="functions-aggregate-statistics-table"/> shows aggregate functions typically used in statistical analysis. (These are separated out merely to avoid cluttering the listing of more-commonly-used aggregates.) Where the description mentions @@ -14102,7 +14102,7 @@ SELECT xmlagg(x) FROM (SELECT x FROM test ORDER BY y DESC) AS tab; </table> <para> - <xref linkend="functions-orderedset-table"> shows some + <xref linkend="functions-orderedset-table"/> shows some aggregate functions that use the <firstterm>ordered-set aggregate</firstterm> syntax. These functions are sometimes referred to as <quote>inverse distribution</quote> functions. @@ -14252,7 +14252,7 @@ SELECT xmlagg(x) FROM (SELECT x FROM test ORDER BY y DESC) AS tab; </table> <para> - All the aggregates listed in <xref linkend="functions-orderedset-table"> + All the aggregates listed in <xref linkend="functions-orderedset-table"/> ignore null values in their sorted input. For those that take a <replaceable>fraction</replaceable> parameter, the fraction value must be between 0 and 1; an error is thrown if not. However, a null fraction value @@ -14266,9 +14266,9 @@ SELECT xmlagg(x) FROM (SELECT x FROM test ORDER BY y DESC) AS tab; <para> Each of the aggregates listed in - <xref linkend="functions-hypothetical-table"> is associated with a + <xref linkend="functions-hypothetical-table"/> is associated with a window function of the same name defined in - <xref linkend="functions-window">. In each case, the aggregate result + <xref linkend="functions-window"/>. In each case, the aggregate result is the value that the associated window function would have returned for the <quote>hypothetical</quote> row constructed from <replaceable>args</replaceable>, if such a row had been added to the sorted @@ -14433,7 +14433,7 @@ SELECT xmlagg(x) FROM (SELECT x FROM test ORDER BY y DESC) AS tab; <para> Grouping operations are used in conjunction with grouping sets (see - <xref linkend="queries-grouping-sets">) to distinguish result rows. The + <xref linkend="queries-grouping-sets"/>) to distinguish result rows. The arguments to the <literal>GROUPING</literal> operation are not actually evaluated, but they must match exactly expressions given in the <literal>GROUP BY</literal> clause of the associated query level. Bits are assigned with the rightmost @@ -14477,14 +14477,14 @@ SELECT xmlagg(x) FROM (SELECT x FROM test ORDER BY y DESC) AS tab; <para> <firstterm>Window functions</firstterm> provide the ability to perform calculations across sets of rows that are related to the current query - row. See <xref linkend="tutorial-window"> for an introduction to this - feature, and <xref linkend="syntax-window-functions"> for syntax + row. See <xref linkend="tutorial-window"/> for an introduction to this + feature, and <xref linkend="syntax-window-functions"/> for syntax details. </para> <para> The built-in window functions are listed in - <xref linkend="functions-window-table">. Note that these functions + <xref linkend="functions-window-table"/>. Note that these functions <emphasis>must</emphasis> be invoked using window function syntax, i.e., an <literal>OVER</literal> clause is required. </para> @@ -14494,7 +14494,7 @@ SELECT xmlagg(x) FROM (SELECT x FROM test ORDER BY y DESC) AS tab; general-purpose or statistical aggregate (i.e., not ordered-set or hypothetical-set aggregates) can be used as a window function; see - <xref linkend="functions-aggregate"> for a list of the built-in aggregates. + <xref linkend="functions-aggregate"/> for a list of the built-in aggregates. Aggregate functions act as window functions only when an <literal>OVER</literal> clause follows the call; otherwise they act as non-window aggregates and return a single row for the entire set. @@ -14706,7 +14706,7 @@ SELECT xmlagg(x) FROM (SELECT x FROM test ORDER BY y DESC) AS tab; <para> All of the functions listed in - <xref linkend="functions-window-table"> depend on the sort ordering + <xref linkend="functions-window-table"/> depend on the sort ordering specified by the <literal>ORDER BY</literal> clause of the associated window definition. Rows that are not distinct when considering only the <literal>ORDER BY</literal> columns are said to be <firstterm>peers</firstterm>. @@ -14723,7 +14723,7 @@ SELECT xmlagg(x) FROM (SELECT x FROM test ORDER BY y DESC) AS tab; sometimes also <function>nth_value</function>. You can redefine the frame by adding a suitable frame specification (<literal>RANGE</literal> or <literal>ROWS</literal>) to the <literal>OVER</literal> clause. - See <xref linkend="syntax-window-functions"> for more information + See <xref linkend="syntax-window-functions"/> for more information about frame specifications. </para> @@ -14887,7 +14887,7 @@ WHERE EXISTS (SELECT 1 FROM tab2 WHERE col2 = tab1.col2); <para> The left-hand side of this form of <token>IN</token> is a row constructor, - as described in <xref linkend="sql-syntax-row-constructors">. + as described in <xref linkend="sql-syntax-row-constructors"/>. The right-hand side is a parenthesized subquery, which must return exactly as many columns as there are expressions in the left-hand row. The left-hand expressions are @@ -14943,7 +14943,7 @@ WHERE EXISTS (SELECT 1 FROM tab2 WHERE col2 = tab1.col2); <para> The left-hand side of this form of <token>NOT IN</token> is a row constructor, - as described in <xref linkend="sql-syntax-row-constructors">. + as described in <xref linkend="sql-syntax-row-constructors"/>. The right-hand side is a parenthesized subquery, which must return exactly as many columns as there are expressions in the left-hand row. The left-hand expressions are @@ -15008,7 +15008,7 @@ WHERE EXISTS (SELECT 1 FROM tab2 WHERE col2 = tab1.col2); <para> The left-hand side of this form of <token>ANY</token> is a row constructor, - as described in <xref linkend="sql-syntax-row-constructors">. + as described in <xref linkend="sql-syntax-row-constructors"/>. The right-hand side is a parenthesized subquery, which must return exactly as many columns as there are expressions in the left-hand row. The left-hand expressions are @@ -15024,7 +15024,7 @@ WHERE EXISTS (SELECT 1 FROM tab2 WHERE col2 = tab1.col2); </para> <para> - See <xref linkend="row-wise-comparison"> for details about the meaning + See <xref linkend="row-wise-comparison"/> for details about the meaning of a row constructor comparison. </para> </sect2> @@ -15064,7 +15064,7 @@ WHERE EXISTS (SELECT 1 FROM tab2 WHERE col2 = tab1.col2); <para> The left-hand side of this form of <token>ALL</token> is a row constructor, - as described in <xref linkend="sql-syntax-row-constructors">. + as described in <xref linkend="sql-syntax-row-constructors"/>. The right-hand side is a parenthesized subquery, which must return exactly as many columns as there are expressions in the left-hand row. The left-hand expressions are @@ -15080,7 +15080,7 @@ WHERE EXISTS (SELECT 1 FROM tab2 WHERE col2 = tab1.col2); </para> <para> - See <xref linkend="row-wise-comparison"> for details about the meaning + See <xref linkend="row-wise-comparison"/> for details about the meaning of a row constructor comparison. </para> </sect2> @@ -15099,7 +15099,7 @@ WHERE EXISTS (SELECT 1 FROM tab2 WHERE col2 = tab1.col2); <para> The left-hand side is a row constructor, - as described in <xref linkend="sql-syntax-row-constructors">. + as described in <xref linkend="sql-syntax-row-constructors"/>. The right-hand side is a parenthesized subquery, which must return exactly as many columns as there are expressions in the left-hand row. Furthermore, the subquery cannot return more than one row. (If it returns zero rows, @@ -15108,7 +15108,7 @@ WHERE EXISTS (SELECT 1 FROM tab2 WHERE col2 = tab1.col2); </para> <para> - See <xref linkend="row-wise-comparison"> for details about the meaning + See <xref linkend="row-wise-comparison"/> for details about the meaning of a row constructor comparison. </para> </sect2> @@ -15327,7 +15327,7 @@ AND <para> Each side is a row constructor, - as described in <xref linkend="sql-syntax-row-constructors">. + as described in <xref linkend="sql-syntax-row-constructors"/>. The two row values must have the same number of fields. Each side is evaluated and they are compared row-wise. Row constructor comparisons are allowed when the <replaceable>operator</replaceable> is @@ -15419,8 +15419,8 @@ AND result depends on comparing two NULL values or a NULL and a non-NULL. <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> does this only when comparing the results of two row constructors (as in - <xref linkend="row-wise-comparison">) or comparing a row constructor - to the output of a subquery (as in <xref linkend="functions-subquery">). + <xref linkend="row-wise-comparison"/>) or comparing a row constructor + to the output of a subquery (as in <xref linkend="functions-subquery"/>). In other contexts where two composite-type values are compared, two NULL field values are considered equal, and a NULL is considered larger than a non-NULL. This is necessary in order to have consistent sorting @@ -15441,7 +15441,7 @@ AND class, or is the negator of the <literal>=</literal> member of a B-tree operator class.) The default behavior of the above operators is the same as for <literal>IS [ NOT ] DISTINCT FROM</literal> for row constructors (see - <xref linkend="row-wise-comparison">). + <xref linkend="row-wise-comparison"/>). </para> <para> @@ -15481,10 +15481,10 @@ AND <para> This section describes functions that possibly return more than one row. The most widely used functions in this class are series generating - functions, as detailed in <xref linkend="functions-srf-series"> and - <xref linkend="functions-srf-subscripts">. Other, more specialized + functions, as detailed in <xref linkend="functions-srf-series"/> and + <xref linkend="functions-srf-subscripts"/>. Other, more specialized set-returning functions are described elsewhere in this manual. - See <xref linkend="queries-tablefunctions"> for ways to combine multiple + See <xref linkend="queries-tablefunctions"/> for ways to combine multiple set-returning functions. </para> @@ -15738,14 +15738,14 @@ SELECT * FROM pg_ls_dir('.') WITH ORDINALITY AS t(ls,n); <title>System Information Functions</title> <para> - <xref linkend="functions-info-session-table"> shows several + <xref linkend="functions-info-session-table"/> shows several functions that extract session and system information. </para> <para> In addition to the functions listed in this section, there are a number of functions related to the statistics system that also provide system - information. See <xref linkend="monitoring-stats-views"> for more + information. See <xref linkend="monitoring-stats-views"/> for more information. </para> @@ -15910,7 +15910,7 @@ SELECT * FROM pg_ls_dir('.') WITH ORDINALITY AS t(ls,n); <row> <entry><literal><function>version()</function></literal></entry> <entry><type>text</type></entry> - <entry><productname>PostgreSQL</productname> version information. See also <xref linkend="guc-server-version-num"> for a machine-readable version.</entry> + <entry><productname>PostgreSQL</productname> version information. See also <xref linkend="guc-server-version-num"/> for a machine-readable version.</entry> </row> </tbody> </tgroup> @@ -15988,11 +15988,11 @@ SELECT * FROM pg_ls_dir('.') WITH ORDINALITY AS t(ls,n); <para> The <function>session_user</function> is normally the user who initiated the current database connection; but superusers can change this setting - with <xref linkend="sql-set-session-authorization">. + with <xref linkend="sql-set-session-authorization"/>. The <function>current_user</function> is the user identifier that is applicable for permission checking. Normally it is equal to the session user, but it can be changed with - <xref linkend="sql-set-role">. + <xref linkend="sql-set-role"/>. It also changes during the execution of functions with the attribute <literal>SECURITY DEFINER</literal>. In Unix parlance, the session user is the <quote>real user</quote> and @@ -16111,7 +16111,7 @@ SET search_path TO <replaceable>schema</replaceable> <optional>, <replaceable>sc <para> <function>pg_current_logfile</function> returns, as <type>text</type>, the path of the log file(s) currently in use by the logging collector. - The path includes the <xref linkend="guc-log-directory"> directory + The path includes the <xref linkend="guc-log-directory"/> directory and the log file name. Log collection must be enabled or the return value is <literal>NULL</literal>. When multiple log files exist, each in a different format, <function>pg_current_logfile</function> called @@ -16122,7 +16122,7 @@ SET search_path TO <replaceable>schema</replaceable> <optional>, <replaceable>sc either <systemitem>csvlog</systemitem> or <systemitem>stderr</systemitem> as the value of the optional parameter. The return value is <literal>NULL</literal> when the log format requested is not a configured - <xref linkend="guc-log-destination">. The + <xref linkend="guc-log-destination"/>. The <function>pg_current_logfiles</function> reflects the contents of the <filename>current_logfiles</filename> file. </para> @@ -16160,7 +16160,7 @@ SET search_path TO <replaceable>schema</replaceable> <optional>, <replaceable>sc fraction of the total available space for notifications currently occupied by notifications that are waiting to be processed, as a <type>double</type> in the range 0-1. - See <xref linkend="sql-listen"> and <xref linkend="sql-notify"> + See <xref linkend="sql-listen"/> and <xref linkend="sql-notify"/> for more information. </para> @@ -16186,7 +16186,7 @@ SET search_path TO <replaceable>schema</replaceable> <optional>, <replaceable>sc running a <literal>SERIALIZABLE</literal> transaction blocks a <literal>SERIALIZABLE READ ONLY DEFERRABLE</literal> transaction from acquiring a snapshot until the latter determines that it is safe to avoid - taking any predicate locks. See <xref linkend="xact-serializable"> for + taking any predicate locks. See <xref linkend="xact-serializable"/> for more information about serializable and deferrable transactions. Frequent calls to this function could have some impact on database performance, because it needs access to the predicate lock manager's shared @@ -16200,10 +16200,10 @@ SET search_path TO <replaceable>schema</replaceable> <optional>, <replaceable>sc <para> <function>version</function> returns a string describing the <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> server's version. You can also - get this information from <xref linkend="guc-server-version"> or - for a machine-readable version, <xref linkend="guc-server-version-num">. + get this information from <xref linkend="guc-server-version"/> or + for a machine-readable version, <xref linkend="guc-server-version-num"/>. Software developers should use <literal>server_version_num</literal> - (available since 8.2) or <xref linkend="libpq-pqserverversion"> instead + (available since 8.2) or <xref linkend="libpq-pqserverversion"/> instead of parsing the text version. </para> @@ -16213,9 +16213,9 @@ SET search_path TO <replaceable>schema</replaceable> <optional>, <replaceable>sc </indexterm> <para> - <xref linkend="functions-info-access-table"> lists functions that + <xref linkend="functions-info-access-table"/> lists functions that allow the user to query object access privileges programmatically. - See <xref linkend="ddl-priv"> for more information about + See <xref linkend="ddl-priv"/> for more information about privileges. </para> @@ -16569,7 +16569,7 @@ SELECT has_table_privilege('joe', 'mytable', 'INSERT, SELECT WITH GRANT OPTION') are analogous to <function>has_table_privilege</function>. When specifying a function by a text string rather than by OID, the allowed input is the same as for the <type>regprocedure</type> data type - (see <xref linkend="datatype-oid">). + (see <xref linkend="datatype-oid"/>). The desired access privilege type must evaluate to <literal>EXECUTE</literal>. An example is: @@ -16631,7 +16631,7 @@ SELECT has_function_privilege('joeuser', 'myfunc(int, text)', 'execute'); are analogous to <function>has_table_privilege</function>. When specifying a type by a text string rather than by OID, the allowed input is the same as for the <type>regtype</type> data type - (see <xref linkend="datatype-oid">). + (see <xref linkend="datatype-oid"/>). The desired access privilege type must evaluate to <literal>USAGE</literal>. </para> @@ -16659,7 +16659,7 @@ SELECT has_function_privilege('joeuser', 'myfunc(int, text)', 'execute'); </para> <para> - <xref linkend="functions-info-schema-table"> shows functions that + <xref linkend="functions-info-schema-table"/> shows functions that determine whether a certain object is <firstterm>visible</firstterm> in the current schema search path. For example, a table is said to be visible if its @@ -16957,7 +16957,7 @@ SELECT pg_type_is_visible('myschema.widget'::regtype); </indexterm> <para> - <xref linkend="functions-info-catalog-table"> lists functions that + <xref linkend="functions-info-catalog-table"/> lists functions that extract information from the system catalogs. </para> @@ -17250,7 +17250,7 @@ SELECT pg_type_is_visible('myschema.widget'::regtype); second parameter, being just a column name, is treated as double-quoted and has its case preserved. The function returns a value suitably formatted for passing to sequence functions - (see <xref linkend="functions-sequence">). A typical use is in reading the + (see <xref linkend="functions-sequence"/>). A typical use is in reading the current value of a sequence for an identity or serial column, for example: <programlisting> SELECT currval(pg_get_serial_sequence('sometable', 'id')); @@ -17270,9 +17270,9 @@ SELECT currval(pg_get_serial_sequence('sometable', 'id')); property. <literal>NULL</literal> is returned if the property name is not known or does not apply to the particular object, or if the OID or column number does not identify a valid object. Refer to - <xref linkend="functions-info-index-column-props"> for column properties, - <xref linkend="functions-info-index-props"> for index properties, and - <xref linkend="functions-info-indexam-props"> for access method properties. + <xref linkend="functions-info-index-column-props"/> for column properties, + <xref linkend="functions-info-index-props"/> for index properties, and + <xref linkend="functions-info-indexam-props"/> for access method properties. (Note that extension access methods can define additional property names for their indexes.) </para> @@ -17423,7 +17423,7 @@ SELECT currval(pg_get_serial_sequence('sometable', 'id')); value that is passed to it. This can be helpful for troubleshooting or dynamically constructing SQL queries. The function is declared as returning <type>regtype</type>, which is an OID alias type (see - <xref linkend="datatype-oid">); this means that it is the same as an + <xref linkend="datatype-oid"/>); this means that it is the same as an OID for comparison purposes but displays as a type name. For example: <programlisting> SELECT pg_typeof(33); @@ -17496,7 +17496,7 @@ SELECT collation for ('foo' COLLATE "de_DE"); </indexterm> <para> - <xref linkend="functions-info-object-table"> lists functions related to + <xref linkend="functions-info-object-table"/> lists functions related to database object identification and addressing. </para> @@ -17603,8 +17603,8 @@ SELECT collation for ('foo' COLLATE "de_DE"); </indexterm> <para> - The functions shown in <xref linkend="functions-info-comment-table"> - extract comments previously stored with the <xref linkend="sql-comment"> + The functions shown in <xref linkend="functions-info-comment-table"/> + extract comments previously stored with the <xref linkend="sql-comment"/> command. A null value is returned if no comment could be found for the specified parameters. </para> @@ -17701,7 +17701,7 @@ SELECT collation for ('foo' COLLATE "de_DE"); </indexterm> <para> - The functions shown in <xref linkend="functions-txid-snapshot"> + The functions shown in <xref linkend="functions-txid-snapshot"/> provide server transaction information in an exportable form. The main use of these functions is to determine which transactions were committed between two snapshots. @@ -17767,7 +17767,7 @@ SELECT collation for ('foo' COLLATE "de_DE"); The data type used by these functions, <type>txid_snapshot</type>, stores information about transaction ID visibility at a particular moment in time. Its components are - described in <xref linkend="functions-txid-snapshot-parts">. + described in <xref linkend="functions-txid-snapshot-parts"/>. </para> <table id="functions-txid-snapshot-parts"> @@ -17843,11 +17843,11 @@ SELECT collation for ('foo' COLLATE "de_DE"); </para> <para> - The functions shown in <xref linkend="functions-commit-timestamp"> + The functions shown in <xref linkend="functions-commit-timestamp"/> provide information about transactions that have been already committed. These functions mainly provide information about when the transactions were committed. They only provide useful data when - <xref linkend="guc-track-commit-timestamp"> configuration option is enabled + <xref linkend="guc-track-commit-timestamp"/> configuration option is enabled and only for transactions that were committed after it was enabled. </para> @@ -17881,13 +17881,13 @@ SELECT collation for ('foo' COLLATE "de_DE"); </table> <para> - The functions shown in <xref linkend="functions-controldata"> + The functions shown in <xref linkend="functions-controldata"/> print information initialized during <command>initdb</command>, such as the catalog version. They also show information about write-ahead logging and checkpoint processing. This information is cluster-wide, and not specific to any one database. They provide most of the same information, from the same source, as - <xref linkend="app-pgcontroldata">, although in a form better suited + <xref linkend="app-pgcontroldata"/>, although in a form better suited to <acronym>SQL</acronym> functions. </para> @@ -17949,7 +17949,7 @@ SELECT collation for ('foo' COLLATE "de_DE"); <para> <function>pg_control_checkpoint</function> returns a record, shown in - <xref linkend="functions-pg-control-checkpoint"> + <xref linkend="functions-pg-control-checkpoint"/> </para> <table id="functions-pg-control-checkpoint"> @@ -18060,7 +18060,7 @@ SELECT collation for ('foo' COLLATE "de_DE"); <para> <function>pg_control_system</function> returns a record, shown in - <xref linkend="functions-pg-control-system"> + <xref linkend="functions-pg-control-system"/> </para> <table id="functions-pg-control-system"> @@ -18101,7 +18101,7 @@ SELECT collation for ('foo' COLLATE "de_DE"); <para> <function>pg_control_init</function> returns a record, shown in - <xref linkend="functions-pg-control-init"> + <xref linkend="functions-pg-control-init"/> </para> <table id="functions-pg-control-init"> @@ -18182,7 +18182,7 @@ SELECT collation for ('foo' COLLATE "de_DE"); <para> <function>pg_control_recovery</function> returns a record, shown in - <xref linkend="functions-pg-control-recovery"> + <xref linkend="functions-pg-control-recovery"/> </para> <table id="functions-pg-control-recovery"> @@ -18240,7 +18240,7 @@ SELECT collation for ('foo' COLLATE "de_DE"); <title>Configuration Settings Functions</title> <para> - <xref linkend="functions-admin-set-table"> shows the functions + <xref linkend="functions-admin-set-table"/> shows the functions available to query and alter run-time configuration parameters. </para> @@ -18356,7 +18356,7 @@ SELECT set_config('log_statement_stats', 'off', false); <para> The functions shown in <xref - linkend="functions-admin-signal-table"> send control signals to + linkend="functions-admin-signal-table"/> send control signals to other server processes. Use of these functions is restricted to superusers by default but access may be granted to others using <command>GRANT</command>, with noted exceptions. @@ -18491,7 +18491,7 @@ SELECT set_config('log_statement_stats', 'off', false); <para> The functions shown in <xref - linkend="functions-admin-backup-table"> assist in making on-line backups. + linkend="functions-admin-backup-table"/> assist in making on-line backups. These functions cannot be executed during recovery (except <function>pg_is_in_backup</function>, <function>pg_backup_start_time</function> and <function>pg_wal_lsn_diff</function>). @@ -18674,7 +18674,7 @@ postgres=# select pg_start_backup('label_goes_here'); <function>pg_create_restore_point</function> creates a named write-ahead log record that can be used as recovery target, and returns the corresponding write-ahead log location. The given name can then be used with - <xref linkend="recovery-target-name"> to specify the point up to which + <xref linkend="recovery-target-name"/> to specify the point up to which recovery will proceed. Avoid creating multiple restore points with the same name, since recovery will stop at the first one whose name matches the recovery target. @@ -18719,12 +18719,12 @@ postgres=# SELECT * FROM pg_walfile_name_offset(pg_stop_backup()); <function>pg_wal_lsn_diff</function> calculates the difference in bytes between two write-ahead log locations. It can be used with <structname>pg_stat_replication</structname> or some functions shown in - <xref linkend="functions-admin-backup-table"> to get the replication lag. + <xref linkend="functions-admin-backup-table"/> to get the replication lag. </para> <para> For details about proper usage of these functions, see - <xref linkend="continuous-archiving">. + <xref linkend="continuous-archiving"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -18747,7 +18747,7 @@ postgres=# SELECT * FROM pg_walfile_name_offset(pg_stop_backup()); <para> The functions shown in <xref - linkend="functions-recovery-info-table"> provide information + linkend="functions-recovery-info-table"/> provide information about the current status of the standby. These functions may be executed both during recovery and in normal running. </para> @@ -18828,7 +18828,7 @@ postgres=# SELECT * FROM pg_walfile_name_offset(pg_stop_backup()); <para> The functions shown in <xref - linkend="functions-recovery-control-table"> control the progress of recovery. + linkend="functions-recovery-control-table"/> control the progress of recovery. These functions may be executed only during recovery. </para> @@ -18919,8 +18919,8 @@ postgres=# SELECT * FROM pg_walfile_name_offset(pg_stop_backup()); <para> Snapshots are exported with the <function>pg_export_snapshot</function> function, - shown in <xref linkend="functions-snapshot-synchronization-table">, and - imported with the <xref linkend="sql-set-transaction"> command. + shown in <xref linkend="functions-snapshot-synchronization-table"/>, and + imported with the <xref linkend="sql-set-transaction"/> command. </para> <table id="functions-snapshot-synchronization-table"> @@ -18953,11 +18953,11 @@ postgres=# SELECT * FROM pg_walfile_name_offset(pg_stop_backup()); COMMITTED</literal> transactions, since in <literal>REPEATABLE READ</literal> and higher isolation levels, transactions use the same snapshot throughout their lifetime. Once a transaction has exported any snapshots, it cannot - be prepared with <xref linkend="sql-prepare-transaction">. + be prepared with <xref linkend="sql-prepare-transaction"/>. </para> <para> - See <xref linkend="sql-set-transaction"> for details of how to use an + See <xref linkend="sql-set-transaction"/> for details of how to use an exported snapshot. </para> </sect2> @@ -18967,25 +18967,25 @@ postgres=# SELECT * FROM pg_walfile_name_offset(pg_stop_backup()); <para> The functions shown - in <xref linkend="functions-replication-table"> are for + in <xref linkend="functions-replication-table"/> are for controlling and interacting with replication features. - See <xref linkend="streaming-replication">, - <xref linkend="streaming-replication-slots">, and - <xref linkend="replication-origins"> + See <xref linkend="streaming-replication"/>, + <xref linkend="streaming-replication-slots"/>, and + <xref linkend="replication-origins"/> for information about the underlying features. Use of these functions is restricted to superusers. </para> <para> Many of these functions have equivalent commands in the replication - protocol; see <xref linkend="protocol-replication">. + protocol; see <xref linkend="protocol-replication"/>. </para> <para> The functions described in - <xref linkend="functions-admin-backup">, - <xref linkend="functions-recovery-control">, and - <xref linkend="functions-snapshot-synchronization"> + <xref linkend="functions-admin-backup"/>, + <xref linkend="functions-recovery-control"/>, and + <xref linkend="functions-snapshot-synchronization"/> are also relevant for replication. </para> @@ -19018,7 +19018,7 @@ postgres=# SELECT * FROM pg_walfile_name_offset(pg_stop_backup()); the <acronym>LSN</acronym> is reserved on first connection from a streaming replication client. Streaming changes from a physical slot is only possible with the streaming-replication protocol — - see <xref linkend="protocol-replication">. The optional third + see <xref linkend="protocol-replication"/>. The optional third parameter, <parameter>temporary</parameter>, when set to true, specifies that the slot should not be permanently stored to disk and is only meant for use by current session. Temporary slots are also @@ -19386,7 +19386,7 @@ postgres=# SELECT * FROM pg_walfile_name_offset(pg_stop_backup()); <title>Database Object Management Functions</title> <para> - The functions shown in <xref linkend="functions-admin-dbsize"> calculate + The functions shown in <xref linkend="functions-admin-dbsize"/> calculate the disk space usage of database objects. </para> @@ -19598,13 +19598,13 @@ postgres=# SELECT * FROM pg_walfile_name_offset(pg_stop_backup()); <listitem> <para> <literal>'fsm'</literal> returns the size of the Free Space Map - (see <xref linkend="storage-fsm">) associated with the relation. + (see <xref linkend="storage-fsm"/>) associated with the relation. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> <literal>'vm'</literal> returns the size of the Visibility Map - (see <xref linkend="storage-vm">) associated with the relation. + (see <xref linkend="storage-vm"/>) associated with the relation. </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -19656,7 +19656,7 @@ postgres=# SELECT * FROM pg_walfile_name_offset(pg_stop_backup()); </para> <para> - The functions shown in <xref linkend="functions-admin-dblocation"> assist + The functions shown in <xref linkend="functions-admin-dblocation"/> assist in identifying the specific disk files associated with database objects. </para> @@ -19714,7 +19714,7 @@ postgres=# SELECT * FROM pg_walfile_name_offset(pg_stop_backup()); <function>pg_relation_filenode</function> accepts the OID or name of a table, index, sequence, or toast table, and returns the <quote>filenode</quote> number currently assigned to it. The filenode is the base component of the file - name(s) used for the relation (see <xref linkend="storage-file-layout"> + name(s) used for the relation (see <xref linkend="storage-file-layout"/> for more information). For most tables the result is the same as <structname>pg_class</structname>.<structfield>relfilenode</structfield>, but for certain system catalogs <structfield>relfilenode</structfield> is zero and this function must @@ -19737,7 +19737,7 @@ postgres=# SELECT * FROM pg_walfile_name_offset(pg_stop_backup()); </para> <para> - <xref linkend="functions-admin-collation"> lists functions used to manage + <xref linkend="functions-admin-collation"/> lists functions used to manage collations. </para> @@ -19775,7 +19775,7 @@ postgres=# SELECT * FROM pg_walfile_name_offset(pg_stop_backup()); operating system. If this is different from the value in <literal>pg_collation.collversion</literal>, then objects depending on the collation might need to be rebuilt. See also - <xref linkend="sql-altercollation">. + <xref linkend="sql-altercollation"/>. </para> <para> @@ -19783,7 +19783,7 @@ postgres=# SELECT * FROM pg_walfile_name_offset(pg_stop_backup()); catalog <literal>pg_collation</literal> based on all the locales it finds in the operating system. This is what <command>initdb</command> uses; - see <xref linkend="collation-managing"> for more details. If additional + see <xref linkend="collation-managing"/> for more details. If additional locales are installed into the operating system later on, this function can be run again to add collations for the new locales. Locales that match existing entries in <literal>pg_collation</literal> will be skipped. @@ -19817,7 +19817,7 @@ postgres=# SELECT * FROM pg_walfile_name_offset(pg_stop_backup()); </indexterm> <para> - <xref linkend="functions-admin-index-table"> shows the functions + <xref linkend="functions-admin-index-table"/> shows the functions available for index maintenance tasks. These functions cannot be executed during recovery. Use of these functions is restricted to superusers and the owner @@ -19882,7 +19882,7 @@ postgres=# SELECT * FROM pg_walfile_name_offset(pg_stop_backup()); Note that if the argument is a GIN index built with the <literal>fastupdate</literal> option disabled, no cleanup happens and the return value is 0, because the index doesn't have a pending list. - Please see <xref linkend="gin-fast-update"> and <xref linkend="gin-tips"> + Please see <xref linkend="gin-fast-update"/> and <xref linkend="gin-tips"/> for details of the pending list and <literal>fastupdate</literal> option. </para> @@ -19893,7 +19893,7 @@ postgres=# SELECT * FROM pg_walfile_name_offset(pg_stop_backup()); <para> The functions shown in <xref - linkend="functions-admin-genfile-table"> provide native access to + linkend="functions-admin-genfile-table"/> provide native access to files on the machine hosting the server. Only files within the database cluster directory and the <varname>log_directory</varname> can be accessed. Use a relative path for files in the cluster directory, @@ -20064,9 +20064,9 @@ SELECT (pg_stat_file('filename')).modification; <title>Advisory Lock Functions</title> <para> - The functions shown in <xref linkend="functions-advisory-locks-table"> + The functions shown in <xref linkend="functions-advisory-locks-table"/> manage advisory locks. For details about proper use of these functions, - see <xref linkend="advisory-locks">. + see <xref linkend="advisory-locks"/>. </para> <table id="functions-advisory-locks-table"> @@ -20392,7 +20392,7 @@ FOR EACH ROW EXECUTE PROCEDURE suppress_redundant_updates_trigger(); </para> <para> For more information about creating triggers, see - <xref linkend="sql-createtrigger">. + <xref linkend="sql-createtrigger"/>. </para> </sect1> @@ -20406,7 +20406,7 @@ FOR EACH ROW EXECUTE PROCEDURE suppress_redundant_updates_trigger(); <para> For more information about event triggers, - see <xref linkend="event-triggers">. + see <xref linkend="event-triggers"/>. </para> <sect2 id="pg-event-trigger-ddl-command-end-functions"> @@ -20645,7 +20645,7 @@ CREATE EVENT TRIGGER test_event_trigger_for_drops <para> The functions shown in - <xref linkend="functions-event-trigger-table-rewrite"> + <xref linkend="functions-event-trigger-table-rewrite"/> provide information about a table for which a <literal>table_rewrite</literal> event has just been called. If called in any other context, an error is raised. diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/geqo.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/geqo.sgml index 0f91272c54e..5120dfbb424 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/geqo.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/geqo.sgml @@ -237,7 +237,7 @@ choices made during both the initial population selection and subsequent <quote>mutation</quote> of the best candidates. To avoid surprising changes of the selected plan, each run of the GEQO algorithm restarts its - random number generator with the current <xref linkend="guc-geqo-seed"> + random number generator with the current <xref linkend="guc-geqo-seed"/> parameter setting. As long as <varname>geqo_seed</varname> and the other GEQO parameters are kept fixed, the same plan will be generated for a given query (and other planner inputs such as statistics). To experiment @@ -320,13 +320,13 @@ <listitem> <para> - <xref linkend="elma04"> + <xref linkend="elma04"/> </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - <xref linkend="fong"> + <xref linkend="fong"/> </para> </listitem> </itemizedlist> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/gin.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/gin.sgml index 95d6278d288..cc7cd1ed2c4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/gin.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/gin.sgml @@ -68,8 +68,8 @@ <para> The core <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> distribution includes the <acronym>GIN</acronym> operator classes shown in - <xref linkend="gin-builtin-opclasses-table">. - (Some of the optional modules described in <xref linkend="contrib"> + <xref linkend="gin-builtin-opclasses-table"/>. + (Some of the optional modules described in <xref linkend="contrib"/> provide additional <acronym>GIN</acronym> operator classes.) </para> @@ -127,7 +127,7 @@ Of the two operator classes for type <type>jsonb</type>, <literal>jsonb_ops</literal> is the default. <literal>jsonb_path_ops</literal> supports fewer operators but offers better performance for those operators. - See <xref linkend="json-indexing"> for details. + See <xref linkend="json-indexing"/> for details. </para> </sect1> @@ -182,7 +182,7 @@ <literal>query</literal> is the value on the right-hand side of an indexable operator whose left-hand side is the indexed column. <literal>n</literal> is the strategy number of the operator within the - operator class (see <xref linkend="xindex-strategies">). + operator class (see <xref linkend="xindex-strategies"/>). Often, <function>extractQuery</function> will need to consult <literal>n</literal> to determine the data type of <literal>query</literal> and the method it should use to extract key values. @@ -406,7 +406,7 @@ provide the <function>comparePartial</function> method, and its <function>extractQuery</function> method must set the <literal>pmatch</literal> parameter when a partial-match query is encountered. See - <xref linkend="gin-partial-match"> for details. + <xref linkend="gin-partial-match"/> for details. </para> <para> @@ -466,7 +466,7 @@ When the table is vacuumed or autoanalyzed, or when <function>gin_clean_pending_list</function> function is called, or if the pending list becomes larger than - <xref linkend="guc-gin-pending-list-limit">, the entries are moved to the + <xref linkend="guc-gin-pending-list-limit"/>, the entries are moved to the main <acronym>GIN</acronym> data structure using the same bulk insert techniques used during initial index creation. This greatly improves <acronym>GIN</acronym> index update speed, even counting the additional @@ -488,7 +488,7 @@ If consistent response time is more important than update speed, use of pending entries can be disabled by turning off the <literal>fastupdate</literal> storage parameter for a - <acronym>GIN</acronym> index. See <xref linkend="sql-createindex"> + <acronym>GIN</acronym> index. See <xref linkend="sql-createindex"/> for details. </para> </sect2> @@ -531,14 +531,14 @@ <para> As of <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> 8.4, this advice is less necessary since delayed indexing is used (see <xref - linkend="gin-fast-update"> for details). But for very large updates + linkend="gin-fast-update"/> for details). But for very large updates it may still be best to drop and recreate the index. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> <varlistentry> - <term><xref linkend="guc-maintenance-work-mem"></term> + <term><xref linkend="guc-maintenance-work-mem"/></term> <listitem> <para> Build time for a <acronym>GIN</acronym> index is very sensitive to @@ -549,7 +549,7 @@ </varlistentry> <varlistentry> - <term><xref linkend="guc-gin-pending-list-limit"></term> + <term><xref linkend="guc-gin-pending-list-limit"/></term> <listitem> <para> During a series of insertions into an existing <acronym>GIN</acronym> @@ -574,7 +574,7 @@ </varlistentry> <varlistentry> - <term><xref linkend="guc-gin-fuzzy-search-limit"></term> + <term><xref linkend="guc-gin-fuzzy-search-limit"/></term> <listitem> <para> The primary goal of developing <acronym>GIN</acronym> indexes was @@ -631,7 +631,7 @@ <para> The core <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> distribution includes the <acronym>GIN</acronym> operator classes previously shown in - <xref linkend="gin-builtin-opclasses-table">. + <xref linkend="gin-builtin-opclasses-table"/>. The following <filename>contrib</filename> modules also contain <acronym>GIN</acronym> operator classes: diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/gist.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/gist.sgml index f2f9ca0853c..44a3b2c03c5 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/gist.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/gist.sgml @@ -46,8 +46,8 @@ <para> The core <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> distribution includes the <acronym>GiST</acronym> operator classes shown in - <xref linkend="gist-builtin-opclasses-table">. - (Some of the optional modules described in <xref linkend="contrib"> + <xref linkend="gist-builtin-opclasses-table"/>. + (Some of the optional modules described in <xref linkend="contrib"/> provide additional <acronym>GiST</acronym> operator classes.) </para> @@ -985,7 +985,7 @@ my_fetch(PG_FUNCTION_ARGS) <para> By default, a GiST index build switches to the buffering method when the - index size reaches <xref linkend="guc-effective-cache-size">. It can + index size reaches <xref linkend="guc-effective-cache-size"/>. It can be manually turned on or off by the <literal>buffering</literal> parameter to the CREATE INDEX command. The default behavior is good for most cases, but turning buffering off might speed up the build somewhat if the input diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml index 6c0679b0a8b..46bf198a2ac 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml @@ -100,7 +100,7 @@ Shared hardware functionality is common in network storage devices. Using a network file system is also possible, though care must be taken that the file system has full <acronym>POSIX</acronym> behavior (see <xref - linkend="creating-cluster-nfs">). One significant limitation of this + linkend="creating-cluster-nfs"/>). One significant limitation of this method is that if the shared disk array fails or becomes corrupt, the primary and standby servers are both nonfunctional. Another issue is that the standby server should never access the shared storage while @@ -151,9 +151,9 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. </para> <para> A standby server can be implemented using file-based log shipping - (<xref linkend="warm-standby">) or streaming replication (see - <xref linkend="streaming-replication">), or a combination of both. For - information on hot standby, see <xref linkend="hot-standby">. + (<xref linkend="warm-standby"/>) or streaming replication (see + <xref linkend="streaming-replication"/>), or a combination of both. For + information on hot standby, see <xref linkend="hot-standby"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -169,8 +169,8 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. individual tables to be replicated. Logical replication doesn't require a particular server to be designated as a master or a replica but allows data to flow in multiple directions. For more information on logical - replication, see <xref linkend="logical-replication">. Through the - logical decoding interface (<xref linkend="logicaldecoding">), + replication, see <xref linkend="logical-replication"/>. Through the + logical decoding interface (<xref linkend="logicaldecoding"/>), third-party extensions can also provide similar functionality. </para> </listitem> @@ -224,8 +224,8 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. standby servers via master-standby replication, not by the replication middleware. Care must also be taken that all transactions either commit or abort on all servers, perhaps - using two-phase commit (<xref linkend="sql-prepare-transaction"> - and <xref linkend="sql-commit-prepared">). + using two-phase commit (<xref linkend="sql-prepare-transaction"/> + and <xref linkend="sql-commit-prepared"/>). <productname>Pgpool-II</productname> and <productname>Continuent Tungsten</productname> are examples of this type of replication. </para> @@ -272,8 +272,8 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <para> <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> does not offer this type of replication, though <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> two-phase commit (<xref - linkend="sql-prepare-transaction"> and <xref - linkend="sql-commit-prepared">) + linkend="sql-prepare-transaction"/> and <xref + linkend="sql-commit-prepared"/>) can be used to implement this in application code or middleware. </para> </listitem> @@ -295,7 +295,7 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. </variablelist> <para> - <xref linkend="high-availability-matrix"> summarizes + <xref linkend="high-availability-matrix"/> summarizes the capabilities of the various solutions listed above. </para> @@ -522,7 +522,7 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. varies according to the transaction rate of the primary server. Record-based log shipping is more granular and streams WAL changes incrementally over a network connection (see <xref - linkend="streaming-replication">). + linkend="streaming-replication"/>). </para> <para> @@ -534,7 +534,7 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <varname>archive_timeout</varname> parameter, which can be set as low as a few seconds. However such a low setting will substantially increase the bandwidth required for file shipping. - Streaming replication (see <xref linkend="streaming-replication">) + Streaming replication (see <xref linkend="streaming-replication"/>) allows a much smaller window of data loss. </para> @@ -547,7 +547,7 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. rollforward will take considerably longer, so that technique only offers a solution for disaster recovery, not high availability. A standby server can also be used for read-only queries, in which case - it is called a Hot Standby server. See <xref linkend="hot-standby"> for + it is called a Hot Standby server. See <xref linkend="hot-standby"/> for more information. </para> @@ -585,7 +585,7 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. associated with tablespaces will be passed across unmodified, so both primary and standby servers must have the same mount paths for tablespaces if that feature is used. Keep in mind that if - <xref linkend="sql-createtablespace"> + <xref linkend="sql-createtablespace"/> is executed on the primary, any new mount point needed for it must be created on the primary and all standby servers before the command is executed. Hardware need not be exactly the same, but experience shows @@ -618,7 +618,7 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <para> In standby mode, the server continuously applies WAL received from the master server. The standby server can read WAL from a WAL archive - (see <xref linkend="restore-command">) or directly from the master + (see <xref linkend="restore-command"/>) or directly from the master over a TCP connection (streaming replication). The standby server will also attempt to restore any WAL found in the standby cluster's <filename>pg_wal</filename> directory. That typically happens after a server @@ -657,7 +657,7 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <para> Set up continuous archiving on the primary to an archive directory accessible from the standby, as described - in <xref linkend="continuous-archiving">. The archive location should be + in <xref linkend="continuous-archiving"/>. The archive location should be accessible from the standby even when the master is down, i.e. it should reside on the standby server itself or another trusted server, not on the master server. @@ -676,7 +676,7 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. </para> <para> - Take a base backup as described in <xref linkend="backup-base-backup"> + Take a base backup as described in <xref linkend="backup-base-backup"/> to bootstrap the standby server. </para> </sect2> @@ -686,7 +686,7 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <para> To set up the standby server, restore the base backup taken from primary - server (see <xref linkend="backup-pitr-recovery">). Create a recovery + server (see <xref linkend="backup-pitr-recovery"/>). Create a recovery command file <filename>recovery.conf</filename> in the standby's cluster data directory, and turn on <varname>standby_mode</varname>. Set <varname>restore_command</varname> to a simple command to copy files from @@ -701,7 +701,7 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. Do not use pg_standby or similar tools with the built-in standby mode described here. <varname>restore_command</varname> should return immediately if the file does not exist; the server will retry the command again if - necessary. See <xref linkend="log-shipping-alternative"> + necessary. See <xref linkend="log-shipping-alternative"/> for using tools like pg_standby. </para> </note> @@ -724,11 +724,11 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <para> If you're using a WAL archive, its size can be minimized using the <xref - linkend="archive-cleanup-command"> parameter to remove files that are no + linkend="archive-cleanup-command"/> parameter to remove files that are no longer required by the standby server. The <application>pg_archivecleanup</application> utility is designed specifically to be used with <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> in typical single-standby - configurations, see <xref linkend="pgarchivecleanup">. + configurations, see <xref linkend="pgarchivecleanup"/>. Note however, that if you're using the archive for backup purposes, you need to retain files needed to recover from at least the latest base backup, even if they're no longer needed by the standby. @@ -768,7 +768,7 @@ archive_cleanup_command = 'pg_archivecleanup /path/to/archive %r' <para> Streaming replication is asynchronous by default - (see <xref linkend="synchronous-replication">), in which case there is + (see <xref linkend="synchronous-replication"/>), in which case there is a small delay between committing a transaction in the primary and the changes becoming visible in the standby. This delay is however much smaller than with file-based log shipping, typically under one second @@ -791,27 +791,27 @@ archive_cleanup_command = 'pg_archivecleanup /path/to/archive %r' <para> To use streaming replication, set up a file-based log-shipping standby - server as described in <xref linkend="warm-standby">. The step that + server as described in <xref linkend="warm-standby"/>. The step that turns a file-based log-shipping standby into streaming replication standby is setting <varname>primary_conninfo</varname> setting in the <filename>recovery.conf</filename> file to point to the primary server. Set - <xref linkend="guc-listen-addresses"> and authentication options + <xref linkend="guc-listen-addresses"/> and authentication options (see <filename>pg_hba.conf</filename>) on the primary so that the standby server can connect to the <literal>replication</literal> pseudo-database on the primary - server (see <xref linkend="streaming-replication-authentication">). + server (see <xref linkend="streaming-replication-authentication"/>). </para> <para> On systems that support the keepalive socket option, setting - <xref linkend="guc-tcp-keepalives-idle">, - <xref linkend="guc-tcp-keepalives-interval"> and - <xref linkend="guc-tcp-keepalives-count"> helps the primary promptly + <xref linkend="guc-tcp-keepalives-idle"/>, + <xref linkend="guc-tcp-keepalives-interval"/> and + <xref linkend="guc-tcp-keepalives-count"/> helps the primary promptly notice a broken connection. </para> <para> Set the maximum number of concurrent connections from the standby servers - (see <xref linkend="guc-max-wal-senders"> for details). + (see <xref linkend="guc-max-wal-senders"/> for details). </para> <para> @@ -882,15 +882,15 @@ primary_conninfo = 'host=192.168.1.50 port=5432 user=foo password=foopass' standby. These locations can be retrieved using <function>pg_current_wal_lsn</function> on the primary and <function>pg_last_wal_receive_lsn</function> on the standby, - respectively (see <xref linkend="functions-admin-backup-table"> and - <xref linkend="functions-recovery-info-table"> for details). + respectively (see <xref linkend="functions-admin-backup-table"/> and + <xref linkend="functions-recovery-info-table"/> for details). The last WAL receive location in the standby is also displayed in the process status of the WAL receiver process, displayed using the - <command>ps</command> command (see <xref linkend="monitoring-ps"> for details). + <command>ps</command> command (see <xref linkend="monitoring-ps"/> for details). </para> <para> You can retrieve a list of WAL sender processes via the - <xref linkend="pg-stat-replication-view"> view. Large differences between + <xref linkend="pg-stat-replication-view"/> view. Large differences between <function>pg_current_wal_lsn</function> and the view's <literal>sent_lsn</literal> field might indicate that the master server is under heavy load, while differences between <literal>sent_lsn</literal> and @@ -899,7 +899,7 @@ primary_conninfo = 'host=192.168.1.50 port=5432 user=foo password=foopass' </para> <para> On a hot standby, the status of the WAL receiver process can be retrieved - via the <xref linkend="pg-stat-wal-receiver-view"> view. A large + via the <xref linkend="pg-stat-wal-receiver-view"/> view. A large difference between <function>pg_last_wal_replay_lsn</function> and the view's <literal>received_lsn</literal> indicates that WAL is being received faster than it can be replayed. @@ -922,9 +922,9 @@ primary_conninfo = 'host=192.168.1.50 port=5432 user=foo password=foopass' </para> <para> In lieu of using replication slots, it is possible to prevent the removal - of old WAL segments using <xref linkend="guc-wal-keep-segments">, or by + of old WAL segments using <xref linkend="guc-wal-keep-segments"/>, or by storing the segments in an archive using - <xref linkend="guc-archive-command">. + <xref linkend="guc-archive-command"/>. However, these methods often result in retaining more WAL segments than required, whereas replication slots retain only the number of segments known to be needed. An advantage of these methods is that they bound @@ -932,8 +932,8 @@ primary_conninfo = 'host=192.168.1.50 port=5432 user=foo password=foopass' to do this using replication slots. </para> <para> - Similarly, <xref linkend="guc-hot-standby-feedback"> - and <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-defer-cleanup-age"> provide protection against + Similarly, <xref linkend="guc-hot-standby-feedback"/> + and <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-defer-cleanup-age"/> provide protection against relevant rows being removed by vacuum, but the former provides no protection during any time period when the standby is not connected, and the latter often needs to be set to a high value to provide adequate @@ -952,8 +952,8 @@ primary_conninfo = 'host=192.168.1.50 port=5432 user=foo password=foopass' </para> <para> Slots can be created and dropped either via the streaming replication - protocol (see <xref linkend="protocol-replication">) or via SQL - functions (see <xref linkend="functions-replication">). + protocol (see <xref linkend="protocol-replication"/>) or via SQL + functions (see <xref linkend="functions-replication"/>). </para> </sect3> <sect3 id="streaming-replication-slots-config"> @@ -1017,7 +1017,7 @@ primary_slot_name = 'node_a_slot' <para> Cascading replication is currently asynchronous. Synchronous replication - (see <xref linkend="synchronous-replication">) settings have no effect on + (see <xref linkend="synchronous-replication"/>) settings have no effect on cascading replication at present. </para> @@ -1034,7 +1034,7 @@ primary_slot_name = 'node_a_slot' <para> To use cascading replication, set up the cascading standby so that it can accept replication connections (that is, set - <xref linkend="guc-max-wal-senders"> and <xref linkend="guc-hot-standby">, + <xref linkend="guc-max-wal-senders"/> and <xref linkend="guc-hot-standby"/>, and configure <link linkend="auth-pg-hba-conf">host-based authentication</link>). You will also need to set <varname>primary_conninfo</varname> in the downstream @@ -1109,11 +1109,11 @@ primary_slot_name = 'node_a_slot' <para> Once streaming replication has been configured, configuring synchronous replication requires only one additional configuration step: - <xref linkend="guc-synchronous-standby-names"> must be set to + <xref linkend="guc-synchronous-standby-names"/> must be set to a non-empty value. <varname>synchronous_commit</varname> must also be set to <literal>on</literal>, but since this is the default value, typically no change is - required. (See <xref linkend="runtime-config-wal-settings"> and - <xref linkend="runtime-config-replication-master">.) + required. (See <xref linkend="runtime-config-wal-settings"/> and + <xref linkend="runtime-config-replication-master"/>.) This configuration will cause each commit to wait for confirmation that the standby has written the commit record to durable storage. @@ -1451,7 +1451,7 @@ synchronous_standby_names = 'ANY 2 (s1, s2, s3)' and might stay down. To return to normal operation, a standby server must be recreated, either on the former primary system when it comes up, or on a third, - possibly new, system. The <xref linkend="app-pgrewind"> utility can be + possibly new, system. The <xref linkend="app-pgrewind"/> utility can be used to speed up this process on large clusters. Once complete, the primary and standby can be considered to have switched roles. Some people choose to use a third @@ -1491,7 +1491,7 @@ synchronous_standby_names = 'ANY 2 (s1, s2, s3)' This was the only option available in versions 8.4 and below. In this setup, set <varname>standby_mode</varname> off, because you are implementing the polling required for standby operation yourself. See the - <xref linkend="pgstandby"> module for a reference + <xref linkend="pgstandby"/> module for a reference implementation of this. </para> @@ -1551,7 +1551,7 @@ if (!triggered) <para> A working example of a waiting <varname>restore_command</varname> is provided - in the <xref linkend="pgstandby"> module. It + in the <xref linkend="pgstandby"/> module. It should be used as a reference on how to correctly implement the logic described above. It can also be extended as needed to support specific configurations and environments. @@ -1592,17 +1592,17 @@ if (!triggered) <para> Set up continuous archiving from the primary to a WAL archive directory on the standby server. Ensure that - <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode">, - <xref linkend="guc-archive-command"> and - <xref linkend="guc-archive-timeout"> + <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"/>, + <xref linkend="guc-archive-command"/> and + <xref linkend="guc-archive-timeout"/> are set appropriately on the primary - (see <xref linkend="backup-archiving-wal">). + (see <xref linkend="backup-archiving-wal"/>). </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> Make a base backup of the primary server (see <xref - linkend="backup-base-backup">), and load this data onto the standby. + linkend="backup-base-backup"/>), and load this data onto the standby. </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -1610,7 +1610,7 @@ if (!triggered) Begin recovery on the standby server from the local WAL archive, using a <filename>recovery.conf</filename> that specifies a <varname>restore_command</varname> that waits as described - previously (see <xref linkend="backup-pitr-recovery">). + previously (see <xref linkend="backup-pitr-recovery"/>). </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> @@ -1644,7 +1644,7 @@ if (!triggered) <para> An external program can call the <function>pg_walfile_name_offset()</function> - function (see <xref linkend="functions-admin">) + function (see <xref linkend="functions-admin"/>) to find out the file name and the exact byte offset within it of the current end of WAL. It can then access the WAL file directly and copy the data from the last known end of WAL through the current end @@ -1663,7 +1663,7 @@ if (!triggered) <para> Starting with <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> version 9.0, you can use - streaming replication (see <xref linkend="streaming-replication">) to + streaming replication (see <xref linkend="streaming-replication"/>) to achieve the same benefits with less effort. </para> </sect2> @@ -1697,7 +1697,7 @@ if (!triggered) <title>User's Overview</title> <para> - When the <xref linkend="guc-hot-standby"> parameter is set to true on a + When the <xref linkend="guc-hot-standby"/> parameter is set to true on a standby server, it will begin accepting connections once the recovery has brought the system to a consistent state. All such connections are strictly read-only; not even temporary tables may be written. @@ -1713,7 +1713,7 @@ if (!triggered) made by that transaction will be visible to any new snapshots taken on the standby. Snapshots may be taken at the start of each query or at the start of each transaction, depending on the current transaction isolation - level. For more details, see <xref linkend="transaction-iso">. + level. For more details, see <xref linkend="transaction-iso"/>. </para> <para> @@ -1891,7 +1891,7 @@ if (!triggered) <para> Users will be able to tell whether their session is read-only by issuing <command>SHOW transaction_read_only</command>. In addition, a set of - functions (<xref linkend="functions-recovery-info-table">) allow users to + functions (<xref linkend="functions-recovery-info-table"/>) allow users to access information about the standby server. These allow you to write programs that are aware of the current state of the database. These can be used to monitor the progress of recovery, or to allow you to @@ -1986,8 +1986,8 @@ if (!triggered) When a conflicting query is short, it's typically desirable to allow it to complete by delaying WAL application for a little bit; but a long delay in WAL application is usually not desirable. So the cancel mechanism has - parameters, <xref linkend="guc-max-standby-archive-delay"> and <xref - linkend="guc-max-standby-streaming-delay">, that define the maximum + parameters, <xref linkend="guc-max-standby-archive-delay"/> and <xref + linkend="guc-max-standby-streaming-delay"/>, that define the maximum allowed delay in WAL application. Conflicting queries will be canceled once it has taken longer than the relevant delay setting to apply any newly-received WAL data. There are two parameters so that different delay @@ -2082,7 +2082,7 @@ if (!triggered) </para> <para> - Another option is to increase <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-defer-cleanup-age"> + Another option is to increase <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-defer-cleanup-age"/> on the primary server, so that dead rows will not be cleaned up as quickly as they normally would be. This will allow more time for queries to execute before they are canceled on the standby, without having to set @@ -2189,8 +2189,8 @@ LOG: database system is ready to accept read only connections <para> It is important that the administrator select appropriate settings for - <xref linkend="guc-max-standby-archive-delay"> and <xref - linkend="guc-max-standby-streaming-delay">. The best choices vary + <xref linkend="guc-max-standby-archive-delay"/> and <xref + linkend="guc-max-standby-streaming-delay"/>. The best choices vary depending on business priorities. For example if the server is primarily tasked as a High Availability server, then you will want low delay settings, perhaps even zero, though that is a very aggressive setting. If @@ -2382,23 +2382,23 @@ LOG: database system is ready to accept read only connections <para> Various parameters have been mentioned above in - <xref linkend="hot-standby-conflict"> and - <xref linkend="hot-standby-admin">. + <xref linkend="hot-standby-conflict"/> and + <xref linkend="hot-standby-admin"/>. </para> <para> - On the primary, parameters <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"> and - <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-defer-cleanup-age"> can be used. - <xref linkend="guc-max-standby-archive-delay"> and - <xref linkend="guc-max-standby-streaming-delay"> have no effect if set on + On the primary, parameters <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"/> and + <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-defer-cleanup-age"/> can be used. + <xref linkend="guc-max-standby-archive-delay"/> and + <xref linkend="guc-max-standby-streaming-delay"/> have no effect if set on the primary. </para> <para> - On the standby, parameters <xref linkend="guc-hot-standby">, - <xref linkend="guc-max-standby-archive-delay"> and - <xref linkend="guc-max-standby-streaming-delay"> can be used. - <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-defer-cleanup-age"> has no effect + On the standby, parameters <xref linkend="guc-hot-standby"/>, + <xref linkend="guc-max-standby-archive-delay"/> and + <xref linkend="guc-max-standby-streaming-delay"/> can be used. + <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-defer-cleanup-age"/> has no effect as long as the server remains in standby mode, though it will become relevant if the standby becomes primary. </para> @@ -2452,8 +2452,8 @@ LOG: database system is ready to accept read only connections <listitem> <para> The Serializable transaction isolation level is not yet available in hot - standby. (See <xref linkend="xact-serializable"> and - <xref linkend="serializable-consistency"> for details.) + standby. (See <xref linkend="xact-serializable"/> and + <xref linkend="serializable-consistency"/> for details.) An attempt to set a transaction to the serializable isolation level in hot standby mode will generate an error. </para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/history.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/history.sgml index b59e65bb209..59bfdb60552 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/history.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/history.sgml @@ -31,12 +31,12 @@ Office (<acronym>ARO</acronym>), the National Science Foundation (<acronym>NSF</acronym>), and ESL, Inc. The implementation of <productname>POSTGRES</productname> began in 1986. The initial - concepts for the system were presented in <xref linkend="ston86">, + concepts for the system were presented in <xref linkend="ston86"/>, and the definition of the initial data model appeared in <xref - linkend="rowe87">. The design of the rule system at that time was - described in <xref linkend="ston87a">. The rationale and + linkend="rowe87"/>. The design of the rule system at that time was + described in <xref linkend="ston87a"/>. The rationale and architecture of the storage manager were detailed in <xref - linkend="ston87b">. + linkend="ston87b"/>. </para> <para> @@ -44,10 +44,10 @@ releases since then. The first <quote>demoware</quote> system became operational in 1987 and was shown at the 1988 <acronym>ACM-SIGMOD</acronym> Conference. Version 1, described in - <xref linkend="ston90a">, was released to a few external users in + <xref linkend="ston90a"/>, was released to a few external users in June 1989. In response to a critique of the first rule system - (<xref linkend="ston89">), the rule system was redesigned (<xref - linkend="ston90b">), and Version 2 was released in June 1990 with + (<xref linkend="ston89"/>), the rule system was redesigned (<xref + linkend="ston90b"/>), and Version 2 was released in June 1990 with the new rule system. Version 3 appeared in 1991 and added support for multiple storage managers, an improved query executor, and a rewritten rule system. For the most part, subsequent releases @@ -216,7 +216,7 @@ <para> Details about what has happened in <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> since - then can be found in <xref linkend="release">. + then can be found in <xref linkend="release"/>. </para> </sect2> </sect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/hstore.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/hstore.sgml index 0264e4e532e..94ccd1201e1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/hstore.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/hstore.sgml @@ -70,7 +70,7 @@ key => NULL constant, then any single-quote characters and (depending on the setting of the <varname>standard_conforming_strings</varname> configuration parameter) backslash characters need to be escaped correctly. See - <xref linkend="sql-syntax-strings"> for more on the handling of string + <xref linkend="sql-syntax-strings"/> for more on the handling of string constants. </para> </note> @@ -87,8 +87,8 @@ key => NULL <para> The operators provided by the <literal>hstore</literal> module are - shown in <xref linkend="hstore-op-table">, the functions - in <xref linkend="hstore-func-table">. + shown in <xref linkend="hstore-op-table"/>, the functions + in <xref linkend="hstore-func-table"/>. </para> <table id="hstore-op-table"> @@ -629,7 +629,7 @@ ALTER TABLE tablename ALTER hstorecol TYPE hstore USING hstorecol || ''; extensions for PL/Python are called <literal>hstore_plpythonu</literal>, <literal>hstore_plpython2u</literal>, and <literal>hstore_plpython3u</literal> - (see <xref linkend="plpython-python23"> for the PL/Python naming + (see <xref linkend="plpython-python23"/> for the PL/Python naming convention). If you use them, <type>hstore</type> values are mapped to Python dictionaries. </para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/indexam.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/indexam.sgml index a94b188f22d..a7f6c8dc6ad 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/indexam.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/indexam.sgml @@ -22,7 +22,7 @@ pages so that they can use the regular storage manager and buffer manager to access the index contents. (All the existing index access methods furthermore use the standard page layout described in <xref - linkend="storage-page-layout">, and most use the same format for index + linkend="storage-page-layout"/>, and most use the same format for index tuple headers; but these decisions are not forced on an access method.) </para> @@ -31,7 +31,7 @@ <firstterm>tuple identifiers</firstterm>, or <acronym>TIDs</acronym>, of row versions (tuples) in the index's parent table. A TID consists of a block number and an item number within that block (see <xref - linkend="storage-page-layout">). This is sufficient + linkend="storage-page-layout"/>). This is sufficient information to fetch a particular row version from the table. Indexes are not directly aware that under MVCC, there might be multiple extant versions of the same logical row; to an index, each tuple is @@ -52,8 +52,8 @@ system catalog. The <structname>pg_am</structname> entry specifies a name and a <firstterm>handler function</firstterm> for the access method. These entries can be created and deleted using the - <xref linkend="sql-create-access-method"> and - <xref linkend="sql-drop-access-method"> SQL commands. + <xref linkend="sql-create-access-method"/> and + <xref linkend="sql-drop-access-method"/> SQL commands. </para> <para> @@ -71,7 +71,7 @@ functions for the access method, which do all of the real work to access indexes. These support functions are plain C functions and are not visible or callable at the SQL level. The support functions are described - in <xref linkend="index-functions">. + in <xref linkend="index-functions"/>. </para> <para> @@ -153,7 +153,7 @@ typedef struct IndexAmRoutine These entries allow the planner to determine what kinds of query qualifications can be used with indexes of this access method. Operator families and classes are described - in <xref linkend="xindex">, which is prerequisite material for reading + in <xref linkend="xindex"/>, which is prerequisite material for reading this chapter. </para> @@ -177,7 +177,7 @@ typedef struct IndexAmRoutine <para> Some of the flag fields of <structname>IndexAmRoutine</structname> have nonobvious implications. The requirements of <structfield>amcanunique</structfield> - are discussed in <xref linkend="index-unique-checks">. + are discussed in <xref linkend="index-unique-checks"/>. The <structfield>amcanmulticol</structfield> flag asserts that the access method supports multicolumn indexes, while <structfield>amoptionalkey</structfield> asserts that it allows scans @@ -271,7 +271,7 @@ aminsert (Relation indexRelation, <structfield>amcanunique</structfield> flag is true) then <literal>checkUnique</literal> indicates the type of uniqueness check to perform. This varies depending on whether the unique constraint is - deferrable; see <xref linkend="index-unique-checks"> for details. + deferrable; see <xref linkend="index-unique-checks"/> for details. Normally the access method only needs the <literal>heapRelation</literal> parameter when performing uniqueness checking (since then it will have to look into the heap to verify tuple liveness). @@ -386,7 +386,7 @@ amcostestimate (PlannerInfo *root, double *indexCorrelation); </programlisting> Estimate the costs of an index scan. This function is described fully - in <xref linkend="index-cost-estimation">, below. + in <xref linkend="index-cost-estimation"/>, below. </para> <para> @@ -480,7 +480,7 @@ amvalidate (Oid opclassoid); The purpose of an index, of course, is to support scans for tuples matching an indexable <literal>WHERE</literal> condition, often called a <firstterm>qualifier</firstterm> or <firstterm>scan key</firstterm>. The semantics of - index scanning are described more fully in <xref linkend="index-scanning">, + index scanning are described more fully in <xref linkend="index-scanning"/>, below. An index access method can support <quote>plain</quote> index scans, <quote>bitmap</quote> index scans, or both. The scan-related functions that an index access method must or may provide are: @@ -594,7 +594,7 @@ amgetbitmap (IndexScanDesc scan, <function>amgetbitmap</function> and <function>amgettuple</function> cannot be used in the same index scan; there are other restrictions too when using <function>amgetbitmap</function>, as explained - in <xref linkend="index-scanning">. + in <xref linkend="index-scanning"/>. </para> <para> @@ -852,7 +852,7 @@ amparallelrescan (IndexScanDesc scan); index tuples. Finally, <function>amgetbitmap</function> does not guarantee any locking of the returned tuples, with implications - spelled out in <xref linkend="index-locking">. + spelled out in <xref linkend="index-locking"/>. </para> <para> @@ -901,7 +901,7 @@ amparallelrescan (IndexScanDesc scan); A new heap entry is made before making its index entries. (Therefore a concurrent index scan is likely to fail to see the heap entry. This is okay because the index reader would be uninterested in an - uncommitted row anyway. But see <xref linkend="index-unique-checks">.) + uncommitted row anyway. But see <xref linkend="index-unique-checks"/>.) </para> </listitem> <listitem> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/indices.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/indices.sgml index 248ed7e8eb0..0818196e766 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/indices.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/indices.sgml @@ -77,7 +77,7 @@ CREATE INDEX test1_id_index ON test1 (id); than a sequential table scan. But you might have to run the <command>ANALYZE</command> command regularly to update statistics to allow the query planner to make educated decisions. - See <xref linkend="performance-tips"> for information about + See <xref linkend="performance-tips"/> for information about how to find out whether an index is used and when and why the planner might choose <emphasis>not</emphasis> to use an index. </para> @@ -99,7 +99,7 @@ CREATE INDEX test1_id_index ON test1 (id); It is possible to allow writes to occur in parallel with index creation, but there are several caveats to be aware of — for more information see <xref linkend="sql-createindex-concurrently" - endterm="sql-createindex-concurrently-title">. + endterm="sql-createindex-concurrently-title"/>. </para> <para> @@ -161,7 +161,7 @@ CREATE INDEX test1_id_index ON test1 (id); <literal>col LIKE '%bar'</literal>. However, if your database does not use the C locale you will need to create the index with a special operator class to support indexing of pattern-matching queries; see - <xref linkend="indexes-opclass"> below. It is also possible to use + <xref linkend="indexes-opclass"/> below. It is also possible to use B-tree indexes for <literal>ILIKE</literal> and <literal>~*</literal>, but only if the pattern starts with non-alphabetic characters, i.e., characters that are not affected by @@ -226,13 +226,13 @@ CREATE INDEX <replaceable>name</replaceable> ON <replaceable>table</replaceable> <member><literal>&&</literal></member> </simplelist> - (See <xref linkend="functions-geometry"> for the meaning of + (See <xref linkend="functions-geometry"/> for the meaning of these operators.) The GiST operator classes included in the standard distribution are - documented in <xref linkend="gist-builtin-opclasses-table">. + documented in <xref linkend="gist-builtin-opclasses-table"/>. Many other GiST operator classes are available in the <literal>contrib</literal> collection or as separate - projects. For more information see <xref linkend="gist">. + projects. For more information see <xref linkend="gist"/>. </para> <para> @@ -244,7 +244,7 @@ SELECT * FROM places ORDER BY location <-> point '(101,456)' LIMIT 10; </programlisting> which finds the ten places closest to a given target point. The ability to do this is again dependent on the particular operator class being used. - In <xref linkend="gist-builtin-opclasses-table">, operators that can be + In <xref linkend="gist-builtin-opclasses-table"/>, operators that can be used in this way are listed in the column <quote>Ordering Operators</quote>. </para> @@ -274,11 +274,11 @@ SELECT * FROM places ORDER BY location <-> point '(101,456)' LIMIT 10; <member><literal>>^</literal></member> </simplelist> - (See <xref linkend="functions-geometry"> for the meaning of + (See <xref linkend="functions-geometry"/> for the meaning of these operators.) The SP-GiST operator classes included in the standard distribution are - documented in <xref linkend="spgist-builtin-opclasses-table">. - For more information see <xref linkend="spgist">. + documented in <xref linkend="spgist-builtin-opclasses-table"/>. + For more information see <xref linkend="spgist"/>. </para> <para> @@ -313,13 +313,13 @@ SELECT * FROM places ORDER BY location <-> point '(101,456)' LIMIT 10; <member><literal>&&</literal></member> </simplelist> - (See <xref linkend="functions-array"> for the meaning of + (See <xref linkend="functions-array"/> for the meaning of these operators.) The GIN operator classes included in the standard distribution are - documented in <xref linkend="gin-builtin-opclasses-table">. + documented in <xref linkend="gin-builtin-opclasses-table"/>. Many other GIN operator classes are available in the <literal>contrib</literal> collection or as separate - projects. For more information see <xref linkend="gin">. + projects. For more information see <xref linkend="gin"/>. </para> <para> @@ -351,8 +351,8 @@ SELECT * FROM places ORDER BY location <-> point '(101,456)' LIMIT 10; </simplelist> The BRIN operator classes included in the standard distribution are - documented in <xref linkend="brin-builtin-opclasses-table">. - For more information see <xref linkend="brin">. + documented in <xref linkend="brin-builtin-opclasses-table"/>. + For more information see <xref linkend="brin"/>. </para> </sect1> @@ -454,8 +454,8 @@ CREATE INDEX test2_mm_idx ON test2 (major, minor); an index on a single column is sufficient and saves space and time. Indexes with more than three columns are unlikely to be helpful unless the usage of the table is extremely stylized. See also - <xref linkend="indexes-bitmap-scans"> and - <xref linkend="indexes-index-only-scans"> for some discussion of the + <xref linkend="indexes-bitmap-scans"/> and + <xref linkend="indexes-index-only-scans"/> for some discussion of the merits of different index configurations. </para> </sect1> @@ -609,7 +609,7 @@ CREATE INDEX test3_desc_index ON test3 (id DESC NULLS LAST); process the queries that use both columns. You could also create a multicolumn index on <literal>(x, y)</literal>. This index would typically be more efficient than index combination for queries involving both - columns, but as discussed in <xref linkend="indexes-multicolumn">, it + columns, but as discussed in <xref linkend="indexes-multicolumn"/>, it would be almost useless for queries involving only <literal>y</literal>, so it should not be the only index. A combination of the multicolumn index and a separate index on <literal>y</literal> would serve reasonably well. For @@ -762,7 +762,7 @@ CREATE INDEX people_names ON people ((first_name || ' ' || last_name)); index at all. This reduces the size of the index, which will speed up those queries that do use the index. It will also speed up many table update operations because the index does not need to be - updated in all cases. <xref linkend="indexes-partial-ex1"> shows a + updated in all cases. <xref linkend="indexes-partial-ex1"/> shows a possible application of this idea. </para> @@ -827,7 +827,7 @@ WHERE client_ip = inet '192.168.100.23'; Another possible use for a partial index is to exclude values from the index that the typical query workload is not interested in; this is shown in <xref - linkend="indexes-partial-ex2">. This results in the same + linkend="indexes-partial-ex2"/>. This results in the same advantages as listed above, but it prevents the <quote>uninteresting</quote> values from being accessed via that index, even if an index scan might be profitable in that @@ -878,7 +878,7 @@ SELECT * FROM orders WHERE order_nr = 3501; </example> <para> - <xref linkend="indexes-partial-ex2"> also illustrates that the + <xref linkend="indexes-partial-ex2"/> also illustrates that the indexed column and the column used in the predicate do not need to match. <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partial indexes with arbitrary predicates, so long as only columns of the @@ -909,7 +909,7 @@ SELECT * FROM orders WHERE order_nr = 3501; A third possible use for partial indexes does not require the index to be used in queries at all. The idea here is to create a unique index over a subset of a table, as in <xref - linkend="indexes-partial-ex3">. This enforces uniqueness + linkend="indexes-partial-ex3"/>. This enforces uniqueness among the rows that satisfy the index predicate, without constraining those that do not. </para> @@ -962,8 +962,8 @@ CREATE UNIQUE INDEX tests_success_constraint ON tests (subject, target) <para> More information about partial indexes can be found in <xref - linkend="ston89b">, <xref linkend="olson93">, and <xref - linkend="seshadri95">. + linkend="ston89b"/>, <xref linkend="olson93"/>, and <xref + linkend="seshadri95"/>. </para> </sect1> @@ -1157,7 +1157,7 @@ CREATE INDEX test1c_content_y_index ON test1c (content COLLATE "y"); the index, the table rows they reference might be anywhere in the heap. The heap-access portion of an index scan thus involves a lot of random access into the heap, which can be slow, particularly on traditional - rotating media. (As described in <xref linkend="indexes-bitmap-scans">, + rotating media. (As described in <xref linkend="indexes-bitmap-scans"/>, bitmap scans try to alleviate this cost by doing the heap accesses in sorted order, but that only goes so far.) </para> @@ -1212,7 +1212,7 @@ SELECT x FROM tab WHERE x = 'key' AND z < 42; is physically possible. But there is an additional requirement for any table scan in <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: it must verify that each retrieved row be <quote>visible</quote> to the query's MVCC snapshot, as - discussed in <xref linkend="mvcc">. Visibility information is not stored + discussed in <xref linkend="mvcc"/>. Visibility information is not stored in index entries, only in heap entries; so at first glance it would seem that every row retrieval would require a heap access anyway. And this is indeed the case, if the table row has been modified recently. However, @@ -1289,7 +1289,7 @@ SELECT f(x) FROM tab WHERE f(x) < 1; <para> Partial indexes also have interesting interactions with index-only scans. - Consider the partial index shown in <xref linkend="indexes-partial-ex3">: + Consider the partial index shown in <xref linkend="indexes-partial-ex3"/>: <programlisting> CREATE UNIQUE INDEX tests_success_constraint ON tests (subject, target) WHERE success; @@ -1325,11 +1325,11 @@ SELECT target FROM tests WHERE subject = 'some-subject' AND success; maintenance or tuning, it is still important to check which indexes are actually used by the real-life query workload. Examining index usage for an individual query is done with the - <xref linkend="sql-explain"> + <xref linkend="sql-explain"/> command; its application for this purpose is - illustrated in <xref linkend="using-explain">. + illustrated in <xref linkend="using-explain"/>. It is also possible to gather overall statistics about index usage - in a running server, as described in <xref linkend="monitoring-stats">. + in a running server, as described in <xref linkend="monitoring-stats"/>. </para> <para> @@ -1343,7 +1343,7 @@ SELECT target FROM tests WHERE subject = 'some-subject' AND success; <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> - Always run <xref linkend="sql-analyze"> + Always run <xref linkend="sql-analyze"/> first. This command collects statistics about the distribution of the values in the table. This information is required to estimate the number of rows @@ -1353,8 +1353,8 @@ SELECT target FROM tests WHERE subject = 'some-subject' AND success; almost certain to be inaccurate. Examining an application's index usage without having run <command>ANALYZE</command> is therefore a lost cause. - See <xref linkend="vacuum-for-statistics"> - and <xref linkend="autovacuum"> for more information. + See <xref linkend="vacuum-for-statistics"/> + and <xref linkend="autovacuum"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> @@ -1386,7 +1386,7 @@ SELECT target FROM tests WHERE subject = 'some-subject' AND success; <para> When indexes are not used, it can be useful for testing to force their use. There are run-time parameters that can turn off - various plan types (see <xref linkend="runtime-config-query-enable">). + various plan types (see <xref linkend="runtime-config-query-enable"/>). For instance, turning off sequential scans (<varname>enable_seqscan</varname>) and nested-loop joins (<varname>enable_nestloop</varname>), which are the most basic plans, @@ -1417,11 +1417,11 @@ SELECT target FROM tests WHERE subject = 'some-subject' AND success; per-row costs of each plan node times the selectivity estimate of the plan node. The costs estimated for the plan nodes can be adjusted via run-time parameters (described in <xref - linkend="runtime-config-query-constants">). + linkend="runtime-config-query-constants"/>). An inaccurate selectivity estimate is due to insufficient statistics. It might be possible to improve this by tuning the statistics-gathering parameters (see - <xref linkend="sql-altertable">). + <xref linkend="sql-altertable"/>). </para> <para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/information_schema.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/information_schema.sgml index 58c54254d7b..99b0ea8519e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/information_schema.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/information_schema.sgml @@ -579,7 +579,7 @@ </table> <para> - See also under <xref linkend="infoschema-columns">, a similarly + See also under <xref linkend="infoschema-columns"/>, a similarly structured view, for further information on some of the columns. </para> </sect1> @@ -776,7 +776,7 @@ <entry><literal>sql_identifier</literal></entry> <entry> The <quote>specific name</quote> of the function. See <xref - linkend="infoschema-routines"> for more information. + linkend="infoschema-routines"/> for more information. </entry> </row> </tbody> @@ -895,7 +895,7 @@ identifies which character set the available collations are applicable to. In PostgreSQL, there is only one character set per database (see explanation - in <xref linkend="infoschema-character-sets">), so this view does + in <xref linkend="infoschema-character-sets"/>), so this view does not provide much useful information. </para> @@ -1178,7 +1178,7 @@ that use data types owned by a currently enabled role. Note that in <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>, built-in data types behave like user-defined types, so they are included here as well. See - also <xref linkend="infoschema-columns"> for details. + also <xref linkend="infoschema-columns"/> for details. </para> <table> @@ -3134,7 +3134,7 @@ ORDER BY c.ordinal_position; <entry><type>sql_identifier</type></entry> <entry> The <quote>specific name</quote> of the function. See <xref - linkend="infoschema-routines"> for more information. + linkend="infoschema-routines"/> for more information. </entry> </row> @@ -3594,7 +3594,7 @@ ORDER BY c.ordinal_position; <entry><type>sql_identifier</type></entry> <entry> The <quote>specific name</quote> of the function. See <xref - linkend="infoschema-routines"> for more information. + linkend="infoschema-routines"/> for more information. </entry> </row> @@ -3930,7 +3930,7 @@ ORDER BY c.ordinal_position; <entry><type>sql_identifier</type></entry> <entry> The <quote>specific name</quote> of the function. See <xref - linkend="infoschema-routines"> for more information. + linkend="infoschema-routines"/> for more information. </entry> </row> @@ -4762,7 +4762,7 @@ ORDER BY c.ordinal_position; The table <literal>sql_features</literal> contains information about which formal features defined in the SQL standard are supported by <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>. This is the - same information that is presented in <xref linkend="features">. + same information that is presented in <xref linkend="features"/>. There you can also find some additional background information. </para> @@ -4998,7 +4998,7 @@ ORDER BY c.ordinal_position; The table <literal>sql_packages</literal> contains information about which feature packages defined in the SQL standard are supported by <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>. Refer to <xref - linkend="features"> for background information on feature packages. + linkend="features"/> for background information on feature packages. </para> <table> @@ -5586,7 +5586,7 @@ ORDER BY c.ordinal_position; <entry><literal>sql_identifier</literal></entry> <entry> The <quote>specific name</quote> of the function. See <xref - linkend="infoschema-routines"> for more information. + linkend="infoschema-routines"/> for more information. </entry> </row> @@ -5891,9 +5891,9 @@ ORDER BY c.ordinal_position; <literal>USAGE</literal> privileges granted on user-defined types to a currently enabled role or by a currently enabled role. There is one row for each combination of type, grantor, and grantee. This view shows only - composite types (see under <xref linkend="infoschema-user-defined-types"> + composite types (see under <xref linkend="infoschema-user-defined-types"/> for why); see - <xref linkend="infoschema-usage-privileges"> for domain privileges. + <xref linkend="infoschema-usage-privileges"/> for domain privileges. </para> <table> @@ -6068,7 +6068,7 @@ ORDER BY c.ordinal_position; differentiate between these. Other user-defined types such as base types and enums, which are <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> extensions, are not shown here. For domains, - see <xref linkend="infoschema-domains"> instead. + see <xref linkend="infoschema-domains"/> instead. </para> <table> @@ -6522,7 +6522,7 @@ ORDER BY c.ordinal_position; <entry><literal>sql_identifier</literal></entry> <entry> The <quote>specific name</quote> of the function. See <xref - linkend="infoschema-routines"> for more information. + linkend="infoschema-routines"/> for more information. </entry> </row> </tbody> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/install-windows.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/install-windows.sgml index 029e1dbc285..99e9c7b78ee 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/install-windows.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/install-windows.sgml @@ -37,8 +37,8 @@ <para> Building using <productname>MinGW</productname> or <productname>Cygwin</productname> uses the normal build system, see - <xref linkend="installation"> and the specific notes in - <xref linkend="installation-notes-mingw"> and <xref linkend="installation-notes-cygwin">. + <xref linkend="installation"/> and the specific notes in + <xref linkend="installation-notes-mingw"/> and <xref linkend="installation-notes-cygwin"/>. To produce native 64 bit binaries in these environments, use the tools from <productname>MinGW-w64</productname>. These tools can also be used to cross-compile for 32 bit and 64 bit <productname>Windows</productname> @@ -457,7 +457,7 @@ $ENV{CONFIG}="Debug"; </screen> For more information about the regression tests, see - <xref linkend="regress">. + <xref linkend="regress"/>. </para> <para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/installation.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/installation.sgml index f8e1d60356a..a922819fce9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/installation.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/installation.sgml @@ -54,7 +54,7 @@ su - postgres In general, a modern Unix-compatible platform should be able to run <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>. The platforms that had received specific testing at the - time of release are listed in <xref linkend="supported-platforms"> + time of release are listed in <xref linkend="supported-platforms"/> below. In the <filename>doc</filename> subdirectory of the distribution there are several platform-specific <acronym>FAQ</acronym> documents you might wish to consult if you are having trouble. @@ -193,7 +193,7 @@ su - postgres required version is <productname>Python</productname> 2.4. <productname>Python 3</productname> is supported if it's version 3.1 or later; but see - <xref linkend="plpython-python23"> + <xref linkend="plpython-python23"/> when using Python 3. </para> @@ -262,7 +262,7 @@ su - postgres <para> To build the <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> documentation, there is a separate set of requirements; see - <xref linkend="docguide-toolsets">. + <xref linkend="docguide-toolsets"/>. </para> </listitem> </itemizedlist> @@ -358,7 +358,7 @@ su - postgres <para> You can also get the source directly from the version control repository, see - <xref linkend="sourcerepo">. + <xref linkend="sourcerepo"/>. </para> </sect1> @@ -835,8 +835,8 @@ su - postgres <para> Build with <acronym>LDAP</acronym><indexterm><primary>LDAP</primary></indexterm> support for authentication and connection parameter lookup (see - <phrase id="install-ldap-links"><xref linkend="libpq-ldap"> and - <xref linkend="auth-ldap"></phrase> for more information). On Unix, + <phrase id="install-ldap-links"><xref linkend="libpq-ldap"/> and + <xref linkend="auth-ldap"/></phrase> for more information). On Unix, this requires the <productname>OpenLDAP</productname> package to be installed. On Windows, the default <productname>WinLDAP</productname> library is used. <filename>configure</filename> will check for the required @@ -855,7 +855,7 @@ su - postgres for <application>systemd</application><indexterm><primary>systemd</primary></indexterm> service notifications. This improves integration if the server binary is started under <application>systemd</application> but has no impact - otherwise<phrase condition="standalone-ignore">; see <xref linkend="server-start"> for more + otherwise<phrase condition="standalone-ignore">; see <xref linkend="server-start"/> for more information</phrase>. <application>libsystemd</application> and the associated header files need to be installed to be able to use this option. @@ -901,7 +901,7 @@ su - postgres <term><option>--with-uuid=<replaceable>LIBRARY</replaceable></option></term> <listitem> <para> - Build the <xref linkend="uuid-ossp"> module + Build the <xref linkend="uuid-ossp"/> module (which provides functions to generate UUIDs), using the specified UUID library.<indexterm><primary>UUID</primary></indexterm> <replaceable>LIBRARY</replaceable> must be one of: @@ -968,7 +968,7 @@ su - postgres <listitem> <para> Use libxslt when building the - <xref linkend="xml2"> + <xref linkend="xml2"/> module. <application>xml2</application> relies on this library to perform XSL transformations of XML. </para> @@ -1084,7 +1084,7 @@ su - postgres has no support for strong random numbers on the platform. A source of random numbers is needed for some authentication protocols, as well as some routines in the - <xref linkend="pgcrypto"> + <xref linkend="pgcrypto"/> module. <option>--disable-strong-random</option> disables functionality that requires cryptographically strong random numbers, and substitutes a weak pseudo-random-number-generator for the generation of @@ -1188,7 +1188,7 @@ su - postgres code coverage testing instrumentation. When run, they generate files in the build directory with code coverage metrics. - <phrase condition="standalone-ignore">See <xref linkend="regress-coverage"> + <phrase condition="standalone-ignore">See <xref linkend="regress-coverage"/> for more information.</phrase> This option is for use only with GCC and when doing development work. </para> @@ -1249,7 +1249,7 @@ su - postgres </indexterm> Compiles <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> with support for the dynamic tracing tool DTrace. - <phrase condition="standalone-ignore">See <xref linkend="dynamic-trace"> + <phrase condition="standalone-ignore">See <xref linkend="dynamic-trace"/> for more information.</phrase> </para> @@ -1285,7 +1285,7 @@ su - postgres <para> Enable tests using the Perl TAP tools. This requires a Perl installation and the Perl module <literal>IPC::Run</literal>. - <phrase condition="standalone-ignore">See <xref linkend="regress-tap"> for more information.</phrase> + <phrase condition="standalone-ignore">See <xref linkend="regress-tap"/> for more information.</phrase> </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -1442,7 +1442,7 @@ su - postgres whether Python 2 or 3 is specified here (or otherwise implicitly chosen) determines which variant of the PL/Python language becomes available. See - <xref linkend="plpython-python23"> + <xref linkend="plpython-python23"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> @@ -1569,7 +1569,7 @@ PostgreSQL, contrib, and documentation successfully made. Ready to install. <userinput>make check</userinput> </screen> (This won't work as root; do it as an unprivileged user.) - See <xref linkend="regress"> for + See <xref linkend="regress"/> for detailed information about interpreting the test results. You can repeat this test at any later time by issuing the same command. </para> @@ -1581,7 +1581,7 @@ PostgreSQL, contrib, and documentation successfully made. Ready to install. <note> <para> If you are upgrading an existing system be sure to read - <xref linkend="upgrading">, + <xref linkend="upgrading"/>, which has instructions about upgrading a cluster. </para> @@ -1593,7 +1593,7 @@ PostgreSQL, contrib, and documentation successfully made. Ready to install. <userinput>make install</userinput> </screen> This will install files into the directories that were specified - in <xref linkend="configure">. Make sure that you have appropriate + in <xref linkend="configure"/>. Make sure that you have appropriate permissions to write into that area. Normally you need to do this step as root. Alternatively, you can create the target directories in advance and arrange for appropriate permissions to @@ -1727,7 +1727,7 @@ export LD_LIBRARY_PATH setenv LD_LIBRARY_PATH /usr/local/pgsql/lib </programlisting> Replace <literal>/usr/local/pgsql/lib</literal> with whatever you set - <option><literal>--libdir</literal></option> to in <xref linkend="configure">. + <option><literal>--libdir</literal></option> to in <xref linkend="configure"/>. You should put these commands into a shell start-up file such as <filename>/etc/profile</filename> or <filename>~/.bash_profile</filename>. Some good information about the caveats associated with this method can @@ -1793,7 +1793,7 @@ libpq.so.2.1: cannot open shared object file: No such file or directory If you installed into <filename>/usr/local/pgsql</filename> or some other location that is not searched for programs by default, you should add <filename>/usr/local/pgsql/bin</filename> (or whatever you set - <option><literal>--bindir</literal></option> to in <xref linkend="configure">) + <option><literal>--bindir</literal></option> to in <xref linkend="configure"/>) into your <envar>PATH</envar>. Strictly speaking, this is not necessary, but it will make the use of <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> much more convenient. @@ -1873,7 +1873,7 @@ export MANPATH Other Unix-like systems may also work but are not currently being tested. In most cases, all CPU architectures supported by a given operating system will work. Look in - <xref linkend="installation-platform-notes"> below to see if + <xref linkend="installation-platform-notes"/> below to see if there is information specific to your operating system, particularly if using an older system. </para> @@ -1895,8 +1895,8 @@ export MANPATH This section documents additional platform-specific issues regarding the installation and setup of PostgreSQL. Be sure to read the installation instructions, and in - particular <xref linkend="install-requirements"> as well. Also, - check <xref linkend="regress"> regarding the + particular <xref linkend="install-requirements"/> as well. Also, + check <xref linkend="regress"/> regarding the interpretation of regression test results. </para> @@ -2247,7 +2247,7 @@ ERROR: could not load library "/opt/dbs/pgsql/lib/plperl.so": Bad address <para> PostgreSQL can be built using Cygwin, a Linux-like environment for Windows, but that method is inferior to the native Windows build - <phrase condition="standalone-ignore">(see <xref linkend="install-windows">)</phrase> and + <phrase condition="standalone-ignore">(see <xref linkend="install-windows"/>)</phrase> and running a server under Cygwin is no longer recommended. </para> @@ -2441,7 +2441,7 @@ PHSS_30849 s700_800 u2comp/be/plugin library Patch Microsoft's <productname>Visual C++</productname> compiler suite. The MinGW build variant uses the normal build system described in this chapter; the Visual C++ build works completely differently - and is described in <xref linkend="install-windows">. + and is described in <xref linkend="install-windows"/>. It is a fully native build and uses no additional software like MinGW. A ready-made installer is available on the main PostgreSQL web site. @@ -2602,7 +2602,7 @@ LIBOBJS = snprintf.o <title>Using DTrace for Tracing PostgreSQL</title> <para> - Yes, using DTrace is possible. See <xref linkend="dynamic-trace"> for + Yes, using DTrace is possible. See <xref linkend="dynamic-trace"/> for further information. </para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/intarray.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/intarray.sgml index 0cf9d5f3f63..b633cf36778 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/intarray.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/intarray.sgml @@ -29,8 +29,8 @@ <para> The functions provided by the <filename>intarray</filename> module - are shown in <xref linkend="intarray-func-table">, the operators - in <xref linkend="intarray-op-table">. + are shown in <xref linkend="intarray-func-table"/>, the operators + in <xref linkend="intarray-op-table"/>. </para> <table id="intarray-func-table"> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/intro.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/intro.sgml index 2fb19725f04..3038826311a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/intro.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/intro.sgml @@ -23,13 +23,13 @@ <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> - <xref linkend="tutorial"> is an informal introduction for new users. + <xref linkend="tutorial"/> is an informal introduction for new users. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - <xref linkend="sql"> documents the <acronym>SQL</acronym> query + <xref linkend="sql"/> documents the <acronym>SQL</acronym> query language environment, including data types and functions, as well as user-level performance tuning. Every <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> user should read this. @@ -38,7 +38,7 @@ <listitem> <para> - <xref linkend="admin"> describes the installation and + <xref linkend="admin"/> describes the installation and administration of the server. Everyone who runs a <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> server, be it for private use or for others, should read this part. @@ -47,7 +47,7 @@ <listitem> <para> - <xref linkend="client-interfaces"> describes the programming + <xref linkend="client-interfaces"/> describes the programming interfaces for <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> client programs. </para> @@ -56,7 +56,7 @@ <listitem> <para> - <xref linkend="server-programming"> contains information for + <xref linkend="server-programming"/> contains information for advanced users about the extensibility capabilities of the server. Topics include user-defined data types and functions. @@ -65,7 +65,7 @@ <listitem> <para> - <xref linkend="reference"> contains reference information about + <xref linkend="reference"/> contains reference information about SQL commands, client and server programs. This part supports the other parts with structured information sorted by command or program. @@ -74,7 +74,7 @@ <listitem> <para> - <xref linkend="internals"> contains assorted information that might be of + <xref linkend="internals"/> contains assorted information that might be of use to <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> developers. </para> </listitem> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/isn.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/isn.sgml index 329b7b2c54d..34d37ede018 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/isn.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/isn.sgml @@ -25,7 +25,7 @@ <title>Data Types</title> <para> - <xref linkend="isn-datatypes"> shows the data types provided by + <xref linkend="isn-datatypes"/> shows the data types provided by the <filename>isn</filename> module. </para> @@ -222,7 +222,7 @@ <para> The <filename>isn</filename> module provides the standard comparison operators, plus B-tree and hash indexing support for all these data types. In - addition there are several specialized functions; shown in <xref linkend="isn-functions">. + addition there are several specialized functions; shown in <xref linkend="isn-functions"/>. In this table, <type>isn</type> means any one of the module's data types. </para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/json.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/json.sgml index 05ecef2ffc9..731b4696139 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/json.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/json.sgml @@ -18,7 +18,7 @@ the JSON data types have the advantage of enforcing that each stored value is valid according to the JSON rules. There are also assorted JSON-specific functions and operators available for data stored - in these data types; see <xref linkend="functions-json">. + in these data types; see <xref linkend="functions-json"/>. </para> <para> @@ -82,7 +82,7 @@ <note> <para> Many of the JSON processing functions described - in <xref linkend="functions-json"> will convert Unicode escapes to + in <xref linkend="functions-json"/> will convert Unicode escapes to regular characters, and will therefore throw the same types of errors just described even if their input is of type <type>json</type> not <type>jsonb</type>. The fact that the <type>json</type> input function does @@ -98,7 +98,7 @@ When converting textual JSON input into <type>jsonb</type>, the primitive types described by <acronym>RFC</acronym> 7159 are effectively mapped onto native <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> types, as shown - in <xref linkend="json-type-mapping-table">. + in <xref linkend="json-type-mapping-table"/>. Therefore, there are some minor additional constraints on what constitutes valid <type>jsonb</type> data that do not apply to the <type>json</type> type, nor to JSON in the abstract, corresponding @@ -380,7 +380,7 @@ SELECT doc->'site_name' FROM websites <para> The various containment and existence operators, along with all other JSON operators and functions are documented - in <xref linkend="functions-json">. + in <xref linkend="functions-json"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -404,7 +404,7 @@ SELECT doc->'site_name' FROM websites and <literal>?|</literal> operators and path/value-exists operator <literal>@></literal>. (For details of the semantics that these operators - implement, see <xref linkend="functions-jsonb-op-table">.) + implement, see <xref linkend="functions-jsonb-op-table"/>.) An example of creating an index with this operator class is: <programlisting> CREATE INDEX idxgin ON api USING GIN (jdoc); @@ -465,7 +465,7 @@ CREATE INDEX idxgintags ON api USING GIN ((jdoc -> 'tags')); operator <literal>?</literal> to the indexed expression <literal>jdoc -> 'tags'</literal>. (More information on expression indexes can be found in <xref - linkend="indexes-expressional">.) + linkend="indexes-expressional"/>.) </para> <para> Another approach to querying is to exploit containment, for example: diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/keywords.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/keywords.sgml index 01bc9b47b17..2dba7adedfe 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/keywords.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/keywords.sgml @@ -9,10 +9,10 @@ </indexterm> <para> - <xref linkend="keywords-table"> lists all tokens that are key words + <xref linkend="keywords-table"/> lists all tokens that are key words in the SQL standard and in <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> &version;. Background information can be found in <xref - linkend="sql-syntax-identifiers">. + linkend="sql-syntax-identifiers"/>. (For space reasons, only the latest two versions of the SQL standard, and SQL-92 for historical comparison, are included. The differences between those and the other intermediate standard versions are small.) @@ -45,7 +45,7 @@ </para> <para> - In <xref linkend="keywords-table"> in the column for + In <xref linkend="keywords-table"/> in the column for <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> we classify as <quote>non-reserved</quote> those key words that are explicitly known to the parser but are allowed as column or table names. @@ -69,7 +69,7 @@ <para> It is important to understand before studying <xref - linkend="keywords-table"> that the fact that a key word is not + linkend="keywords-table"/> that the fact that a key word is not reserved in <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> does not mean that the feature related to the word is not implemented. Conversely, the presence of a key word does not indicate the existence of a feature. diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/libpq.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/libpq.sgml index 694921f2126..4703309254a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/libpq.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/libpq.sgml @@ -25,15 +25,15 @@ those written for C++, Perl, Python, Tcl and <application>ECPG</application>. So some aspects of <application>libpq</application>'s behavior will be important to you if you use one of those packages. In particular, - <xref linkend="libpq-envars">, - <xref linkend="libpq-pgpass"> and - <xref linkend="libpq-ssl"> + <xref linkend="libpq-envars"/>, + <xref linkend="libpq-pgpass"/> and + <xref linkend="libpq-ssl"/> describe behavior that is visible to the user of any application that uses <application>libpq</application>. </para> <para> - Some short programs are included at the end of this chapter (<xref linkend="libpq-example">) to show how + Some short programs are included at the end of this chapter (<xref linkend="libpq-example"/>) to show how to write programs that use <application>libpq</application>. There are also several complete examples of <application>libpq</application> applications in the directory <filename>src/test/examples</filename> in the source code distribution. @@ -118,7 +118,7 @@ PGconn *PQconnectdbParams(const char * const *keywords, <para> The currently recognized parameter key words are listed in - <xref linkend="libpq-paramkeywords">. + <xref linkend="libpq-paramkeywords"/>. </para> <para> @@ -128,7 +128,7 @@ PGconn *PQconnectdbParams(const char * const *keywords, <parameter>dbname</parameter> is expanded this way, any subsequent <parameter>dbname</parameter> value is processed as plain database name. More details on the possible connection string formats appear in - <xref linkend="libpq-connstring">. + <xref linkend="libpq-connstring"/>. </para> <para> @@ -140,7 +140,7 @@ PGconn *PQconnectdbParams(const char * const *keywords, <para> If any parameter is <symbol>NULL</symbol> or an empty string, the corresponding - environment variable (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars">) is checked. + environment variable (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars"/>) is checked. If the environment variable is not set either, then the indicated built-in defaults are used. </para> @@ -176,7 +176,7 @@ PGconn *PQconnectdb(const char *conninfo); The passed string can be empty to use all default parameters, or it can contain one or more parameter settings separated by whitespace, or it can contain a <acronym>URI</acronym>. - See <xref linkend="libpq-connstring"> for details. + See <xref linkend="libpq-connstring"/> for details. </para> @@ -289,7 +289,7 @@ PostgresPollingStatusType PQconnectPoll(PGconn *conn); <para> The <literal>hostaddr</literal> and <literal>host</literal> parameters are used appropriately to ensure that name and reverse name queries are not made. See the documentation of - these parameters in <xref linkend="libpq-paramkeywords"> for details. + these parameters in <xref linkend="libpq-paramkeywords"/> for details. </para> </listitem> @@ -802,7 +802,7 @@ host=localhost port=5432 dbname=mydb connect_timeout=10 <para> The recognized parameter key words are listed in <xref - linkend="libpq-paramkeywords">. + linkend="libpq-paramkeywords"/>. </para> </sect3> @@ -847,7 +847,7 @@ postgresql:///mydb?host=localhost&port=5433 <para> Any connection parameters not corresponding to key words listed in <xref - linkend="libpq-paramkeywords"> are ignored and a warning message about them + linkend="libpq-paramkeywords"/> are ignored and a warning message about them is sent to <filename>stderr</filename>. </para> @@ -867,7 +867,7 @@ postgresql://[2001:db8::1234]/database <para> The host component is interpreted as described for the parameter <xref - linkend="libpq-connect-host">. In particular, a Unix-domain socket + linkend="libpq-connect-host"/>. In particular, a Unix-domain socket connection is chosen if the host part is either empty or starts with a slash, otherwise a TCP/IP connection is initiated. Note, however, that the slash is a reserved character in the hierarchical part of the URI. So, to @@ -954,7 +954,7 @@ postgresql://%2Fvar%2Flib%2Fpostgresql/dbname <para> A comma-separated list of host names is also accepted, in which case each host name in the list is tried in order. See - <xref linkend="libpq-multiple-hosts"> for details. + <xref linkend="libpq-multiple-hosts"/> for details. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -1006,13 +1006,13 @@ postgresql://%2Fvar%2Flib%2Fpostgresql/dbname is not the name of the server at network address <literal>hostaddr</literal>. Also, note that <literal>host</literal> rather than <literal>hostaddr</literal> is used to identify the connection in a password file (see - <xref linkend="libpq-pgpass">). + <xref linkend="libpq-pgpass"/>). </para> <para> A comma-separated list of <literal>hostaddrs</literal> is also accepted, in which case each host in the list is tried in order. See - <xref linkend="libpq-multiple-hosts"> for details. + <xref linkend="libpq-multiple-hosts"/> for details. </para> <para> Without either a host name or host address, @@ -1044,7 +1044,7 @@ postgresql://%2Fvar%2Flib%2Fpostgresql/dbname <para> The database name. Defaults to be the same as the user name. In certain contexts, the value is checked for extended - formats; see <xref linkend="libpq-connstring"> for more details on + formats; see <xref linkend="libpq-connstring"/> for more details on those. </para> </listitem> @@ -1075,7 +1075,7 @@ postgresql://%2Fvar%2Flib%2Fpostgresql/dbname <listitem> <para> Specifies the name of the file used to store passwords - (see <xref linkend="libpq-pgpass">). + (see <xref linkend="libpq-pgpass"/>). Defaults to <filename>~/.pgpass</filename>, or <filename>%APPDATA%\postgresql\pgpass.conf</filename> on Microsoft Windows. (No error is reported if this file does not exist.) @@ -1125,7 +1125,7 @@ postgresql://%2Fvar%2Flib%2Fpostgresql/dbname separate command-line arguments, unless escaped with a backslash (<literal>\</literal>); write <literal>\\</literal> to represent a literal backslash. For a detailed discussion of the available - options, consult <xref linkend="runtime-config">. + options, consult <xref linkend="runtime-config"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -1134,7 +1134,7 @@ postgresql://%2Fvar%2Flib%2Fpostgresql/dbname <term><literal>application_name</literal></term> <listitem> <para> - Specifies a value for the <xref linkend="guc-application-name"> + Specifies a value for the <xref linkend="guc-application-name"/> configuration parameter. </para> </listitem> @@ -1145,7 +1145,7 @@ postgresql://%2Fvar%2Flib%2Fpostgresql/dbname <listitem> <para> Specifies a fallback value for the <xref - linkend="guc-application-name"> configuration parameter. + linkend="guc-application-name"/> configuration parameter. This value will be used if no value has been given for <literal>application_name</literal> via a connection parameter or the <envar>PGAPPNAME</envar> environment variable. Specifying @@ -1295,7 +1295,7 @@ postgresql://%2Fvar%2Flib%2Fpostgresql/dbname </varlistentry> </variablelist> - See <xref linkend="libpq-ssl"> for a detailed description of how + See <xref linkend="libpq-ssl"/> for a detailed description of how these options work. </para> @@ -1430,7 +1430,7 @@ postgresql://%2Fvar%2Flib%2Fpostgresql/dbname to ensure that you are connected to a server run by a trusted user.) This option is only supported on platforms for which the <literal>peer</literal> authentication method is implemented; see - <xref linkend="auth-peer">. + <xref linkend="auth-peer"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -1442,7 +1442,7 @@ postgresql://%2Fvar%2Flib%2Fpostgresql/dbname Kerberos service name to use when authenticating with GSSAPI. This must match the service name specified in the server configuration for Kerberos authentication to succeed. (See also - <xref linkend="gssapi-auth">.) + <xref linkend="gssapi-auth"/>.) </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -1465,7 +1465,7 @@ postgresql://%2Fvar%2Flib%2Fpostgresql/dbname Service name to use for additional parameters. It specifies a service name in <filename>pg_service.conf</filename> that holds additional connection parameters. This allows applications to specify only a service name so connection parameters - can be centrally maintained. See <xref linkend="libpq-pgservice">. + can be centrally maintained. See <xref linkend="libpq-pgservice"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -2225,7 +2225,7 @@ PGresult *PQexec(PGconn *conn, const char *command); <function>PQexec</function> call are processed in a single transaction, unless there are explicit <command>BEGIN</command>/<command>COMMIT</command> commands included in the query string to divide it into multiple - transactions. (See <xref linkend="protocol-flow-multi-statement"> + transactions. (See <xref linkend="protocol-flow-multi-statement"/> for more details about how the server handles multi-query strings.) Note however that the returned <structname>PGresult</structname> structure describes only the result @@ -2447,7 +2447,7 @@ PGresult *PQprepare(PGconn *conn, <function>PQprepare</function> creates a prepared statement for later execution with <function>PQexecPrepared</function>. This feature allows commands to be executed repeatedly without being parsed and - planned each time; see <xref linkend="sql-prepare"> for details. + planned each time; see <xref linkend="sql-prepare"/> for details. <function>PQprepare</function> is supported only in protocol 3.0 and later connections; it will fail when using protocol 2.0. </para> @@ -2489,10 +2489,10 @@ PGresult *PQprepare(PGconn *conn, </variablelist> Prepared statements for use with <function>PQexecPrepared</function> can also - be created by executing SQL <xref linkend="sql-prepare"> + be created by executing SQL <xref linkend="sql-prepare"/> statements. Also, although there is no <application>libpq</application> function for deleting a prepared statement, the SQL <xref - linkend="sql-deallocate"> statement + linkend="sql-deallocate"/> statement can be used for that purpose. </para> @@ -2746,7 +2746,7 @@ ExecStatusType PQresultStatus(const PGresult *res); The <structname>PGresult</structname> contains a single result tuple from the current command. This status occurs only when single-row mode has been selected for the query - (see <xref linkend="libpq-single-row-mode">). + (see <xref linkend="libpq-single-row-mode"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -2770,7 +2770,7 @@ ExecStatusType PQresultStatus(const PGresult *res); never be returned directly by <function>PQexec</function> or other query execution functions; results of this kind are instead passed to the notice processor (see <xref - linkend="libpq-notice-processing">). + linkend="libpq-notice-processing"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -2941,7 +2941,7 @@ char *PQresultErrorField(const PGresult *res, int fieldcode); front-end applications to perform specific operations (such as error handling) in response to a particular database error. For a list of the possible SQLSTATE codes, see <xref - linkend="errcodes-appendix">. This field is not localizable, + linkend="errcodes-appendix"/>. This field is not localizable, and is always present. </para> </listitem> @@ -3118,7 +3118,7 @@ char *PQresultErrorField(const PGresult *res, int fieldcode); <para> The fields for schema name, table name, column name, data type name, and constraint name are supplied only for a limited number of error - types; see <xref linkend="errcodes-appendix">. Do not assume that + types; see <xref linkend="errcodes-appendix"/>. Do not assume that the presence of any of these fields guarantees the presence of another field. Core error sources observe the interrelationships noted above, but user-defined functions may use these fields in other @@ -4075,7 +4075,7 @@ unsigned char *PQescapeByteaConn(PGconn *conn, <type>bytea</type> literal in an <acronym>SQL</acronym> statement. <function>PQescapeByteaConn</function> escapes bytes using either hex encoding or backslash escaping. See <xref - linkend="datatype-binary"> for more information. + linkend="datatype-binary"/> for more information. </para> <para> @@ -4508,7 +4508,7 @@ PGresult *PQgetResult(PGconn *conn); Another frequently-desired feature that can be obtained with <function>PQsendQuery</function> and <function>PQgetResult</function> is retrieving large query results a row at a time. This is discussed - in <xref linkend="libpq-single-row-mode">. + in <xref linkend="libpq-single-row-mode"/>. </para> <para> @@ -4600,14 +4600,14 @@ int PQisBusy(PGconn *conn); <function>PQgetResult</function> if <function>PQisBusy</function> returns false (0). It can also call <function>PQnotifies</function> to detect <command>NOTIFY</command> messages (see <xref - linkend="libpq-notify">). + linkend="libpq-notify"/>). </para> <para> A client that uses <function>PQsendQuery</function>/<function>PQgetResult</function> can also attempt to cancel a command that is still being processed - by the server; see <xref linkend="libpq-cancel">. But regardless of + by the server; see <xref linkend="libpq-cancel"/>. But regardless of the return value of <function>PQcancel</function>, the application must continue with the normal result-reading sequence using <function>PQgetResult</function>. A successful cancellation will @@ -4753,7 +4753,7 @@ int PQflush(PGconn *conn); (or a sibling function). This mode selection is effective only for the currently executing query. Then call <function>PQgetResult</function> repeatedly, until it returns null, as documented in <xref - linkend="libpq-async">. If the query returns any rows, they are returned + linkend="libpq-async"/>. If the query returns any rows, they are returned as individual <structname>PGresult</structname> objects, which look like normal query results except for having status code <literal>PGRES_SINGLE_TUPLE</literal> instead of @@ -5119,7 +5119,7 @@ typedef struct pgNotify </para> <para> - <xref linkend="libpq-example-2"> gives a sample program that illustrates + <xref linkend="libpq-example-2"/> gives a sample program that illustrates the use of asynchronous notification. </para> @@ -5242,7 +5242,7 @@ typedef struct pgNotify 0 indicates the overall copy format is textual (rows separated by newlines, columns separated by separator characters, etc). 1 indicates the overall copy format is binary. See <xref - linkend="sql-copy"> for more information. + linkend="sql-copy"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -5322,7 +5322,7 @@ int PQputCopyData(PGconn *conn, into buffer loads of any convenient size. Buffer-load boundaries have no semantic significance when sending. The contents of the data stream must match the data format expected by the - <command>COPY</command> command; see <xref linkend="sql-copy"> for details. + <command>COPY</command> command; see <xref linkend="sql-copy"/> for details. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -5982,7 +5982,7 @@ char *PQencryptPasswordConn(PGconn *conn, const char *passwd, const char *user, version 10, and will not work correctly with older server versions. If <parameter>algorithm</parameter> is <symbol>NULL</symbol>, this function will query the server for the current value of the - <xref linkend="guc-password-encryption"> setting. That can block, and + <xref linkend="guc-password-encryption"/> setting. That can block, and will fail if the current transaction is aborted, or if the connection is busy executing another query. If you wish to use the default algorithm for the server but want to avoid blocking, query @@ -6072,7 +6072,7 @@ PGresult *PQmakeEmptyPGresult(PGconn *conn, ExecStatusType status); <listitem> <para> Fires a <literal>PGEVT_RESULTCREATE</literal> event (see <xref - linkend="libpq-events">) for each event procedure registered in the + linkend="libpq-events"/>) for each event procedure registered in the <structname>PGresult</structname> object. Returns non-zero for success, zero if any event procedure fails. @@ -7004,7 +7004,7 @@ myEventProc(PGEventId evtId, void *evtInfo, void *passThrough) <primary><envar>PGHOST</envar></primary> </indexterm> <envar>PGHOST</envar> behaves the same as the <xref - linkend="libpq-connect-host"> connection parameter. + linkend="libpq-connect-host"/> connection parameter. </para> </listitem> @@ -7014,7 +7014,7 @@ myEventProc(PGEventId evtId, void *evtInfo, void *passThrough) <primary><envar>PGHOSTADDR</envar></primary> </indexterm> <envar>PGHOSTADDR</envar> behaves the same as the <xref - linkend="libpq-connect-hostaddr"> connection parameter. + linkend="libpq-connect-hostaddr"/> connection parameter. This can be set instead of or in addition to <envar>PGHOST</envar> to avoid DNS lookup overhead. </para> @@ -7026,7 +7026,7 @@ myEventProc(PGEventId evtId, void *evtInfo, void *passThrough) <primary><envar>PGPORT</envar></primary> </indexterm> <envar>PGPORT</envar> behaves the same as the <xref - linkend="libpq-connect-port"> connection parameter. + linkend="libpq-connect-port"/> connection parameter. </para> </listitem> @@ -7036,7 +7036,7 @@ myEventProc(PGEventId evtId, void *evtInfo, void *passThrough) <primary><envar>PGDATABASE</envar></primary> </indexterm> <envar>PGDATABASE</envar> behaves the same as the <xref - linkend="libpq-connect-dbname"> connection parameter. + linkend="libpq-connect-dbname"/> connection parameter. </para> </listitem> @@ -7046,7 +7046,7 @@ myEventProc(PGEventId evtId, void *evtInfo, void *passThrough) <primary><envar>PGUSER</envar></primary> </indexterm> <envar>PGUSER</envar> behaves the same as the <xref - linkend="libpq-connect-user"> connection parameter. + linkend="libpq-connect-user"/> connection parameter. </para> </listitem> @@ -7056,12 +7056,12 @@ myEventProc(PGEventId evtId, void *evtInfo, void *passThrough) <primary><envar>PGPASSWORD</envar></primary> </indexterm> <envar>PGPASSWORD</envar> behaves the same as the <xref - linkend="libpq-connect-password"> connection parameter. + linkend="libpq-connect-password"/> connection parameter. Use of this environment variable is not recommended for security reasons, as some operating systems allow non-root users to see process environment variables via <application>ps</application>; instead consider using a password file - (see <xref linkend="libpq-pgpass">). + (see <xref linkend="libpq-pgpass"/>). </para> </listitem> @@ -7071,7 +7071,7 @@ myEventProc(PGEventId evtId, void *evtInfo, void *passThrough) <primary><envar>PGPASSFILE</envar></primary> </indexterm> <envar>PGPASSFILE</envar> behaves the same as the <xref - linkend="libpq-connect-passfile"> connection parameter. + linkend="libpq-connect-passfile"/> connection parameter. </para> </listitem> @@ -7081,7 +7081,7 @@ myEventProc(PGEventId evtId, void *evtInfo, void *passThrough) <primary><envar>PGSERVICE</envar></primary> </indexterm> <envar>PGSERVICE</envar> behaves the same as the <xref - linkend="libpq-connect-service"> connection parameter. + linkend="libpq-connect-service"/> connection parameter. </para> </listitem> @@ -7093,7 +7093,7 @@ myEventProc(PGEventId evtId, void *evtInfo, void *passThrough) <envar>PGSERVICEFILE</envar> specifies the name of the per-user connection service file. If not set, it defaults to <filename>~/.pg_service.conf</filename> - (see <xref linkend="libpq-pgservice">). + (see <xref linkend="libpq-pgservice"/>). </para> </listitem> @@ -7103,7 +7103,7 @@ myEventProc(PGEventId evtId, void *evtInfo, void *passThrough) <primary><envar>PGOPTIONS</envar></primary> </indexterm> <envar>PGOPTIONS</envar> behaves the same as the <xref - linkend="libpq-connect-options"> connection parameter. + linkend="libpq-connect-options"/> connection parameter. </para> </listitem> @@ -7113,7 +7113,7 @@ myEventProc(PGEventId evtId, void *evtInfo, void *passThrough) <primary><envar>PGAPPNAME</envar></primary> </indexterm> <envar>PGAPPNAME</envar> behaves the same as the <xref - linkend="libpq-connect-application-name"> connection parameter. + linkend="libpq-connect-application-name"/> connection parameter. </para> </listitem> @@ -7123,7 +7123,7 @@ myEventProc(PGEventId evtId, void *evtInfo, void *passThrough) <primary><envar>PGSSLMODE</envar></primary> </indexterm> <envar>PGSSLMODE</envar> behaves the same as the <xref - linkend="libpq-connect-sslmode"> connection parameter. + linkend="libpq-connect-sslmode"/> connection parameter. </para> </listitem> @@ -7133,7 +7133,7 @@ myEventProc(PGEventId evtId, void *evtInfo, void *passThrough) <primary><envar>PGREQUIRESSL</envar></primary> </indexterm> <envar>PGREQUIRESSL</envar> behaves the same as the <xref - linkend="libpq-connect-requiressl"> connection parameter. + linkend="libpq-connect-requiressl"/> connection parameter. This environment variable is deprecated in favor of the <envar>PGSSLMODE</envar> variable; setting both variables suppresses the effect of this one. @@ -7146,7 +7146,7 @@ myEventProc(PGEventId evtId, void *evtInfo, void *passThrough) <primary><envar>PGSSLCOMPRESSION</envar></primary> </indexterm> <envar>PGSSLCOMPRESSION</envar> behaves the same as the <xref - linkend="libpq-connect-sslcompression"> connection parameter. + linkend="libpq-connect-sslcompression"/> connection parameter. </para> </listitem> @@ -7156,7 +7156,7 @@ myEventProc(PGEventId evtId, void *evtInfo, void *passThrough) <primary><envar>PGSSLCERT</envar></primary> </indexterm> <envar>PGSSLCERT</envar> behaves the same as the <xref - linkend="libpq-connect-sslcert"> connection parameter. + linkend="libpq-connect-sslcert"/> connection parameter. </para> </listitem> @@ -7166,7 +7166,7 @@ myEventProc(PGEventId evtId, void *evtInfo, void *passThrough) <primary><envar>PGSSLKEY</envar></primary> </indexterm> <envar>PGSSLKEY</envar> behaves the same as the <xref - linkend="libpq-connect-sslkey"> connection parameter. + linkend="libpq-connect-sslkey"/> connection parameter. </para> </listitem> @@ -7176,7 +7176,7 @@ myEventProc(PGEventId evtId, void *evtInfo, void *passThrough) <primary><envar>PGSSLROOTCERT</envar></primary> </indexterm> <envar>PGSSLROOTCERT</envar> behaves the same as the <xref - linkend="libpq-connect-sslrootcert"> connection parameter. + linkend="libpq-connect-sslrootcert"/> connection parameter. </para> </listitem> @@ -7186,7 +7186,7 @@ myEventProc(PGEventId evtId, void *evtInfo, void *passThrough) <primary><envar>PGSSLCRL</envar></primary> </indexterm> <envar>PGSSLCRL</envar> behaves the same as the <xref - linkend="libpq-connect-sslcrl"> connection parameter. + linkend="libpq-connect-sslcrl"/> connection parameter. </para> </listitem> @@ -7196,7 +7196,7 @@ myEventProc(PGEventId evtId, void *evtInfo, void *passThrough) <primary><envar>PGREQUIREPEER</envar></primary> </indexterm> <envar>PGREQUIREPEER</envar> behaves the same as the <xref - linkend="libpq-connect-requirepeer"> connection parameter. + linkend="libpq-connect-requirepeer"/> connection parameter. </para> </listitem> @@ -7206,7 +7206,7 @@ myEventProc(PGEventId evtId, void *evtInfo, void *passThrough) <primary><envar>PGKRBSRVNAME</envar></primary> </indexterm> <envar>PGKRBSRVNAME</envar> behaves the same as the <xref - linkend="libpq-connect-krbsrvname"> connection parameter. + linkend="libpq-connect-krbsrvname"/> connection parameter. </para> </listitem> @@ -7216,7 +7216,7 @@ myEventProc(PGEventId evtId, void *evtInfo, void *passThrough) <primary><envar>PGGSSLIB</envar></primary> </indexterm> <envar>PGGSSLIB</envar> behaves the same as the <xref - linkend="libpq-connect-gsslib"> connection parameter. + linkend="libpq-connect-gsslib"/> connection parameter. </para> </listitem> @@ -7226,7 +7226,7 @@ myEventProc(PGEventId evtId, void *evtInfo, void *passThrough) <primary><envar>PGCONNECT_TIMEOUT</envar></primary> </indexterm> <envar>PGCONNECT_TIMEOUT</envar> behaves the same as the <xref - linkend="libpq-connect-connect-timeout"> connection parameter. + linkend="libpq-connect-connect-timeout"/> connection parameter. </para> </listitem> @@ -7236,7 +7236,7 @@ myEventProc(PGEventId evtId, void *evtInfo, void *passThrough) <primary><envar>PGCLIENTENCODING</envar></primary> </indexterm> <envar>PGCLIENTENCODING</envar> behaves the same as the <xref - linkend="libpq-connect-client-encoding"> connection parameter. + linkend="libpq-connect-client-encoding"/> connection parameter. </para> </listitem> @@ -7246,7 +7246,7 @@ myEventProc(PGEventId evtId, void *evtInfo, void *passThrough) <primary><envar>PGTARGETSESSIONATTRS</envar></primary> </indexterm> <envar>PGTARGETSESSIONATTRS</envar> behaves the same as the <xref - linkend="libpq-connect-target-session-attrs"> connection parameter. + linkend="libpq-connect-target-session-attrs"/> connection parameter. </para> </listitem> </itemizedlist> @@ -7255,8 +7255,8 @@ myEventProc(PGEventId evtId, void *evtInfo, void *passThrough) <para> The following environment variables can be used to specify default behavior for each <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> session. (See - also the <xref linkend="sql-alterrole"> - and <xref linkend="sql-alterdatabase"> + also the <xref linkend="sql-alterrole"/> + and <xref linkend="sql-alterdatabase"/> commands for ways to set default behavior on a per-user or per-database basis.) @@ -7293,7 +7293,7 @@ myEventProc(PGEventId evtId, void *evtInfo, void *passThrough) </listitem> </itemizedlist> - Refer to the <acronym>SQL</acronym> command <xref linkend="sql-set"> + Refer to the <acronym>SQL</acronym> command <xref linkend="sql-set"/> for information on correct values for these environment variables. </para> @@ -7348,7 +7348,7 @@ myEventProc(PGEventId evtId, void *evtInfo, void *passThrough) <filename>%APPDATA%</filename> refers to the Application Data subdirectory in the user's profile). Alternatively, a password file can be specified - using the connection parameter <xref linkend="libpq-connect-passfile"> + using the connection parameter <xref linkend="libpq-connect-passfile"/> or the environment variable <envar>PGPASSFILE</envar>. </para> @@ -7422,7 +7422,7 @@ myEventProc(PGEventId evtId, void *evtInfo, void *passThrough) <para> The file uses an <quote>INI file</quote> format where the section name is the service name and the parameters are connection - parameters; see <xref linkend="libpq-paramkeywords"> for a list. For + parameters; see <xref linkend="libpq-paramkeywords"/> for a list. For example: <programlisting> # comment @@ -7456,7 +7456,7 @@ user=admin <para> LDAP connection parameter lookup uses the connection service file <filename>pg_service.conf</filename> (see <xref - linkend="libpq-pgservice">). A line in a + linkend="libpq-pgservice"/>). A line in a <filename>pg_service.conf</filename> stanza that starts with <literal>ldap://</literal> will be recognized as an LDAP URL and an LDAP query will be performed. The result must be a list of @@ -7528,7 +7528,7 @@ ldap://ldap.acme.com/cn=dbserver,cn=hosts?pgconnectinfo?base?(objectclass=*) <para> <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> has native support for using <acronym>SSL</acronym> connections to encrypt client/server communications for increased - security. See <xref linkend="ssl-tcp"> for details about the server-side + security. See <xref linkend="ssl-tcp"/> for details about the server-side <acronym>SSL</acronym> functionality. </para> @@ -7643,7 +7643,7 @@ ldap://ldap.acme.com/cn=dbserver,cn=hosts?pgconnectinfo?base?(objectclass=*) file, then its parent authority's certificate, and so on up to a certificate authority, <quote>root</quote> or <quote>intermediate</quote>, that is trusted by the server, i.e. signed by a certificate in the server's root CA file - (<xref linkend="guc-ssl-ca-file">). + (<xref linkend="guc-ssl-ca-file"/>). </para> <para> @@ -7728,7 +7728,7 @@ ldap://ldap.acme.com/cn=dbserver,cn=hosts?pgconnectinfo?base?(objectclass=*) <para> All <acronym>SSL</acronym> options carry overhead in the form of encryption and key-exchange, so there is a trade-off that has to be made between performance - and security. <xref linkend="libpq-ssl-sslmode-statements"> + and security. <xref linkend="libpq-ssl-sslmode-statements"/> illustrates the risks the different <literal>sslmode</literal> values protect against, and what statement they make about security and overhead. </para> @@ -7828,7 +7828,7 @@ ldap://ldap.acme.com/cn=dbserver,cn=hosts?pgconnectinfo?base?(objectclass=*) <title>SSL Client File Usage</title> <para> - <xref linkend="libpq-ssl-file-usage"> summarizes the files that are + <xref linkend="libpq-ssl-file-usage"/> summarizes the files that are relevant to the SSL setup on the client. </para> @@ -8027,7 +8027,7 @@ int PQisthreadsafe(); <structname>PGresult</structname> objects are normally read-only after creation, and so can be passed around freely between threads. However, if you use any of the <structname>PGresult</structname>-modifying functions described in - <xref linkend="libpq-misc"> or <xref linkend="libpq-events">, it's up + <xref linkend="libpq-misc"/> or <xref linkend="libpq-events"/>, it's up to you to avoid concurrent operations on the same <structname>PGresult</structname>, too. </para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/lo.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/lo.sgml index 8d8ee827227..ab8d192bc15 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/lo.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/lo.sgml @@ -102,7 +102,7 @@ CREATE TRIGGER t_raster BEFORE UPDATE OR DELETE ON image <para> If you already have, or suspect you have, orphaned large objects, see the - <xref linkend="vacuumlo"> module to help + <xref linkend="vacuumlo"/> module to help you clean them up. It's a good idea to run <application>vacuumlo</application> occasionally as a back-stop to the <function>lo_manage</function> trigger. </para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/lobj.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/lobj.sgml index e11c8e0f8b1..086cb8dbe8d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/lobj.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/lobj.sgml @@ -83,8 +83,8 @@ <para> As of <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> 9.0, large objects have an owner and a set of access permissions, which can be managed using - <xref linkend="sql-grant"> and - <xref linkend="sql-revoke">. + <xref linkend="sql-grant"/> and + <xref linkend="sql-revoke"/>. <literal>SELECT</literal> privileges are required to read a large object, and <literal>UPDATE</literal> privileges are required to write or @@ -92,7 +92,7 @@ Only the large object's owner (or a database superuser) can delete, comment on, or change the owner of a large object. To adjust this behavior for compatibility with prior releases, see the - <xref linkend="guc-lo-compat-privileges"> run-time parameter. + <xref linkend="guc-lo-compat-privileges"/> run-time parameter. </para> </sect1> @@ -301,7 +301,7 @@ int lo_open(PGconn *conn, Oid lobjId, int mode); checks were instead performed at the first actual read or write call using the descriptor.) These privilege checks can be disabled with the - <xref linkend="guc-lo-compat-privileges"> run-time parameter. + <xref linkend="guc-lo-compat-privileges"/> run-time parameter. </para> <para> @@ -539,7 +539,7 @@ int lo_unlink(PGconn *conn, Oid lobjId); <para> Server-side functions tailored for manipulating large objects from SQL are - listed in <xref linkend="lo-funcs-table">. + listed in <xref linkend="lo-funcs-table"/>. </para> <table id="lo-funcs-table"> @@ -656,7 +656,7 @@ SELECT lo_export(image.raster, '/tmp/motd') FROM image <caution> <para> - It is possible to <xref linkend="sql-grant"> use of the + It is possible to <xref linkend="sql-grant"/> use of the server-side <function>lo_import</function> and <function>lo_export</function> functions to non-superusers, but careful consideration of the security implications is required. A @@ -688,7 +688,7 @@ SELECT lo_export(image.raster, '/tmp/motd') FROM image <title>Example Program</title> <para> - <xref linkend="lo-example"> is a sample program which shows how the large object + <xref linkend="lo-example"/> is a sample program which shows how the large object interface in <application>libpq</application> can be used. Parts of the program are commented out but are left in the source for the reader's diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/logical-replication.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/logical-replication.sgml index 676ab1f5ad7..75551d8ee1a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/logical-replication.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/logical-replication.sgml @@ -8,7 +8,7 @@ changes, based upon their replication identity (usually a primary key). We use the term logical in contrast to physical replication, which uses exact block addresses and byte-by-byte replication. PostgreSQL supports both - mechanisms concurrently, see <xref linkend="high-availability">. Logical + mechanisms concurrently, see <xref linkend="high-availability"/>. Logical replication allows fine-grained control over both data replication and security. </para> @@ -126,7 +126,7 @@ fallback if no other solution is possible. If a replica identity other than <quote>full</quote> is set on the publisher side, a replica identity comprising the same or fewer columns must also be set on the subscriber - side. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable-replica-identity"> for details on + side. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable-replica-identity"/> for details on how to set the replica identity. If a table without a replica identity is added to a publication that replicates <command>UPDATE</command> or <command>DELETE</command> operations then @@ -140,13 +140,13 @@ </para> <para> - A publication is created using the <xref linkend="sql-createpublication"> + A publication is created using the <xref linkend="sql-createpublication"/> command and may later be altered or dropped using corresponding commands. </para> <para> The individual tables can be added and removed dynamically using - <xref linkend="sql-alterpublication">. Both the <literal>ADD + <xref linkend="sql-alterpublication"/>. Both the <literal>ADD TABLE</literal> and <literal>DROP TABLE</literal> operations are transactional; so the table will start or stop replicating at the correct snapshot once the transaction has committed. @@ -179,14 +179,14 @@ <para> Each subscription will receive changes via one replication slot (see - <xref linkend="streaming-replication-slots">). Additional temporary + <xref linkend="streaming-replication-slots"/>). Additional temporary replication slots may be required for the initial data synchronization of pre-existing table data. </para> <para> A logical replication subscription can be a standby for synchronous - replication (see <xref linkend="synchronous-replication">). The standby + replication (see <xref linkend="synchronous-replication"/>). The standby name is by default the subscription name. An alternative name can be specified as <literal>application_name</literal> in the connection information of the subscription. @@ -200,10 +200,10 @@ </para> <para> - The subscription is added using <xref linkend="sql-createsubscription"> and + The subscription is added using <xref linkend="sql-createsubscription"/> and can be stopped/resumed at any time using the - <xref linkend="sql-altersubscription"> command and removed using - <xref linkend="sql-dropsubscription">. + <xref linkend="sql-altersubscription"/> command and removed using + <xref linkend="sql-dropsubscription"/>. </para> <para> @@ -375,7 +375,7 @@ <listitem> <para> - Large objects (see <xref linkend="largeobjects">) are not replicated. + Large objects (see <xref linkend="largeobjects"/>) are not replicated. There is no workaround for that, other than storing data in normal tables. </para> @@ -409,13 +409,13 @@ <para> Logical replication is built with an architecture similar to physical - streaming replication (see <xref linkend="streaming-replication">). It is + streaming replication (see <xref linkend="streaming-replication"/>). It is implemented by <quote>walsender</quote> and <quote>apply</quote> processes. The walsender process starts logical decoding (described - in <xref linkend="logicaldecoding">) of the WAL and loads the standard + in <xref linkend="logicaldecoding"/>) of the WAL and loads the standard logical decoding plugin (pgoutput). The plugin transforms the changes read from WAL to the logical replication protocol - (see <xref linkend="protocol-logical-replication">) and filters the data + (see <xref linkend="protocol-logical-replication"/>) and filters the data according to the publication specification. The data is then continuously transferred using the streaming replication protocol to the apply worker, which maps the data to local tables and applies the individual changes as @@ -461,7 +461,7 @@ <link linkend="streaming-replication">physical streaming replication</link>, the monitoring on a publication node is similar to monitoring of a physical replication master - (see <xref linkend="streaming-replication-monitoring">). + (see <xref linkend="streaming-replication-monitoring"/>). </para> <para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/logicaldecoding.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/logicaldecoding.sgml index 3b268c3f3c8..6bab1b9b322 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/logicaldecoding.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/logicaldecoding.sgml @@ -24,17 +24,17 @@ by <command>INSERT</command> and the new row version created by <command>UPDATE</command>. Availability of old row versions for <command>UPDATE</command> and <command>DELETE</command> depends on - the configured replica identity (see <xref linkend="sql-createtable-replica-identity">). + the configured replica identity (see <xref linkend="sql-createtable-replica-identity"/>). </para> <para> Changes can be consumed either using the streaming replication protocol - (see <xref linkend="protocol-replication"> and - <xref linkend="logicaldecoding-walsender">), or by calling functions - via SQL (see <xref linkend="logicaldecoding-sql">). It is also possible + (see <xref linkend="protocol-replication"/> and + <xref linkend="logicaldecoding-walsender"/>), or by calling functions + via SQL (see <xref linkend="logicaldecoding-sql"/>). It is also possible to write additional methods of consuming the output of a replication slot without modifying core code - (see <xref linkend="logicaldecoding-writer">). + (see <xref linkend="logicaldecoding-writer"/>). </para> <sect1 id="logicaldecoding-example"> @@ -47,8 +47,8 @@ <para> Before you can use logical decoding, you must set - <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"> to <literal>logical</literal> and - <xref linkend="guc-max-replication-slots"> to at least 1. Then, you + <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"/> to <literal>logical</literal> and + <xref linkend="guc-max-replication-slots"/> to at least 1. Then, you should connect to the target database (in the example below, <literal>postgres</literal>) as a superuser. </para> @@ -146,10 +146,10 @@ postgres=# SELECT pg_drop_replication_slot('regression_slot'); <para> The following example shows how logical decoding is controlled over the streaming replication protocol, using the - program <xref linkend="app-pgrecvlogical"> included in the PostgreSQL + program <xref linkend="app-pgrecvlogical"/> included in the PostgreSQL distribution. This requires that client authentication is set up to allow replication connections - (see <xref linkend="streaming-replication-authentication">) and + (see <xref linkend="streaming-replication-authentication"/>) and that <varname>max_wal_senders</varname> is set sufficiently high to allow an additional connection. </para> @@ -208,7 +208,7 @@ $ pg_recvlogical -d postgres --slot test --drop-slot <note> <para><productname>PostgreSQL</productname> also has streaming replication slots - (see <xref linkend="streaming-replication">), but they are used somewhat + (see <xref linkend="streaming-replication"/>), but they are used somewhat differently there. </para> </note> @@ -272,9 +272,9 @@ $ pg_recvlogical -d postgres --slot test --drop-slot <title>Exported Snapshots</title> <para> When a new replication slot is created using the streaming replication - interface (see <xref linkend="protocol-replication-create-slot">), a + interface (see <xref linkend="protocol-replication-create-slot"/>), a snapshot is exported - (see <xref linkend="functions-snapshot-synchronization">), which will show + (see <xref linkend="functions-snapshot-synchronization"/>), which will show exactly the state of the database after which all changes will be included in the change stream. This can be used to create a new replica by using <link linkend="sql-set-transaction"><literal>SET TRANSACTION @@ -313,11 +313,11 @@ $ pg_recvlogical -d postgres --slot test --drop-slot are used to create, drop, and stream changes from a replication slot, respectively. These commands are only available over a replication connection; they cannot be used via SQL. - See <xref linkend="protocol-replication"> for details on these commands. + See <xref linkend="protocol-replication"/> for details on these commands. </para> <para> - The command <xref linkend="app-pgrecvlogical"> can be used to control + The command <xref linkend="app-pgrecvlogical"/> can be used to control logical decoding over a streaming replication connection. (It uses these commands internally.) </para> @@ -327,12 +327,12 @@ $ pg_recvlogical -d postgres --slot test --drop-slot <title>Logical Decoding <acronym>SQL</acronym> Interface</title> <para> - See <xref linkend="functions-replication"> for detailed documentation on + See <xref linkend="functions-replication"/> for detailed documentation on the SQL-level API for interacting with logical decoding. </para> <para> - Synchronous replication (see <xref linkend="synchronous-replication">) is + Synchronous replication (see <xref linkend="synchronous-replication"/>) is only supported on replication slots used over the streaming replication interface. The function interface and additional, non-core interfaces do not support synchronous replication. @@ -489,7 +489,7 @@ typedef struct OutputPluginOptions <literal>output_type</literal> has to either be set to <literal>OUTPUT_PLUGIN_TEXTUAL_OUTPUT</literal> or <literal>OUTPUT_PLUGIN_BINARY_OUTPUT</literal>. See also - <xref linkend="logicaldecoding-output-mode">. + <xref linkend="logicaldecoding-output-mode"/>. </para> <para> @@ -576,8 +576,8 @@ typedef void (*LogicalDecodeChangeCB) (struct LogicalDecodingContext *ctx, <note> <para> Only changes in user defined tables that are not unlogged - (see <xref linkend="sql-createtable-unlogged">) and not temporary - (see <xref linkend="sql-createtable-temporary">) can be extracted using + (see <xref linkend="sql-createtable-unlogged"/>) and not temporary + (see <xref linkend="sql-createtable-temporary"/>) can be extracted using logical decoding. </para> </note> @@ -685,7 +685,7 @@ OutputPluginWrite(ctx, true); <filename>src/backend/replication/logical/logicalfuncs.c</filename>. Essentially, three functions need to be provided: one to read WAL, one to prepare writing output, and one to write the output - (see <xref linkend="logicaldecoding-output-plugin-output">). + (see <xref linkend="logicaldecoding-output-plugin-output"/>). </para> </sect1> @@ -698,9 +698,9 @@ OutputPluginWrite(ctx, true); replication</link> solutions with the same user interface as synchronous replication for <link linkend="streaming-replication">streaming replication</link>. To do this, the streaming replication interface - (see <xref linkend="logicaldecoding-walsender">) must be used to stream out + (see <xref linkend="logicaldecoding-walsender"/>) must be used to stream out data. Clients have to send <literal>Standby status update (F)</literal> - (see <xref linkend="protocol-replication">) messages, just like streaming + (see <xref linkend="protocol-replication"/>) messages, just like streaming replication clients do. </para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ltree.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ltree.sgml index 602d9403f70..ea362f8a1d9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ltree.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ltree.sgml @@ -183,7 +183,7 @@ Europe & Russia*@ & !Transportation <literal><</literal>, <literal>></literal>, <literal><=</literal>, <literal>>=</literal>. Comparison sorts in the order of a tree traversal, with the children of a node sorted by label text. In addition, the specialized - operators shown in <xref linkend="ltree-op-table"> are available. + operators shown in <xref linkend="ltree-op-table"/> are available. </para> <table id="ltree-op-table"> @@ -362,7 +362,7 @@ Europe & Russia*@ & !Transportation </para> <para> - The available functions are shown in <xref linkend="ltree-func-table">. + The available functions are shown in <xref linkend="ltree-func-table"/>. </para> <table id="ltree-func-table"> @@ -672,7 +672,7 @@ ltreetest=> SELECT ins_label(path,2,'Space') FROM test WHERE path <@ 'Top. the <type>ltree</type> type for PL/Python. The extensions are called <literal>ltree_plpythonu</literal>, <literal>ltree_plpython2u</literal>, and <literal>ltree_plpython3u</literal> - (see <xref linkend="plpython-python23"> for the PL/Python naming + (see <xref linkend="plpython-python23"/> for the PL/Python naming convention). If you install these transforms and specify them when creating a function, <type>ltree</type> values are mapped to Python lists. (The reverse is currently not supported, however.) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/maintenance.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/maintenance.sgml index 1a379058a2e..4a68ec3b404 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/maintenance.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/maintenance.sgml @@ -28,20 +28,20 @@ after a catastrophe (disk failure, fire, mistakenly dropping a critical table, etc.). The backup and recovery mechanisms available in <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> are discussed at length in - <xref linkend="backup">. + <xref linkend="backup"/>. </para> <para> The other main category of maintenance task is periodic <quote>vacuuming</quote> of the database. This activity is discussed in - <xref linkend="routine-vacuuming">. Closely related to this is updating + <xref linkend="routine-vacuuming"/>. Closely related to this is updating the statistics that will be used by the query planner, as discussed in - <xref linkend="vacuum-for-statistics">. + <xref linkend="vacuum-for-statistics"/>. </para> <para> Another task that might need periodic attention is log file management. - This is discussed in <xref linkend="logfile-maintenance">. + This is discussed in <xref linkend="logfile-maintenance"/>. </para> <para> @@ -70,7 +70,7 @@ <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> databases require periodic maintenance known as <firstterm>vacuuming</firstterm>. For many installations, it is sufficient to let vacuuming be performed by the <firstterm>autovacuum - daemon</firstterm>, which is described in <xref linkend="autovacuum">. You might + daemon</firstterm>, which is described in <xref linkend="autovacuum"/>. You might need to adjust the autovacuuming parameters described there to obtain best results for your situation. Some database administrators will want to supplement or replace the daemon's activities with manually-managed @@ -87,7 +87,7 @@ <para> <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>'s - <xref linkend="sql-vacuum"> command has to + <xref linkend="sql-vacuum"/> command has to process each table on a regular basis for several reasons: <orderedlist> @@ -140,7 +140,7 @@ traffic, which can cause poor performance for other active sessions. There are configuration parameters that can be adjusted to reduce the performance impact of background vacuuming — see - <xref linkend="runtime-config-resource-vacuum-cost">. + <xref linkend="runtime-config-resource-vacuum-cost"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -156,7 +156,7 @@ <command>UPDATE</command> or <command>DELETE</command> of a row does not immediately remove the old version of the row. This approach is necessary to gain the benefits of multiversion - concurrency control (<acronym>MVCC</acronym>, see <xref linkend="mvcc">): the row version + concurrency control (<acronym>MVCC</acronym>, see <xref linkend="mvcc"/>): the row version must not be deleted while it is still potentially visible to other transactions. But eventually, an outdated or deleted row version is no longer of interest to any transaction. The space it occupies must then be @@ -217,7 +217,7 @@ their busiest tables as often as once every few minutes.) If you have multiple databases in a cluster, don't forget to <command>VACUUM</command> each one; the program <xref - linkend="app-vacuumdb"> might be helpful. + linkend="app-vacuumdb"/> might be helpful. </para> <tip> @@ -227,9 +227,9 @@ massive update or delete activity. If you have such a table and you need to reclaim the excess disk space it occupies, you will need to use <command>VACUUM FULL</command>, or alternatively - <xref linkend="sql-cluster"> + <xref linkend="sql-cluster"/> or one of the table-rewriting variants of - <xref linkend="sql-altertable">. + <xref linkend="sql-altertable"/>. These commands rewrite an entire new copy of the table and build new indexes for it. All these options require exclusive lock. Note that they also temporarily use extra disk space approximately equal to the size @@ -242,7 +242,7 @@ <para> If you have a table whose entire contents are deleted on a periodic basis, consider doing it with - <xref linkend="sql-truncate"> rather + <xref linkend="sql-truncate"/> rather than using <command>DELETE</command> followed by <command>VACUUM</command>. <command>TRUNCATE</command> removes the entire content of the table immediately, without requiring a @@ -269,7 +269,7 @@ The <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> query planner relies on statistical information about the contents of tables in order to generate good plans for queries. These statistics are gathered by - the <xref linkend="sql-analyze"> command, + the <xref linkend="sql-analyze"/> command, which can be invoked by itself or as an optional step in <command>VACUUM</command>. It is important to have reasonably accurate statistics, otherwise poor choices of plans might @@ -323,7 +323,7 @@ clauses and have highly irregular data distributions might require a finer-grain data histogram than other columns. See <command>ALTER TABLE SET STATISTICS</command>, or change the database-wide default using the <xref - linkend="guc-default-statistics-target"> configuration parameter. + linkend="guc-default-statistics-target"/> configuration parameter. </para> <para> @@ -453,7 +453,7 @@ </note> <para> - <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-freeze-min-age"> + <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-freeze-min-age"/> controls how old an XID value has to be before rows bearing that XID will be frozen. Increasing this setting may avoid unnecessary work if the rows that would otherwise be frozen will soon be modified again, @@ -471,7 +471,7 @@ Periodically, <command>VACUUM</command> will perform an <firstterm>aggressive vacuum</firstterm>, skipping only those pages which contain neither dead rows nor any unfrozen XID or MXID values. - <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-freeze-table-age"> + <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-freeze-table-age"/> controls when <command>VACUUM</command> does that: all-visible but not all-frozen pages are scanned if the number of transactions that have passed since the last such scan is greater than <varname>vacuum_freeze_table_age</varname> minus @@ -488,7 +488,7 @@ that, data loss could result. To ensure that this does not happen, autovacuum is invoked on any table that might contain unfrozen rows with XIDs older than the age specified by the configuration parameter <xref - linkend="guc-autovacuum-freeze-max-age">. (This will happen even if + linkend="guc-autovacuum-freeze-max-age"/>. (This will happen even if autovacuum is disabled.) </para> @@ -636,7 +636,7 @@ HINT: Stop the postmaster and vacuum that database in single-user mode. execute commands once it has gone into the safety shutdown mode, the only way to do this is to stop the server and start the server in single-user mode to execute <command>VACUUM</command>. The shutdown mode is not enforced - in single-user mode. See the <xref linkend="app-postgres"> reference + in single-user mode. See the <xref linkend="app-postgres"/> reference page for details about using single-user mode. </para> @@ -673,13 +673,13 @@ HINT: Stop the postmaster and vacuum that database in single-user mode. <para> Whenever <command>VACUUM</command> scans any part of a table, it will replace any multixact ID it encounters which is older than - <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-multixact-freeze-min-age"> + <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-multixact-freeze-min-age"/> by a different value, which can be the zero value, a single transaction ID, or a newer multixact ID. For each table, <structname>pg_class</structname>.<structfield>relminmxid</structfield> stores the oldest possible multixact ID still appearing in any tuple of that table. If this value is older than - <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-multixact-freeze-table-age">, an aggressive + <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-multixact-freeze-table-age"/>, an aggressive vacuum is forced. As discussed in the previous section, an aggressive vacuum means that only those pages which are known to be all-frozen will be skipped. <function>mxid_age()</function> can be used on @@ -697,7 +697,7 @@ HINT: Stop the postmaster and vacuum that database in single-user mode. <para> As a safety device, an aggressive vacuum scan will occur for any table whose multixact-age is greater than - <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-multixact-freeze-max-age">. Aggressive + <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-multixact-freeze-max-age"/>. Aggressive vacuum scans will also occur progressively for all tables, starting with those that have the oldest multixact-age, if the amount of used member storage space exceeds the amount 50% of the addressable storage space. @@ -723,7 +723,7 @@ HINT: Stop the postmaster and vacuum that database in single-user mode. tables that have had a large number of inserted, updated or deleted tuples. These checks use the statistics collection facility; therefore, autovacuum cannot be used unless <xref - linkend="guc-track-counts"> is set to <literal>true</literal>. + linkend="guc-track-counts"/> is set to <literal>true</literal>. In the default configuration, autovacuuming is enabled and the related configuration parameters are appropriately set. </para> @@ -734,17 +734,17 @@ HINT: Stop the postmaster and vacuum that database in single-user mode. <firstterm>autovacuum launcher</firstterm>, which is in charge of starting <firstterm>autovacuum worker</firstterm> processes for all databases. The launcher will distribute the work across time, attempting to start one - worker within each database every <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-naptime"> + worker within each database every <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-naptime"/> seconds. (Therefore, if the installation has <replaceable>N</replaceable> databases, a new worker will be launched every <varname>autovacuum_naptime</varname>/<replaceable>N</replaceable> seconds.) - A maximum of <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-max-workers"> worker processes + A maximum of <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-max-workers"/> worker processes are allowed to run at the same time. If there are more than <varname>autovacuum_max_workers</varname> databases to be processed, the next database will be processed as soon as the first worker finishes. Each worker process will check each table within its database and execute <command>VACUUM</command> and/or <command>ANALYZE</command> as needed. - <xref linkend="guc-log-autovacuum-min-duration"> can be set to monitor + <xref linkend="guc-log-autovacuum-min-duration"/> can be set to monitor autovacuum workers' activity. </para> @@ -756,13 +756,13 @@ HINT: Stop the postmaster and vacuum that database in single-user mode. available. There is no limit on how many workers might be in a single database, but workers do try to avoid repeating work that has already been done by other workers. Note that the number of running - workers does not count towards <xref linkend="guc-max-connections"> or - <xref linkend="guc-superuser-reserved-connections"> limits. + workers does not count towards <xref linkend="guc-max-connections"/> or + <xref linkend="guc-superuser-reserved-connections"/> limits. </para> <para> Tables whose <structfield>relfrozenxid</structfield> value is more than - <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-freeze-max-age"> transactions old are always + <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-freeze-max-age"/> transactions old are always vacuumed (this also applies to those tables whose freeze max age has been modified via storage parameters; see below). Otherwise, if the number of tuples obsoleted since the last @@ -772,9 +772,9 @@ HINT: Stop the postmaster and vacuum that database in single-user mode. vacuum threshold = vacuum base threshold + vacuum scale factor * number of tuples </programlisting> where the vacuum base threshold is - <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-vacuum-threshold">, + <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-vacuum-threshold"/>, the vacuum scale factor is - <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-vacuum-scale-factor">, + <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-vacuum-scale-factor"/>, and the number of tuples is <structname>pg_class</structname>.<structfield>reltuples</structfield>. The number of obsolete tuples is obtained from the statistics @@ -808,16 +808,16 @@ analyze threshold = analyze base threshold + analyze scale factor * number of tu <filename>postgresql.conf</filename>, but it is possible to override them (and many other autovacuum control parameters) on a per-table basis; see <xref linkend="sql-createtable-storage-parameters" - endterm="sql-createtable-storage-parameters-title"> for more information. + endterm="sql-createtable-storage-parameters-title"/> for more information. If a setting has been changed via a table's storage parameters, that value is used when processing that table; otherwise the global settings are - used. See <xref linkend="runtime-config-autovacuum"> for more details on + used. See <xref linkend="runtime-config-autovacuum"/> for more details on the global settings. </para> <para> When multiple workers are running, the autovacuum cost delay parameters - (see <xref linkend="runtime-config-resource-vacuum-cost">) are + (see <xref linkend="runtime-config-resource-vacuum-cost"/>) are <quote>balanced</quote> among all the running workers, so that the total I/O impact on the system is the same regardless of the number of workers actually running. However, any workers processing tables whose @@ -838,7 +838,7 @@ analyze threshold = analyze base threshold + analyze scale factor * number of tu <para> In some situations it is worthwhile to rebuild indexes periodically - with the <xref linkend="sql-reindex"> command or a series of individual + with the <xref linkend="sql-reindex"/> command or a series of individual rebuilding steps. </para> @@ -868,16 +868,16 @@ analyze threshold = analyze base threshold + analyze scale factor * number of tu </para> <para> - <xref linkend="sql-reindex"> can be used safely and easily in all cases. + <xref linkend="sql-reindex"/> can be used safely and easily in all cases. But since the command requires an exclusive table lock, it is often preferable to execute an index rebuild with a sequence of creation and replacement steps. Index types that support - <xref linkend="sql-createindex"> with the <literal>CONCURRENTLY</literal> + <xref linkend="sql-createindex"/> with the <literal>CONCURRENTLY</literal> option can instead be recreated that way. If that is successful and the resulting index is valid, the original index can then be replaced by - the newly built one using a combination of <xref linkend="sql-alterindex"> - and <xref linkend="sql-dropindex">. When an index is used to enforce - uniqueness or other constraints, <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> might + the newly built one using a combination of <xref linkend="sql-alterindex"/> + and <xref linkend="sql-dropindex"/>. When an index is used to enforce + uniqueness or other constraints, <xref linkend="sql-altertable"/> might be necessary to swap the existing constraint with one enforced by the new index. Review this alternate multistep rebuild approach carefully before using it as there are limitations on which @@ -922,7 +922,7 @@ analyze threshold = analyze base threshold + analyze scale factor * number of tu setting the configuration parameter <varname>logging_collector</varname> to <literal>true</literal> in <filename>postgresql.conf</filename>. The control parameters for this program are described in <xref - linkend="runtime-config-logging-where">. You can also use this approach + linkend="runtime-config-logging-where"/>. You can also use this approach to capture the log data in machine readable <acronym>CSV</acronym> (comma-separated values) format. </para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/manage-ag.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/manage-ag.sgml index f0055382206..0154064e506 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/manage-ag.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/manage-ag.sgml @@ -49,20 +49,20 @@ resources, they should be put in the same database but possibly into separate schemas. Schemas are a purely logical structure and who can access what is managed by the privilege system. More information about - managing schemas is in <xref linkend="ddl-schemas">. + managing schemas is in <xref linkend="ddl-schemas"/>. </para> <para> Databases are created with the <command>CREATE DATABASE</command> command - (see <xref linkend="manage-ag-createdb">) and destroyed with the + (see <xref linkend="manage-ag-createdb"/>) and destroyed with the <command>DROP DATABASE</command> command - (see <xref linkend="manage-ag-dropdb">). + (see <xref linkend="manage-ag-dropdb"/>). To determine the set of existing databases, examine the <structname>pg_database</structname> system catalog, for example <synopsis> SELECT datname FROM pg_database; </synopsis> - The <xref linkend="app-psql"> program's <literal>\l</literal> meta-command + The <xref linkend="app-psql"/> program's <literal>\l</literal> meta-command and <option>-l</option> command-line option are also useful for listing the existing databases. </para> @@ -83,12 +83,12 @@ SELECT datname FROM pg_database; <para> In order to create a database, the <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> server must be up and running (see <xref - linkend="server-start">). + linkend="server-start"/>). </para> <para> Databases are created with the SQL command - <xref linkend="sql-createdatabase">: + <xref linkend="sql-createdatabase"/>: <synopsis> CREATE DATABASE <replaceable>name</replaceable>; </synopsis> @@ -101,7 +101,7 @@ CREATE DATABASE <replaceable>name</replaceable>; <para> The creation of databases is a restricted operation. See <xref - linkend="role-attributes"> for how to grant permission. + linkend="role-attributes"/> for how to grant permission. </para> <para> @@ -110,7 +110,7 @@ CREATE DATABASE <replaceable>name</replaceable>; question remains how the <emphasis>first</emphasis> database at any given site can be created. The first database is always created by the <command>initdb</command> command when the data storage area is - initialized. (See <xref linkend="creating-cluster">.) This + initialized. (See <xref linkend="creating-cluster"/>.) This database is called <literal>postgres</literal>.<indexterm><primary>postgres</primary></indexterm> So to create the first <quote>ordinary</quote> database you can connect to @@ -127,7 +127,7 @@ CREATE DATABASE <replaceable>name</replaceable>; propagated to all subsequently created databases. Because of this, avoid creating objects in <literal>template1</literal> unless you want them propagated to every newly created database. More details - appear in <xref linkend="manage-ag-templatedbs">. + appear in <xref linkend="manage-ag-templatedbs"/>. </para> <para> @@ -142,14 +142,14 @@ createdb <replaceable class="parameter">dbname</replaceable> <command>createdb</command> does no magic. It connects to the <literal>postgres</literal> database and issues the <command>CREATE DATABASE</command> command, exactly as described above. - The <xref linkend="app-createdb"> reference page contains the invocation + The <xref linkend="app-createdb"/> reference page contains the invocation details. Note that <command>createdb</command> without any arguments will create a database with the current user name. </para> <note> <para> - <xref linkend="client-authentication"> contains information about + <xref linkend="client-authentication"/> contains information about how to restrict who can connect to a given database. </para> </note> @@ -283,7 +283,7 @@ createdb -T template0 <replaceable>dbname</replaceable> <title>Database Configuration</title> <para> - Recall from <xref linkend="runtime-config"> that the + Recall from <xref linkend="runtime-config"/> that the <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> server provides a large number of run-time configuration variables. You can set database-specific default values for many of these settings. @@ -315,7 +315,7 @@ ALTER DATABASE mydb SET geqo TO off; <para> Databases are destroyed with the command - <xref linkend="sql-dropdatabase">:<indexterm><primary>DROP DATABASE</primary></indexterm> + <xref linkend="sql-dropdatabase"/>:<indexterm><primary>DROP DATABASE</primary></indexterm> <synopsis> DROP DATABASE <replaceable>name</replaceable>; </synopsis> @@ -337,7 +337,7 @@ DROP DATABASE <replaceable>name</replaceable>; <para> For convenience, there is also a shell program to drop - databases, <xref linkend="app-dropdb">:<indexterm><primary>dropdb</primary></indexterm> + databases, <xref linkend="app-dropdb"/>:<indexterm><primary>dropdb</primary></indexterm> <synopsis> dropdb <replaceable class="parameter">dbname</replaceable> </synopsis> @@ -396,7 +396,7 @@ dropdb <replaceable class="parameter">dbname</replaceable> <para> To define a tablespace, use the <xref - linkend="sql-createtablespace"> + linkend="sql-createtablespace"/> command, for example:<indexterm><primary>CREATE TABLESPACE</primary></indexterm>: <programlisting> CREATE TABLESPACE fastspace LOCATION '/ssd1/postgresql/data'; @@ -438,7 +438,7 @@ CREATE TABLE foo(i int) TABLESPACE space1; </para> <para> - Alternatively, use the <xref linkend="guc-default-tablespace"> parameter: + Alternatively, use the <xref linkend="guc-default-tablespace"/> parameter: <programlisting> SET default_tablespace = space1; CREATE TABLE foo(i int); @@ -450,7 +450,7 @@ CREATE TABLE foo(i int); </para> <para> - There is also a <xref linkend="guc-temp-tablespaces"> parameter, which + There is also a <xref linkend="guc-temp-tablespaces"/> parameter, which determines the placement of temporary tables and indexes, as well as temporary files that are used for purposes such as sorting large data sets. This can be a list of tablespace names, rather than only one, @@ -490,7 +490,7 @@ CREATE TABLE foo(i int); <para> To remove an empty tablespace, use the <xref - linkend="sql-droptablespace"> + linkend="sql-droptablespace"/> command. </para> @@ -501,7 +501,7 @@ CREATE TABLE foo(i int); <synopsis> SELECT spcname FROM pg_tablespace; </synopsis> - The <xref linkend="app-psql"> program's <literal>\db</literal> meta-command + The <xref linkend="app-psql"/> program's <literal>\db</literal> meta-command is also useful for listing the existing tablespaces. </para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/monitoring.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/monitoring.sgml index 6f8203355e7..8d461c81459 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/monitoring.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/monitoring.sgml @@ -27,8 +27,8 @@ <command>ps</command>, <command>top</command>, <command>iostat</command>, and <command>vmstat</command>. Also, once one has identified a poorly-performing query, further investigation might be needed using - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>'s <xref linkend="sql-explain"> command. - <xref linkend="using-explain"> discusses <command>EXPLAIN</command> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>'s <xref linkend="sql-explain"/> command. + <xref linkend="using-explain"/> discusses <command>EXPLAIN</command> and other methods for understanding the behavior of an individual query. </para> @@ -92,7 +92,7 @@ postgres: <replaceable>user</replaceable> <replaceable>database</replaceable> <r </para> <para> - If <xref linkend="guc-cluster-name"> has been configured the + If <xref linkend="guc-cluster-name"/> has been configured the cluster name will also be shown in <command>ps</command> output: <screen> $ psql -c 'SHOW cluster_name' @@ -108,7 +108,7 @@ postgres 27093 0.0 0.0 30096 2752 ? Ss 11:34 0:00 postgres: ser </para> <para> - If you have turned off <xref linkend="guc-update-process-title"> then the + If you have turned off <xref linkend="guc-update-process-title"/> then the activity indicator is not updated; the process title is set only once when a new process is launched. On some platforms this saves a measurable amount of per-command overhead; on others it's insignificant. @@ -161,27 +161,27 @@ postgres 27093 0.0 0.0 30096 2752 ? Ss 11:34 0:00 postgres: ser Since collection of statistics adds some overhead to query execution, the system can be configured to collect or not collect information. This is controlled by configuration parameters that are normally set in - <filename>postgresql.conf</filename>. (See <xref linkend="runtime-config"> for + <filename>postgresql.conf</filename>. (See <xref linkend="runtime-config"/> for details about setting configuration parameters.) </para> <para> - The parameter <xref linkend="guc-track-activities"> enables monitoring + The parameter <xref linkend="guc-track-activities"/> enables monitoring of the current command being executed by any server process. </para> <para> - The parameter <xref linkend="guc-track-counts"> controls whether + The parameter <xref linkend="guc-track-counts"/> controls whether statistics are collected about table and index accesses. </para> <para> - The parameter <xref linkend="guc-track-functions"> enables tracking of + The parameter <xref linkend="guc-track-functions"/> enables tracking of usage of user-defined functions. </para> <para> - The parameter <xref linkend="guc-track-io-timing"> enables monitoring + The parameter <xref linkend="guc-track-io-timing"/> enables monitoring of block read and write times. </para> @@ -189,7 +189,7 @@ postgres 27093 0.0 0.0 30096 2752 ? Ss 11:34 0:00 postgres: ser Normally these parameters are set in <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> so that they apply to all server processes, but it is possible to turn them on or off in individual sessions using the <xref - linkend="sql-set"> command. (To prevent + linkend="sql-set"/> command. (To prevent ordinary users from hiding their activity from the administrator, only superusers are allowed to change these parameters with <command>SET</command>.) @@ -199,7 +199,7 @@ postgres 27093 0.0 0.0 30096 2752 ? Ss 11:34 0:00 postgres: ser The statistics collector transmits the collected information to other <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> processes through temporary files. These files are stored in the directory named by the - <xref linkend="guc-stats-temp-directory"> parameter, + <xref linkend="guc-stats-temp-directory"/> parameter, <filename>pg_stat_tmp</filename> by default. For better performance, <varname>stats_temp_directory</varname> can be pointed at a RAM-based file system, decreasing physical I/O requirements. @@ -217,13 +217,13 @@ postgres 27093 0.0 0.0 30096 2752 ? Ss 11:34 0:00 postgres: ser <para> Several predefined views, listed in <xref - linkend="monitoring-stats-dynamic-views-table">, are available to show + linkend="monitoring-stats-dynamic-views-table"/>, are available to show the current state of the system. There are also several other views, listed in <xref - linkend="monitoring-stats-views-table">, available to show the results + linkend="monitoring-stats-views-table"/>, available to show the results of statistics collection. Alternatively, one can build custom views using the underlying statistics functions, as discussed - in <xref linkend="monitoring-stats-functions">. + in <xref linkend="monitoring-stats-functions"/>. </para> <para> @@ -288,7 +288,7 @@ postgres 27093 0.0 0.0 30096 2752 ? Ss 11:34 0:00 postgres: ser <entry> One row per server process, showing information related to the current activity of that process, such as state and current query. - See <xref linkend="pg-stat-activity-view"> for details. + See <xref linkend="pg-stat-activity-view"/> for details. </entry> </row> @@ -296,7 +296,7 @@ postgres 27093 0.0 0.0 30096 2752 ? Ss 11:34 0:00 postgres: ser <entry><structname>pg_stat_replication</structname><indexterm><primary>pg_stat_replication</primary></indexterm></entry> <entry>One row per WAL sender process, showing statistics about replication to that sender's connected standby server. - See <xref linkend="pg-stat-replication-view"> for details. + See <xref linkend="pg-stat-replication-view"/> for details. </entry> </row> @@ -304,7 +304,7 @@ postgres 27093 0.0 0.0 30096 2752 ? Ss 11:34 0:00 postgres: ser <entry><structname>pg_stat_wal_receiver</structname><indexterm><primary>pg_stat_wal_receiver</primary></indexterm></entry> <entry>Only one row, showing statistics about the WAL receiver from that receiver's connected server. - See <xref linkend="pg-stat-wal-receiver-view"> for details. + See <xref linkend="pg-stat-wal-receiver-view"/> for details. </entry> </row> @@ -312,7 +312,7 @@ postgres 27093 0.0 0.0 30096 2752 ? Ss 11:34 0:00 postgres: ser <entry><structname>pg_stat_subscription</structname><indexterm><primary>pg_stat_subscription</primary></indexterm></entry> <entry>At least one row per subscription, showing information about the subscription workers. - See <xref linkend="pg-stat-subscription"> for details. + See <xref linkend="pg-stat-subscription"/> for details. </entry> </row> @@ -320,7 +320,7 @@ postgres 27093 0.0 0.0 30096 2752 ? Ss 11:34 0:00 postgres: ser <entry><structname>pg_stat_ssl</structname><indexterm><primary>pg_stat_ssl</primary></indexterm></entry> <entry>One row per connection (regular and replication), showing information about SSL used on this connection. - See <xref linkend="pg-stat-ssl-view"> for details. + See <xref linkend="pg-stat-ssl-view"/> for details. </entry> </row> @@ -328,7 +328,7 @@ postgres 27093 0.0 0.0 30096 2752 ? Ss 11:34 0:00 postgres: ser <entry><structname>pg_stat_progress_vacuum</structname><indexterm><primary>pg_stat_progress_vacuum</primary></indexterm></entry> <entry>One row for each backend (including autovacuum worker processes) running <command>VACUUM</command>, showing current progress. - See <xref linkend='vacuum-progress-reporting'>. + See <xref linkend='vacuum-progress-reporting'/>. </entry> </row> @@ -352,7 +352,7 @@ postgres 27093 0.0 0.0 30096 2752 ? Ss 11:34 0:00 postgres: ser <entry><structname>pg_stat_archiver</structname><indexterm><primary>pg_stat_archiver</primary></indexterm></entry> <entry>One row only, showing statistics about the WAL archiver process's activity. See - <xref linkend="pg-stat-archiver-view"> for details. + <xref linkend="pg-stat-archiver-view"/> for details. </entry> </row> @@ -360,14 +360,14 @@ postgres 27093 0.0 0.0 30096 2752 ? Ss 11:34 0:00 postgres: ser <entry><structname>pg_stat_bgwriter</structname><indexterm><primary>pg_stat_bgwriter</primary></indexterm></entry> <entry>One row only, showing statistics about the background writer process's activity. See - <xref linkend="pg-stat-bgwriter-view"> for details. + <xref linkend="pg-stat-bgwriter-view"/> for details. </entry> </row> <row> <entry><structname>pg_stat_database</structname><indexterm><primary>pg_stat_database</primary></indexterm></entry> <entry>One row per database, showing database-wide statistics. See - <xref linkend="pg-stat-database-view"> for details. + <xref linkend="pg-stat-database-view"/> for details. </entry> </row> @@ -376,7 +376,7 @@ postgres 27093 0.0 0.0 30096 2752 ? Ss 11:34 0:00 postgres: ser <entry> One row per database, showing database-wide statistics about query cancels due to conflict with recovery on standby servers. - See <xref linkend="pg-stat-database-conflicts-view"> for details. + See <xref linkend="pg-stat-database-conflicts-view"/> for details. </entry> </row> @@ -385,7 +385,7 @@ postgres 27093 0.0 0.0 30096 2752 ? Ss 11:34 0:00 postgres: ser <entry> One row for each table in the current database, showing statistics about accesses to that specific table. - See <xref linkend="pg-stat-all-tables-view"> for details. + See <xref linkend="pg-stat-all-tables-view"/> for details. </entry> </row> @@ -427,7 +427,7 @@ postgres 27093 0.0 0.0 30096 2752 ? Ss 11:34 0:00 postgres: ser <entry> One row for each index in the current database, showing statistics about accesses to that specific index. - See <xref linkend="pg-stat-all-indexes-view"> for details. + See <xref linkend="pg-stat-all-indexes-view"/> for details. </entry> </row> @@ -448,7 +448,7 @@ postgres 27093 0.0 0.0 30096 2752 ? Ss 11:34 0:00 postgres: ser <entry> One row for each table in the current database, showing statistics about I/O on that specific table. - See <xref linkend="pg-statio-all-tables-view"> for details. + See <xref linkend="pg-statio-all-tables-view"/> for details. </entry> </row> @@ -469,7 +469,7 @@ postgres 27093 0.0 0.0 30096 2752 ? Ss 11:34 0:00 postgres: ser <entry> One row for each index in the current database, showing statistics about I/O on that specific index. - See <xref linkend="pg-statio-all-indexes-view"> for details. + See <xref linkend="pg-statio-all-indexes-view"/> for details. </entry> </row> @@ -490,7 +490,7 @@ postgres 27093 0.0 0.0 30096 2752 ? Ss 11:34 0:00 postgres: ser <entry> One row for each sequence in the current database, showing statistics about I/O on that specific sequence. - See <xref linkend="pg-statio-all-sequences-view"> for details. + See <xref linkend="pg-statio-all-sequences-view"/> for details. </entry> </row> @@ -512,7 +512,7 @@ postgres 27093 0.0 0.0 30096 2752 ? Ss 11:34 0:00 postgres: ser <entry> One row for each tracked function, showing statistics about executions of that function. See - <xref linkend="pg-stat-user-functions-view"> for details. + <xref linkend="pg-stat-user-functions-view"/> for details. </entry> </row> @@ -609,7 +609,7 @@ postgres 27093 0.0 0.0 30096 2752 ? Ss 11:34 0:00 postgres: ser <entry>Host name of the connected client, as reported by a reverse DNS lookup of <structfield>client_addr</structfield>. This field will only be non-null for IP connections, and only when <xref - linkend="guc-log-hostname"> is enabled. + linkend="guc-log-hostname"/> is enabled. </entry> </row> <row> @@ -731,7 +731,7 @@ postgres 27093 0.0 0.0 30096 2752 ? Ss 11:34 0:00 postgres: ser <entry><structfield>wait_event</structfield></entry> <entry><type>text</type></entry> <entry>Wait event name if backend is currently waiting, otherwise NULL. - See <xref linkend="wait-event-table"> for details. + See <xref linkend="wait-event-table"/> for details. </entry> </row> <row> @@ -772,7 +772,7 @@ postgres 27093 0.0 0.0 30096 2752 ? Ss 11:34 0:00 postgres: ser <listitem> <para> <literal>disabled</literal>: This state is reported if <xref - linkend="guc-track-activities"> is disabled in this backend. + linkend="guc-track-activities"/> is disabled in this backend. </para> </listitem> </itemizedlist> @@ -796,7 +796,7 @@ postgres 27093 0.0 0.0 30096 2752 ? Ss 11:34 0:00 postgres: ser currently executing query. In all other states, it shows the last query that was executed. By default the query text is truncated at 1024 characters; this value can be changed via the parameter - <xref linkend="guc-track-activity-query-size">. + <xref linkend="guc-track-activity-query-size"/>. </entry> </row> <row> @@ -1683,7 +1683,7 @@ SELECT pid, wait_event_type, wait_event FROM pg_stat_activity WHERE wait_event i <entry>Host name of the connected client, as reported by a reverse DNS lookup of <structfield>client_addr</structfield>. This field will only be non-null for IP connections, and only when <xref - linkend="guc-log-hostname"> is enabled. + linkend="guc-log-hostname"/> is enabled. </entry> </row> <row> @@ -1704,7 +1704,7 @@ SELECT pid, wait_event_type, wait_event FROM pg_stat_activity WHERE wait_event i <entry><structfield>backend_xmin</structfield></entry> <entry><type>xid</type></entry> <entry>This standby's <literal>xmin</literal> horizon reported - by <xref linkend="guc-hot-standby-feedback">.</entry> + by <xref linkend="guc-hot-standby-feedback"/>.</entry> </row> <row> <entry><structfield>state</structfield></entry> @@ -2347,7 +2347,7 @@ SELECT pid, wait_event_type, wait_event FROM pg_stat_activity WHERE wait_event i <entry><type>bigint</type></entry> <entry>Number of queries canceled due to conflicts with recovery in this database. (Conflicts occur only on standby servers; see - <xref linkend="pg-stat-database-conflicts-view"> for details.) + <xref linkend="pg-stat-database-conflicts-view"/> for details.) </entry> </row> <row> @@ -2356,7 +2356,7 @@ SELECT pid, wait_event_type, wait_event FROM pg_stat_activity WHERE wait_event i <entry>Number of temporary files created by queries in this database. All temporary files are counted, regardless of why the temporary file was created (e.g., sorting or hashing), and regardless of the - <xref linkend="guc-log-temp-files"> setting. + <xref linkend="guc-log-temp-files"/> setting. </entry> </row> <row> @@ -2365,7 +2365,7 @@ SELECT pid, wait_event_type, wait_event FROM pg_stat_activity WHERE wait_event i <entry>Total amount of data written to temporary files by queries in this database. All temporary files are counted, regardless of why the temporary file was created, and - regardless of the <xref linkend="guc-log-temp-files"> setting. + regardless of the <xref linkend="guc-log-temp-files"/> setting. </entry> </row> <row> @@ -2942,7 +2942,7 @@ SELECT pid, wait_event_type, wait_event FROM pg_stat_activity WHERE wait_event i <para> The <structname>pg_stat_user_functions</structname> view will contain one row for each tracked function, showing statistics about executions of - that function. The <xref linkend="guc-track-functions"> parameter + that function. The <xref linkend="guc-track-functions"/> parameter controls exactly which functions are tracked. </para> @@ -2967,7 +2967,7 @@ SELECT pid, wait_event_type, wait_event FROM pg_stat_activity WHERE wait_event i <para> Additional functions related to statistics collection are listed in <xref - linkend="monitoring-stats-funcs-table">. + linkend="monitoring-stats-funcs-table"/>. </para> <table id="monitoring-stats-funcs-table"> @@ -3074,7 +3074,7 @@ SELECT pid, wait_event_type, wait_event FROM pg_stat_activity WHERE wait_event i Sometimes it may be more convenient to obtain just a subset of this information. In such cases, an older set of per-backend statistics access functions can be used; these are shown in <xref - linkend="monitoring-stats-backend-funcs-table">. + linkend="monitoring-stats-backend-funcs-table"/>. These access functions use a backend ID number, which ranges from one to the number of currently active backends. The function <function>pg_stat_get_backend_idset</function> provides a @@ -3162,7 +3162,7 @@ SELECT pg_stat_get_backend_pid(s.backendid) AS pid, <entry><literal><function>pg_stat_get_backend_wait_event_type(integer)</function></literal></entry> <entry><type>text</type></entry> <entry>Wait event type name if backend is currently waiting, otherwise NULL. - See <xref linkend="wait-event-table"> for details. + See <xref linkend="wait-event-table"/> for details. </entry> </row> @@ -3170,7 +3170,7 @@ SELECT pg_stat_get_backend_pid(s.backendid) AS pid, <entry><literal><function>pg_stat_get_backend_wait_event(integer)</function></literal></entry> <entry><type>text</type></entry> <entry>Wait event name if backend is currently waiting, otherwise NULL. - See <xref linkend="wait-event-table"> for details. + See <xref linkend="wait-event-table"/> for details. </entry> </row> @@ -3230,9 +3230,9 @@ SELECT pg_stat_get_backend_pid(s.backendid) AS pid, </itemizedlist> Details of the <structname>pg_locks</structname> view appear in - <xref linkend="view-pg-locks">. + <xref linkend="view-pg-locks"/>. For more information on locking and managing concurrency with - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>, refer to <xref linkend="mvcc">. + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>, refer to <xref linkend="mvcc"/>. </para> </sect1> @@ -3296,7 +3296,7 @@ SELECT pg_stat_get_backend_pid(s.backendid) AS pid, <entry><structfield>phase</structfield></entry> <entry><type>text</type></entry> <entry> - Current processing phase of vacuum. See <xref linkend='vacuum-phases'>. + Current processing phase of vacuum. See <xref linkend='vacuum-phases'/>. </entry> </row> <row> @@ -3343,7 +3343,7 @@ SELECT pg_stat_get_backend_pid(s.backendid) AS pid, <entry> Number of dead tuples that we can store before needing to perform an index vacuum cycle, based on - <xref linkend="guc-maintenance-work-mem">. + <xref linkend="guc-maintenance-work-mem"/>. </entry> </row> <row> @@ -3390,7 +3390,7 @@ SELECT pg_stat_get_backend_pid(s.backendid) AS pid, <command>VACUUM</command> is currently vacuuming the indexes. If a table has any indexes, this will happen at least once per vacuum, after the heap has been completely scanned. It may happen multiple times per vacuum - if <xref linkend="guc-maintenance-work-mem"> is insufficient to + if <xref linkend="guc-maintenance-work-mem"/> is insufficient to store the number of dead tuples found. </entry> </row> @@ -3478,7 +3478,7 @@ SELECT pg_stat_get_backend_pid(s.backendid) AS pid, explicitly tell the configure script to make the probes available in <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>. To include DTrace support specify <option>--enable-dtrace</option> to configure. See <xref - linkend="install-procedure"> for further information. + linkend="install-procedure"/> for further information. </para> </sect2> @@ -3487,8 +3487,8 @@ SELECT pg_stat_get_backend_pid(s.backendid) AS pid, <para> A number of standard probes are provided in the source code, - as shown in <xref linkend="dtrace-probe-point-table">; - <xref linkend="typedefs-table"> + as shown in <xref linkend="dtrace-probe-point-table"/>; + <xref linkend="typedefs-table"/> shows the types used in the probes. More probes can certainly be added to enhance <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>'s observability. </para> @@ -3752,7 +3752,7 @@ SELECT pg_stat_get_backend_pid(s.backendid) AS pid, <entry><literal>(ForkNumber, BlockNumber, Oid, Oid, Oid)</literal></entry> <entry>Probe that fires when a server process begins to write a dirty buffer. (If this happens often, it implies that - <xref linkend="guc-shared-buffers"> is too + <xref linkend="guc-shared-buffers"/> is too small or the background writer control parameters need adjustment.) arg0 and arg1 contain the fork and block numbers of the page. arg2, arg3, and arg4 contain the tablespace, database, and relation OIDs @@ -3770,7 +3770,7 @@ SELECT pg_stat_get_backend_pid(s.backendid) AS pid, <entry>Probe that fires when a server process begins to write a dirty WAL buffer because no more WAL buffer space is available. (If this happens often, it implies that - <xref linkend="guc-wal-buffers"> is too small.)</entry> + <xref linkend="guc-wal-buffers"/> is too small.)</entry> </row> <row> <entry><literal>wal-buffer-write-dirty-done</literal></entry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/mvcc.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/mvcc.sgml index a0ca2851e57..24613e3c754 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/mvcc.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/mvcc.sgml @@ -165,7 +165,7 @@ <primary>transaction isolation level</primary> </indexterm> The SQL standard and PostgreSQL-implemented transaction isolation levels - are described in <xref linkend="mvcc-isolevel-table">. + are described in <xref linkend="mvcc-isolevel-table"/>. </para> <table tocentry="1" id="mvcc-isolevel-table"> @@ -286,7 +286,7 @@ <para> To set the transaction isolation level of a transaction, use the - command <xref linkend="sql-set-transaction">. + command <xref linkend="sql-set-transaction"/>. </para> <important> @@ -296,8 +296,8 @@ made to a sequence (and therefore the counter of a column declared using <type>serial</type>) are immediately visible to all other transactions and are not rolled back if the transaction - that made the changes aborts. See <xref linkend="functions-sequence"> - and <xref linkend="datatype-serial">. + that made the changes aborts. See <xref linkend="functions-sequence"/> + and <xref linkend="datatype-serial"/>. </para> </important> @@ -461,7 +461,7 @@ COMMIT; even though they are not yet committed.) This is a stronger guarantee than is required by the <acronym>SQL</acronym> standard for this isolation level, and prevents all of the phenomena described - in <xref linkend="mvcc-isolevel-table"> except for serialization + in <xref linkend="mvcc-isolevel-table"/> except for serialization anomalies. As mentioned above, this is specifically allowed by the standard, which only describes the <emphasis>minimum</emphasis> protections each isolation level must @@ -748,7 +748,7 @@ ERROR: could not serialize access due to read/write dependencies among transact <para> Don't leave connections dangling <quote>idle in transaction</quote> longer than necessary. The configuration parameter - <xref linkend="guc-idle-in-transaction-session-timeout"> may be used to + <xref linkend="guc-idle-in-transaction-session-timeout"/> may be used to automatically disconnect lingering sessions. </para> </listitem> @@ -765,9 +765,9 @@ ERROR: could not serialize access due to read/write dependencies among transact locks into a single relation-level predicate lock because the predicate lock table is short of memory, an increase in the rate of serialization failures may occur. You can avoid this by increasing - <xref linkend="guc-max-pred-locks-per-transaction">, - <xref linkend="guc-max-pred-locks-per-relation">, and/or - <xref linkend="guc-max-pred-locks-per-page">. + <xref linkend="guc-max-pred-locks-per-transaction"/>, + <xref linkend="guc-max-pred-locks-per-relation"/>, and/or + <xref linkend="guc-max-pred-locks-per-page"/>. </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -775,8 +775,8 @@ ERROR: could not serialize access due to read/write dependencies among transact A sequential scan will always necessitate a relation-level predicate lock. This can result in an increased rate of serialization failures. It may be helpful to encourage the use of index scans by reducing - <xref linkend="guc-random-page-cost"> and/or increasing - <xref linkend="guc-cpu-tuple-cost">. Be sure to weigh any decrease + <xref linkend="guc-random-page-cost"/> and/or increasing + <xref linkend="guc-cpu-tuple-cost"/>. Be sure to weigh any decrease in transaction rollbacks and restarts against any overall change in query execution time. </para> @@ -811,7 +811,7 @@ ERROR: could not serialize access due to read/write dependencies among transact server, use the <link linkend="view-pg-locks"><structname>pg_locks</structname></link> system view. For more information on monitoring the status of the lock - manager subsystem, refer to <xref linkend="monitoring">. + manager subsystem, refer to <xref linkend="monitoring"/>. </para> <sect2 id="locking-tables"> @@ -826,14 +826,14 @@ ERROR: could not serialize access due to read/write dependencies among transact which they are used automatically by <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>. You can also acquire any of these locks explicitly with the command <xref - linkend="sql-lock">. + linkend="sql-lock"/>. Remember that all of these lock modes are table-level locks, even if the name contains the word <quote>row</quote>; the names of the lock modes are historical. To some extent the names reflect the typical usage of each lock mode — but the semantics are all the same. The only real difference between one lock mode and another is the set of lock modes with - which each conflicts (see <xref linkend="table-lock-compatibility">). + which each conflicts (see <xref linkend="table-lock-compatibility"/>). Two transactions cannot hold locks of conflicting modes on the same table at the same time. (However, a transaction never conflicts with itself. For example, it might acquire @@ -929,7 +929,7 @@ ERROR: could not serialize access due to read/write dependencies among transact <command>CREATE STATISTICS</command> and <command>ALTER TABLE VALIDATE</command> and other <command>ALTER TABLE</command> variants (for full details see - <xref linkend="sql-altertable">). + <xref linkend="sql-altertable"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -972,7 +972,7 @@ ERROR: could not serialize access due to read/write dependencies among transact <para> Acquired by <command>CREATE COLLATION</command>, <command>CREATE TRIGGER</command>, and many forms of - <command>ALTER TABLE</command> (see <xref linkend="sql-altertable">). + <command>ALTER TABLE</command> (see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -1053,9 +1053,9 @@ ERROR: could not serialize access due to read/write dependencies among transact <table tocentry="1" id="table-lock-compatibility"> <title> Conflicting Lock Modes</title> <tgroup cols="9"> - <colspec colnum="2" colname="lockst"> - <colspec colnum="9" colname="lockend"> - <spanspec namest="lockst" nameend="lockend" spanname="lockreq"> + <colspec colnum="2" colname="lockst"/> + <colspec colnum="9" colname="lockend"/> + <spanspec namest="lockst" nameend="lockend" spanname="lockreq"/> <thead> <row> <entry morerows="1">Requested Lock Mode</entry> @@ -1173,7 +1173,7 @@ ERROR: could not serialize access due to read/write dependencies among transact In addition to table-level locks, there are row-level locks, which are listed as below with the contexts in which they are used automatically by <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>. See - <xref linkend="row-lock-compatibility"> for a complete table of + <xref linkend="row-lock-compatibility"/> for a complete table of row-level lock conflicts. Note that a transaction can hold conflicting locks on the same row, even in different subtransactions; but other than that, two transactions can never hold conflicting locks @@ -1208,7 +1208,7 @@ ERROR: could not serialize access due to read/write dependencies among transact <literal>SERIALIZABLE</literal> transaction, however, an error will be thrown if a row to be locked has changed since the transaction started. For further discussion see - <xref linkend="applevel-consistency">. + <xref linkend="applevel-consistency"/>. </para> <para> The <literal>FOR UPDATE</literal> lock mode @@ -1286,9 +1286,9 @@ ERROR: could not serialize access due to read/write dependencies among transact <table tocentry="1" id="row-lock-compatibility"> <title>Conflicting Row-level Locks</title> <tgroup cols="5"> - <colspec colnum="2" colname="lockst"> - <colspec colnum="5" colname="lockend"> - <spanspec namest="lockst" nameend="lockend" spanname="lockreq"> + <colspec colnum="2" colname="lockst"/> + <colspec colnum="5" colname="lockend"/> + <spanspec namest="lockst" nameend="lockend" spanname="lockreq"/> <thead> <row> <entry morerows="1">Requested Lock Mode</entry> @@ -1495,8 +1495,8 @@ UPDATE accounts SET balance = balance - 100.00 WHERE acctnum = 22222; <para> Both advisory locks and regular locks are stored in a shared memory pool whose size is defined by the configuration variables - <xref linkend="guc-max-locks-per-transaction"> and - <xref linkend="guc-max-connections">. + <xref linkend="guc-max-locks-per-transaction"/> and + <xref linkend="guc-max-connections"/>. Care must be taken not to exhaust this memory or the server will be unable to grant any locks at all. This imposes an upper limit on the number of advisory locks @@ -1529,7 +1529,7 @@ SELECT pg_advisory_lock(q.id) FROM <para> The functions provided to manipulate advisory locks are described in - <xref linkend="functions-advisory-locks">. + <xref linkend="functions-advisory-locks"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1565,7 +1565,7 @@ SELECT pg_advisory_lock(q.id) FROM </para> <para> - As mentioned in <xref linkend="xact-serializable">, Serializable + As mentioned in <xref linkend="xact-serializable"/>, Serializable transactions are just Repeatable Read transactions which add nonblocking monitoring for dangerous patterns of read/write conflicts. When a pattern is detected which could cause a cycle in the apparent @@ -1598,13 +1598,13 @@ SELECT pg_advisory_lock(q.id) FROM </para> <para> - See <xref linkend="xact-serializable"> for performance suggestions. + See <xref linkend="xact-serializable"/> for performance suggestions. </para> <warning> <para> This level of integrity protection using Serializable transactions - does not yet extend to hot standby mode (<xref linkend="hot-standby">). + does not yet extend to hot standby mode (<xref linkend="hot-standby"/>). Because of that, those using hot standby may want to use Repeatable Read and explicit locking on the master. </para> @@ -1687,8 +1687,8 @@ SELECT pg_advisory_lock(q.id) FROM <title>Caveats</title> <para> - Some DDL commands, currently only <xref linkend="sql-truncate"> and the - table-rewriting forms of <xref linkend="sql-altertable">, are not + Some DDL commands, currently only <xref linkend="sql-truncate"/> and the + table-rewriting forms of <xref linkend="sql-altertable"/>, are not MVCC-safe. This means that after the truncation or rewrite commits, the table will appear empty to concurrent transactions, if they are using a snapshot taken before the DDL command committed. This will only be an @@ -1705,7 +1705,7 @@ SELECT pg_advisory_lock(q.id) FROM <para> Support for the Serializable transaction isolation level has not yet been added to Hot Standby replication targets (described in - <xref linkend="hot-standby">). The strictest isolation level currently + <xref linkend="hot-standby"/>). The strictest isolation level currently supported in hot standby mode is Repeatable Read. While performing all permanent database writes within Serializable transactions on the master will ensure that all standbys will eventually reach a consistent diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/nls.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/nls.sgml index f312b5bfb5d..16e25abd31e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/nls.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/nls.sgml @@ -272,7 +272,7 @@ msgstr "Die Datei %2$s hat %1$u Zeichen." open file %s</literal>) should probably not start with a capital letter (if your language distinguishes letter case) or end with a period (if your language uses punctuation marks). - It might help to read <xref linkend="error-style-guide">. + It might help to read <xref linkend="error-style-guide"/>. </para> </listitem> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/oid2name.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/oid2name.sgml index 4ab2cf1a859..dd875281c81 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/oid2name.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/oid2name.sgml @@ -30,7 +30,7 @@ <application>oid2name</application> is a utility program that helps administrators to examine the file structure used by PostgreSQL. To make use of it, you need to be familiar with the database file structure, which is described in - <xref linkend="storage">. + <xref linkend="storage"/>. </para> <note> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/parallel.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/parallel.sgml index 6aac506942e..f15a9233cbf 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/parallel.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/parallel.sgml @@ -64,10 +64,10 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT * FROM pgbench_accounts WHERE filler LIKE '%x%'; worker processes</link> equal to the number of workers chosen by the planner. The number of background workers that the planner will consider using is limited to at most - <xref linkend="guc-max-parallel-workers-per-gather">. The total number + <xref linkend="guc-max-parallel-workers-per-gather"/>. The total number of background workers that can exist at any one time is limited by both - <xref linkend="guc-max-worker-processes"> and - <xref linkend="guc-max-parallel-workers">. Therefore, it is possible for a + <xref linkend="guc-max-worker-processes"/> and + <xref linkend="guc-max-parallel-workers"/>. Therefore, it is possible for a parallel query to run with fewer workers than planned, or even with no workers at all. The optimal plan may depend on the number of workers that are available, so this can result in poor query performance. If this @@ -118,7 +118,7 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT * FROM pgbench_accounts WHERE filler LIKE '%x%'; <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> - <xref linkend="guc-max-parallel-workers-per-gather"> must be set to a + <xref linkend="guc-max-parallel-workers-per-gather"/> must be set to a value which is greater than zero. This is a special case of the more general principle that no more workers should be used than the number configured via <varname>max_parallel_workers_per_gather</varname>. @@ -127,7 +127,7 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT * FROM pgbench_accounts WHERE filler LIKE '%x%'; <listitem> <para> - <xref linkend="guc-dynamic-shared-memory-type"> must be set to a + <xref linkend="guc-dynamic-shared-memory-type"/> must be set to a value other than <literal>none</literal>. Parallel query requires dynamic shared memory in order to pass data between cooperating processes. </para> @@ -178,7 +178,7 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT * FROM pgbench_accounts WHERE filler LIKE '%x%'; Most system-defined functions are <literal>PARALLEL SAFE</literal>, but user-defined functions are marked <literal>PARALLEL UNSAFE</literal> by default. See the discussion of - <xref linkend="parallel-safety">. + <xref linkend="parallel-safety"/>. </para> </listitem> @@ -215,7 +215,7 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT * FROM pgbench_accounts WHERE filler LIKE '%x%'; <para> No background workers can be obtained because of the limitation that the total number of background workers cannot exceed - <xref linkend="guc-max-worker-processes">. + <xref linkend="guc-max-worker-processes"/>. </para> </listitem> @@ -223,7 +223,7 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT * FROM pgbench_accounts WHERE filler LIKE '%x%'; <para> No background workers can be obtained because of the limitation that the total number of background workers launched for purposes of - parallel query cannot exceed <xref linkend="guc-max-parallel-workers">. + parallel query cannot exceed <xref linkend="guc-max-parallel-workers"/>. </para> </listitem> @@ -236,7 +236,7 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT * FROM pgbench_accounts WHERE filler LIKE '%x%'; send such a message, this can only occur when using a client that does not rely on libpq. If this is a frequent occurrence, it may be a good idea to set - <xref linkend="guc-max-parallel-workers-per-gather"> to zero in + <xref linkend="guc-max-parallel-workers-per-gather"/> to zero in sessions where it is likely, so as to avoid generating query plans that may be suboptimal when run serially. </para> @@ -374,7 +374,7 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT * FROM pgbench_accounts WHERE filler LIKE '%x%'; must be <link linkend="parallel-safety">safe</link> for parallelism and must have a combine function. If the aggregate has a transition state of type <literal>internal</literal>, it must have serialization and deserialization - functions. See <xref linkend="sql-createaggregate"> for more details. + functions. See <xref linkend="sql-createaggregate"/> for more details. Parallel aggregation is not supported if any aggregate function call contains <literal>DISTINCT</literal> or <literal>ORDER BY</literal> clause and is also not supported for ordered set aggregates or when the query involves @@ -389,15 +389,15 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT * FROM pgbench_accounts WHERE filler LIKE '%x%'; <para> If a query that is expected to do so does not produce a parallel plan, - you can try reducing <xref linkend="guc-parallel-setup-cost"> or - <xref linkend="guc-parallel-tuple-cost">. Of course, this plan may turn + you can try reducing <xref linkend="guc-parallel-setup-cost"/> or + <xref linkend="guc-parallel-tuple-cost"/>. Of course, this plan may turn out to be slower than the serial plan which the planner preferred, but this will not always be the case. If you don't get a parallel plan even with very small values of these settings (e.g. after setting them both to zero), there may be some reason why the query planner is unable to generate a parallel plan for your query. See - <xref linkend="when-can-parallel-query-be-used"> and - <xref linkend="parallel-safety"> for information on why this may be + <xref linkend="when-can-parallel-query-be-used"/> and + <xref linkend="parallel-safety"/> for information on why this may be the case. </para> @@ -473,11 +473,11 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT * FROM pgbench_accounts WHERE filler LIKE '%x%'; where it conceivably be done, we do not try, since this would be expensive and error-prone. Instead, all user-defined functions are assumed to be parallel unsafe unless otherwise marked. When using - <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"> or - <xref linkend="sql-alterfunction">, markings can be set by specifying + <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"/> or + <xref linkend="sql-alterfunction"/>, markings can be set by specifying <literal>PARALLEL SAFE</literal>, <literal>PARALLEL RESTRICTED</literal>, or <literal>PARALLEL UNSAFE</literal> as appropriate. When using - <xref linkend="sql-createaggregate">, the + <xref linkend="sql-createaggregate"/>, the <literal>PARALLEL</literal> option can be specified with <literal>SAFE</literal>, <literal>RESTRICTED</literal>, or <literal>UNSAFE</literal> as the corresponding value. </para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/passwordcheck.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/passwordcheck.sgml index d034f8887f3..3db169b4c18 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/passwordcheck.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/passwordcheck.sgml @@ -10,15 +10,15 @@ <para> The <filename>passwordcheck</filename> module checks users' passwords whenever they are set with - <xref linkend="sql-createrole"> or - <xref linkend="sql-alterrole">. + <xref linkend="sql-createrole"/> or + <xref linkend="sql-alterrole"/>. If a password is considered too weak, it will be rejected and the command will terminate with an error. </para> <para> To enable this module, add <literal>'$libdir/passwordcheck'</literal> - to <xref linkend="guc-shared-preload-libraries"> in + to <xref linkend="guc-shared-preload-libraries"/> in <filename>postgresql.conf</filename>, then restart the server. </para> @@ -49,7 +49,7 @@ For this reason, <filename>passwordcheck</filename> is not recommended if your security requirements are high. It is more secure to use an external authentication method such as GSSAPI - (see <xref linkend="client-authentication">) than to rely on + (see <xref linkend="client-authentication"/>) than to rely on passwords within the database. </para> <para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/perform.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/perform.sgml index fed5c956a20..a51fd1c7dcd 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/perform.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/perform.sgml @@ -31,7 +31,7 @@ plan to match the query structure and the properties of the data is absolutely critical for good performance, so the system includes a complex <firstterm>planner</firstterm> that tries to choose good plans. - You can use the <xref linkend="sql-explain"> command + You can use the <xref linkend="sql-explain"/> command to see what query plan the planner creates for any query. Plan-reading is an art that requires some experience to master, but this section attempts to cover the basics. @@ -132,9 +132,9 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT * FROM tenk1; <para> The costs are measured in arbitrary units determined by the planner's - cost parameters (see <xref linkend="runtime-config-query-constants">). + cost parameters (see <xref linkend="runtime-config-query-constants"/>). Traditional practice is to measure the costs in units of disk page - fetches; that is, <xref linkend="guc-seq-page-cost"> is conventionally + fetches; that is, <xref linkend="guc-seq-page-cost"/> is conventionally set to <literal>1.0</literal> and the other cost parameters are set relative to that. The examples in this section are run with the default cost parameters. @@ -182,8 +182,8 @@ SELECT relpages, reltuples FROM pg_class WHERE relname = 'tenk1'; you will find that <classname>tenk1</classname> has 358 disk pages and 10000 rows. The estimated cost is computed as (disk pages read * - <xref linkend="guc-seq-page-cost">) + (rows scanned * - <xref linkend="guc-cpu-tuple-cost">). By default, + <xref linkend="guc-seq-page-cost"/>) + (rows scanned * + <xref linkend="guc-cpu-tuple-cost"/>). By default, <varname>seq_page_cost</varname> is 1.0 and <varname>cpu_tuple_cost</varname> is 0.01, so the estimated cost is (358 * 1.0) + (10000 * 0.01) = 458. </para> @@ -209,7 +209,7 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT * FROM tenk1 WHERE unique1 < 7000; <literal>WHERE</literal> clause. However, the scan will still have to visit all 10000 rows, so the cost hasn't decreased; in fact it has gone up a bit (by 10000 * <xref - linkend="guc-cpu-operator-cost">, to be exact) to reflect the extra CPU + linkend="guc-cpu-operator-cost"/>, to be exact) to reflect the extra CPU time spent checking the <literal>WHERE</literal> condition. </para> @@ -508,9 +508,9 @@ WHERE t1.unique1 < 100 AND t1.unique2 = t2.unique2; <para> One way to look at variant plans is to force the planner to disregard whatever strategy it thought was the cheapest, using the enable/disable - flags described in <xref linkend="runtime-config-query-enable">. + flags described in <xref linkend="runtime-config-query-enable"/>. (This is a crude tool, but useful. See - also <xref linkend="explicit-joins">.) + also <xref linkend="explicit-joins"/>.) For example, if we're unconvinced that sequential-scan-and-sort is the best way to deal with table <literal>onek</literal> in the previous example, we could try @@ -828,7 +828,7 @@ EXPLAIN UPDATE parent SET f2 = f2 + 1 WHERE f1 = 101; Second, the measurement overhead added by <command>EXPLAIN ANALYZE</command> can be significant, especially on machines with slow <function>gettimeofday()</function> operating-system calls. You can use the - <xref linkend="pgtesttiming"> tool to measure the overhead of timing + <xref linkend="pgtesttiming"/> tool to measure the overhead of timing on your system. </para> @@ -1032,7 +1032,7 @@ WHERE tablename = 'road'; arrays for each column, can be set on a column-by-column basis using the <command>ALTER TABLE SET STATISTICS</command> command, or globally by setting the - <xref linkend="guc-default-statistics-target"> configuration variable. + <xref linkend="guc-default-statistics-target"/> configuration variable. The default limit is presently 100 entries. Raising the limit might allow more accurate planner estimates to be made, particularly for columns with irregular data distributions, at the price of consuming @@ -1043,7 +1043,7 @@ WHERE tablename = 'road'; <para> Further details about the planner's use of statistics can be found in - <xref linkend="planner-stats-details">. + <xref linkend="planner-stats-details"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1087,7 +1087,7 @@ WHERE tablename = 'road'; <para> Statistics objects are created using - <xref linkend="sql-createstatistics">, which see for more details. + <xref linkend="sql-createstatistics"/>, which see for more details. Creation of such an object merely creates a catalog entry expressing interest in the statistics. Actual data collection is performed by <command>ANALYZE</command> (either a manual command, or background @@ -1323,7 +1323,7 @@ SELECT * FROM a, b, c WHERE a.id = b.id AND b.ref = c.id; <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> planner will switch from exhaustive search to a <firstterm>genetic</firstterm> probabilistic search through a limited number of possibilities. (The switch-over threshold is - set by the <xref linkend="guc-geqo-threshold"> run-time + set by the <xref linkend="guc-geqo-threshold"/> run-time parameter.) The genetic search takes less time, but it won't necessarily find the best possible plan. @@ -1379,7 +1379,7 @@ SELECT * FROM a JOIN (b JOIN c ON (b.ref = c.id)) ON (a.id = b.id); <para> To force the planner to follow the join order laid out by explicit <literal>JOIN</literal>s, - set the <xref linkend="guc-join-collapse-limit"> run-time parameter to 1. + set the <xref linkend="guc-join-collapse-limit"/> run-time parameter to 1. (Other possible values are discussed below.) </para> @@ -1436,8 +1436,8 @@ SELECT * FROM x, y, a, b, c WHERE something AND somethingelse; </para> <para> - <xref linkend="guc-from-collapse-limit"> and <xref - linkend="guc-join-collapse-limit"> + <xref linkend="guc-from-collapse-limit"/> and <xref + linkend="guc-join-collapse-limit"/> are similarly named because they do almost the same thing: one controls when the planner will <quote>flatten out</quote> subqueries, and the other controls when it will flatten out explicit joins. Typically @@ -1488,7 +1488,7 @@ SELECT * FROM x, y, a, b, c WHERE something AND somethingelse; <title>Use <command>COPY</command></title> <para> - Use <xref linkend="sql-copy"> to load + Use <xref linkend="sql-copy"/> to load all the rows in one command, instead of using a series of <command>INSERT</command> commands. The <command>COPY</command> command is optimized for loading large numbers of rows; it is less @@ -1500,7 +1500,7 @@ SELECT * FROM x, y, a, b, c WHERE something AND somethingelse; <para> If you cannot use <command>COPY</command>, it might help to use <xref - linkend="sql-prepare"> to create a + linkend="sql-prepare"/> to create a prepared <command>INSERT</command> statement, and then use <command>EXECUTE</command> as many times as required. This avoids some of the overhead of repeatedly parsing and planning @@ -1523,7 +1523,7 @@ SELECT * FROM x, y, a, b, c WHERE something AND somethingelse; needs to be written, because in case of an error, the files containing the newly loaded data will be removed anyway. However, this consideration only applies when - <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"> is <literal>minimal</literal> as all commands + <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"/> is <literal>minimal</literal> as all commands must write WAL otherwise. </para> @@ -1581,7 +1581,7 @@ SELECT * FROM x, y, a, b, c WHERE something AND somethingelse; <title>Increase <varname>maintenance_work_mem</varname></title> <para> - Temporarily increasing the <xref linkend="guc-maintenance-work-mem"> + Temporarily increasing the <xref linkend="guc-maintenance-work-mem"/> configuration variable when loading large amounts of data can lead to improved performance. This will help to speed up <command>CREATE INDEX</command> commands and <command>ALTER TABLE ADD FOREIGN KEY</command> commands. @@ -1594,7 +1594,7 @@ SELECT * FROM x, y, a, b, c WHERE something AND somethingelse; <title>Increase <varname>max_wal_size</varname></title> <para> - Temporarily increasing the <xref linkend="guc-max-wal-size"> + Temporarily increasing the <xref linkend="guc-max-wal-size"/> configuration variable can also make large data loads faster. This is because loading a large amount of data into <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> will @@ -1617,9 +1617,9 @@ SELECT * FROM x, y, a, b, c WHERE something AND somethingelse; new base backup after the load has completed than to process a large amount of incremental WAL data. To prevent incremental WAL logging while loading, disable archiving and streaming replication, by setting - <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"> to <literal>minimal</literal>, - <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"> to <literal>off</literal>, and - <xref linkend="guc-max-wal-senders"> to zero. + <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"/> to <literal>minimal</literal>, + <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"/> to <literal>off</literal>, and + <xref linkend="guc-max-wal-senders"/> to zero. But note that changing these settings requires a server restart. </para> @@ -1668,7 +1668,7 @@ SELECT * FROM x, y, a, b, c WHERE something AND somethingelse; <para> Whenever you have significantly altered the distribution of data - within a table, running <xref linkend="sql-analyze"> is strongly recommended. This + within a table, running <xref linkend="sql-analyze"/> is strongly recommended. This includes bulk loading large amounts of data into the table. Running <command>ANALYZE</command> (or <command>VACUUM ANALYZE</command>) ensures that the planner has up-to-date statistics about the @@ -1677,8 +1677,8 @@ SELECT * FROM x, y, a, b, c WHERE something AND somethingelse; performance on any tables with inaccurate or nonexistent statistics. Note that if the autovacuum daemon is enabled, it might run <command>ANALYZE</command> automatically; see - <xref linkend="vacuum-for-statistics"> - and <xref linkend="autovacuum"> for more information. + <xref linkend="vacuum-for-statistics"/> + and <xref linkend="autovacuum"/> for more information. </para> </sect2> @@ -1779,8 +1779,8 @@ SELECT * FROM x, y, a, b, c WHERE something AND somethingelse; <varname>maintenance_work_mem</varname>; rather, you'd do that while manually recreating indexes and foreign keys afterwards. And don't forget to <command>ANALYZE</command> when you're done; see - <xref linkend="vacuum-for-statistics"> - and <xref linkend="autovacuum"> for more information. + <xref linkend="vacuum-for-statistics"/> + and <xref linkend="autovacuum"/> for more information. </para> </sect2> </sect1> @@ -1816,14 +1816,14 @@ SELECT * FROM x, y, a, b, c WHERE something AND somethingelse; <listitem> <para> - Turn off <xref linkend="guc-fsync">; there is no need to flush + Turn off <xref linkend="guc-fsync"/>; there is no need to flush data to disk. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Turn off <xref linkend="guc-synchronous-commit">; there might be no + Turn off <xref linkend="guc-synchronous-commit"/>; there might be no need to force <acronym>WAL</acronym> writes to disk on every commit. This setting does risk transaction loss (though not data corruption) in case of a crash of the <emphasis>database</emphasis>. @@ -1832,15 +1832,15 @@ SELECT * FROM x, y, a, b, c WHERE something AND somethingelse; <listitem> <para> - Turn off <xref linkend="guc-full-page-writes">; there is no need + Turn off <xref linkend="guc-full-page-writes"/>; there is no need to guard against partial page writes. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Increase <xref linkend="guc-max-wal-size"> and <xref - linkend="guc-checkpoint-timeout">; this reduces the frequency + Increase <xref linkend="guc-max-wal-size"/> and <xref + linkend="guc-checkpoint-timeout"/>; this reduces the frequency of checkpoints, but increases the storage requirements of <filename>/pg_wal</filename>. </para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/pgbuffercache.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/pgbuffercache.sgml index 18ac781d0db..faf5a3115dc 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/pgbuffercache.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/pgbuffercache.sgml @@ -33,7 +33,7 @@ <title>The <structname>pg_buffercache</structname> View</title> <para> - The definitions of the columns exposed by the view are shown in <xref linkend="pgbuffercache-columns">. + The definitions of the columns exposed by the view are shown in <xref linkend="pgbuffercache-columns"/>. </para> <table id="pgbuffercache-columns"> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/pgcrypto.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/pgcrypto.sgml index 80595e193b9..25341d684c9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/pgcrypto.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/pgcrypto.sgml @@ -40,7 +40,7 @@ digest(data bytea, type text) returns bytea <literal>sha384</literal> and <literal>sha512</literal>. If <filename>pgcrypto</filename> was built with OpenSSL, more algorithms are available, as detailed in - <xref linkend="pgcrypto-with-without-openssl">. + <xref linkend="pgcrypto-with-without-openssl"/>. </para> <para> @@ -129,7 +129,7 @@ hmac(data bytea, key text, type text) returns bytea </orderedlist> <para> - <xref linkend="pgcrypto-crypt-algorithms"> lists the algorithms + <xref linkend="pgcrypto-crypt-algorithms"/> lists the algorithms supported by the <function>crypt()</function> function. </para> @@ -247,7 +247,7 @@ gen_salt(type text [, iter_count integer ]) returns text — which is somewhat impractical. If the <parameter>iter_count</parameter> parameter is omitted, the default iteration count is used. Allowed values for <parameter>iter_count</parameter> depend on the algorithm and - are shown in <xref linkend="pgcrypto-icfc-table">. + are shown in <xref linkend="pgcrypto-icfc-table"/>. </para> <table id="pgcrypto-icfc-table"> @@ -292,7 +292,7 @@ gen_salt(type text [, iter_count integer ]) returns text </para> <para> - <xref linkend="pgcrypto-hash-speed-table"> gives an overview of the relative slowness + <xref linkend="pgcrypto-hash-speed-table"/> gives an overview of the relative slowness of different hashing algorithms. The table shows how much time it would take to try all combinations of characters in an 8-character password, assuming diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/pgprewarm.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/pgprewarm.sgml index e0a6d0503f4..51afc5df3f5 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/pgprewarm.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/pgprewarm.sgml @@ -13,7 +13,7 @@ or the <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> buffer cache. Prewarming can be performed manually using the <filename>pg_prewarm</filename> function, or can be performed automatically by including <literal>pg_prewarm</literal> in - <xref linkend="guc-shared-preload-libraries">. In the latter case, the + <xref linkend="guc-shared-preload-libraries"/>. In the latter case, the system will run a background worker which periodically records the contents of shared buffers in a file called <filename>autoprewarm.blocks</filename> and will, using 2 background workers, reload those same blocks after a restart. diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/pgrowlocks.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/pgrowlocks.sgml index 57dcf6beb24..39de41a03cf 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/pgrowlocks.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/pgrowlocks.sgml @@ -33,7 +33,7 @@ pgrowlocks(text) returns setof record <para> The parameter is the name of a table. The result is a set of records, with one row for each locked row within the table. The output columns - are shown in <xref linkend="pgrowlocks-columns">. + are shown in <xref linkend="pgrowlocks-columns"/>. </para> <table id="pgrowlocks-columns"> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/pgstandby.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/pgstandby.sgml index 7feba8cdd6e..2cc58fe3567 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/pgstandby.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/pgstandby.sgml @@ -41,7 +41,7 @@ <varname>restore_command</varname>, which is needed to turn a standard archive recovery into a warm standby operation. Other configuration is required as well, all of which is described in the main - server manual (see <xref linkend="warm-standby">). + server manual (see <xref linkend="warm-standby"/>). </para> <para> @@ -180,7 +180,7 @@ restore_command = 'pg_standby <replaceable>archiveDir</replaceable> %f %p %r' Set the number of seconds (up to 60, default 5) to sleep between tests to see if the WAL file to be restored is available in the archive yet. The default setting is not necessarily - recommended; consult <xref linkend="warm-standby"> for discussion. + recommended; consult <xref linkend="warm-standby"/> for discussion. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -216,7 +216,7 @@ restore_command = 'pg_standby <replaceable>archiveDir</replaceable> %f %p %r' after which a fast failover will be performed. A setting of zero (the default) means wait forever. The default setting is not necessarily recommended; - consult <xref linkend="warm-standby"> for discussion. + consult <xref linkend="warm-standby"/> for discussion. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -388,7 +388,7 @@ recovery_end_command = 'del C:\pgsql.trigger.5442' <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="pgarchivecleanup"></member> + <member><xref linkend="pgarchivecleanup"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/pgstatstatements.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/pgstatstatements.sgml index 4b15a268cd7..c0217ed485f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/pgstatstatements.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/pgstatstatements.sgml @@ -14,7 +14,7 @@ <para> The module must be loaded by adding <literal>pg_stat_statements</literal> to - <xref linkend="guc-shared-preload-libraries"> in + <xref linkend="guc-shared-preload-libraries"/> in <filename>postgresql.conf</filename>, because it requires additional shared memory. This means that a server restart is needed to add or remove the module. </para> @@ -38,7 +38,7 @@ contains one row for each distinct database ID, user ID and query ID (up to the maximum number of distinct statements that the module can track). The columns of the view are shown in - <xref linkend="pgstatstatements-columns">. + <xref linkend="pgstatstatements-columns"/>. </para> <table id="pgstatstatements-columns"> @@ -207,7 +207,7 @@ <entry></entry> <entry> Total time the statement spent reading blocks, in milliseconds - (if <xref linkend="guc-track-io-timing"> is enabled, otherwise zero) + (if <xref linkend="guc-track-io-timing"/> is enabled, otherwise zero) </entry> </row> @@ -217,7 +217,7 @@ <entry></entry> <entry> Total time the statement spent writing blocks, in milliseconds - (if <xref linkend="guc-track-io-timing"> is enabled, otherwise zero) + (if <xref linkend="guc-track-io-timing"/> is enabled, otherwise zero) </entry> </row> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/pgstattuple.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/pgstattuple.sgml index 04a4423dc54..b17b3c59e0d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/pgstattuple.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/pgstattuple.sgml @@ -55,7 +55,7 @@ dead_tuple_percent | 0.69 free_space | 8932 free_percent | 1.95 </programlisting> - The output columns are described in <xref linkend="pgstattuple-columns">. + The output columns are described in <xref linkend="pgstattuple-columns"/>. </para> <table id="pgstattuple-columns"> @@ -509,7 +509,7 @@ dead_tuple_percent | 0 approx_free_space | 11996 approx_free_percent | 2.09 </programlisting> - The output columns are described in <xref linkend="pgstatapprox-columns">. + The output columns are described in <xref linkend="pgstatapprox-columns"/>. </para> <para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/pgtrgm.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/pgtrgm.sgml index 7903dc3d82b..338ef30fbcd 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/pgtrgm.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/pgtrgm.sgml @@ -58,8 +58,8 @@ <para> The functions provided by the <filename>pg_trgm</filename> module - are shown in <xref linkend="pgtrgm-func-table">, the operators - in <xref linkend="pgtrgm-op-table">. + are shown in <xref linkend="pgtrgm-func-table"/>, the operators + in <xref linkend="pgtrgm-op-table"/>. </para> <table id="pgtrgm-func-table"> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/planstats.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/planstats.sgml index ee081308a92..ef643ad0646 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/planstats.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/planstats.sgml @@ -5,7 +5,7 @@ <para> This chapter builds on the material covered in <xref - linkend="using-explain"> and <xref linkend="planner-stats"> to show some + linkend="using-explain"/> and <xref linkend="planner-stats"/> to show some additional details about how the planner uses the system statistics to estimate the number of rows each part of a query might return. This is a significant part of the planning process, @@ -49,7 +49,7 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT * FROM tenk1; </programlisting> How the planner determines the cardinality of <structname>tenk1</structname> - is covered in <xref linkend="planner-stats">, but is repeated here for + is covered in <xref linkend="planner-stats"/>, but is repeated here for completeness. The number of pages and rows is looked up in <structname>pg_class</structname>: @@ -468,7 +468,7 @@ INSERT INTO t SELECT i % 100, i % 100 FROM generate_series(1, 10000) s(i); ANALYZE t; </programlisting> - As explained in <xref linkend="planner-stats">, the planner can determine + As explained in <xref linkend="planner-stats"/>, the planner can determine cardinality of <structname>t</structname> using the number of pages and rows obtained from <structname>pg_class</structname>: diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/plhandler.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/plhandler.sgml index 95e7dc9fc0e..363f84b9f34 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/plhandler.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/plhandler.sgml @@ -29,7 +29,7 @@ special pseudo-type identifies the function as a call handler and prevents it from being called directly in SQL commands. For more details on C language calling conventions and dynamic loading, - see <xref linkend="xfunc-c">. + see <xref linkend="xfunc-c"/>. </para> <para> @@ -144,7 +144,7 @@ plsample_call_handler(PG_FUNCTION_ARGS) <para> After having compiled the handler function into a loadable module - (see <xref linkend="dfunc">), the following commands then + (see <xref linkend="dfunc"/>), the following commands then register the sample procedural language: <programlisting> CREATE FUNCTION plsample_call_handler() RETURNS language_handler @@ -162,9 +162,9 @@ CREATE LANGUAGE plsample are a <firstterm>validator</firstterm> and an <firstterm>inline handler</firstterm>. A validator can be provided to allow language-specific checking to be done during - <xref linkend="sql-createfunction">. + <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"/>. An inline handler can be provided to allow the language to support - anonymous code blocks executed via the <xref linkend="sql-do"> command. + anonymous code blocks executed via the <xref linkend="sql-do"/> command. </para> <para> @@ -191,7 +191,7 @@ CREATE LANGUAGE plsample <para> Validator functions should typically honor the <xref - linkend="guc-check-function-bodies"> parameter: if it is turned off then + linkend="guc-check-function-bodies"/> parameter: if it is turned off then any expensive or context-sensitive checking should be skipped. If the language provides for code execution at compilation time, the validator must suppress checks that would induce such execution. In particular, @@ -230,7 +230,7 @@ CREATE LANGUAGE plsample as well as the <command>CREATE LANGUAGE</command> command itself, into an <firstterm>extension</firstterm> so that a simple <command>CREATE EXTENSION</command> command is sufficient to install the language. See - <xref linkend="extend-extensions"> for information about writing + <xref linkend="extend-extensions"/> for information about writing extensions. </para> @@ -238,7 +238,7 @@ CREATE LANGUAGE plsample The procedural languages included in the standard distribution are good references when trying to write your own language handler. Look into the <filename>src/pl</filename> subdirectory of the source tree. - The <xref linkend="sql-createlanguage"> + The <xref linkend="sql-createlanguage"/> reference page also has some useful details. </para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/plperl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/plperl.sgml index dfffa4077f1..33e39d85e40 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/plperl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/plperl.sgml @@ -41,7 +41,7 @@ <para> Users of source packages must specially enable the build of PL/Perl during the installation process. (Refer to <xref - linkend="installation"> for more information.) Users of + linkend="installation"/> for more information.) Users of binary packages might find PL/Perl in a separate subpackage. </para> </note> @@ -51,7 +51,7 @@ <para> To create a function in the PL/Perl language, use the standard - <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"> + <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"/> syntax: <programlisting> @@ -69,7 +69,7 @@ $$ LANGUAGE plperl; <para> PL/Perl also supports anonymous code blocks called with the - <xref linkend="sql-do"> statement: + <xref linkend="sql-do"/> statement: <programlisting> DO $$ @@ -99,11 +99,11 @@ $$ LANGUAGE plperl; The syntax of the <command>CREATE FUNCTION</command> command requires the function body to be written as a string constant. It is usually most convenient to use dollar quoting (see <xref - linkend="sql-syntax-dollar-quoting">) for the string constant. + linkend="sql-syntax-dollar-quoting"/>) for the string constant. If you choose to use escape string syntax <literal>E''</literal>, you must double any single quote marks (<literal>'</literal>) and backslashes (<literal>\</literal>) used in the body of the function - (see <xref linkend="sql-syntax-strings">). + (see <xref linkend="sql-syntax-strings"/>). </para> <para> @@ -686,9 +686,9 @@ SELECT release_hosts_query(); priority levels. Whether messages of a particular priority are reported to the client, written to the server log, or both is controlled by the - <xref linkend="guc-log-min-messages"> and - <xref linkend="guc-client-min-messages"> configuration - variables. See <xref linkend="runtime-config"> for more + <xref linkend="guc-log-min-messages"/> and + <xref linkend="guc-client-min-messages"/> configuration + variables. See <xref linkend="runtime-config"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> @@ -792,7 +792,7 @@ SELECT release_hosts_query(); <listitem> <para> Returns the contents of the referenced array as a string in array literal format - (see <xref linkend="arrays-input">). + (see <xref linkend="arrays-input"/>). Returns the argument value unaltered if it's not a reference to an array. The delimiter used between elements of the array literal defaults to "<literal>, </literal>" if a delimiter is not specified or is undef. @@ -828,7 +828,7 @@ SELECT release_hosts_query(); <listitem> <para> Returns the contents of the referenced array as a string in array constructor format - (see <xref linkend="sql-syntax-array-constructors">). + (see <xref linkend="sql-syntax-array-constructors"/>). Individual values are quoted using <function>quote_nullable</function>. Returns the argument value, quoted using <function>quote_nullable</function>, if it's not a reference to an array. @@ -1336,7 +1336,7 @@ DO 'elog(WARNING, join ", ", sort keys %INC)' LANGUAGE plperl; </para> <para> Initialization will happen in the postmaster if the <literal>plperl</literal> library is - included in <xref linkend="guc-shared-preload-libraries">, in which + included in <xref linkend="guc-shared-preload-libraries"/>, in which case extra consideration should be given to the risk of destabilizing the postmaster. The principal reason for making use of this feature is that Perl modules loaded by <literal>plperl.on_init</literal> need be diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/plpgsql.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/plpgsql.sgml index 7323c2f67d3..6d14b344487 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/plpgsql.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/plpgsql.sgml @@ -125,14 +125,14 @@ It is also possible to declare a <application>PL/pgSQL</application> function as returning <type>record</type>, which means that the result is a row type whose columns are determined by specification in the - calling query, as discussed in <xref linkend="queries-tablefunctions">. + calling query, as discussed in <xref linkend="queries-tablefunctions"/>. </para> <para> <application>PL/pgSQL</application> functions can be declared to accept a variable number of arguments by using the <literal>VARIADIC</literal> marker. This works exactly the same way as for SQL functions, as discussed in - <xref linkend="xfunc-sql-variadic-functions">. + <xref linkend="xfunc-sql-variadic-functions"/>. </para> <para> @@ -141,8 +141,8 @@ <type>anyelement</type>, <type>anyarray</type>, <type>anynonarray</type>, <type>anyenum</type>, and <type>anyrange</type>. The actual data types handled by a polymorphic function can vary from call to - call, as discussed in <xref linkend="extend-types-polymorphic">. - An example is shown in <xref linkend="plpgsql-declaration-parameters">. + call, as discussed in <xref linkend="extend-types-polymorphic"/>. + An example is shown in <xref linkend="plpgsql-declaration-parameters"/>. </para> <para> @@ -170,8 +170,8 @@ <para> Specific examples appear in - <xref linkend="plpgsql-declaration-parameters"> and - <xref linkend="plpgsql-statements-returning">. + <xref linkend="plpgsql-declaration-parameters"/> and + <xref linkend="plpgsql-statements-returning"/>. </para> </sect2> </sect1> @@ -181,7 +181,7 @@ <para> Functions written in <application>PL/pgSQL</application> are defined - to the server by executing <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"> commands. + to the server by executing <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"/> commands. Such a command would normally look like, say, <programlisting> CREATE FUNCTION somefunc(integer, text) RETURNS integer @@ -190,7 +190,7 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> The function body is simply a string literal so far as <command>CREATE FUNCTION</command> is concerned. It is often helpful to use dollar quoting - (see <xref linkend="sql-syntax-dollar-quoting">) to write the function + (see <xref linkend="sql-syntax-dollar-quoting"/>) to write the function body, rather than the normal single quote syntax. Without dollar quoting, any single quotes or backslashes in the function body must be escaped by doubling them. Almost all the examples in this chapter use dollar-quoted @@ -289,7 +289,7 @@ $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of any <application>PL/pgSQL</application> function. This block provides the declarations of the function's parameters (if any), as well as some special variables such as <literal>FOUND</literal> (see - <xref linkend="plpgsql-statements-diagnostics">). The outer block is + <xref linkend="plpgsql-statements-diagnostics"/>). The outer block is labeled with the function's name, meaning that parameters and special variables can be qualified with the function's name. </para> @@ -308,7 +308,7 @@ $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; However, a block containing an <literal>EXCEPTION</literal> clause effectively forms a subtransaction that can be rolled back without affecting the outer transaction. For more about that see <xref - linkend="plpgsql-error-trapping">. + linkend="plpgsql-error-trapping"/>. </para> </sect1> @@ -356,7 +356,7 @@ arow RECORD; assigned to after initialization, so that its value will remain constant for the duration of the block. The <literal>COLLATE</literal> option specifies a collation to use for the - variable (see <xref linkend="plpgsql-declaration-collation">). + variable (see <xref linkend="plpgsql-declaration-collation"/>). If <literal>NOT NULL</literal> is specified, an assignment of a null value results in a run-time error. All variables declared as <literal>NOT NULL</literal> @@ -491,7 +491,7 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> - As discussed in <xref linkend="xfunc-output-parameters">, this + As discussed in <xref linkend="xfunc-output-parameters"/>, this effectively creates an anonymous record type for the function's results. If a <literal>RETURNS</literal> clause is given, it must say <literal>RETURNS record</literal>. @@ -523,9 +523,9 @@ $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; or <type>anyrange</type>), a special parameter <literal>$0</literal> is created. Its data type is the actual return type of the function, as deduced from the actual input types (see <xref - linkend="extend-types-polymorphic">). + linkend="extend-types-polymorphic"/>). This allows the function to access its actual return type - as shown in <xref linkend="plpgsql-declaration-type">. + as shown in <xref linkend="plpgsql-declaration-type"/>. <literal>$0</literal> is initialized to null and can be modified by the function, so it can be used to hold the return value if desired, though that is not required. <literal>$0</literal> can also be @@ -740,7 +740,7 @@ SELECT merge_fields(t.*) FROM table1 t WHERE ... ; When a <application>PL/pgSQL</application> function has one or more parameters of collatable data types, a collation is identified for each function call depending on the collations assigned to the actual - arguments, as described in <xref linkend="collation">. If a collation is + arguments, as described in <xref linkend="collation"/>. If a collation is successfully identified (i.e., there are no conflicts of implicit collations among the arguments) then all the collatable parameters are treated as having that collation implicitly. This will affect the @@ -841,7 +841,7 @@ SELECT <replaceable>expression</replaceable> to the main SQL engine. While forming the <command>SELECT</command> command, any occurrences of <application>PL/pgSQL</application> variable names are replaced by parameters, as discussed in detail in - <xref linkend="plpgsql-var-subst">. + <xref linkend="plpgsql-var-subst"/>. This allows the query plan for the <command>SELECT</command> to be prepared just once and then reused for subsequent evaluations with different values of the variables. Thus, what @@ -861,7 +861,7 @@ PREPARE <replaceable>statement_name</replaceable>(integer, integer) AS SELECT $1 parameter values. Normally these details are not important to a <application>PL/pgSQL</application> user, but they are useful to know when trying to diagnose a problem. - More information appears in <xref linkend="plpgsql-plan-caching">. + More information appears in <xref linkend="plpgsql-plan-caching"/>. </para> </sect1> @@ -874,8 +874,8 @@ PREPARE <replaceable>statement_name</replaceable>(integer, integer) AS SELECT $1 <application>PL/pgSQL</application>. Anything not recognized as one of these statement types is presumed to be an SQL command and is sent to the main database engine to execute, - as described in <xref linkend="plpgsql-statements-sql-noresult"> - and <xref linkend="plpgsql-statements-sql-onerow">. + as described in <xref linkend="plpgsql-statements-sql-noresult"/> + and <xref linkend="plpgsql-statements-sql-onerow"/>. </para> <sect2 id="plpgsql-statements-assignment"> @@ -900,7 +900,7 @@ PREPARE <replaceable>statement_name</replaceable>(integer, integer) AS SELECT $1 <para> If the expression's result data type doesn't match the variable's data type, the value will be coerced as though by an assignment cast - (see <xref linkend="typeconv-query">). If no assignment cast is known + (see <xref linkend="typeconv-query"/>). If no assignment cast is known for the pair of data types involved, the <application>PL/pgSQL</application> interpreter will attempt to convert the result value textually, that is by applying the result type's output function followed by the variable @@ -933,14 +933,14 @@ my_record.user_id := 20; in the command text is treated as a parameter, and then the current value of the variable is provided as the parameter value at run time. This is exactly like the processing described earlier - for expressions; for details see <xref linkend="plpgsql-var-subst">. + for expressions; for details see <xref linkend="plpgsql-var-subst"/>. </para> <para> When executing a SQL command in this way, <application>PL/pgSQL</application> may cache and re-use the execution plan for the command, as discussed in - <xref linkend="plpgsql-plan-caching">. + <xref linkend="plpgsql-plan-caching"/>. </para> <para> @@ -966,7 +966,7 @@ PERFORM <replaceable>query</replaceable>; and the plan is cached in the same way. Also, the special variable <literal>FOUND</literal> is set to true if the query produced at least one row, or false if it produced no rows (see - <xref linkend="plpgsql-statements-diagnostics">). + <xref linkend="plpgsql-statements-diagnostics"/>). </para> <note> @@ -1067,7 +1067,7 @@ DELETE ... RETURNING <replaceable>expressions</replaceable> INTO <optional>STRIC well-defined unless you've used <literal>ORDER BY</literal>.) Any result rows after the first row are discarded. You can check the special <literal>FOUND</literal> variable (see - <xref linkend="plpgsql-statements-diagnostics">) to + <xref linkend="plpgsql-statements-diagnostics"/>) to determine whether a row was returned: <programlisting> @@ -1147,7 +1147,7 @@ CONTEXT: PL/pgSQL function get_userid(text) line 6 at SQL statement <para> To handle cases where you need to process multiple result rows - from a SQL query, see <xref linkend="plpgsql-records-iterating">. + from a SQL query, see <xref linkend="plpgsql-records-iterating"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1161,7 +1161,7 @@ CONTEXT: PL/pgSQL function get_userid(text) line 6 at SQL statement that will involve different tables or different data types each time they are executed. <application>PL/pgSQL</application>'s normal attempts to cache plans for commands (as discussed in - <xref linkend="plpgsql-plan-caching">) will not work in such + <xref linkend="plpgsql-plan-caching"/>) will not work in such scenarios. To handle this sort of problem, the <command>EXECUTE</command> statement is provided: @@ -1283,7 +1283,7 @@ EXECUTE format('SELECT count(*) FROM %I ' <para> The <application>PL/pgSQL</application> <command>EXECUTE</command> statement is not related to the - <xref linkend="sql-execute"> SQL + <xref linkend="sql-execute"/> SQL statement supported by the <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> server. The server's <command>EXECUTE</command> statement cannot be used directly within @@ -1319,7 +1319,7 @@ EXECUTE format('SELECT count(*) FROM %I ' of single quotes. The recommended method for quoting fixed text in your function body is dollar quoting. (If you have legacy code that does not use dollar quoting, please refer to the - overview in <xref linkend="plpgsql-quote-tips">, which can save you + overview in <xref linkend="plpgsql-quote-tips"/>, which can save you some effort when translating said code to a more reasonable scheme.) </para> @@ -1347,7 +1347,7 @@ EXECUTE 'UPDATE tbl SET ' This example demonstrates the use of the <function>quote_ident</function> and <function>quote_literal</function> functions (see <xref - linkend="functions-string">). For safety, expressions containing column + linkend="functions-string"/>). For safety, expressions containing column or table identifiers should be passed through <function>quote_ident</function> before insertion in a dynamic query. Expressions containing values that should be literal strings in the @@ -1394,7 +1394,7 @@ EXECUTE 'UPDATE tbl SET ' </programlisting> (At present, <literal>IS NOT DISTINCT FROM</literal> is handled much less efficiently than <literal>=</literal>, so don't do this unless you must. - See <xref linkend="functions-comparison"> for + See <xref linkend="functions-comparison"/> for more information on nulls and <literal>IS DISTINCT</literal>.) </para> @@ -1420,7 +1420,7 @@ EXECUTE 'UPDATE tbl SET ' <para> Dynamic SQL statements can also be safely constructed using the <function>format</function> function (see <xref - linkend="functions-string">). For example: + linkend="functions-string"/>). For example: <programlisting> EXECUTE format('UPDATE tbl SET %I = %L ' 'WHERE key = %L', colname, newvalue, keyvalue); @@ -1442,7 +1442,7 @@ EXECUTE format('UPDATE tbl SET %I = $1 WHERE key = $2', colname) <para> A much larger example of a dynamic command and <command>EXECUTE</command> can be seen in <xref - linkend="plpgsql-porting-ex2">, which builds and executes a + linkend="plpgsql-porting-ex2"/>, which builds and executes a <command>CREATE FUNCTION</command> command to define a new function. </para> </sect2> @@ -1461,12 +1461,12 @@ GET <optional> CURRENT </optional> DIAGNOSTICS <replaceable>variable</replaceabl This command allows retrieval of system status indicators. <literal>CURRENT</literal> is a noise word (but see also <command>GET STACKED - DIAGNOSTICS</command> in <xref linkend="plpgsql-exception-diagnostics">). + DIAGNOSTICS</command> in <xref linkend="plpgsql-exception-diagnostics"/>). Each <replaceable>item</replaceable> is a key word identifying a status value to be assigned to the specified <replaceable>variable</replaceable> (which should be of the right data type to receive it). The currently available status items are shown - in <xref linkend="plpgsql-current-diagnostics-values">. Colon-equal + in <xref linkend="plpgsql-current-diagnostics-values"/>. Colon-equal (<literal>:=</literal>) can be used instead of the SQL-standard <literal>=</literal> token. An example: <programlisting> @@ -1503,7 +1503,7 @@ GET DIAGNOSTICS integer_var = ROW_COUNT; <entry><literal>PG_CONTEXT</literal></entry> <entry><type>text</type></entry> <entry>line(s) of text describing the current call stack - (see <xref linkend="plpgsql-call-stack">)</entry> + (see <xref linkend="plpgsql-call-stack"/>)</entry> </row> </tbody> </tgroup> @@ -1856,7 +1856,7 @@ SELECT * FROM get_available_flightid(CURRENT_DATE); allow users to define set-returning functions that do not have this limitation. Currently, the point at which data begins being written to disk is controlled by the - <xref linkend="guc-work-mem"> + <xref linkend="guc-work-mem"/> configuration variable. Administrators who have sufficient memory to store larger result sets in memory should consider increasing this parameter. @@ -2440,8 +2440,8 @@ $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; <para> <application>PL/pgSQL</application> variables are substituted into the query text, and the query plan is cached for possible re-use, as discussed in - detail in <xref linkend="plpgsql-var-subst"> and - <xref linkend="plpgsql-plan-caching">. + detail in <xref linkend="plpgsql-var-subst"/> and + <xref linkend="plpgsql-plan-caching"/>. </para> <para> @@ -2465,7 +2465,7 @@ END LOOP <optional> <replaceable>label</replaceable> </optional>; <para> Another way to specify the query whose results should be iterated through is to declare it as a cursor. This is described in - <xref linkend="plpgsql-cursor-for-loop">. + <xref linkend="plpgsql-cursor-for-loop"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2605,7 +2605,7 @@ END; <para> The <replaceable>condition</replaceable> names can be any of - those shown in <xref linkend="errcodes-appendix">. A category + those shown in <xref linkend="errcodes-appendix"/>. A category name matches any error within its category. The special condition name <literal>OTHERS</literal> matches every error type except <literal>QUERY_CANCELED</literal> and <literal>ASSERT_FAILURE</literal>. @@ -2729,7 +2729,7 @@ SELECT merge_db(1, 'dennis'); <para> Within an exception handler, the special variable <varname>SQLSTATE</varname> contains the error code that corresponds to - the exception that was raised (refer to <xref linkend="errcodes-table"> + the exception that was raised (refer to <xref linkend="errcodes-table"/> for a list of possible error codes). The special variable <varname>SQLERRM</varname> contains the error message associated with the exception. These variables are undefined outside exception handlers. @@ -2748,7 +2748,7 @@ GET STACKED DIAGNOSTICS <replaceable>variable</replaceable> { = | := } <replacea value to be assigned to the specified <replaceable>variable</replaceable> (which should be of the right data type to receive it). The currently available status items are shown - in <xref linkend="plpgsql-exception-diagnostics-values">. + in <xref linkend="plpgsql-exception-diagnostics-values"/>. </para> <table id="plpgsql-exception-diagnostics-values"> @@ -2811,7 +2811,7 @@ GET STACKED DIAGNOSTICS <replaceable>variable</replaceable> { = | := } <replacea <entry><literal>PG_EXCEPTION_CONTEXT</literal></entry> <entry><type>text</type></entry> <entry>line(s) of text describing the call stack at the time of the - exception (see <xref linkend="plpgsql-call-stack">)</entry> + exception (see <xref linkend="plpgsql-call-stack"/>)</entry> </row> </tbody> </tgroup> @@ -2847,7 +2847,7 @@ END; <para> The <command>GET DIAGNOSTICS</command> command, previously described - in <xref linkend="plpgsql-statements-diagnostics">, retrieves information + in <xref linkend="plpgsql-statements-diagnostics"/>, retrieves information about current execution state (whereas the <command>GET STACKED DIAGNOSTICS</command> command discussed above reports information about the execution state as of a previous error). Its <literal>PG_CONTEXT</literal> @@ -2978,7 +2978,7 @@ DECLARE <para> Bound cursor variables can also be used without explicitly opening the cursor, via the <command>FOR</command> statement described in - <xref linkend="plpgsql-cursor-for-loop">. + <xref linkend="plpgsql-cursor-for-loop"/>. </para> </note> @@ -3031,7 +3031,7 @@ OPEN <replaceable>unbound_cursorvar</replaceable> <optional> <optional> NO </opt <type>refcursor</type> variable). The query is specified as a string expression, in the same way as in the <command>EXECUTE</command> command. As usual, this gives flexibility so the query plan can vary - from one run to the next (see <xref linkend="plpgsql-plan-caching">), + from one run to the next (see <xref linkend="plpgsql-plan-caching"/>), and it also means that variable substitution is not done on the command string. As with <command>EXECUTE</command>, parameter values can be inserted into the dynamic command via @@ -3082,7 +3082,7 @@ OPEN <replaceable>bound_cursorvar</replaceable> <optional> ( <optional> <replace notation, all arguments are specified in order. In named notation, each argument's name is specified using <literal>:=</literal> to separate it from the argument expression. Similar to calling - functions, described in <xref linkend="sql-syntax-calling-funcs">, it + functions, described in <xref linkend="sql-syntax-calling-funcs"/>, it is also allowed to mix positional and named notation. </para> @@ -3160,7 +3160,7 @@ FETCH <optional> <replaceable>direction</replaceable> { FROM | IN } </optional> <para> The <replaceable>direction</replaceable> clause can be any of the - variants allowed in the SQL <xref linkend="sql-fetch"> + variants allowed in the SQL <xref linkend="sql-fetch"/> command except the ones that can fetch more than one row; namely, it can be <literal>NEXT</literal>, @@ -3212,7 +3212,7 @@ MOVE <optional> <replaceable>direction</replaceable> { FROM | IN } </optional> < <para> The <replaceable>direction</replaceable> clause can be any of the - variants allowed in the SQL <xref linkend="sql-fetch"> + variants allowed in the SQL <xref linkend="sql-fetch"/> command, namely <literal>NEXT</literal>, <literal>PRIOR</literal>, @@ -3255,7 +3255,7 @@ DELETE FROM <replaceable>table</replaceable> WHERE CURRENT OF <replaceable>curso restrictions on what the cursor's query can be (in particular, no grouping) and it's best to use <literal>FOR UPDATE</literal> in the cursor. For more information see the - <xref linkend="sql-declare"> + <xref linkend="sql-declare"/> reference page. </para> @@ -3422,7 +3422,7 @@ END LOOP <optional> <replaceable>label</replaceable> </optional>; expressions must appear if and only if the cursor was declared to take arguments. These values will be substituted in the query, in just the same way as during an <command>OPEN</command> (see <xref - linkend="plpgsql-open-bound-cursor">). + linkend="plpgsql-open-bound-cursor"/>). </para> <para> @@ -3475,9 +3475,9 @@ RAISE ; priority levels. Whether messages of a particular priority are reported to the client, written to the server log, or both is controlled by the - <xref linkend="guc-log-min-messages"> and - <xref linkend="guc-client-min-messages"> configuration - variables. See <xref linkend="runtime-config"> for more + <xref linkend="guc-log-min-messages"/> and + <xref linkend="guc-client-min-messages"/> configuration + variables. See <xref linkend="runtime-config"/> for more information. </para> @@ -3541,7 +3541,7 @@ RAISE NOTICE 'Calling cs_create_job(%)', v_job_id; <term><literal>ERRCODE</literal></term> <listitem> <para>Specifies the error code (SQLSTATE) to report, either by condition - name, as shown in <xref linkend="errcodes-appendix">, or directly as a + name, as shown in <xref linkend="errcodes-appendix"/>, or directly as a five-character SQLSTATE code.</para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -3928,7 +3928,7 @@ ASSERT <replaceable class="parameter">condition</replaceable> <optional> , <repl </para> <para> - <xref linkend="plpgsql-trigger-example"> shows an example of a + <xref linkend="plpgsql-trigger-example"/> shows an example of a trigger procedure in <application>PL/pgSQL</application>. </para> @@ -3981,7 +3981,7 @@ CREATE TRIGGER emp_stamp BEFORE INSERT OR UPDATE ON emp Another way to log changes to a table involves creating a new table that holds a row for each insert, update, or delete that occurs. This approach can be thought of as auditing changes to a table. - <xref linkend="plpgsql-trigger-audit-example"> shows an example of an + <xref linkend="plpgsql-trigger-audit-example"/> shows an example of an audit trigger procedure in <application>PL/pgSQL</application>. </para> @@ -4038,7 +4038,7 @@ AFTER INSERT OR UPDATE OR DELETE ON emp approach still records the full audit trail of changes to the table, but also presents a simplified view of the audit trail, showing just the last modified timestamp derived from the audit trail for each entry. - <xref linkend="plpgsql-view-trigger-audit-example"> shows an example + <xref linkend="plpgsql-view-trigger-audit-example"/> shows an example of an audit trigger on a view in <application>PL/pgSQL</application>. </para> @@ -4118,7 +4118,7 @@ INSTEAD OF INSERT OR UPDATE OR DELETE ON emp_view times. This technique is commonly used in Data Warehousing, where the tables of measured or observed data (called fact tables) might be extremely large. - <xref linkend="plpgsql-trigger-summary-example"> shows an example of a + <xref linkend="plpgsql-trigger-summary-example"/> shows an example of a trigger procedure in <application>PL/pgSQL</application> that maintains a summary table for a fact table in a data warehouse. </para> @@ -4272,7 +4272,7 @@ SELECT * FROM sales_summary_bytime; statement. The <command>CREATE TRIGGER</command> command assigns names to one or both transition tables, and then the function can refer to those names as though they were read-only temporary tables. - <xref linkend="plpgsql-trigger-audit-transition-example"> shows an example. + <xref linkend="plpgsql-trigger-audit-transition-example"/> shows an example. </para> <example id="plpgsql-trigger-audit-transition-example"> @@ -4280,7 +4280,7 @@ SELECT * FROM sales_summary_bytime; <para> This example produces the same results as - <xref linkend="plpgsql-trigger-audit-example">, but instead of using a + <xref linkend="plpgsql-trigger-audit-example"/>, but instead of using a trigger that fires for every row, it uses a trigger that fires once per statement, after collecting the relevant information in a transition table. This can be significantly faster than the row-trigger approach @@ -4383,7 +4383,7 @@ CREATE TRIGGER emp_audit_del </para> <para> - <xref linkend="plpgsql-event-trigger-example"> shows an example of an + <xref linkend="plpgsql-event-trigger-example"/> shows an example of an event trigger procedure in <application>PL/pgSQL</application>. </para> @@ -4482,7 +4482,7 @@ INSERT INTO dest (col) SELECT foo + bar FROM src; In the above example, <literal>src.foo</literal> would be an unambiguous reference to the table column. To create an unambiguous reference to a variable, declare it in a labeled block and use the block's label - (see <xref linkend="plpgsql-structure">). For example, + (see <xref linkend="plpgsql-structure"/>). For example, <programlisting> <<block>> DECLARE @@ -4575,7 +4575,7 @@ $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; to <command>EXECUTE</command> or one of its variants. If you need to insert a varying value into such a command, do so as part of constructing the string value, or use <literal>USING</literal>, as illustrated in - <xref linkend="plpgsql-statements-executing-dyn">. + <xref linkend="plpgsql-statements-executing-dyn"/>. </para> <para> @@ -4636,7 +4636,7 @@ $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; this will happen only if the execution plan is not very sensitive to the values of the <application>PL/pgSQL</application> variables referenced in it. If it is, generating a plan each time is a net win. See <xref - linkend="sql-prepare"> for more information about the behavior of + linkend="sql-prepare"/> for more information about the behavior of prepared statements. </para> @@ -4796,7 +4796,7 @@ $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; easily find yourself needing half a dozen or more adjacent quote marks. It's recommended that you instead write the function body as a <quote>dollar-quoted</quote> string literal (see <xref - linkend="sql-syntax-dollar-quoting">). In the dollar-quoting + linkend="sql-syntax-dollar-quoting"/>). In the dollar-quoting approach, you never double any quote marks, but instead take care to choose a different dollar-quoting delimiter for each level of nesting you need. For example, you might write the <command>CREATE @@ -4907,7 +4907,7 @@ a_output := a_output || $$ AND name LIKE 'foobar'$$ accounts for 8 quotation marks) and this is adjacent to the end of that string constant (2 more). You will probably only need that if you are writing a function that generates other functions, as in - <xref linkend="plpgsql-porting-ex2">. + <xref linkend="plpgsql-porting-ex2"/>. For example: <programlisting> a_output := a_output || '' if v_'' || @@ -5029,7 +5029,7 @@ CREATE FUNCTION to <application>PL/pgSQL</application>'s <literal>plpgsql.variable_conflict</literal> = <literal>use_column</literal> behavior, which is not the default, - as explained in <xref linkend="plpgsql-var-subst">. + as explained in <xref linkend="plpgsql-var-subst"/>. It's often best to avoid such ambiguities in the first place, but if you have to port a large amount of code that depends on this behavior, setting <literal>variable_conflict</literal> may be the @@ -5042,7 +5042,7 @@ CREATE FUNCTION In <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> the function body must be written as a string literal. Therefore you need to use dollar quoting or escape single quotes in the function body. (See <xref - linkend="plpgsql-quote-tips">.) + linkend="plpgsql-quote-tips"/>.) </para> </listitem> @@ -5080,7 +5080,7 @@ CREATE FUNCTION from the first number to the second, requiring the loop bounds to be swapped when porting. This incompatibility is unfortunate but is unlikely to be changed. (See <xref - linkend="plpgsql-integer-for">.) + linkend="plpgsql-integer-for"/>.) </para> </listitem> @@ -5108,7 +5108,7 @@ CREATE FUNCTION <title>Porting Examples</title> <para> - <xref linkend="pgsql-porting-ex1"> shows how to port a simple + <xref linkend="pgsql-porting-ex1"/> shows how to port a simple function from <application>PL/SQL</application> to <application>PL/pgSQL</application>. </para> @@ -5197,7 +5197,7 @@ $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </example> <para> - <xref linkend="plpgsql-porting-ex2"> shows how to port a + <xref linkend="plpgsql-porting-ex2"/> shows how to port a function that creates another function and how to handle the ensuing quoting problems. </para> @@ -5292,12 +5292,12 @@ $func$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </example> <para> - <xref linkend="plpgsql-porting-ex3"> shows how to port a function + <xref linkend="plpgsql-porting-ex3"/> shows how to port a function with <literal>OUT</literal> parameters and string manipulation. <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> does not have a built-in <function>instr</function> function, but you can create one using a combination of other - functions. In <xref linkend="plpgsql-porting-appendix"> there is a + functions. In <xref linkend="plpgsql-porting-appendix"/> there is a <application>PL/pgSQL</application> implementation of <function>instr</function> that you can use to make your porting easier. @@ -5406,7 +5406,7 @@ SELECT * FROM cs_parse_url('http://foobar.com/query.cgi?baz'); </example> <para> - <xref linkend="plpgsql-porting-ex4"> shows how to port a procedure + <xref linkend="plpgsql-porting-ex4"/> shows how to port a procedure that uses numerous features that are specific to Oracle. </para> @@ -5419,14 +5419,14 @@ SELECT * FROM cs_parse_url('http://foobar.com/query.cgi?baz'); <programlisting> CREATE OR REPLACE PROCEDURE cs_create_job(v_job_id IN INTEGER) IS a_running_job_count INTEGER; - PRAGMA AUTONOMOUS_TRANSACTION; -- <co id="co.plpgsql-porting-pragma"> + PRAGMA AUTONOMOUS_TRANSACTION; -- <co id="co.plpgsql-porting-pragma"/> BEGIN - LOCK TABLE cs_jobs IN EXCLUSIVE MODE; -- <co id="co.plpgsql-porting-locktable"> + LOCK TABLE cs_jobs IN EXCLUSIVE MODE; -- <co id="co.plpgsql-porting-locktable"/> SELECT count(*) INTO a_running_job_count FROM cs_jobs WHERE end_stamp IS NULL; IF a_running_job_count > 0 THEN - COMMIT; -- free lock <co id="co.plpgsql-porting-commit"> + COMMIT; -- free lock <co id="co.plpgsql-porting-commit"/> raise_application_error(-20000, 'Unable to create a new job: a job is currently running.'); END IF; @@ -5493,7 +5493,7 @@ BEGIN SELECT count(*) INTO a_running_job_count FROM cs_jobs WHERE end_stamp IS NULL; IF a_running_job_count > 0 THEN - RAISE EXCEPTION 'Unable to create a new job: a job is currently running'; -- <co id="co.plpgsql-porting-raise"> + RAISE EXCEPTION 'Unable to create a new job: a job is currently running'; -- <co id="co.plpgsql-porting-raise"/> END IF; DELETE FROM cs_active_job; @@ -5502,7 +5502,7 @@ BEGIN BEGIN INSERT INTO cs_jobs (job_id, start_stamp) VALUES (v_job_id, now()); EXCEPTION - WHEN unique_violation THEN -- <co id="co.plpgsql-porting-exception"> + WHEN unique_violation THEN -- <co id="co.plpgsql-porting-exception"/> -- don't worry if it already exists END; END; @@ -5522,7 +5522,7 @@ $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; <para> The exception names supported by <application>PL/pgSQL</application> are different from Oracle's. The set of built-in exception names - is much larger (see <xref linkend="errcodes-appendix">). There + is much larger (see <xref linkend="errcodes-appendix"/>). There is not currently a way to declare user-defined exception names, although you can throw user-chosen SQLSTATE values instead. </para> @@ -5588,7 +5588,7 @@ END; <application>PL/SQL</application> version, but you have to remember to use <function>quote_literal</function> and <function>quote_ident</function> as described in <xref - linkend="plpgsql-statements-executing-dyn">. Constructs of the + linkend="plpgsql-statements-executing-dyn"/>. Constructs of the type <literal>EXECUTE 'SELECT * FROM $1';</literal> will not work reliably unless you use these functions. </para> @@ -5603,7 +5603,7 @@ END; the function always returns the same result when given the same arguments) and <quote>strictness</quote> (whether the function returns null if any argument is null). Consult the <xref - linkend="sql-createfunction"> + linkend="sql-createfunction"/> reference page for details. </para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/plpython.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/plpython.sgml index 043225fc47c..ec5f671632d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/plpython.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/plpython.sgml @@ -15,7 +15,7 @@ <para> To install PL/Python in a particular database, use <literal>CREATE EXTENSION plpythonu</literal> (but - see also <xref linkend="plpython-python23">). + see also <xref linkend="plpython-python23"/>). </para> <tip> @@ -103,7 +103,7 @@ The built variant depends on which Python version was found during the installation or which version was explicitly set using the <envar>PYTHON</envar> environment variable; - see <xref linkend="install-procedure">. To make both variants of + see <xref linkend="install-procedure"/>. To make both variants of PL/Python available in one installation, the source tree has to be configured and built twice. </para> @@ -186,7 +186,7 @@ <para> Functions in PL/Python are declared via the - standard <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"> syntax: + standard <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"/> syntax: <programlisting> CREATE FUNCTION <replaceable>funcname</replaceable> (<replaceable>argument-list</replaceable>) @@ -420,7 +420,7 @@ $$ LANGUAGE plpythonu; sortas="PL/Python">in PL/Python</secondary></indexterm> is passed to a function, the argument value will appear as <symbol>None</symbol> in Python. For example, the function definition of <function>pymax</function> - shown in <xref linkend="plpython-funcs"> will return the wrong answer for null + shown in <xref linkend="plpython-funcs"/> will return the wrong answer for null inputs. We could add <literal>STRICT</literal> to the function definition to make <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> do something more reasonable: if a null value is passed, the function will not be called at all, @@ -774,7 +774,7 @@ SELECT * FROM multiout_simple_setof(3); <para> PL/Python also supports anonymous code blocks called with the - <xref linkend="sql-do"> statement: + <xref linkend="sql-do"/> statement: <programlisting> DO $$ @@ -1056,16 +1056,16 @@ rv = plan.execute(["name"], 5) <para> Query parameters and result row fields are converted between PostgreSQL - and Python data types as described in <xref linkend="plpython-data">. + and Python data types as described in <xref linkend="plpython-data"/>. </para> <para> When you prepare a plan using the PL/Python module it is automatically - saved. Read the SPI documentation (<xref linkend="spi">) for a + saved. Read the SPI documentation (<xref linkend="spi"/>) for a description of what this means. In order to make effective use of this across function calls one needs to use one of the persistent storage dictionaries <literal>SD</literal> or <literal>GD</literal> (see - <xref linkend="plpython-sharing">). For example: + <xref linkend="plpython-sharing"/>). For example: <programlisting> CREATE FUNCTION usesavedplan() RETURNS trigger AS $$ if "plan" in SD: @@ -1190,7 +1190,7 @@ $$ LANGUAGE plpythonu; <para> The actual class of the exception being raised corresponds to the specific condition that caused the error. Refer - to <xref linkend="errcodes-table"> for a list of possible + to <xref linkend="errcodes-table"/> for a list of possible conditions. The module <literal>plpy.spiexceptions</literal> defines an exception class for each <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> condition, deriving @@ -1241,7 +1241,7 @@ $$ LANGUAGE plpythonu; <para> Recovering from errors caused by database access as described in - <xref linkend="plpython-trapping"> can lead to an undesirable + <xref linkend="plpython-trapping"/> can lead to an undesirable situation where some operations succeed before one of them fails, and after recovering from that error the data is left in an inconsistent state. PL/Python offers a solution to this problem in @@ -1391,9 +1391,9 @@ $$ LANGUAGE plpythonu; The other functions only generate messages of different priority levels. Whether messages of a particular priority are reported to the client, written to the server log, or both is controlled by the - <xref linkend="guc-log-min-messages"> and - <xref linkend="guc-client-min-messages"> configuration - variables. See <xref linkend="runtime-config"> for more information. + <xref linkend="guc-log-min-messages"/> and + <xref linkend="guc-client-min-messages"/> configuration + variables. See <xref linkend="runtime-config"/> for more information. </para> <para> @@ -1442,9 +1442,9 @@ PL/Python function "raise_custom_exception" <literal>plpy.quote_nullable(<replaceable>string</replaceable>)</literal>, and <literal>plpy.quote_ident(<replaceable>string</replaceable>)</literal>. They are equivalent to the built-in quoting functions described in <xref - linkend="functions-string">. They are useful when constructing + linkend="functions-string"/>. They are useful when constructing ad-hoc queries. A PL/Python equivalent of dynamic SQL from <xref - linkend="plpgsql-quote-literal-example"> would be: + linkend="plpgsql-quote-literal-example"/> would be: <programlisting> plpy.execute("UPDATE tbl SET %s = %s WHERE key = %s" % ( plpy.quote_ident(colname), diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/pltcl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/pltcl.sgml index e74321a06e6..0646a8ba0ba 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/pltcl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/pltcl.sgml @@ -79,7 +79,7 @@ <para> To create a function in the <application>PL/Tcl</application> language, use - the standard <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"> syntax: + the standard <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"/> syntax: <programlisting> CREATE FUNCTION <replaceable>funcname</replaceable> (<replaceable>argument-types</replaceable>) RETURNS <replaceable>return-type</replaceable> AS $$ @@ -483,7 +483,7 @@ $$ LANGUAGE pltcl; executed within a SQL subtransaction. If the script returns an error, that entire subtransaction is rolled back before returning the error out to the surrounding Tcl code. - See <xref linkend="pltcl-subtransactions"> for more details and an + See <xref linkend="pltcl-subtransactions"/> for more details and an example. </para> </listitem> @@ -559,10 +559,10 @@ SELECT 'doesn''t' AS ret priority levels. Whether messages of a particular priority are reported to the client, written to the server log, or both is controlled by the - <xref linkend="guc-log-min-messages"> and - <xref linkend="guc-client-min-messages"> configuration - variables. See <xref linkend="runtime-config"> - and <xref linkend="pltcl-error-handling"> + <xref linkend="guc-log-min-messages"/> and + <xref linkend="guc-client-min-messages"/> configuration + variables. See <xref linkend="runtime-config"/> + and <xref linkend="pltcl-error-handling"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> @@ -888,7 +888,7 @@ CREATE EVENT TRIGGER tcl_a_snitch ON ddl_command_start EXECUTE PROCEDURE tclsnit Fields <varname>SQLSTATE</varname>, <varname>condition</varname>, and <varname>message</varname> are always supplied (the first two represent the error code and condition name as shown - in <xref linkend="errcodes-appendix">). + in <xref linkend="errcodes-appendix"/>). Fields that may be present include <varname>detail</varname>, <varname>hint</varname>, <varname>context</varname>, <varname>schema</varname>, <varname>table</varname>, <varname>column</varname>, @@ -929,7 +929,7 @@ if {[catch { spi_exec $sql_command }]} { <para> Recovering from errors caused by database access as described in - <xref linkend="pltcl-error-handling"> can lead to an undesirable + <xref linkend="pltcl-error-handling"/> can lead to an undesirable situation where some operations succeed before one of them fails, and after recovering from that error the data is left in an inconsistent state. PL/Tcl offers a solution to this problem in diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/postgres-fdw.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/postgres-fdw.sgml index 265effbe48b..54b5e98a0e3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/postgres-fdw.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/postgres-fdw.sgml @@ -15,7 +15,7 @@ <para> The functionality provided by this module overlaps substantially - with the functionality of the older <xref linkend="dblink"> module. + with the functionality of the older <xref linkend="dblink"/> module. But <filename>postgres_fdw</filename> provides more transparent and standards-compliant syntax for accessing remote tables, and can give better performance in many cases. @@ -27,12 +27,12 @@ <listitem> <para> Install the <filename>postgres_fdw</filename> extension using <xref - linkend="sql-createextension">. + linkend="sql-createextension"/>. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create a foreign server object, using <xref linkend="sql-createserver">, + Create a foreign server object, using <xref linkend="sql-createserver"/>, to represent each remote database you want to connect to. Specify connection information, except <literal>user</literal> and <literal>password</literal>, as options of the server object. @@ -40,7 +40,7 @@ </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create a user mapping, using <xref linkend="sql-createusermapping">, for + Create a user mapping, using <xref linkend="sql-createusermapping"/>, for each database user you want to allow to access each foreign server. Specify the remote user name and password to use as <literal>user</literal> and <literal>password</literal> options of the @@ -49,8 +49,8 @@ </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create a foreign table, using <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable"> - or <xref linkend="sql-importforeignschema">, + Create a foreign table, using <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable"/> + or <xref linkend="sql-importforeignschema"/>, for each remote table you want to access. The columns of the foreign table must match the referenced remote table. You can, however, use table and/or column names different from the remote table's, if you @@ -101,7 +101,7 @@ <para> A foreign server using the <filename>postgres_fdw</filename> foreign data wrapper can have the same options that <application>libpq</application> accepts in - connection strings, as described in <xref linkend="libpq-paramkeywords">, + connection strings, as described in <xref linkend="libpq-paramkeywords"/>, except that these options are not allowed: <itemizedlist spacing="compact"> @@ -254,7 +254,7 @@ <literal>fdw_tuple_cost</literal> to the cost estimates. This local estimation is unlikely to be very accurate unless local copies of the remote table's statistics are available. Running - <xref linkend="sql-analyze"> on the foreign table is the way to update + <xref linkend="sql-analyze"/> on the foreign table is the way to update the local statistics; this will perform a scan of the remote table and then calculate and store statistics just as though the table were local. Keeping local statistics can be a useful way to reduce per-query planning @@ -359,7 +359,7 @@ <para> <filename>postgres_fdw</filename> is able to import foreign table definitions - using <xref linkend="sql-importforeignschema">. This command creates + using <xref linkend="sql-importforeignschema"/>. This command creates foreign table definitions on the local server that match tables or views present on the remote server. If the remote tables to be imported have columns of user-defined data types, the local server must have @@ -423,7 +423,7 @@ So if you wish to import <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints, you must do so manually, and you should verify the semantics of each one carefully. For more detail about the treatment of <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints on - foreign tables, see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">. + foreign tables, see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable"/>. </para> <para> @@ -528,7 +528,7 @@ <para> In the remote sessions opened by <filename>postgres_fdw</filename>, - the <xref linkend="guc-search-path"> parameter is set to + the <xref linkend="guc-search-path"/> parameter is set to just <literal>pg_catalog</literal>, so that only built-in objects are visible without schema qualification. This is not an issue for queries generated by <filename>postgres_fdw</filename> itself, because it always @@ -538,7 +538,7 @@ any functions used in that view will be executed with the restricted search path. It is recommended to schema-qualify all names in such functions, or else attach <literal>SET search_path</literal> options - (see <xref linkend="sql-createfunction">) to such functions + (see <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"/>) to such functions to establish their expected search path environment. </para> @@ -548,22 +548,22 @@ <itemizedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - <xref linkend="guc-timezone"> is set to <literal>UTC</literal> + <xref linkend="guc-timezone"/> is set to <literal>UTC</literal> </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - <xref linkend="guc-datestyle"> is set to <literal>ISO</literal> + <xref linkend="guc-datestyle"/> is set to <literal>ISO</literal> </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - <xref linkend="guc-intervalstyle"> is set to <literal>postgres</literal> + <xref linkend="guc-intervalstyle"/> is set to <literal>postgres</literal> </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - <xref linkend="guc-extra-float-digits"> is set to <literal>3</literal> for remote + <xref linkend="guc-extra-float-digits"/> is set to <literal>3</literal> for remote servers 9.0 and newer and is set to <literal>2</literal> for older versions </para> </listitem> @@ -612,7 +612,7 @@ CREATE EXTENSION postgres_fdw; </programlisting> <para> - Then create a foreign server using <xref linkend="sql-createserver">. + Then create a foreign server using <xref linkend="sql-createserver"/>. In this example we wish to connect to a <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> server on host <literal>192.83.123.89</literal> listening on port <literal>5432</literal>. The database to which the connection is made @@ -626,7 +626,7 @@ CREATE SERVER foreign_server </para> <para> - A user mapping, defined with <xref linkend="sql-createusermapping">, is + A user mapping, defined with <xref linkend="sql-createusermapping"/>, is needed as well to identify the role that will be used on the remote server: @@ -639,7 +639,7 @@ CREATE USER MAPPING FOR local_user <para> Now it is possible to create a foreign table with - <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">. In this example we + <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable"/>. In this example we wish to access the table named <structname>some_schema.some_table</structname> on the remote server. The local name for it will be <structname>foreign_table</structname>: @@ -658,7 +658,7 @@ CREATE FOREIGN TABLE foreign_table ( Column names must match as well, unless you attach <literal>column_name</literal> options to the individual columns to show how they are named in the remote table. - In many cases, use of <xref linkend="sql-importforeignschema"> is + In many cases, use of <xref linkend="sql-importforeignschema"/> is preferable to constructing foreign table definitions manually. </para> </sect2> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/postgres.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/postgres.sgml index f8a6c48a57c..041afdbd860 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/postgres.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/postgres.sgml @@ -1,6 +1,8 @@ <!-- doc/src/sgml/postgres.sgml --> -<!DOCTYPE book PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook V4.2//EN" [ +<!DOCTYPE book PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook XML V4.2//EN" + "http://www.oasis-open.org/docbook/xml/4.2/docbookx.dtd" +[ <!ENTITY % version SYSTEM "version.sgml"> %version; @@ -42,11 +44,11 @@ <para> After you have worked through this tutorial you might want to move - on to reading <xref linkend="sql"> to gain a more formal knowledge - of the SQL language, or <xref linkend="client-interfaces"> for + on to reading <xref linkend="sql"/> to gain a more formal knowledge + of the SQL language, or <xref linkend="client-interfaces"/> for information about developing applications for <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>. Those who set up and - manage their own server should also read <xref linkend="admin">. + manage their own server should also read <xref linkend="admin"/>. </para> </partintro> @@ -80,14 +82,14 @@ chapters individually as they choose. The information in this part is presented in a narrative fashion in topical units. Readers looking for a complete description of a particular command - should see <xref linkend="reference">. + should see <xref linkend="reference"/>. </para> <para> Readers of this part should know how to connect to a <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> database and issue <acronym>SQL</acronym> commands. Readers that are unfamiliar with - these issues are encouraged to read <xref linkend="tutorial"> + these issues are encouraged to read <xref linkend="tutorial"/> first. <acronym>SQL</acronym> commands are typically entered using the <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> interactive terminal <application>psql</application>, but other programs that have @@ -130,7 +132,7 @@ self-contained and can be read individually as desired. The information in this part is presented in a narrative fashion in topical units. Readers looking for a complete description of a - particular command should see <xref linkend="reference">. + particular command should see <xref linkend="reference"/>. </para> <para> @@ -140,8 +142,8 @@ The rest of this part is about tuning and management; that material assumes that the reader is familiar with the general use of the <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> database system. Readers are - encouraged to look at <xref linkend="tutorial"> and <xref - linkend="sql"> for additional information. + encouraged to look at <xref linkend="tutorial"/> and <xref + linkend="sql"/> for additional information. </para> </partintro> @@ -174,10 +176,10 @@ with <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>. Each of these chapters can be read independently. Note that there are many other programming interfaces for client programs that are distributed separately and - contain their own documentation (<xref linkend="external-projects"> + contain their own documentation (<xref linkend="external-projects"/> lists some of the more popular ones). Readers of this part should be familiar with using <acronym>SQL</acronym> commands to manipulate - and query the database (see <xref linkend="sql">) and of course + and query the database (see <xref linkend="sql"/>) and of course with the programming language that the interface uses. </para> </partintro> @@ -203,7 +205,7 @@ <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> distribution as well as general issues concerning server-side programming languages. It is essential to read at least the earlier sections of <xref - linkend="extend"> (covering functions) before diving into the + linkend="extend"/> (covering functions) before diving into the material about server-side programming languages. </para> </partintro> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/problems.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/problems.sgml index edceec33813..7d14789e51a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/problems.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/problems.sgml @@ -170,7 +170,7 @@ form of the message. In <application>psql</application>, say <literal>\set VERBOSITY verbose</literal> beforehand. If you are extracting the message from the server log, set the run-time parameter - <xref linkend="guc-log-error-verbosity"> to <literal>verbose</literal> so that all + <xref linkend="guc-log-error-verbosity"/> to <literal>verbose</literal> so that all details are logged. </para> </note> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/protocol.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/protocol.sgml index 999fa060188..8174e3defa7 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/protocol.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/protocol.sgml @@ -207,7 +207,7 @@ <para> This section describes the message flow and the semantics of each message type. (Details of the exact representation of each message - appear in <xref linkend="protocol-message-formats">.) There are + appear in <xref linkend="protocol-message-formats"/>.) There are several different sub-protocols depending on the state of the connection: start-up, query, function call, <command>COPY</command>, and termination. There are also special @@ -383,7 +383,7 @@ SASLInitialResponse with the name of the selected mechanism, and the first part of the SASL data stream in response to this. If further messages are needed, the server will respond with - AuthenticationSASLContinue. See <xref linkend="sasl-authentication"> + AuthenticationSASLContinue. See <xref linkend="sasl-authentication"/> for details. </para> </listitem> @@ -478,9 +478,9 @@ <para> This message informs the frontend about the current (initial) setting of backend parameters, such as <xref - linkend="guc-client-encoding"> or <xref linkend="guc-datestyle">. + linkend="guc-client-encoding"/> or <xref linkend="guc-datestyle"/>. The frontend can ignore this message, or record the settings - for its future use; see <xref linkend="protocol-async"> for + for its future use; see <xref linkend="protocol-async"/> for more details. The frontend should not respond to this message, but should continue listening for a ReadyForQuery message. @@ -564,7 +564,7 @@ <listitem> <para> The backend is ready to copy data from the frontend to a - table; see <xref linkend="protocol-copy">. + table; see <xref linkend="protocol-copy"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -574,7 +574,7 @@ <listitem> <para> The backend is ready to copy data from a table to the - frontend; see <xref linkend="protocol-copy">. + frontend; see <xref linkend="protocol-copy"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -654,7 +654,7 @@ normally consists of RowDescription, zero or more DataRow messages, and then CommandComplete. <command>COPY</command> to or from the frontend invokes special protocol - as described in <xref linkend="protocol-copy">. + as described in <xref linkend="protocol-copy"/>. All other query types normally produce only a CommandComplete message. </para> @@ -691,7 +691,7 @@ <para> A frontend must be prepared to accept ErrorResponse and NoticeResponse messages whenever it is expecting any other type of - message. See also <xref linkend="protocol-async"> concerning messages + message. See also <xref linkend="protocol-async"/> concerning messages that the backend might generate due to outside events. </para> @@ -1198,7 +1198,7 @@ SELCT 1/0; It is possible for NoticeResponse and ParameterStatus messages to be interspersed between CopyData messages; frontends must handle these cases, and should be prepared for other asynchronous message types as well (see - <xref linkend="protocol-async">). Otherwise, any message type other than + <xref linkend="protocol-async"/>). Otherwise, any message type other than CopyData or CopyDone may be treated as terminating copy-out mode. </para> @@ -1221,7 +1221,7 @@ SELCT 1/0; until a Sync message is received, and then issue ReadyForQuery and return to normal processing. The frontend should treat receipt of ErrorResponse as terminating the copy in both directions; no CopyDone should be sent - in this case. See <xref linkend="protocol-replication"> for more + in this case. See <xref linkend="protocol-replication"/> for more information on the subprotocol transmitted over copy-both mode. </para> @@ -1435,7 +1435,7 @@ SELCT 1/0; communication security in environments where attackers might be able to capture the session traffic. For more information on encrypting <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> sessions with - <acronym>SSL</acronym>, see <xref linkend="ssl-tcp">. + <acronym>SSL</acronym>, see <xref linkend="ssl-tcp"/>. </para> <para> @@ -1635,7 +1635,7 @@ of <literal>true</literal> tells the backend to go into walsender mode, wherein small set of replication commands can be issued instead of SQL statements. Only the simple query protocol can be used in walsender mode. Replication commands are logged in the server log when -<xref linkend="guc-log-replication-commands"> is enabled. +<xref linkend="guc-log-replication-commands"/> is enabled. Passing <literal>database</literal> as the value instructs walsender to connect to the database specified in the <literal>dbname</literal> parameter, which will allow the connection to be used for logical replication from that database. @@ -1649,8 +1649,8 @@ the connection to be used for logical replication from that database. psql "dbname=postgres replication=database" -c "IDENTIFY_SYSTEM;" </programlisting> However, it is often more useful to use - <xref linkend="app-pgreceivewal"> (for physical replication) or - <xref linkend="app-pgrecvlogical"> (for logical replication). + <xref linkend="app-pgreceivewal"/> (for physical replication) or + <xref linkend="app-pgrecvlogical"/> (for logical replication). </para> <para> @@ -1728,7 +1728,7 @@ The commands accepted in walsender mode are: <listitem> <para> Requests the server to send the current setting of a run-time parameter. - This is similar to the SQL command <xref linkend="sql-show">. + This is similar to the SQL command <xref linkend="sql-show"/>. </para> <variablelist> @@ -1737,7 +1737,7 @@ The commands accepted in walsender mode are: <listitem> <para> The name of a run-time parameter. Available parameters are documented - in <xref linkend="runtime-config">. + in <xref linkend="runtime-config"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -1792,7 +1792,7 @@ The commands accepted in walsender mode are: <listitem> <para> Create a physical or logical replication - slot. See <xref linkend="streaming-replication-slots"> for more about + slot. See <xref linkend="streaming-replication-slots"/> for more about replication slots. </para> <variablelist> @@ -1801,7 +1801,7 @@ The commands accepted in walsender mode are: <listitem> <para> The name of the slot to create. Must be a valid replication slot - name (see <xref linkend="streaming-replication-slots-manipulation">). + name (see <xref linkend="streaming-replication-slots-manipulation"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -1811,7 +1811,7 @@ The commands accepted in walsender mode are: <listitem> <para> The name of the output plugin used for logical decoding - (see <xref linkend="logicaldecoding-output-plugin">). + (see <xref linkend="logicaldecoding-output-plugin"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -2378,7 +2378,7 @@ The commands accepted in walsender mode are: Sets the label of the backup. If none is specified, a backup label of <literal>base backup</literal> will be used. The quoting rules for the label are the same as a standard SQL string with - <xref linkend="guc-standard-conforming-strings"> turned on. + <xref linkend="guc-standard-conforming-strings"/> turned on. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -2642,7 +2642,7 @@ The commands accepted in walsender mode are: <para> The individual protocol messages are discussed in the following subsections. Individual messages are described in - <xref linkend="protocol-logicalrep-message-formats">. + <xref linkend="protocol-logicalrep-message-formats"/>. </para> <para> @@ -4006,7 +4006,7 @@ CopyInResponse (B) characters, etc). 1 indicates the overall copy format is binary (similar to DataRow format). - See <xref linkend="sql-copy"> + See <xref linkend="sql-copy"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> @@ -4080,7 +4080,7 @@ CopyOutResponse (B) is textual (rows separated by newlines, columns separated by separator characters, etc). 1 indicates the overall copy format is binary (similar to DataRow - format). See <xref linkend="sql-copy"> for more information. + format). See <xref linkend="sql-copy"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -4153,7 +4153,7 @@ CopyBothResponse (B) is textual (rows separated by newlines, columns separated by separator characters, etc). 1 indicates the overall copy format is binary (similar to DataRow - format). See <xref linkend="sql-copy"> for more information. + format). See <xref linkend="sql-copy"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -4394,7 +4394,7 @@ ErrorResponse (B) A code identifying the field type; if zero, this is the message terminator and no string follows. The presently defined field types are listed in - <xref linkend="protocol-error-fields">. + <xref linkend="protocol-error-fields"/>. Since more field types might be added in future, frontends should silently ignore fields of unrecognized type. @@ -4886,7 +4886,7 @@ NoticeResponse (B) A code identifying the field type; if zero, this is the message terminator and no string follows. The presently defined field types are listed in - <xref linkend="protocol-error-fields">. + <xref linkend="protocol-error-fields"/>. Since more field types might be added in future, frontends should silently ignore fields of unrecognized type. @@ -5757,7 +5757,7 @@ StartupMessage (F) <literal>true</literal>, <literal>false</literal>, or <literal>database</literal>, and the default is <literal>false</literal>. See - <xref linkend="protocol-replication"> for details. + <xref linkend="protocol-replication"/> for details. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -5919,7 +5919,7 @@ message. <listitem> <para> Code: the SQLSTATE code for the error (see <xref - linkend="errcodes-appendix">). Not localizable. Always present. + linkend="errcodes-appendix"/>). Not localizable. Always present. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -6124,7 +6124,7 @@ message. <para> The fields for schema name, table name, column name, data type name, and constraint name are supplied only for a limited number of error types; - see <xref linkend="errcodes-appendix">. Frontends should not assume that + see <xref linkend="errcodes-appendix"/>. Frontends should not assume that the presence of any of these fields guarantees the presence of another field. Core error sources observe the interrelationships noted above, but user-defined functions may use these fields in other ways. In the same @@ -6149,7 +6149,7 @@ not line breaks. This section describes the detailed format of each logical replication message. These messages are returned either by the replication slot SQL interface or are sent by a walsender. In case of a walsender they are encapsulated inside the replication -protocol WAL messages as described in <xref linkend="protocol-replication"> +protocol WAL messages as described in <xref linkend="protocol-replication"/> and generally obey same message flow as physical replication. </para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/queries.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/queries.sgml index 52cc37a1d61..19a7d2e18bc 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/queries.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/queries.sgml @@ -24,7 +24,7 @@ <para> The process of retrieving or the command to retrieve data from a database is called a <firstterm>query</firstterm>. In SQL the - <xref linkend="sql-select"> command is + <xref linkend="sql-select"/> command is used to specify queries. The general syntax of the <command>SELECT</command> command is <synopsis> @@ -59,7 +59,7 @@ SELECT a, b + c FROM table1; </programlisting> (assuming that <literal>b</literal> and <literal>c</literal> are of a numerical data type). - See <xref linkend="queries-select-lists"> for more details. + See <xref linkend="queries-select-lists"/> for more details. </para> <para> @@ -110,7 +110,7 @@ SELECT random(); <title>The <literal>FROM</literal> Clause</title> <para> - The <xref linkend="sql-from" endterm="sql-from-title"> derives a + The <xref linkend="sql-from" endterm="sql-from-title"/> derives a table from one or more other tables given in a comma-separated table reference list. <synopsis> @@ -589,7 +589,7 @@ SELECT * FROM my_table AS m WHERE my_table.a > 5; -- wrong SELECT * FROM people AS mother JOIN people AS child ON mother.id = child.mother_id; </programlisting> Additionally, an alias is required if the table reference is a - subquery (see <xref linkend="queries-subqueries">). + subquery (see <xref linkend="queries-subqueries"/>). </para> <para> @@ -640,7 +640,7 @@ SELECT a.* FROM (my_table AS a JOIN your_table AS b ON ...) AS c <para> Subqueries specifying a derived table must be enclosed in parentheses and <emphasis>must</emphasis> be assigned a table - alias name (as in <xref linkend="queries-table-aliases">). For + alias name (as in <xref linkend="queries-table-aliases"/>). For example: <programlisting> FROM (SELECT * FROM table1) AS alias_name @@ -662,7 +662,7 @@ FROM (VALUES ('anne', 'smith'), ('bob', 'jones'), ('joe', 'blow')) </programlisting> Again, a table alias is required. Assigning alias names to the columns of the <command>VALUES</command> list is optional, but is good practice. - For more information see <xref linkend="queries-values">. + For more information see <xref linkend="queries-values"/>. </para> </sect3> @@ -713,7 +713,7 @@ ROWS FROM( <replaceable>function_call</replaceable> <optional>, ... </optional> The special table function <literal>UNNEST</literal> may be called with any number of array parameters, and it returns a corresponding number of columns, as if <literal>UNNEST</literal> - (<xref linkend="functions-array">) had been called on each parameter + (<xref linkend="functions-array"/>) had been called on each parameter separately and combined using the <literal>ROWS FROM</literal> construct. </para> @@ -795,8 +795,8 @@ SELECT * AS t1(proname name, prosrc text) WHERE proname LIKE 'bytea%'; </programlisting> - The <xref linkend="contrib-dblink-function"> function - (part of the <xref linkend="dblink"> module) executes + The <xref linkend="contrib-dblink-function"/> function + (part of the <xref linkend="dblink"/> module) executes a remote query. It is declared to return <type>record</type> since it might be used for any kind of query. The actual column set must be specified in the calling query so @@ -908,12 +908,12 @@ WHERE pname IS NULL; <para> The syntax of the <xref linkend="sql-where" - endterm="sql-where-title"> is + endterm="sql-where-title"/> is <synopsis> WHERE <replaceable>search_condition</replaceable> </synopsis> where <replaceable>search_condition</replaceable> is any value - expression (see <xref linkend="sql-expressions">) that + expression (see <xref linkend="sql-expressions"/>) that returns a value of type <type>boolean</type>. </para> @@ -1014,7 +1014,7 @@ SELECT <replaceable>select_list</replaceable> </synopsis> <para> - The <xref linkend="sql-groupby" endterm="sql-groupby-title"> is + The <xref linkend="sql-groupby" endterm="sql-groupby-title"/> is used to group together those rows in a table that have the same values in all the columns listed. The order in which the columns are listed does not matter. The effect is to combine each set @@ -1066,7 +1066,7 @@ SELECT <replaceable>select_list</replaceable> Here <literal>sum</literal> is an aggregate function that computes a single value over the entire group. More information about the available aggregate functions can be found in <xref - linkend="functions-aggregate">. + linkend="functions-aggregate"/>. </para> <tip> @@ -1074,7 +1074,7 @@ SELECT <replaceable>select_list</replaceable> Grouping without aggregate expressions effectively calculates the set of distinct values in a column. This can also be achieved using the <literal>DISTINCT</literal> clause (see <xref - linkend="queries-distinct">). + linkend="queries-distinct"/>). </para> </tip> @@ -1236,7 +1236,7 @@ SELECT product_id, p.name, (sum(s.units) * (p.price - p.cost)) AS profit References to the grouping columns or expressions are replaced by null values in result rows for grouping sets in which those columns do not appear. To distinguish which grouping a particular output - row resulted from, see <xref linkend="functions-grouping-table">. + row resulted from, see <xref linkend="functions-grouping-table"/>. </para> <para> @@ -1366,9 +1366,9 @@ GROUP BY GROUPING SETS ( <para> If the query contains any window functions (see - <xref linkend="tutorial-window">, - <xref linkend="functions-window"> and - <xref linkend="syntax-window-functions">), these functions are evaluated + <xref linkend="tutorial-window"/>, + <xref linkend="functions-window"/> and + <xref linkend="syntax-window-functions"/>), these functions are evaluated after any grouping, aggregation, and <literal>HAVING</literal> filtering is performed. That is, if the query uses any aggregates, <literal>GROUP BY</literal>, or <literal>HAVING</literal>, then the rows seen by the window functions @@ -1430,7 +1430,7 @@ GROUP BY GROUPING SETS ( The simplest kind of select list is <literal>*</literal> which emits all columns that the table expression produces. Otherwise, a select list is a comma-separated list of value expressions (as - defined in <xref linkend="sql-expressions">). For instance, it + defined in <xref linkend="sql-expressions"/>). For instance, it could be a list of column names: <programlisting> SELECT a, b, c FROM ... @@ -1438,7 +1438,7 @@ SELECT a, b, c FROM ... The columns names <literal>a</literal>, <literal>b</literal>, and <literal>c</literal> are either the actual names of the columns of tables referenced in the <literal>FROM</literal> clause, or the aliases given to them as - explained in <xref linkend="queries-table-aliases">. The name + explained in <xref linkend="queries-table-aliases"/>. The name space available in the select list is the same as in the <literal>WHERE</literal> clause, unless grouping is used, in which case it is the same as in the <literal>HAVING</literal> clause. @@ -1455,7 +1455,7 @@ SELECT tbl1.a, tbl2.a, tbl1.b FROM ... <programlisting> SELECT tbl1.*, tbl2.a FROM ... </programlisting> - See <xref linkend="rowtypes-usage"> for more about + See <xref linkend="rowtypes-usage"/> for more about the <replaceable>table_name</replaceable><literal>.*</literal> notation. </para> @@ -1499,7 +1499,7 @@ SELECT a AS value, b + c AS sum FROM ... The <literal>AS</literal> keyword is optional, but only if the new column name does not match any <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> keyword (see <xref - linkend="sql-keywords-appendix">). To avoid an accidental match to + linkend="sql-keywords-appendix"/>). To avoid an accidental match to a keyword, you can double-quote the column name. For example, <literal>VALUE</literal> is a keyword, so this does not work: <programlisting> @@ -1518,7 +1518,7 @@ SELECT a "value", b + c AS sum FROM ... <para> The naming of output columns here is different from that done in the <literal>FROM</literal> clause (see <xref - linkend="queries-table-aliases">). It is possible + linkend="queries-table-aliases"/>). It is possible to rename the same column twice, but the name assigned in the select list is the one that will be passed on. </para> @@ -1663,7 +1663,7 @@ SELECT DISTINCT ON (<replaceable>expression</replaceable> <optional>, <replaceab queries, the two queries must be <quote>union compatible</quote>, which means that they return the same number of columns and the corresponding columns have compatible data types, as - described in <xref linkend="typeconv-union-case">. + described in <xref linkend="typeconv-union-case"/>. </para> </sect1> @@ -1861,7 +1861,7 @@ VALUES ( <replaceable class="parameter">expression</replaceable> [, ...] ) [, .. of columns in the table), and corresponding entries in each list must have compatible data types. The actual data type assigned to each column of the result is determined using the same rules as for <literal>UNION</literal> - (see <xref linkend="typeconv-union-case">). + (see <xref linkend="typeconv-union-case"/>). </para> <para> @@ -1912,7 +1912,7 @@ SELECT <replaceable>select_list</replaceable> FROM <replaceable>table_expression </para> <para> - For more information see <xref linkend="sql-values">. + For more information see <xref linkend="sql-values"/>. </para> </sect1> @@ -2261,7 +2261,7 @@ SELECT * FROM moved_rows; <para> Data-modifying statements in <literal>WITH</literal> usually have - <literal>RETURNING</literal> clauses (see <xref linkend="dml-returning">), + <literal>RETURNING</literal> clauses (see <xref linkend="dml-returning"/>), as shown in the example above. It is the output of the <literal>RETURNING</literal> clause, <emphasis>not</emphasis> the target table of the data-modifying statement, that forms the temporary @@ -2317,7 +2317,7 @@ DELETE FROM parts each other and with the main query. Therefore, when using data-modifying statements in <literal>WITH</literal>, the order in which the specified updates actually happen is unpredictable. All the statements are executed with - the same <firstterm>snapshot</firstterm> (see <xref linkend="mvcc">), so they + the same <firstterm>snapshot</firstterm> (see <xref linkend="mvcc"/>), so they cannot <quote>see</quote> one another's effects on the target tables. This alleviates the effects of the unpredictability of the actual order of row updates, and means that <literal>RETURNING</literal> data is the only way to diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/query.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/query.sgml index b139c345778..c0889743c4c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/query.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/query.sgml @@ -12,7 +12,7 @@ tutorial is only intended to give you an introduction and is in no way a complete tutorial on <acronym>SQL</acronym>. Numerous books have been written on <acronym>SQL</acronym>, including <xref - linkend="melt93"> and <xref linkend="date97">. + linkend="melt93"/> and <xref linkend="date97"/>. You should be aware that some <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> language features are extensions to the standard. </para> @@ -267,7 +267,7 @@ COPY weather FROM '/home/user/weather.txt'; where the file name for the source file must be available on the machine running the backend process, not the client, since the backend process reads the file directly. You can read more about the - <command>COPY</command> command in <xref linkend="sql-copy">. + <command>COPY</command> command in <xref linkend="sql-copy"/>. </para> </sect1> @@ -754,7 +754,7 @@ SELECT city, max(temp_lo) <programlisting> SELECT city, max(temp_lo) FROM weather - WHERE city LIKE 'S%' -- <co id="co.tutorial-agg-like"> + WHERE city LIKE 'S%' -- <co id="co.tutorial-agg-like"/> GROUP BY city HAVING max(temp_lo) < 40; </programlisting> @@ -762,7 +762,7 @@ SELECT city, max(temp_lo) <callout arearefs="co.tutorial-agg-like"> <para> The <literal>LIKE</literal> operator does pattern matching and - is explained in <xref linkend="functions-matching">. + is explained in <xref linkend="functions-matching"/>. </para> </callout> </calloutlist> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/rangetypes.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/rangetypes.sgml index ef2bff9cd93..3a034d9b06c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/rangetypes.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/rangetypes.sgml @@ -65,7 +65,7 @@ </listitem> </itemizedlist> In addition, you can define your own range types; - see <xref linkend="sql-createtype"> for more information. + see <xref linkend="sql-createtype"/> for more information. </para> </sect2> @@ -94,8 +94,8 @@ SELECT int4range(10, 20) * int4range(15, 25); SELECT isempty(numrange(1, 5)); </programlisting> - See <xref linkend="range-operators-table"> - and <xref linkend="range-functions-table"> for complete lists of + See <xref linkend="range-operators-table"/> + and <xref linkend="range-functions-table"/> for complete lists of operators and functions on range types. </para> </sect2> @@ -117,7 +117,7 @@ SELECT isempty(numrange(1, 5)); represented by <quote><literal>(</literal></quote>. Likewise, an inclusive upper bound is represented by <quote><literal>]</literal></quote>, while an exclusive upper bound is represented by <quote><literal>)</literal></quote>. - (See <xref linkend="rangetypes-io"> for more details.) + (See <xref linkend="rangetypes-io"/> for more details.) </para> <para> @@ -214,7 +214,7 @@ empty <note> <para> These rules are very similar to those for writing field values in - composite-type literals. See <xref linkend="rowtypes-io-syntax"> for + composite-type literals. See <xref linkend="rowtypes-io-syntax"/> for additional commentary. </para> </note> @@ -406,7 +406,7 @@ SELECT '[11:10, 23:00]'::timerange; </programlisting> <para> - See <xref linkend="sql-createtype"> for more information about creating + See <xref linkend="sql-createtype"/> for more information about creating range types. </para> </sect2> @@ -435,7 +435,7 @@ CREATE INDEX reservation_idx ON reservation USING GIST (during); <literal>-|-</literal>, <literal>&<</literal>, and <literal>&></literal> - (see <xref linkend="range-operators-table"> for more information). + (see <xref linkend="range-operators-table"/> for more information). </para> <para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/recovery-config.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/recovery-config.sgml index ca37ab51875..92825fdf192 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/recovery-config.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/recovery-config.sgml @@ -58,7 +58,7 @@ to truncate the archive to just the minimum required to support restarting from the current restore. <literal>%r</literal> is typically only used by warm-standby configurations - (see <xref linkend="warm-standby">). + (see <xref linkend="warm-standby"/>). Write <literal>%%</literal> to embed an actual <literal>%</literal> character. </para> @@ -99,7 +99,7 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows may be safely removed. This information can be used to truncate the archive to just the minimum required to support restart from the current restore. - The <xref linkend="pgarchivecleanup"> module + The <xref linkend="pgarchivecleanup"/> module is often used in <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> for single-standby configurations, for example: <programlisting>archive_cleanup_command = 'pg_archivecleanup /mnt/server/archivedir %r'</programlisting> @@ -107,7 +107,7 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows same archive directory, you will need to ensure that you do not delete WAL files until they are no longer needed by any of the servers. <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> would typically be used in a - warm-standby configuration (see <xref linkend="warm-standby">). + warm-standby configuration (see <xref linkend="warm-standby"/>). Write <literal>%%</literal> to embed an actual <literal>%</literal> character in the command. </para> @@ -133,7 +133,7 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows <varname>recovery_end_command</varname> is to provide a mechanism for cleanup following replication or recovery. Any <literal>%r</literal> is replaced by the name of the file containing the - last valid restart point, like in <xref linkend="archive-cleanup-command">. + last valid restart point, like in <xref linkend="archive-cleanup-command"/>. </para> <para> If the command returns a nonzero exit status then a warning log @@ -209,7 +209,7 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows This parameter specifies the time stamp up to which recovery will proceed. The precise stopping point is also influenced by - <xref linkend="recovery-target-inclusive">. + <xref linkend="recovery-target-inclusive"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -229,7 +229,7 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows The transactions that will be recovered are those that committed before (and optionally including) the specified one. The precise stopping point is also influenced by - <xref linkend="recovery-target-inclusive">. + <xref linkend="recovery-target-inclusive"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -244,7 +244,7 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows <para> This parameter specifies the LSN of the write-ahead log location up to which recovery will proceed. The precise stopping point is also - influenced by <xref linkend="recovery-target-inclusive">. This + influenced by <xref linkend="recovery-target-inclusive"/>. This parameter is parsed using the system data type <link linkend="datatype-pg-lsn"><type>pg_lsn</type></link>. </para> @@ -270,9 +270,9 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows Specifies whether to stop just after the specified recovery target (<literal>true</literal>), or just before the recovery target (<literal>false</literal>). - Applies when <xref linkend="recovery-target-lsn">, - <xref linkend="recovery-target-time">, or - <xref linkend="recovery-target-xid"> is specified. + Applies when <xref linkend="recovery-target-lsn"/>, + <xref linkend="recovery-target-time"/>, or + <xref linkend="recovery-target-xid"/> is specified. This setting controls whether transactions having exactly the target WAL location (LSN), commit time, or transaction ID, respectively, will be included in the recovery. Default is <literal>true</literal>. @@ -296,7 +296,7 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows a standby server. Other than that you only need to set this parameter in complex re-recovery situations, where you need to return to a state that itself was reached after a point-in-time recovery. - See <xref linkend="backup-timelines"> for discussion. + See <xref linkend="backup-timelines"/> for discussion. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -323,7 +323,7 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows is the most desirable point for recovery. The paused state can be resumed by using <function>pg_wal_replay_resume()</function> (see - <xref linkend="functions-recovery-control-table">), which then + <xref linkend="functions-recovery-control-table"/>), which then causes recovery to end. If this recovery target is not the desired stopping point, then shut down the server, change the recovery target settings to a later target and restart to @@ -344,7 +344,7 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows </para> <para> This setting has no effect if no recovery target is set. - If <xref linkend="guc-hot-standby"> is not enabled, a setting of + If <xref linkend="guc-hot-standby"/> is not enabled, a setting of <literal>pause</literal> will act the same as <literal>shutdown</literal>. </para> </listitem> @@ -386,9 +386,9 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows <para> Specifies a connection string to be used for the standby server to connect with the primary. This string is in the format - described in <xref linkend="libpq-connstring">. If any option is + described in <xref linkend="libpq-connstring"/>. If any option is unspecified in this string, then the corresponding environment - variable (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars">) is checked. If the + variable (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars"/>) is checked. If the environment variable is not set either, then defaults are used. </para> @@ -398,7 +398,7 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows the same as the standby server's default. Also specify a user name corresponding to a suitably-privileged role on the primary (see - <xref linkend="streaming-replication-authentication">). + <xref linkend="streaming-replication-authentication"/>). A password needs to be provided too, if the primary demands password authentication. It can be provided in the <varname>primary_conninfo</varname> string, or in a separate @@ -423,7 +423,7 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows Optionally specifies an existing replication slot to be used when connecting to the primary via streaming replication to control resource removal on the upstream node - (see <xref linkend="streaming-replication-slots">). + (see <xref linkend="streaming-replication-slots"/>). This setting has no effect if <varname>primary_conninfo</varname> is not set. </para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/abort.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/abort.sgml index d3415957856..21799d2a83f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/abort.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/abort.sgml @@ -33,7 +33,7 @@ ABORT [ WORK | TRANSACTION ] all the updates made by the transaction to be discarded. This command is identical in behavior to the standard <acronym>SQL</acronym> command - <xref linkend="sql-rollback">, + <xref linkend="sql-rollback"/>, and is present only for historical reasons. </para> </refsect1> @@ -58,7 +58,7 @@ ABORT [ WORK | TRANSACTION ] <title>Notes</title> <para> - Use <xref linkend="sql-commit"> to + Use <xref linkend="sql-commit"/> to successfully terminate a transaction. </para> @@ -92,9 +92,9 @@ ABORT; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-begin"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-commit"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-rollback"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-begin"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-commit"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-rollback"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_aggregate.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_aggregate.sgml index e00e726ad85..2ad3e0440bf 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_aggregate.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_aggregate.sgml @@ -142,7 +142,7 @@ ALTER AGGREGATE <replaceable>name</replaceable> ( <replaceable>aggregate_signatu The recommended syntax for referencing an ordered-set aggregate is to write <literal>ORDER BY</literal> between the direct and aggregated argument specifications, in the same style as in - <xref linkend="sql-createaggregate">. However, it will also work to + <xref linkend="sql-createaggregate"/>. However, it will also work to omit <literal>ORDER BY</literal> and just run the direct and aggregated argument specifications into a single list. In this abbreviated form, if <literal>VARIADIC "any"</literal> was used in both the direct and @@ -195,8 +195,8 @@ ALTER AGGREGATE mypercentile(float8, integer) SET SCHEMA myschema; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createaggregate"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropaggregate"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createaggregate"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropaggregate"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_collation.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_collation.sgml index c7ad7437e87..b51b3a25647 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_collation.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_collation.sgml @@ -94,7 +94,7 @@ ALTER COLLATION <replaceable>name</replaceable> SET SCHEMA <replaceable>new_sche <para> Update the collation's version. See <xref linkend="sql-altercollation-notes" - endterm="sql-altercollation-notes-title"> below. + endterm="sql-altercollation-notes-title"/> below. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -176,8 +176,8 @@ ALTER COLLATION "en_US" OWNER TO joe; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createcollation"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropcollation"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createcollation"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropcollation"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_conversion.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_conversion.sgml index 08ed5e28fbf..c42bd8b3e40 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_conversion.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_conversion.sgml @@ -120,8 +120,8 @@ ALTER CONVERSION iso_8859_1_to_utf8 OWNER TO joe; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createconversion"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropconversion"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createconversion"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropconversion"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_database.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_database.sgml index 1e09b5df1d9..7db878cf532 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_database.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_database.sgml @@ -188,7 +188,7 @@ ALTER DATABASE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> RESET ALL </para> <para> - See <xref linkend="sql-set"> and <xref linkend="runtime-config"> + See <xref linkend="sql-set"/> and <xref linkend="runtime-config"/> for more information about allowed parameter names and values. </para> @@ -203,7 +203,7 @@ ALTER DATABASE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> RESET ALL <para> It is also possible to tie a session default to a specific role rather than to a database; see - <xref linkend="sql-alterrole">. + <xref linkend="sql-alterrole"/>. Role-specific settings override database-specific ones if there is a conflict. </para> @@ -234,10 +234,10 @@ ALTER DATABASE test SET enable_indexscan TO off; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createdatabase"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropdatabase"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-set"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createtablespace"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createdatabase"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropdatabase"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-set"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createtablespace"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_default_privileges.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_default_privileges.sgml index bc7401f845a..ab2c35b4dd0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_default_privileges.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_default_privileges.sgml @@ -106,7 +106,7 @@ REVOKE [ GRANT OPTION FOR ] </para> <para> - As explained under <xref linkend="sql-grant">, + As explained under <xref linkend="sql-grant"/>, the default privileges for any object type normally grant all grantable permissions to the object owner, and may grant some privileges to <literal>PUBLIC</literal> as well. However, this behavior can be changed by @@ -150,8 +150,8 @@ REVOKE [ GRANT OPTION FOR ] This parameter, and all the other parameters in <replaceable class="parameter">abbreviated_grant_or_revoke</replaceable>, act as described under - <xref linkend="sql-grant"> or - <xref linkend="sql-revoke">, + <xref linkend="sql-grant"/> or + <xref linkend="sql-revoke"/>, except that one is setting permissions for a whole class of objects rather than specific named objects. </para> @@ -165,11 +165,11 @@ REVOKE [ GRANT OPTION FOR ] <title>Notes</title> <para> - Use <xref linkend="app-psql">'s <command>\ddp</command> command + Use <xref linkend="app-psql"/>'s <command>\ddp</command> command to obtain information about existing assignments of default privileges. The meaning of the privilege values is the same as explained for <command>\dp</command> under - <xref linkend="sql-grant">. + <xref linkend="sql-grant"/>. </para> <para> @@ -226,8 +226,8 @@ ALTER DEFAULT PRIVILEGES FOR ROLE admin REVOKE EXECUTE ON FUNCTIONS FROM PUBLIC; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-grant"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-revoke"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-grant"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-revoke"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_domain.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_domain.sgml index 9cd044de540..85253e209b0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_domain.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_domain.sgml @@ -80,7 +80,7 @@ ALTER DOMAIN <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> <listitem> <para> This form adds a new constraint to a domain using the same syntax as - <xref linkend="sql-createdomain">. + <xref linkend="sql-createdomain"/>. When a new constraint is added to a domain, all columns using that domain will be checked against the newly added constraint. These checks can be suppressed by adding the new constraint using the @@ -214,7 +214,7 @@ ALTER DOMAIN <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> <para> Automatically drop objects that depend on the constraint, and in turn all objects that depend on those objects - (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend">). + (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -342,8 +342,8 @@ ALTER DOMAIN zipcode SET SCHEMA customers; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createdomain"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropdomain"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createdomain"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropdomain"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_event_trigger.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_event_trigger.sgml index b913ac9a5bd..61919f7845d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_event_trigger.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_event_trigger.sgml @@ -78,7 +78,7 @@ ALTER EVENT TRIGGER <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> RENAME TO <para> These forms configure the firing of event triggers. A disabled trigger is still known to the system, but is not executed when its triggering - event occurs. See also <xref linkend="guc-session-replication-role">. + event occurs. See also <xref linkend="guc-session-replication-role"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -98,8 +98,8 @@ ALTER EVENT TRIGGER <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> RENAME TO <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createeventtrigger"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropeventtrigger"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createeventtrigger"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropeventtrigger"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_extension.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_extension.sgml index c2b0669c381..e54925507e1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_extension.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_extension.sgml @@ -119,7 +119,7 @@ ALTER EXTENSION <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> DROP <replacea </varlistentry> </variablelist> - See <xref linkend="extend-extensions"> for more information about these + See <xref linkend="extend-extensions"/> for more information about these operations. </para> @@ -323,8 +323,8 @@ ALTER EXTENSION hstore ADD FUNCTION populate_record(anyelement, hstore); <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createextension"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropextension"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createextension"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropextension"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_foreign_data_wrapper.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_foreign_data_wrapper.sgml index 21bc83e512c..14f3d616e71 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_foreign_data_wrapper.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_foreign_data_wrapper.sgml @@ -180,8 +180,8 @@ ALTER FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER dbi VALIDATOR bob.myvalidator; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createforeigndatawrapper"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropforeigndatawrapper"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createforeigndatawrapper"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropforeigndatawrapper"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_foreign_table.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_foreign_table.sgml index df3d6d0696d..f266be0c37b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_foreign_table.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_foreign_table.sgml @@ -72,7 +72,7 @@ ALTER FOREIGN TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceab <listitem> <para> This form adds a new column to the foreign table, using the same syntax as - <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">. + <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable"/>. Unlike the case when adding a column to a regular table, nothing happens to the underlying storage: this action simply declares that some new column is now accessible through the foreign table. @@ -134,8 +134,8 @@ ALTER FOREIGN TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceab <para> This form sets the per-column statistics-gathering target for subsequent - <xref linkend="sql-analyze"> operations. - See the similar form of <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> + <xref linkend="sql-analyze"/> operations. + See the similar form of <xref linkend="sql-altertable"/> for more details. </para> </listitem> @@ -147,7 +147,7 @@ ALTER FOREIGN TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceab <listitem> <para> This form sets or resets per-attribute options. - See the similar form of <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> + See the similar form of <xref linkend="sql-altertable"/> for more details. </para> </listitem> @@ -160,7 +160,7 @@ ALTER FOREIGN TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceab <listitem> <para> This form sets the storage mode for a column. - See the similar form of <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> + See the similar form of <xref linkend="sql-altertable"/> for more details. Note that the storage mode has no effect unless the table's foreign-data wrapper chooses to pay attention to it. @@ -173,7 +173,7 @@ ALTER FOREIGN TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceab <listitem> <para> This form adds a new constraint to a foreign table, using the same - syntax as <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">. + syntax as <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable"/>. Currently only <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are supported. </para> @@ -182,7 +182,7 @@ ALTER FOREIGN TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceab done to verify the constraint is correct; rather, this action simply declares that some new condition should be assumed to hold for all rows in the foreign table. (See the discussion - in <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">.) + in <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable"/>.) If the constraint is marked <literal>NOT VALID</literal>, then it isn't assumed to hold, but is only recorded for possible future use. </para> @@ -217,7 +217,7 @@ ALTER FOREIGN TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceab <listitem> <para> These forms configure the firing of trigger(s) belonging to the foreign - table. See the similar form of <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> for more + table. See the similar form of <xref linkend="sql-altertable"/> for more details. </para> </listitem> @@ -228,7 +228,7 @@ ALTER FOREIGN TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceab <listitem> <para> This form adds an <literal>oid</literal> system column to the - table (see <xref linkend="ddl-system-columns">). + table (see <xref linkend="ddl-system-columns"/>). It does nothing if the table already has OIDs. Unless the table's foreign-data wrapper supports OIDs, this column will simply read as zeroes. @@ -261,7 +261,7 @@ ALTER FOREIGN TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceab <para> This form adds the target foreign table as a new child of the specified parent table. - See the similar form of <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> + See the similar form of <xref linkend="sql-altertable"/> for more details. </para> </listitem> @@ -433,7 +433,7 @@ ALTER FOREIGN TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceab Automatically drop objects that depend on the dropped column or constraint (for example, views referencing the column), and in turn all objects that depend on those objects - (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend">). + (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -525,7 +525,7 @@ ALTER FOREIGN TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceab </para> <para> - Refer to <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable"> for a further description of valid + Refer to <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable"/> for a further description of valid parameters. </para> </refsect1> @@ -571,8 +571,8 @@ ALTER FOREIGN TABLE myschema.distributors OPTIONS (ADD opt1 'value', SET opt2 'v <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropforeigntable"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropforeigntable"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_function.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_function.sgml index fd35e98a886..196d2dde0c0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_function.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_function.sgml @@ -171,7 +171,7 @@ ALTER FUNCTION <replaceable>name</replaceable> [ ( [ [ <replaceable class="param null. <literal>RETURNS NULL ON NULL INPUT</literal> or <literal>STRICT</literal> changes the function so that it is not invoked if any of its arguments are null; instead, a null result - is assumed automatically. See <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"> + is assumed automatically. See <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> @@ -185,7 +185,7 @@ ALTER FUNCTION <replaceable>name</replaceable> [ ( [ [ <replaceable class="param <listitem> <para> Change the volatility of the function to the specified setting. - See <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"> for details. + See <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"/> for details. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -198,7 +198,7 @@ ALTER FUNCTION <replaceable>name</replaceable> [ ( [ [ <replaceable class="param <para> Change whether the function is a security definer or not. The key word <literal>EXTERNAL</literal> is ignored for SQL - conformance. See <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"> for more information about + conformance. See <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"/> for more information about this capability. </para> </listitem> @@ -210,7 +210,7 @@ ALTER FUNCTION <replaceable>name</replaceable> [ ( [ [ <replaceable class="param <listitem> <para> Change whether the function is deemed safe for parallelism. - See <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"> for details. + See <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"/> for details. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -220,7 +220,7 @@ ALTER FUNCTION <replaceable>name</replaceable> [ ( [ [ <replaceable class="param <listitem> <para> Change whether the function is considered leakproof or not. - See <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"> for more information about + See <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"/> for more information about this capability. </para> </listitem> @@ -232,7 +232,7 @@ ALTER FUNCTION <replaceable>name</replaceable> [ ( [ [ <replaceable class="param <listitem> <para> Change the estimated execution cost of the function. - See <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"> for more information. + See <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -243,7 +243,7 @@ ALTER FUNCTION <replaceable>name</replaceable> [ ( [ [ <replaceable class="param <listitem> <para> Change the estimated number of rows returned by a set-returning - function. See <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"> for more information. + function. See <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -266,8 +266,8 @@ ALTER FUNCTION <replaceable>name</replaceable> [ ( [ [ <replaceable class="param </para> <para> - See <xref linkend="sql-set"> and - <xref linkend="runtime-config"> + See <xref linkend="sql-set"/> and + <xref linkend="runtime-config"/> for more information about allowed parameter names and values. </para> </listitem> @@ -357,8 +357,8 @@ ALTER FUNCTION check_password(text) RESET search_path; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createfunction"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropfunction"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createfunction"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropfunction"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_group.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_group.sgml index 172a62a6f7d..39cc2b88cfa 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_group.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_group.sgml @@ -50,14 +50,14 @@ ALTER GROUP <replaceable class="parameter">group_name</replaceable> RENAME TO <r <quote>group</quote> for this purpose.) These variants are effectively equivalent to granting or revoking membership in the role named as the <quote>group</quote>; so the preferred way to do this is to use - <xref linkend="sql-grant"> or - <xref linkend="sql-revoke">. + <xref linkend="sql-grant"/> or + <xref linkend="sql-revoke"/>. </para> <para> The third variant changes the name of the group. This is exactly equivalent to renaming the role with - <xref linkend="sql-alterrole">. + <xref linkend="sql-alterrole"/>. </para> </refsect1> @@ -125,9 +125,9 @@ ALTER GROUP workers DROP USER beth; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-grant"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-revoke"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterrole"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-grant"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-revoke"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterrole"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_index.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_index.sgml index 5d0b792e505..e54237272c6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_index.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_index.sgml @@ -70,7 +70,7 @@ ALTER INDEX ALL IN TABLESPACE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> this command, use <command>ALTER DATABASE</command> or explicit <command>ALTER INDEX</command> invocations instead if desired. See also - <xref linkend="sql-createtablespace">. + <xref linkend="sql-createtablespace"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -91,11 +91,11 @@ ALTER INDEX ALL IN TABLESPACE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> <para> This form changes one or more index-method-specific storage parameters for the index. See - <xref linkend="sql-createindex"> + <xref linkend="sql-createindex"/> for details on the available parameters. Note that the index contents will not be modified immediately by this command; depending on the parameter you might need to rebuild the index with - <xref linkend="sql-reindex"> + <xref linkend="sql-reindex"/> to get the desired effects. </para> </listitem> @@ -117,16 +117,16 @@ ALTER INDEX ALL IN TABLESPACE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> <listitem> <para> This form sets the per-column statistics-gathering target for - subsequent <xref linkend="sql-analyze"> operations, though can + subsequent <xref linkend="sql-analyze"/> operations, though can be used only on index columns that are defined as an expression. Since expressions lack a unique name, we refer to them using the ordinal number of the index column. The target can be set in the range 0 to 10000; alternatively, set it to -1 to revert to using the system default statistics - target (<xref linkend="guc-default-statistics-target">). + target (<xref linkend="guc-default-statistics-target"/>). For more information on the use of statistics by the <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> query planner, refer to - <xref linkend="planner-stats">. + <xref linkend="planner-stats"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -225,7 +225,7 @@ ALTER INDEX ALL IN TABLESPACE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> <para> These operations are also possible using - <xref linkend="sql-altertable">. + <xref linkend="sql-altertable"/>. <command>ALTER INDEX</command> is in fact just an alias for the forms of <command>ALTER TABLE</command> that apply to indexes. </para> @@ -290,8 +290,8 @@ ALTER INDEX coord_idx ALTER COLUMN 3 SET STATISTICS 1000; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createindex"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-reindex"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createindex"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-reindex"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_language.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_language.sgml index 389824e3d21..eac63dec132 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_language.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_language.sgml @@ -83,8 +83,8 @@ ALTER [ PROCEDURAL ] LANGUAGE <replaceable>name</replaceable> OWNER TO { <replac <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createlanguage"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-droplanguage"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createlanguage"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-droplanguage"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_large_object.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_large_object.sgml index 0fbb8d5b624..f4a9c9e2a52 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_large_object.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_large_object.sgml @@ -73,7 +73,7 @@ ALTER LARGE OBJECT <replaceable class="parameter">large_object_oid</replaceable> <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="largeobjects"></member> + <member><xref linkend="largeobjects"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_materialized_view.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_materialized_view.sgml index f41b5058ff3..03e3df1ffdb 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_materialized_view.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_materialized_view.sgml @@ -78,7 +78,7 @@ ALTER MATERIALIZED VIEW ALL IN TABLESPACE <replaceable class="parameter">name</r The statement subforms and actions available for <command>ALTER MATERIALIZED VIEW</command> are a subset of those available for <command>ALTER TABLE</command>, and have the same meaning when used for - materialized views. See the descriptions for <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> + materialized views. See the descriptions for <xref linkend="sql-altertable"/> for details. </para> </refsect1> @@ -177,9 +177,9 @@ ALTER MATERIALIZED VIEW foo RENAME TO bar; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-creatematerializedview"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropmaterializedview"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-refreshmaterializedview"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-creatematerializedview"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropmaterializedview"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-refreshmaterializedview"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_opclass.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_opclass.sgml index e69bcf2dd76..59a64caa4fa 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_opclass.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_opclass.sgml @@ -116,9 +116,9 @@ ALTER OPERATOR CLASS <replaceable>name</replaceable> USING <replaceable class="p <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createopclass"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropopclass"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alteropfamily"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createopclass"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropopclass"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alteropfamily"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_operator.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_operator.sgml index 4c6f75efff3..b3bfa9ccbe9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_operator.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_operator.sgml @@ -154,8 +154,8 @@ ALTER OPERATOR && (_int4, _int4) SET (RESTRICT = _int_contsel, JOIN = _i <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createoperator"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropoperator"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createoperator"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropoperator"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_opfamily.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_opfamily.sgml index f327267ff81..3c0922c6452 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_opfamily.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_opfamily.sgml @@ -62,7 +62,7 @@ ALTER OPERATOR FAMILY <replaceable>name</replaceable> USING <replaceable class=" are compatible with the family's semantics, but are not required for correct functioning of any specific index. (Operators and functions that are so required should be declared as part of an operator class, - instead; see <xref linkend="sql-createopclass">.) + instead; see <xref linkend="sql-createopclass"/>.) <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> will allow loose members of a family to be dropped from the family at any time, but members of an operator class cannot be dropped without dropping the whole class and @@ -88,7 +88,7 @@ ALTER OPERATOR FAMILY <replaceable>name</replaceable> USING <replaceable class=" </para> <para> - Refer to <xref linkend="xindex"> for further information. + Refer to <xref linkend="xindex"/> for further information. </para> </refsect1> @@ -349,11 +349,11 @@ ALTER OPERATOR FAMILY integer_ops USING btree DROP <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createopfamily"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropopfamily"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createopclass"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alteropclass"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropopclass"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createopfamily"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropopfamily"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createopclass"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alteropclass"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropopclass"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_policy.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_policy.sgml index a49f2fc5a5f..a1c720a9569 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_policy.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_policy.sgml @@ -105,7 +105,7 @@ ALTER POLICY <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> ON <replaceable c <listitem> <para> The <literal>USING</literal> expression for the policy. - See <xref linkend="sql-createpolicy"> for details. + See <xref linkend="sql-createpolicy"/> for details. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -115,7 +115,7 @@ ALTER POLICY <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> ON <replaceable c <listitem> <para> The <literal>WITH CHECK</literal> expression for the policy. - See <xref linkend="sql-createpolicy"> for details. + See <xref linkend="sql-createpolicy"/> for details. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -135,8 +135,8 @@ ALTER POLICY <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> ON <replaceable c <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createpolicy"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-droppolicy"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createpolicy"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-droppolicy"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_publication.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_publication.sgml index 5557f9b2318..534e598d93e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_publication.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_publication.sgml @@ -52,7 +52,7 @@ ALTER PUBLICATION <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> RENAME TO <r <para> The fourth variant of this command listed in the synopsis can change all of the publication properties specified in - <xref linkend="sql-createpublication">. Properties not mentioned in the + <xref linkend="sql-createpublication"/>. Properties not mentioned in the command retain their previous settings. </para> @@ -101,7 +101,7 @@ ALTER PUBLICATION <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> RENAME TO <r <listitem> <para> This clause alters publication parameters originally set by - <xref linkend="sql-createpublication">. See there for more information. + <xref linkend="sql-createpublication"/>. See there for more information. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -156,10 +156,10 @@ ALTER PUBLICATION mypublication ADD TABLE users, departments; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createpublication"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-droppublication"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createsubscription"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-altersubscription"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createpublication"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-droppublication"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createsubscription"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-altersubscription"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_role.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_role.sgml index c135364d4ec..573a3e80f75 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_role.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_role.sgml @@ -62,11 +62,11 @@ ALTER ROLE { <replaceable class="parameter">role_specification</replaceable> | A <para> The first variant of this command listed in the synopsis can change many of the role attributes that can be specified in - <xref linkend="sql-createrole">. + <xref linkend="sql-createrole"/>. (All the possible attributes are covered, except that there are no options for adding or removing memberships; use - <xref linkend="sql-grant"> and - <xref linkend="sql-revoke"> for that.) + <xref linkend="sql-grant"/> and + <xref linkend="sql-revoke"/> for that.) Attributes not mentioned in the command retain their previous settings. Database superusers can change any of these settings for any role. Roles having <literal>CREATEROLE</literal> privilege can change any of these @@ -102,8 +102,8 @@ ALTER ROLE { <replaceable class="parameter">role_specification</replaceable> | A default, overriding whatever setting is present in <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> or has been received from the <command>postgres</command> command line. This only happens at login time; executing - <xref linkend="sql-set-role"> or - <xref linkend="sql-set-session-authorization"> does not cause new + <xref linkend="sql-set-role"/> or + <xref linkend="sql-set-session-authorization"/> does not cause new configuration values to be set. Settings set for all databases are overridden by database-specific settings attached to a role. Settings for specific databases or specific roles override @@ -173,7 +173,7 @@ ALTER ROLE { <replaceable class="parameter">role_specification</replaceable> | A <listitem> <para> These clauses alter attributes originally set by - <xref linkend="sql-createrole">. For more information, see the + <xref linkend="sql-createrole"/>. For more information, see the <command>CREATE ROLE</command> reference page. </para> </listitem> @@ -217,14 +217,14 @@ ALTER ROLE { <replaceable class="parameter">role_specification</replaceable> | A <para> Role-specific variable settings take effect only at login; - <xref linkend="sql-set-role"> and - <xref linkend="sql-set-session-authorization"> + <xref linkend="sql-set-role"/> and + <xref linkend="sql-set-session-authorization"/> do not process role-specific variable settings. </para> <para> - See <xref linkend="sql-set"> and <xref - linkend="runtime-config"> for more information about allowed + See <xref linkend="sql-set"/> and <xref + linkend="runtime-config"/> for more information about allowed parameter names and values. </para> </listitem> @@ -236,14 +236,14 @@ ALTER ROLE { <replaceable class="parameter">role_specification</replaceable> | A <title>Notes</title> <para> - Use <xref linkend="sql-createrole"> - to add new roles, and <xref linkend="sql-droprole"> to remove a role. + Use <xref linkend="sql-createrole"/> + to add new roles, and <xref linkend="sql-droprole"/> to remove a role. </para> <para> <command>ALTER ROLE</command> cannot change a role's memberships. - Use <xref linkend="sql-grant"> and - <xref linkend="sql-revoke"> + Use <xref linkend="sql-grant"/> and + <xref linkend="sql-revoke"/> to do that. </para> @@ -251,7 +251,7 @@ ALTER ROLE { <replaceable class="parameter">role_specification</replaceable> | A Caution must be exercised when specifying an unencrypted password with this command. The password will be transmitted to the server in cleartext, and it might also be logged in the client's command - history or the server log. <xref linkend="app-psql"> + history or the server log. <xref linkend="app-psql"/> contains a command <command>\password</command> that can be used to change a role's password without exposing the cleartext password. @@ -260,7 +260,7 @@ ALTER ROLE { <replaceable class="parameter">role_specification</replaceable> | A <para> It is also possible to tie a session default to a specific database rather than to a role; see - <xref linkend="sql-alterdatabase">. + <xref linkend="sql-alterdatabase"/>. If there is a conflict, database-role-specific settings override role-specific ones, which in turn override database-specific ones. </para> @@ -311,7 +311,7 @@ ALTER ROLE miriam CREATEROLE CREATEDB; <para> Give a role a non-default setting of the - <xref linkend="guc-maintenance-work-mem"> parameter: + <xref linkend="guc-maintenance-work-mem"/> parameter: <programlisting> ALTER ROLE worker_bee SET maintenance_work_mem = 100000; @@ -320,7 +320,7 @@ ALTER ROLE worker_bee SET maintenance_work_mem = 100000; <para> Give a role a non-default, database-specific setting of the - <xref linkend="guc-client-min-messages"> parameter: + <xref linkend="guc-client-min-messages"/> parameter: <programlisting> ALTER ROLE fred IN DATABASE devel SET client_min_messages = DEBUG; @@ -340,10 +340,10 @@ ALTER ROLE fred IN DATABASE devel SET client_min_messages = DEBUG; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createrole"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-droprole"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterdatabase"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-set"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createrole"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-droprole"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterdatabase"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-set"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_rule.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_rule.sgml index f8833feee71..c20bfb35e10 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_rule.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_rule.sgml @@ -97,8 +97,8 @@ ALTER RULE notify_all ON emp RENAME TO notify_me; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createrule"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-droprule"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createrule"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-droprule"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_schema.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_schema.sgml index dc914209545..2937214026e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_schema.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_schema.sgml @@ -92,8 +92,8 @@ ALTER SCHEMA <replaceable>name</replaceable> OWNER TO { <replaceable>new_owner</ <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createschema"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropschema"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createschema"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropschema"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_sequence.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_sequence.sgml index 655b35c6fcd..bfd20af6d3d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_sequence.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_sequence.sgml @@ -343,8 +343,8 @@ ALTER SEQUENCE serial RESTART WITH 105; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createsequence"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropsequence"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createsequence"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropsequence"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_server.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_server.sgml index 53529abff7e..17e55b093e9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_server.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_server.sgml @@ -136,8 +136,8 @@ ALTER SERVER foo VERSION '8.4' OPTIONS (SET host 'baz'); <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createserver"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropserver"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createserver"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropserver"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_statistics.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_statistics.sgml index d7b012fd543..58c7ed020dd 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_statistics.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_statistics.sgml @@ -109,8 +109,8 @@ ALTER STATISTICS <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> SET SCHEMA <r <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createstatistics"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropstatistics"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createstatistics"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropstatistics"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_subscription.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_subscription.sgml index 7e0240d696e..6dfb2e4d3e0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_subscription.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_subscription.sgml @@ -38,7 +38,7 @@ ALTER SUBSCRIPTION <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> RENAME TO < <para> <command>ALTER SUBSCRIPTION</command> can change most of the subscription properties that can be specified - in <xref linkend="sql-createsubscription">. + in <xref linkend="sql-createsubscription"/>. </para> <para> @@ -68,7 +68,7 @@ ALTER SUBSCRIPTION <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> RENAME TO < <listitem> <para> This clause alters the connection property originally set by - <xref linkend="sql-createsubscription">. See there for more + <xref linkend="sql-createsubscription"/>. See there for more information. </para> </listitem> @@ -79,7 +79,7 @@ ALTER SUBSCRIPTION <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> RENAME TO < <listitem> <para> Changes list of subscribed publications. See - <xref linkend="sql-createsubscription"> for more information. + <xref linkend="sql-createsubscription"/> for more information. By default this command will also act like <literal>REFRESH PUBLICATION</literal>. </para> @@ -162,7 +162,7 @@ ALTER SUBSCRIPTION <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> RENAME TO < <listitem> <para> This clause alters parameters originally set by - <xref linkend="sql-createsubscription">. See there for more + <xref linkend="sql-createsubscription"/>. See there for more information. The allowed options are <literal>slot_name</literal> and <literal>synchronous_commit</literal> </para> @@ -220,10 +220,10 @@ ALTER SUBSCRIPTION mysub DISABLE; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createsubscription"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropsubscription"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createpublication"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterpublication"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createsubscription"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropsubscription"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createpublication"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterpublication"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_system.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_system.sgml index 887c4392dd5..5e41f7f6444 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_system.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_system.sgml @@ -70,7 +70,7 @@ ALTER SYSTEM RESET ALL <listitem> <para> Name of a settable configuration parameter. Available parameters are - documented in <xref linkend="runtime-config">. + documented in <xref linkend="runtime-config"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -94,13 +94,13 @@ ALTER SYSTEM RESET ALL <title>Notes</title> <para> - This command can't be used to set <xref linkend="guc-data-directory">, + This command can't be used to set <xref linkend="guc-data-directory"/>, nor parameters that are not allowed in <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> (e.g., <link linkend="runtime-config-preset">preset options</link>). </para> <para> - See <xref linkend="config-setting"> for other ways to set the parameters. + See <xref linkend="config-setting"/> for other ways to set the parameters. </para> </refsect1> @@ -135,8 +135,8 @@ ALTER SYSTEM RESET wal_level; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-set"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-show"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-set"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-show"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_table.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_table.sgml index 92db00f52d4..7bcf2428465 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_table.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_table.sgml @@ -120,7 +120,7 @@ ALTER TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> <listitem> <para> This form adds a new column to the table, using the same syntax as - <xref linkend="sql-createtable">. If <literal>IF NOT EXISTS</literal> + <xref linkend="sql-createtable"/>. If <literal>IF NOT EXISTS</literal> is specified and a column already exists with this name, no error is thrown. </para> @@ -209,7 +209,7 @@ ALTER TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> <para> These forms change whether a column is an identity column or change the generation attribute of an existing identity column. - See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for details. + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"/> for details. </para> <para> @@ -227,7 +227,7 @@ ALTER TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> <para> These forms alter the sequence that underlies an existing identity column. <replaceable>sequence_option</replaceable> is an option - supported by <xref linkend="sql-altersequence"> such + supported by <xref linkend="sql-altersequence"/> such as <literal>INCREMENT BY</literal>. </para> </listitem> @@ -239,13 +239,13 @@ ALTER TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> <para> This form sets the per-column statistics-gathering target for subsequent - <xref linkend="sql-analyze"> operations. + <xref linkend="sql-analyze"/> operations. The target can be set in the range 0 to 10000; alternatively, set it to -1 to revert to using the system default statistics - target (<xref linkend="guc-default-statistics-target">). + target (<xref linkend="guc-default-statistics-target"/>). For more information on the use of statistics by the <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> query planner, refer to - <xref linkend="planner-stats">. + <xref linkend="planner-stats"/>. </para> <para> <literal>SET STATISTICS</literal> acquires a @@ -263,7 +263,7 @@ ALTER TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> defined per-attribute options are <literal>n_distinct</literal> and <literal>n_distinct_inherited</literal>, which override the number-of-distinct-values estimates made by subsequent - <xref linkend="sql-analyze"> + <xref linkend="sql-analyze"/> operations. <literal>n_distinct</literal> affects the statistics for the table itself, while <literal>n_distinct_inherited</literal> affects the statistics gathered for the table plus its inheritance children. When set to a @@ -281,7 +281,7 @@ ALTER TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> until query planning time. Specify a value of 0 to revert to estimating the number of distinct values normally. For more information on the use of statistics by the <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> query - planner, refer to <xref linkend="planner-stats">. + planner, refer to <xref linkend="planner-stats"/>. </para> <para> Changing per-attribute options acquires a @@ -315,7 +315,7 @@ ALTER TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> at the penalty of increased storage space. Note that <literal>SET STORAGE</literal> doesn't itself change anything in the table, it just sets the strategy to be pursued during future table updates. - See <xref linkend="storage-toast"> for more information. + See <xref linkend="storage-toast"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -325,7 +325,7 @@ ALTER TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> <listitem> <para> This form adds a new constraint to a table using the same syntax as - <xref linkend="sql-createtable">, plus the option <literal>NOT + <xref linkend="sql-createtable"/>, plus the option <literal>NOT VALID</literal>, which is currently only allowed for foreign key and CHECK constraints. If the constraint is marked <literal>NOT VALID</literal>, the @@ -457,7 +457,7 @@ ALTER TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> of course the integrity of the constraint cannot be guaranteed if the triggers are not executed. The trigger firing mechanism is also affected by the configuration - variable <xref linkend="guc-session-replication-role">. Simply enabled + variable <xref linkend="guc-session-replication-role"/>. Simply enabled triggers will fire when the replication role is <quote>origin</quote> (the default) or <quote>local</quote>. Triggers configured as <literal>ENABLE REPLICA</literal> will only fire if the session is in <quote>replica</quote> @@ -494,7 +494,7 @@ ALTER TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> even if row level security is disabled - in this case, the policies will NOT be applied and the policies will be ignored. See also - <xref linkend="sql-createpolicy">. + <xref linkend="sql-createpolicy"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -509,7 +509,7 @@ ALTER TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> disabled (the default) then row level security will not be applied when the user is the table owner. See also - <xref linkend="sql-createpolicy">. + <xref linkend="sql-createpolicy"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -519,7 +519,7 @@ ALTER TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> <listitem> <para> This form selects the default index for future - <xref linkend="sql-cluster"> + <xref linkend="sql-cluster"/> operations. It does not actually re-cluster the table. </para> <para> @@ -533,7 +533,7 @@ ALTER TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> <listitem> <para> This form removes the most recently used - <xref linkend="sql-cluster"> + <xref linkend="sql-cluster"/> index specification from the table. This affects future cluster operations that don't specify an index. </para> @@ -548,7 +548,7 @@ ALTER TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> <listitem> <para> This form adds an <literal>oid</literal> system column to the - table (see <xref linkend="ddl-system-columns">). + table (see <xref linkend="ddl-system-columns"/>). It does nothing if the table already has OIDs. </para> @@ -593,7 +593,7 @@ ALTER TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> <literal>information_schema</literal> relations are not considered part of the system catalogs and will be moved. See also - <xref linkend="sql-createtablespace">. + <xref linkend="sql-createtablespace"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -603,7 +603,7 @@ ALTER TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> <listitem> <para> This form changes the table from unlogged to logged or vice-versa - (see <xref linkend="sql-createtable-unlogged">). It cannot be applied + (see <xref linkend="sql-createtable-unlogged"/>). It cannot be applied to a temporary table. </para> </listitem> @@ -615,12 +615,12 @@ ALTER TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> <para> This form changes one or more storage parameters for the table. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable-storage-parameters" - endterm="sql-createtable-storage-parameters-title"> + endterm="sql-createtable-storage-parameters-title"/> for details on the available parameters. Note that the table contents will not be modified immediately by this command; depending on the parameter you might need to rewrite the table to get the desired effects. That can be done with <link linkend="sql-vacuum">VACUUM - FULL</link>, <xref linkend="sql-cluster"> or one of the forms + FULL</link>, <xref linkend="sql-cluster"/> or one of the forms of <command>ALTER TABLE</command> that forces a table rewrite. For planner related parameters, changes will take effect from the next time the table is locked so currently executing queries will not be @@ -789,7 +789,7 @@ ALTER TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> <para> A partition using <literal>FOR VALUES</literal> uses same syntax for <replaceable class="parameter">partition_bound_spec</replaceable> as - <xref linkend="sql-createtable">. The partition bound specification + <xref linkend="sql-createtable"/>. The partition bound specification must correspond to the partitioning strategy and partition key of the target table. The table to be attached must have all the same columns as the target table and no more; moreover, the column types must also @@ -821,7 +821,7 @@ ALTER TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> <para> If the new partition is a foreign table, nothing is done to verify that all the rows in the foreign table obey the partition constraint. - (See the discussion in <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable"> about + (See the discussion in <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable"/> about constraints on the foreign table.) </para> @@ -972,7 +972,7 @@ ALTER TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> Automatically drop objects that depend on the dropped column or constraint (for example, views referencing the column), and in turn all objects that depend on those objects - (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend">). + (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -1099,7 +1099,7 @@ ALTER TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> <listitem> <para> The partition bound specification for a new partition. Refer to - <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details on the syntax of the same. + <xref linkend="sql-createtable"/> for more details on the syntax of the same. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -1177,7 +1177,7 @@ ALTER TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> The rewriting forms of <command>ALTER TABLE</command> are not MVCC-safe. After a table rewrite, the table will appear empty to concurrent transactions, if they are using a snapshot taken before the rewrite - occurred. See <xref linkend="mvcc-caveats"> for more details. + occurred. See <xref linkend="mvcc-caveats"/> for more details. </para> <para> @@ -1239,8 +1239,8 @@ ALTER TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> </para> <para> - Refer to <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for a further description of valid - parameters. <xref linkend="ddl"> has further information on + Refer to <xref linkend="sql-createtable"/> for a further description of valid + parameters. <xref linkend="ddl"/> has further information on inheritance. </para> </refsect1> @@ -1472,7 +1472,7 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createtable"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createtable"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_tablespace.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_tablespace.sgml index 4d6f011e2fb..acec33469f1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_tablespace.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_tablespace.sgml @@ -88,9 +88,9 @@ ALTER TABLESPACE <replaceable>name</replaceable> RESET ( <replaceable class="par Setting either value for a particular tablespace will override the planner's usual estimate of the cost of reading pages from tables in that tablespace, as established by the configuration parameters of the - same name (see <xref linkend="guc-seq-page-cost">, - <xref linkend="guc-random-page-cost">, - <xref linkend="guc-effective-io-concurrency">). This may be useful if + same name (see <xref linkend="guc-seq-page-cost"/>, + <xref linkend="guc-random-page-cost"/>, + <xref linkend="guc-effective-io-concurrency"/>). This may be useful if one tablespace is located on a disk which is faster or slower than the remainder of the I/O subsystem. </para> @@ -130,8 +130,8 @@ ALTER TABLESPACE index_space OWNER TO mary; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createtablespace"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-droptablespace"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createtablespace"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-droptablespace"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_trigger.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_trigger.sgml index 4b4dacbf28d..6cf789a67a3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_trigger.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_trigger.sgml @@ -90,7 +90,7 @@ ALTER TRIGGER <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> ON <replaceable <para> The ability to temporarily enable or disable a trigger is provided by - <xref linkend="sql-altertable">, not by + <xref linkend="sql-altertable"/>, not by <command>ALTER TRIGGER</command>, because <command>ALTER TRIGGER</command> has no convenient way to express the option of enabling or disabling all of a table's triggers at once. @@ -126,7 +126,7 @@ ALTER TRIGGER emp_stamp ON emp DEPENDS ON EXTENSION emplib; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-altertable"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-altertable"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_tsconfig.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_tsconfig.sgml index 630927c15ba..ebe0b94b27e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_tsconfig.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_tsconfig.sgml @@ -182,8 +182,8 @@ ALTER TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION my_config <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createtsconfig"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-droptsconfig"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createtsconfig"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-droptsconfig"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_tsdictionary.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_tsdictionary.sgml index 75a8b1dac62..b29865e11e9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_tsdictionary.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_tsdictionary.sgml @@ -163,8 +163,8 @@ ALTER TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY my_dict ( dummy ); <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createtsdictionary"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-droptsdictionary"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createtsdictionary"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-droptsdictionary"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_tsparser.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_tsparser.sgml index c71faeec050..9edff4b71ae 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_tsparser.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_tsparser.sgml @@ -86,8 +86,8 @@ ALTER TEXT SEARCH PARSER <replaceable>name</replaceable> SET SCHEMA <replaceable <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createtsparser"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-droptsparser"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createtsparser"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-droptsparser"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_tstemplate.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_tstemplate.sgml index 210baa7125c..5d3c8265334 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_tstemplate.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_tstemplate.sgml @@ -86,8 +86,8 @@ ALTER TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE <replaceable>name</replaceable> SET SCHEMA <replaceab <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createtstemplate"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-droptstemplate"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createtstemplate"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-droptstemplate"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_type.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_type.sgml index 7c32f0c5d5a..9127dfd88de 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_type.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_type.sgml @@ -52,7 +52,7 @@ ALTER TYPE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> RENAME VALUE <repla <listitem> <para> This form adds a new attribute to a composite type, using the same syntax as - <xref linkend="sql-createtype">. + <xref linkend="sql-createtype"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -368,8 +368,8 @@ ALTER TYPE colors RENAME VALUE 'purple' TO 'mauve'; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createtype"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-droptype"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createtype"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-droptype"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_user.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_user.sgml index 8e03510bd4e..8f50f43089a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_user.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_user.sgml @@ -56,7 +56,7 @@ ALTER USER { <replaceable class="parameter">role_specification</replaceable> | A <para> <command>ALTER USER</command> is now an alias for - <xref linkend="sql-alterrole">. + <xref linkend="sql-alterrole"/>. </para> </refsect1> @@ -74,7 +74,7 @@ ALTER USER { <replaceable class="parameter">role_specification</replaceable> | A <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterrole"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterrole"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_user_mapping.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_user_mapping.sgml index eecff388cb0..7a9b5a188af 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_user_mapping.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_user_mapping.sgml @@ -116,8 +116,8 @@ ALTER USER MAPPING FOR bob SERVER foo OPTIONS (SET password 'public'); <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createusermapping"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropusermapping"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createusermapping"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropusermapping"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_view.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_view.sgml index f33519bd79a..2e9edc19758 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_view.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_view.sgml @@ -194,8 +194,8 @@ INSERT INTO a_view(id) VALUES(2); -- ts will receive the current time <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createview"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropview"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createview"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropview"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/analyze.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/analyze.sgml index bc33f0fa236..83b07a03003 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/analyze.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/analyze.sgml @@ -111,7 +111,7 @@ ANALYZE [ VERBOSE ] [ <replaceable class="parameter">table_and_columns</replacea <para> In the default <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> configuration, - the autovacuum daemon (see <xref linkend="autovacuum">) + the autovacuum daemon (see <xref linkend="autovacuum"/>) takes care of automatic analyzing of tables when they are first loaded with data, and as they change throughout regular operation. When autovacuum is disabled, @@ -119,7 +119,7 @@ ANALYZE [ VERBOSE ] [ <replaceable class="parameter">table_and_columns</replacea just after making major changes in the contents of a table. Accurate statistics will help the planner to choose the most appropriate query plan, and thereby improve the speed of query processing. A common - strategy for read-mostly databases is to run <xref linkend="sql-vacuum"> + strategy for read-mostly databases is to run <xref linkend="sql-vacuum"/> and <command>ANALYZE</command> once a day during a low-usage time of day. (This will not be sufficient if there is heavy update activity.) </para> @@ -139,7 +139,7 @@ ANALYZE [ VERBOSE ] [ <replaceable class="parameter">table_and_columns</replacea in a unique-key column, there are no common values) or if the column data type does not support the appropriate operators. There is more information about the statistics in <xref - linkend="maintenance">. + linkend="maintenance"/>. </para> <para> @@ -150,7 +150,7 @@ ANALYZE [ VERBOSE ] [ <replaceable class="parameter">table_and_columns</replacea will change slightly each time <command>ANALYZE</command> is run, even if the actual table contents did not change. This might result in small changes in the planner's estimated costs shown by - <xref linkend="sql-explain">. + <xref linkend="sql-explain"/>. In rare situations, this non-determinism will cause the planner's choices of query plans to change after <command>ANALYZE</command> is run. To avoid this, raise the amount of statistics collected by @@ -159,10 +159,10 @@ ANALYZE [ VERBOSE ] [ <replaceable class="parameter">table_and_columns</replacea <para> The extent of analysis can be controlled by adjusting the - <xref linkend="guc-default-statistics-target"> configuration variable, or + <xref linkend="guc-default-statistics-target"/> configuration variable, or on a column-by-column basis by setting the per-column statistics target with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ALTER COLUMN ... SET - STATISTICS</command> (see <xref linkend="sql-altertable">). + STATISTICS</command> (see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"/>). The target value sets the maximum number of entries in the most-common-value list and the maximum number of bins in the histogram. The default target value @@ -192,7 +192,7 @@ ANALYZE [ VERBOSE ] [ <replaceable class="parameter">table_and_columns</replacea bad query plans, a more accurate value can be determined manually and then installed with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ALTER COLUMN ... SET (n_distinct = ...)</command> - (see <xref linkend="sql-altertable">). + (see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"/>). </para> <para> @@ -233,10 +233,10 @@ ANALYZE [ VERBOSE ] [ <replaceable class="parameter">table_and_columns</replacea <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-vacuum"></member> - <member><xref linkend="app-vacuumdb"></member> - <member><xref linkend="runtime-config-resource-vacuum-cost"></member> - <member><xref linkend="autovacuum"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-vacuum"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="app-vacuumdb"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="runtime-config-resource-vacuum-cost"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="autovacuum"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/begin.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/begin.sgml index 45f85aea34e..c23bbfb4e71 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/begin.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/begin.sgml @@ -38,8 +38,8 @@ BEGIN [ WORK | TRANSACTION ] [ <replaceable class="parameter">transaction_mode</ <command>BEGIN</command> initiates a transaction block, that is, all statements after a <command>BEGIN</command> command will be executed in a single transaction until an explicit <xref - linkend="sql-commit"> or <xref - linkend="sql-rollback"> is given. + linkend="sql-commit"/> or <xref + linkend="sql-rollback"/> is given. By default (without <command>BEGIN</command>), <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> executes transactions in <quote>autocommit</quote> mode, that is, each @@ -60,7 +60,7 @@ BEGIN [ WORK | TRANSACTION ] [ <replaceable class="parameter">transaction_mode</ <para> If the isolation level, read/write mode, or deferrable mode is specified, the new transaction has those characteristics, as if - <xref linkend="sql-set-transaction"> + <xref linkend="sql-set-transaction"/> was executed. </para> </refsect1> @@ -81,7 +81,7 @@ BEGIN [ WORK | TRANSACTION ] [ <replaceable class="parameter">transaction_mode</ </variablelist> <para> - Refer to <xref linkend="sql-set-transaction"> for information on the meaning + Refer to <xref linkend="sql-set-transaction"/> for information on the meaning of the other parameters to this statement. </para> </refsect1> @@ -90,13 +90,13 @@ BEGIN [ WORK | TRANSACTION ] [ <replaceable class="parameter">transaction_mode</ <title>Notes</title> <para> - <xref linkend="sql-start-transaction"> has the same functionality + <xref linkend="sql-start-transaction"/> has the same functionality as <command>BEGIN</command>. </para> <para> - Use <xref linkend="sql-commit"> or - <xref linkend="sql-rollback"> + Use <xref linkend="sql-commit"/> or + <xref linkend="sql-rollback"/> to terminate a transaction block. </para> @@ -104,7 +104,7 @@ BEGIN [ WORK | TRANSACTION ] [ <replaceable class="parameter">transaction_mode</ Issuing <command>BEGIN</command> when already inside a transaction block will provoke a warning message. The state of the transaction is not affected. To nest transactions within a transaction block, use savepoints - (see <xref linkend="sql-savepoint">). + (see <xref linkend="sql-savepoint"/>). </para> <para> @@ -131,7 +131,7 @@ BEGIN; <para> <command>BEGIN</command> is a <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> language extension. It is equivalent to the SQL-standard command - <xref linkend="sql-start-transaction">, whose reference page + <xref linkend="sql-start-transaction"/>, whose reference page contains additional compatibility information. </para> @@ -152,10 +152,10 @@ BEGIN; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-commit"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-rollback"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-start-transaction"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-savepoint"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-commit"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-rollback"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-start-transaction"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-savepoint"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/checkpoint.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/checkpoint.sgml index a8f3186d8c0..dfcadcf4024 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/checkpoint.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/checkpoint.sgml @@ -29,7 +29,7 @@ CHECKPOINT A checkpoint is a point in the write-ahead log sequence at which all data files have been updated to reflect the information in the log. All data files will be flushed to disk. Refer to - <xref linkend="wal-configuration"> for more details about what happens + <xref linkend="wal-configuration"/> for more details about what happens during a checkpoint. </para> @@ -37,14 +37,14 @@ CHECKPOINT The <command>CHECKPOINT</command> command forces an immediate checkpoint when the command is issued, without waiting for a regular checkpoint scheduled by the system (controlled by the settings in - <xref linkend="runtime-config-wal-checkpoints">). + <xref linkend="runtime-config-wal-checkpoints"/>). <command>CHECKPOINT</command> is not intended for use during normal operation. </para> <para> If executed during recovery, the <command>CHECKPOINT</command> command - will force a restartpoint (see <xref linkend="wal-configuration">) + will force a restartpoint (see <xref linkend="wal-configuration"/>) rather than writing a new checkpoint. </para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/close.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/close.sgml index 7ecc0cc4632..e464df1965d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/close.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/close.sgml @@ -84,7 +84,7 @@ CLOSE { <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> | ALL } <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> does not have an explicit <command>OPEN</command> cursor statement; a cursor is considered open when it is declared. Use the - <xref linkend="sql-declare"> + <xref linkend="sql-declare"/> statement to declare a cursor. </para> @@ -124,9 +124,9 @@ CLOSE liahona; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-declare"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-fetch"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-move"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-declare"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-fetch"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-move"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/cluster.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/cluster.sgml index 1210b5dffbf..4da60d8d56a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/cluster.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/cluster.sgml @@ -57,7 +57,7 @@ CLUSTER [VERBOSE] <command>CLUSTER <replaceable class="parameter">table_name</replaceable></command> reclusters the table using the same index as before. You can also use the <literal>CLUSTER</literal> or <literal>SET WITHOUT CLUSTER</literal> - forms of <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to set the index to be used for + forms of <xref linkend="sql-altertable"/> to set the index to be used for future cluster operations, or to clear any previous setting. </para> @@ -148,18 +148,18 @@ CLUSTER [VERBOSE] as double the table size, plus the index sizes. This method is often faster than the index scan method, but if the disk space requirement is intolerable, you can disable this choice by temporarily setting <xref - linkend="guc-enable-sort"> to <literal>off</literal>. + linkend="guc-enable-sort"/> to <literal>off</literal>. </para> <para> - It is advisable to set <xref linkend="guc-maintenance-work-mem"> to + It is advisable to set <xref linkend="guc-maintenance-work-mem"/> to a reasonably large value (but not more than the amount of RAM you can dedicate to the <command>CLUSTER</command> operation) before clustering. </para> <para> Because the planner records statistics about the ordering of - tables, it is advisable to run <xref linkend="sql-analyze"> + tables, it is advisable to run <xref linkend="sql-analyze"/> on the newly clustered table. Otherwise, the planner might make poor choices of query plans. </para> @@ -221,7 +221,7 @@ CLUSTER <replaceable class="parameter">index_name</replaceable> ON <replaceable <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="app-clusterdb"></member> + <member><xref linkend="app-clusterdb"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/clusterdb.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/clusterdb.sgml index d2d4b52f48c..ed343dd7dae 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/clusterdb.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/clusterdb.sgml @@ -60,7 +60,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> <application>clusterdb</application> is a wrapper around the SQL - command <xref linkend="sql-cluster">. + command <xref linkend="sql-cluster"/>. There is no effective difference between clustering databases via this utility and via other methods for accessing the server. </para> @@ -279,7 +279,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> This utility, like most other <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> utilities, also uses the environment variables supported by <application>libpq</application> - (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars">). + (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars"/>). </para> </refsect1> @@ -289,8 +289,8 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <title>Diagnostics</title> <para> - In case of difficulty, see <xref linkend="sql-cluster"> - and <xref linkend="app-psql"> for + In case of difficulty, see <xref linkend="sql-cluster"/> + and <xref linkend="app-psql"/> for discussions of potential problems and error messages. The database server must be running at the targeted host. Also, any default connection settings and environment @@ -325,7 +325,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-cluster"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-cluster"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/comment.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/comment.sgml index d705792a451..7d66c1a34ca 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/comment.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/comment.sgml @@ -105,7 +105,7 @@ COMMENT ON the same built-in functions that <application>psql</application> uses, namely <function>obj_description</function>, <function>col_description</function>, and <function>shobj_description</function> - (see <xref linkend="functions-info-comment-table">). + (see <xref linkend="functions-info-comment-table"/>). </para> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/commit.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/commit.sgml index e41d6ff3cfb..b2e8d5d1807 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/commit.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/commit.sgml @@ -55,7 +55,7 @@ COMMIT [ WORK | TRANSACTION ] <title>Notes</title> <para> - Use <xref linkend="sql-rollback"> to + Use <xref linkend="sql-rollback"/> to abort a transaction. </para> @@ -89,8 +89,8 @@ COMMIT; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-begin"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-rollback"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-begin"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-rollback"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/commit_prepared.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/commit_prepared.sgml index c200a3e5737..d938b65bbec 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/commit_prepared.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/commit_prepared.sgml @@ -99,8 +99,8 @@ COMMIT PREPARED 'foobar'; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-prepare-transaction"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-rollback-prepared"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-prepare-transaction"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-rollback-prepared"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/copy.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/copy.sgml index eb91ad971d7..af2a0e91b9a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/copy.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/copy.sgml @@ -112,9 +112,9 @@ COPY { <replaceable class="parameter">table_name</replaceable> [ ( <replaceable <term><replaceable class="parameter">query</replaceable></term> <listitem> <para> - A <xref linkend="sql-select">, <xref linkend="sql-values">, - <xref linkend="sql-insert">, <xref linkend="sql-update"> or - <xref linkend="sql-delete"> command whose results are to be + A <xref linkend="sql-select"/>, <xref linkend="sql-values"/>, + <xref linkend="sql-insert"/>, <xref linkend="sql-update"/> or + <xref linkend="sql-delete"/> command whose results are to be copied. Note that parentheses are required around the query. </para> <para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_access_method.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_access_method.sgml index 1bb1a79bd23..851c5e63beb 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_access_method.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_access_method.sgml @@ -78,7 +78,7 @@ CREATE ACCESS METHOD <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> for <literal>INDEX</literal> access methods, it must be <type>index_am_handler</type>. The C-level API that the handler function must implement varies depending on the type of access method. - The index access method API is described in <xref linkend="indexam">. + The index access method API is described in <xref linkend="indexam"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -109,9 +109,9 @@ CREATE ACCESS METHOD heptree TYPE INDEX HANDLER heptree_handler; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-drop-access-method"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createopclass"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createopfamily"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-drop-access-method"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createopclass"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createopfamily"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_aggregate.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_aggregate.sgml index 4a8cee80574..a4aaae876ec 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_aggregate.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_aggregate.sgml @@ -91,7 +91,7 @@ CREATE AGGREGATE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> ( <command>CREATE AGGREGATE</command> defines a new aggregate function. Some basic and commonly-used aggregate functions are included with the distribution; they are documented in <xref - linkend="functions-aggregate">. If one defines new types or needs + linkend="functions-aggregate"/>. If one defines new types or needs an aggregate function not already provided, then <command>CREATE AGGREGATE</command> can be used to provide the desired features. </para> @@ -110,7 +110,7 @@ CREATE AGGREGATE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> ( the name and input data type(s) of every ordinary function in the same schema. This behavior is identical to overloading of ordinary function names - (see <xref linkend="sql-createfunction">). + (see <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"/>). </para> <para> @@ -199,7 +199,7 @@ CREATE AGGREGATE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> ( <para> An aggregate can optionally support <firstterm>moving-aggregate mode</firstterm>, - as described in <xref linkend="xaggr-moving-aggregates">. This requires + as described in <xref linkend="xaggr-moving-aggregates"/>. This requires specifying the <literal>MSFUNC</literal>, <literal>MINVFUNC</literal>, and <literal>MSTYPE</literal> parameters, and optionally the <literal>MSPACE</literal>, <literal>MFINALFUNC</literal>, @@ -228,7 +228,7 @@ CREATE AGGREGATE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> ( <para> An aggregate can optionally support <firstterm>partial aggregation</firstterm>, - as described in <xref linkend="xaggr-partial-aggregates">. + as described in <xref linkend="xaggr-partial-aggregates"/>. This requires specifying the <literal>COMBINEFUNC</literal> parameter. If the <replaceable class="parameter">state_data_type</replaceable> is <type>internal</type>, it's usually also appropriate to provide the @@ -379,7 +379,7 @@ SELECT col FROM tab ORDER BY col USING sortop LIMIT 1; The planner uses this value to estimate the memory required for a grouped aggregate query. The planner will consider using hash aggregation for such a query only if the hash table is estimated to fit - in <xref linkend="guc-work-mem">; therefore, large values of this + in <xref linkend="guc-work-mem"/>; therefore, large values of this parameter discourage use of hash aggregation. </para> </listitem> @@ -426,7 +426,7 @@ SELECT col FROM tab ORDER BY col USING sortop LIMIT 1; that does not modify its arguments. <literal>READ_ONLY</literal> indicates it does not; the other two values indicate that it may change the transition state value. See <xref linkend="sql-createaggregate-notes" - endterm="sql-createaggregate-notes-title"> below for more detail. The + endterm="sql-createaggregate-notes-title"/> below for more detail. The default is <literal>READ_ONLY</literal>, except for ordered-set aggregates, for which the default is <literal>READ_WRITE</literal>. </para> @@ -623,7 +623,7 @@ SELECT col FROM tab ORDER BY col USING sortop LIMIT 1; <para> The meanings of <literal>PARALLEL SAFE</literal>, <literal>PARALLEL RESTRICTED</literal>, and <literal>PARALLEL UNSAFE</literal> are the same as - in <xref linkend="sql-createfunction">. An aggregate will not be + in <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"/>. An aggregate will not be considered for parallelization if it is marked <literal>PARALLEL UNSAFE</literal> (which is the default!) or <literal>PARALLEL RESTRICTED</literal>. Note that the parallel-safety markings of the aggregate's support @@ -773,7 +773,7 @@ SELECT col FROM tab ORDER BY col USING sortop LIMIT 1; <title>Examples</title> <para> - See <xref linkend="xaggr">. + See <xref linkend="xaggr"/>. </para> </refsect1> @@ -791,8 +791,8 @@ SELECT col FROM tab ORDER BY col USING sortop LIMIT 1; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alteraggregate"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropaggregate"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alteraggregate"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropaggregate"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_cast.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_cast.sgml index cd4565e3368..84317047c23 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_cast.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_cast.sgml @@ -153,7 +153,7 @@ SELECT CAST ( 2 AS numeric ) + 4.0; ambiguity that cannot be avoided as above. The parser has a fallback heuristic based on <firstterm>type categories</firstterm> and <firstterm>preferred types</firstterm> that can help to provide desired behavior in such cases. See - <xref linkend="sql-createtype"> for + <xref linkend="sql-createtype"/> for more information. </para> </note> @@ -301,7 +301,7 @@ SELECT CAST ( 2 AS numeric ) + 4.0; <title>Notes</title> <para> - Use <xref linkend="sql-dropcast"> to remove user-defined casts. + Use <xref linkend="sql-dropcast"/> to remove user-defined casts. </para> <para> @@ -412,9 +412,9 @@ CREATE CAST (bigint AS int4) WITH FUNCTION int4(bigint) AS ASSIGNMENT; <title>See Also</title> <para> - <xref linkend="sql-createfunction">, - <xref linkend="sql-createtype">, - <xref linkend="sql-dropcast"> + <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"/>, + <xref linkend="sql-createtype"/>, + <xref linkend="sql-dropcast"/> </para> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_collation.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_collation.sgml index cc76b040272..5bc9af5499e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_collation.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_collation.sgml @@ -138,7 +138,7 @@ CREATE COLLATION [ IF NOT EXISTS ] <replaceable>name</replaceable> FROM <replace </para> <para> - See also <xref linkend="sql-altercollation"> for how to handle + See also <xref linkend="sql-altercollation"/> for how to handle collation version mismatches. </para> </listitem> @@ -167,13 +167,13 @@ CREATE COLLATION [ IF NOT EXISTS ] <replaceable>name</replaceable> FROM <replace </para> <para> - See <xref linkend="collation-create"> for more information on how to create collations. + See <xref linkend="collation-create"/> for more information on how to create collations. </para> <para> When using the <literal>libc</literal> collation provider, the locale must be applicable to the current database encoding. - See <xref linkend="sql-createdatabase"> for the precise rules. + See <xref linkend="sql-createdatabase"/> for the precise rules. </para> </refsect1> @@ -223,8 +223,8 @@ CREATE COLLATION german FROM "de_DE"; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-altercollation"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropcollation"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-altercollation"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropcollation"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_conversion.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_conversion.sgml index 44475eb30ea..4ddbcfacef2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_conversion.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_conversion.sgml @@ -161,9 +161,9 @@ CREATE CONVERSION myconv FOR 'UTF8' TO 'LATIN1' FROM myfunc; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterconversion"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createfunction"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropconversion"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterconversion"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createfunction"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropconversion"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_database.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_database.sgml index f63f1f92ac7..b2c9e241c2f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_database.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_database.sgml @@ -45,7 +45,7 @@ CREATE DATABASE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> <para> To create a database, you must be a superuser or have the special <literal>CREATEDB</literal> privilege. - See <xref linkend="sql-createrole">. + See <xref linkend="sql-createrole"/>. </para> <para> @@ -106,7 +106,7 @@ CREATE DATABASE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> to use the default encoding (namely, the encoding of the template database). The character sets supported by the <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> server are described in - <xref linkend="multibyte-charset-supported">. See below for + <xref linkend="multibyte-charset-supported"/>. See below for additional restrictions. </para> </listitem> @@ -143,7 +143,7 @@ CREATE DATABASE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> template database's tablespace. This tablespace will be the default tablespace used for objects created in this database. See - <xref linkend="sql-createtablespace"> + <xref linkend="sql-createtablespace"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> @@ -203,17 +203,17 @@ CREATE DATABASE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> </para> <para> - Use <xref linkend="sql-dropdatabase"> to remove a database. + Use <xref linkend="sql-dropdatabase"/> to remove a database. </para> <para> - The program <xref linkend="app-createdb"> is a + The program <xref linkend="app-createdb"/> is a wrapper program around this command, provided for convenience. </para> <para> Database-level configuration parameters (set via <xref - linkend="sql-alterdatabase">) are not copied from the template + linkend="sql-alterdatabase"/>) are not copied from the template database. </para> @@ -226,7 +226,7 @@ CREATE DATABASE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> DATABASE</command> will fail if any other connection exists when it starts; otherwise, new connections to the template database are locked out until <command>CREATE DATABASE</command> completes. - See <xref linkend="manage-ag-templatedbs"> for more information. + See <xref linkend="manage-ag-templatedbs"/> for more information. </para> <para> @@ -328,8 +328,8 @@ CREATE DATABASE music2 <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterdatabase"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropdatabase"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterdatabase"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropdatabase"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_domain.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_domain.sgml index d38914e2888..49d53043304 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_domain.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_domain.sgml @@ -255,8 +255,8 @@ CREATE TABLE us_snail_addy ( <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterdomain"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropdomain"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterdomain"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropdomain"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_event_trigger.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_event_trigger.sgml index 42cd0656122..396d82118ee 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_event_trigger.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_event_trigger.sgml @@ -36,7 +36,7 @@ CREATE EVENT TRIGGER <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> Whenever the designated event occurs and the <literal>WHEN</literal> condition associated with the trigger, if any, is satisfied, the trigger function will be executed. For a general introduction to event triggers, see - <xref linkend="event-triggers">. The user who creates an event trigger + <xref linkend="event-triggers"/>. The user who creates an event trigger becomes its owner. </para> </refsect1> @@ -60,7 +60,7 @@ CREATE EVENT TRIGGER <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> <listitem> <para> The name of the event that triggers a call to the given function. - See <xref linkend="event-trigger-definition"> for more information + See <xref linkend="event-trigger-definition"/> for more information on event names. </para> </listitem> @@ -113,7 +113,7 @@ CREATE EVENT TRIGGER <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> <para> Event triggers are disabled in single-user mode (see <xref - linkend="app-postgres">). If an erroneous event trigger disables the + linkend="app-postgres"/>). If an erroneous event trigger disables the database so much that you can't even drop the trigger, restart in single-user mode and you'll be able to do that. </para> @@ -154,9 +154,9 @@ CREATE EVENT TRIGGER abort_ddl ON ddl_command_start <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-altereventtrigger"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropeventtrigger"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createfunction"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-altereventtrigger"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropeventtrigger"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createfunction"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_extension.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_extension.sgml index 3e0f849f5b5..36837f927d4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_extension.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_extension.sgml @@ -195,7 +195,7 @@ CREATE EXTENSION [ IF NOT EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">extension_name <para> For information about writing new extensions, see - <xref linkend="extend-extensions">. + <xref linkend="extend-extensions"/>. </para> </refsect1> @@ -234,8 +234,8 @@ CREATE EXTENSION hstore SCHEMA public FROM unpackaged; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterextension"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropextension"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterextension"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropextension"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_foreign_data_wrapper.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_foreign_data_wrapper.sgml index d9a1c187358..0fcba18a347 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_foreign_data_wrapper.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_foreign_data_wrapper.sgml @@ -172,11 +172,11 @@ CREATE FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER mywrapper <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterforeigndatawrapper"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropforeigndatawrapper"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createserver"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createusermapping"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterforeigndatawrapper"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropforeigndatawrapper"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createserver"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createusermapping"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_foreign_table.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_foreign_table.sgml index 212c62ae1b7..37a45b26dbc 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_foreign_table.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_foreign_table.sgml @@ -131,7 +131,7 @@ CHECK ( <replaceable class="parameter">expression</replaceable> ) [ NO INHERIT ] The data type of the column. This can include array specifiers. For more information on the data types supported by <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>, refer to <xref - linkend="datatype">. + linkend="datatype"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -155,7 +155,7 @@ CHECK ( <replaceable class="parameter">expression</replaceable> ) [ NO INHERIT ] tables from which the new foreign table automatically inherits all columns. Parent tables can be plain tables or foreign tables. See the similar form of - <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details. + <xref linkend="sql-createtable"/> for more details. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -252,7 +252,7 @@ CHECK ( <replaceable class="parameter">expression</replaceable> ) [ NO INHERIT ] <para> The name of an existing foreign server to use for the foreign table. For details on defining a server, see <xref - linkend="sql-createserver">. + linkend="sql-createserver"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -361,11 +361,11 @@ CREATE FOREIGN TABLE measurement_y2016m07 <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterforeigntable"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropforeigntable"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createtable"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createserver"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-importforeignschema"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterforeigntable"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropforeigntable"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createtable"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createserver"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-importforeignschema"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_function.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_function.sgml index 970dc133595..75331165fef 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_function.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_function.sgml @@ -141,7 +141,7 @@ CREATE [ OR REPLACE ] FUNCTION name of an input argument is just extra documentation, so far as the function itself is concerned; but you can use input argument names when calling a function to improve readability (see <xref - linkend="sql-syntax-calling-funcs">). In any case, the name + linkend="sql-syntax-calling-funcs"/>). In any case, the name of an output argument is significant, because it defines the column name in the result row type. (If you omit the name for an output argument, the system will choose a default column name.) @@ -269,7 +269,7 @@ CREATE [ OR REPLACE ] FUNCTION <para> Lists which transforms a call to the function should apply. Transforms convert between SQL types and language-specific data types; - see <xref linkend="sql-createtransform">. Procedural language + see <xref linkend="sql-createtransform"/>. Procedural language implementations usually have hardcoded knowledge of the built-in types, so those don't need to be listed here. If a procedural language implementation does not know how to handle a type and no transform is @@ -338,7 +338,7 @@ CREATE [ OR REPLACE ] FUNCTION </para> <para> - For additional details see <xref linkend="xfunc-volatility">. + For additional details see <xref linkend="xfunc-volatility"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -363,7 +363,7 @@ CREATE [ OR REPLACE ] FUNCTION In addition, functions which do not take arguments or which are not passed any arguments from the security barrier view or table do not have to be marked as leakproof to be executed before security conditions. See - <xref linkend="sql-createview"> and <xref linkend="rules-privileges">. + <xref linkend="sql-createview"/> and <xref linkend="rules-privileges"/>. This option can only be set by the superuser. </para> </listitem> @@ -455,7 +455,7 @@ CREATE [ OR REPLACE ] FUNCTION <listitem> <para> A positive number giving the estimated execution cost for the function, - in units of <xref linkend="guc-cpu-operator-cost">. If the function + in units of <xref linkend="guc-cpu-operator-cost"/>. If the function returns a set, this is the cost per returned row. If the cost is not specified, 1 unit is assumed for C-language and internal functions, and 100 units for functions in all other languages. Larger values @@ -504,8 +504,8 @@ CREATE [ OR REPLACE ] FUNCTION </para> <para> - See <xref linkend="sql-set"> and - <xref linkend="runtime-config"> + See <xref linkend="sql-set"/> and + <xref linkend="runtime-config"/> for more information about allowed parameter names and values. </para> </listitem> @@ -523,7 +523,7 @@ CREATE [ OR REPLACE ] FUNCTION <para> It is often helpful to use dollar quoting (see <xref - linkend="sql-syntax-dollar-quoting">) to write the function definition + linkend="sql-syntax-dollar-quoting"/>) to write the function definition string, rather than the normal single quote syntax. Without dollar quoting, any single quotes or backslashes in the function definition must be escaped by doubling them. @@ -543,7 +543,7 @@ CREATE [ OR REPLACE ] FUNCTION the SQL function. The string <replaceable class="parameter">obj_file</replaceable> is the name of the shared library file containing the compiled C function, and is interpreted - as for the <xref linkend="sql-load"> command. The string + as for the <xref linkend="sql-load"/> command. The string <replaceable class="parameter">link_symbol</replaceable> is the function's link symbol, that is, the name of the function in the C language source code. If the link symbol is omitted, it is assumed @@ -598,7 +598,7 @@ CREATE [ OR REPLACE ] FUNCTION </variablelist> <para> - Refer to <xref linkend="xfunc"> for further information on writing + Refer to <xref linkend="xfunc"/> for further information on writing functions. </para> @@ -681,7 +681,7 @@ CREATE FUNCTION foo(int, int default 42) ... <para> Here are some trivial examples to help you get started. For more - information and examples, see <xref linkend="xfunc">. + information and examples, see <xref linkend="xfunc"/>. <programlisting> CREATE FUNCTION add(integer, integer) RETURNS integer AS 'select $1 + $2;' @@ -750,7 +750,7 @@ SELECT * FROM dup(42); Because a <literal>SECURITY DEFINER</literal> function is executed with the privileges of the user that owns it, care is needed to ensure that the function cannot be misused. For security, - <xref linkend="guc-search-path"> should be set to exclude any schemas + <xref linkend="guc-search-path"/> should be set to exclude any schemas writable by untrusted users. This prevents malicious users from creating objects (e.g., tables, functions, and operators) that mask objects intended to be used by the function. @@ -795,7 +795,7 @@ $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql <para> Another point to keep in mind is that by default, execute privilege is granted to <literal>PUBLIC</literal> for newly created functions - (see <xref linkend="sql-grant"> for more + (see <xref linkend="sql-grant"/> for more information). Frequently you will wish to restrict use of a security definer function to only some users. To do that, you must revoke the default <literal>PUBLIC</literal> privileges and then grant execute @@ -843,11 +843,11 @@ COMMIT; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterfunction"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropfunction"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-grant"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-load"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-revoke"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterfunction"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropfunction"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-grant"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-load"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-revoke"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_group.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_group.sgml index 0382349404c..1b8e76e326f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_group.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_group.sgml @@ -46,7 +46,7 @@ CREATE GROUP <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ [ WITH ] <repla <para> <command>CREATE GROUP</command> is now an alias for - <xref linkend="sql-createrole">. + <xref linkend="sql-createrole"/>. </para> </refsect1> @@ -63,7 +63,7 @@ CREATE GROUP <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ [ WITH ] <repla <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createrole"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createrole"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_index.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_index.sgml index 92c0090dfd4..025537575b8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_index.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_index.sgml @@ -72,7 +72,7 @@ CREATE [ UNIQUE ] INDEX [ CONCURRENTLY ] [ [ IF NOT EXISTS ] <replaceable class= can improve performance by creating an index on just that portion. Another possible application is to use <literal>WHERE</literal> with <literal>UNIQUE</literal> to enforce uniqueness over a subset of a - table. See <xref linkend="indexes-partial"> for more discussion. + table. See <xref linkend="indexes-partial"/> for more discussion. </para> <para> @@ -121,7 +121,7 @@ CREATE [ UNIQUE ] INDEX [ CONCURRENTLY ] [ [ IF NOT EXISTS ] <replaceable class= locks out writes (but not reads) on the table until it's done. There are several caveats to be aware of when using this option — see <xref linkend="sql-createindex-concurrently" - endterm="sql-createindex-concurrently-title">. + endterm="sql-createindex-concurrently-title"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -259,7 +259,7 @@ CREATE [ UNIQUE ] INDEX [ CONCURRENTLY ] [ [ IF NOT EXISTS ] <replaceable class= <listitem> <para> The name of an index-method-specific storage parameter. See - <xref linkend="sql-createindex-storage-parameters" endterm="sql-createindex-storage-parameters-title"> + <xref linkend="sql-createindex-storage-parameters" endterm="sql-createindex-storage-parameters-title"/> for details. </para> </listitem> @@ -270,8 +270,8 @@ CREATE [ UNIQUE ] INDEX [ CONCURRENTLY ] [ [ IF NOT EXISTS ] <replaceable class= <listitem> <para> The tablespace in which to create the index. If not specified, - <xref linkend="guc-default-tablespace"> is consulted, or - <xref linkend="guc-temp-tablespaces"> for indexes on temporary + <xref linkend="guc-default-tablespace"/> is consulted, or + <xref linkend="guc-temp-tablespaces"/> for indexes on temporary tables. </para> </listitem> @@ -331,10 +331,10 @@ CREATE [ UNIQUE ] INDEX [ CONCURRENTLY ] [ [ IF NOT EXISTS ] <replaceable class= <listitem> <para> Determines whether the buffering build technique described in - <xref linkend="gist-buffering-build"> is used to build the index. With + <xref linkend="gist-buffering-build"/> is used to build the index. With <literal>OFF</literal> it is disabled, with <literal>ON</literal> it is enabled, and with <literal>AUTO</literal> it is initially disabled, but turned on - on-the-fly once the index size reaches <xref linkend="guc-effective-cache-size">. The default is <literal>AUTO</literal>. + on-the-fly once the index size reaches <xref linkend="guc-effective-cache-size"/>. The default is <literal>AUTO</literal>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -350,10 +350,10 @@ CREATE [ UNIQUE ] INDEX [ CONCURRENTLY ] [ [ IF NOT EXISTS ] <replaceable class= <listitem> <para> This setting controls usage of the fast update technique described in - <xref linkend="gin-fast-update">. It is a Boolean parameter: + <xref linkend="gin-fast-update"/>. It is a Boolean parameter: <literal>ON</literal> enables fast update, <literal>OFF</literal> disables it. (Alternative spellings of <literal>ON</literal> and <literal>OFF</literal> are - allowed as described in <xref linkend="config-setting">.) The + allowed as described in <xref linkend="config-setting"/>.) The default is <literal>ON</literal>. </para> @@ -374,7 +374,7 @@ CREATE [ UNIQUE ] INDEX [ CONCURRENTLY ] [ [ IF NOT EXISTS ] <replaceable class= <term><literal>gin_pending_list_limit</literal></term> <listitem> <para> - Custom <xref linkend="guc-gin-pending-list-limit"> parameter. + Custom <xref linkend="guc-gin-pending-list-limit"/> parameter. This value is specified in kilobytes. </para> </listitem> @@ -391,7 +391,7 @@ CREATE [ UNIQUE ] INDEX [ CONCURRENTLY ] [ [ IF NOT EXISTS ] <replaceable class= <listitem> <para> Defines the number of table blocks that make up one block range for - each entry of a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index (see <xref linkend="brin-intro"> + each entry of a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index (see <xref linkend="brin-intro"/> for more details). The default is <literal>128</literal>. </para> </listitem> @@ -450,7 +450,7 @@ CREATE [ UNIQUE ] INDEX [ CONCURRENTLY ] [ [ IF NOT EXISTS ] <replaceable class= two more transactions. Before each table scan, the index build must wait for existing transactions that have modified the table to terminate. After the second scan, the index build must wait for any transactions - that have a snapshot (see <xref linkend="mvcc">) predating the second + that have a snapshot (see <xref linkend="mvcc"/>) predating the second scan to terminate. Then finally the index can be marked ready for use, and the <command>CREATE INDEX</command> command terminates. Even then, however, the index may not be immediately usable for queries: @@ -515,7 +515,7 @@ Indexes: <title>Notes</title> <para> - See <xref linkend="indexes"> for information about when indexes can + See <xref linkend="indexes"/> for information about when indexes can be used, when they are not used, and in which particular situations they can be useful. </para> @@ -541,8 +541,8 @@ Indexes: type either by absolute value or by real part. We could do this by defining two operator classes for the data type and then selecting the proper class when making an index. More information about - operator classes is in <xref linkend="indexes-opclass"> and in <xref - linkend="xindex">. + operator classes is in <xref linkend="indexes-opclass"/> and in <xref + linkend="xindex"/>. </para> <para> @@ -562,14 +562,14 @@ Indexes: <para> For most index methods, the speed of creating an index is - dependent on the setting of <xref linkend="guc-maintenance-work-mem">. + dependent on the setting of <xref linkend="guc-maintenance-work-mem"/>. Larger values will reduce the time needed for index creation, so long as you don't make it larger than the amount of memory really available, which would drive the machine into swapping. </para> <para> - Use <xref linkend="sql-dropindex"> + Use <xref linkend="sql-dropindex"/> to remove an index. </para> @@ -675,8 +675,8 @@ CREATE INDEX CONCURRENTLY sales_quantity_index ON sales_table (quantity); <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterindex"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropindex"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterindex"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropindex"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_language.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_language.sgml index 92dae40ecc6..6bb69cf0ef6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_language.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_language.sgml @@ -41,7 +41,7 @@ CREATE [ OR REPLACE ] [ TRUSTED ] [ PROCEDURAL ] LANGUAGE <replaceable class="pa <para> As of <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> 9.1, most procedural languages have been made into <quote>extensions</quote>, and should - therefore be installed with <xref linkend="sql-createextension"> + therefore be installed with <xref linkend="sql-createextension"/> not <command>CREATE LANGUAGE</command>. Direct use of <command>CREATE LANGUAGE</command> should now be confined to extension installation scripts. If you have a <quote>bare</quote> @@ -55,7 +55,7 @@ CREATE [ OR REPLACE ] [ TRUSTED ] [ PROCEDURAL ] LANGUAGE <replaceable class="pa <para> <command>CREATE LANGUAGE</command> effectively associates the language name with handler function(s) that are responsible for executing - functions written in the language. Refer to <xref linkend="plhandler"> + functions written in the language. Refer to <xref linkend="plhandler"/> for more information about language handlers. </para> @@ -178,7 +178,7 @@ CREATE [ OR REPLACE ] [ TRUSTED ] [ PROCEDURAL ] LANGUAGE <replaceable class="pa <para><replaceable class="parameter">inline_handler</replaceable> is the name of a previously registered function that will be called to execute an anonymous code block - (<xref linkend="sql-do"> command) + (<xref linkend="sql-do"/> command) in this language. If no <replaceable class="parameter">inline_handler</replaceable> function is specified, the language does not support anonymous code @@ -230,12 +230,12 @@ CREATE [ OR REPLACE ] [ TRUSTED ] [ PROCEDURAL ] LANGUAGE <replaceable class="pa <title>Notes</title> <para> - Use <xref linkend="sql-droplanguage"> to drop procedural languages. + Use <xref linkend="sql-droplanguage"/> to drop procedural languages. </para> <para> The system catalog <classname>pg_language</classname> (see <xref - linkend="catalog-pg-language">) records information about the + linkend="catalog-pg-language"/>) records information about the currently installed languages. Also, the <application>psql</application> command <command>\dL</command> lists the installed languages. </para> @@ -313,11 +313,11 @@ CREATE LANGUAGE plsample <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterlanguage"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createfunction"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-droplanguage"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-grant"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-revoke"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterlanguage"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createfunction"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-droplanguage"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-grant"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-revoke"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_materialized_view.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_materialized_view.sgml index 8dd138f8161..eed4273c4b4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_materialized_view.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_materialized_view.sgml @@ -92,11 +92,11 @@ CREATE MATERIALIZED VIEW [ IF NOT EXISTS ] <replaceable>table_name</replaceable> <para> This clause specifies optional storage parameters for the new materialized view; see <xref linkend="sql-createtable-storage-parameters" - endterm="sql-createtable-storage-parameters-title"> for more + endterm="sql-createtable-storage-parameters-title"/> for more information. All parameters supported for <literal>CREATE TABLE</literal> are also supported for <literal>CREATE MATERIALIZED VIEW</literal> with the exception of <literal>OIDS</literal>. - See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more information. + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -107,7 +107,7 @@ CREATE MATERIALIZED VIEW [ IF NOT EXISTS ] <replaceable>table_name</replaceable> <para> The <replaceable class="parameter">tablespace_name</replaceable> is the name of the tablespace in which the new materialized view is to be created. - If not specified, <xref linkend="guc-default-tablespace"> is consulted. + If not specified, <xref linkend="guc-default-tablespace"/> is consulted. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -116,8 +116,8 @@ CREATE MATERIALIZED VIEW [ IF NOT EXISTS ] <replaceable>table_name</replaceable> <term><replaceable>query</replaceable></term> <listitem> <para> - A <xref linkend="sql-select">, <link linkend="sql-table">TABLE</link>, - or <xref linkend="sql-values"> command. This query will run within a + A <xref linkend="sql-select"/>, <link linkend="sql-table">TABLE</link>, + or <xref linkend="sql-values"/> command. This query will run within a security-restricted operation; in particular, calls to functions that themselves create temporary tables will fail. </para> @@ -152,11 +152,11 @@ CREATE MATERIALIZED VIEW [ IF NOT EXISTS ] <replaceable>table_name</replaceable> <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-altermaterializedview"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createtableas"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createview"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropmaterializedview"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-refreshmaterializedview"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-altermaterializedview"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createtableas"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createview"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropmaterializedview"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-refreshmaterializedview"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_opclass.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_opclass.sgml index 882100583e5..0714aeca7ca 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_opclass.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_opclass.sgml @@ -77,7 +77,7 @@ CREATE OPERATOR CLASS <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ DEFAUL </para> <para> - Refer to <xref linkend="xindex"> for further information. + Refer to <xref linkend="xindex"/> for further information. </para> </refsect1> @@ -283,7 +283,7 @@ CREATE OPERATOR CLASS <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ DEFAUL <para> The following example command defines a GiST index operator class for the data type <literal>_int4</literal> (array of <type>int4</type>). See the - <xref linkend="intarray"> module for the complete example. + <xref linkend="intarray"/> module for the complete example. </para> <programlisting> @@ -319,10 +319,10 @@ CREATE OPERATOR CLASS gist__int_ops <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alteropclass"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropopclass"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createopfamily"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alteropfamily"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alteropclass"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropopclass"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createopfamily"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alteropfamily"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_operator.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_operator.sgml index 774616e244f..35f2f46985b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_operator.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_operator.sgml @@ -101,7 +101,7 @@ CREATE OPERATOR <replaceable>name</replaceable> ( <para> The other clauses specify optional operator optimization clauses. - Their meaning is detailed in <xref linkend="xoper-optimization">. + Their meaning is detailed in <xref linkend="xoper-optimization"/>. </para> <para> @@ -228,13 +228,13 @@ COMMUTATOR = OPERATOR(myschema.===) , <title>Notes</title> <para> - Refer to <xref linkend="xoper"> for further information. + Refer to <xref linkend="xoper"/> for further information. </para> <para> It is not possible to specify an operator's lexical precedence in <command>CREATE OPERATOR</command>, because the parser's precedence behavior - is hard-wired. See <xref linkend="sql-precedence"> for precedence details. + is hard-wired. See <xref linkend="sql-precedence"/> for precedence details. </para> <para> @@ -248,8 +248,8 @@ COMMUTATOR = OPERATOR(myschema.===) , </para> <para> - Use <xref linkend="sql-dropoperator"> to delete user-defined operators - from a database. Use <xref linkend="sql-alteroperator"> to modify operators in a + Use <xref linkend="sql-dropoperator"/> to delete user-defined operators + from a database. Use <xref linkend="sql-alteroperator"/> to modify operators in a database. </para> </refsect1> @@ -288,9 +288,9 @@ CREATE OPERATOR === ( <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alteroperator"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createopclass"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropoperator"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alteroperator"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createopclass"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropoperator"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_opfamily.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_opfamily.sgml index 0953e238ce7..ba612c2f2b0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_opfamily.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_opfamily.sgml @@ -64,7 +64,7 @@ CREATE OPERATOR FAMILY <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> USING < </para> <para> - Refer to <xref linkend="xindex"> for further information. + Refer to <xref linkend="xindex"/> for further information. </para> </refsect1> @@ -108,11 +108,11 @@ CREATE OPERATOR FAMILY <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> USING < <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alteropfamily"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropopfamily"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createopclass"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alteropclass"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropopclass"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alteropfamily"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropopfamily"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createopclass"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alteropclass"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropopclass"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_policy.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_policy.sgml index 64d3a6baa6c..c30506abc2c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_policy.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_policy.sgml @@ -515,7 +515,7 @@ AND <para> Additional discussion and practical examples can be found - in <xref linkend="ddl-rowsecurity">. + in <xref linkend="ddl-rowsecurity"/>. </para> </refsect1> @@ -533,9 +533,9 @@ AND <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterpolicy"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-droppolicy"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-altertable"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterpolicy"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-droppolicy"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-altertable"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_publication.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_publication.sgml index 55771d1d310..bfe12d5f410 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_publication.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_publication.sgml @@ -41,7 +41,7 @@ CREATE PUBLICATION <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> <para> A publication is essentially a group of tables whose data changes are intended to be replicated through logical replication. See - <xref linkend="logical-replication-publication"> for details about how + <xref linkend="logical-replication-publication"/> for details about how publications fit into the logical replication setup. </para> </refsect1> @@ -212,8 +212,8 @@ CREATE PUBLICATION insert_only FOR TABLE mydata <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterpublication"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-droppublication"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterpublication"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-droppublication"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_role.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_role.sgml index 7c050a3addf..9c3b6978af4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_role.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_role.sgml @@ -53,8 +53,8 @@ CREATE ROLE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ [ WITH ] <replac an entity that can own database objects and have database privileges; a role can be considered a <quote>user</quote>, a <quote>group</quote>, or both depending on how it is used. Refer to - <xref linkend="user-manag"> and <xref - linkend="client-authentication"> for information about managing + <xref linkend="user-manag"/> and <xref + linkend="client-authentication"/> for information about managing users and authentication. You must have <literal>CREATEROLE</literal> privilege or be a database superuser to use this command. </para> @@ -157,7 +157,7 @@ CREATE ROLE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ [ WITH ] <replac If not specified, <literal>NOLOGIN</literal> is the default, except when <command>CREATE ROLE</command> is invoked through its alternative spelling - <xref linkend="sql-createuser">. + <xref linkend="sql-createuser"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -237,7 +237,7 @@ CREATE ROLE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ [ WITH ] <replac The password is always stored encrypted in the system catalogs. The <literal>ENCRYPTED</literal> keyword has no effect, but is accepted for backwards compatibility. The method of encryption is determined - by the configuration parameter <xref linkend="guc-password-encryption">. + by the configuration parameter <xref linkend="guc-password-encryption"/>. If the presented password string is already in MD5-encrypted or SCRAM-encrypted format, then it is stored as-is regardless of <varname>password_encryption</varname> (since the system cannot decrypt @@ -329,8 +329,8 @@ CREATE ROLE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ [ WITH ] <replac <title>Notes</title> <para> - Use <xref linkend="sql-alterrole"> to - change the attributes of a role, and <xref linkend="sql-droprole"> + Use <xref linkend="sql-alterrole"/> to + change the attributes of a role, and <xref linkend="sql-droprole"/> to remove a role. All the attributes specified by <command>CREATE ROLE</command> can be modified by later <command>ALTER ROLE</command> commands. @@ -339,8 +339,8 @@ CREATE ROLE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ [ WITH ] <replac <para> The preferred way to add and remove members of roles that are being used as groups is to use - <xref linkend="sql-grant"> and - <xref linkend="sql-revoke">. + <xref linkend="sql-grant"/> and + <xref linkend="sql-revoke"/>. </para> <para> @@ -358,7 +358,7 @@ CREATE ROLE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ [ WITH ] <replac a member of a role with <literal>CREATEDB</literal> privilege does not immediately grant the ability to create databases, even if <literal>INHERIT</literal> is set; it would be necessary to become that role via - <xref linkend="sql-set-role"> before + <xref linkend="sql-set-role"/> before creating a database. </para> @@ -385,7 +385,7 @@ CREATE ROLE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ [ WITH ] <replac <para> <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> includes a program <xref - linkend="app-createuser"> that has + linkend="app-createuser"/> that has the same functionality as <command>CREATE ROLE</command> (in fact, it calls this command) but can be run from the command shell. </para> @@ -402,8 +402,8 @@ CREATE ROLE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ [ WITH ] <replac with this command. The password will be transmitted to the server in cleartext, and it might also be logged in the client's command history or the server log. The command <xref - linkend="app-createuser">, however, transmits - the password encrypted. Also, <xref linkend="app-psql"> + linkend="app-createuser"/>, however, transmits + the password encrypted. Also, <xref linkend="app-psql"/> contains a command <command>\password</command> that can be used to safely change the password later. @@ -480,12 +480,12 @@ CREATE ROLE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ WITH ADMIN <repl <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-set-role"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterrole"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-droprole"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-grant"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-revoke"></member> - <member><xref linkend="app-createuser"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-set-role"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterrole"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-droprole"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-grant"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-revoke"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="app-createuser"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_rule.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_rule.sgml index c6403c05306..dbf4c937841 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_rule.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_rule.sgml @@ -55,7 +55,7 @@ CREATE [ OR REPLACE ] RULE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> AS transformation happens before the execution of the command starts. If you actually want an operation that fires independently for each physical row, you probably want to use a trigger, not a rule. - More information about the rules system is in <xref linkend="rules">. + More information about the rules system is in <xref linkend="rules"/>. </para> <para> @@ -101,7 +101,7 @@ CREATE [ OR REPLACE ] RULE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> AS <note> <para> A view that is simple enough to be automatically updatable (see <xref - linkend="sql-createview">) does not require a user-created rule in + linkend="sql-createview"/>) does not require a user-created rule in order to be updatable. While you can create an explicit rule anyway, the automatic update transformation will generally outperform an explicit rule. @@ -109,7 +109,7 @@ CREATE [ OR REPLACE ] RULE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> AS <para> Another alternative worth considering is to use <literal>INSTEAD OF</literal> - triggers (see <xref linkend="sql-createtrigger">) in place of rules. + triggers (see <xref linkend="sql-createtrigger"/>) in place of rules. </para> </note> </refsect1> @@ -297,8 +297,8 @@ UPDATE mytable SET name = 'foo' WHERE id = 42; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterrule"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-droprule"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterrule"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-droprule"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_schema.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_schema.sgml index ed856e21e47..ffbe1ba3bcc 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_schema.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_schema.sgml @@ -219,8 +219,8 @@ CREATE VIEW hollywood.winners AS <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterschema"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropschema"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterschema"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropschema"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_sequence.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_sequence.sgml index 0cea9a49ce8..3e0d339c859 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_sequence.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_sequence.sgml @@ -56,7 +56,7 @@ CREATE [ TEMPORARY | TEMP ] SEQUENCE [ IF NOT EXISTS ] <replaceable class="param <function>currval</function>, and <function>setval</function> to operate on the sequence. These functions are documented in - <xref linkend="functions-sequence">. + <xref linkend="functions-sequence"/>. </para> <para> @@ -383,8 +383,8 @@ END; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-altersequence"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropsequence"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-altersequence"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropsequence"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_server.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_server.sgml index e13636a2682..eb4ca890c2a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_server.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_server.sgml @@ -122,9 +122,9 @@ CREATE SERVER [IF NOT EXISTS] <replaceable class="parameter">server_name</replac <title>Notes</title> <para> - When using the <xref linkend="dblink"> module, + When using the <xref linkend="dblink"/> module, a foreign server's name can be used - as an argument of the <xref linkend="contrib-dblink-connect"> + as an argument of the <xref linkend="contrib-dblink-connect"/> function to indicate the connection parameters. It is necessary to have the <literal>USAGE</literal> privilege on the foreign server to be able to use it in this way. @@ -140,7 +140,7 @@ CREATE SERVER [IF NOT EXISTS] <replaceable class="parameter">server_name</replac <programlisting> CREATE SERVER myserver FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER postgres_fdw OPTIONS (host 'foo', dbname 'foodb', port '5432'); </programlisting> - See <xref linkend="postgres-fdw"> for more details. + See <xref linkend="postgres-fdw"/> for more details. </para> </refsect1> @@ -156,11 +156,11 @@ CREATE SERVER myserver FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER postgres_fdw OPTIONS (host 'foo', db <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterserver"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropserver"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createforeigndatawrapper"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createusermapping"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterserver"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropserver"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createforeigndatawrapper"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createusermapping"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_statistics.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_statistics.sgml index bb99d8e785d..382a1eb64bf 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_statistics.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_statistics.sgml @@ -86,8 +86,8 @@ CREATE STATISTICS [ IF NOT EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">statistics_na dependency statistics. If this clause is omitted, all supported statistics kinds are included in the statistics object. - For more information, see <xref linkend="planner-stats-extended"> - and <xref linkend="multivariate-statistics-examples">. + For more information, see <xref linkend="planner-stats-extended"/> + and <xref linkend="multivariate-statistics-examples"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -178,8 +178,8 @@ EXPLAIN ANALYZE SELECT * FROM t1 WHERE (a = 1) AND (b = 0); <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterstatistics"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropstatistics"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterstatistics"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropstatistics"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_subscription.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_subscription.sgml index 2a1514a5ac2..49e4841188b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_subscription.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_subscription.sgml @@ -50,8 +50,8 @@ CREATE SUBSCRIPTION <replaceable class="parameter">subscription_name</replaceabl <para> Additional info about subscriptions and logical replication as a whole - can is available at <xref linkend="logical-replication-subscription"> and - <xref linkend="logical-replication">. + can is available at <xref linkend="logical-replication-subscription"/> and + <xref linkend="logical-replication"/>. </para> </refsect1> @@ -74,7 +74,7 @@ CREATE SUBSCRIPTION <replaceable class="parameter">subscription_name</replaceabl <listitem> <para> The connection string to the publisher. For details - see <xref linkend="libpq-connstring">. + see <xref linkend="libpq-connstring"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -152,7 +152,7 @@ CREATE SUBSCRIPTION <replaceable class="parameter">subscription_name</replaceabl <listitem> <para> The value of this parameter overrides the - <xref linkend="guc-synchronous-commit"> setting. The default + <xref linkend="guc-synchronous-commit"/> setting. The default value is <literal>off</literal>. </para> @@ -217,7 +217,7 @@ CREATE SUBSCRIPTION <replaceable class="parameter">subscription_name</replaceabl <title>Notes</title> <para> - See <xref linkend="logical-replication-security"> for details on + See <xref linkend="logical-replication-security"/> for details on how to configure access control between the subscription and the publication instance. </para> @@ -281,10 +281,10 @@ CREATE SUBSCRIPTION mysub <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-altersubscription"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropsubscription"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createpublication"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterpublication"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-altersubscription"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropsubscription"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createpublication"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterpublication"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_table.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_table.sgml index 3bc155a7752..a0c9a6d2571 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_table.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_table.sgml @@ -187,7 +187,7 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM This presently makes no difference in <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> and is deprecated; see <xref linkend="sql-createtable-compatibility" - endterm="sql-createtable-compatibility-title">. + endterm="sql-createtable-compatibility-title"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -198,7 +198,7 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM <para> If specified, the table is created as an unlogged table. Data written to unlogged tables is not written to the write-ahead log (see <xref - linkend="wal">), which makes them considerably faster than ordinary + linkend="wal"/>), which makes them considerably faster than ordinary tables. However, they are not crash-safe: an unlogged table is automatically truncated after a crash or unclean shutdown. The contents of an unlogged table are also not replicated to standby servers. @@ -296,7 +296,7 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM are valid values of the corresponding partition key columns for this partition, whereas those in the <literal>TO</literal> list are not. Note that this statement must be understood according to the - rules of row-wise comparison (<xref linkend="row-wise-comparison">). + rules of row-wise comparison (<xref linkend="row-wise-comparison"/>). For example, given <literal>PARTITION BY RANGE (x,y)</literal>, a partition bound <literal>FROM (1, 2) TO (3, 4)</literal> allows <literal>x=1</literal> with any <literal>y>=2</literal>, @@ -438,7 +438,7 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM The data type of the column. This can include array specifiers. For more information on the data types supported by <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>, refer to <xref - linkend="datatype">. + linkend="datatype"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -532,7 +532,7 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM specified explicitly, the default operator class of the appropriate type will be used; if no default operator class exists, an error will be raised. When hash partitioning is used, the operator class used - must implement support function 2 (see <xref linkend="xindex-support"> + must implement support function 2 (see <xref linkend="xindex-support"/> for details). </para> @@ -607,7 +607,7 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM default behavior is to exclude <literal>STORAGE</literal> settings, resulting in the copied columns in the new table having type-specific default settings. For more on <literal>STORAGE</literal> settings, see - <xref linkend="storage-toast">. + <xref linkend="storage-toast"/>. </para> <para> Comments for the copied columns, constraints, and indexes @@ -749,7 +749,7 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM only accepted if the <command>INSERT</command> statement specifies <literal>OVERRIDING SYSTEM VALUE</literal>. If <literal>BY DEFAULT</literal> is specified, then the user-specified value takes - precedence. See <xref linkend="sql-insert"> for details. (In + precedence. See <xref linkend="sql-insert"/> for details. (In the <command>COPY</command> command, user-specified values are always used regardless of this setting.) </para> @@ -757,7 +757,7 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM <para> The optional <replaceable>sequence_options</replaceable> clause can be used to override the options of the sequence. - See <xref linkend="sql-createsequence"> for details. + See <xref linkend="sql-createsequence"/> for details. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -832,7 +832,7 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM constraints that are more general than simple equality. For example, you can specify a constraint that no two rows in the table contain overlapping circles - (see <xref linkend="datatype-geometric">) by using the + (see <xref linkend="datatype-geometric"/>) by using the <literal>&&</literal> operator. </para> @@ -840,18 +840,18 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM Exclusion constraints are implemented using an index, so each specified operator must be associated with an appropriate operator class - (see <xref linkend="indexes-opclass">) for the index access + (see <xref linkend="indexes-opclass"/>) for the index access method <replaceable>index_method</replaceable>. The operators are required to be commutative. Each <replaceable class="parameter">exclude_element</replaceable> can optionally specify an operator class and/or ordering options; these are described fully under - <xref linkend="sql-createindex">. + <xref linkend="sql-createindex"/>. </para> <para> The access method must support <literal>amgettuple</literal> (see <xref - linkend="indexam">); at present this means <acronym>GIN</acronym> + linkend="indexam"/>); at present this means <acronym>GIN</acronym> cannot be used. Although it's allowed, there is little point in using B-tree or hash indexes with an exclusion constraint, because this does nothing that an ordinary unique constraint doesn't do better. @@ -1001,7 +1001,7 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM constraint that is not deferrable will be checked immediately after every command. Checking of constraints that are deferrable can be postponed until the end of the transaction - (using the <xref linkend="sql-set-constraints"> command). + (using the <xref linkend="sql-set-constraints"/> command). <literal>NOT DEFERRABLE</literal> is the default. Currently, only <literal>UNIQUE</literal>, <literal>PRIMARY KEY</literal>, <literal>EXCLUDE</literal>, and @@ -1025,7 +1025,7 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM statement. This is the default. If the constraint is <literal>INITIALLY DEFERRED</literal>, it is checked only at the end of the transaction. The constraint check time can be - altered with the <xref linkend="sql-set-constraints"> command. + altered with the <xref linkend="sql-set-constraints"/> command. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -1036,14 +1036,14 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM <para> This clause specifies optional storage parameters for a table or index; see <xref linkend="sql-createtable-storage-parameters" - endterm="sql-createtable-storage-parameters-title"> for more + endterm="sql-createtable-storage-parameters-title"/> for more information. The <literal>WITH</literal> clause for a table can also include <literal>OIDS=TRUE</literal> (or just <literal>OIDS</literal>) to specify that rows of the new table should have OIDs (object identifiers) assigned to them, or <literal>OIDS=FALSE</literal> to specify that the rows should not have OIDs. If <literal>OIDS</literal> is not specified, the default setting depends upon - the <xref linkend="guc-default-with-oids"> configuration parameter. + the <xref linkend="guc-default-with-oids"/> configuration parameter. (If the new table inherits from any tables that have OIDs, then <literal>OIDS=TRUE</literal> is forced even if the command says <literal>OIDS=FALSE</literal>.) @@ -1063,7 +1063,7 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM <para> To remove OIDs from a table after it has been created, use <xref - linkend="sql-altertable">. + linkend="sql-altertable"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -1106,7 +1106,7 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM <para> All rows in the temporary table will be deleted at the end of each transaction block. Essentially, an automatic <xref - linkend="sql-truncate"> is done + linkend="sql-truncate"/> is done at each commit. </para> </listitem> @@ -1132,8 +1132,8 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM The <replaceable class="parameter">tablespace_name</replaceable> is the name of the tablespace in which the new table is to be created. If not specified, - <xref linkend="guc-default-tablespace"> is consulted, or - <xref linkend="guc-temp-tablespaces"> if the table is temporary. + <xref linkend="guc-default-tablespace"/> is consulted, or + <xref linkend="guc-temp-tablespaces"/> if the table is temporary. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -1146,8 +1146,8 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM associated with a <literal>UNIQUE</literal>, <literal>PRIMARY KEY</literal>, or <literal>EXCLUDE</literal> constraint will be created. If not specified, - <xref linkend="guc-default-tablespace"> is consulted, or - <xref linkend="guc-temp-tablespaces"> if the table is temporary. + <xref linkend="guc-default-tablespace"/> is consulted, or + <xref linkend="guc-temp-tablespaces"/> if the table is temporary. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -1166,13 +1166,13 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM for tables, and for indexes associated with a <literal>UNIQUE</literal>, <literal>PRIMARY KEY</literal>, or <literal>EXCLUDE</literal> constraint. Storage parameters for - indexes are documented in <xref linkend="sql-createindex">. + indexes are documented in <xref linkend="sql-createindex"/>. The storage parameters currently available for tables are listed below. For many of these parameters, as shown, there is an additional parameter with the same name prefixed with <literal>toast.</literal>, which controls the behavior of the table's secondary <acronym>TOAST</acronym> table, if any - (see <xref linkend="storage-toast"> for more information about TOAST). + (see <xref linkend="storage-toast"/> for more information about TOAST). If a table parameter value is set and the equivalent <literal>toast.</literal> parameter is not, the TOAST table will use the table's parameter value. @@ -1229,7 +1229,7 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM scan of this table. If not set, the system will determine a value based on the relation size. The actual number of workers chosen by the planner may be less, for example due to - the setting of <xref linkend="guc-max-worker-processes">. + the setting of <xref linkend="guc-max-worker-processes"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -1241,12 +1241,12 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM Enables or disables the autovacuum daemon for a particular table. If true, the autovacuum daemon will perform automatic <command>VACUUM</command> and/or <command>ANALYZE</command> operations on this table following the rules - discussed in <xref linkend="autovacuum">. + discussed in <xref linkend="autovacuum"/>. If false, this table will not be autovacuumed, except to prevent - transaction ID wraparound. See <xref linkend="vacuum-for-wraparound"> for + transaction ID wraparound. See <xref linkend="vacuum-for-wraparound"/> for more about wraparound prevention. Note that the autovacuum daemon does not run at all (except to prevent - transaction ID wraparound) if the <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum"> + transaction ID wraparound) if the <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum"/> parameter is false; setting individual tables' storage parameters does not override that. Therefore there is seldom much point in explicitly setting this storage parameter to <literal>true</literal>, only @@ -1259,7 +1259,7 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM <term><literal>autovacuum_vacuum_threshold</literal>, <literal>toast.autovacuum_vacuum_threshold</literal> (<type>integer</type>)</term> <listitem> <para> - Per-table value for <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-vacuum-threshold"> + Per-table value for <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-vacuum-threshold"/> parameter. </para> </listitem> @@ -1269,7 +1269,7 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM <term><literal>autovacuum_vacuum_scale_factor</literal>, <literal>toast.autovacuum_vacuum_scale_factor</literal> (<type>float4</type>)</term> <listitem> <para> - Per-table value for <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-vacuum-scale-factor"> + Per-table value for <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-vacuum-scale-factor"/> parameter. </para> </listitem> @@ -1279,7 +1279,7 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM <term><literal>autovacuum_analyze_threshold</literal> (<type>integer</type>)</term> <listitem> <para> - Per-table value for <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-analyze-threshold"> + Per-table value for <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-analyze-threshold"/> parameter. </para> </listitem> @@ -1289,7 +1289,7 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM <term><literal>autovacuum_analyze_scale_factor</literal> (<type>float4</type>)</term> <listitem> <para> - Per-table value for <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-analyze-scale-factor"> + Per-table value for <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-analyze-scale-factor"/> parameter. </para> </listitem> @@ -1299,7 +1299,7 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM <term><literal>autovacuum_vacuum_cost_delay</literal>, <literal>toast.autovacuum_vacuum_cost_delay</literal> (<type>integer</type>)</term> <listitem> <para> - Per-table value for <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-vacuum-cost-delay"> + Per-table value for <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-vacuum-cost-delay"/> parameter. </para> </listitem> @@ -1309,7 +1309,7 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM <term><literal>autovacuum_vacuum_cost_limit</literal>, <literal>toast.autovacuum_vacuum_cost_limit</literal> (<type>integer</type>)</term> <listitem> <para> - Per-table value for <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-vacuum-cost-limit"> + Per-table value for <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-vacuum-cost-limit"/> parameter. </para> </listitem> @@ -1319,11 +1319,11 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM <term><literal>autovacuum_freeze_min_age</literal>, <literal>toast.autovacuum_freeze_min_age</literal> (<type>integer</type>)</term> <listitem> <para> - Per-table value for <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-freeze-min-age"> + Per-table value for <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-freeze-min-age"/> parameter. Note that autovacuum will ignore per-table <literal>autovacuum_freeze_min_age</literal> parameters that are larger than half the - system-wide <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-freeze-max-age"> setting. + system-wide <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-freeze-max-age"/> setting. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -1332,7 +1332,7 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM <term><literal>autovacuum_freeze_max_age</literal>, <literal>toast.autovacuum_freeze_max_age</literal> (<type>integer</type>)</term> <listitem> <para> - Per-table value for <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-freeze-max-age"> + Per-table value for <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-freeze-max-age"/> parameter. Note that autovacuum will ignore per-table <literal>autovacuum_freeze_max_age</literal> parameters that are larger than the system-wide setting (it can only be set smaller). @@ -1344,7 +1344,7 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM <term><literal>autovacuum_freeze_table_age</literal>, <literal>toast.autovacuum_freeze_table_age</literal> (<type>integer</type>)</term> <listitem> <para> - Per-table value for <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-freeze-table-age"> + Per-table value for <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-freeze-table-age"/> parameter. </para> </listitem> @@ -1354,11 +1354,11 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM <term><literal>autovacuum_multixact_freeze_min_age</literal>, <literal>toast.autovacuum_multixact_freeze_min_age</literal> (<type>integer</type>)</term> <listitem> <para> - Per-table value for <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-multixact-freeze-min-age"> + Per-table value for <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-multixact-freeze-min-age"/> parameter. Note that autovacuum will ignore per-table <literal>autovacuum_multixact_freeze_min_age</literal> parameters that are larger than half the - system-wide <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-multixact-freeze-max-age"> + system-wide <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-multixact-freeze-max-age"/> setting. </para> </listitem> @@ -1369,7 +1369,7 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM <listitem> <para> Per-table value - for <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-multixact-freeze-max-age"> parameter. + for <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-multixact-freeze-max-age"/> parameter. Note that autovacuum will ignore per-table <literal>autovacuum_multixact_freeze_max_age</literal> parameters that are larger than the system-wide setting (it can only be set @@ -1383,7 +1383,7 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM <listitem> <para> Per-table value - for <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-multixact-freeze-table-age"> parameter. + for <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-multixact-freeze-table-age"/> parameter. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -1392,7 +1392,7 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM <term><literal>log_autovacuum_min_duration</literal>, <literal>toast.log_autovacuum_min_duration</literal> (<type>integer</type>)</term> <listitem> <para> - Per-table value for <xref linkend="guc-log-autovacuum-min-duration"> + Per-table value for <xref linkend="guc-log-autovacuum-min-duration"/> parameter. </para> </listitem> @@ -1404,7 +1404,7 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM <para> Declare the table as an additional catalog table for purposes of logical replication. See - <xref linkend="logicaldecoding-capabilities"> for details. + <xref linkend="logicaldecoding-capabilities"/> for details. This parameter cannot be set for TOAST tables. </para> </listitem> @@ -1445,7 +1445,7 @@ WITH ( MODULUS <replaceable class="parameter">numeric_literal</replaceable>, REM index for each unique constraint and primary key constraint to enforce uniqueness. Thus, it is not necessary to create an index explicitly for primary key columns. (See <xref - linkend="sql-createindex"> for more information.) + linkend="sql-createindex"/> for more information.) </para> <para> @@ -2006,11 +2006,11 @@ CREATE TABLE cities_partdef <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-altertable"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-droptable"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createtableas"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createtablespace"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createtype"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-altertable"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-droptable"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createtableas"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createtablespace"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createtype"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_table_as.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_table_as.sgml index 89ca82baa5c..527138e7872 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_table_as.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_table_as.sgml @@ -63,7 +63,7 @@ CREATE [ [ GLOBAL | LOCAL ] { TEMPORARY | TEMP } | UNLOGGED ] TABLE [ IF NOT EXI <listitem> <para> Ignored for compatibility. Use of these keywords is deprecated; - refer to <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for details. + refer to <xref linkend="sql-createtable"/> for details. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -75,7 +75,7 @@ CREATE [ [ GLOBAL | LOCAL ] { TEMPORARY | TEMP } | UNLOGGED ] TABLE [ IF NOT EXI <listitem> <para> If specified, the table is created as a temporary table. - Refer to <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for details. + Refer to <xref linkend="sql-createtable"/> for details. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -85,7 +85,7 @@ CREATE [ [ GLOBAL | LOCAL ] { TEMPORARY | TEMP } | UNLOGGED ] TABLE [ IF NOT EXI <listitem> <para> If specified, the table is created as an unlogged table. - Refer to <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for details. + Refer to <xref linkend="sql-createtable"/> for details. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -95,7 +95,7 @@ CREATE [ [ GLOBAL | LOCAL ] { TEMPORARY | TEMP } | UNLOGGED ] TABLE [ IF NOT EXI <listitem> <para> Do not throw an error if a relation with the same name already exists. - A notice is issued in this case. Refer to <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> + A notice is issued in this case. Refer to <xref linkend="sql-createtable"/> for details. </para> </listitem> @@ -126,13 +126,13 @@ CREATE [ [ GLOBAL | LOCAL ] { TEMPORARY | TEMP } | UNLOGGED ] TABLE [ IF NOT EXI <para> This clause specifies optional storage parameters for the new table; see <xref linkend="sql-createtable-storage-parameters" - endterm="sql-createtable-storage-parameters-title"> for more + endterm="sql-createtable-storage-parameters-title"/> for more information. The <literal>WITH</literal> clause can also include <literal>OIDS=TRUE</literal> (or just <literal>OIDS</literal>) to specify that rows of the new table should have OIDs (object identifiers) assigned to them, or <literal>OIDS=FALSE</literal> to specify that the rows should not have OIDs. - See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more information. + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -175,7 +175,7 @@ CREATE [ [ GLOBAL | LOCAL ] { TEMPORARY | TEMP } | UNLOGGED ] TABLE [ IF NOT EXI <para> All rows in the temporary table will be deleted at the end of each transaction block. Essentially, an automatic <xref - linkend="sql-truncate"> is done + linkend="sql-truncate"/> is done at each commit. </para> </listitem> @@ -201,8 +201,8 @@ CREATE [ [ GLOBAL | LOCAL ] { TEMPORARY | TEMP } | UNLOGGED ] TABLE [ IF NOT EXI The <replaceable class="parameter">tablespace_name</replaceable> is the name of the tablespace in which the new table is to be created. If not specified, - <xref linkend="guc-default-tablespace"> is consulted, or - <xref linkend="guc-temp-tablespaces"> if the table is temporary. + <xref linkend="guc-default-tablespace"/> is consulted, or + <xref linkend="guc-temp-tablespaces"/> if the table is temporary. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -211,9 +211,9 @@ CREATE [ [ GLOBAL | LOCAL ] { TEMPORARY | TEMP } | UNLOGGED ] TABLE [ IF NOT EXI <term><replaceable>query</replaceable></term> <listitem> <para> - A <xref linkend="sql-select">, <link - linkend="sql-table">TABLE</link>, or <xref linkend="sql-values"> - command, or an <xref linkend="sql-execute"> command that runs a + A <xref linkend="sql-select"/>, <link + linkend="sql-table">TABLE</link>, or <xref linkend="sql-values"/> + command, or an <xref linkend="sql-execute"/> command that runs a prepared <command>SELECT</command>, <command>TABLE</command>, or <command>VALUES</command> query. </para> @@ -239,7 +239,7 @@ CREATE [ [ GLOBAL | LOCAL ] { TEMPORARY | TEMP } | UNLOGGED ] TABLE [ IF NOT EXI <para> This command is functionally similar to <xref - linkend="sql-selectinto">, but it is + linkend="sql-selectinto"/>, but it is preferred since it is less likely to be confused with other uses of the <command>SELECT INTO</command> syntax. Furthermore, <command>CREATE TABLE AS</command> offers a superset of the functionality offered @@ -250,7 +250,7 @@ CREATE [ [ GLOBAL | LOCAL ] { TEMPORARY | TEMP } | UNLOGGED ] TABLE [ IF NOT EXI The <command>CREATE TABLE AS</command> command allows the user to explicitly specify whether OIDs should be included. If the presence of OIDs is not explicitly specified, - the <xref linkend="guc-default-with-oids"> configuration variable is + the <xref linkend="guc-default-with-oids"/> configuration variable is used. </para> </refsect1> @@ -317,7 +317,7 @@ CREATE TEMP TABLE films_recent WITH (OIDS) ON COMMIT DROP AS <listitem> <para><productname>PostgreSQL</productname> handles temporary tables in a way rather different from the standard; see - <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> + <xref linkend="sql-createtable"/> for details. </para> </listitem> @@ -343,12 +343,12 @@ CREATE TEMP TABLE films_recent WITH (OIDS) ON COMMIT DROP AS <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-creatematerializedview"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createtable"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-execute"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-select"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-selectinto"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-values"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-creatematerializedview"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createtable"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-execute"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-select"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-selectinto"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-values"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_tablespace.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_tablespace.sgml index ed9635ef400..18fa5f0ebf0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_tablespace.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_tablespace.sgml @@ -54,7 +54,7 @@ CREATE TABLESPACE <replaceable class="parameter">tablespace_name</replaceable> <warning> <para> A tablespace cannot be used independently of the cluster in which it - is defined; see <xref linkend="manage-ag-tablespaces">. + is defined; see <xref linkend="manage-ag-tablespaces"/>. </para> </warning> @@ -109,9 +109,9 @@ CREATE TABLESPACE <replaceable class="parameter">tablespace_name</replaceable> Setting either value for a particular tablespace will override the planner's usual estimate of the cost of reading pages from tables in that tablespace, as established by the configuration parameters of the - same name (see <xref linkend="guc-seq-page-cost">, - <xref linkend="guc-random-page-cost">, - <xref linkend="guc-effective-io-concurrency">). This may be useful if + same name (see <xref linkend="guc-seq-page-cost"/>, + <xref linkend="guc-random-page-cost"/>, + <xref linkend="guc-effective-io-concurrency"/>). This may be useful if one tablespace is located on a disk which is faster or slower than the remainder of the I/O subsystem. </para> @@ -164,11 +164,11 @@ CREATE TABLESPACE indexspace OWNER genevieve LOCATION '/data/indexes'; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createdatabase"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createtable"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createindex"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-droptablespace"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-altertablespace"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createdatabase"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createtable"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createindex"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-droptablespace"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-altertablespace"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_transform.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_transform.sgml index dfb83a76da4..17cb1932cfe 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_transform.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_transform.sgml @@ -144,7 +144,7 @@ CREATE [ OR REPLACE ] TRANSFORM FOR <replaceable>type_name</replaceable> LANGUAG <title>Notes</title> <para> - Use <xref linkend="sql-droptransform"> to remove transforms. + Use <xref linkend="sql-droptransform"/> to remove transforms. </para> </refsect1> @@ -201,10 +201,10 @@ CREATE TRANSFORM FOR hstore LANGUAGE plpythonu ( <title>See Also</title> <para> - <xref linkend="sql-createfunction">, - <xref linkend="sql-createlanguage">, - <xref linkend="sql-createtype">, - <xref linkend="sql-droptransform"> + <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"/>, + <xref linkend="sql-createlanguage"/>, + <xref linkend="sql-createtype"/>, + <xref linkend="sql-droptransform"/> </para> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_trigger.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_trigger.sgml index 9e97c364ef8..ad7f9efb558 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_trigger.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_trigger.sgml @@ -170,7 +170,7 @@ CREATE [ CONSTRAINT ] TRIGGER <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> When the <literal>CONSTRAINT</literal> option is specified, this command creates a <firstterm>constraint trigger</firstterm>. This is the same as a regular trigger except that the timing of the trigger firing can be adjusted using - <xref linkend="sql-set-constraints">. + <xref linkend="sql-set-constraints"/>. Constraint triggers must be <literal>AFTER ROW</literal> triggers on plain tables (not foreign tables). They can be fired either at the end of the statement causing the triggering @@ -208,7 +208,7 @@ CREATE [ CONSTRAINT ] TRIGGER <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> </para> <para> - Refer to <xref linkend="triggers"> for more information about triggers. + Refer to <xref linkend="triggers"/> for more information about triggers. </para> </refsect1> @@ -302,7 +302,7 @@ UPDATE OF <replaceable>column_name1</replaceable> [, <replaceable>column_name2</ <listitem> <para> The default timing of the trigger. - See the <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> documentation for details of + See the <xref linkend="sql-createtable"/> documentation for details of these constraint options. This can only be specified for constraint triggers. </para> @@ -432,7 +432,7 @@ UPDATE OF <replaceable>column_name1</replaceable> [, <replaceable>column_name2</ </para> <para> - Use <xref linkend="sql-droptrigger"> to remove a trigger. + Use <xref linkend="sql-droptrigger"/> to remove a trigger. </para> <para> @@ -605,7 +605,7 @@ CREATE TRIGGER paired_items_update </para> <para> - <xref linkend="trigger-example"> contains a complete example of a trigger + <xref linkend="trigger-example"/> contains a complete example of a trigger function written in C. </para> </refsect1> @@ -707,10 +707,10 @@ CREATE TRIGGER paired_items_update <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-altertrigger"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-droptrigger"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createfunction"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-set-constraints"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-altertrigger"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-droptrigger"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createfunction"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-set-constraints"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_tsconfig.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_tsconfig.sgml index 49634b43629..390d3cfe512 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_tsconfig.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_tsconfig.sgml @@ -57,7 +57,7 @@ CREATE TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceabl </para> <para> - Refer to <xref linkend="textsearch"> for further information. + Refer to <xref linkend="textsearch"/> for further information. </para> </refsect1> @@ -119,8 +119,8 @@ CREATE TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceabl <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-altertsconfig"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-droptsconfig"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-altertsconfig"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-droptsconfig"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_tsdictionary.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_tsdictionary.sgml index 20a01765b75..06081048210 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_tsdictionary.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_tsdictionary.sgml @@ -50,7 +50,7 @@ CREATE TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> </para> <para> - Refer to <xref linkend="textsearch"> for further information. + Refer to <xref linkend="textsearch"/> for further information. </para> </refsect1> @@ -134,8 +134,8 @@ CREATE TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY my_russian ( <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-altertsdictionary"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-droptsdictionary"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-altertsdictionary"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-droptsdictionary"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_tsparser.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_tsparser.sgml index 8e5e1b0b484..088d92323a0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_tsparser.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_tsparser.sgml @@ -55,7 +55,7 @@ CREATE TEXT SEARCH PARSER <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> ( </para> <para> - Refer to <xref linkend="textsearch"> for further information. + Refer to <xref linkend="textsearch"/> for further information. </para> </refsect1> @@ -146,8 +146,8 @@ CREATE TEXT SEARCH PARSER <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> ( <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-altertsparser"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-droptsparser"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-altertsparser"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-droptsparser"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_tstemplate.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_tstemplate.sgml index 0340e1ab1f4..5b82d5564b5 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_tstemplate.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_tstemplate.sgml @@ -56,7 +56,7 @@ CREATE TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> ( </para> <para> - Refer to <xref linkend="textsearch"> for further information. + Refer to <xref linkend="textsearch"/> for further information. </para> </refsect1> @@ -119,8 +119,8 @@ CREATE TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> ( <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-altertstemplate"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-droptstemplate"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-altertstemplate"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-droptstemplate"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_type.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_type.sgml index 1b409ad22f6..fa9b520b241 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_type.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_type.sgml @@ -116,7 +116,7 @@ CREATE TYPE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> <para> The second form of <command>CREATE TYPE</command> creates an enumerated - (enum) type, as described in <xref linkend="datatype-enum">. + (enum) type, as described in <xref linkend="datatype-enum"/>. Enum types take a list of one or more quoted labels, each of which must be less than <symbol>NAMEDATALEN</symbol> bytes long (64 bytes in a standard <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> build). @@ -128,7 +128,7 @@ CREATE TYPE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> <para> The third form of <command>CREATE TYPE</command> creates a new - range type, as described in <xref linkend="rangetypes">. + range type, as described in <xref linkend="rangetypes"/>. </para> <para> @@ -148,7 +148,7 @@ CREATE TYPE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> function must take one argument of the range type being defined, and return a value of the same type. This is used to convert range values to a canonical form, when applicable. See <xref - linkend="rangetypes-defining"> for more information. Creating a + linkend="rangetypes-defining"/> for more information. Creating a <replaceable class="parameter">canonical</replaceable> function is a bit tricky, since it must be defined before the range type can be declared. To do this, you must first create a shell type, which is a @@ -167,7 +167,7 @@ CREATE TYPE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> and return a <type>double precision</type> value representing the difference between the two given values. While this is optional, providing it allows much greater efficiency of GiST indexes on columns of - the range type. See <xref linkend="rangetypes-defining"> for more + the range type. See <xref linkend="rangetypes-defining"/> for more information. </para> </refsect2> @@ -330,7 +330,7 @@ CREATE TYPE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> by setting <literal>typlen</literal> to -1.) The internal representation of all variable-length types must start with a 4-byte integer giving the total length of this value of the type. (Note that the length field is often - encoded, as described in <xref linkend="storage-toast">; it's unwise + encoded, as described in <xref linkend="storage-toast"/>; it's unwise to access it directly.) </para> @@ -373,7 +373,7 @@ CREATE TYPE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> All <replaceable class="parameter">storage</replaceable> values other than <literal>plain</literal> imply that the functions of the data type can handle values that have been <firstterm>toasted</firstterm>, as described - in <xref linkend="storage-toast"> and <xref linkend="xtypes-toast">. + in <xref linkend="storage-toast"/> and <xref linkend="xtypes-toast"/>. The specific other value given merely determines the default TOAST storage strategy for columns of a toastable data type; users can pick other strategies for individual columns using <literal>ALTER TABLE @@ -404,7 +404,7 @@ CREATE TYPE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> category. The parser will prefer casting to preferred types (but only from other types within the same category) when this rule is helpful in resolving overloaded functions or operators. For more details see <xref - linkend="typeconv">. For types that have no implicit casts to or from any + linkend="typeconv"/>. For types that have no implicit casts to or from any other types, it is sufficient to leave these settings at the defaults. However, for a group of related types that have implicit casts, it is often helpful to mark them all as belonging to a category and select one or two @@ -709,7 +709,7 @@ CREATE TYPE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> The category code (a single ASCII character) for this type. The default is <literal>'U'</literal> for <quote>user-defined type</quote>. Other standard category codes can be found in - <xref linkend="catalog-typcategory-table">. You may also choose + <xref linkend="catalog-typcategory-table"/>. You may also choose other ASCII characters in order to create custom categories. </para> </listitem> @@ -924,7 +924,7 @@ CREATE TABLE big_objs ( <para> More examples, including suitable input and output functions, are - in <xref linkend="xtypes">. + in <xref linkend="xtypes"/>. </para> </refsect1> @@ -951,10 +951,10 @@ CREATE TABLE big_objs ( <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-altertype"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createdomain"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createfunction"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-droptype"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-altertype"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createdomain"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createfunction"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-droptype"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_user.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_user.sgml index 13dfd64c6d0..a51dc50c978 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_user.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_user.sgml @@ -49,7 +49,7 @@ CREATE USER <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ [ WITH ] <replac <para> <command>CREATE USER</command> is now an alias for - <xref linkend="sql-createrole">. + <xref linkend="sql-createrole"/>. The only difference is that when the command is spelled <command>CREATE USER</command>, <literal>LOGIN</literal> is assumed by default, whereas <literal>NOLOGIN</literal> is assumed when @@ -72,7 +72,7 @@ CREATE USER <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ [ WITH ] <replac <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createrole"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createrole"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_user_mapping.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_user_mapping.sgml index d18cc91a002..c2f5278f623 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_user_mapping.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_user_mapping.sgml @@ -122,10 +122,10 @@ CREATE USER MAPPING FOR bob SERVER foo OPTIONS (user 'bob', password 'secret'); <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterusermapping"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropusermapping"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createforeigndatawrapper"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createserver"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterusermapping"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropusermapping"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createforeigndatawrapper"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createserver"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_view.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_view.sgml index e52a4b85a77..b325c1be50f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_view.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_view.sgml @@ -133,7 +133,7 @@ CREATE VIEW [ <replaceable>schema</replaceable> . ] <replaceable>view_name</repl <literal>cascaded</literal>, and is equivalent to specifying <literal>WITH [ CASCADED | LOCAL ] CHECK OPTION</literal> (see below). This option can be changed on existing views using <xref - linkend="sql-alterview">. + linkend="sql-alterview"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -143,7 +143,7 @@ CREATE VIEW [ <replaceable>schema</replaceable> . ] <replaceable>view_name</repl <listitem> <para> This should be used if the view is intended to provide row-level - security. See <xref linkend="rules-privileges"> for full details. + security. See <xref linkend="rules-privileges"/> for full details. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -156,8 +156,8 @@ CREATE VIEW [ <replaceable>schema</replaceable> . ] <replaceable>view_name</repl <term><replaceable class="parameter">query</replaceable></term> <listitem> <para> - A <xref linkend="sql-select"> or - <xref linkend="sql-values"> command + A <xref linkend="sql-select"/> or + <xref linkend="sql-values"/> command which will provide the columns and rows of the view. </para> </listitem> @@ -241,7 +241,7 @@ CREATE VIEW [ <replaceable>schema</replaceable> . ] <replaceable>view_name</repl <title>Notes</title> <para> - Use the <xref linkend="sql-dropview"> + Use the <xref linkend="sql-dropview"/> statement to drop views. </para> @@ -264,7 +264,7 @@ CREATE VIEW vista AS SELECT text 'Hello World' AS hello; Access to tables referenced in the view is determined by permissions of the view owner. In some cases, this can be used to provide secure but restricted access to the underlying tables. However, not all views are - secure against tampering; see <xref linkend="rules-privileges"> for + secure against tampering; see <xref linkend="rules-privileges"/> for details. Functions called in the view are treated the same as if they had been called directly from the query using the view. Therefore the user of a view must have permissions to call all functions used by the view. @@ -360,7 +360,7 @@ CREATE VIEW vista AS SELECT text 'Hello World' AS hello; <literal>security_barrier</literal> property then all the view's <literal>WHERE</literal> conditions (and any conditions using operators which are marked as <literal>LEAKPROOF</literal>) will always be evaluated before any conditions that a user of the view has - added. See <xref linkend="rules-privileges"> for full details. Note that, + added. See <xref linkend="rules-privileges"/> for full details. Note that, due to this, rows which are not ultimately returned (because they do not pass the user's <literal>WHERE</literal> conditions) may still end up being locked. <command>EXPLAIN</command> can be used to see which conditions are @@ -375,8 +375,8 @@ CREATE VIEW vista AS SELECT text 'Hello World' AS hello; creating <literal>INSTEAD OF</literal> triggers on the view, which must convert attempted inserts, etc. on the view into appropriate actions on other tables. For more information see <xref - linkend="sql-createtrigger">. Another possibility is to create rules - (see <xref linkend="sql-createrule">), but in practice triggers are + linkend="sql-createtrigger"/>. Another possibility is to create rules + (see <xref linkend="sql-createrule"/>), but in practice triggers are easier to understand and use correctly. </para> @@ -386,7 +386,7 @@ CREATE VIEW vista AS SELECT text 'Hello World' AS hello; view. In addition the view's owner must have the relevant privileges on the underlying base relations, but the user performing the update does not need any permissions on the underlying base relations (see - <xref linkend="rules-privileges">). + <xref linkend="rules-privileges"/>). </para> </refsect2> </refsect1> @@ -490,9 +490,9 @@ UNION ALL <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterview"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropview"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-creatematerializedview"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterview"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropview"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-creatematerializedview"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/createdb.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/createdb.sgml index 265d14e1491..2658efeb1a1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/createdb.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/createdb.sgml @@ -48,7 +48,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> <application>createdb</application> is a wrapper around the - <acronym>SQL</acronym> command <xref linkend="sql-createdatabase">. + <acronym>SQL</acronym> command <xref linkend="sql-createdatabase"/>. There is no effective difference between creating databases via this utility and via other methods for accessing the server. </para> @@ -115,7 +115,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation Specifies the character encoding scheme to be used in this database. The character sets supported by the <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> server are described in - <xref linkend="multibyte-charset-supported">. + <xref linkend="multibyte-charset-supported"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -199,7 +199,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation The options <option>-D</option>, <option>-l</option>, <option>-E</option>, <option>-O</option>, and <option>-T</option> correspond to options of the underlying - SQL command <xref linkend="sql-createdatabase">; see there for more information + SQL command <xref linkend="sql-createdatabase"/>; see there for more information about them. </para> @@ -327,7 +327,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> This utility, like most other <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> utilities, also uses the environment variables supported by <application>libpq</application> - (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars">). + (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars"/>). </para> </refsect1> @@ -337,8 +337,8 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <title>Diagnostics</title> <para> - In case of difficulty, see <xref linkend="sql-createdatabase"> - and <xref linkend="app-psql"> for + In case of difficulty, see <xref linkend="sql-createdatabase"/> + and <xref linkend="app-psql"/> for discussions of potential problems and error messages. The database server must be running at the targeted host. Also, any default connection settings and environment @@ -376,8 +376,8 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="app-dropdb"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createdatabase"></member> + <member><xref linkend="app-dropdb"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createdatabase"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/createuser.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/createuser.sgml index f3c50c41131..22ee99f2cc4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/createuser.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/createuser.sgml @@ -49,7 +49,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> <application>createuser</application> is a wrapper around the - <acronym>SQL</acronym> command <xref linkend="sql-createrole">. + <acronym>SQL</acronym> command <xref linkend="sql-createrole"/>. There is no effective difference between creating users via this utility and via other methods for accessing the server. </para> @@ -274,7 +274,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> The new user will have the <literal>REPLICATION</literal> privilege, which is described more fully in the documentation for <xref - linkend="sql-createrole">. + linkend="sql-createrole"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -285,7 +285,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> The new user will not have the <literal>REPLICATION</literal> privilege, which is described more fully in the documentation for <xref - linkend="sql-createrole">. + linkend="sql-createrole"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -405,7 +405,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> This utility, like most other <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> utilities, also uses the environment variables supported by <application>libpq</application> - (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars">). + (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars"/>). </para> </refsect1> @@ -415,8 +415,8 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <title>Diagnostics</title> <para> - In case of difficulty, see <xref linkend="sql-createrole"> - and <xref linkend="app-psql"> for + In case of difficulty, see <xref linkend="sql-createrole"/> + and <xref linkend="app-psql"/> for discussions of potential problems and error messages. The database server must be running at the targeted host. Also, any default connection settings and environment @@ -479,8 +479,8 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="app-dropuser"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createrole"></member> + <member><xref linkend="app-dropuser"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createrole"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/deallocate.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/deallocate.sgml index 4e23c6e091e..3875e5069e1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/deallocate.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/deallocate.sgml @@ -41,7 +41,7 @@ DEALLOCATE [ PREPARE ] { <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> | ALL <para> For more information on prepared statements, see <xref - linkend="sql-prepare">. + linkend="sql-prepare"/>. </para> </refsect1> @@ -91,8 +91,8 @@ DEALLOCATE [ PREPARE ] { <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> | ALL <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-execute"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-prepare"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-execute"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-prepare"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/declare.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/declare.sgml index a70e2466e5d..648c2950f41 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/declare.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/declare.sgml @@ -39,7 +39,7 @@ DECLARE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ BINARY ] [ INSENSITI can be used to retrieve a small number of rows at a time out of a larger query. After the cursor is created, rows are fetched from it using - <xref linkend="sql-fetch">. + <xref linkend="sql-fetch"/>. </para> <note> @@ -47,7 +47,7 @@ DECLARE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ BINARY ] [ INSENSITI This page describes usage of cursors at the SQL command level. If you are trying to use cursors inside a <application>PL/pgSQL</application> function, the rules are different — - see <xref linkend="plpgsql-cursors">. + see <xref linkend="plpgsql-cursors"/>. </para> </note> </refsect1> @@ -100,7 +100,7 @@ DECLARE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ BINARY ] [ INSENSITI used to retrieve rows in a nonsequential fashion. The default is to allow scrolling in some cases; this is not the same as specifying <literal>SCROLL</literal>. See <xref linkend="sql-declare-notes" - endterm="sql-declare-notes-title"> for details. + endterm="sql-declare-notes-title"/> for details. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -124,8 +124,8 @@ DECLARE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ BINARY ] [ INSENSITI <term><replaceable class="parameter">query</replaceable></term> <listitem> <para> - A <xref linkend="sql-select"> or - <xref linkend="sql-values"> command + A <xref linkend="sql-select"/> or + <xref linkend="sql-values"/> command which will provide the rows to be returned by the cursor. </para> </listitem> @@ -183,9 +183,9 @@ DECLARE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ BINARY ] [ INSENSITI <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> reports an error if such a command is used outside a transaction block. Use - <xref linkend="sql-begin"> and - <xref linkend="sql-commit"> - (or <xref linkend="sql-rollback">) + <xref linkend="sql-begin"/> and + <xref linkend="sql-commit"/> + (or <xref linkend="sql-rollback"/>) to define a transaction block. </para> @@ -230,7 +230,7 @@ DECLARE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ BINARY ] [ INSENSITI <para> Scrollable and <literal>WITH HOLD</literal> cursors may give unexpected results if they invoke any volatile functions (see <xref - linkend="xfunc-volatility">). When a previously fetched row is + linkend="xfunc-volatility"/>). When a previously fetched row is re-fetched, the functions might be re-executed, perhaps leading to results different from the first time. One workaround for such cases is to declare the cursor <literal>WITH HOLD</literal> and commit the @@ -244,7 +244,7 @@ DECLARE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ BINARY ] [ INSENSITI If the cursor's query includes <literal>FOR UPDATE</literal> or <literal>FOR SHARE</literal>, then returned rows are locked at the time they are first fetched, in the same way as for a regular - <xref linkend="sql-select"> command with + <xref linkend="sql-select"/> command with these options. In addition, the returned rows will be the most up-to-date versions; therefore these options provide the equivalent of what the SQL standard @@ -309,7 +309,7 @@ DECLARE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ BINARY ] [ INSENSITI <programlisting> DECLARE liahona CURSOR FOR SELECT * FROM films; </programlisting> - See <xref linkend="sql-fetch"> for more + See <xref linkend="sql-fetch"/> for more examples of cursor usage. </para> </refsect1> @@ -341,9 +341,9 @@ DECLARE liahona CURSOR FOR SELECT * FROM films; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-close"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-fetch"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-move"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-close"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-fetch"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-move"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/delete.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/delete.sgml index d7869efd9a2..df8cea48cf4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/delete.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/delete.sgml @@ -41,7 +41,7 @@ DELETE FROM [ ONLY ] <replaceable class="parameter">table_name</replaceable> [ * <tip> <para> - <xref linkend="sql-truncate"> provides a + <xref linkend="sql-truncate"/> provides a faster mechanism to remove all rows from a table. </para> </tip> @@ -82,7 +82,7 @@ DELETE FROM [ ONLY ] <replaceable class="parameter">table_name</replaceable> [ * <para> The <literal>WITH</literal> clause allows you to specify one or more subqueries that can be referenced by name in the <command>DELETE</command> - query. See <xref linkend="queries-with"> and <xref linkend="sql-select"> + query. See <xref linkend="queries-with"/> and <xref linkend="sql-select"/> for details. </para> </listitem> @@ -123,7 +123,7 @@ DELETE FROM [ ONLY ] <replaceable class="parameter">table_name</replaceable> [ * A list of table expressions, allowing columns from other tables to appear in the <literal>WHERE</literal> condition. This is similar to the list of tables that can be specified in the <xref - linkend="sql-from" endterm="sql-from-title"> of a + linkend="sql-from" endterm="sql-from-title"/> of a <command>SELECT</command> statement; for example, an alias for the table name can be specified. Do not repeat the target table in the <replaceable class="parameter">using_list</replaceable>, @@ -153,7 +153,7 @@ DELETE FROM [ ONLY ] <replaceable class="parameter">table_name</replaceable> [ * query on the <command>DELETE</command>'s target table. Note that <literal>WHERE CURRENT OF</literal> cannot be specified together with a Boolean condition. See - <xref linkend="sql-declare"> + <xref linkend="sql-declare"/> for more information about using cursors with <literal>WHERE CURRENT OF</literal>. </para> @@ -283,7 +283,7 @@ DELETE FROM tasks WHERE CURRENT OF c_tasks; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-truncate"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-truncate"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/discard.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/discard.sgml index 063342494fa..6b909b7232a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/discard.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/discard.sgml @@ -60,7 +60,7 @@ DISCARD { ALL | PLANS | SEQUENCES | TEMPORARY | TEMP } including <function>currval()</function>/<function>lastval()</function> information and any preallocated sequence values that have not yet been returned by <function>nextval()</function>. - (See <xref linkend="sql-createsequence"> for a description of + (See <xref linkend="sql-createsequence"/> for a description of preallocated sequence values.) </para> </listitem> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/do.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/do.sgml index c14dff0a281..061218b135a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/do.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/do.sgml @@ -122,7 +122,7 @@ END$$; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createlanguage"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createlanguage"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_access_method.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_access_method.sgml index aa5d2505c7d..a908a64b74c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_access_method.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_access_method.sgml @@ -64,7 +64,7 @@ DROP ACCESS METHOD [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceabl Automatically drop objects that depend on the access method (such as operator classes, operator families, and indexes), and in turn all objects that depend on those objects - (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend">). + (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -104,7 +104,7 @@ DROP ACCESS METHOD heptree; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-create-access-method"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-create-access-method"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_aggregate.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_aggregate.sgml index 1e5b3e8bd47..ba74f4f5eba 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_aggregate.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_aggregate.sgml @@ -110,7 +110,7 @@ DROP AGGREGATE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable>name</replaceable> ( <replaceable>aggr Automatically drop objects that depend on the aggregate function (such as views using it), and in turn all objects that depend on those objects - (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend">). + (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -132,7 +132,7 @@ DROP AGGREGATE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable>name</replaceable> ( <replaceable>aggr <para> Alternative syntaxes for referencing ordered-set aggregates - are described under <xref linkend="sql-alteraggregate">. + are described under <xref linkend="sql-alteraggregate"/>. </para> </refsect1> @@ -176,8 +176,8 @@ DROP AGGREGATE myavg(integer), myavg(bigint); <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alteraggregate"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createaggregate"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alteraggregate"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createaggregate"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_cast.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_cast.sgml index 6e0d7416371..9f42867e125 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_cast.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_cast.sgml @@ -107,7 +107,7 @@ DROP CAST (text AS int); <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createcast"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createcast"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_collation.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_collation.sgml index 03df0d17b1e..89b975aac3c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_collation.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_collation.sgml @@ -62,7 +62,7 @@ DROP COLLATION [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable>name</replaceable> [ CASCADE | RESTRIC <para> Automatically drop objects that depend on the collation, and in turn all objects that depend on those objects - (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend">). + (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -103,8 +103,8 @@ DROP COLLATION german; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-altercollation"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createcollation"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-altercollation"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createcollation"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_conversion.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_conversion.sgml index d5cf18c3e91..131e3cbc0b7 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_conversion.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_conversion.sgml @@ -96,8 +96,8 @@ DROP CONVERSION myname; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterconversion"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createconversion"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterconversion"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createconversion"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_database.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_database.sgml index bbf3fd37769..3ac06c984a3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_database.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_database.sgml @@ -78,7 +78,7 @@ DROP DATABASE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> <para> This command cannot be executed while connected to the target database. Thus, it might be more convenient to use the program - <xref linkend="app-dropdb"> instead, + <xref linkend="app-dropdb"/> instead, which is a wrapper around this command. </para> </refsect1> @@ -95,7 +95,7 @@ DROP DATABASE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createdatabase"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createdatabase"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_domain.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_domain.sgml index 59379e82348..b18faf39175 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_domain.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_domain.sgml @@ -64,7 +64,7 @@ DROP DOMAIN [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [, . Automatically drop objects that depend on the domain (such as table columns), and in turn all objects that depend on those objects - (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend">). + (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -106,8 +106,8 @@ DROP DOMAIN box; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createdomain"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterdomain"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createdomain"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterdomain"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_event_trigger.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_event_trigger.sgml index a773170fa68..137884cc83d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_event_trigger.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_event_trigger.sgml @@ -65,7 +65,7 @@ DROP EVENT TRIGGER [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceabl <para> Automatically drop objects that depend on the trigger, and in turn all objects that depend on those objects - (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend">). + (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -107,8 +107,8 @@ DROP EVENT TRIGGER snitch; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createeventtrigger"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-altereventtrigger"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createeventtrigger"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-altereventtrigger"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_extension.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_extension.sgml index bb296df17f3..5e507dec928 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_extension.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_extension.sgml @@ -68,7 +68,7 @@ DROP EXTENSION [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ <para> Automatically drop objects that depend on the extension, and in turn all objects that depend on those objects - (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend">). + (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -115,8 +115,8 @@ DROP EXTENSION hstore; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createextension"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterextension"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createextension"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterextension"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_foreign_data_wrapper.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_foreign_data_wrapper.sgml index 8e8968ab1a6..e53178b8c71 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_foreign_data_wrapper.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_foreign_data_wrapper.sgml @@ -65,7 +65,7 @@ DROP FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</rep Automatically drop objects that depend on the foreign-data wrapper (such as foreign tables and servers), and in turn all objects that depend on those objects - (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend">). + (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -106,8 +106,8 @@ DROP FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER dbi; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createforeigndatawrapper"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterforeigndatawrapper"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createforeigndatawrapper"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterforeigndatawrapper"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_foreign_table.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_foreign_table.sgml index b12de03e65d..b29169e0d35 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_foreign_table.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_foreign_table.sgml @@ -60,7 +60,7 @@ DROP FOREIGN TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceabl <para> Automatically drop objects that depend on the foreign table (such as views), and in turn all objects that depend on those objects - (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend">). + (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -104,8 +104,8 @@ DROP FOREIGN TABLE films, distributors; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterforeigntable"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterforeigntable"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_function.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_function.sgml index 05b405dda17..eda1a59c846 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_function.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_function.sgml @@ -110,7 +110,7 @@ DROP FUNCTION [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ Automatically drop objects that depend on the function (such as operators or triggers), and in turn all objects that depend on those objects - (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend">). + (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -183,8 +183,8 @@ DROP FUNCTION update_employee_salaries(); <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createfunction"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterfunction"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createfunction"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterfunction"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_group.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_group.sgml index 7844db0f7d6..47d4a72121b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_group.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_group.sgml @@ -30,7 +30,7 @@ DROP GROUP [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [, .. <para> <command>DROP GROUP</command> is now an alias for - <xref linkend="sql-droprole">. + <xref linkend="sql-droprole"/>. </para> </refsect1> @@ -46,7 +46,7 @@ DROP GROUP [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [, .. <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-droprole"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-droprole"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_index.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_index.sgml index fd235a0c276..2a8ca5bf689 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_index.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_index.sgml @@ -86,7 +86,7 @@ DROP INDEX [ CONCURRENTLY ] [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</r <para> Automatically drop objects that depend on the index, and in turn all objects that depend on those objects - (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend">). + (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -128,7 +128,7 @@ DROP INDEX title_idx; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createindex"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createindex"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_language.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_language.sgml index 350375baef1..976f3a0ce1a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_language.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_language.sgml @@ -38,7 +38,7 @@ DROP [ PROCEDURAL ] LANGUAGE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</ <para> As of <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> 9.1, most procedural languages have been made into <quote>extensions</quote>, and should - therefore be removed with <xref linkend="sql-dropextension"> + therefore be removed with <xref linkend="sql-dropextension"/> not <command>DROP LANGUAGE</command>. </para> </note> @@ -76,7 +76,7 @@ DROP [ PROCEDURAL ] LANGUAGE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</ Automatically drop objects that depend on the language (such as functions in the language), and in turn all objects that depend on those objects - (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend">). + (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -118,8 +118,8 @@ DROP LANGUAGE plsample; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterlanguage"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createlanguage"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterlanguage"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createlanguage"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_materialized_view.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_materialized_view.sgml index b115aceb384..c8f3bc5b0da 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_materialized_view.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_materialized_view.sgml @@ -66,7 +66,7 @@ DROP MATERIALIZED VIEW [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replac Automatically drop objects that depend on the materialized view (such as other materialized views, or regular views), and in turn all objects that depend on those objects - (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend">). + (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -107,9 +107,9 @@ DROP MATERIALIZED VIEW order_summary; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-creatematerializedview"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-altermaterializedview"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-refreshmaterializedview"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-creatematerializedview"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-altermaterializedview"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-refreshmaterializedview"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_opclass.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_opclass.sgml index 53a40ff73ec..4cb4cc35f77 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_opclass.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_opclass.sgml @@ -80,7 +80,7 @@ DROP OPERATOR CLASS [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceab <para> Automatically drop objects that depend on the operator class (such as indexes), and in turn all objects that depend on those objects - (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend">). + (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -140,9 +140,9 @@ DROP OPERATOR CLASS widget_ops USING btree; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alteropclass"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createopclass"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropopfamily"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alteropclass"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createopclass"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropopfamily"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_operator.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_operator.sgml index b10bed09cc8..2dff050ecf2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_operator.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_operator.sgml @@ -85,7 +85,7 @@ DROP OPERATOR [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> ( <para> Automatically drop objects that depend on the operator (such as views using it), and in turn all objects that depend on those objects - (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend">). + (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -146,8 +146,8 @@ DROP OPERATOR ~ (none, bit), ! (bigint, none); <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createoperator"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alteroperator"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createoperator"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alteroperator"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_opfamily.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_opfamily.sgml index eb92664d85e..c1bcd0d1dfd 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_opfamily.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_opfamily.sgml @@ -81,7 +81,7 @@ DROP OPERATOR FAMILY [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replacea <para> Automatically drop objects that depend on the operator family, and in turn all objects that depend on those objects - (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend">). + (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -127,11 +127,11 @@ DROP OPERATOR FAMILY float_ops USING btree; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alteropfamily"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createopfamily"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alteropclass"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createopclass"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropopclass"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alteropfamily"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createopfamily"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alteropclass"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createopclass"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropopclass"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_owned.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_owned.sgml index 1eb054dee61..4c66da2b340 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_owned.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_owned.sgml @@ -57,7 +57,7 @@ DROP OWNED BY { <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> | CURRENT_USER <para> Automatically drop objects that depend on the affected objects, and in turn all objects that depend on those objects - (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend">). + (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -90,7 +90,7 @@ DROP OWNED BY { <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> | CURRENT_USER </para> <para> - The <xref linkend="sql-reassign-owned"> command is an alternative that + The <xref linkend="sql-reassign-owned"/> command is an alternative that reassigns the ownership of all the database objects owned by one or more roles. However, <command>REASSIGN OWNED</command> does not deal with privileges for other objects. @@ -101,7 +101,7 @@ DROP OWNED BY { <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> | CURRENT_USER </para> <para> - See <xref linkend="role-removal"> for more discussion. + See <xref linkend="role-removal"/> for more discussion. </para> </refsect1> @@ -118,8 +118,8 @@ DROP OWNED BY { <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> | CURRENT_USER <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-reassign-owned"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-droprole"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-reassign-owned"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-droprole"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_policy.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_policy.sgml index 2bc1e25f9c3..9297ade1133 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_policy.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_policy.sgml @@ -111,8 +111,8 @@ DROP POLICY p1 ON my_table; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createpolicy"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterpolicy"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createpolicy"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterpolicy"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_publication.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_publication.sgml index 3195c040bb3..5dcbb837d1e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_publication.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_publication.sgml @@ -98,8 +98,8 @@ DROP PUBLICATION mypublication; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createpublication"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterpublication"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createpublication"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterpublication"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_role.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_role.sgml index 413d1870d42..13079f3e1f4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_role.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_role.sgml @@ -40,8 +40,8 @@ DROP ROLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [, ... of the cluster; an error will be raised if so. Before dropping the role, you must drop all the objects it owns (or reassign their ownership) and revoke any privileges the role has been granted on other objects. - The <xref linkend="sql-reassign-owned"> and <xref linkend="sql-drop-owned"> - commands can be useful for this purpose; see <xref linkend="role-removal"> + The <xref linkend="sql-reassign-owned"/> and <xref linkend="sql-drop-owned"/> + commands can be useful for this purpose; see <xref linkend="role-removal"/> for more discussion. </para> @@ -83,7 +83,7 @@ DROP ROLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [, ... <para> <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> includes a program <xref - linkend="app-dropuser"> that has the + linkend="app-dropuser"/> that has the same functionality as this command (in fact, it calls this command) but can be run from the command shell. </para> @@ -113,9 +113,9 @@ DROP ROLE jonathan; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createrole"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterrole"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-set-role"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createrole"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterrole"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-set-role"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_rule.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_rule.sgml index 6955016c272..cc5d00e4dc5 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_rule.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_rule.sgml @@ -73,7 +73,7 @@ DROP RULE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> ON <re <para> Automatically drop objects that depend on the rule, and in turn all objects that depend on those objects - (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend">). + (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -115,8 +115,8 @@ DROP RULE newrule ON mytable; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createrule"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterrule"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createrule"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterrule"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_schema.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_schema.sgml index 2e608b2b207..4d5d9f55dff 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_schema.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_schema.sgml @@ -69,7 +69,7 @@ DROP SCHEMA [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [, . Automatically drop objects (tables, functions, etc.) that are contained in the schema, and in turn all objects that depend on those objects - (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend">). + (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -123,8 +123,8 @@ DROP SCHEMA mystuff CASCADE; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterschema"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createschema"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterschema"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createschema"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_sequence.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_sequence.sgml index be30f8f8104..387c98edbcd 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_sequence.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_sequence.sgml @@ -63,7 +63,7 @@ DROP SEQUENCE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [, <para> Automatically drop objects that depend on the sequence, and in turn all objects that depend on those objects - (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend">). + (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -107,8 +107,8 @@ DROP SEQUENCE serial; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createsequence"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-altersequence"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createsequence"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-altersequence"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_server.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_server.sgml index fa941e8cd20..f83a661b3eb 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_server.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_server.sgml @@ -65,7 +65,7 @@ DROP SERVER [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [, . Automatically drop objects that depend on the server (such as user mappings), and in turn all objects that depend on those objects - (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend">). + (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -106,8 +106,8 @@ DROP SERVER IF EXISTS foo; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createserver"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterserver"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createserver"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterserver"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_statistics.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_statistics.sgml index b34d070d50c..f58c3d6d221 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_statistics.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_statistics.sgml @@ -88,8 +88,8 @@ DROP STATISTICS IF EXISTS <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterstatistics"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createstatistics"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterstatistics"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createstatistics"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_subscription.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_subscription.sgml index 5ab2f9eae84..adbdeafb4e1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_subscription.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_subscription.sgml @@ -91,7 +91,7 @@ DROP SUBSCRIPTION [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable actions on a remote host. Note that if the remote replication slot still exists, it should then be dropped manually; otherwise it will continue to reserve WAL and might eventually cause the disk to fill up. See - also <xref linkend="logical-replication-subscription-slot">. + also <xref linkend="logical-replication-subscription-slot"/>. </para> <para> @@ -123,8 +123,8 @@ DROP SUBSCRIPTION mysub; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createsubscription"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-altersubscription"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createsubscription"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-altersubscription"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_table.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_table.sgml index b2153699103..bf8996d1985 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_table.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_table.sgml @@ -32,8 +32,8 @@ DROP TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [, .. <command>DROP TABLE</command> removes tables from the database. Only the table owner, the schema owner, and superuser can drop a table. To empty a table of rows - without destroying the table, use <xref linkend="sql-delete"> - or <xref linkend="sql-truncate">. + without destroying the table, use <xref linkend="sql-delete"/> + or <xref linkend="sql-truncate"/>. </para> <para> @@ -77,7 +77,7 @@ DROP TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [, .. Automatically drop objects that depend on the table (such as views), and in turn all objects that depend on those objects - (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend">). + (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -121,8 +121,8 @@ DROP TABLE films, distributors; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-altertable"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createtable"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-altertable"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createtable"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_tablespace.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_tablespace.sgml index b761a4d92e0..047e4e04810 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_tablespace.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_tablespace.sgml @@ -38,7 +38,7 @@ DROP TABLESPACE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> dropped. It is possible that objects in other databases might still reside in the tablespace even if no objects in the current database are using the tablespace. Also, if the tablespace is listed in the <xref - linkend="guc-temp-tablespaces"> setting of any active session, the + linkend="guc-temp-tablespaces"/> setting of any active session, the <command>DROP</command> might fail due to temporary files residing in the tablespace. </para> @@ -102,8 +102,8 @@ DROP TABLESPACE mystuff; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createtablespace"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-altertablespace"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createtablespace"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-altertablespace"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_transform.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_transform.sgml index c7de707fcc4..582e7822191 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_transform.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_transform.sgml @@ -76,7 +76,7 @@ DROP TRANSFORM [ IF EXISTS ] FOR <replaceable>type_name</replaceable> LANGUAGE < <para> Automatically drop objects that depend on the transform, and in turn all objects that depend on those objects - (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend">). + (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -110,7 +110,7 @@ DROP TRANSFORM FOR hstore LANGUAGE plpythonu; <para> This form of <command>DROP TRANSFORM</command> is a <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> extension. See <xref - linkend="sql-createtransform"> for details. + linkend="sql-createtransform"/> for details. </para> </refsect1> @@ -118,7 +118,7 @@ DROP TRANSFORM FOR hstore LANGUAGE plpythonu; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createtransform"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createtransform"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_trigger.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_trigger.sgml index 118f38f3f48..728541e5576 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_trigger.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_trigger.sgml @@ -75,7 +75,7 @@ DROP TRIGGER [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> ON <para> Automatically drop objects that depend on the trigger, and in turn all objects that depend on those objects - (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend">). + (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -120,7 +120,7 @@ DROP TRIGGER if_dist_exists ON films; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createtrigger"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createtrigger"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_tsconfig.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_tsconfig.sgml index b7acf46ff7a..9eec4bab532 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_tsconfig.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_tsconfig.sgml @@ -66,7 +66,7 @@ DROP TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name <para> Automatically drop objects that depend on the text search configuration, and in turn all objects that depend on those objects - (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend">). + (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -113,8 +113,8 @@ DROP TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION my_english; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-altertsconfig"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createtsconfig"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-altertsconfig"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createtsconfig"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_tsdictionary.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_tsdictionary.sgml index b670f55ff2b..8d22cfdc75c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_tsdictionary.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_tsdictionary.sgml @@ -66,7 +66,7 @@ DROP TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</r <para> Automatically drop objects that depend on the text search dictionary, and in turn all objects that depend on those objects - (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend">). + (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -112,8 +112,8 @@ DROP TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY english; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-altertsdictionary"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createtsdictionary"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-altertsdictionary"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createtsdictionary"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_tsparser.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_tsparser.sgml index dea9b2b1bda..2b647ccaa61 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_tsparser.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_tsparser.sgml @@ -64,7 +64,7 @@ DROP TEXT SEARCH PARSER [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</repla <para> Automatically drop objects that depend on the text search parser, and in turn all objects that depend on those objects - (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend">). + (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -110,8 +110,8 @@ DROP TEXT SEARCH PARSER my_parser; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-altertsparser"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createtsparser"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-altertsparser"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createtsparser"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_tstemplate.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_tstemplate.sgml index 244af48191e..972b90a85cb 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_tstemplate.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_tstemplate.sgml @@ -65,7 +65,7 @@ DROP TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</rep <para> Automatically drop objects that depend on the text search template, and in turn all objects that depend on those objects - (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend">). + (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -111,8 +111,8 @@ DROP TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE thesaurus; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-altertstemplate"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createtstemplate"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-altertstemplate"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createtstemplate"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_type.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_type.sgml index 37449ed19fd..9e555c06241 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_type.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_type.sgml @@ -64,7 +64,7 @@ DROP TYPE [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [, ... Automatically drop objects that depend on the type (such as table columns, functions, and operators), and in turn all objects that depend on those objects - (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend">). + (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -108,8 +108,8 @@ DROP TYPE box; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-altertype"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createtype"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-altertype"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createtype"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_user.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_user.sgml index 0e680f30f63..37ab856125d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_user.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_user.sgml @@ -30,7 +30,7 @@ DROP USER [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [, ... <para> <command>DROP USER</command> is simply an alternate spelling of - <xref linkend="sql-droprole">. + <xref linkend="sql-droprole"/>. </para> </refsect1> @@ -48,7 +48,7 @@ DROP USER [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [, ... <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-droprole"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-droprole"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_user_mapping.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_user_mapping.sgml index 393a1eadcf6..7cb09f1166d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_user_mapping.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_user_mapping.sgml @@ -102,8 +102,8 @@ DROP USER MAPPING IF EXISTS FOR bob SERVER foo; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createusermapping"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterusermapping"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createusermapping"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterusermapping"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_view.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_view.sgml index 47e55bffb47..a1c550ec3e1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_view.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/drop_view.sgml @@ -64,7 +64,7 @@ DROP VIEW [ IF EXISTS ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [, ... Automatically drop objects that depend on the view (such as other views), and in turn all objects that depend on those objects - (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend">). + (see <xref linkend="ddl-depend"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -106,8 +106,8 @@ DROP VIEW kinds; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterview"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createview"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterview"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createview"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/dropdb.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/dropdb.sgml index f7ca0877b1d..38f38f01ce6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/dropdb.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/dropdb.sgml @@ -41,7 +41,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> <application>dropdb</application> is a wrapper around the - <acronym>SQL</acronym> command <xref linkend="sql-dropdatabase">. + <acronym>SQL</acronym> command <xref linkend="sql-dropdatabase"/>. There is no effective difference between dropping databases via this utility and via other methods for accessing the server. </para> @@ -233,7 +233,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> This utility, like most other <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> utilities, also uses the environment variables supported by <application>libpq</application> - (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars">). + (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars"/>). </para> </refsect1> @@ -243,8 +243,8 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <title>Diagnostics</title> <para> - In case of difficulty, see <xref linkend="sql-dropdatabase"> - and <xref linkend="app-psql"> for + In case of difficulty, see <xref linkend="sql-dropdatabase"/> + and <xref linkend="app-psql"/> for discussions of potential problems and error messages. The database server must be running at the targeted host. Also, any default connection settings and environment @@ -283,8 +283,8 @@ Are you sure? (y/n) </computeroutput><userinput>y</userinput> <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="app-createdb"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropdatabase"></member> + <member><xref linkend="app-createdb"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropdatabase"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/dropuser.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/dropuser.sgml index 4c6a8bdb409..3d4e4b37b35 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/dropuser.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/dropuser.sgml @@ -42,7 +42,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> <application>dropuser</application> is a wrapper around the - <acronym>SQL</acronym> command <xref linkend="sql-droprole">. + <acronym>SQL</acronym> command <xref linkend="sql-droprole"/>. There is no effective difference between dropping users via this utility and via other methods for accessing the server. </para> @@ -225,7 +225,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> This utility, like most other <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> utilities, also uses the environment variables supported by <application>libpq</application> - (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars">). + (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars"/>). </para> </refsect1> @@ -235,8 +235,8 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <title>Diagnostics</title> <para> - In case of difficulty, see <xref linkend="sql-droprole"> - and <xref linkend="app-psql"> for + In case of difficulty, see <xref linkend="sql-droprole"/> + and <xref linkend="app-psql"/> for discussions of potential problems and error messages. The database server must be running at the targeted host. Also, any default connection settings and environment @@ -275,8 +275,8 @@ Are you sure? (y/n) </computeroutput><userinput>y</userinput> <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="app-createuser"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-droprole"></member> + <member><xref linkend="app-createuser"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-droprole"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/ecpg-ref.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/ecpg-ref.sgml index 18e7ed526ae..7bfee805a7d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/ecpg-ref.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/ecpg-ref.sgml @@ -51,7 +51,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> This reference page does not describe the embedded SQL language. - See <xref linkend="ecpg"> for more information on that topic. + See <xref linkend="ecpg"/> for more information on that topic. </para> </refsect1> @@ -235,7 +235,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> The value of either of these directories that is appropriate for the installation can be found out using <xref - linkend="app-pgconfig">. + linkend="app-pgconfig"/>. </para> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/end.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/end.sgml index 4904980dab4..7523315f344 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/end.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/end.sgml @@ -33,7 +33,7 @@ END [ WORK | TRANSACTION ] made by the transaction become visible to others and are guaranteed to be durable if a crash occurs. This command is a <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> extension - that is equivalent to <xref linkend="sql-commit">. + that is equivalent to <xref linkend="sql-commit"/>. </para> </refsect1> @@ -57,7 +57,7 @@ END [ WORK | TRANSACTION ] <title>Notes</title> <para> - Use <xref linkend="sql-rollback"> to + Use <xref linkend="sql-rollback"/> to abort a transaction. </para> @@ -83,7 +83,7 @@ END; <para> <command>END</command> is a <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> extension that provides functionality equivalent to <xref - linkend="sql-commit">, which is + linkend="sql-commit"/>, which is specified in the SQL standard. </para> </refsect1> @@ -92,9 +92,9 @@ END; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-begin"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-commit"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-rollback"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-begin"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-commit"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-rollback"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/execute.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/execute.sgml index 113a07a3ce5..aab1f4b7e08 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/execute.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/execute.sgml @@ -52,7 +52,7 @@ EXECUTE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ ( <replaceable class <para> For more information on the creation and usage of prepared statements, - see <xref linkend="sql-prepare">. + see <xref linkend="sql-prepare"/>. </para> </refsect1> @@ -95,8 +95,8 @@ EXECUTE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ ( <replaceable class <title>Examples</title> <para> Examples are given in the <xref linkend="sql-prepare-examples" - endterm="sql-prepare-examples-title"> section of the <xref - linkend="sql-prepare"> documentation. + endterm="sql-prepare-examples-title"/> section of the <xref + linkend="sql-prepare"/> documentation. </para> </refsect1> @@ -115,8 +115,8 @@ EXECUTE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ ( <replaceable class <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-deallocate"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-prepare"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-deallocate"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-prepare"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/explain.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/explain.sgml index a32c1505111..8dc0d7038ac 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/explain.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/explain.sgml @@ -260,7 +260,7 @@ ROLLBACK; The command's result is a textual description of the plan selected for the <replaceable class="parameter">statement</replaceable>, optionally annotated with execution statistics. - <xref linkend="using-explain"> describes the information provided. + <xref linkend="using-explain"/> describes the information provided. </para> </refsect1> @@ -276,7 +276,7 @@ ROLLBACK; the <link linkend="autovacuum">autovacuum daemon</link> will take care of that automatically. But if a table has recently had substantial changes in its contents, you might need to do a manual - <xref linkend="sql-analyze"> rather than wait for autovacuum to catch up + <xref linkend="sql-analyze"/> rather than wait for autovacuum to catch up with the changes. </para> @@ -450,7 +450,7 @@ EXPLAIN ANALYZE EXECUTE query(100, 200); <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-analyze"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-analyze"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/fetch.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/fetch.sgml index aa2e8f64b8a..5ef63f00583 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/fetch.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/fetch.sgml @@ -99,7 +99,7 @@ FETCH [ <replaceable class="parameter">direction</replaceable> [ FROM | IN ] ] < This page describes usage of cursors at the SQL command level. If you are trying to use cursors inside a <application>PL/pgSQL</application> function, the rules are different — - see <xref linkend="plpgsql-cursors">. + see <xref linkend="plpgsql-cursors"/>. </para> </note> </refsect1> @@ -335,9 +335,9 @@ FETCH <replaceable class="parameter">count</replaceable> </para> <para> - <xref linkend="sql-declare"> + <xref linkend="sql-declare"/> is used to define a cursor. Use - <xref linkend="sql-move"> + <xref linkend="sql-move"/> to change cursor position without retrieving data. </para> </refsect1> @@ -410,9 +410,9 @@ COMMIT WORK; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-close"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-declare"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-move"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-close"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-declare"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-move"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/grant.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/grant.sgml index 475c85b835e..a5e895d09d7 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/grant.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/grant.sgml @@ -178,7 +178,7 @@ GRANT <replaceable class="parameter">role_name</replaceable> [, ...] TO <replace creates the object; then there is no window in which another user can use the object.) Also, these initial default privilege settings can be changed using the - <xref linkend="sql-alterdefaultprivileges"> + <xref linkend="sql-alterdefaultprivileges"/> command. </para> @@ -190,14 +190,14 @@ GRANT <replaceable class="parameter">role_name</replaceable> [, ...] TO <replace <term><literal>SELECT</literal></term> <listitem> <para> - Allows <xref linkend="sql-select"> from + Allows <xref linkend="sql-select"/> from any column, or the specific columns listed, of the specified table, view, or sequence. Also allows the use of - <xref linkend="sql-copy"> TO. + <xref linkend="sql-copy"/> TO. This privilege is also needed to reference existing column values in - <xref linkend="sql-update"> or - <xref linkend="sql-delete">. + <xref linkend="sql-update"/> or + <xref linkend="sql-delete"/>. For sequences, this privilege also allows the use of the <function>currval</function> function. For large objects, this privilege allows the object to be read. @@ -209,11 +209,11 @@ GRANT <replaceable class="parameter">role_name</replaceable> [, ...] TO <replace <term><literal>INSERT</literal></term> <listitem> <para> - Allows <xref linkend="sql-insert"> of a new + Allows <xref linkend="sql-insert"/> of a new row into the specified table. If specific columns are listed, only those columns may be assigned to in the <command>INSERT</command> command (other columns will therefore receive default values). - Also allows <xref linkend="sql-copy"> FROM. + Also allows <xref linkend="sql-copy"/> FROM. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -222,7 +222,7 @@ GRANT <replaceable class="parameter">role_name</replaceable> [, ...] TO <replace <term><literal>UPDATE</literal></term> <listitem> <para> - Allows <xref linkend="sql-update"> of any + Allows <xref linkend="sql-update"/> of any column, or the specific columns listed, of the specified table. (In practice, any nontrivial <command>UPDATE</command> command will require <literal>SELECT</literal> privilege as well, since it must reference table @@ -244,7 +244,7 @@ GRANT <replaceable class="parameter">role_name</replaceable> [, ...] TO <replace <term><literal>DELETE</literal></term> <listitem> <para> - Allows <xref linkend="sql-delete"> of a row + Allows <xref linkend="sql-delete"/> of a row from the specified table. (In practice, any nontrivial <command>DELETE</command> command will require <literal>SELECT</literal> privilege as well, since it must reference table @@ -257,7 +257,7 @@ GRANT <replaceable class="parameter">role_name</replaceable> [, ...] TO <replace <term><literal>TRUNCATE</literal></term> <listitem> <para> - Allows <xref linkend="sql-truncate"> on + Allows <xref linkend="sql-truncate"/> on the specified table. </para> </listitem> @@ -269,7 +269,7 @@ GRANT <replaceable class="parameter">role_name</replaceable> [, ...] TO <replace <para> Allows creation of a foreign key constraint referencing the specified table, or specified column(s) of the table. (See the - <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> statement.) + <xref linkend="sql-createtable"/> statement.) </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -279,7 +279,7 @@ GRANT <replaceable class="parameter">role_name</replaceable> [, ...] TO <replace <listitem> <para> Allows the creation of a trigger on the specified table. (See the - <xref linkend="sql-createtrigger"> statement.) + <xref linkend="sql-createtrigger"/> statement.) </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -433,7 +433,7 @@ GRANT <replaceable class="parameter">role_name</replaceable> [, ...] TO <replace <title>Notes</title> <para> - The <xref linkend="sql-revoke"> command is used + The <xref linkend="sql-revoke"/> command is used to revoke access privileges. </para> @@ -515,7 +515,7 @@ GRANT <replaceable class="parameter">role_name</replaceable> [, ...] TO <replace </para> <para> - Use <xref linkend="app-psql">'s <command>\dp</command> command + Use <xref linkend="app-psql"/>'s <command>\dp</command> command to obtain information about existing privileges for tables and columns. For example: <programlisting> @@ -682,8 +682,8 @@ GRANT admins TO joe; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-revoke"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterdefaultprivileges"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-revoke"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterdefaultprivileges"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/import_foreign_schema.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/import_foreign_schema.sgml index 66c8462a5a8..f07f757ac6f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/import_foreign_schema.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/import_foreign_schema.sgml @@ -159,8 +159,8 @@ IMPORT FOREIGN SCHEMA foreign_films LIMIT TO (actors, directors) <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createserver"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createserver"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/initdb.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/initdb.sgml index 9a02bc1dbb1..585665f1611 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/initdb.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/initdb.sgml @@ -100,12 +100,12 @@ PostgreSQL documentation default for all locale categories, including collation order and character set classes. All server locale values (<literal>lc_*</literal>) can be displayed via <command>SHOW ALL</command>. - More details can be found in <xref linkend="locale">. + More details can be found in <xref linkend="locale"/>. </para> <para> To alter the default encoding, use the <option>--encoding</option>. - More details can be found in <xref linkend="multibyte">. + More details can be found in <xref linkend="multibyte"/>. </para> </refsect1> @@ -183,7 +183,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation unless you override it there. The default is derived from the locale, or <literal>SQL_ASCII</literal> if that does not work. The character sets supported by the <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> server are described - in <xref linkend="multibyte-charset-supported">. + in <xref linkend="multibyte-charset-supported"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -209,7 +209,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation Sets the default locale for the database cluster. If this option is not specified, the locale is inherited from the environment that <command>initdb</command> runs in. Locale - support is described in <xref linkend="locale">. + support is described in <xref linkend="locale"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -281,7 +281,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <listitem> <para> Sets the default text search configuration. - See <xref linkend="guc-default-text-search-config"> for further information. + See <xref linkend="guc-default-text-search-config"/> for further information. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -442,7 +442,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> Specifies the default time zone of the created database cluster. The value should be a full time zone name - (see <xref linkend="datatype-timezones">). + (see <xref linkend="datatype-timezones"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -451,7 +451,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> This utility, like most other <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> utilities, also uses the environment variables supported by <application>libpq</application> - (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars">). + (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars"/>). </para> </refsect1> @@ -469,8 +469,8 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="app-pg-ctl"></member> - <member><xref linkend="app-postgres"></member> + <member><xref linkend="app-pg-ctl"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="app-postgres"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/insert.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/insert.sgml index f13fad4dd68..134092fa9c5 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/insert.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/insert.sgml @@ -78,7 +78,7 @@ INSERT INTO <replaceable class="parameter">table_name</replaceable> [ AS <replac <literal>ON CONFLICT</literal> can be used to specify an alternative action to raising a unique constraint or exclusion constraint violation error. (See <xref linkend="sql-on-conflict" - endterm="sql-on-conflict-title"> below.) + endterm="sql-on-conflict-title"/> below.) </para> <para> @@ -145,7 +145,7 @@ INSERT INTO <replaceable class="parameter">table_name</replaceable> [ AS <replac <para> The <literal>WITH</literal> clause allows you to specify one or more subqueries that can be referenced by name in the <command>INSERT</command> - query. See <xref linkend="queries-with"> and <xref linkend="sql-select"> + query. See <xref linkend="queries-with"/> and <xref linkend="sql-select"/> for details. </para> <para> @@ -270,7 +270,7 @@ INSERT INTO <replaceable class="parameter">table_name</replaceable> [ AS <replac <para> A query (<command>SELECT</command> statement) that supplies the rows to be inserted. Refer to the - <xref linkend="sql-select"> + <xref linkend="sql-select"/> statement for a description of the syntax. </para> </listitem> @@ -754,7 +754,7 @@ INSERT INTO distributors (did, dname) VALUES (10, 'Conrad International') <para> Possible limitations of the <replaceable class="parameter">query</replaceable> clause are documented under - <xref linkend="sql-select">. + <xref linkend="sql-select"/>. </para> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/listen.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/listen.sgml index f4c25efbd04..ecc1fb82def 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/listen.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/listen.sgml @@ -65,7 +65,7 @@ LISTEN <replaceable class="parameter">channel</replaceable> </para> <para> - <xref linkend="sql-notify"> + <xref linkend="sql-notify"/> contains a more extensive discussion of the use of <command>LISTEN</command> and <command>NOTIFY</command>. @@ -129,8 +129,8 @@ Asynchronous notification "virtual" received from server process with PID 8448. <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-notify"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-unlisten"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-notify"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-unlisten"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/load.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/load.sgml index 14886199dee..506699ef6f8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/load.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/load.sgml @@ -40,10 +40,10 @@ LOAD '<replaceable class="parameter">filename</replaceable>' <para> The library file name is typically given as just a bare file name, which is sought in the server's library search path (set - by <xref linkend="guc-dynamic-library-path">). Alternatively it can be + by <xref linkend="guc-dynamic-library-path"/>). Alternatively it can be given as a full path name. In either case the platform's standard shared library file name extension may be omitted. - See <xref linkend="xfunc-c-dynload"> for more information on this topic. + See <xref linkend="xfunc-c-dynload"/> for more information on this topic. </para> <indexterm> @@ -74,7 +74,7 @@ LOAD '<replaceable class="parameter">filename</replaceable>' <title>See Also</title> <para> - <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"> + <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"/> </para> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/lock.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/lock.sgml index 49e29339386..b2c72039195 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/lock.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/lock.sgml @@ -98,7 +98,7 @@ LOCK [ TABLE ] [ ONLY ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ * ] <para> More information about the lock modes and locking strategies can be - found in <xref linkend="explicit-locking">. + found in <xref linkend="explicit-locking"/>. </para> </refsect1> @@ -132,7 +132,7 @@ LOCK [ TABLE ] [ ONLY ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ * ] <listitem> <para> The lock mode specifies which locks this lock conflicts with. - Lock modes are described in <xref linkend="explicit-locking">. + Lock modes are described in <xref linkend="explicit-locking"/>. </para> <para> @@ -174,9 +174,9 @@ LOCK [ TABLE ] [ ONLY ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ * ] <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> reports an error if <command>LOCK</command> is used outside a transaction block. Use - <xref linkend="sql-begin"> and - <xref linkend="sql-commit"> - (or <xref linkend="sql-rollback">) + <xref linkend="sql-begin"/> and + <xref linkend="sql-commit"/> + (or <xref linkend="sql-rollback"/>) to define a transaction block. </para> @@ -189,9 +189,9 @@ LOCK [ TABLE ] [ ONLY ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ * ] mind that all the lock modes have identical semantics so far as <command>LOCK TABLE</command> is concerned, differing only in the rules about which modes conflict with which. For information on how to - acquire an actual row-level lock, see <xref linkend="locking-rows"> + acquire an actual row-level lock, see <xref linkend="locking-rows"/> and the <xref linkend="sql-for-update-share" - endterm="sql-for-update-share-title"> in the <command>SELECT</command> + endterm="sql-for-update-share-title"/> in the <command>SELECT</command> reference documentation. </para> </refsect1> @@ -236,7 +236,7 @@ COMMIT WORK; There is no <command>LOCK TABLE</command> in the SQL standard, which instead uses <command>SET TRANSACTION</command> to specify concurrency levels on transactions. <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports that too; - see <xref linkend="sql-set-transaction"> for details. + see <xref linkend="sql-set-transaction"/> for details. </para> <para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/move.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/move.sgml index 50533e5e0ea..4c7d1dca391 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/move.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/move.sgml @@ -60,7 +60,7 @@ MOVE [ <replaceable class="parameter">direction</replaceable> [ FROM | IN ] ] <r <para> The parameters for the <command>MOVE</command> command are identical to those of the <command>FETCH</command> command; refer to - <xref linkend="sql-fetch"> + <xref linkend="sql-fetch"/> for details on syntax and usage. </para> </refsect1> @@ -116,9 +116,9 @@ COMMIT WORK; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-close"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-declare"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-fetch"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-close"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-declare"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-fetch"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/notify.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/notify.sgml index 481163634fa..e0e125a2a2d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/notify.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/notify.sgml @@ -168,7 +168,7 @@ NOTIFY <replaceable class="parameter">channel</replaceable> [ , <replaceable cla <para> The function <function>pg_notification_queue_usage</function> returns the fraction of the queue that is currently occupied by pending notifications. - See <xref linkend="functions-info"> for more information. + See <xref linkend="functions-info"/> for more information. </para> <para> A transaction that has executed <command>NOTIFY</command> cannot be @@ -226,8 +226,8 @@ Asynchronous notification "foo" with payload "payload" received from server proc <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-listen"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-unlisten"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-listen"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-unlisten"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_basebackup.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_basebackup.sgml index 167d523f5dc..e8921b1bb48 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_basebackup.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_basebackup.sgml @@ -34,9 +34,9 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <application>pg_basebackup</application> is used to take base backups of a running <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> database cluster. These are taken without affecting other clients to the database, and can be used - both for point-in-time recovery (see <xref linkend="continuous-archiving">) + both for point-in-time recovery (see <xref linkend="continuous-archiving"/>) and as the starting point for a log shipping or streaming replication standby - servers (see <xref linkend="warm-standby">). + servers (see <xref linkend="warm-standby"/>). </para> <para> @@ -45,17 +45,17 @@ PostgreSQL documentation out of backup mode automatically. Backups are always taken of the entire database cluster; it is not possible to back up individual databases or database objects. For individual database backups, a tool such as - <xref linkend="app-pgdump"> must be used. + <xref linkend="app-pgdump"/> must be used. </para> <para> The backup is made over a regular <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> connection, and uses the replication protocol. The connection must be made with a superuser or a user having <literal>REPLICATION</literal> - permissions (see <xref linkend="role-attributes">), + permissions (see <xref linkend="role-attributes"/>), and <filename>pg_hba.conf</filename> must explicitly permit the replication connection. The server must also be configured - with <xref linkend="guc-max-wal-senders"> set high enough to leave at least + with <xref linkend="guc-max-wal-senders"/> set high enough to leave at least one session available for the backup and one for WAL streaming (if used). </para> @@ -69,9 +69,9 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <application>pg_basebackup</application> can make a base backup from not only the master but also the standby. To take a backup from the standby, set up the standby so that it can accept replication connections (that is, set - <varname>max_wal_senders</varname> and <xref linkend="guc-hot-standby">, + <varname>max_wal_senders</varname> and <xref linkend="guc-hot-standby"/>, and configure <link linkend="auth-pg-hba-conf">host-based authentication</link>). - You will also need to enable <xref linkend="guc-full-page-writes"> on the master. + You will also need to enable <xref linkend="guc-full-page-writes"/> on the master. </para> <para> @@ -299,7 +299,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> The write-ahead log files are collected at the end of the backup. Therefore, it is necessary for the - <xref linkend="guc-wal-keep-segments"> parameter to be set high + <xref linkend="guc-wal-keep-segments"/> parameter to be set high enough that the log is not removed before the end of the backup. If the log has been rotated when it's time to transfer it, the backup will fail and be unusable. @@ -320,7 +320,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation open a second connection to the server and start streaming the write-ahead log in parallel while running the backup. Therefore, it will use up two connections configured by the - <xref linkend="guc-max-wal-senders"> parameter. As long as the + <xref linkend="guc-max-wal-senders"/> parameter. As long as the client can keep up with write-ahead log received, using this mode requires no extra write-ahead logs to be saved on the master. </para> @@ -377,7 +377,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <term><option>--checkpoint=<replaceable class="parameter">fast|spread</replaceable></option></term> <listitem> <para> - Sets checkpoint mode to fast (immediate) or spread (default) (see <xref linkend="backup-lowlevel-base-backup">). + Sets checkpoint mode to fast (immediate) or spread (default) (see <xref linkend="backup-lowlevel-base-backup"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -531,7 +531,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <listitem> <para> Specifies parameters used to connect to the server, as a connection - string. See <xref linkend="libpq-connstring"> for more information. + string. See <xref linkend="libpq-connstring"/> for more information. </para> <para> The option is called <literal>--dbname</literal> for consistency with other @@ -667,7 +667,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> This utility, like most other <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> utilities, uses the environment variables supported by <application>libpq</application> - (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars">). + (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars"/>). </para> </refsect1> @@ -691,7 +691,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation symbolic links used for tablespaces are preserved. Symbolic links pointing to certain directories known to PostgreSQL are copied as empty directories. Other symbolic links and special device files are skipped. - See <xref linkend="protocol-replication"> for the precise details. + See <xref linkend="protocol-replication"/> for the precise details. </para> <para> @@ -768,7 +768,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="app-pgdump"></member> + <member><xref linkend="app-pgdump"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_ctl-ref.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_ctl-ref.sgml index f930c7e2452..7eb5dd320c1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_ctl-ref.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_ctl-ref.sgml @@ -140,7 +140,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <application>pg_ctl</application> is a utility for initializing a <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> database cluster, starting, stopping, or restarting the <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> - database server (<xref linkend="app-postgres">), or displaying the + database server (<xref linkend="app-postgres"/>), or displaying the status of a running server. Although the server can be started manually, <application>pg_ctl</application> encapsulates tasks such as redirecting log output and properly detaching from the terminal @@ -153,7 +153,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> database cluster, that is, a collection of databases that will be managed by a single server instance. This mode invokes the <command>initdb</command> - command. See <xref linkend="app-initdb"> for details. + command. See <xref linkend="app-initdb"/> for details. </para> <para> @@ -475,7 +475,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation default is <literal>PostgreSQL</literal>. Note that this only controls messages sent from <application>pg_ctl</application> itself; once started, the server will use the event source specified - by its <xref linkend="guc-event-source"> parameter. Should the server + by its <xref linkend="guc-event-source"/> parameter. Should the server fail very early in startup, before that parameter has been set, it might also log using the default event source name <literal>PostgreSQL</literal>. @@ -567,12 +567,12 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <command>pg_ctl</command>, like most other <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> utilities, also uses the environment variables supported by <application>libpq</application> - (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars">). + (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars"/>). </para> <para> For additional variables that affect the server, - see <xref linkend="app-postgres">. + see <xref linkend="app-postgres"/>. </para> </refsect1> @@ -691,8 +691,8 @@ pg_ctl: server is running (PID: 13718) <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="app-initdb"></member> - <member><xref linkend="app-postgres"></member> + <member><xref linkend="app-initdb"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="app-postgres"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_dump.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_dump.sgml index 57272e33bfe..08cad68199f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_dump.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_dump.sgml @@ -48,7 +48,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> <application>pg_dump</application> only dumps a single database. To backup global objects that are common to all databases in a cluster, such as roles - and tablespaces, use <xref linkend="app-pg-dumpall">. + and tablespaces, use <xref linkend="app-pg-dumpall"/>. </para> <para> @@ -56,7 +56,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation dumps are plain-text files containing the SQL commands required to reconstruct the database to the state it was in at the time it was saved. To restore from such a script, feed it to <xref - linkend="app-psql">. Script files + linkend="app-psql"/>. Script files can be used to reconstruct the database even on other machines and other architectures; with some modifications, even on other SQL database products. @@ -64,7 +64,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> The alternative archive file formats must be used with - <xref linkend="app-pgrestore"> to rebuild the database. They + <xref linkend="app-pgrestore"/> to rebuild the database. They allow <application>pg_restore</application> to be selective about what is restored, or even to reorder the items prior to being restored. @@ -316,7 +316,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation can write their data at the same time. </para> <para><application>pg_dump</application> will open <replaceable class="parameter">njobs</replaceable> - + 1 connections to the database, so make sure your <xref linkend="guc-max-connections"> + + 1 connections to the database, so make sure your <xref linkend="guc-max-connections"/> setting is high enough to accommodate all connections. </para> <para> @@ -375,11 +375,11 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <replaceable class="parameter">schema</replaceable> parameter is interpreted as a pattern according to the same rules used by <application>psql</application>'s <literal>\d</literal> commands (see <xref - linkend="app-psql-patterns" endterm="app-psql-patterns-title">), + linkend="app-psql-patterns" endterm="app-psql-patterns-title"/>), so multiple schemas can also be selected by writing wildcard characters in the pattern. When using wildcards, be careful to quote the pattern if needed to prevent the shell from expanding the wildcards; see - <xref linkend="pg-dump-examples" endterm="pg-dump-examples-title">. + <xref linkend="pg-dump-examples" endterm="pg-dump-examples-title"/>. </para> <note> @@ -526,11 +526,11 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <replaceable class="parameter">table</replaceable> parameter is interpreted as a pattern according to the same rules used by <application>psql</application>'s <literal>\d</literal> commands (see <xref - linkend="app-psql-patterns" endterm="app-psql-patterns-title">), + linkend="app-psql-patterns" endterm="app-psql-patterns-title"/>), so multiple tables can also be selected by writing wildcard characters in the pattern. When using wildcards, be careful to quote the pattern if needed to prevent the shell from expanding the wildcards; see - <xref linkend="pg-dump-examples" endterm="pg-dump-examples-title">. + <xref linkend="pg-dump-examples" endterm="pg-dump-examples-title"/>. </para> <para> @@ -712,11 +712,11 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> This option is relevant only when dumping the contents of a table which has row security. By default, <application>pg_dump</application> will set - <xref linkend="guc-row-security"> to off, to ensure + <xref linkend="guc-row-security"/> to off, to ensure that all data is dumped from the table. If the user does not have sufficient privileges to bypass row security, then an error is thrown. This parameter instructs <application>pg_dump</application> to set - <xref linkend="guc-row-security"> to on instead, allowing the user + <xref linkend="guc-row-security"/> to on instead, allowing the user to dump the parts of the contents of the table that they have access to. </para> @@ -933,7 +933,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation states; but do this by waiting for a point in the transaction stream at which no anomalies can be present, so that there isn't a risk of the dump failing or causing other transactions to roll back with a - <literal>serialization_failure</literal>. See <xref linkend="mvcc"> + <literal>serialization_failure</literal>. See <xref linkend="mvcc"/> for more information about transaction isolation and concurrency control. </para> @@ -965,12 +965,12 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> Use the specified synchronized snapshot when making a dump of the database (see - <xref linkend="functions-snapshot-synchronization-table"> for more + <xref linkend="functions-snapshot-synchronization-table"/> for more details). </para> <para> This option is useful when needing to synchronize the dump with - a logical replication slot (see <xref linkend="logicaldecoding">) + a logical replication slot (see <xref linkend="logicaldecoding"/>) or with a concurrent session. </para> <para> @@ -1050,7 +1050,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation with a valid <acronym>URI</acronym> prefix (<literal>postgresql://</literal> or <literal>postgres://</literal>), it is treated as a - <parameter>conninfo</parameter> string. See <xref linkend="libpq-connect"> for more information. + <parameter>conninfo</parameter> string. See <xref linkend="libpq-connect"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -1171,7 +1171,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> This utility, like most other <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> utilities, also uses the environment variables supported by <application>libpq</application> - (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars">). + (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars"/>). </para> </refsect1> @@ -1184,7 +1184,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <command>SELECT</command> statements. If you have problems running <application>pg_dump</application>, make sure you are able to select information from the database using, for example, <xref - linkend="app-psql">. Also, any default connection settings and environment + linkend="app-psql"/>. Also, any default connection settings and environment variables used by the <application>libpq</application> front-end library will apply. </para> @@ -1229,11 +1229,11 @@ CREATE DATABASE foo WITH TEMPLATE template0; does not contain the statistics used by the optimizer to make query planning decisions. Therefore, it is wise to run <command>ANALYZE</command> after restoring from a dump file - to ensure optimal performance; see <xref linkend="vacuum-for-statistics"> - and <xref linkend="autovacuum"> for more information. + to ensure optimal performance; see <xref linkend="vacuum-for-statistics"/> + and <xref linkend="autovacuum"/> for more information. The dump file also does not contain any <command>ALTER DATABASE ... SET</command> commands; - these settings are dumped by <xref linkend="app-pg-dumpall">, + these settings are dumped by <xref linkend="app-pg-dumpall"/>, along with database users and other installation-wide settings. </para> @@ -1374,7 +1374,7 @@ CREATE DATABASE foo WITH TEMPLATE template0; To specify an upper-case or mixed-case name in <option>-t</option> and related switches, you need to double-quote the name; else it will be folded to lower case (see <xref - linkend="app-psql-patterns" endterm="app-psql-patterns-title">). But + linkend="app-psql-patterns" endterm="app-psql-patterns-title"/>). But double quotes are special to the shell, so in turn they must be quoted. Thus, to dump a single table with a mixed-case name, you need something like @@ -1389,9 +1389,9 @@ CREATE DATABASE foo WITH TEMPLATE template0; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="app-pg-dumpall"></member> - <member><xref linkend="app-pgrestore"></member> - <member><xref linkend="app-psql"></member> + <member><xref linkend="app-pg-dumpall"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="app-pgrestore"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="app-psql"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_dumpall.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_dumpall.sgml index ce6b895da28..5196a211b1e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_dumpall.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_dumpall.sgml @@ -35,8 +35,8 @@ PostgreSQL documentation (<quote>dumping</quote>) all <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> databases of a cluster into one script file. The script file contains <acronym>SQL</acronym> commands that can be used as input to <xref - linkend="app-psql"> to restore the databases. It does this by - calling <xref linkend="app-pgdump"> for each database in a cluster. + linkend="app-psql"/> to restore the databases. It does this by + calling <xref linkend="app-pgdump"/> for each database in a cluster. <application>pg_dumpall</application> also dumps global objects that are common to all databases. (<application>pg_dump</application> does not save these objects.) @@ -64,7 +64,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation database). If you use password authentication it will ask for a password each time. It is convenient to have a <filename>~/.pgpass</filename> file in such cases. See <xref - linkend="libpq-pgpass"> for more information. + linkend="libpq-pgpass"/> for more information. </para> </refsect1> @@ -495,7 +495,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <listitem> <para> Specifies parameters used to connect to the server, as a connection - string. See <xref linkend="libpq-connstring"> for more information. + string. See <xref linkend="libpq-connstring"/> for more information. </para> <para> The option is called <literal>--dbname</literal> for consistency with other @@ -642,7 +642,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> This utility, like most other <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> utilities, also uses the environment variables supported by <application>libpq</application> - (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars">). + (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars"/>). </para> </refsect1> @@ -699,7 +699,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <title>See Also</title> <para> - Check <xref linkend="app-pgdump"> for details on possible + Check <xref linkend="app-pgdump"/> for details on possible error conditions. </para> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_isready.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_isready.sgml index f140c820792..9567b57ebe2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_isready.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_isready.sgml @@ -55,7 +55,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation (<literal>postgresql://</literal> or <literal>postgres://</literal>), it is treated as a <parameter>conninfo</parameter> string. See <xref - linkend="libpq-connstring"> for more information. + linkend="libpq-connstring"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -162,7 +162,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <command>pg_isready</command>, like most other <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> utilities, also uses the environment variables supported by <application>libpq</application> - (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars">). + (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars"/>). </para> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_receivewal.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_receivewal.sgml index 4e2e0cb44c2..e3f2ce1fcb7 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_receivewal.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_receivewal.sgml @@ -36,15 +36,15 @@ PostgreSQL documentation log is streamed using the streaming replication protocol, and is written to a local directory of files. This directory can be used as the archive location for doing a restore using point-in-time recovery (see - <xref linkend="continuous-archiving">). + <xref linkend="continuous-archiving"/>). </para> <para> <application>pg_receivewal</application> streams the write-ahead log in real time as it's being generated on the server, and does not wait - for segments to complete like <xref linkend="guc-archive-command"> does. + for segments to complete like <xref linkend="guc-archive-command"/> does. For this reason, it is not necessary to set - <xref linkend="guc-archive-timeout"> when using + <xref linkend="guc-archive-timeout"/> when using <application>pg_receivewal</application>. </para> @@ -60,9 +60,9 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> connection and uses the replication protocol. The connection must be made with a superuser or a user having <literal>REPLICATION</literal> permissions (see - <xref linkend="role-attributes">), and <filename>pg_hba.conf</filename> + <xref linkend="role-attributes"/>), and <filename>pg_hba.conf</filename> must permit the replication connection. The server must also be - configured with <xref linkend="guc-max-wal-senders"> set high enough to + configured with <xref linkend="guc-max-wal-senders"/> set high enough to leave at least one session available for the stream. </para> @@ -172,7 +172,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <listitem> <para> Require <application>pg_receivewal</application> to use an existing - replication slot (see <xref linkend="streaming-replication-slots">). + replication slot (see <xref linkend="streaming-replication-slots"/>). When this option is used, <application>pg_receivewal</application> will report a flush position to the server, indicating when each segment has been synchronized to disk so that the server can remove that segment if it @@ -244,7 +244,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <listitem> <para> Specifies parameters used to connect to the server, as a connection - string. See <xref linkend="libpq-connstring"> for more information. + string. See <xref linkend="libpq-connstring"/> for more information. </para> <para> The option is called <literal>--dbname</literal> for consistency with other @@ -405,7 +405,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> This utility, like most other <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> utilities, uses the environment variables supported by <application>libpq</application> - (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars">). + (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars"/>). </para> </refsect1> @@ -415,11 +415,11 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> When using <application>pg_receivewal</application> instead of - <xref linkend="guc-archive-command"> as the main WAL backup method, it is + <xref linkend="guc-archive-command"/> as the main WAL backup method, it is strongly recommended to use replication slots. Otherwise, the server is free to recycle or remove write-ahead log files before they are backed up, because it does not have any information, either - from <xref linkend="guc-archive-command"> or the replication slots, about + from <xref linkend="guc-archive-command"/> or the replication slots, about how far the WAL stream has been archived. Note, however, that a replication slot will fill up the server's disk space if the receiver does not keep up with fetching the WAL data. @@ -443,7 +443,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="app-pgbasebackup"></member> + <member><xref linkend="app-pgbasebackup"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_recvlogical.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_recvlogical.sgml index 86f660070f1..a79ca200849 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_recvlogical.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_recvlogical.sgml @@ -35,8 +35,8 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> It creates a replication-mode connection, so it is subject to the same - constraints as <xref linkend="app-pgreceivewal">, plus those for logical - replication (see <xref linkend="logicaldecoding">). + constraints as <xref linkend="app-pgreceivewal"/>, plus those for logical + replication (see <xref linkend="logicaldecoding"/>). </para> <para> @@ -182,8 +182,8 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> In <option>--start</option> mode, start replication from the given LSN. For details on the effect of this, see the documentation - in <xref linkend="logicaldecoding"> - and <xref linkend="protocol-replication">. Ignored in other modes. + in <xref linkend="logicaldecoding"/> + and <xref linkend="protocol-replication"/>. Ignored in other modes. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -226,7 +226,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <listitem> <para> When creating a slot, use the specified logical decoding output - plugin. See <xref linkend="logicaldecoding">. This option has no + plugin. See <xref linkend="logicaldecoding"/>. This option has no effect if the slot already exists. </para> </listitem> @@ -238,7 +238,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <listitem> <para> This option has the same effect as the option of the same name - in <xref linkend="app-pgreceivewal">. See the description there. + in <xref linkend="app-pgreceivewal"/>. See the description there. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -279,7 +279,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> The database to connect to. See the description of the actions for what this means in detail. This can be a <application>libpq</application> connection string; - see <xref linkend="libpq-connstring"> for more information. Defaults + see <xref linkend="libpq-connstring"/> for more information. Defaults to user name. </para> </listitem> @@ -395,7 +395,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> This utility, like most other <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> utilities, uses the environment variables supported by <application>libpq</application> - (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars">). + (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars"/>). </para> </refsect1> @@ -403,7 +403,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <title>Examples</title> <para> - See <xref linkend="logicaldecoding-example"> for an example. + See <xref linkend="logicaldecoding-example"/> for an example. </para> </refsect1> @@ -411,7 +411,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="app-pgreceivewal"></member> + <member><xref linkend="app-pgreceivewal"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_resetwal.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_resetwal.sgml index 0c30addd30b..43b58a49e60 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_resetwal.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_resetwal.sgml @@ -292,7 +292,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="app-pgcontroldata"></member> + <member><xref linkend="app-pgcontroldata"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_restore.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_restore.sgml index 2b0a3340257..9946b94e84d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_restore.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_restore.sgml @@ -36,7 +36,7 @@ <para> <application>pg_restore</application> is a utility for restoring a <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> database from an archive - created by <xref linkend="app-pgdump"> in one of the non-plain-text + created by <xref linkend="app-pgdump"/> in one of the non-plain-text formats. It will issue the commands necessary to reconstruct the database to the state it was in at the time it was saved. The archive files also allow <application>pg_restore</application> to @@ -531,11 +531,11 @@ <para> This option is relevant only when restoring the contents of a table which has row security. By default, <application>pg_restore</application> will set - <xref linkend="guc-row-security"> to off, to ensure + <xref linkend="guc-row-security"/> to off, to ensure that all data is restored in to the table. If the user does not have sufficient privileges to bypass row security, then an error is thrown. This parameter instructs <application>pg_restore</application> to set - <xref linkend="guc-row-security"> to on instead, allowing the user to attempt to restore + <xref linkend="guc-row-security"/> to on instead, allowing the user to attempt to restore the contents of the table with row security enabled. This might still fail if the user does not have the right to insert the rows from the dump into the table. @@ -801,7 +801,7 @@ <para> This utility, like most other <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> utilities, also uses the environment variables supported by <application>libpq</application> - (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars">). However, it does not read + (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars"/>). However, it does not read <envar>PGDATABASE</envar> when a database name is not supplied. </para> @@ -817,7 +817,7 @@ internally executes <acronym>SQL</acronym> statements. If you have problems running <application>pg_restore</application>, make sure you are able to select information from the database using, for - example, <xref linkend="app-psql">. Also, any default connection + example, <xref linkend="app-psql"/>. Also, any default connection settings and environment variables used by the <application>libpq</application> front-end library will apply. </para> @@ -867,15 +867,15 @@ CREATE DATABASE foo WITH TEMPLATE template0; </para> <para> - See also the <xref linkend="app-pgdump"> documentation for details on + See also the <xref linkend="app-pgdump"/> documentation for details on limitations of <application>pg_dump</application>. </para> <para> Once restored, it is wise to run <command>ANALYZE</command> on each restored table so the optimizer has useful statistics; see - <xref linkend="vacuum-for-statistics"> and - <xref linkend="autovacuum"> for more information. + <xref linkend="vacuum-for-statistics"/> and + <xref linkend="autovacuum"/> for more information. </para> </refsect1> @@ -976,9 +976,9 @@ CREATE DATABASE foo WITH TEMPLATE template0; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="app-pgdump"></member> - <member><xref linkend="app-pg-dumpall"></member> - <member><xref linkend="app-psql"></member> + <member><xref linkend="app-pgdump"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="app-pg-dumpall"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="app-psql"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_rewind.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_rewind.sgml index 4bafdfe581c..8e492498268 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_rewind.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_rewind.sgml @@ -89,10 +89,10 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> <application>pg_rewind</application> requires that the target server either has - the <xref linkend="guc-wal-log-hints"> option enabled + the <xref linkend="guc-wal-log-hints"/> option enabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> or data checksums enabled when the cluster was initialized with <application>initdb</application>. Neither of these - are currently on by default. <xref linkend="guc-full-page-writes"> + are currently on by default. <xref linkend="guc-full-page-writes"/> must also be set to <literal>on</literal>, but is enabled by default. </para> </refsect1> @@ -194,7 +194,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> When <option>--source-server</option> option is used, <application>pg_rewind</application> also uses the environment variables - supported by <application>libpq</application> (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars">). + supported by <application>libpq</application> (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars"/>). </para> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_waldump.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_waldump.sgml index 40049c51e54..35f974f8c1b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_waldump.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_waldump.sgml @@ -230,7 +230,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="wal-internals"></member> + <member><xref linkend="wal-internals"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/pgarchivecleanup.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/pgarchivecleanup.sgml index 65ba3df9282..4117a4392c1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/pgarchivecleanup.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/pgarchivecleanup.sgml @@ -31,7 +31,7 @@ <para> <application>pg_archivecleanup</application> is designed to be used as an <literal>archive_cleanup_command</literal> to clean up WAL file archives when - running as a standby server (see <xref linkend="warm-standby">). + running as a standby server (see <xref linkend="warm-standby"/>). <application>pg_archivecleanup</application> can also be used as a standalone program to clean WAL file archives. </para> @@ -47,7 +47,7 @@ archive_cleanup_command = 'pg_archivecleanup <replaceable>archivelocation</repla files should be removed. </para> <para> - When used within <xref linkend="archive-cleanup-command">, all WAL files + When used within <xref linkend="archive-cleanup-command"/>, all WAL files logically preceding the value of the <literal>%r</literal> argument will be removed from <replaceable>archivelocation</replaceable>. This minimizes the number of files that need to be retained, while preserving crash-restart capability. Use of @@ -194,7 +194,7 @@ archive_cleanup_command = 'pg_archivecleanup -d /mnt/standby/archive %r 2>>clean <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="pgstandby"></member> + <member><xref linkend="pgstandby"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/pgbench.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/pgbench.sgml index f6e93c3ade6..94b495e6063 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/pgbench.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/pgbench.sgml @@ -473,7 +473,7 @@ pgbench <optional> <replaceable>options</replaceable> </optional> <replaceable>d <para><literal>prepared</literal>: use extended query protocol with prepared statements.</para> </listitem> </itemizedlist> - The default is simple query protocol. (See <xref linkend="protocol"> + The default is simple query protocol. (See <xref linkend="protocol"/> for more information.) </para> </listitem> @@ -854,7 +854,7 @@ pgbench <optional> <replaceable>options</replaceable> </optional> <replaceable>d explained above, or by the meta commands explained below. In addition to any variables preset by <option>-D</option> command-line options, there are a few variables that are preset automatically, listed in - <xref linkend="pgbench-automatic-variables">. A value specified for these + <xref linkend="pgbench-automatic-variables"/>. A value specified for these variables using <option>-D</option> takes precedence over the automatic presets. Once set, a variable's value can be inserted into a SQL command by writing @@ -1000,7 +1000,7 @@ pgbench <optional> <replaceable>options</replaceable> </optional> <replaceable>d <title>Built-In Functions</title> <para> - The functions listed in <xref linkend="pgbench-functions"> are built + The functions listed in <xref linkend="pgbench-functions"/> are built into <application>pgbench</application> and may be used in expressions appearing in <link linkend="pgbench-metacommand-set"><literal>\set</literal></link>. </para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/pgtestfsync.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/pgtestfsync.sgml index 811438ceaf3..501157cb369 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/pgtestfsync.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/pgtestfsync.sgml @@ -28,7 +28,7 @@ <para> <application>pg_test_fsync</application> is intended to give you a reasonable - idea of what the fastest <xref linkend="guc-wal-sync-method"> is on your + idea of what the fastest <xref linkend="guc-wal-sync-method"/> is on your specific system, as well as supplying diagnostic information in the event of an identified I/O problem. However, differences shown by @@ -37,7 +37,7 @@ are not speed-limited by their write-ahead logs. <application>pg_test_fsync</application> reports average file sync operation time in microseconds for each <literal>wal_sync_method</literal>, which can also be used to - inform efforts to optimize the value of <xref linkend="guc-commit-delay">. + inform efforts to optimize the value of <xref linkend="guc-commit-delay"/>. </para> </refsect1> @@ -107,7 +107,7 @@ <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="app-postgres"></member> + <member><xref linkend="app-postgres"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/pgtesttiming.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/pgtesttiming.sgml index 966546747e0..545a934cf82 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/pgtesttiming.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/pgtesttiming.sgml @@ -294,7 +294,7 @@ Histogram of timing durations: <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-explain"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-explain"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/pgupgrade.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/pgupgrade.sgml index 8785a3ded2f..055eac31a01 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/pgupgrade.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/pgupgrade.sgml @@ -287,7 +287,7 @@ make prefix=/usr/local/pgsql.new install <command>pg_upgrade</command> will connect to the old and new servers several times, so you might want to set authentication to <literal>peer</literal> in <filename>pg_hba.conf</filename> or use a <filename>~/.pgpass</filename> file - (see <xref linkend="libpq-pgpass">). + (see <xref linkend="libpq-pgpass"/>). </para> </step> @@ -321,7 +321,7 @@ NET STOP postgresql-&majorversion; <para> If you are upgrading standby servers using methods outlined in section <xref - linkend="pgupgrade-step-replicas">, verify that the old standby + linkend="pgupgrade-step-replicas"/>, verify that the old standby servers are caught up by running <application>pg_controldata</application> against the old primary and standby clusters. Verify that the <quote>Latest checkpoint location</quote> values match in all clusters. @@ -404,7 +404,7 @@ pg_upgrade.exe <para> If an error occurs while restoring the database schema, <command>pg_upgrade</command> will - exit and you will have to revert to the old cluster as outlined in <xref linkend="pgupgrade-step-revert"> + exit and you will have to revert to the old cluster as outlined in <xref linkend="pgupgrade-step-revert"/> below. To try <command>pg_upgrade</command> again, you will need to modify the old cluster so the pg_upgrade schema restore succeeds. If the problem is a <filename>contrib</filename> module, you might need to uninstall the <filename>contrib</filename> module from @@ -418,8 +418,8 @@ pg_upgrade.exe <para> If you used link mode and have Streaming Replication (see <xref - linkend="streaming-replication">) or Log-Shipping (see <xref - linkend="warm-standby">) standby servers, you can follow these steps to + linkend="streaming-replication"/>) or Log-Shipping (see <xref + linkend="warm-standby"/>) standby servers, you can follow these steps to quickly upgrade them. You will not be running <application>pg_upgrade</application> on the standby servers, but rather <application>rsync</application> on the primary. Do not start any servers yet. @@ -730,7 +730,7 @@ psql --username=postgres --file=script.sql postgres is necessary because <command>rsync</command> only has file modification-time granularity of one second.) You might want to exclude some files, e.g. <filename>postmaster.pid</filename>, as documented in <xref - linkend="backup-lowlevel-base-backup">. If your file system supports + linkend="backup-lowlevel-base-backup"/>. If your file system supports file system snapshots or copy-on-write file copies, you can use that to make a backup of the old cluster and tablespaces, though the snapshot and copies must be created simultaneously or while the database server @@ -743,10 +743,10 @@ psql --username=postgres --file=script.sql postgres <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="app-initdb"></member> - <member><xref linkend="app-pg-ctl"></member> - <member><xref linkend="app-pgdump"></member> - <member><xref linkend="app-postgres"></member> + <member><xref linkend="app-initdb"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="app-pg-ctl"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="app-pgdump"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="app-postgres"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/postgres-ref.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/postgres-ref.sgml index b62e626e7af..53dc05a78f0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/postgres-ref.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/postgres-ref.sgml @@ -51,8 +51,8 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <option>-D</option> option or the <envar>PGDATA</envar> environment variable; there is no default. Typically, <option>-D</option> or <envar>PGDATA</envar> points directly to the data area directory - created by <xref linkend="app-initdb">. Other possible file layouts are - discussed in <xref linkend="runtime-config-file-locations">. + created by <xref linkend="app-initdb"/>. Other possible file layouts are + discussed in <xref linkend="runtime-config-file-locations"/>. </para> <para> @@ -65,7 +65,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> The <command>postgres</command> command can also be called in single-user mode. The primary use for this mode is during - bootstrapping by <xref linkend="app-initdb">. Sometimes it is used + bootstrapping by <xref linkend="app-initdb"/>. Sometimes it is used for debugging or disaster recovery; note that running a single-user server is not truly suitable for debugging the server, since no realistic interprocess communication and locking will happen. @@ -87,7 +87,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> <command>postgres</command> accepts the following command-line arguments. For a detailed discussion of the options consult <xref - linkend="runtime-config">. You can save typing most of these + linkend="runtime-config"/>. You can save typing most of these options by setting up a configuration file. Some (safe) options can also be set from the connecting client in an application-dependent way to apply only for that session. For @@ -109,7 +109,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation processes. The default value of this parameter is chosen automatically by <application>initdb</application>. Specifying this option is equivalent to setting the - <xref linkend="guc-shared-buffers"> configuration parameter. + <xref linkend="guc-shared-buffers"/> configuration parameter. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -120,7 +120,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> Sets a named run-time parameter. The configuration parameters supported by <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> are - described in <xref linkend="runtime-config">. Most of the + described in <xref linkend="runtime-config"/>. Most of the other command line options are in fact short forms of such a parameter assignment. <option>-c</option> can appear multiple times to set multiple parameters. @@ -142,9 +142,9 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> This option is meant for other programs that interact with a server - instance, such as <xref linkend="app-pg-ctl">, to query configuration + instance, such as <xref linkend="app-pg-ctl"/>, to query configuration parameter values. User-facing applications should instead use <xref - linkend="sql-show"> or the <structname>pg_settings</structname> view. + linkend="sql-show"/> or the <structname>pg_settings</structname> view. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -169,7 +169,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> Specifies the file system location of the database configuration files. See - <xref linkend="runtime-config-file-locations"> for details. + <xref linkend="runtime-config-file-locations"/> for details. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -181,7 +181,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation Sets the default date style to <quote>European</quote>, that is <literal>DMY</literal> ordering of input date fields. This also causes the day to be printed before the month in certain date output formats. - See <xref linkend="datatype-datetime"> for more information. + See <xref linkend="datatype-datetime"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -193,7 +193,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation Disables <function>fsync</function> calls for improved performance, at the risk of data corruption in the event of a system crash. Specifying this option is equivalent to - disabling the <xref linkend="guc-fsync"> configuration + disabling the <xref linkend="guc-fsync"/> configuration parameter. Read the detailed documentation before using this! </para> </listitem> @@ -213,7 +213,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation server. Defaults to listening only on <systemitem class="systemname">localhost</systemitem>. Specifying this option is equivalent to setting the <xref - linkend="guc-listen-addresses"> configuration parameter. + linkend="guc-listen-addresses"/> configuration parameter. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -230,7 +230,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation </para> <para> This option is deprecated since it does not allow access to the - full functionality of <xref linkend="guc-listen-addresses">. + full functionality of <xref linkend="guc-listen-addresses"/>. It's usually better to set <varname>listen_addresses</varname> directly. </para> </listitem> @@ -249,7 +249,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation The default value is normally <filename>/tmp</filename>, but that can be changed at build time. Specifying this option is equivalent to setting the <xref - linkend="guc-unix-socket-directories"> configuration parameter. + linkend="guc-unix-socket-directories"/> configuration parameter. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -262,7 +262,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> must have been compiled with support for <acronym>SSL</acronym> for this option to be available. For more information on using <acronym>SSL</acronym>, - refer to <xref linkend="ssl-tcp">. + refer to <xref linkend="ssl-tcp"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -275,7 +275,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation server will accept. The default value of this parameter is chosen automatically by <application>initdb</application>. Specifying this option is equivalent to setting the - <xref linkend="guc-max-connections"> configuration parameter. + <xref linkend="guc-max-connections"/> configuration parameter. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -341,7 +341,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation Specifies the amount of memory to be used by internal sorts and hashes before resorting to temporary disk files. See the description of the <varname>work_mem</varname> configuration parameter in <xref - linkend="runtime-config-resource-memory">. + linkend="runtime-config-resource-memory"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -531,7 +531,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> The following options only apply to the single-user mode (see <xref linkend="app-postgres-single-user" - endterm="app-postgres-single-user-title">). + endterm="app-postgres-single-user-title"/>). </para> <variablelist> @@ -620,7 +620,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <listitem> <para> - Default value of the <xref linkend="guc-datestyle"> run-time + Default value of the <xref linkend="guc-datestyle"/> run-time parameter. (The use of this environment variable is deprecated.) </para> </listitem> @@ -646,11 +646,11 @@ PostgreSQL documentation A failure message mentioning <literal>semget</literal> or <literal>shmget</literal> probably indicates you need to configure your kernel to provide adequate shared memory and semaphores. For more - discussion see <xref linkend="kernel-resources">. You might be able + discussion see <xref linkend="kernel-resources"/>. You might be able to postpone reconfiguring your kernel by decreasing <xref - linkend="guc-shared-buffers"> to reduce the shared memory + linkend="guc-shared-buffers"/> to reduce the shared memory consumption of <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>, and/or by reducing - <xref linkend="guc-max-connections"> to reduce the semaphore + <xref linkend="guc-max-connections"/> to reduce the semaphore consumption. </para> @@ -689,7 +689,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <title>Notes</title> <para> - The utility command <xref linkend="app-pg-ctl"> can be used to + The utility command <xref linkend="app-pg-ctl"/> can be used to start and shut down the <command>postgres</command> server safely and comfortably. </para> @@ -726,7 +726,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation to the process running that command. To terminate a backend process cleanly, send <literal>SIGTERM</literal> to that process. See also <function>pg_cancel_backend</function> and <function>pg_terminate_backend</function> - in <xref linkend="functions-admin-signal"> for the SQL-callable equivalents + in <xref linkend="functions-admin-signal"/> for the SQL-callable equivalents of these two actions. </para> @@ -857,8 +857,8 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <title>See Also</title> <para> - <xref linkend="app-initdb">, - <xref linkend="app-pg-ctl"> + <xref linkend="app-initdb"/>, + <xref linkend="app-pg-ctl"/> </para> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/postmaster.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/postmaster.sgml index ec11ec65f55..311510a44d9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/postmaster.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/postmaster.sgml @@ -38,7 +38,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <title>See Also</title> <para> - <xref linkend="app-postgres"> + <xref linkend="app-postgres"/> </para> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/prepare.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/prepare.sgml index fb91ef8d50f..704fb5e4ab3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/prepare.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/prepare.sgml @@ -55,7 +55,7 @@ PREPARE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ ( <replaceable class in which the parameter is used (if possible). When executing the statement, specify the actual values for these parameters in the <command>EXECUTE</command> statement. Refer to <xref - linkend="sql-execute"> for more + linkend="sql-execute"/> for more information about that. </para> @@ -66,7 +66,7 @@ PREPARE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ ( <replaceable class also means that a single prepared statement cannot be used by multiple simultaneous database clients; however, each client can create their own prepared statement to use. Prepared statements can be - manually cleaned up using the <xref linkend="sql-deallocate"> command. + manually cleaned up using the <xref linkend="sql-deallocate"/> command. </para> <para> @@ -154,7 +154,7 @@ PREPARE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ ( <replaceable class <para> To examine the query plan <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> is using - for a prepared statement, use <xref linkend="sql-explain">, e.g. + for a prepared statement, use <xref linkend="sql-explain"/>, e.g. <command>EXPLAIN EXECUTE</command>. If a generic plan is in use, it will contain parameter symbols <literal>$<replaceable>n</replaceable></literal>, while a custom plan will have the @@ -166,7 +166,7 @@ PREPARE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ ( <replaceable class <para> For more information on query planning and the statistics collected by <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> for that purpose, see - the <xref linkend="sql-analyze"> + the <xref linkend="sql-analyze"/> documentation. </para> @@ -176,7 +176,7 @@ PREPARE <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ ( <replaceable class force re-analysis and re-planning of the statement before using it whenever database objects used in the statement have undergone definitional (DDL) changes since the previous use of the prepared - statement. Also, if the value of <xref linkend="guc-search-path"> changes + statement. Also, if the value of <xref linkend="guc-search-path"/> changes from one use to the next, the statement will be re-parsed using the new <varname>search_path</varname>. (This latter behavior is new as of <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> 9.3.) These rules make use of a @@ -240,8 +240,8 @@ EXECUTE usrrptplan(1, current_date); <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-deallocate"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-execute"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-deallocate"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-execute"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/prepare_transaction.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/prepare_transaction.sgml index 990546a8c72..d958f7a06f5 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/prepare_transaction.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/prepare_transaction.sgml @@ -39,8 +39,8 @@ PREPARE TRANSACTION <replaceable class="parameter">transaction_id</replaceable> <para> Once prepared, a transaction can later be committed or rolled back - with <xref linkend="sql-commit-prepared"> - or <xref linkend="sql-rollback-prepared">, + with <xref linkend="sql-commit-prepared"/> + or <xref linkend="sql-rollback-prepared"/>, respectively. Those commands can be issued from any session, not only the one that executed the original transaction. </para> @@ -93,7 +93,7 @@ PREPARE TRANSACTION <replaceable class="parameter">transaction_id</replaceable> <para> This command must be used inside a transaction block. Use <xref - linkend="sql-begin"> to start one. + linkend="sql-begin"/> to start one. </para> <para> @@ -128,7 +128,7 @@ PREPARE TRANSACTION <replaceable class="parameter">transaction_id</replaceable> This will interfere with the ability of <command>VACUUM</command> to reclaim storage, and in extreme cases could cause the database to shut down to prevent transaction ID wraparound (see <xref - linkend="vacuum-for-wraparound">). Keep in mind also that the transaction + linkend="vacuum-for-wraparound"/>). Keep in mind also that the transaction continues to hold whatever locks it held. The intended usage of the feature is that a prepared transaction will normally be committed or rolled back as soon as an external transaction manager has verified that @@ -139,7 +139,7 @@ PREPARE TRANSACTION <replaceable class="parameter">transaction_id</replaceable> If you have not set up an external transaction manager to track prepared transactions and ensure they get closed out promptly, it is best to keep the prepared-transaction feature disabled by setting - <xref linkend="guc-max-prepared-transactions"> to zero. This will + <xref linkend="guc-max-prepared-transactions"/> to zero. This will prevent accidental creation of prepared transactions that might then be forgotten and eventually cause problems. </para> @@ -173,8 +173,8 @@ PREPARE TRANSACTION 'foobar'; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-commit-prepared"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-rollback-prepared"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-commit-prepared"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-rollback-prepared"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/psql-ref.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/psql-ref.sgml index e520cdf3ba1..fce7e3a5854 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/psql-ref.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/psql-ref.sgml @@ -125,7 +125,7 @@ echo '\x \\ SELECT * FROM foo;' | psql if the string contains multiple <acronym>SQL</acronym> commands, unless there are explicit <command>BEGIN</command>/<command>COMMIT</command> commands included in the string to divide it into multiple - transactions. (See <xref linkend="protocol-flow-multi-statement"> + transactions. (See <xref linkend="protocol-flow-multi-statement"/> for more details about how the server handles multi-query strings.) Also, <application>psql</application> only prints the result of the last <acronym>SQL</acronym> command in the string. @@ -167,7 +167,7 @@ EOF (<literal>postgresql://</literal> or <literal>postgres://</literal>), it is treated as a <parameter>conninfo</parameter> string. See <xref - linkend="libpq-connstring"> for more information. + linkend="libpq-connstring"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -662,9 +662,9 @@ EOF <envar>PGDATABASE</envar>, <envar>PGHOST</envar>, <envar>PGPORT</envar> and/or <envar>PGUSER</envar> to appropriate values. (For additional environment variables, see <xref - linkend="libpq-envars">.) It is also convenient to have a + linkend="libpq-envars"/>.) It is also convenient to have a <filename>~/.pgpass</filename> file to avoid regularly having to type in - passwords. See <xref linkend="libpq-pgpass"> for more information. + passwords. See <xref linkend="libpq-pgpass"/> for more information. </para> <para> @@ -678,8 +678,8 @@ $ <userinput>psql "service=myservice sslmode=require"</userinput> $ <userinput>psql postgresql://dbmaster:5433/mydb?sslmode=require</userinput> </programlisting> This way you can also use <acronym>LDAP</acronym> for connection - parameter lookup as described in <xref linkend="libpq-ldap">. - See <xref linkend="libpq-paramkeywords"> for more information on all the + parameter lookup as described in <xref linkend="libpq-ldap"/>. + See <xref linkend="libpq-paramkeywords"/> for more information on all the available connection options. </para> @@ -730,8 +730,8 @@ testdb=> <para> Whenever a command is executed, <application>psql</application> also polls for asynchronous notification events generated by - <xref linkend="sql-listen"> and - <xref linkend="sql-notify">. + <xref linkend="sql-listen"/> and + <xref linkend="sql-notify"/>. </para> <para> @@ -779,7 +779,7 @@ testdb=> If an unquoted colon (<literal>:</literal>) followed by a <application>psql</application> variable name appears within an argument, it is replaced by the variable's value, as described in <xref - linkend="app-psql-interpolation" endterm="app-psql-interpolation-title">. + linkend="app-psql-interpolation" endterm="app-psql-interpolation-title"/>. The forms <literal>:'<replaceable>variable_name</replaceable>'</literal> and <literal>:"<replaceable>variable_name</replaceable>"</literal> described there work as well. @@ -864,7 +864,7 @@ testdb=> Establishes a new connection to a <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> server. The connection parameters to use can be specified either using a positional syntax, or using <replaceable>conninfo</replaceable> connection - strings as detailed in <xref linkend="libpq-connstring">. + strings as detailed in <xref linkend="libpq-connstring"/>. </para> <para> @@ -958,7 +958,7 @@ testdb=> <listitem> <para> Performs a frontend (client) copy. This is an operation that - runs an <acronym>SQL</acronym> <xref linkend="sql-copy"> + runs an <acronym>SQL</acronym> <xref linkend="sql-copy"/> command, but instead of the server reading or writing the specified file, <application>psql</application> reads or writes the file and @@ -995,9 +995,9 @@ testdb=> <para> The syntax of this command is similar to that of the - <acronym>SQL</acronym> <xref linkend="sql-copy"> + <acronym>SQL</acronym> <xref linkend="sql-copy"/> command. All options other than the data source/destination are - as specified for <xref linkend="sql-copy">. + as specified for <xref linkend="sql-copy"/>. Because of this, special parsing rules apply to the <command>\copy</command> meta-command. Unlike most other meta-commands, the entire remainder of the line is always taken to be the arguments of <command>\copy</command>, @@ -1116,7 +1116,7 @@ testdb=> also shown. For foreign tables, the associated foreign server is shown as well. (<quote>Matching the pattern</quote> is defined in - <xref linkend="app-psql-patterns" endterm="app-psql-patterns-title"> + <xref linkend="app-psql-patterns" endterm="app-psql-patterns-title"/> below.) </para> @@ -1255,7 +1255,7 @@ testdb=> <para> Descriptions for objects can be created with the <xref - linkend="sql-comment"> + linkend="sql-comment"/> <acronym>SQL</acronym> command. </para> </listitem> @@ -1292,10 +1292,10 @@ testdb=> </para> <para> - The <xref linkend="sql-alterdefaultprivileges"> command is used to set + The <xref linkend="sql-alterdefaultprivileges"/> command is used to set default access privileges. The meaning of the privilege display is explained under - <xref linkend="sql-grant">. + <xref linkend="sql-grant"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -1606,11 +1606,11 @@ testdb=> </para> <para> - The <xref linkend="sql-grant"> and - <xref linkend="sql-revoke"> + The <xref linkend="sql-grant"/> and + <xref linkend="sql-revoke"/> commands are used to set access privileges. The meaning of the privilege display is explained under - <xref linkend="sql-grant">. + <xref linkend="sql-grant"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -1629,8 +1629,8 @@ testdb=> </para> <para> - The <xref linkend="sql-alterrole"> and - <xref linkend="sql-alterdatabase"> + The <xref linkend="sql-alterrole"/> and + <xref linkend="sql-alterdatabase"/> commands are used to define per-role and per-database configuration settings. </para> @@ -1770,7 +1770,7 @@ testdb=> <tip> <para> See under <xref linkend="app-psql-environment" - endterm="app-psql-environment-title"> for how to configure and + endterm="app-psql-environment-title"/> for how to configure and customize your editor. </para> </tip> @@ -1844,7 +1844,7 @@ Tue Oct 26 21:40:57 CEST 1999 <tip> <para> See under <xref linkend="app-psql-environment" - endterm="app-psql-environment-title"> for how to configure and + endterm="app-psql-environment-title"/> for how to configure and customize your editor. </para> </tip> @@ -2027,7 +2027,7 @@ CREATE INDEX <para> Sends the current query buffer to the server and stores the query's output into <application>psql</application> variables (see <xref - linkend="app-psql-variables" endterm="app-psql-variables-title">). + linkend="app-psql-variables" endterm="app-psql-variables-title"/>). The query to be executed must return exactly one row. Each column of the row is stored into a separate variable, named the same as the column. For example: @@ -2832,7 +2832,7 @@ lo_import 152801 <para> Illustrations of how these different formats look can be seen in the <xref linkend="app-psql-examples" - endterm="app-psql-examples-title"> section. + endterm="app-psql-examples-title"/> section. </para> <tip> @@ -2918,7 +2918,7 @@ lo_import 152801 Valid variable names can contain letters, digits, and underscores. See the section <xref linkend="app-psql-variables" - endterm="app-psql-variables-title"> below for details. + endterm="app-psql-variables-title"/> below for details. Variable names are case-sensitive. </para> @@ -2927,13 +2927,13 @@ lo_import 152801 control <application>psql</application>'s behavior or are automatically set to reflect connection state. These variables are documented in <xref linkend="app-psql-variables" - endterm="app-psql-variables-title">, below. + endterm="app-psql-variables-title"/>, below. </para> <note> <para> This command is unrelated to the <acronym>SQL</acronym> - command <xref linkend="sql-set">. + command <xref linkend="sql-set"/>. </para> </note> </listitem> @@ -3071,7 +3071,7 @@ testdb=> <userinput>\setenv LESS -imx4F</userinput> cannot be unset; instead, an <literal>\unset</literal> command is interpreted as setting them to their default values. See <xref linkend="app-psql-variables" - endterm="app-psql-variables-title">, below. + endterm="app-psql-variables-title"/>, below. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -3216,7 +3216,7 @@ select 1\; select 2\; select 3; The server executes such a request as a single transaction, unless there are explicit <command>BEGIN</command>/<command>COMMIT</command> commands included in the string to divide it into multiple - transactions. (See <xref linkend="protocol-flow-multi-statement"> + transactions. (See <xref linkend="protocol-flow-multi-statement"/> for more details about how the server handles multi-query strings.) <application>psql</application> prints only the last query result it receives for each request; in this example, although all @@ -3295,7 +3295,7 @@ select 1\; select 2\; select 3; Advanced users can use regular-expression notations such as character classes, for example <literal>[0-9]</literal> to match any digit. All regular expression special characters work as specified in - <xref linkend="functions-posix-regexp">, except for <literal>.</literal> which + <xref linkend="functions-posix-regexp"/>, except for <literal>.</literal> which is taken as a separator as mentioned above, <literal>*</literal> which is translated to the regular-expression notation <literal>.*</literal>, <literal>?</literal> which is translated to <literal>.</literal>, and @@ -3348,7 +3348,7 @@ bar </programlisting> This works in both regular SQL commands and meta-commands; there is more detail in <xref linkend="app-psql-interpolation" - endterm="app-psql-interpolation-title">, below. + endterm="app-psql-interpolation-title"/>, below. </para> <para> @@ -3743,7 +3743,7 @@ bar These specify what the prompts <application>psql</application> issues should look like. See <xref linkend="app-psql-prompting" - endterm="app-psql-prompting-title"> below. + endterm="app-psql-prompting-title"/> below. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -3825,7 +3825,7 @@ bar <term><varname>SQLSTATE</varname></term> <listitem> <para> - The error code (see <xref linkend="errcodes-appendix">) associated + The error code (see <xref linkend="errcodes-appendix"/>) associated with the last SQL query's failure, or <literal>00000</literal> if it succeeded. </para> @@ -4119,7 +4119,7 @@ testdb=> <userinput>INSERT INTO my_table VALUES (:'content');</userinput> The value of the <application>psql</application> variable <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable>. See the section <xref linkend="app-psql-variables" - endterm="app-psql-variables-title"> for details. + endterm="app-psql-variables-title"/> for details. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -4230,7 +4230,7 @@ $endif <listitem> <para> - Default connection parameters (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars">). + Default connection parameters (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -4346,7 +4346,7 @@ PSQL_EDITOR_LINENUMBER_ARG='--line ' <para> This utility, like most other <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> utilities, also uses the environment variables supported by <application>libpq</application> - (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars">). + (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars"/>). </para> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/reassign_owned.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/reassign_owned.sgml index e29b88292be..0fffd6088a9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/reassign_owned.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/reassign_owned.sgml @@ -82,7 +82,7 @@ REASSIGN OWNED BY { <replaceable class="parameter">old_role</replaceable> | CURR </para> <para> - The <xref linkend="sql-drop-owned"> command is an alternative that + The <xref linkend="sql-drop-owned"/> command is an alternative that simply drops all the database objects owned by one or more roles. </para> @@ -94,7 +94,7 @@ REASSIGN OWNED BY { <replaceable class="parameter">old_role</replaceable> | CURR </para> <para> - See <xref linkend="role-removal"> for more discussion. + See <xref linkend="role-removal"/> for more discussion. </para> </refsect1> @@ -112,9 +112,9 @@ REASSIGN OWNED BY { <replaceable class="parameter">old_role</replaceable> | CURR <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-drop-owned"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-droprole"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-alterdatabase"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-drop-owned"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-droprole"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-alterdatabase"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/refresh_materialized_view.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/refresh_materialized_view.sgml index e2ee836efb9..9cf01a25a5d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/refresh_materialized_view.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/refresh_materialized_view.sgml @@ -93,7 +93,7 @@ REFRESH MATERIALIZED VIEW [ CONCURRENTLY ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</ <para> While the default index for future - <xref linkend="sql-cluster"> + <xref linkend="sql-cluster"/> operations is retained, <command>REFRESH MATERIALIZED VIEW</command> does not order the generated rows based on this property. If you want the data to be ordered upon generation, you must use an <literal>ORDER BY</literal> @@ -135,9 +135,9 @@ REFRESH MATERIALIZED VIEW annual_statistics_basis WITH NO DATA; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-creatematerializedview"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-altermaterializedview"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-dropmaterializedview"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-creatematerializedview"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-altermaterializedview"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-dropmaterializedview"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/reindex.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/reindex.sgml index 2e053c4c24d..79f6931c6a2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/reindex.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/reindex.sgml @@ -52,7 +52,7 @@ REINDEX [ ( VERBOSE ) ] { INDEX | TABLE | SCHEMA | DATABASE | SYSTEM } <replacea patterns. <command>REINDEX</command> provides a way to reduce the space consumption of the index by writing a new version of the index without the dead pages. See <xref - linkend="routine-reindex"> for more information. + linkend="routine-reindex"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> @@ -192,7 +192,7 @@ REINDEX [ ( VERBOSE ) ] { INDEX | TABLE | SCHEMA | DATABASE | SYSTEM } <replacea doubt, use <command>REINDEX SYSTEM</command> to select reconstruction of all system indexes in the database. Then quit the single-user server session and restart the regular server. - See the <xref linkend="app-postgres"> reference page for more + See the <xref linkend="app-postgres"/> reference page for more information about how to interact with the single-user server interface. </para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/reindexdb.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/reindexdb.sgml index a7cc9c2d946..1273dad8072 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/reindexdb.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/reindexdb.sgml @@ -93,7 +93,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> <application>reindexdb</application> is a wrapper around the SQL - command <xref linkend="sql-reindex">. + command <xref linkend="sql-reindex"/>. There is no effective difference between reindexing databases via this utility and via other methods for accessing the server. </para> @@ -347,7 +347,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> This utility, like most other <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> utilities, also uses the environment variables supported by <application>libpq</application> - (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars">). + (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars"/>). </para> </refsect1> @@ -357,8 +357,8 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <title>Diagnostics</title> <para> - In case of difficulty, see <xref linkend="sql-reindex"> - and <xref linkend="app-psql"> for + In case of difficulty, see <xref linkend="sql-reindex"/> + and <xref linkend="app-psql"/> for discussions of potential problems and error messages. The database server must be running at the targeted host. Also, any default connection settings and environment @@ -377,7 +377,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation times to the <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> server, asking for a password each time. It is convenient to have a <filename>~/.pgpass</filename> file in such cases. See <xref - linkend="libpq-pgpass"> for more information. + linkend="libpq-pgpass"/> for more information. </para> </refsect1> @@ -405,7 +405,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-reindex"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-reindex"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/release_savepoint.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/release_savepoint.sgml index 7e629176b71..39665d28efa 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/release_savepoint.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/release_savepoint.sgml @@ -42,7 +42,7 @@ RELEASE [ SAVEPOINT ] <replaceable>savepoint_name</replaceable> Destroying a savepoint makes it unavailable as a rollback point, but it has no other user visible behavior. It does not undo the effects of commands executed after the savepoint was established. - (To do that, see <xref linkend="sql-rollback-to">.) + (To do that, see <xref linkend="sql-rollback-to"/>.) Destroying a savepoint when it is no longer needed allows the system to reclaim some resources earlier than transaction end. @@ -120,11 +120,11 @@ COMMIT; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-begin"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-commit"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-rollback"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-rollback-to"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-savepoint"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-begin"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-commit"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-rollback"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-rollback-to"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-savepoint"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/reset.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/reset.sgml index bf3f5226ec2..95599072e77 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/reset.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/reset.sgml @@ -36,7 +36,7 @@ RESET ALL <synopsis> SET <replaceable class="parameter">configuration_parameter</replaceable> TO DEFAULT </synopsis> - Refer to <xref linkend="sql-set"> for + Refer to <xref linkend="sql-set"/> for details. </para> @@ -49,7 +49,7 @@ SET <replaceable class="parameter">configuration_parameter</replaceable> TO DEFA from defining it as <quote>the value that the parameter had at session start</quote>, because if the value came from the configuration file, it will be reset to whatever is specified by the configuration file now. - See <xref linkend="runtime-config"> for details. + See <xref linkend="runtime-config"/> for details. </para> <para> @@ -67,8 +67,8 @@ SET <replaceable class="parameter">configuration_parameter</replaceable> TO DEFA <listitem> <para> Name of a settable run-time parameter. Available parameters are - documented in <xref linkend="runtime-config"> and on the - <xref linkend="sql-set"> reference page. + documented in <xref linkend="runtime-config"/> and on the + <xref linkend="sql-set"/> reference page. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -106,8 +106,8 @@ RESET timezone; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-set"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-show"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-set"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-show"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/revoke.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/revoke.sgml index e3e3f2ffc3f..4d133a782b6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/revoke.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/revoke.sgml @@ -122,7 +122,7 @@ REVOKE [ ADMIN OPTION FOR ] </para> <para> - See the description of the <xref linkend="sql-grant"> command for + See the description of the <xref linkend="sql-grant"/> command for the meaning of the privilege types. </para> @@ -178,9 +178,9 @@ REVOKE [ ADMIN OPTION FOR ] <title>Notes</title> <para> - Use <xref linkend="app-psql">'s <command>\dp</command> command to + Use <xref linkend="app-psql"/>'s <command>\dp</command> command to display the privileges granted on existing tables and columns. See <xref - linkend="sql-grant"> for information about the + linkend="sql-grant"/> for information about the format. For non-table objects there are other <command>\d</command> commands that can display their privileges. </para> @@ -282,7 +282,7 @@ REVOKE admins FROM joe; <title>Compatibility</title> <para> - The compatibility notes of the <xref linkend="sql-grant"> command + The compatibility notes of the <xref linkend="sql-grant"/> command apply analogously to <command>REVOKE</command>. The keyword <literal>RESTRICT</literal> or <literal>CASCADE</literal> is required according to the standard, but <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> @@ -294,7 +294,7 @@ REVOKE admins FROM joe; <title>See Also</title> <simpara> - <xref linkend="sql-grant"> + <xref linkend="sql-grant"/> </simpara> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/rollback.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/rollback.sgml index 1f99343b08d..3cafb848a9a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/rollback.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/rollback.sgml @@ -54,7 +54,7 @@ ROLLBACK [ WORK | TRANSACTION ] <title>Notes</title> <para> - Use <xref linkend="sql-commit"> to + Use <xref linkend="sql-commit"/> to successfully terminate a transaction. </para> @@ -88,9 +88,9 @@ ROLLBACK; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-begin"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-commit"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-rollback-to"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-begin"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-commit"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-rollback-to"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/rollback_prepared.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/rollback_prepared.sgml index d7468f78d72..08821a6652b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/rollback_prepared.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/rollback_prepared.sgml @@ -99,8 +99,8 @@ ROLLBACK PREPARED 'foobar'; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-prepare-transaction"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-commit-prepared"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-prepare-transaction"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-commit-prepared"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/rollback_to.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/rollback_to.sgml index 1957cace117..4d5647a302e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/rollback_to.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/rollback_to.sgml @@ -64,7 +64,7 @@ ROLLBACK [ WORK | TRANSACTION ] TO [ SAVEPOINT ] <replaceable>savepoint_name</re <title>Notes</title> <para> - Use <xref linkend="sql-release-savepoint"> to destroy a savepoint + Use <xref linkend="sql-release-savepoint"/> to destroy a savepoint without discarding the effects of commands executed after it was established. </para> @@ -148,11 +148,11 @@ COMMIT; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-begin"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-commit"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-release-savepoint"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-rollback"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-savepoint"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-begin"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-commit"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-release-savepoint"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-rollback"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-savepoint"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/savepoint.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/savepoint.sgml index 6fa11a7358f..87243b1d204 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/savepoint.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/savepoint.sgml @@ -64,8 +64,8 @@ SAVEPOINT <replaceable>savepoint_name</replaceable> <title>Notes</title> <para> - Use <xref linkend="sql-rollback-to"> to - rollback to a savepoint. Use <xref linkend="sql-release-savepoint"> + Use <xref linkend="sql-rollback-to"/> to + rollback to a savepoint. Use <xref linkend="sql-release-savepoint"/> to destroy a savepoint, keeping the effects of commands executed after it was established. </para> @@ -127,11 +127,11 @@ COMMIT; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-begin"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-commit"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-release-savepoint"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-rollback"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-rollback-to"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-begin"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-commit"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-release-savepoint"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-rollback"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-rollback-to"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/security_label.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/security_label.sgml index ce5a1c19754..d52113e0359 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/security_label.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/security_label.sgml @@ -208,7 +208,7 @@ SECURITY LABEL FOR selinux ON TABLE mytable IS 'system_u:object_r:sepgsql_table_ <refsect1> <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sepgsql"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sepgsql"/></member> <member><filename>src/test/modules/dummy_seclabel</filename></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/select.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/select.sgml index 3aab3fd8a72..8a3e86b6db6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/select.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/select.sgml @@ -94,7 +94,7 @@ TABLE [ ONLY ] <replaceable class="parameter">table_name</replaceable> [ * ] in the <literal>FROM</literal> list. A <literal>WITH</literal> query that is referenced more than once in <literal>FROM</literal> is computed only once. - (See <xref linkend="sql-with" endterm="sql-with-title"> below.) + (See <xref linkend="sql-with" endterm="sql-with-title"/> below.) </para> </listitem> @@ -104,7 +104,7 @@ TABLE [ ONLY ] <replaceable class="parameter">table_name</replaceable> [ * ] (Each element in the <literal>FROM</literal> list is a real or virtual table.) If more than one element is specified in the <literal>FROM</literal> list, they are cross-joined together. - (See <xref linkend="sql-from" endterm="sql-from-title"> below.) + (See <xref linkend="sql-from" endterm="sql-from-title"/> below.) </para> </listitem> @@ -113,7 +113,7 @@ TABLE [ ONLY ] <replaceable class="parameter">table_name</replaceable> [ * ] If the <literal>WHERE</literal> clause is specified, all rows that do not satisfy the condition are eliminated from the output. (See <xref linkend="sql-where" - endterm="sql-where-title"> below.) + endterm="sql-where-title"/> below.) </para> </listitem> @@ -125,8 +125,8 @@ TABLE [ ONLY ] <replaceable class="parameter">table_name</replaceable> [ * ] values, and the results of aggregate functions are computed. If the <literal>HAVING</literal> clause is present, it eliminates groups that do not satisfy the given condition. (See - <xref linkend="sql-groupby" endterm="sql-groupby-title"> and - <xref linkend="sql-having" endterm="sql-having-title"> below.) + <xref linkend="sql-groupby" endterm="sql-groupby-title"/> and + <xref linkend="sql-having" endterm="sql-having-title"/> below.) </para> </listitem> @@ -135,7 +135,7 @@ TABLE [ ONLY ] <replaceable class="parameter">table_name</replaceable> [ * ] The actual output rows are computed using the <command>SELECT</command> output expressions for each selected row or row group. (See - <xref linkend="sql-select-list" endterm="sql-select-list-title"> + <xref linkend="sql-select-list" endterm="sql-select-list-title"/> below.) </para> </listitem> @@ -146,7 +146,7 @@ TABLE [ ONLY ] <replaceable class="parameter">table_name</replaceable> [ * ] match on all the specified expressions. <literal>SELECT ALL</literal> (the default) will return all candidate rows, including duplicates. (See <xref linkend="sql-distinct" - endterm="sql-distinct-title"> below.) + endterm="sql-distinct-title"/> below.) </para> </listitem> @@ -167,9 +167,9 @@ TABLE [ ONLY ] <replaceable class="parameter">table_name</replaceable> [ * ] eliminating duplicate rows. Notice that <literal>DISTINCT</literal> is the default behavior here, even though <literal>ALL</literal> is the default for <command>SELECT</command> itself. (See - <xref linkend="sql-union" endterm="sql-union-title">, <xref - linkend="sql-intersect" endterm="sql-intersect-title">, and - <xref linkend="sql-except" endterm="sql-except-title"> below.) + <xref linkend="sql-union" endterm="sql-union-title"/>, <xref + linkend="sql-intersect" endterm="sql-intersect-title"/>, and + <xref linkend="sql-except" endterm="sql-except-title"/> below.) </para> </listitem> @@ -179,7 +179,7 @@ TABLE [ ONLY ] <replaceable class="parameter">table_name</replaceable> [ * ] returned rows are sorted in the specified order. If <literal>ORDER BY</literal> is not given, the rows are returned in whatever order the system finds fastest to produce. (See - <xref linkend="sql-orderby" endterm="sql-orderby-title"> below.) + <xref linkend="sql-orderby" endterm="sql-orderby-title"/> below.) </para> </listitem> @@ -188,7 +188,7 @@ TABLE [ ONLY ] <replaceable class="parameter">table_name</replaceable> [ * ] If the <literal>LIMIT</literal> (or <literal>FETCH FIRST</literal>) or <literal>OFFSET</literal> clause is specified, the <command>SELECT</command> statement only returns a subset of the result rows. (See <xref - linkend="sql-limit" endterm="sql-limit-title"> below.) + linkend="sql-limit" endterm="sql-limit-title"/> below.) </para> </listitem> @@ -199,7 +199,7 @@ TABLE [ ONLY ] <replaceable class="parameter">table_name</replaceable> [ * ] is specified, the <command>SELECT</command> statement locks the selected rows against concurrent updates. (See <xref linkend="sql-for-update-share" - endterm="sql-for-update-share-title"> below.) + endterm="sql-for-update-share-title"/> below.) </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> @@ -258,7 +258,7 @@ TABLE [ ONLY ] <replaceable class="parameter">table_name</replaceable> [ * ] is permitted per query. Recursive data-modifying statements are not supported, but you can use the results of a recursive <command>SELECT</command> query in - a data-modifying statement. See <xref linkend="queries-with"> for + a data-modifying statement. See <xref linkend="queries-with"/> for an example. </para> @@ -291,7 +291,7 @@ TABLE [ ONLY ] <replaceable class="parameter">table_name</replaceable> [ * ] </para> <para> - See <xref linkend="queries-with"> for additional information. + See <xref linkend="queries-with"/> for additional information. </para> </refsect2> @@ -410,7 +410,7 @@ TABLE [ ONLY ] <replaceable class="parameter">table_name</replaceable> [ * ] sub-<command>SELECT</command> must be surrounded by parentheses, and an alias <emphasis>must</emphasis> be provided for it. A - <xref linkend="sql-values"> command + <xref linkend="sql-values"/> command can also be used here. </para> </listitem> @@ -714,7 +714,7 @@ GROUP BY <replaceable class="parameter">grouping_element</replaceable> [, ...] equivalent to constructing a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> between subqueries with the individual grouping sets as their <literal>GROUP BY</literal> clauses. For further details on the handling - of grouping sets see <xref linkend="queries-grouping-sets">. + of grouping sets see <xref linkend="queries-grouping-sets"/>. </para> <para> @@ -725,7 +725,7 @@ GROUP BY <replaceable class="parameter">grouping_element</replaceable> [, ...] the selected rows.) The set of rows fed to each aggregate function can be further filtered by attaching a <literal>FILTER</literal> clause to the aggregate function - call; see <xref linkend="syntax-aggregates"> for more information. When + call; see <xref linkend="syntax-aggregates"/> for more information. When a <literal>FILTER</literal> clause is present, only those rows matching it are included in the input to that aggregate function. </para> @@ -747,7 +747,7 @@ GROUP BY <replaceable class="parameter">grouping_element</replaceable> [, ...] evaluating any <quote>scalar</quote> expressions in the <literal>HAVING</literal> clause or <literal>SELECT</literal> list. This means that, for example, a <literal>CASE</literal> expression cannot be used to skip evaluation of - an aggregate function; see <xref linkend="syntax-express-eval">. + an aggregate function; see <xref linkend="syntax-express-eval"/>. </para> <para> @@ -834,7 +834,7 @@ WINDOW <replaceable class="parameter">window_name</replaceable> AS ( <replaceabl <para> The elements of the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> list are interpreted in much the same fashion as elements of a - <xref linkend="sql-groupby" endterm="sql-groupby-title">, except that + <xref linkend="sql-groupby" endterm="sql-groupby-title"/>, except that they are always simple expressions and never the name or number of an output column. Another difference is that these expressions can contain aggregate @@ -846,7 +846,7 @@ WINDOW <replaceable class="parameter">window_name</replaceable> AS ( <replaceabl <para> Similarly, the elements of the <literal>ORDER BY</literal> list are interpreted in much the same fashion as elements of an - <xref linkend="sql-orderby" endterm="sql-orderby-title">, except that + <xref linkend="sql-orderby" endterm="sql-orderby-title"/>, except that the expressions are always taken as simple expressions and never the name or number of an output column. </para> @@ -920,8 +920,8 @@ UNBOUNDED FOLLOWING <para> The purpose of a <literal>WINDOW</literal> clause is to specify the behavior of <firstterm>window functions</firstterm> appearing in the query's - <xref linkend="sql-select-list" endterm="sql-select-list-title"> or - <xref linkend="sql-orderby" endterm="sql-orderby-title">. These functions + <xref linkend="sql-select-list" endterm="sql-select-list-title"/> or + <xref linkend="sql-orderby" endterm="sql-orderby-title"/>. These functions can reference the <literal>WINDOW</literal> clause entries by name in their <literal>OVER</literal> clauses. A <literal>WINDOW</literal> clause entry does not have to be referenced anywhere, however; if it is not @@ -941,9 +941,9 @@ UNBOUNDED FOLLOWING <para> Window functions are described in detail in - <xref linkend="tutorial-window">, - <xref linkend="syntax-window-functions">, and - <xref linkend="queries-window">. + <xref linkend="tutorial-window"/>, + <xref linkend="syntax-window-functions"/>, and + <xref linkend="queries-window"/>. </para> </refsect2> @@ -969,7 +969,7 @@ UNBOUNDED FOLLOWING after the column's expression. (You can omit <literal>AS</literal>, but only if the desired output name does not match any <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> keyword (see <xref - linkend="sql-keywords-appendix">). For protection against possible + linkend="sql-keywords-appendix"/>). For protection against possible future keyword additions, it is recommended that you always either write <literal>AS</literal> or double-quote the output name.) If you do not specify a column name, a name is chosen automatically @@ -1311,8 +1311,8 @@ SELECT name FROM distributors ORDER BY code; a <literal>COLLATE</literal> clause in the <replaceable class="parameter">expression</replaceable>, for example <literal>ORDER BY mycolumn COLLATE "en_US"</literal>. - For more information see <xref linkend="sql-syntax-collate-exprs"> and - <xref linkend="collation">. + For more information see <xref linkend="sql-syntax-collate-exprs"/> and + <xref linkend="collation"/>. </para> </refsect2> @@ -1425,7 +1425,7 @@ KEY SHARE <para> For more information on each row-level lock mode, refer to - <xref linkend="locking-rows">. + <xref linkend="locking-rows"/>. </para> <para> @@ -1441,8 +1441,8 @@ KEY SHARE Note that <literal>NOWAIT</literal> and <literal>SKIP LOCKED</literal> apply only to the row-level lock(s) — the required <literal>ROW SHARE</literal> table-level lock is still taken in the ordinary way (see - <xref linkend="mvcc">). You can use - <xref linkend="sql-lock"> + <xref linkend="mvcc"/>). You can use + <xref linkend="sql-lock"/> with the <literal>NOWAIT</literal> option first, if you need to acquire the table-level lock without waiting. </para> @@ -1791,7 +1791,7 @@ SELECT distance, employee_name FROM employee_recursive; an initial condition, followed by <literal>UNION</literal>, followed by the recursive part of the query. Be sure that the recursive part of the query will eventually return no tuples, or - else the query will loop indefinitely. (See <xref linkend="queries-with"> + else the query will loop indefinitely. (See <xref linkend="queries-with"/> for more examples.) </para> @@ -2001,7 +2001,7 @@ SELECT distributors.* WHERE distributors.name = 'Westward'; used by <productname>MySQL</productname>. The SQL:2008 standard has introduced the clauses <literal>OFFSET ... FETCH {FIRST|NEXT} ...</literal> for the same functionality, as shown above - in <xref linkend="sql-limit" endterm="sql-limit-title">. This + in <xref linkend="sql-limit" endterm="sql-limit-title"/>. This syntax is also used by <productname>IBM DB2</productname>. (Applications written for <productname>Oracle</productname> frequently use a workaround involving the automatically diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/select_into.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/select_into.sgml index a5b6ac9245a..6c1a25f5ed5 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/select_into.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/select_into.sgml @@ -60,7 +60,7 @@ SELECT [ ALL | DISTINCT [ ON ( <replaceable class="parameter">expression</replac <listitem> <para> If specified, the table is created as a temporary table. Refer - to <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for details. + to <xref linkend="sql-createtable"/> for details. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -70,7 +70,7 @@ SELECT [ ALL | DISTINCT [ ON ( <replaceable class="parameter">expression</replac <listitem> <para> If specified, the table is created as an unlogged table. Refer - to <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for details. + to <xref linkend="sql-createtable"/> for details. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -87,7 +87,7 @@ SELECT [ ALL | DISTINCT [ ON ( <replaceable class="parameter">expression</replac <para> All other parameters are described in detail under <xref - linkend="sql-select">. + linkend="sql-select"/>. </para> </refsect1> @@ -95,7 +95,7 @@ SELECT [ ALL | DISTINCT [ ON ( <replaceable class="parameter">expression</replac <title>Notes</title> <para> - <xref linkend="sql-createtableas"> is functionally similar to + <xref linkend="sql-createtableas"/> is functionally similar to <command>SELECT INTO</command>. <command>CREATE TABLE AS</command> is the recommended syntax, since this form of <command>SELECT INTO</command> is not available in <application>ECPG</application> @@ -107,7 +107,7 @@ SELECT [ ALL | DISTINCT [ ON ( <replaceable class="parameter">expression</replac <para> To add OIDs to the table created by <command>SELECT INTO</command>, - enable the <xref linkend="guc-default-with-oids"> configuration + enable the <xref linkend="guc-default-with-oids"/> configuration variable. Alternatively, <command>CREATE TABLE AS</command> can be used with the <literal>WITH OIDS</literal> clause. </para> @@ -132,8 +132,8 @@ SELECT * INTO films_recent FROM films WHERE date_prod >= '2002-01-01'; The SQL standard uses <command>SELECT INTO</command> to represent selecting values into scalar variables of a host program, rather than creating a new table. This indeed is the usage found - in <application>ECPG</application> (see <xref linkend="ecpg">) and - <application>PL/pgSQL</application> (see <xref linkend="plpgsql">). + in <application>ECPG</application> (see <xref linkend="ecpg"/>) and + <application>PL/pgSQL</application> (see <xref linkend="plpgsql"/>). The <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> usage of <command>SELECT INTO</command> to represent table creation is historical. It is best to use <command>CREATE TABLE AS</command> for this purpose in @@ -145,7 +145,7 @@ SELECT * INTO films_recent FROM films WHERE date_prod >= '2002-01-01'; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-createtableas"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-createtableas"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/set.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/set.sgml index 4bc8108765c..63f312e812a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/set.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/set.sgml @@ -32,7 +32,7 @@ SET [ SESSION | LOCAL ] TIME ZONE { <replaceable class="parameter">timezone</rep <para> The <command>SET</command> command changes run-time configuration parameters. Many of the run-time parameters listed in - <xref linkend="runtime-config"> can be changed on-the-fly with + <xref linkend="runtime-config"/> can be changed on-the-fly with <command>SET</command>. (But some require superuser privileges to change, and others cannot be changed after server or session start.) @@ -67,7 +67,7 @@ SET [ SESSION | LOCAL ] TIME ZONE { <replaceable class="parameter">timezone</rep <para> If <command>SET LOCAL</command> is used within a function that has a <literal>SET</literal> option for the same variable (see - <xref linkend="sql-createfunction">), + <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"/>), the effects of the <command>SET LOCAL</command> command disappear at function exit; that is, the value in effect when the function was called is restored anyway. This allows <command>SET LOCAL</command> to be used for @@ -122,7 +122,7 @@ SET [ SESSION | LOCAL ] TIME ZONE { <replaceable class="parameter">timezone</rep <listitem> <para> Name of a settable run-time parameter. Available parameters are - documented in <xref linkend="runtime-config"> and below. + documented in <xref linkend="runtime-config"/> and below. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -145,7 +145,7 @@ SET [ SESSION | LOCAL ] TIME ZONE { <replaceable class="parameter">timezone</rep <para> Besides the configuration parameters documented in <xref - linkend="runtime-config">, there are a few that can only be + linkend="runtime-config"/>, there are a few that can only be adjusted using the <command>SET</command> command or that have a special syntax: @@ -253,7 +253,7 @@ SELECT setseed(<replaceable>value</replaceable>); </para> <para> - See <xref linkend="datatype-timezones"> for more information + See <xref linkend="datatype-timezones"/> for more information about time zones. </para> </listitem> @@ -267,7 +267,7 @@ SELECT setseed(<replaceable>value</replaceable>); <para> The function <function>set_config</function> provides equivalent - functionality; see <xref linkend="functions-admin">. + functionality; see <xref linkend="functions-admin"/>. Also, it is possible to UPDATE the <link linkend="view-pg-settings"><structname>pg_settings</structname></link> system view to perform the equivalent of <command>SET</command>. @@ -323,8 +323,8 @@ SET TIME ZONE 'Europe/Rome'; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-reset"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-show"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-reset"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-show"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/set_role.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/set_role.sgml index 351e953f757..0ef6eb9a9c1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/set_role.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/set_role.sgml @@ -48,7 +48,7 @@ RESET ROLE <para> The <literal>SESSION</literal> and <literal>LOCAL</literal> modifiers act the same - as for the regular <xref linkend="sql-set"> + as for the regular <xref linkend="sql-set"/> command. </para> @@ -82,7 +82,7 @@ RESET ROLE <para> <command>SET ROLE</command> has effects comparable to - <xref linkend="sql-set-session-authorization">, but the privilege + <xref linkend="sql-set-session-authorization"/>, but the privilege checks involved are quite different. Also, <command>SET SESSION AUTHORIZATION</command> determines which roles are allowable for later <command>SET ROLE</command> commands, whereas changing @@ -92,7 +92,7 @@ RESET ROLE <para> <command>SET ROLE</command> does not process session variables as specified by - the role's <xref linkend="sql-alterrole"> settings; this only happens during + the role's <xref linkend="sql-alterrole"/> settings; this only happens during login. </para> @@ -142,7 +142,7 @@ SELECT SESSION_USER, CURRENT_USER; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-set-session-authorization"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-set-session-authorization"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/set_session_auth.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/set_session_auth.sgml index 45fa378e188..37b9ff8b18f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/set_session_auth.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/set_session_auth.sgml @@ -41,7 +41,7 @@ RESET SESSION AUTHORIZATION identifier is normally equal to the session user identifier, but might change temporarily in the context of <literal>SECURITY DEFINER</literal> functions and similar mechanisms; it can also be changed by - <xref linkend="sql-set-role">. + <xref linkend="sql-set-role"/>. The current user identifier is relevant for permission checking. </para> @@ -54,7 +54,7 @@ RESET SESSION AUTHORIZATION <para> The <literal>SESSION</literal> and <literal>LOCAL</literal> modifiers act the same - as for the regular <xref linkend="sql-set"> + as for the regular <xref linkend="sql-set"/> command. </para> @@ -120,7 +120,7 @@ SELECT SESSION_USER, CURRENT_USER; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-set-role"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-set-role"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/set_transaction.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/set_transaction.sgml index 3ab1e6f7719..43b1c6c892b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/set_transaction.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/set_transaction.sgml @@ -119,7 +119,7 @@ SET SESSION CHARACTERISTICS AS TRANSACTION <replaceable class="parameter">transa <command>INSERT</command>, <command>DELETE</command>, <command>UPDATE</command>, <command>FETCH</command>, or <command>COPY</command>) of a transaction has been executed. See - <xref linkend="mvcc"> for more information about transaction + <xref linkend="mvcc"/> for more information about transaction isolation and concurrency control. </para> @@ -156,7 +156,7 @@ SET SESSION CHARACTERISTICS AS TRANSACTION <replaceable class="parameter">transa transaction to run with the same <firstterm>snapshot</firstterm> as an existing transaction. The pre-existing transaction must have exported its snapshot with the <literal>pg_export_snapshot</literal> function (see <xref - linkend="functions-snapshot-synchronization">). That function returns a + linkend="functions-snapshot-synchronization"/>). That function returns a snapshot identifier, which must be given to <literal>SET TRANSACTION SNAPSHOT</literal> to specify which snapshot is to be imported. The identifier must be written as a string literal in this command, for example @@ -199,13 +199,13 @@ SET SESSION CHARACTERISTICS AS TRANSACTION <replaceable class="parameter">transa <para> The session default transaction modes can also be set by setting the - configuration parameters <xref linkend="guc-default-transaction-isolation">, - <xref linkend="guc-default-transaction-read-only">, and - <xref linkend="guc-default-transaction-deferrable">. + configuration parameters <xref linkend="guc-default-transaction-isolation"/>, + <xref linkend="guc-default-transaction-read-only"/>, and + <xref linkend="guc-default-transaction-deferrable"/>. (In fact <command>SET SESSION CHARACTERISTICS</command> is just a verbose equivalent for setting these variables with <command>SET</command>.) This means the defaults can be set in the configuration file, via - <command>ALTER DATABASE</command>, etc. Consult <xref linkend="runtime-config"> + <command>ALTER DATABASE</command>, etc. Consult <xref linkend="runtime-config"/> for more information. </para> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/show.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/show.sgml index 53b47ac3d8f..945b0491b14 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/show.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/show.sgml @@ -38,7 +38,7 @@ SHOW ALL <application>libpq</application> or a <application>libpq</application>-based application), or through command-line flags when starting the <command>postgres</command> server. See <xref - linkend="runtime-config"> for details. + linkend="runtime-config"/> for details. </para> </refsect1> @@ -51,8 +51,8 @@ SHOW ALL <listitem> <para> The name of a run-time parameter. Available parameters are - documented in <xref linkend="runtime-config"> and on the <xref - linkend="sql-set"> reference page. In + documented in <xref linkend="runtime-config"/> and on the <xref + linkend="sql-set"/> reference page. In addition, there are a few parameters that can be shown but not set: @@ -129,7 +129,7 @@ SHOW ALL <para> The function <function>current_setting</function> produces - equivalent output; see <xref linkend="functions-admin">. + equivalent output; see <xref linkend="functions-admin"/>. Also, the <link linkend="view-pg-settings"><structname>pg_settings</structname></link> system view produces the same information. @@ -192,8 +192,8 @@ SHOW ALL; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-set"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-reset"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-set"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-reset"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/start_transaction.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/start_transaction.sgml index 605fda53575..d6cd1d41779 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/start_transaction.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/start_transaction.sgml @@ -37,8 +37,8 @@ START TRANSACTION [ <replaceable class="parameter">transaction_mode</replaceable <para> This command begins a new transaction block. If the isolation level, read/write mode, or deferrable mode is specified, the new transaction has those - characteristics, as if <xref linkend="sql-set-transaction"> was executed. This is the same - as the <xref linkend="sql-begin"> command. + characteristics, as if <xref linkend="sql-set-transaction"/> was executed. This is the same + as the <xref linkend="sql-begin"/> command. </para> </refsect1> @@ -46,7 +46,7 @@ START TRANSACTION [ <replaceable class="parameter">transaction_mode</replaceable <title>Parameters</title> <para> - Refer to <xref linkend="sql-set-transaction"> for information on the meaning + Refer to <xref linkend="sql-set-transaction"/> for information on the meaning of the parameters to this statement. </para> </refsect1> @@ -79,7 +79,7 @@ START TRANSACTION [ <replaceable class="parameter">transaction_mode</replaceable </para> <para> - See also the compatibility section of <xref linkend="sql-set-transaction">. + See also the compatibility section of <xref linkend="sql-set-transaction"/>. </para> </refsect1> @@ -87,11 +87,11 @@ START TRANSACTION [ <replaceable class="parameter">transaction_mode</replaceable <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-begin"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-commit"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-rollback"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-savepoint"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-set-transaction"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-begin"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-commit"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-rollback"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-savepoint"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-set-transaction"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/truncate.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/truncate.sgml index 68925169879..c1e42376abd 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/truncate.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/truncate.sgml @@ -144,7 +144,7 @@ TRUNCATE [ TABLE ] [ ONLY ] <replaceable class="parameter">name</replaceable> [ <command>TRUNCATE</command> is not MVCC-safe. After truncation, the table will appear empty to concurrent transactions, if they are using a snapshot taken before the truncation occurred. - See <xref linkend="mvcc-caveats"> for more details. + See <xref linkend="mvcc-caveats"/> for more details. </para> <para> @@ -225,7 +225,7 @@ TRUNCATE othertable CASCADE; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-delete"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-delete"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/unlisten.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/unlisten.sgml index 1bffac3cb2c..687bf485c94 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/unlisten.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/unlisten.sgml @@ -40,7 +40,7 @@ UNLISTEN { <replaceable class="parameter">channel</replaceable> | * } </para> <para> - <xref linkend="sql-notify"> + <xref linkend="sql-notify"/> contains a more extensive discussion of the use of <command>LISTEN</command> and <command>NOTIFY</command>. @@ -126,8 +126,8 @@ NOTIFY virtual; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-listen"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-notify"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-listen"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-notify"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/update.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/update.sgml index 0e99aa97398..c0d0f7134d3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/update.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/update.sgml @@ -81,7 +81,7 @@ UPDATE [ ONLY ] <replaceable class="parameter">table_name</replaceable> [ * ] [ <para> The <literal>WITH</literal> clause allows you to specify one or more subqueries that can be referenced by name in the <command>UPDATE</command> - query. See <xref linkend="queries-with"> and <xref linkend="sql-select"> + query. See <xref linkend="queries-with"/> and <xref linkend="sql-select"/> for details. </para> </listitem> @@ -171,7 +171,7 @@ UPDATE [ ONLY ] <replaceable class="parameter">table_name</replaceable> [ * ] [ to appear in the <literal>WHERE</literal> condition and the update expressions. This is similar to the list of tables that can be specified in the <xref linkend="sql-from" - endterm="sql-from-title"> of a <command>SELECT</command> + endterm="sql-from-title"/> of a <command>SELECT</command> statement. Note that the target table must not appear in the <replaceable>from_list</replaceable>, unless you intend a self-join (in which case it must appear with an alias in the <replaceable>from_list</replaceable>). @@ -200,7 +200,7 @@ UPDATE [ ONLY ] <replaceable class="parameter">table_name</replaceable> [ * ] [ query on the <command>UPDATE</command>'s target table. Note that <literal>WHERE CURRENT OF</literal> cannot be specified together with a Boolean condition. See - <xref linkend="sql-declare"> + <xref linkend="sql-declare"/> for more information about using cursors with <literal>WHERE CURRENT OF</literal>. </para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/vacuum.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/vacuum.sgml index 7ecd08977c5..b760e8ede18 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/vacuum.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/vacuum.sgml @@ -61,7 +61,7 @@ VACUUM [ FULL ] [ FREEZE ] [ VERBOSE ] [ ANALYZE ] [ <replaceable class="paramet <command>VACUUM ANALYZE</command> performs a <command>VACUUM</command> and then an <command>ANALYZE</command> for each selected table. This is a handy combination form for routine maintenance scripts. See - <xref linkend="sql-analyze"> + <xref linkend="sql-analyze"/> for more details about its processing. </para> @@ -113,8 +113,8 @@ VACUUM [ FULL ] [ FREEZE ] [ VERBOSE ] [ ANALYZE ] [ <replaceable class="paramet Selects aggressive <quote>freezing</quote> of tuples. Specifying <literal>FREEZE</literal> is equivalent to performing <command>VACUUM</command> with the - <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-freeze-min-age"> and - <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-freeze-table-age"> parameters + <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-freeze-min-age"/> and + <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-freeze-table-age"/> parameters set to zero. Aggressive freezing is always performed when the table is rewritten, so this option is redundant when <literal>FULL</literal> is specified. @@ -215,7 +215,7 @@ VACUUM [ FULL ] [ FREEZE ] [ VERBOSE ] [ ANALYZE ] [ <replaceable class="paramet For tables with <acronym>GIN</acronym> indexes, <command>VACUUM</command> (in any form) also completes any pending index insertions, by moving pending index entries to the appropriate places in the main <acronym>GIN</acronym> index - structure. See <xref linkend="gin-fast-update"> for details. + structure. See <xref linkend="gin-fast-update"/> for details. </para> <para> @@ -243,14 +243,14 @@ VACUUM [ FULL ] [ FREEZE ] [ VERBOSE ] [ ANALYZE ] [ <replaceable class="paramet <command>VACUUM</command> causes a substantial increase in I/O traffic, which might cause poor performance for other active sessions. Therefore, it is sometimes advisable to use the cost-based vacuum delay feature. - See <xref linkend="runtime-config-resource-vacuum-cost"> for details. + See <xref linkend="runtime-config-resource-vacuum-cost"/> for details. </para> <para> <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> includes an <quote>autovacuum</quote> facility which can automate routine vacuum maintenance. For more information about automatic and manual vacuuming, see - <xref linkend="routine-vacuuming">. + <xref linkend="routine-vacuuming"/>. </para> </refsect1> @@ -278,9 +278,9 @@ VACUUM (VERBOSE, ANALYZE) onek; <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="app-vacuumdb"></member> - <member><xref linkend="runtime-config-resource-vacuum-cost"></member> - <member><xref linkend="autovacuum"></member> + <member><xref linkend="app-vacuumdb"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="runtime-config-resource-vacuum-cost"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="autovacuum"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/vacuumdb.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/vacuumdb.sgml index 2d47d8c1f11..955a17a849b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/vacuumdb.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/vacuumdb.sgml @@ -62,7 +62,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> <application>vacuumdb</application> is a wrapper around the SQL - command <xref linkend="sql-vacuum">. + command <xref linkend="sql-vacuum"/>. There is no effective difference between vacuuming and analyzing databases via this utility and via other methods for accessing the server. @@ -146,7 +146,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> <application>vacuumdb</application> will open <replaceable class="parameter">njobs</replaceable> connections to the - database, so make sure your <xref linkend="guc-max-connections"> + database, so make sure your <xref linkend="guc-max-connections"/> setting is high enough to accommodate all connections. </para> <para> @@ -372,7 +372,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <para> This utility, like most other <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> utilities, also uses the environment variables supported by <application>libpq</application> - (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars">). + (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars"/>). </para> </refsect1> @@ -382,8 +382,8 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <title>Diagnostics</title> <para> - In case of difficulty, see <xref linkend="sql-vacuum"> - and <xref linkend="app-psql"> for + In case of difficulty, see <xref linkend="sql-vacuum"/> + and <xref linkend="app-psql"/> for discussions of potential problems and error messages. The database server must be running at the targeted host. Also, any default connection settings and environment @@ -402,7 +402,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation times to the <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> server, asking for a password each time. It is convenient to have a <filename>~/.pgpass</filename> file in such cases. See <xref - linkend="libpq-pgpass"> for more information. + linkend="libpq-pgpass"/> for more information. </para> </refsect1> @@ -439,7 +439,7 @@ PostgreSQL documentation <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-vacuum"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-vacuum"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/values.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/values.sgml index 6b8083fc9d3..849220b1206 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/values.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/values.sgml @@ -44,7 +44,7 @@ VALUES ( <replaceable class="parameter">expression</replaceable> [, ...] ) [, .. number of elements. The data types of the resulting table's columns are determined by combining the explicit or inferred types of the expressions appearing in that column, using the same rules as for <literal>UNION</literal> - (see <xref linkend="typeconv-union-case">). + (see <xref linkend="typeconv-union-case"/>). </para> <para> @@ -85,7 +85,7 @@ VALUES ( <replaceable class="parameter">expression</replaceable> [, ...] ) [, .. rows. This expression can refer to the columns of the <command>VALUES</command> result as <literal>column1</literal>, <literal>column2</literal>, etc. For more details see - <xref linkend="sql-orderby" endterm="sql-orderby-title">. + <xref linkend="sql-orderby" endterm="sql-orderby-title"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -95,7 +95,7 @@ VALUES ( <replaceable class="parameter">expression</replaceable> [, ...] ) [, .. <listitem> <para> A sorting operator. For details see - <xref linkend="sql-orderby" endterm="sql-orderby-title">. + <xref linkend="sql-orderby" endterm="sql-orderby-title"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -105,7 +105,7 @@ VALUES ( <replaceable class="parameter">expression</replaceable> [, ...] ) [, .. <listitem> <para> The maximum number of rows to return. For details see - <xref linkend="sql-limit" endterm="sql-limit-title">. + <xref linkend="sql-limit" endterm="sql-limit-title"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -116,7 +116,7 @@ VALUES ( <replaceable class="parameter">expression</replaceable> [, ...] ) [, .. <para> The number of rows to skip before starting to return rows. For details see - <xref linkend="sql-limit" endterm="sql-limit-title">. + <xref linkend="sql-limit" endterm="sql-limit-title"/>. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -233,7 +233,7 @@ WHERE ip_address IN (VALUES('192.168.0.1'::inet), ('192.168.0.10'), ('192.168.1. <para><command>VALUES</command> conforms to the SQL standard. <literal>LIMIT</literal> and <literal>OFFSET</literal> are <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> extensions; see also - under <xref linkend="sql-select">. + under <xref linkend="sql-select"/>. </para> </refsect1> @@ -241,8 +241,8 @@ WHERE ip_address IN (VALUES('192.168.0.1'::inet), ('192.168.0.10'), ('192.168.1. <title>See Also</title> <simplelist type="inline"> - <member><xref linkend="sql-insert"></member> - <member><xref linkend="sql-select"></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-insert"/></member> + <member><xref linkend="sql-select"/></member> </simplelist> </refsect1> </refentry> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/reference.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/reference.sgml index 9000b3aaaa7..d20eaa87e76 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/reference.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/reference.sgml @@ -264,7 +264,7 @@ <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> server applications and support utilities. These commands can only be run usefully on the host where the database server resides. Other utility programs - are listed in <xref linkend="reference-client">. + are listed in <xref linkend="reference-client"/>. </para> </partintro> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/regress.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/regress.sgml index e83edf96ece..53716a029fa 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/regress.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/regress.sgml @@ -52,7 +52,7 @@ make check </computeroutput> </screen> or otherwise a note about which tests failed. See <xref - linkend="regress-evaluation"> below before assuming that a + linkend="regress-evaluation"/> below before assuming that a <quote>failure</quote> represents a serious problem. </para> @@ -97,9 +97,9 @@ make MAX_CONNECTIONS=10 check <title>Running the Tests Against an Existing Installation</title> <para> - To run the tests after installation (see <xref linkend="installation">), + To run the tests after installation (see <xref linkend="installation"/>), initialize a data area and start the - server as explained in <xref linkend="runtime">, then type: + server as explained in <xref linkend="runtime"/>, then type: <screen> make installcheck </screen> @@ -193,7 +193,7 @@ make installcheck-world <listitem> <para> Tests of client programs under <filename>src/bin</filename>. See - also <xref linkend="regress-tap">. + also <xref linkend="regress-tap"/>. </para> </listitem> </itemizedlist> @@ -371,7 +371,7 @@ make standbycheck for a given test, but inspection of the output convinces you that the result is valid, you can add a new comparison file to silence the failure report in future test runs. See - <xref linkend="regress-variant"> for details. + <xref linkend="regress-variant"/> for details. </para> <sect2> @@ -521,7 +521,7 @@ exclusion of those that don't. If the <literal>errors</literal> test results in a server crash at the <literal>select infinite_recurse()</literal> command, it means that the platform's limit on process stack size is smaller than the - <xref linkend="guc-max-stack-depth"> parameter indicates. This + <xref linkend="guc-max-stack-depth"/> parameter indicates. This can be fixed by running the server under a higher stack size limit (4MB is recommended with the default value of <varname>max_stack_depth</varname>). If you are unable to do that, an diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/release-10.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/release-10.sgml index 30d602a053d..18323b349c3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/release-10.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/release-10.sgml @@ -12,7 +12,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 10.0. For information about new features in major release 10, see - <xref linkend="release-10">. + <xref linkend="release-10"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -781,8 +781,8 @@ Branch: REL_10_STABLE [5159626af] 2017-11-03 14:14:16 -0400 <title>Migration to Version 10</title> <para> - A dump/restore using <xref linkend="app-pg-dumpall">, or use of <xref - linkend="pgupgrade">, is required for those wishing to migrate data + A dump/restore using <xref linkend="app-pg-dumpall"/>, or use of <xref + linkend="pgupgrade"/>, is required for those wishing to migrate data from any previous release. </para> @@ -893,7 +893,7 @@ Branch: REL_10_STABLE [5159626af] 2017-11-03 14:14:16 -0400 functions' periods. In addition, set-returning functions are now disallowed within <literal>CASE</literal> and <literal>COALESCE</literal> constructs. For more information - see <xref linkend="xfunc-sql-functions-returning-set">. + see <xref linkend="xfunc-sql-functions-returning-set"/>. </para> </listitem> @@ -1003,7 +1003,7 @@ Branch: REL_10_STABLE [5159626af] 2017-11-03 14:14:16 -0400 2017-01-04 [9a4d51077] Make wal streaming the default mode for pg_basebackup --> <para> - Make <application><xref linkend="app-pgbasebackup"></application> stream the + Make <application><xref linkend="app-pgbasebackup"/></application> stream the <acronym>WAL</acronym> needed to restore the backup by default (Magnus Hagander) </para> @@ -1043,7 +1043,7 @@ Branch: REL_10_STABLE [5159626af] 2017-11-03 14:14:16 -0400 2017-01-14 [05cd12ed5] pg_ctl: Change default to wait for all actions --> <para> - Make all <application><xref linkend="app-pg-ctl"></application> actions wait + Make all <application><xref linkend="app-pg-ctl"/></application> actions wait for completion by default (Peter Eisentraut) </para> @@ -1058,7 +1058,7 @@ Branch: REL_10_STABLE [5159626af] 2017-11-03 14:14:16 -0400 2017-03-27 [3371e4d9b] Change default of log_directory to 'log' --> <para> - Change the default value of the <xref linkend="guc-log-directory"> + Change the default value of the <xref linkend="guc-log-directory"/> server parameter from <filename>pg_log</filename> to <filename>log</filename> (Andreas Karlsson) </para> @@ -1069,7 +1069,7 @@ Branch: REL_10_STABLE [5159626af] 2017-11-03 14:14:16 -0400 2017-07-31 [c0a15e07c] Always use 2048 bit DH parameters for OpenSSL ephemeral --> <para> - Add configuration option <xref linkend="guc-ssl-dh-params-file"> to + Add configuration option <xref linkend="guc-ssl-dh-params-file"/> to specify file name for custom OpenSSL DH parameters (Heikki Linnakangas) </para> @@ -1098,7 +1098,7 @@ Branch: REL_10_STABLE [5159626af] 2017-11-03 14:14:16 -0400 DH parameters longer than 1024 bits, and hence will not be able to connect over SSL. If it's necessary to support such old clients, you can use custom 1024-bit DH parameters instead of the compiled-in - defaults. See <xref linkend="guc-ssl-dh-params-file">. + defaults. See <xref linkend="guc-ssl-dh-params-file"/>. </para> </listitem> @@ -1112,7 +1112,7 @@ Branch: REL_10_STABLE [5159626af] 2017-11-03 14:14:16 -0400 </para> <para> - The <xref linkend="guc-password-encryption"> server parameter + The <xref linkend="guc-password-encryption"/> server parameter no longer supports <literal>off</literal> or <literal>plain</literal>. The <literal>UNENCRYPTED</literal> option is no longer supported in <command>CREATE/ALTER USER ... PASSWORD</command>. Similarly, the @@ -1129,8 +1129,8 @@ Branch: REL_10_STABLE [5159626af] 2017-11-03 14:14:16 -0400 2017-02-15 [51ee6f316] Replace min_parallel_relation_size with two new GUCs. --> <para> - Add <xref linkend="guc-min-parallel-table-scan-size"> - and <xref linkend="guc-min-parallel-index-scan-size"> server + Add <xref linkend="guc-min-parallel-table-scan-size"/> + and <xref linkend="guc-min-parallel-index-scan-size"/> server parameters to control parallel queries (Amit Kapila, Robert Haas) </para> @@ -1146,7 +1146,7 @@ Branch: REL_10_STABLE [5159626af] 2017-11-03 14:14:16 -0400 --> <para> Don't downcase unquoted text - within <xref linkend="guc-shared-preload-libraries"> and related + within <xref linkend="guc-shared-preload-libraries"/> and related server parameters (QL Zhuo) </para> @@ -1205,8 +1205,8 @@ Branch: REL_10_STABLE [5159626af] 2017-11-03 14:14:16 -0400 <para> This functionality has been replaced by new server - parameters <xref linkend="guc-pltcl-start-proc"> - and <xref linkend="guc-pltclu-start-proc">, which are easier to use + parameters <xref linkend="guc-pltcl-start-proc"/> + and <xref linkend="guc-pltclu-start-proc"/>, which are easier to use and more similar to features available in other PLs. </para> </listitem> @@ -1398,14 +1398,14 @@ Branch: REL_10_STABLE [5159626af] 2017-11-03 14:14:16 -0400 2016-12-05 [2b959d495] Reduce the default for max_worker_processes back to 8. --> <para> - Add <xref linkend="guc-max-parallel-workers"> server parameter + Add <xref linkend="guc-max-parallel-workers"/> server parameter to limit the number of worker processes that can be used for query parallelism (Julien Rouhaud) </para> <para> This parameter can be set lower than <xref - linkend="guc-max-worker-processes"> to reserve worker processes + linkend="guc-max-worker-processes"/> to reserve worker processes for purposes other than parallel queries. </para> </listitem> @@ -1548,7 +1548,7 @@ Branch: REL_10_STABLE [5159626af] 2017-11-03 14:14:16 -0400 <para> For example, changing a table's <xref - linkend="guc-effective-io-concurrency"> setting can now be done + linkend="guc-effective-io-concurrency"/> setting can now be done with a more lightweight lock. </para> </listitem> @@ -1565,8 +1565,8 @@ Branch: REL_10_STABLE [5159626af] 2017-11-03 14:14:16 -0400 <para> Lock promotion can now be controlled through two new server parameters, <xref - linkend="guc-max-pred-locks-per-relation"> and - <xref linkend="guc-max-pred-locks-per-page">. + linkend="guc-max-pred-locks-per-relation"/> and + <xref linkend="guc-max-pred-locks-per-page"/>. </para> </listitem> @@ -1768,7 +1768,7 @@ Branch: REL_10_STABLE [5159626af] 2017-11-03 14:14:16 -0400 2016-10-17 [7d3235ba4] By default, set log_line_prefix = '%m [%p] '. --> <para> - Change the default value of <xref linkend="guc-log-line-prefix"> + Change the default value of <xref linkend="guc-log-line-prefix"/> to include current timestamp (with milliseconds) and the process ID in each line of postmaster log output (Christoph Berg) </para> @@ -1845,12 +1845,12 @@ Branch: REL_10_STABLE [5159626af] 2017-11-03 14:14:16 -0400 <para> Reduce message verbosity of lower-numbered debug levels controlled by - <xref linkend="guc-log-min-messages"> (Robert Haas) + <xref linkend="guc-log-min-messages"/> (Robert Haas) </para> <para> This also changes the verbosity of <xref - linkend="guc-client-min-messages"> debug levels. + linkend="guc-client-min-messages"/> debug levels. </para> </listitem> @@ -1957,7 +1957,7 @@ Branch: REL_10_STABLE [5159626af] 2017-11-03 14:14:16 -0400 2016-09-28 [babe05bc2] Turn password_encryption GUC into an enum. --> <para> - Change the <xref linkend="guc-password-encryption"> server parameter + Change the <xref linkend="guc-password-encryption"/> server parameter from <type>boolean</type> to <type>enum</type> (Michael Paquier) </para> @@ -2034,7 +2034,7 @@ Branch: REL_10_STABLE [5159626af] 2017-11-03 14:14:16 -0400 --> <para> Make the maximum value of <xref - linkend="guc-bgwriter-lru-maxpages"> effectively unlimited + linkend="guc-bgwriter-lru-maxpages"/> effectively unlimited (Jim Nasby) </para> </listitem> @@ -2085,7 +2085,7 @@ Branch: REL_10_STABLE [5159626af] 2017-11-03 14:14:16 -0400 2017-03-14 [bb4a39637] hash: Support WAL consistency checking. --> <para> - Add <xref linkend="guc-wal-consistency-checking"> server parameter + Add <xref linkend="guc-wal-consistency-checking"/> server parameter to add details to <acronym>WAL</acronym> that can be sanity-checked on the standby (Kuntal Ghosh, Robert Haas) </para> @@ -2106,7 +2106,7 @@ Branch: REL_10_STABLE [5159626af] 2017-11-03 14:14:16 -0400 <para> A larger <acronym>WAL</acronym> segment size allows for fewer - <xref linkend="guc-archive-command"> invocations and fewer + <xref linkend="guc-archive-command"/> invocations and fewer <acronym>WAL</acronym> files to manage. </para> </listitem> @@ -2150,7 +2150,7 @@ Branch: REL_10_STABLE [5159626af] 2017-11-03 14:14:16 -0400 <para> Allow waiting for commit acknowledgement from standby servers irrespective of the order they appear in <xref - linkend="guc-synchronous-standby-names"> (Masahiko Sawada) + linkend="guc-synchronous-standby-names"/> (Masahiko Sawada) </para> <para> @@ -2174,9 +2174,9 @@ Branch: REL_10_STABLE [5159626af] 2017-11-03 14:14:16 -0400 <para> Specifically, the defaults were changed for <xref - linkend="guc-wal-level">, <xref linkend="guc-max-wal-senders">, - <xref linkend="guc-max-replication-slots">, and <xref - linkend="guc-hot-standby"> to make them suitable for these usages + linkend="guc-wal-level"/>, <xref linkend="guc-max-wal-senders"/>, + <xref linkend="guc-max-replication-slots"/>, and <xref + linkend="guc-hot-standby"/> to make them suitable for these usages out-of-the-box. </para> </listitem> @@ -2194,7 +2194,7 @@ Branch: REL_10_STABLE [5159626af] 2017-11-03 14:14:16 -0400 <para> Previously <filename>pg_hba.conf</filename>'s replication connection lines were commented out by default. This is particularly useful for - <application><xref linkend="app-pgbasebackup"></application>. + <application><xref linkend="app-pgbasebackup"/></application>. </para> </listitem> @@ -2497,7 +2497,7 @@ Branch: REL_10_STABLE [5159626af] 2017-11-03 14:14:16 -0400 <para> This information is also included in <xref - linkend="guc-log-autovacuum-min-duration"> output. + linkend="guc-log-autovacuum-min-duration"/> output. </para> </listitem> @@ -2830,8 +2830,8 @@ Branch: REL_10_STABLE [5159626af] 2017-11-03 14:14:16 -0400 2017-03-07 [0d2b1f305] Invent start_proc parameters for PL/Tcl. --> <para> - Add server parameters <xref linkend="guc-pltcl-start-proc"> - and <xref linkend="guc-pltclu-start-proc">, to allow initialization + Add server parameters <xref linkend="guc-pltcl-start-proc"/> + and <xref linkend="guc-pltclu-start-proc"/>, to allow initialization functions to be called on PL/Tcl startup (Tom Lane) </para> </listitem> @@ -2939,7 +2939,7 @@ Branch: REL_10_STABLE [5159626af] 2017-11-03 14:14:16 -0400 <title>Client Applications</title> <sect4> - <title><xref linkend="app-psql"></title> + <title><xref linkend="app-psql"/></title> <itemizedlist> @@ -3080,7 +3080,7 @@ Branch: REL_10_STABLE [5159626af] 2017-11-03 14:14:16 -0400 </sect4> <sect4> - <title><xref linkend="pgbench"></title> + <title><xref linkend="pgbench"/></title> <itemizedlist> @@ -3258,7 +3258,7 @@ Branch: REL_10_STABLE [5159626af] 2017-11-03 14:14:16 -0400 <sect4> - <title><xref linkend="app-pgbasebackup"></title> + <title><xref linkend="app-pgbasebackup"/></title> <itemizedlist> @@ -3331,7 +3331,7 @@ Branch: REL_10_STABLE [5159626af] 2017-11-03 14:14:16 -0400 </sect4> <sect4> - <title><application><xref linkend="app-pg-ctl"></application></title> + <title><application><xref linkend="app-pg-ctl"/></application></title> <itemizedlist> @@ -3340,7 +3340,7 @@ Branch: REL_10_STABLE [5159626af] 2017-11-03 14:14:16 -0400 2016-09-21 [e7010ce47] pg_ctl: Add wait option to promote action --> <para> - Add wait option for <application><xref linkend="app-pg-ctl"></application>'s + Add wait option for <application><xref linkend="app-pg-ctl"/></application>'s promote operation (Peter Eisentraut) </para> </listitem> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/release-7.4.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/release-7.4.sgml index bdbfe8e0063..a67945a42b5 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/release-7.4.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/release-7.4.sgml @@ -12,7 +12,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 7.4.29. For information about new features in the 7.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-7-4">. + <xref linkend="release-7-4"/>. </para> <para> @@ -27,7 +27,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 7.4.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 7.4.26, - see <xref linkend="release-7-4-26">. + see <xref linkend="release-7-4-26"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -146,7 +146,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 7.4.28. For information about new features in the 7.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-7-4">. + <xref linkend="release-7-4"/>. </para> <para> @@ -161,7 +161,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 7.4.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 7.4.26, - see <xref linkend="release-7-4-26">. + see <xref linkend="release-7-4-26"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -290,7 +290,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 7.4.27. For information about new features in the 7.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-7-4">. + <xref linkend="release-7-4"/>. </para> <para> @@ -305,7 +305,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 7.4.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 7.4.26, - see <xref linkend="release-7-4-26">. + see <xref linkend="release-7-4-26"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -409,7 +409,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 7.4.26. For information about new features in the 7.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-7-4">. + <xref linkend="release-7-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -418,7 +418,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 7.4.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 7.4.26, - see <xref linkend="release-7-4-26">. + see <xref linkend="release-7-4-26"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -529,7 +529,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 7.4.25. For information about new features in the 7.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-7-4">. + <xref linkend="release-7-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -540,7 +540,7 @@ However, if you have any hash indexes on <type>interval</type> columns, you must <command>REINDEX</command> them after updating to 7.4.26. Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 7.4.11, - see <xref linkend="release-7-4-11">. + see <xref linkend="release-7-4-11"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -659,7 +659,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 7.4.24. For information about new features in the 7.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-7-4">. + <xref linkend="release-7-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -668,7 +668,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 7.4.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 7.4.11, - see <xref linkend="release-7-4-11">. + see <xref linkend="release-7-4-11"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -739,7 +739,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 7.4.23. For information about new features in the 7.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-7-4">. + <xref linkend="release-7-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -748,7 +748,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 7.4.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 7.4.11, - see <xref linkend="release-7-4-11">. + see <xref linkend="release-7-4-11"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -825,7 +825,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 7.4.22. For information about new features in the 7.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-7-4">. + <xref linkend="release-7-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -834,7 +834,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 7.4.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 7.4.11, - see <xref linkend="release-7-4-11">. + see <xref linkend="release-7-4-11"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -909,7 +909,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 7.4.21. For information about new features in the 7.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-7-4">. + <xref linkend="release-7-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -918,7 +918,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 7.4.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 7.4.11, - see <xref linkend="release-7-4-11">. + see <xref linkend="release-7-4-11"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -985,7 +985,7 @@ <para> This release contains one serious bug fix over 7.4.20. For information about new features in the 7.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-7-4">. + <xref linkend="release-7-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -994,7 +994,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 7.4.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 7.4.11, - see <xref linkend="release-7-4-11">. + see <xref linkend="release-7-4-11"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1039,7 +1039,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 7.4.19. For information about new features in the 7.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-7-4">. + <xref linkend="release-7-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1048,7 +1048,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 7.4.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 7.4.11, - see <xref linkend="release-7-4-11">. + see <xref linkend="release-7-4-11"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1185,7 +1185,7 @@ This release contains a variety of fixes from 7.4.18, including fixes for significant security issues. For information about new features in the 7.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-7-4">. + <xref linkend="release-7-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1194,7 +1194,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 7.4.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 7.4.11, - see <xref linkend="release-7-4-11">. + see <xref linkend="release-7-4-11"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1338,7 +1338,7 @@ <para> This release contains fixes from 7.4.17. For information about new features in the 7.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-7-4">. + <xref linkend="release-7-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1347,7 +1347,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 7.4.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 7.4.11, - see <xref linkend="release-7-4-11">. + see <xref linkend="release-7-4-11"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1415,7 +1415,7 @@ This release contains fixes from 7.4.16, including a security fix. For information about new features in the 7.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-7-4">. + <xref linkend="release-7-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1424,7 +1424,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 7.4.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 7.4.11, - see <xref linkend="release-7-4-11">. + see <xref linkend="release-7-4-11"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1486,7 +1486,7 @@ This release contains a variety of fixes from 7.4.15, including a security fix. For information about new features in the 7.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-7-4">. + <xref linkend="release-7-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1495,7 +1495,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 7.4.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 7.4.11, - see <xref linkend="release-7-4-11">. + see <xref linkend="release-7-4-11"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1556,7 +1556,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 7.4.14. For information about new features in the 7.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-7-4">. + <xref linkend="release-7-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1565,7 +1565,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 7.4.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 7.4.11, - see <xref linkend="release-7-4-11">. + see <xref linkend="release-7-4-11"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1645,7 +1645,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 7.4.13. For information about new features in the 7.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-7-4">. + <xref linkend="release-7-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1654,7 +1654,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 7.4.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 7.4.11, - see <xref linkend="release-7-4-11">. + see <xref linkend="release-7-4-11"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1693,7 +1693,7 @@ ANYARRAY</para></listitem> This release contains a variety of fixes from 7.4.12, including patches for extremely serious security issues. For information about new features in the 7.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-7-4">. + <xref linkend="release-7-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1702,7 +1702,7 @@ ANYARRAY</para></listitem> <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 7.4.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 7.4.11, - see <xref linkend="release-7-4-11">. + see <xref linkend="release-7-4-11"/>. </para> <para> @@ -1799,7 +1799,7 @@ Fuhr)</para></listitem> <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 7.4.11. For information about new features in the 7.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-7-4">. + <xref linkend="release-7-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1808,7 +1808,7 @@ Fuhr)</para></listitem> <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 7.4.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 7.4.11, - see <xref linkend="release-7-4-11">. + see <xref linkend="release-7-4-11"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1862,7 +1862,7 @@ and <function>isinf</function> during configure (Tom)</para></listitem> <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 7.4.10. For information about new features in the 7.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-7-4">. + <xref linkend="release-7-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1871,7 +1871,7 @@ and <function>isinf</function> during configure (Tom)</para></listitem> <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 7.4.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 7.4.8, - see <xref linkend="release-7-4-8">. + see <xref linkend="release-7-4-8"/>. Also, you might need to <command>REINDEX</command> indexes on textual columns after updating, if you are affected by the locale or <application>plperl</application> issues described below. @@ -1929,7 +1929,7 @@ what's actually returned by the query (Joe)</para></listitem> <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 7.4.9. For information about new features in the 7.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-7-4">. + <xref linkend="release-7-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1938,7 +1938,7 @@ what's actually returned by the query (Joe)</para></listitem> <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 7.4.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 7.4.8, - see <xref linkend="release-7-4-8">. + see <xref linkend="release-7-4-8"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1982,7 +1982,7 @@ table has been dropped</para></listitem> <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 7.4.8. For information about new features in the 7.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-7-4">. + <xref linkend="release-7-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1991,7 +1991,7 @@ table has been dropped</para></listitem> <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 7.4.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 7.4.8, - see <xref linkend="release-7-4-8">. + see <xref linkend="release-7-4-8"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2052,7 +2052,7 @@ code</para></listitem> This release contains a variety of fixes from 7.4.7, including several security-related issues. For information about new features in the 7.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-7-4">. + <xref linkend="release-7-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2236,7 +2236,7 @@ holder of the lock released it within a very narrow window. This release contains a variety of fixes from 7.4.6, including several security-related issues. For information about new features in the 7.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-7-4">. + <xref linkend="release-7-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2295,7 +2295,7 @@ GMT</para></listitem> <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 7.4.5. For information about new features in the 7.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-7-4">. + <xref linkend="release-7-4"/>. </para> @@ -2367,7 +2367,7 @@ ECPG prepare statement</para></listitem> <para> This release contains one serious bug fix over 7.4.4. For information about new features in the 7.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-7-4">. + <xref linkend="release-7-4"/>. </para> @@ -2405,7 +2405,7 @@ still worth a re-release. The bug does not exist in pre-7.4 releases. <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 7.4.3. For information about new features in the 7.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-7-4">. + <xref linkend="release-7-4"/>. </para> @@ -2457,7 +2457,7 @@ aggregate plan</para></listitem> <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 7.4.2. For information about new features in the 7.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-7-4">. + <xref linkend="release-7-4"/>. </para> @@ -2515,7 +2515,7 @@ names from outer query levels. <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 7.4.1. For information about new features in the 7.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-7-4">. + <xref linkend="release-7-4"/>. </para> @@ -2658,7 +2658,7 @@ inconveniences associated with the <literal>i/I</literal> problem.</para></listi <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 7.4. For information about new features in the 7.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-7-4">. + <xref linkend="release-7-4"/>. </para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/release-8.0.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/release-8.0.sgml index 46ca87e93aa..6171e0d1eee 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/release-8.0.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/release-8.0.sgml @@ -12,7 +12,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.0.25. For information about new features in the 8.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-0">. + <xref linkend="release-8-0"/>. </para> <para> @@ -27,7 +27,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.0.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.0.22, - see <xref linkend="release-8-0-22">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-0-22"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -216,7 +216,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.0.24. For information about new features in the 8.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-0">. + <xref linkend="release-8-0"/>. </para> <para> @@ -231,7 +231,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.0.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.0.22, - see <xref linkend="release-8-0-22">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-0-22"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -376,7 +376,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.0.23. For information about new features in the 8.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-0">. + <xref linkend="release-8-0"/>. </para> <para> @@ -391,7 +391,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.0.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.0.22, - see <xref linkend="release-8-0-22">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-0-22"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -553,7 +553,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.0.22. For information about new features in the 8.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-0">. + <xref linkend="release-8-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -562,7 +562,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.0.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.0.22, - see <xref linkend="release-8-0-22">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-0-22"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -708,7 +708,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.0.21. For information about new features in the 8.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-0">. + <xref linkend="release-8-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -719,7 +719,7 @@ However, if you have any hash indexes on <type>interval</type> columns, you must <command>REINDEX</command> them after updating to 8.0.22. Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.0.6, - see <xref linkend="release-8-0-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-0-6"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -872,7 +872,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.0.20. For information about new features in the 8.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-0">. + <xref linkend="release-8-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -881,7 +881,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.0.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.0.6, - see <xref linkend="release-8-0-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-0-6"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -952,7 +952,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.0.19. For information about new features in the 8.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-0">. + <xref linkend="release-8-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -961,7 +961,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.0.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.0.6, - see <xref linkend="release-8-0-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-0-6"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1038,7 +1038,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.0.18. For information about new features in the 8.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-0">. + <xref linkend="release-8-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1047,7 +1047,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.0.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.0.6, - see <xref linkend="release-8-0-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-0-6"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1149,7 +1149,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.0.17. For information about new features in the 8.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-0">. + <xref linkend="release-8-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1158,7 +1158,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.0.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.0.6, - see <xref linkend="release-8-0-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-0-6"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1283,7 +1283,7 @@ <para> This release contains one serious bug fix over 8.0.16. For information about new features in the 8.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-0">. + <xref linkend="release-8-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1292,7 +1292,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.0.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.0.6, - see <xref linkend="release-8-0-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-0-6"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1337,7 +1337,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.0.15. For information about new features in the 8.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-0">. + <xref linkend="release-8-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1346,7 +1346,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.0.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.0.6, - see <xref linkend="release-8-0-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-0-6"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1575,7 +1575,7 @@ This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.0.14, including fixes for significant security issues. For information about new features in the 8.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-0">. + <xref linkend="release-8-0"/>. </para> <para> @@ -1593,7 +1593,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.0.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.0.6, - see <xref linkend="release-8-0-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-0-6"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1790,7 +1790,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.0.13. For information about new features in the 8.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-0">. + <xref linkend="release-8-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1799,7 +1799,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.0.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.0.6, - see <xref linkend="release-8-0-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-0-6"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1899,7 +1899,7 @@ This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.0.12, including a security fix. For information about new features in the 8.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-0">. + <xref linkend="release-8-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1908,7 +1908,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.0.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.0.6, - see <xref linkend="release-8-0-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-0-6"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1975,7 +1975,7 @@ <para> This release contains one fix from 8.0.11. For information about new features in the 8.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-0">. + <xref linkend="release-8-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1984,7 +1984,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.0.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.0.6, - see <xref linkend="release-8-0-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-0-6"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2018,7 +2018,7 @@ This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.0.10, including a security fix. For information about new features in the 8.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-0">. + <xref linkend="release-8-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2027,7 +2027,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.0.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.0.6, - see <xref linkend="release-8-0-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-0-6"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2088,7 +2088,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.0.9. For information about new features in the 8.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-0">. + <xref linkend="release-8-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2097,7 +2097,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.0.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.0.6, - see <xref linkend="release-8-0-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-0-6"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2207,7 +2207,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.0.8. For information about new features in the 8.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-0">. + <xref linkend="release-8-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2216,7 +2216,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.0.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.0.6, - see <xref linkend="release-8-0-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-0-6"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2264,7 +2264,7 @@ Wieland)</para></listitem> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.0.7, including patches for extremely serious security issues. For information about new features in the 8.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-0">. + <xref linkend="release-8-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2273,7 +2273,7 @@ Wieland)</para></listitem> <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.0.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.0.6, - see <xref linkend="release-8-0-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-0-6"/>. </para> <para> @@ -2377,7 +2377,7 @@ Fuhr)</para></listitem> <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.0.6. For information about new features in the 8.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-0">. + <xref linkend="release-8-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2386,7 +2386,7 @@ Fuhr)</para></listitem> <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.0.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.0.6, - see <xref linkend="release-8-0-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-0-6"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2476,7 +2476,7 @@ and <function>isinf</function> during configure (Tom)</para></listitem> <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.0.5. For information about new features in the 8.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-0">. + <xref linkend="release-8-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2485,7 +2485,7 @@ and <function>isinf</function> during configure (Tom)</para></listitem> <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.0.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.0.3, - see <xref linkend="release-8-0-3">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-0-3"/>. Also, you might need to <command>REINDEX</command> indexes on textual columns after updating, if you are affected by the locale or <application>plperl</application> issues described below. @@ -2561,7 +2561,7 @@ what's actually returned by the query (Joe)</para></listitem> <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.0.4. For information about new features in the 8.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-0">. + <xref linkend="release-8-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2570,7 +2570,7 @@ what's actually returned by the query (Joe)</para></listitem> <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.0.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.0.3, - see <xref linkend="release-8-0-3">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-0-3"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2643,7 +2643,7 @@ to subquery results</para></listitem> <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.0.3. For information about new features in the 8.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-0">. + <xref linkend="release-8-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2652,7 +2652,7 @@ to subquery results</para></listitem> <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.0.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.0.3, - see <xref linkend="release-8-0-3">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-0-3"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2741,7 +2741,7 @@ code</para></listitem> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.0.2, including several security-related issues. For information about new features in the 8.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-0">. + <xref linkend="release-8-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2860,7 +2860,7 @@ data types</para></listitem> <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.0.1. For information about new features in the 8.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-0">. + <xref linkend="release-8-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -3018,7 +3018,7 @@ addresses in <type>INET</type> data types (Tom)</para></listitem> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.0.0, including several security-related issues. For information about new features in the 8.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-0">. + <xref linkend="release-8-0"/>. </para> <sect2> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/release-8.1.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/release-8.1.sgml index 6827afd7e00..44a30892fdb 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/release-8.1.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/release-8.1.sgml @@ -12,7 +12,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.1.22. For information about new features in the 8.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-1">. + <xref linkend="release-8-1"/>. </para> <para> @@ -27,7 +27,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.1.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.1.18, - see <xref linkend="release-8-1-18">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-1-18"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -231,7 +231,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.1.21. For information about new features in the 8.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-1">. + <xref linkend="release-8-1"/>. </para> <para> @@ -246,7 +246,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.1.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.1.18, - see <xref linkend="release-8-1-18">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-1-18"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -449,7 +449,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.1.20. For information about new features in the 8.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-1">. + <xref linkend="release-8-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -458,7 +458,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.1.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.1.18, - see <xref linkend="release-8-1-18">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-1-18"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -603,7 +603,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.1.19. For information about new features in the 8.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-1">. + <xref linkend="release-8-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -612,7 +612,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.1.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.1.18, - see <xref linkend="release-8-1-18">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-1-18"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -793,7 +793,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.1.18. For information about new features in the 8.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-1">. + <xref linkend="release-8-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -802,7 +802,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.1.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.1.18, - see <xref linkend="release-8-1-18">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-1-18"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -974,7 +974,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.1.17. For information about new features in the 8.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-1">. + <xref linkend="release-8-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -985,7 +985,7 @@ However, if you have any hash indexes on <type>interval</type> columns, you must <command>REINDEX</command> them after updating to 8.1.18. Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.1.15, - see <xref linkend="release-8-1-15">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-1-15"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1138,7 +1138,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.1.16. For information about new features in the 8.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-1">. + <xref linkend="release-8-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1147,7 +1147,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.1.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.1.15, - see <xref linkend="release-8-1-15">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-1-15"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1261,7 +1261,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.1.15. For information about new features in the 8.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-1">. + <xref linkend="release-8-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1270,7 +1270,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.1.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.1.15, - see <xref linkend="release-8-1-15">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-1-15"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1381,7 +1381,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.1.14. For information about new features in the 8.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-1">. + <xref linkend="release-8-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1390,7 +1390,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.1.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.1.2, - see <xref linkend="release-8-1-2">. Also, if you were running a previous + see <xref linkend="release-8-1-2"/>. Also, if you were running a previous 8.1.X release, it is recommended to <command>REINDEX</command> all GiST indexes after the upgrade. </para> @@ -1533,7 +1533,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.1.13. For information about new features in the 8.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-1">. + <xref linkend="release-8-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1542,7 +1542,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.1.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.1.2, - see <xref linkend="release-8-1-2">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-1-2"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1709,7 +1709,7 @@ <para> This release contains one serious and one minor bug fix over 8.1.12. For information about new features in the 8.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-1">. + <xref linkend="release-8-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1718,7 +1718,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.1.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.1.2, - see <xref linkend="release-8-1-2">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-1-2"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1776,7 +1776,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.1.11. For information about new features in the 8.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-1">. + <xref linkend="release-8-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1785,7 +1785,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.1.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.1.2, - see <xref linkend="release-8-1-2">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-1-2"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2027,7 +2027,7 @@ This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.1.10, including fixes for significant security issues. For information about new features in the 8.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-1">. + <xref linkend="release-8-1"/>. </para> <para> @@ -2045,7 +2045,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.1.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.1.2, - see <xref linkend="release-8-1-2">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-1-2"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2278,7 +2278,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.1.9. For information about new features in the 8.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-1">. + <xref linkend="release-8-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2287,7 +2287,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.1.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.1.2, - see <xref linkend="release-8-1-2">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-1-2"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2400,7 +2400,7 @@ This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.1.8, including a security fix. For information about new features in the 8.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-1">. + <xref linkend="release-8-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2409,7 +2409,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.1.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.1.2, - see <xref linkend="release-8-1-2">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-1-2"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2490,7 +2490,7 @@ <para> This release contains one fix from 8.1.7. For information about new features in the 8.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-1">. + <xref linkend="release-8-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2499,7 +2499,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.1.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.1.2, - see <xref linkend="release-8-1-2">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-1-2"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2533,7 +2533,7 @@ This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.1.6, including a security fix. For information about new features in the 8.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-1">. + <xref linkend="release-8-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2542,7 +2542,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.1.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.1.2, - see <xref linkend="release-8-1-2">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-1-2"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2634,7 +2634,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.1.5. For information about new features in the 8.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-1">. + <xref linkend="release-8-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2643,7 +2643,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.1.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.1.2, - see <xref linkend="release-8-1-2">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-1-2"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2784,7 +2784,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.1.4. For information about new features in the 8.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-1">. + <xref linkend="release-8-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2793,7 +2793,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.1.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.1.2, - see <xref linkend="release-8-1-2">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-1-2"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2862,7 +2862,7 @@ compilers (Hiroshi Saito)</para></listitem> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.1.3, including patches for extremely serious security issues. For information about new features in the 8.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-1">. + <xref linkend="release-8-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2871,7 +2871,7 @@ compilers (Hiroshi Saito)</para></listitem> <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.1.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.1.2, - see <xref linkend="release-8-1-2">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-1-2"/>. </para> <para> @@ -3016,7 +3016,7 @@ documented (Tom)</para></listitem> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.1.2, including one very serious security issue. For information about new features in the 8.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-1">. + <xref linkend="release-8-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -3025,7 +3025,7 @@ documented (Tom)</para></listitem> <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.1.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.1.2, - see <xref linkend="release-8-1-2">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-1-2"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -3137,7 +3137,7 @@ creation (Tom)</para></listitem> <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.1.1. For information about new features in the 8.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-1">. + <xref linkend="release-8-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -3240,7 +3240,7 @@ what's actually returned by the query (Joe)</para></listitem> <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.1.0. For information about new features in the 8.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-1">. + <xref linkend="release-8-1"/>. </para> <sect2> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/release-8.2.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/release-8.2.sgml index 39666e665be..51239f9b9d9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/release-8.2.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/release-8.2.sgml @@ -12,7 +12,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.2.22. For information about new features in the 8.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-2">. + <xref linkend="release-8-2"/>. </para> <para> @@ -37,7 +37,7 @@ <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.2.14, - see <xref linkend="release-8-2-14">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-2-14"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -240,7 +240,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.2.21. For information about new features in the 8.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-2">. + <xref linkend="release-8-2"/>. </para> <para> @@ -255,7 +255,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.2.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.2.14, - see <xref linkend="release-8-2-14">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-2-14"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -547,7 +547,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.2.20. For information about new features in the 8.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-2">. + <xref linkend="release-8-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -556,7 +556,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.2.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.2.14, - see <xref linkend="release-8-2-14">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-2-14"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -679,7 +679,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.2.19. For information about new features in the 8.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-2">. + <xref linkend="release-8-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -688,7 +688,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.2.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.2.14, - see <xref linkend="release-8-2-14">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-2-14"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -811,7 +811,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.2.18. For information about new features in the 8.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-2">. + <xref linkend="release-8-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -820,7 +820,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.2.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.2.14, - see <xref linkend="release-8-2-14">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-2-14"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1055,7 +1055,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.2.17. For information about new features in the 8.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-2">. + <xref linkend="release-8-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1064,7 +1064,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.2.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.2.14, - see <xref linkend="release-8-2-14">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-2-14"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1341,7 +1341,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.2.16. For information about new features in the 8.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-2">. + <xref linkend="release-8-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1350,7 +1350,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.2.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.2.14, - see <xref linkend="release-8-2-14">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-2-14"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1542,7 +1542,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.2.15. For information about new features in the 8.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-2">. + <xref linkend="release-8-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1551,7 +1551,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.2.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.2.14, - see <xref linkend="release-8-2-14">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-2-14"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1813,7 +1813,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.2.14. For information about new features in the 8.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-2">. + <xref linkend="release-8-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1822,7 +1822,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.2.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.2.14, - see <xref linkend="release-8-2-14">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-2-14"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2057,7 +2057,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.2.13. For information about new features in the 8.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-2">. + <xref linkend="release-8-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2068,7 +2068,7 @@ However, if you have any hash indexes on <type>interval</type> columns, you must <command>REINDEX</command> them after updating to 8.2.14. Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.2.11, - see <xref linkend="release-8-2-11">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-2-11"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2287,7 +2287,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.2.12. For information about new features in the 8.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-2">. + <xref linkend="release-8-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2296,7 +2296,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.2.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.2.11, - see <xref linkend="release-8-2-11">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-2-11"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2453,7 +2453,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.2.11. For information about new features in the 8.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-2">. + <xref linkend="release-8-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2462,7 +2462,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.2.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.2.11, - see <xref linkend="release-8-2-11">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-2-11"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2632,7 +2632,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.2.10. For information about new features in the 8.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-2">. + <xref linkend="release-8-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2641,7 +2641,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.2.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.2.7, - see <xref linkend="release-8-2-7">. Also, if you were running a previous + see <xref linkend="release-8-2-7"/>. Also, if you were running a previous 8.2.X release, it is recommended to <command>REINDEX</command> all GiST indexes after the upgrade. </para> @@ -2816,7 +2816,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.2.9. For information about new features in the 8.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-2">. + <xref linkend="release-8-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2825,7 +2825,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.2.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.2.7, - see <xref linkend="release-8-2-7">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-2-7"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -3048,7 +3048,7 @@ <para> This release contains one serious and one minor bug fix over 8.2.8. For information about new features in the 8.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-2">. + <xref linkend="release-8-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -3057,7 +3057,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.2.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.2.7, - see <xref linkend="release-8-2-7">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-2-7"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -3115,7 +3115,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.2.7. For information about new features in the 8.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-2">. + <xref linkend="release-8-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -3124,7 +3124,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.2.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.2.7, - see <xref linkend="release-8-2-7">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-2-7"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -3310,7 +3310,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.2.6. For information about new features in the 8.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-2">. + <xref linkend="release-8-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -3580,7 +3580,7 @@ This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.2.5, including fixes for significant security issues. For information about new features in the 8.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-2">. + <xref linkend="release-8-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -3870,7 +3870,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.2.4. For information about new features in the 8.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-2">. + <xref linkend="release-8-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -4048,7 +4048,7 @@ This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.2.3, including a security fix. For information about new features in the 8.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-2">. + <xref linkend="release-8-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -4191,7 +4191,7 @@ <para> This release contains two fixes from 8.2.2. For information about new features in the 8.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-2">. + <xref linkend="release-8-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -4238,7 +4238,7 @@ This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.2.1, including a security fix. For information about new features in the 8.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-2">. + <xref linkend="release-8-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -4395,7 +4395,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.2. For information about new features in the 8.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-2">. + <xref linkend="release-8-2"/>. </para> <sect2> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/release-8.3.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/release-8.3.sgml index 844f7961794..2e10bc49827 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/release-8.3.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/release-8.3.sgml @@ -12,7 +12,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.3.22. For information about new features in the 8.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-3">. + <xref linkend="release-8-3"/>. </para> <para> @@ -30,7 +30,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.3.17, - see <xref linkend="release-8-3-17">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-3-17"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -181,7 +181,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.3.21. For information about new features in the 8.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-3">. + <xref linkend="release-8-3"/>. </para> <para> @@ -199,7 +199,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.3.17, - see <xref linkend="release-8-3-17">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-3-17"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -477,7 +477,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.3.20. For information about new features in the 8.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-3">. + <xref linkend="release-8-3"/>. </para> <para> @@ -495,7 +495,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.3.17, - see <xref linkend="release-8-3-17">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-3-17"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -587,7 +587,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.3.19. For information about new features in the 8.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-3">. + <xref linkend="release-8-3"/>. </para> <para> @@ -605,7 +605,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.3.17, - see <xref linkend="release-8-3-17">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-3-17"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -810,7 +810,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.3.18. For information about new features in the 8.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-3">. + <xref linkend="release-8-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -822,7 +822,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.3.17, - see <xref linkend="release-8-3-17">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-3-17"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1039,7 +1039,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.3.17. For information about new features in the 8.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-3">. + <xref linkend="release-8-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1051,7 +1051,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.3.17, - see <xref linkend="release-8-3-17">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-3-17"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1327,7 +1327,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.3.16. For information about new features in the 8.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-3">. + <xref linkend="release-8-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1346,7 +1346,7 @@ <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.3.8, - see <xref linkend="release-8-3-8">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-3-8"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1594,7 +1594,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.3.15. For information about new features in the 8.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-3">. + <xref linkend="release-8-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1603,7 +1603,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.3.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.3.8, - see <xref linkend="release-8-3-8">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-3-8"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1965,7 +1965,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.3.14. For information about new features in the 8.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-3">. + <xref linkend="release-8-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1974,7 +1974,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.3.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.3.8, - see <xref linkend="release-8-3-8">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-3-8"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2128,7 +2128,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.3.13. For information about new features in the 8.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-3">. + <xref linkend="release-8-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2137,7 +2137,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.3.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.3.8, - see <xref linkend="release-8-3-8">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-3-8"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2260,7 +2260,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.3.12. For information about new features in the 8.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-3">. + <xref linkend="release-8-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2269,7 +2269,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.3.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.3.8, - see <xref linkend="release-8-3-8">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-3-8"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2538,7 +2538,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.3.11. For information about new features in the 8.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-3">. + <xref linkend="release-8-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2547,7 +2547,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.3.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.3.8, - see <xref linkend="release-8-3-8">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-3-8"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2901,7 +2901,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.3.10. For information about new features in the 8.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-3">. + <xref linkend="release-8-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2910,7 +2910,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.3.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.3.8, - see <xref linkend="release-8-3-8">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-3-8"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -3130,7 +3130,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.3.9. For information about new features in the 8.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-3">. + <xref linkend="release-8-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -3139,7 +3139,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.3.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.3.8, - see <xref linkend="release-8-3-8">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-3-8"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -3457,7 +3457,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.3.8. For information about new features in the 8.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-3">. + <xref linkend="release-8-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -3466,7 +3466,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.3.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.3.8, - see <xref linkend="release-8-3-8">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-3-8"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -3790,7 +3790,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.3.7. For information about new features in the 8.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-3">. + <xref linkend="release-8-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -3801,7 +3801,7 @@ However, if you have any hash indexes on <type>interval</type> columns, you must <command>REINDEX</command> them after updating to 8.3.8. Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.3.5, - see <xref linkend="release-8-3-5">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-3-5"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -4080,7 +4080,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.3.6. For information about new features in the 8.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-3">. + <xref linkend="release-8-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -4089,7 +4089,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.3.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.3.5, - see <xref linkend="release-8-3-5">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-3-5"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -4303,7 +4303,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.3.5. For information about new features in the 8.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-3">. + <xref linkend="release-8-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -4312,7 +4312,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.3.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.3.5, - see <xref linkend="release-8-3-5">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-3-5"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -4597,7 +4597,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.3.4. For information about new features in the 8.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-3">. + <xref linkend="release-8-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -4606,7 +4606,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.3.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.3.1, - see <xref linkend="release-8-3-1">. Also, if you were running a previous + see <xref linkend="release-8-3-1"/>. Also, if you were running a previous 8.3.X release, it is recommended to <command>REINDEX</command> all GiST indexes after the upgrade. </para> @@ -4852,7 +4852,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.3.3. For information about new features in the 8.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-3">. + <xref linkend="release-8-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -4861,7 +4861,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.3.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.3.1, - see <xref linkend="release-8-3-1">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-3-1"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -5206,7 +5206,7 @@ <para> This release contains one serious and one minor bug fix over 8.3.2. For information about new features in the 8.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-3">. + <xref linkend="release-8-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -5215,7 +5215,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.3.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.3.1, - see <xref linkend="release-8-3-1">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-3-1"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -5273,7 +5273,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.3.1. For information about new features in the 8.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-3">. + <xref linkend="release-8-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -5282,7 +5282,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.3.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.3.1, - see <xref linkend="release-8-3-1">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-3-1"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -5638,7 +5638,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.3.0. For information about new features in the 8.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-3">. + <xref linkend="release-8-3"/>. </para> <sect2> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/release-8.4.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/release-8.4.sgml index 521048ad93b..6e6efa3bd19 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/release-8.4.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/release-8.4.sgml @@ -12,7 +12,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.4.21. For information about new features in the 8.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-4">. + <xref linkend="release-8-4"/>. </para> <para> @@ -36,7 +36,7 @@ <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.4.19, - see <xref linkend="release-8-4-19">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-4-19"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -216,7 +216,7 @@ <listitem> <para> On Windows, allow new sessions to absorb values of PGC_BACKEND - parameters (such as <xref linkend="guc-log-connections">) from the + parameters (such as <xref linkend="guc-log-connections"/>) from the configuration file (Amit Kapila) </para> @@ -331,7 +331,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.4.20. For information about new features in the 8.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-4">. + <xref linkend="release-8-4"/>. </para> <para> @@ -349,7 +349,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.4.19, - see <xref linkend="release-8-4-19">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-4-19"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -450,7 +450,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.4.19. For information about new features in the 8.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-4">. + <xref linkend="release-8-4"/>. </para> <para> @@ -468,7 +468,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.4.19, - see <xref linkend="release-8-4-19">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-4-19"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -909,7 +909,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.4.18. For information about new features in the 8.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-4">. + <xref linkend="release-8-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -927,7 +927,7 @@ <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.4.17, - see <xref linkend="release-8-4-17">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-4-17"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1110,7 +1110,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.4.17. For information about new features in the 8.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-4">. + <xref linkend="release-8-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1122,7 +1122,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.4.17, - see <xref linkend="release-8-4-17">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-4-17"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1310,7 +1310,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.4.16. For information about new features in the 8.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-4">. + <xref linkend="release-8-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1329,7 +1329,7 @@ <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.4.10, - see <xref linkend="release-8-4-10">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-4-10"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1539,7 +1539,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.4.15. For information about new features in the 8.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-4">. + <xref linkend="release-8-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1551,7 +1551,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.4.10, - see <xref linkend="release-8-4-10">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-4-10"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1749,7 +1749,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.4.14. For information about new features in the 8.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-4">. + <xref linkend="release-8-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1761,7 +1761,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.4.10, - see <xref linkend="release-8-4-10">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-4-10"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2051,7 +2051,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.4.13. For information about new features in the 8.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-4">. + <xref linkend="release-8-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2063,7 +2063,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.4.10, - see <xref linkend="release-8-4-10">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-4-10"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2167,7 +2167,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.4.12. For information about new features in the 8.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-4">. + <xref linkend="release-8-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2179,7 +2179,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.4.10, - see <xref linkend="release-8-4-10">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-4-10"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2401,7 +2401,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.4.11. For information about new features in the 8.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-4">. + <xref linkend="release-8-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2413,7 +2413,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.4.10, - see <xref linkend="release-8-4-10">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-4-10"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2686,7 +2686,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.4.10. For information about new features in the 8.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-4">. + <xref linkend="release-8-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2698,7 +2698,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.4.10, - see <xref linkend="release-8-4-10">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-4-10"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -3048,7 +3048,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.4.9. For information about new features in the 8.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-4">. + <xref linkend="release-8-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -3067,7 +3067,7 @@ <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.4.8, - see <xref linkend="release-8-4-8">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-4-8"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -3363,7 +3363,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.4.8. For information about new features in the 8.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-4">. + <xref linkend="release-8-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -3375,7 +3375,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.4.8, - see <xref linkend="release-8-4-8">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-4-8"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -3888,7 +3888,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.4.7. For information about new features in the 8.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-4">. + <xref linkend="release-8-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -3911,7 +3911,7 @@ <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.4.2, - see <xref linkend="release-8-4-2">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-4-2"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -4133,7 +4133,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.4.6. For information about new features in the 8.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-4">. + <xref linkend="release-8-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -4142,7 +4142,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.4.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.4.2, - see <xref linkend="release-8-4-2">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-4-2"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -4265,7 +4265,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.4.5. For information about new features in the 8.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-4">. + <xref linkend="release-8-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -4274,7 +4274,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.4.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.4.2, - see <xref linkend="release-8-4-2">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-4-2"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -4576,7 +4576,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.4.4. For information about new features in the 8.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-4">. + <xref linkend="release-8-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -4585,7 +4585,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.4.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.4.2, - see <xref linkend="release-8-4-2">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-4-2"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -5098,7 +5098,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.4.3. For information about new features in the 8.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-4">. + <xref linkend="release-8-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -5107,7 +5107,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.4.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.4.2, - see <xref linkend="release-8-4-2">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-4-2"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -5389,7 +5389,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.4.2. For information about new features in the 8.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-4">. + <xref linkend="release-8-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -5398,7 +5398,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 8.4.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 8.4.2, - see <xref linkend="release-8-4-2">. + see <xref linkend="release-8-4-2"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -5856,7 +5856,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.4.1. For information about new features in the 8.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-4">. + <xref linkend="release-8-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -6387,7 +6387,7 @@ WITH w AS (SELECT * FROM foo) SELECT * FROM w, bar ... FOR UPDATE <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 8.4. For information about new features in the 8.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-8-4">. + <xref linkend="release-8-4"/>. </para> <sect2> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/release-9.0.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/release-9.0.sgml index d5b3239c30d..9e90f5a7f32 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/release-9.0.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/release-9.0.sgml @@ -12,7 +12,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.0.22. For information about new features in the 9.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-0">. + <xref linkend="release-9-0"/>. </para> <para> @@ -30,7 +30,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.0.18, - see <xref linkend="release-9-0-18">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-0-18"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -509,7 +509,7 @@ <para> This release contains a small number of fixes from 9.0.21. For information about new features in the 9.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-0">. + <xref linkend="release-9-0"/>. </para> <para> @@ -527,7 +527,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.0.18, - see <xref linkend="release-9-0-18">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-0-18"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -583,7 +583,7 @@ <para> This release contains a small number of fixes from 9.0.20. For information about new features in the 9.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-0">. + <xref linkend="release-9-0"/>. </para> <para> @@ -601,7 +601,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.0.18, - see <xref linkend="release-9-0-18">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-0-18"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -677,7 +677,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.0.19. For information about new features in the 9.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-0">. + <xref linkend="release-9-0"/>. </para> <para> @@ -695,7 +695,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.0.18, - see <xref linkend="release-9-0-18">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-0-18"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1121,7 +1121,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.0.18. For information about new features in the 9.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-0">. + <xref linkend="release-9-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1133,7 +1133,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.0.18, - see <xref linkend="release-9-0-18">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-0-18"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1847,7 +1847,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.0.17. For information about new features in the 9.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-0">. + <xref linkend="release-9-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1865,7 +1865,7 @@ <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.0.15, - see <xref linkend="release-9-0-15">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-0-15"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2069,7 +2069,7 @@ <listitem> <para> On Windows, allow new sessions to absorb values of PGC_BACKEND - parameters (such as <xref linkend="guc-log-connections">) from the + parameters (such as <xref linkend="guc-log-connections"/>) from the configuration file (Amit Kapila) </para> @@ -2193,7 +2193,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.0.16. For information about new features in the 9.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-0">. + <xref linkend="release-9-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2205,7 +2205,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.0.15, - see <xref linkend="release-9-0-15">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-0-15"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2346,7 +2346,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.0.15. For information about new features in the 9.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-0">. + <xref linkend="release-9-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2358,7 +2358,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.0.15, - see <xref linkend="release-9-0-15">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-0-15"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2847,7 +2847,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.0.14. For information about new features in the 9.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-0">. + <xref linkend="release-9-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2865,7 +2865,7 @@ <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.0.13, - see <xref linkend="release-9-0-13">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-0-13"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -3085,7 +3085,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.0.13. For information about new features in the 9.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-0">. + <xref linkend="release-9-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -3097,7 +3097,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.0.13, - see <xref linkend="release-9-0-13">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-0-13"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -3351,7 +3351,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.0.12. For information about new features in the 9.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-0">. + <xref linkend="release-9-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -3370,7 +3370,7 @@ <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.0.6, - see <xref linkend="release-9-0-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-0-6"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -3648,7 +3648,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.0.11. For information about new features in the 9.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-0">. + <xref linkend="release-9-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -3660,7 +3660,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.0.6, - see <xref linkend="release-9-0-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-0-6"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -3910,7 +3910,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.0.10. For information about new features in the 9.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-0">. + <xref linkend="release-9-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -3922,7 +3922,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.0.6, - see <xref linkend="release-9-0-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-0-6"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -4288,7 +4288,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.0.9. For information about new features in the 9.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-0">. + <xref linkend="release-9-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -4300,7 +4300,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.0.6, - see <xref linkend="release-9-0-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-0-6"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -4430,7 +4430,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.0.8. For information about new features in the 9.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-0">. + <xref linkend="release-9-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -4442,7 +4442,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.0.6, - see <xref linkend="release-9-0-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-0-6"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -4736,7 +4736,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.0.7. For information about new features in the 9.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-0">. + <xref linkend="release-9-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -4748,7 +4748,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.0.6, - see <xref linkend="release-9-0-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-0-6"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -5056,7 +5056,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.0.6. For information about new features in the 9.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-0">. + <xref linkend="release-9-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -5068,7 +5068,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.0.6, - see <xref linkend="release-9-0-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-0-6"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -5572,7 +5572,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.0.5. For information about new features in the 9.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-0">. + <xref linkend="release-9-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -5591,7 +5591,7 @@ <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.0.4, - see <xref linkend="release-9-0-4">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-0-4"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -5956,7 +5956,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.0.4. For information about new features in the 9.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-0">. + <xref linkend="release-9-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -5968,7 +5968,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.0.4, - see <xref linkend="release-9-0-4">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-0-4"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -6606,7 +6606,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.0.3. For information about new features in the 9.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-0">. + <xref linkend="release-9-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -6947,7 +6947,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.0.2. For information about new features in the 9.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-0">. + <xref linkend="release-9-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -7123,7 +7123,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.0.1. For information about new features in the 9.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-0">. + <xref linkend="release-9-0"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -7570,7 +7570,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.0.0. For information about new features in the 9.0 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-0">. + <xref linkend="release-9-0"/>. </para> <sect2> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/release-9.1.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/release-9.1.sgml index 92948a4ad02..ad5998e495e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/release-9.1.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/release-9.1.sgml @@ -12,7 +12,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.1.23. For information about new features in the 9.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-1">. + <xref linkend="release-9-1"/>. </para> <para> @@ -30,7 +30,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.1.16, - see <xref linkend="release-9-1-16">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-1-16"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -222,7 +222,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.1.22. For information about new features in the 9.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-1">. + <xref linkend="release-9-1"/>. </para> <para> @@ -240,7 +240,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.1.16, - see <xref linkend="release-9-1-16">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-1-16"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -564,7 +564,7 @@ Branch: REL9_1_STABLE [354b3a3ac] 2016-06-19 14:01:17 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.1.21. For information about new features in the 9.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-1">. + <xref linkend="release-9-1"/>. </para> <para> @@ -582,7 +582,7 @@ Branch: REL9_1_STABLE [354b3a3ac] 2016-06-19 14:01:17 -0400 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.1.16, - see <xref linkend="release-9-1-16">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-1-16"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -729,7 +729,7 @@ Branch: REL9_1_STABLE [354b3a3ac] 2016-06-19 14:01:17 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.1.20. For information about new features in the 9.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-1">. + <xref linkend="release-9-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -741,7 +741,7 @@ Branch: REL9_1_STABLE [354b3a3ac] 2016-06-19 14:01:17 -0400 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.1.16, - see <xref linkend="release-9-1-16">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-1-16"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -935,7 +935,7 @@ Branch: REL9_1_STABLE [354b3a3ac] 2016-06-19 14:01:17 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.1.19. For information about new features in the 9.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-1">. + <xref linkend="release-9-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -947,7 +947,7 @@ Branch: REL9_1_STABLE [354b3a3ac] 2016-06-19 14:01:17 -0400 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.1.16, - see <xref linkend="release-9-1-16">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-1-16"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1448,7 +1448,7 @@ Branch: REL9_1_STABLE [354b3a3ac] 2016-06-19 14:01:17 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.1.18. For information about new features in the 9.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-1">. + <xref linkend="release-9-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1460,7 +1460,7 @@ Branch: REL9_1_STABLE [354b3a3ac] 2016-06-19 14:01:17 -0400 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.1.16, - see <xref linkend="release-9-1-16">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-1-16"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2009,7 +2009,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <para> This release contains a small number of fixes from 9.1.17. For information about new features in the 9.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-1">. + <xref linkend="release-9-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2021,7 +2021,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.1.16, - see <xref linkend="release-9-1-16">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-1-16"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2077,7 +2077,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <para> This release contains a small number of fixes from 9.1.16. For information about new features in the 9.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-1">. + <xref linkend="release-9-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2089,7 +2089,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.1.16, - see <xref linkend="release-9-1-16">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-1-16"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2165,7 +2165,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.1.15. For information about new features in the 9.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-1">. + <xref linkend="release-9-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2183,7 +2183,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.1.14, - see <xref linkend="release-9-1-14">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-1-14"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2691,7 +2691,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.1.14. For information about new features in the 9.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-1">. + <xref linkend="release-9-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2703,7 +2703,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.1.14, - see <xref linkend="release-9-1-14">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-1-14"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -3501,7 +3501,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.1.13. For information about new features in the 9.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-1">. + <xref linkend="release-9-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -3519,7 +3519,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.1.11, - see <xref linkend="release-9-1-11">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-1-11"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -3570,7 +3570,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <listitem> <para> - Fix feedback status when <xref linkend="guc-hot-standby-feedback"> is + Fix feedback status when <xref linkend="guc-hot-standby-feedback"/> is turned off on-the-fly (Simon Riggs) </para> </listitem> @@ -3654,7 +3654,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <listitem> <para> Prevent foreign tables from being created with OIDS - when <xref linkend="guc-default-with-oids"> is true + when <xref linkend="guc-default-with-oids"/> is true (Etsuro Fujita) </para> </listitem> @@ -3760,7 +3760,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <listitem> <para> On Windows, allow new sessions to absorb values of PGC_BACKEND - parameters (such as <xref linkend="guc-log-connections">) from the + parameters (such as <xref linkend="guc-log-connections"/>) from the configuration file (Amit Kapila) </para> @@ -3884,7 +3884,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.1.12. For information about new features in the 9.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-1">. + <xref linkend="release-9-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -3896,7 +3896,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.1.11, - see <xref linkend="release-9-1-11">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-1-11"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -4051,7 +4051,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.1.11. For information about new features in the 9.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-1">. + <xref linkend="release-9-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -4063,7 +4063,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.1.11, - see <xref linkend="release-9-1-11">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-1-11"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -4601,7 +4601,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.1.10. For information about new features in the 9.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-1">. + <xref linkend="release-9-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -4619,7 +4619,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.1.9, - see <xref linkend="release-9-1-9">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-1-9"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -4858,7 +4858,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.1.9. For information about new features in the 9.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-1">. + <xref linkend="release-9-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -4870,7 +4870,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.1.9, - see <xref linkend="release-9-1-9">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-1-9"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -5193,7 +5193,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.1.8. For information about new features in the 9.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-1">. + <xref linkend="release-9-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -5212,7 +5212,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.1.6, - see <xref linkend="release-9-1-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-1-6"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -5527,7 +5527,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.1.7. For information about new features in the 9.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-1">. + <xref linkend="release-9-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -5539,7 +5539,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.1.6, - see <xref linkend="release-9-1-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-1-6"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -5849,7 +5849,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.1.6. For information about new features in the 9.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-1">. + <xref linkend="release-9-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -5861,7 +5861,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.1.6, - see <xref linkend="release-9-1-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-1-6"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -6312,7 +6312,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.1.5. For information about new features in the 9.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-1">. + <xref linkend="release-9-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -6330,7 +6330,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.1.4, - see <xref linkend="release-9-1-4">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-1-4"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -6564,7 +6564,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.1.4. For information about new features in the 9.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-1">. + <xref linkend="release-9-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -6576,7 +6576,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.1.4, - see <xref linkend="release-9-1-4">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-1-4"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -6951,7 +6951,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.1.3. For information about new features in the 9.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-1">. + <xref linkend="release-9-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -6975,7 +6975,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.1.2, - see <xref linkend="release-9-1-2">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-1-2"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -7441,7 +7441,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.1.2. For information about new features in the 9.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-1">. + <xref linkend="release-9-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -7453,7 +7453,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.1.2, - see <xref linkend="release-9-1-2">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-1-2"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -8078,7 +8078,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.1.1. For information about new features in the 9.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-1">. + <xref linkend="release-9-1"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -8725,7 +8725,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [9d6af7367] 2015-08-15 11:02:34 -0400 <para> This release contains a small number of fixes from 9.1.0. For information about new features in the 9.1 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-1">. + <xref linkend="release-9-1"/>. </para> <sect2> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/release-9.2.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/release-9.2.sgml index e2da35bcd44..1f2240f158d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/release-9.2.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/release-9.2.sgml @@ -12,7 +12,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.2.23. For information about new features in the 9.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-2">. + <xref linkend="release-9-2"/>. </para> <para> @@ -30,7 +30,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.2.22, - see <xref linkend="release-9-2-22">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-2-22"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -213,7 +213,7 @@ <para> This release contains a small number of fixes from 9.2.22. For information about new features in the 9.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-2">. + <xref linkend="release-9-2"/>. </para> <para> @@ -231,7 +231,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.2.22, - see <xref linkend="release-9-2-22">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-2-22"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -382,7 +382,7 @@ CREATE OR REPLACE VIEW table_privileges AS <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.2.21. For information about new features in the 9.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-2">. + <xref linkend="release-9-2"/>. </para> <para> @@ -405,7 +405,7 @@ CREATE OR REPLACE VIEW table_privileges AS <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.2.20, - see <xref linkend="release-9-2-20">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-2-20"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -575,7 +575,7 @@ UPDATE pg_database SET datallowconn = false WHERE datname = 'template0'; <listitem> <para> - Fix code for setting <xref linkend="guc-tcp-keepalives-idle"> on + Fix code for setting <xref linkend="guc-tcp-keepalives-idle"/> on Solaris (Tom Lane) </para> </listitem> @@ -776,7 +776,7 @@ UPDATE pg_database SET datallowconn = false WHERE datname = 'template0'; <listitem> <para> Fix <application>pg_upgrade</application> to ensure that the ending WAL record - does not have <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"> = <literal>minimum</literal> + does not have <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"/> = <literal>minimum</literal> (Bruce Momjian) </para> @@ -848,7 +848,7 @@ UPDATE pg_database SET datallowconn = false WHERE datname = 'template0'; <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.2.20. For information about new features in the 9.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-2">. + <xref linkend="release-9-2"/>. </para> <para> @@ -871,7 +871,7 @@ UPDATE pg_database SET datallowconn = false WHERE datname = 'template0'; <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.2.20, - see <xref linkend="release-9-2-20">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-2-20"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -906,7 +906,7 @@ UPDATE pg_database SET datallowconn = false WHERE datname = 'template0'; By itself, this patch will only fix the behavior in newly initdb'd databases. If you wish to apply this change in an existing database, follow the corrected procedure shown in the changelog entry for - CVE-2017-7547, in <xref linkend="release-9-2-22">. + CVE-2017-7547, in <xref linkend="release-9-2-22"/>. </para> </listitem> @@ -1206,7 +1206,7 @@ UPDATE pg_database SET datallowconn = false WHERE datname = 'template0'; will use the current and historical DST transition dates of the <literal>US/Eastern</literal> zone. If you don't want that, remove the <filename>posixrules</filename> file, or replace it with a copy of some - other zone file (see <xref linkend="datatype-timezones">). Note that + other zone file (see <xref linkend="datatype-timezones"/>). Note that due to caching, you may need to restart the server to get such changes to take effect. </para> @@ -1228,7 +1228,7 @@ UPDATE pg_database SET datallowconn = false WHERE datname = 'template0'; <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.2.19. For information about new features in the 9.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-2">. + <xref linkend="release-9-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1246,7 +1246,7 @@ UPDATE pg_database SET datallowconn = false WHERE datname = 'template0'; <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.2.11, - see <xref linkend="release-9-2-11">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-2-11"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1281,7 +1281,7 @@ UPDATE pg_database SET datallowconn = false WHERE datname = 'template0'; </para> <para> - Previously, this was skipped when <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"> + Previously, this was skipped when <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"/> = <literal>minimal</literal>, but actually it's necessary even in that case to ensure that the unlogged table is properly reset to empty after a crash. @@ -1351,7 +1351,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [38bec1805] 2017-01-25 07:02:25 +0900 <para> Previously, non-default settings - of <xref linkend="guc-default-tablespace"> could result in broken + of <xref linkend="guc-default-tablespace"/> could result in broken indexes. </para> </listitem> @@ -1640,7 +1640,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [38bec1805] 2017-01-25 07:02:25 +0900 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.2.18. For information about new features in the 9.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-2">. + <xref linkend="release-9-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1652,7 +1652,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [38bec1805] 2017-01-25 07:02:25 +0900 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.2.11, - see <xref linkend="release-9-2-11">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-2-11"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1691,7 +1691,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [38bec1805] 2017-01-25 07:02:25 +0900 <listitem> <para> Fix <command>EXPLAIN</command> to emit valid XML when - <xref linkend="guc-track-io-timing"> is on (Markus Winand) + <xref linkend="guc-track-io-timing"/> is on (Markus Winand) </para> <para> @@ -1906,7 +1906,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [38bec1805] 2017-01-25 07:02:25 +0900 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.2.17. For information about new features in the 9.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-2">. + <xref linkend="release-9-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1918,7 +1918,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [38bec1805] 2017-01-25 07:02:25 +0900 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.2.11, - see <xref linkend="release-9-2-11">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-2-11"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2247,7 +2247,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [38bec1805] 2017-01-25 07:02:25 +0900 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.2.16. For information about new features in the 9.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-2">. + <xref linkend="release-9-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2259,7 +2259,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [38bec1805] 2017-01-25 07:02:25 +0900 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.2.11, - see <xref linkend="release-9-2-11">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-2-11"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2443,7 +2443,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [38bec1805] 2017-01-25 07:02:25 +0900 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.2.15. For information about new features in the 9.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-2">. + <xref linkend="release-9-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2455,7 +2455,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [38bec1805] 2017-01-25 07:02:25 +0900 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.2.11, - see <xref linkend="release-9-2-11">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-2-11"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2649,7 +2649,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [38bec1805] 2017-01-25 07:02:25 +0900 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.2.14. For information about new features in the 9.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-2">. + <xref linkend="release-9-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2661,7 +2661,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [38bec1805] 2017-01-25 07:02:25 +0900 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.2.11, - see <xref linkend="release-9-2-11">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-2-11"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -3193,7 +3193,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [38bec1805] 2017-01-25 07:02:25 +0900 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.2.13. For information about new features in the 9.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-2">. + <xref linkend="release-9-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -3205,7 +3205,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [38bec1805] 2017-01-25 07:02:25 +0900 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.2.11, - see <xref linkend="release-9-2-11">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-2-11"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -3790,7 +3790,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [e90a629e1] 2015-09-22 14:58:38 -0700 <para> This release contains a small number of fixes from 9.2.12. For information about new features in the 9.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-2">. + <xref linkend="release-9-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -3802,7 +3802,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [e90a629e1] 2015-09-22 14:58:38 -0700 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.2.11, - see <xref linkend="release-9-2-11">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-2-11"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -3858,7 +3858,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [e90a629e1] 2015-09-22 14:58:38 -0700 <para> This release contains a small number of fixes from 9.2.11. For information about new features in the 9.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-2">. + <xref linkend="release-9-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -3870,7 +3870,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [e90a629e1] 2015-09-22 14:58:38 -0700 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.2.11, - see <xref linkend="release-9-2-11">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-2-11"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -3953,7 +3953,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [e90a629e1] 2015-09-22 14:58:38 -0700 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.2.10. For information about new features in the 9.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-2">. + <xref linkend="release-9-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -3971,7 +3971,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [e90a629e1] 2015-09-22 14:58:38 -0700 <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.2.10, - see <xref linkend="release-9-2-10">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-2-10"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -4535,7 +4535,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [6b700301c] 2015-02-17 16:03:00 +0100 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.2.9. For information about new features in the 9.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-2">. + <xref linkend="release-9-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -4556,7 +4556,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [6b700301c] 2015-02-17 16:03:00 +0100 <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.2.9, - see <xref linkend="release-9-2-9">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-2-9"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -5452,7 +5452,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [6b700301c] 2015-02-17 16:03:00 +0100 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.2.8. For information about new features in the 9.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-2">. + <xref linkend="release-9-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -5470,7 +5470,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [6b700301c] 2015-02-17 16:03:00 +0100 <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.2.6, - see <xref linkend="release-9-2-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-2-6"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -5528,7 +5528,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [6b700301c] 2015-02-17 16:03:00 +0100 <listitem> <para> - Fix feedback status when <xref linkend="guc-hot-standby-feedback"> is + Fix feedback status when <xref linkend="guc-hot-standby-feedback"/> is turned off on-the-fly (Simon Riggs) </para> </listitem> @@ -5650,7 +5650,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [6b700301c] 2015-02-17 16:03:00 +0100 <listitem> <para> Prevent foreign tables from being created with OIDS - when <xref linkend="guc-default-with-oids"> is true + when <xref linkend="guc-default-with-oids"/> is true (Etsuro Fujita) </para> </listitem> @@ -5769,7 +5769,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [6b700301c] 2015-02-17 16:03:00 +0100 <listitem> <para> On Windows, allow new sessions to absorb values of PGC_BACKEND - parameters (such as <xref linkend="guc-log-connections">) from the + parameters (such as <xref linkend="guc-log-connections"/>) from the configuration file (Amit Kapila) </para> @@ -5933,7 +5933,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [6b700301c] 2015-02-17 16:03:00 +0100 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.2.7. For information about new features in the 9.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-2">. + <xref linkend="release-9-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -5945,7 +5945,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [6b700301c] 2015-02-17 16:03:00 +0100 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.2.6, - see <xref linkend="release-9-2-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-2-6"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -6122,7 +6122,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [6b700301c] 2015-02-17 16:03:00 +0100 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.2.6. For information about new features in the 9.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-2">. + <xref linkend="release-9-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -6134,7 +6134,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [6b700301c] 2015-02-17 16:03:00 +0100 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.2.6, - see <xref linkend="release-9-2-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-2-6"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -6729,7 +6729,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [6b700301c] 2015-02-17 16:03:00 +0100 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.2.5. For information about new features in the 9.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-2">. + <xref linkend="release-9-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -6747,7 +6747,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [6b700301c] 2015-02-17 16:03:00 +0100 <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.2.4, - see <xref linkend="release-9-2-4">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-2-4"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -7066,7 +7066,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [6b700301c] 2015-02-17 16:03:00 +0100 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.2.4. For information about new features in the 9.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-2">. + <xref linkend="release-9-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -7078,7 +7078,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [6b700301c] 2015-02-17 16:03:00 +0100 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.2.4, - see <xref linkend="release-9-2-4">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-2-4"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -7485,7 +7485,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [6b700301c] 2015-02-17 16:03:00 +0100 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.2.3. For information about new features in the 9.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-2">. + <xref linkend="release-9-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -7504,7 +7504,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [6b700301c] 2015-02-17 16:03:00 +0100 <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.2.2, - see <xref linkend="release-9-2-2">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-2-2"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -7892,7 +7892,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [6b700301c] 2015-02-17 16:03:00 +0100 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.2.2. For information about new features in the 9.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-2">. + <xref linkend="release-9-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -7904,7 +7904,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [6b700301c] 2015-02-17 16:03:00 +0100 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.2.2, - see <xref linkend="release-9-2-2">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-2-2"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -8343,7 +8343,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [6b700301c] 2015-02-17 16:03:00 +0100 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.2.1. For information about new features in the 9.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-2">. + <xref linkend="release-9-2"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -8361,7 +8361,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [6b700301c] 2015-02-17 16:03:00 +0100 <para> Also, if you are upgrading from version 9.2.0, - see <xref linkend="release-9-2-1">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-2-1"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -9067,7 +9067,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [6b700301c] 2015-02-17 16:03:00 +0100 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.2.0. For information about new features in the 9.2 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-2">. + <xref linkend="release-9-2"/>. </para> <sect2> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/release-9.3.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/release-9.3.sgml index ed0e292d9a8..3c540bcc260 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/release-9.3.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/release-9.3.sgml @@ -12,7 +12,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.3.19. For information about new features in the 9.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-3">. + <xref linkend="release-9-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -24,7 +24,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.3.18, - see <xref linkend="release-9-3-18">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-3-18"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -246,7 +246,7 @@ <para> This release contains a small number of fixes from 9.3.18. For information about new features in the 9.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-3">. + <xref linkend="release-9-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -258,7 +258,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.3.18, - see <xref linkend="release-9-3-18">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-3-18"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -417,7 +417,7 @@ CREATE OR REPLACE VIEW table_privileges AS <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.3.17. For information about new features in the 9.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-3">. + <xref linkend="release-9-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -434,7 +434,7 @@ CREATE OR REPLACE VIEW table_privileges AS <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.3.16, - see <xref linkend="release-9-3-16">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-3-16"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -626,7 +626,7 @@ UPDATE pg_database SET datallowconn = false WHERE datname = 'template0'; <listitem> <para> - Fix code for setting <xref linkend="guc-tcp-keepalives-idle"> on + Fix code for setting <xref linkend="guc-tcp-keepalives-idle"/> on Solaris (Tom Lane) </para> </listitem> @@ -879,7 +879,7 @@ UPDATE pg_database SET datallowconn = false WHERE datname = 'template0'; <listitem> <para> Fix <application>pg_upgrade</application> to ensure that the ending WAL record - does not have <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"> = <literal>minimum</literal> + does not have <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"/> = <literal>minimum</literal> (Bruce Momjian) </para> @@ -976,7 +976,7 @@ UPDATE pg_database SET datallowconn = false WHERE datname = 'template0'; <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.3.16. For information about new features in the 9.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-3">. + <xref linkend="release-9-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -993,7 +993,7 @@ UPDATE pg_database SET datallowconn = false WHERE datname = 'template0'; <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.3.16, - see <xref linkend="release-9-3-16">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-3-16"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1028,7 +1028,7 @@ UPDATE pg_database SET datallowconn = false WHERE datname = 'template0'; By itself, this patch will only fix the behavior in newly initdb'd databases. If you wish to apply this change in an existing database, follow the corrected procedure shown in the changelog entry for - CVE-2017-7547, in <xref linkend="release-9-3-18">. + CVE-2017-7547, in <xref linkend="release-9-3-18"/>. </para> </listitem> @@ -1373,7 +1373,7 @@ UPDATE pg_database SET datallowconn = false WHERE datname = 'template0'; will use the current and historical DST transition dates of the <literal>US/Eastern</literal> zone. If you don't want that, remove the <filename>posixrules</filename> file, or replace it with a copy of some - other zone file (see <xref linkend="datatype-timezones">). Note that + other zone file (see <xref linkend="datatype-timezones"/>). Note that due to caching, you may need to restart the server to get such changes to take effect. </para> @@ -1395,7 +1395,7 @@ UPDATE pg_database SET datallowconn = false WHERE datname = 'template0'; <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.3.15. For information about new features in the 9.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-3">. + <xref linkend="release-9-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1413,7 +1413,7 @@ UPDATE pg_database SET datallowconn = false WHERE datname = 'template0'; <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.3.15, - see <xref linkend="release-9-3-15">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-3-15"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1448,7 +1448,7 @@ UPDATE pg_database SET datallowconn = false WHERE datname = 'template0'; </para> <para> - Previously, this was skipped when <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"> + Previously, this was skipped when <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"/> = <literal>minimal</literal>, but actually it's necessary even in that case to ensure that the unlogged table is properly reset to empty after a crash. @@ -1509,7 +1509,7 @@ UPDATE pg_database SET datallowconn = false WHERE datname = 'template0'; <para> Previously, non-default settings - of <xref linkend="guc-default-tablespace"> could result in broken + of <xref linkend="guc-default-tablespace"/> could result in broken indexes. </para> </listitem> @@ -1843,7 +1843,7 @@ UPDATE pg_database SET datallowconn = false WHERE datname = 'template0'; <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.3.14. For information about new features in the 9.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-3">. + <xref linkend="release-9-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1861,7 +1861,7 @@ UPDATE pg_database SET datallowconn = false WHERE datname = 'template0'; <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.3.9, - see <xref linkend="release-9-3-9">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-3-9"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1937,7 +1937,7 @@ UPDATE pg_database SET datallowconn = false WHERE datname = 'template0'; <listitem> <para> Fix <command>EXPLAIN</command> to emit valid XML when - <xref linkend="guc-track-io-timing"> is on (Markus Winand) + <xref linkend="guc-track-io-timing"/> is on (Markus Winand) </para> <para> @@ -2172,7 +2172,7 @@ UPDATE pg_database SET datallowconn = false WHERE datname = 'template0'; <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.3.13. For information about new features in the 9.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-3">. + <xref linkend="release-9-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2184,7 +2184,7 @@ UPDATE pg_database SET datallowconn = false WHERE datname = 'template0'; <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.3.9, - see <xref linkend="release-9-3-9">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-3-9"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2662,7 +2662,7 @@ UPDATE pg_database SET datallowconn = false WHERE datname = 'template0'; <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.3.12. For information about new features in the 9.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-3">. + <xref linkend="release-9-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2674,7 +2674,7 @@ UPDATE pg_database SET datallowconn = false WHERE datname = 'template0'; <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.3.9, - see <xref linkend="release-9-3-9">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-3-9"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2892,7 +2892,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [37f30b251] 2016-04-18 13:19:52 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.3.11. For information about new features in the 9.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-3">. + <xref linkend="release-9-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2904,7 +2904,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [37f30b251] 2016-04-18 13:19:52 -0400 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.3.9, - see <xref linkend="release-9-3-9">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-3-9"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -3111,7 +3111,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [37f30b251] 2016-04-18 13:19:52 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.3.10. For information about new features in the 9.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-3">. + <xref linkend="release-9-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -3123,7 +3123,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [37f30b251] 2016-04-18 13:19:52 -0400 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.3.9, - see <xref linkend="release-9-3-9">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-3-9"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -3734,7 +3734,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [37f30b251] 2016-04-18 13:19:52 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.3.9. For information about new features in the 9.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-3">. + <xref linkend="release-9-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -3746,7 +3746,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [37f30b251] 2016-04-18 13:19:52 -0400 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.3.9, - see <xref linkend="release-9-3-9">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-3-9"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -4363,7 +4363,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [37f30b251] 2016-04-18 13:19:52 -0400 <para> This release contains a small number of fixes from 9.3.8. For information about new features in the 9.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-3">. + <xref linkend="release-9-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -4381,7 +4381,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [37f30b251] 2016-04-18 13:19:52 -0400 <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.3.7, - see <xref linkend="release-9-3-7">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-3-7"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -4438,10 +4438,10 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [37f30b251] 2016-04-18 13:19:52 -0400 Otherwise, for each table that has <structname>pg_class</structname>.<structfield>relminmxid</structfield> equal to 1, <command>VACUUM</command> that table with - both <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-multixact-freeze-min-age"> - and <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-multixact-freeze-table-age"> set to + both <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-multixact-freeze-min-age"/> + and <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-multixact-freeze-table-age"/> set to zero. (You can use the vacuum cost delay parameters described - in <xref linkend="runtime-config-resource-vacuum-cost"> to reduce + in <xref linkend="runtime-config-resource-vacuum-cost"/> to reduce the performance consequences for concurrent sessions.) You must use <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> 9.3.5 or later to perform this step. </para> @@ -4512,7 +4512,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [37f30b251] 2016-04-18 13:19:52 -0400 <para> This release contains a small number of fixes from 9.3.7. For information about new features in the 9.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-3">. + <xref linkend="release-9-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -4524,7 +4524,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [37f30b251] 2016-04-18 13:19:52 -0400 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.3.7, - see <xref linkend="release-9-3-7">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-3-7"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -4620,7 +4620,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [4dddf8552] 2015-05-21 20:41:55 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.3.6. For information about new features in the 9.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-3">. + <xref linkend="release-9-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -4638,7 +4638,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [4dddf8552] 2015-05-21 20:41:55 -0400 <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.3.6, - see <xref linkend="release-9-3-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-3-6"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -5210,7 +5210,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [4dddf8552] 2015-05-21 20:41:55 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.3.5. For information about new features in the 9.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-3">. + <xref linkend="release-9-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -5231,7 +5231,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [4dddf8552] 2015-05-21 20:41:55 -0400 <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.3.5, - see <xref linkend="release-9-3-5">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-3-5"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -7095,7 +7095,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [b6391f587] 2014-10-04 14:18:43 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.3.4. For information about new features in the 9.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-3">. + <xref linkend="release-9-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -7115,7 +7115,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [b6391f587] 2014-10-04 14:18:43 -0400 <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.3.4, - see <xref linkend="release-9-3-4">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-3-4"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -7577,7 +7577,7 @@ Branch: REL9_1_STABLE [dd1a5b09b] 2014-06-24 13:30:41 +0300 <listitem> <para> Prevent foreign tables from being created with OIDS - when <xref linkend="guc-default-with-oids"> is true + when <xref linkend="guc-default-with-oids"/> is true (Etsuro Fujita) </para> </listitem> @@ -7859,7 +7859,7 @@ Branch: REL8_4_STABLE [30e434bdf] 2014-04-05 12:41:40 -0400 <listitem> <para> On Windows, allow new sessions to absorb values of PGC_BACKEND - parameters (such as <xref linkend="guc-log-connections">) from the + parameters (such as <xref linkend="guc-log-connections"/>) from the configuration file (Amit Kapila) </para> @@ -8215,7 +8215,7 @@ Branch: REL8_4_STABLE [c51da696b] 2014-07-19 15:01:45 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.3.3. For information about new features in the 9.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-3">. + <xref linkend="release-9-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -8234,7 +8234,7 @@ Branch: REL8_4_STABLE [c51da696b] 2014-07-19 15:01:45 -0400 <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.3.3, - see <xref linkend="release-9-3-3">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-3-3"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -8480,7 +8480,7 @@ Branch: REL9_3_STABLE [dcd1131c8] 2014-03-06 21:40:50 +0200 <application>walsender</application> failed to send ping messages to the client if it was constantly busy sending WAL data; but it expected to see ping responses despite that, and would therefore disconnect - once <xref linkend="guc-wal-sender-timeout"> elapsed. + once <xref linkend="guc-wal-sender-timeout"/> elapsed. </para> </listitem> @@ -8536,7 +8536,7 @@ Branch: REL9_3_STABLE [5a7e75849] 2014-02-20 10:46:54 +0200 <listitem> <para> - Add read-only <xref linkend="guc-data-checksums"> parameter to + Add read-only <xref linkend="guc-data-checksums"/> parameter to display whether page checksums are enabled (Heikki Linnakangas) </para> @@ -8677,7 +8677,7 @@ Branch: REL8_4_STABLE [6e6c2c2e1] 2014-03-15 13:36:57 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.3.2. For information about new features in the 9.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-3">. + <xref linkend="release-9-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -8706,7 +8706,7 @@ Branch: REL8_4_STABLE [6e6c2c2e1] 2014-03-15 13:36:57 -0400 <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.3.2, - see <xref linkend="release-9-3-2">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-3-2"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -8985,9 +8985,9 @@ Branch: REL9_3_STABLE [fb47de2be] 2014-02-13 19:30:30 -0300 freezing parameters were used for multixact IDs too; but since the consumption rates of transaction IDs and multixact IDs can be quite different, this did not work very well. Introduce new settings - <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-multixact-freeze-min-age">, - <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-multixact-freeze-table-age">, and - <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-multixact-freeze-max-age"> + <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-multixact-freeze-min-age"/>, + <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-multixact-freeze-table-age"/>, and + <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-multixact-freeze-max-age"/> to control when to freeze multixacts. </para> </listitem> @@ -10139,7 +10139,7 @@ Branch: REL8_4_STABLE [c0c2d62ac] 2014-02-14 21:59:56 -0500 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.3.1. For information about new features in the 9.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-3">. + <xref linkend="release-9-3"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -10157,7 +10157,7 @@ Branch: REL8_4_STABLE [c0c2d62ac] 2014-02-14 21:59:56 -0500 <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.3.1, - see <xref linkend="release-9-3-1">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-3-1"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -10618,7 +10618,7 @@ SELECT ... FROM tab1 x CROSS JOIN (tab2 x CROSS JOIN tab3 y) z <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.3.0. For information about new features in the 9.3 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-3">. + <xref linkend="release-9-3"/>. </para> <sect2> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/release-9.4.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/release-9.4.sgml index d8b6b1777c7..4ecf90d6912 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/release-9.4.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/release-9.4.sgml @@ -12,7 +12,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.4.14. For information about new features in the 9.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-4">. + <xref linkend="release-9-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -24,7 +24,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.4.13, - see <xref linkend="release-9-4-13">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-4-13"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -290,7 +290,7 @@ <para> This release contains a small number of fixes from 9.4.13. For information about new features in the 9.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-4">. + <xref linkend="release-9-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -302,7 +302,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.4.13, - see <xref linkend="release-9-4-13">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-4-13"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -477,7 +477,7 @@ CREATE OR REPLACE VIEW table_privileges AS <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.4.12. For information about new features in the 9.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-4">. + <xref linkend="release-9-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -494,7 +494,7 @@ CREATE OR REPLACE VIEW table_privileges AS <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.4.12, - see <xref linkend="release-9-4-12">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-4-12"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -706,7 +706,7 @@ UPDATE pg_database SET datallowconn = false WHERE datname = 'template0'; <listitem> <para> - Fix code for setting <xref linkend="guc-tcp-keepalives-idle"> on + Fix code for setting <xref linkend="guc-tcp-keepalives-idle"/> on Solaris (Tom Lane) </para> </listitem> @@ -1039,7 +1039,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [23a2b818f] 2017-08-05 14:56:40 -0700 <listitem> <para> Fix <application>pg_upgrade</application> to ensure that the ending WAL record - does not have <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"> = <literal>minimum</literal> + does not have <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"/> = <literal>minimum</literal> (Bruce Momjian) </para> @@ -1150,7 +1150,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [23a2b818f] 2017-08-05 14:56:40 -0700 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.4.11. For information about new features in the 9.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-4">. + <xref linkend="release-9-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1172,7 +1172,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [23a2b818f] 2017-08-05 14:56:40 -0700 <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.4.11, - see <xref linkend="release-9-4-11">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-4-11"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1206,7 +1206,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [23a2b818f] 2017-08-05 14:56:40 -0700 By itself, this patch will only fix the behavior in newly initdb'd databases. If you wish to apply this change in an existing database, follow the corrected procedure shown in the changelog entry for - CVE-2017-7547, in <xref linkend="release-9-4-13">. + CVE-2017-7547, in <xref linkend="release-9-4-13"/>. </para> </listitem> @@ -1636,7 +1636,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [fb50c38e9] 2017-04-17 13:52:42 -0400 will use the current and historical DST transition dates of the <literal>US/Eastern</literal> zone. If you don't want that, remove the <filename>posixrules</filename> file, or replace it with a copy of some - other zone file (see <xref linkend="datatype-timezones">). Note that + other zone file (see <xref linkend="datatype-timezones"/>). Note that due to caching, you may need to restart the server to get such changes to take effect. </para> @@ -1658,7 +1658,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [fb50c38e9] 2017-04-17 13:52:42 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.4.10. For information about new features in the 9.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-4">. + <xref linkend="release-9-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1676,7 +1676,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [fb50c38e9] 2017-04-17 13:52:42 -0400 <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.4.10, - see <xref linkend="release-9-4-10">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-4-10"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1724,7 +1724,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [fb50c38e9] 2017-04-17 13:52:42 -0400 </para> <para> - Previously, this was skipped when <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"> + Previously, this was skipped when <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"/> = <literal>minimal</literal>, but actually it's necessary even in that case to ensure that the unlogged table is properly reset to empty after a crash. @@ -1797,7 +1797,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [fb50c38e9] 2017-04-17 13:52:42 -0400 <para> Previously, non-default settings - of <xref linkend="guc-default-tablespace"> could result in broken + of <xref linkend="guc-default-tablespace"/> could result in broken indexes. </para> </listitem> @@ -2191,7 +2191,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [fb50c38e9] 2017-04-17 13:52:42 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.4.9. For information about new features in the 9.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-4">. + <xref linkend="release-9-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2209,7 +2209,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [fb50c38e9] 2017-04-17 13:52:42 -0400 <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.4.6, - see <xref linkend="release-9-4-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-4-6"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2304,7 +2304,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [fb50c38e9] 2017-04-17 13:52:42 -0400 <listitem> <para> Fix <command>EXPLAIN</command> to emit valid XML when - <xref linkend="guc-track-io-timing"> is on (Markus Winand) + <xref linkend="guc-track-io-timing"/> is on (Markus Winand) </para> <para> @@ -2657,7 +2657,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [10ad15f48] 2016-09-01 11:45:16 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.4.8. For information about new features in the 9.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-4">. + <xref linkend="release-9-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2669,7 +2669,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [10ad15f48] 2016-09-01 11:45:16 -0400 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.4.6, - see <xref linkend="release-9-4-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-4-6"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -3179,7 +3179,7 @@ Branch: REL9_1_STABLE [de887cc8a] 2016-05-25 19:39:49 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.4.7. For information about new features in the 9.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-4">. + <xref linkend="release-9-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -3191,7 +3191,7 @@ Branch: REL9_1_STABLE [de887cc8a] 2016-05-25 19:39:49 -0400 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.4.6, - see <xref linkend="release-9-4-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-4-6"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -3442,7 +3442,7 @@ Branch: REL9_1_STABLE [de887cc8a] 2016-05-25 19:39:49 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.4.6. For information about new features in the 9.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-4">. + <xref linkend="release-9-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -3454,7 +3454,7 @@ Branch: REL9_1_STABLE [de887cc8a] 2016-05-25 19:39:49 -0400 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.4.6, - see <xref linkend="release-9-4-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-4-6"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -3504,7 +3504,7 @@ Branch: REL9_1_STABLE [de887cc8a] 2016-05-25 19:39:49 -0400 <listitem> <para> - Ignore <xref linkend="recovery-min-apply-delay"> parameter until + Ignore <xref linkend="recovery-min-apply-delay"/> parameter until recovery has reached a consistent state (Michael Paquier) </para> @@ -3713,7 +3713,7 @@ Branch: REL9_1_STABLE [de887cc8a] 2016-05-25 19:39:49 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.4.5. For information about new features in the 9.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-4">. + <xref linkend="release-9-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -3731,7 +3731,7 @@ Branch: REL9_1_STABLE [de887cc8a] 2016-05-25 19:39:49 -0400 <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.4.4, - see <xref linkend="release-9-4-4">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-4-4"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -4810,7 +4810,7 @@ Branch: REL9_1_STABLE [386dcd539] 2015-12-11 19:08:40 -0500 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.4.4. For information about new features in the 9.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-4">. + <xref linkend="release-9-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -4822,7 +4822,7 @@ Branch: REL9_1_STABLE [386dcd539] 2015-12-11 19:08:40 -0500 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.4.4, - see <xref linkend="release-9-4-4">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-4-4"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -6333,7 +6333,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [47ac95f37] 2015-10-02 19:16:37 -0400 <para> This release contains a small number of fixes from 9.4.3. For information about new features in the 9.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-4">. + <xref linkend="release-9-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -6351,7 +6351,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [47ac95f37] 2015-10-02 19:16:37 -0400 <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.4.2, - see <xref linkend="release-9-4-2">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-4-2"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -6414,10 +6414,10 @@ Branch: REL9_3_STABLE [2a9b01928] 2015-06-05 09:34:15 -0400 Otherwise, for each table that has <structname>pg_class</structname>.<structfield>relminmxid</structfield> equal to 1, <command>VACUUM</command> that table with - both <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-multixact-freeze-min-age"> - and <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-multixact-freeze-table-age"> set to + both <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-multixact-freeze-min-age"/> + and <xref linkend="guc-vacuum-multixact-freeze-table-age"/> set to zero. (You can use the vacuum cost delay parameters described - in <xref linkend="runtime-config-resource-vacuum-cost"> to reduce + in <xref linkend="runtime-config-resource-vacuum-cost"/> to reduce the performance consequences for concurrent sessions.) </para> </listitem> @@ -6514,7 +6514,7 @@ Branch: REL9_3_STABLE [d3fdec6ae] 2015-06-03 11:58:47 -0400 <para> This release contains a small number of fixes from 9.4.2. For information about new features in the 9.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-4">. + <xref linkend="release-9-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -6526,7 +6526,7 @@ Branch: REL9_3_STABLE [d3fdec6ae] 2015-06-03 11:58:47 -0400 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.4.2, - see <xref linkend="release-9-4-2">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-4-2"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -6657,7 +6657,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [b06649b7f] 2015-05-26 22:15:00 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.4.1. For information about new features in the 9.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-4">. + <xref linkend="release-9-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -6675,7 +6675,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [b06649b7f] 2015-05-26 22:15:00 -0400 <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.4.1, - see <xref linkend="release-9-4-1">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-4-1"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -7938,7 +7938,7 @@ Branch: REL9_0_STABLE [3c3749a3b] 2015-05-15 19:36:20 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.4.0. For information about new features in the 9.4 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-4">. + <xref linkend="release-9-4"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -8768,14 +8768,14 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> - Add new <acronym>SQL</acronym> command <xref linkend="sql-altersystem"> + Add new <acronym>SQL</acronym> command <xref linkend="sql-altersystem"/> for changing <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> configuration file entries </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Reduce lock strength for some <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> + Reduce lock strength for some <xref linkend="sql-altertable"/> commands </para> </listitem> @@ -8815,8 +8815,8 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <title>Migration to Version 9.4</title> <para> - A dump/restore using <xref linkend="app-pg-dumpall">, or use - of <xref linkend="pgupgrade">, is required for those wishing to migrate + A dump/restore using <xref linkend="app-pg-dumpall"/>, or use + of <xref linkend="pgupgrade"/>, is required for those wishing to migrate data from any previous release. </para> @@ -8850,7 +8850,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <para> Previously such values were rendered according to the current - <xref linkend="guc-datestyle"> setting; but many JSON processors + <xref linkend="guc-datestyle"/> setting; but many JSON processors require timestamps to be in ISO 8601 format. If necessary, the previous behavior can be obtained by explicitly casting the datetime value to <type>text</type> before passing it to the JSON conversion @@ -8957,7 +8957,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> - <xref linkend="sql-discard"> now also discards sequence-related state + <xref linkend="sql-discard"/> now also discards sequence-related state (Fabrízio de Royes Mello, Robert Haas) </para> </listitem> @@ -9043,7 +9043,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <para> User commands that did their own quote preservation might need adjustment. This is likely to be an issue for commands used in - <xref linkend="guc-archive-command">, <xref linkend="restore-command">, + <xref linkend="guc-archive-command"/>, <xref linkend="restore-command"/>, and <link linkend="sql-copy"><command>COPY TO/FROM PROGRAM</command></link>. </para> </listitem> @@ -9112,7 +9112,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> - Change empty arrays returned by the <xref linkend="intarray"> module + Change empty arrays returned by the <xref linkend="intarray"/> module to be zero-dimensional arrays (Bruce Momjian) </para> @@ -9127,7 +9127,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> - <xref linkend="pgupgrade"> now uses <option>-U</option> + <xref linkend="pgupgrade"/> now uses <option>-U</option> or <option>--username</option> to specify the user name (Bruce Momjian) </para> @@ -9188,7 +9188,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <para> This reduces the likelihood of leaving orphaned child processes - behind after <xref linkend="app-postmaster"> shutdown, as well + behind after <xref linkend="app-postmaster"/> shutdown, as well as ensuring that crash recovery can proceed if some child processes have become <quote>stuck</quote>. </para> @@ -9202,7 +9202,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> - Make <xref linkend="sql-vacuum"> properly report dead but + Make <xref linkend="sql-vacuum"/> properly report dead but not-yet-removable rows to the statistics collector (Hari Babu) </para> @@ -9225,9 +9225,9 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 </para> <para> - Indexes upgraded via <xref linkend="pgupgrade"> will work fine + Indexes upgraded via <xref linkend="pgupgrade"/> will work fine but will still be in the old, larger <acronym>GIN</acronym> format. - Use <xref linkend="sql-reindex"> to recreate old GIN indexes in the + Use <xref linkend="sql-reindex"/> to recreate old GIN indexes in the new format. </para> </listitem> @@ -9316,7 +9316,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <para> Attempt to <link linkend="vacuum-for-wraparound">freeze</link> tuples when tables are rewritten with <xref - linkend="sql-cluster"> or <link + linkend="sql-cluster"/> or <link linkend="sql-vacuum"><command>VACUUM FULL</command></link> (Robert Haas, Andres Freund) </para> @@ -9328,7 +9328,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> - Improve speed of <xref linkend="sql-copy"> with default <link + Improve speed of <xref linkend="sql-copy"/> with default <link linkend="functions-sequence-table"><function>nextval()</function></link> columns (Simon Riggs) </para> @@ -9352,7 +9352,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> Reduce memory allocated by <application>PL/pgSQL</application> - <xref linkend="sql-do"> blocks (Tom Lane) + <xref linkend="sql-do"/> blocks (Tom Lane) </para> </listitem> @@ -9399,7 +9399,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> - Add <xref linkend="pg-stat-archiver-view"> system view to + Add <xref linkend="pg-stat-archiver-view"/> system view to report <link linkend="wal"><acronym>WAL</acronym></link> archiver activity (Gabriele Bartolini) </para> @@ -9408,13 +9408,13 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> Add <structfield>n_mod_since_analyze</structfield> columns to - <xref linkend="pg-stat-all-tables-view"> and related system views + <xref linkend="pg-stat-all-tables-view"/> and related system views (Mark Kirkwood) </para> <para> These columns expose the system's estimate of the number of changed - tuples since the table's last <xref linkend="sql-analyze">. This + tuples since the table's last <xref linkend="sql-analyze"/>. This estimate drives decisions about when to auto-analyze. </para> </listitem> @@ -9422,9 +9422,9 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> Add <structfield>backend_xid</structfield> and <structfield>backend_xmin</structfield> - columns to the system view <xref linkend="pg-stat-activity-view">, + columns to the system view <xref linkend="pg-stat-activity-view"/>, and a <structfield>backend_xmin</structfield> column to - <xref linkend="pg-stat-replication-view"> (Christian Kruse) + <xref linkend="pg-stat-replication-view"/> (Christian Kruse) </para> </listitem> @@ -9447,14 +9447,14 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 This allows use of Elliptic Curve keys for server authentication. Such keys are faster and have better security than <acronym>RSA</acronym> keys. The new configuration parameter - <xref linkend="guc-ssl-ecdh-curve"> + <xref linkend="guc-ssl-ecdh-curve"/> controls which curve is used for <acronym>ECDH</acronym>. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Improve the default <xref linkend="guc-ssl-ciphers"> setting + Improve the default <xref linkend="guc-ssl-ciphers"/> setting (Marko Kreen) </para> </listitem> @@ -9467,17 +9467,17 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 </para> <para> - Previously, the order specified by <xref linkend="guc-ssl-ciphers"> + Previously, the order specified by <xref linkend="guc-ssl-ciphers"/> was usually ignored in favor of client-side defaults, which are not configurable in most <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> clients. If desired, the old behavior can be restored via the new configuration - parameter <xref linkend="guc-ssl-prefer-server-ciphers">. + parameter <xref linkend="guc-ssl-prefer-server-ciphers"/>. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Make <xref linkend="guc-log-connections"> show <acronym>SSL</acronym> + Make <xref linkend="guc-log-connections"/> show <acronym>SSL</acronym> encryption information (Andreas Kunert) </para> </listitem> @@ -9500,7 +9500,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> - Add new <acronym>SQL</acronym> command <xref linkend="sql-altersystem"> + Add new <acronym>SQL</acronym> command <xref linkend="sql-altersystem"/> for changing <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> configuration file entries (Amit Kapila) </para> @@ -9513,7 +9513,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> - Add <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-work-mem"> configuration parameter + Add <xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-work-mem"/> configuration parameter to control the amount of memory used by autovacuum workers (Peter Geoghegan) </para> @@ -9521,7 +9521,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> - Add <xref linkend="guc-huge-pages"> parameter to allow using huge + Add <xref linkend="guc-huge-pages"/> parameter to allow using huge memory pages on Linux (Christian Kruse, Richard Poole, Abhijit Menon-Sen) </para> @@ -9533,7 +9533,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> - Add <xref linkend="guc-max-worker-processes"> parameter + Add <xref linkend="guc-max-worker-processes"/> parameter to limit the number of background workers (Robert Haas) </para> @@ -9545,12 +9545,12 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> - Add superuser-only <xref linkend="guc-session-preload-libraries"> + Add superuser-only <xref linkend="guc-session-preload-libraries"/> parameter to load libraries at session start (Peter Eisentraut) </para> <para> - In contrast to <xref linkend="guc-local-preload-libraries">, this + In contrast to <xref linkend="guc-local-preload-libraries"/>, this parameter can load any shared library, not just those in the <filename>$libdir/plugins</filename> directory. </para> @@ -9558,7 +9558,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> - Add <xref linkend="guc-wal-log-hints"> parameter to enable WAL + Add <xref linkend="guc-wal-log-hints"/> parameter to enable WAL logging of hint-bit changes (Sawada Masahiko) </para> @@ -9571,8 +9571,8 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> - Increase the default settings of <xref linkend="guc-work-mem"> - and <xref linkend="guc-maintenance-work-mem"> by four times (Bruce + Increase the default settings of <xref linkend="guc-work-mem"/> + and <xref linkend="guc-maintenance-work-mem"/> by four times (Bruce Momjian) </para> @@ -9584,7 +9584,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> Increase the default setting of <xref - linkend="guc-effective-cache-size"> + linkend="guc-effective-cache-size"/> to 4GB (Bruce Momjian, Tom Lane) </para> </listitem> @@ -9592,7 +9592,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> Allow <function>printf</function>-style space padding to be - specified in <xref linkend="guc-log-line-prefix"> (David Rowley) + specified in <xref linkend="guc-log-line-prefix"/> (David Rowley) </para> </listitem> @@ -9606,7 +9606,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> Show <acronym>PID</acronym>s of lock holders and waiters and improve - information about relations in <xref linkend="guc-log-lock-waits"> + information about relations in <xref linkend="guc-log-lock-waits"/> log messages (Christian Kruse) </para> </listitem> @@ -9626,7 +9626,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> On Windows, make <literal>SQL_ASCII</literal>-encoded databases and server - processes (e.g., <xref linkend="app-postmaster">) emit messages in + processes (e.g., <xref linkend="app-postmaster"/>) emit messages in the character encoding of the server's Windows user locale (Alexander Law, Noah Misch) </para> @@ -9664,7 +9664,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> - Add recovery parameter <xref linkend="recovery-min-apply-delay"> + Add recovery parameter <xref linkend="recovery-min-apply-delay"/> to delay replication (Robert Haas, Fabrízio de Royes Mello, Simon Riggs) </para> @@ -9677,7 +9677,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> - Add <xref linkend="recovery-target"> + Add <xref linkend="recovery-target"/> option <option>immediate</option> to stop <link linkend="wal"><acronym>WAL</acronym></link> recovery as soon as a consistent state is reached (MauMau, Heikki Linnakangas) @@ -9764,7 +9764,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> - Add new <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"> setting <option>logical</option> + Add new <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"/> setting <option>logical</option> to enable logical change-set encoding in <acronym>WAL</acronym> (Andres Freund) </para> @@ -9789,14 +9789,14 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> - Add <xref linkend="app-pgrecvlogical"> application to receive + Add <xref linkend="app-pgrecvlogical"/> application to receive logical-decoding data (Andres Freund) </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add <xref linkend="test-decoding"> module to illustrate logical + Add <xref linkend="test-decoding"/> module to illustrate logical decoding at the <acronym>SQL</acronym> level (Andres Freund) </para> </listitem> @@ -9836,7 +9836,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> - Allow <xref linkend="sql-select"> to have + Allow <xref linkend="sql-select"/> to have an empty target list (Tom Lane) </para> @@ -9906,7 +9906,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 </itemizedlist> <sect4> - <title><xref linkend="sql-explain"></title> + <title><xref linkend="sql-explain"/></title> <itemizedlist> @@ -9979,7 +9979,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 </para> <para> - This is controlled with the new <xref linkend="sql-createview"> + This is controlled with the new <xref linkend="sql-createview"/> clause <literal>WITH CHECK OPTION</literal>. </para> </listitem> @@ -10013,22 +10013,22 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <para> Allow moving groups of objects from one tablespace to another using the <literal>ALL IN TABLESPACE ... SET TABLESPACE</literal> form of - <xref linkend="sql-altertable">, <xref linkend="sql-alterindex">, or - <xref linkend="sql-altermaterializedview"> (Stephen Frost) + <xref linkend="sql-altertable"/>, <xref linkend="sql-alterindex"/>, or + <xref linkend="sql-altermaterializedview"/> (Stephen Frost) </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> Allow changing foreign key constraint deferrability - via <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> ... <literal>ALTER + via <xref linkend="sql-altertable"/> ... <literal>ALTER CONSTRAINT</literal> (Simon Riggs) </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Reduce lock strength for some <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> + Reduce lock strength for some <xref linkend="sql-altertable"/> commands (Simon Riggs, Noah Misch, Robert Haas) </para> @@ -10046,18 +10046,18 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> Allow tablespace options to be set - in <xref linkend="sql-createtablespace"> (Vik Fearing) + in <xref linkend="sql-createtablespace"/> (Vik Fearing) </para> <para> Formerly these options could only be set - via <xref linkend="sql-altertablespace">. + via <xref linkend="sql-altertablespace"/>. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Allow <xref linkend="sql-createaggregate"> to define the estimated + Allow <xref linkend="sql-createaggregate"/> to define the estimated size of the aggregate's transition state data (Hadi Moshayedi) </para> @@ -10544,14 +10544,14 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> - Add <xref linkend="app-createuser"> option <option>-g</option> + Add <xref linkend="app-createuser"/> option <option>-g</option> to specify role membership (Christopher Browne) </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add <xref linkend="app-vacuumdb"> + Add <xref linkend="app-vacuumdb"/> option <option>--analyze-in-stages</option> to analyze in stages of increasing granularity (Peter Eisentraut) </para> @@ -10571,7 +10571,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> - Make <xref linkend="app-initdb"> throw error for incorrect locale + Make <xref linkend="app-initdb"/> throw error for incorrect locale settings, rather than silently falling back to a default choice (Tom Lane) </para> @@ -10579,7 +10579,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> - Make <xref linkend="app-pg-ctl"> return exit code <literal>4</literal> for + Make <xref linkend="app-pg-ctl"/> return exit code <literal>4</literal> for an inaccessible data directory (Amit Kapila, Bruce Momjian) </para> @@ -10593,7 +10593,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <para> On Windows, ensure that a non-absolute <option>-D</option> path specification is interpreted relative - to <xref linkend="app-pg-ctl">'s current directory + to <xref linkend="app-pg-ctl"/>'s current directory (Kumar Rajeev Rastogi) </para> @@ -10621,7 +10621,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 </itemizedlist> <sect4> - <title><xref linkend="app-psql"></title> + <title><xref linkend="app-psql"/></title> <itemizedlist> @@ -10753,13 +10753,13 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 </sect4> <sect4> - <title><xref linkend="app-pgdump"></title> + <title><xref linkend="app-pgdump"/></title> <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> - Allow <xref linkend="app-pgrestore"> options + Allow <xref linkend="app-pgrestore"/> options <option>-I</option>, <option>-P</option>, <option>-T</option> and <option>-n</option> to be specified multiple times (Heikki Linnakangas) </para> @@ -10779,8 +10779,8 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <para> This change prevents unnecessary errors when removing old objects. The new <option>--if-exists</option> option - for <xref linkend="app-pgdump">, <xref linkend="app-pg-dumpall">, - and <xref linkend="app-pgrestore"> is only available + for <xref linkend="app-pgdump"/>, <xref linkend="app-pg-dumpall"/>, + and <xref linkend="app-pgrestore"/> is only available when <option>--clean</option> is also specified. </para> </listitem> @@ -10790,7 +10790,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 </sect4> <sect4> - <title><xref linkend="app-pgbasebackup"></title> + <title><xref linkend="app-pgbasebackup"/></title> <itemizedlist> @@ -11081,7 +11081,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> - Add <xref linkend="pgprewarm"> extension to preload relation data + Add <xref linkend="pgprewarm"/> extension to preload relation data into the shared buffer cache at server start (Robert Haas) </para> @@ -11093,19 +11093,19 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> Add <acronym>UUID</acronym> random number generator - <function>gen_random_uuid()</function> to <xref linkend="pgcrypto"> + <function>gen_random_uuid()</function> to <xref linkend="pgcrypto"/> (Oskari Saarenmaa) </para> <para> This allows creation of version 4 <acronym>UUID</acronym>s without - requiring installation of <xref linkend="uuid-ossp">. + requiring installation of <xref linkend="uuid-ossp"/>. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Allow <xref linkend="uuid-ossp"> to work with + Allow <xref linkend="uuid-ossp"/> to work with the <systemitem>BSD</systemitem> or <systemitem>e2fsprogs</systemitem> UUID libraries, not only the <systemitem>OSSP</systemitem> UUID library (Matteo Beccati) </para> @@ -11120,21 +11120,21 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> - Add option to <xref linkend="auto-explain"> to include trigger + Add option to <xref linkend="auto-explain"/> to include trigger execution time (Horiguchi Kyotaro) </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Fix <xref linkend="pgstattuple"> to not report rows from + Fix <xref linkend="pgstattuple"/> to not report rows from uncommitted transactions as dead (Robert Haas) </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Make <xref linkend="pgstattuple"> functions + Make <xref linkend="pgstattuple"/> functions use <type>regclass</type>-type arguments (Satoshi Nagayasu) </para> @@ -11146,14 +11146,14 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> - Improve consistency of <xref linkend="pgrowlocks"> output to honor + Improve consistency of <xref linkend="pgrowlocks"/> output to honor snapshot rules more consistently (Robert Haas) </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Improve <xref linkend="pgtrgm">'s choice of trigrams for indexed + Improve <xref linkend="pgtrgm"/>'s choice of trigrams for indexed regular expression searches (Alexander Korotkov) </para> @@ -11173,7 +11173,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> - Store <xref linkend="cube"> data more compactly (Stas Kelvich) + Store <xref linkend="cube"/> data more compactly (Stas Kelvich) </para> <para> @@ -11184,7 +11184,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> - Reduce <xref linkend="vacuumlo"> client-side memory usage by using + Reduce <xref linkend="vacuumlo"/> client-side memory usage by using a cursor (Andrew Dunstan) </para> </listitem> @@ -11192,13 +11192,13 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 <listitem> <para> Dramatically reduce memory consumption - in <xref linkend="pgupgrade"> (Bruce Momjian) + in <xref linkend="pgupgrade"/> (Bruce Momjian) </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Pass <xref linkend="pgupgrade">'s user name (<option>-U</option>) option to + Pass <xref linkend="pgupgrade"/>'s user name (<option>-U</option>) option to generated analyze scripts (Bruce Momjian) </para> </listitem> @@ -11206,7 +11206,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 </itemizedlist> <sect4> - <title><xref linkend="pgbench"></title> + <title><xref linkend="pgbench"/></title> <itemizedlist> @@ -11247,7 +11247,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [c2b06ab17] 2015-01-30 22:45:58 -0500 </sect4> <sect4> - <title><xref linkend="pgstatstatements"></title> + <title><xref linkend="pgstatstatements"/></title> <itemizedlist> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/release-9.5.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/release-9.5.sgml index a1e68ba283a..d79d953d516 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/release-9.5.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/release-9.5.sgml @@ -12,7 +12,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.5.9. For information about new features in the 9.5 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-5">. + <xref linkend="release-9-5"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -28,7 +28,7 @@ <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.5.8, - see <xref linkend="release-9-5-8">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-5-8"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -373,7 +373,7 @@ <para> This release contains a small number of fixes from 9.5.8. For information about new features in the 9.5 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-5">. + <xref linkend="release-9-5"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -385,7 +385,7 @@ <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.5.8, - see <xref linkend="release-9-5-8">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-5-8"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -550,7 +550,7 @@ CREATE OR REPLACE VIEW table_privileges AS <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.5.7. For information about new features in the 9.5 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-5">. + <xref linkend="release-9-5"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -567,7 +567,7 @@ CREATE OR REPLACE VIEW table_privileges AS <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.5.7, - see <xref linkend="release-9-5-7">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-5-7"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -792,7 +792,7 @@ UPDATE pg_database SET datallowconn = false WHERE datname = 'template0'; <listitem> <para> - Fix code for setting <xref linkend="guc-tcp-keepalives-idle"> on + Fix code for setting <xref linkend="guc-tcp-keepalives-idle"/> on Solaris (Tom Lane) </para> </listitem> @@ -1132,7 +1132,7 @@ UPDATE pg_database SET datallowconn = false WHERE datname = 'template0'; <listitem> <para> Fix <application>pg_upgrade</application> to ensure that the ending WAL record - does not have <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"> = <literal>minimum</literal> + does not have <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"/> = <literal>minimum</literal> (Bruce Momjian) </para> @@ -1257,7 +1257,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [1188b9b2c] 2017-08-02 15:07:21 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.5.6. For information about new features in the 9.5 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-5">. + <xref linkend="release-9-5"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1279,7 +1279,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [1188b9b2c] 2017-08-02 15:07:21 -0400 <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.5.6, - see <xref linkend="release-9-5-6">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-5-6"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1313,7 +1313,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [1188b9b2c] 2017-08-02 15:07:21 -0400 By itself, this patch will only fix the behavior in newly initdb'd databases. If you wish to apply this change in an existing database, follow the corrected procedure shown in the changelog entry for - CVE-2017-7547, in <xref linkend="release-9-5-8">. + CVE-2017-7547, in <xref linkend="release-9-5-8"/>. </para> </listitem> @@ -1804,7 +1804,7 @@ Branch: REL9_3_STABLE [3aa16b117] 2017-05-06 22:17:35 -0400 will use the current and historical DST transition dates of the <literal>US/Eastern</literal> zone. If you don't want that, remove the <filename>posixrules</filename> file, or replace it with a copy of some - other zone file (see <xref linkend="datatype-timezones">). Note that + other zone file (see <xref linkend="datatype-timezones"/>). Note that due to caching, you may need to restart the server to get such changes to take effect. </para> @@ -1826,7 +1826,7 @@ Branch: REL9_3_STABLE [3aa16b117] 2017-05-06 22:17:35 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.5.5. For information about new features in the 9.5 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-5">. + <xref linkend="release-9-5"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -1844,7 +1844,7 @@ Branch: REL9_3_STABLE [3aa16b117] 2017-05-06 22:17:35 -0400 <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.5.5, - see <xref linkend="release-9-5-5">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-5-5"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1904,7 +1904,7 @@ Branch: REL9_3_STABLE [3aa16b117] 2017-05-06 22:17:35 -0400 </para> <para> - Previously, this was skipped when <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"> + Previously, this was skipped when <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"/> = <literal>minimal</literal>, but actually it's necessary even in that case to ensure that the unlogged table is properly reset to empty after a crash. @@ -1982,7 +1982,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [30e3cb307] 2016-11-17 13:31:30 -0300 <para> Previously, non-default settings - of <xref linkend="guc-default-tablespace"> could result in broken + of <xref linkend="guc-default-tablespace"/> could result in broken indexes. </para> </listitem> @@ -2488,7 +2488,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [60314e28e] 2016-12-13 19:08:09 -0600 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.5.4. For information about new features in the 9.5 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-5">. + <xref linkend="release-9-5"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2506,7 +2506,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [60314e28e] 2016-12-13 19:08:09 -0600 <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.5.2, - see <xref linkend="release-9-5-2">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-5-2"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2677,7 +2677,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [566afa15c] 2016-08-24 22:20:01 -0400 <listitem> <para> Fix <command>EXPLAIN</command> to emit valid XML when - <xref linkend="guc-track-io-timing"> is on (Markus Winand) + <xref linkend="guc-track-io-timing"/> is on (Markus Winand) </para> <para> @@ -2802,7 +2802,7 @@ Branch: REL9_1_STABLE [7e01c8ef3] 2016-08-14 15:06:02 -0400 </para> <para> - With <xref linkend="guc-track-commit-timestamp"> turned on, old + With <xref linkend="guc-track-commit-timestamp"/> turned on, old commit timestamps became inaccessible after a clean server restart. </para> </listitem> @@ -3312,7 +3312,7 @@ Branch: REL9_1_STABLE [380dad29d] 2016-09-02 17:29:32 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.5.3. For information about new features in the 9.5 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-5">. + <xref linkend="release-9-5"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -3324,7 +3324,7 @@ Branch: REL9_1_STABLE [380dad29d] 2016-09-02 17:29:32 -0400 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.5.2, - see <xref linkend="release-9-5-2">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-5-2"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -4385,7 +4385,7 @@ Branch: REL9_1_STABLE [a44388ffe] 2016-08-05 12:59:02 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.5.2. For information about new features in the 9.5 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-5">. + <xref linkend="release-9-5"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -4397,7 +4397,7 @@ Branch: REL9_1_STABLE [a44388ffe] 2016-08-05 12:59:02 -0400 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.5.2, - see <xref linkend="release-9-5-2">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-5-2"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -4484,7 +4484,7 @@ Branch: REL9_5_STABLE [81deadd31] 2016-04-21 23:17:36 -0400 --> <para> Fix corner-case parser failures occurring - when <xref linkend="guc-operator-precedence-warning"> is turned on + when <xref linkend="guc-operator-precedence-warning"/> is turned on (Tom Lane) </para> @@ -4886,7 +4886,7 @@ Branch: REL9_1_STABLE [bfc39da64] 2016-05-05 20:09:32 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.5.1. For information about new features in the 9.5 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-5">. + <xref linkend="release-9-5"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -5170,7 +5170,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [a9613ee69] 2016-03-06 02:43:26 +0900 <listitem> <para> - Ignore <xref linkend="recovery-min-apply-delay"> parameter until + Ignore <xref linkend="recovery-min-apply-delay"/> parameter until recovery has reached a consistent state (Michael Paquier) </para> @@ -5597,7 +5597,7 @@ Branch: REL9_1_STABLE [e5fd35cc5] 2016-03-25 19:03:54 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.5.0. For information about new features in the 9.5 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-5">. + <xref linkend="release-9-5"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -6116,8 +6116,8 @@ Branch: REL9_1_STABLE [6887d72d0] 2016-02-05 10:59:39 -0500 <title>Migration to Version 9.5</title> <para> - A dump/restore using <xref linkend="app-pg-dumpall">, or use - of <xref linkend="pgupgrade">, is required for those wishing to migrate + A dump/restore using <xref linkend="app-pg-dumpall"/>, or use + of <xref linkend="pgupgrade"/>, is required for those wishing to migrate data from any previous release. </para> @@ -6150,7 +6150,7 @@ Branch: REL9_1_STABLE [6887d72d0] 2016-02-05 10:59:39 -0500 before they had inconsistent precedence, behaving like <literal>NOT</literal> with respect to their left operand but like their base operator with respect to their right operand. The new configuration - parameter <xref linkend="guc-operator-precedence-warning"> can be + parameter <xref linkend="guc-operator-precedence-warning"/> can be enabled to warn about queries in which these precedence changes result in different parsing choices. </para> @@ -6161,7 +6161,7 @@ Branch: REL9_1_STABLE [6887d72d0] 2016-02-05 10:59:39 -0500 2015-03-31 [0badb06] Bruce ..: pg_ctl: change default shutdown mode from 'sma.. --> <para> - Change <xref linkend="app-pg-ctl">'s default shutdown mode from + Change <xref linkend="app-pg-ctl"/>'s default shutdown mode from <literal>smart</literal> to <literal>fast</literal> (Bruce Momjian) </para> @@ -6229,8 +6229,8 @@ Branch: REL9_1_STABLE [6887d72d0] 2016-02-05 10:59:39 -0500 --> <para> Replace configuration parameter <varname>checkpoint_segments</varname> - with <xref linkend="guc-min-wal-size"> - and <xref linkend="guc-max-wal-size"> (Heikki Linnakangas) + with <xref linkend="guc-min-wal-size"/> + and <xref linkend="guc-max-wal-size"/> (Heikki Linnakangas) </para> <para> @@ -6409,14 +6409,14 @@ max_wal_size = (3 * checkpoint_segments) * 16MB Add GUC and storage parameter to set the maximum size of GIN pending list. --> <para> - Add configuration parameter <xref linkend="guc-gin-pending-list-limit"> + Add configuration parameter <xref linkend="guc-gin-pending-list-limit"/> to control the size of <acronym>GIN</acronym> pending lists (Fujii Masao) </para> <para> This value can also be set on a per-index basis as an index storage parameter. Previously the pending-list size was controlled - by <xref linkend="guc-work-mem">, which was awkward because + by <xref linkend="guc-work-mem"/>, which was awkward because appropriate values for <varname>work_mem</varname> are often much too large for this purpose. </para> @@ -6654,7 +6654,7 @@ Add GUC and storage parameter to set the maximum size of GIN pending list. 2014-06-29 [51adcaa] Andres..: Add cluster_name GUC which is included in proce.. --> <para> - Add new configuration parameter <xref linkend="guc-cluster-name"> + Add new configuration parameter <xref linkend="guc-cluster-name"/> (Thomas Munro) </para> @@ -6673,7 +6673,7 @@ Add GUC and storage parameter to set the maximum size of GIN pending list. --> <para> Prevent non-superusers from changing <xref - linkend="guc-log-disconnections"> on connection startup (Fujii Masao) + linkend="guc-log-disconnections"/> on connection startup (Fujii Masao) </para> </listitem> @@ -6768,8 +6768,8 @@ Add GUC and storage parameter to set the maximum size of GIN pending list. --> <para> Replace configuration parameter <varname>checkpoint_segments</varname> - with <xref linkend="guc-min-wal-size"> - and <xref linkend="guc-max-wal-size"> (Heikki Linnakangas) + with <xref linkend="guc-min-wal-size"/> + and <xref linkend="guc-max-wal-size"/> (Heikki Linnakangas) </para> <para> @@ -6812,7 +6812,7 @@ Add GUC and storage parameter to set the maximum size of GIN pending list. <para> Allow recording of transaction commit time stamps when configuration parameter <xref - linkend="guc-track-commit-timestamp"> + linkend="guc-track-commit-timestamp"/> is enabled (Álvaro Herrera, Petr Jelínek) </para> @@ -6828,7 +6828,7 @@ Add GUC and storage parameter to set the maximum size of GIN pending list. 2014-12-22 [584e35d] Peter ..: Change local_preload_libraries to PGC_USERSET --> <para> - Allow <xref linkend="guc-local-preload-libraries"> to be set + Allow <xref linkend="guc-local-preload-libraries"/> to be set by <command>ALTER ROLE SET</command> (Peter Eisentraut, Kyotaro Horiguchi) </para> </listitem> @@ -6849,7 +6849,7 @@ Add GUC and storage parameter to set the maximum size of GIN pending list. 2014-06-20 [3bdcf6a] Andres..: Don't allow to disable backend assertions via t.. --> <para> - Make configuration parameter <xref linkend="guc-debug-assertions"> + Make configuration parameter <xref linkend="guc-debug-assertions"/> read-only (Andres Freund) </para> @@ -6866,7 +6866,7 @@ Add GUC and storage parameter to set the maximum size of GIN pending list. 2014-10-18 [7feaccc] Peter ..: Allow setting effective_io_concurrency even on.. --> <para> - Allow setting <xref linkend="guc-effective-io-concurrency"> on + Allow setting <xref linkend="guc-effective-io-concurrency"/> on systems where it has no effect (Peter Eisentraut) </para> </listitem> @@ -6977,7 +6977,7 @@ Add GUC and storage parameter to set the maximum size of GIN pending list. 2015-05-15 [ffd3774] Heikki..: Add archive_mode='always' option. --> <para> - Add new <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"> value + Add new <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"/> value <literal>always</literal> to allow standbys to always archive received <acronym>WAL</acronym> files (Fujii Masao) </para> @@ -6989,7 +6989,7 @@ Add GUC and storage parameter to set the maximum size of GIN pending list. --> <para> Add configuration - parameter <xref linkend="guc-wal-retrieve-retry-interval"> to + parameter <xref linkend="guc-wal-retrieve-retry-interval"/> to control <acronym>WAL</acronym> read retry after failure (Alexey Vasiliev, Michael Paquier) </para> @@ -7011,7 +7011,7 @@ Add GUC and storage parameter to set the maximum size of GIN pending list. <para> This feature reduces WAL volume, at the cost of more CPU time spent on WAL logging and WAL replay. It is controlled by a new - configuration parameter <xref linkend="guc-wal-compression">, which + configuration parameter <xref linkend="guc-wal-compression"/>, which currently is off by default. </para> </listitem> @@ -7032,14 +7032,14 @@ Add GUC and storage parameter to set the maximum size of GIN pending list. --> <para> Add configuration parameter <xref - linkend="guc-log-replication-commands"> + linkend="guc-log-replication-commands"/> to log replication commands (Fujii Masao) </para> <para> By default, replication commands, e.g. <link linkend="protocol-replication"><literal>IDENTIFY_SYSTEM</literal></link>, - are not logged, even when <xref linkend="guc-log-statement"> is set + are not logged, even when <xref linkend="guc-log-statement"/> is set to <literal>all</literal>. </para> </listitem> @@ -7219,7 +7219,7 @@ Add GUC and storage parameter to set the maximum size of GIN pending list. </itemizedlist> <sect4> - <title><xref linkend="sql-reindex"></title> + <title><xref linkend="sql-reindex"/></title> <itemizedlist> @@ -7347,8 +7347,8 @@ Add GUC and storage parameter to set the maximum size of GIN pending list. <para> This feature is now supported in - <xref linkend="sql-alteruser">, <xref linkend="sql-altergroup">, - <xref linkend="sql-alterrole">, <xref linkend="sql-grant">, + <xref linkend="sql-alteruser"/>, <xref linkend="sql-altergroup"/>, + <xref linkend="sql-alterrole"/>, <xref linkend="sql-grant"/>, and <command>ALTER <replaceable>object</replaceable> OWNER TO</command> commands. </para> </listitem> @@ -7436,7 +7436,7 @@ Add GUC and storage parameter to set the maximum size of GIN pending list. 2014-07-10 [59efda3] Tom Lane: Implement IMPORT FOREIGN SCHEMA. --> <para> - Add support for <xref linkend="sql-importforeignschema"> + Add support for <xref linkend="sql-importforeignschema"/> (Ronan Dunklau, Michael Paquier, Tom Lane) </para> @@ -8190,7 +8190,7 @@ Add GUC and storage parameter to set the maximum size of GIN pending list. </itemizedlist> <sect4> - <title><xref linkend="app-psql"></title> + <title><xref linkend="app-psql"/></title> <itemizedlist> @@ -8289,7 +8289,7 @@ Add GUC and storage parameter to set the maximum size of GIN pending list. --> <para> Add <application>psql</application> tab completion when setting the - <xref linkend="guc-search-path"> variable (Jeff Janes) + <xref linkend="guc-search-path"/> variable (Jeff Janes) </para> <para> @@ -8406,7 +8406,7 @@ Add GUC and storage parameter to set the maximum size of GIN pending list. </sect4> <sect4> - <title><xref linkend="app-pgdump"></title> + <title><xref linkend="app-pgdump"/></title> <itemizedlist> @@ -8474,7 +8474,7 @@ Add GUC and storage parameter to set the maximum size of GIN pending list. </sect4> <sect4> - <title><xref linkend="app-pg-ctl"></title> + <title><xref linkend="app-pg-ctl"/></title> <itemizedlist> @@ -8525,7 +8525,7 @@ Add GUC and storage parameter to set the maximum size of GIN pending list. </sect4> <sect4> - <title><xref linkend="pgupgrade"></title> + <title><xref linkend="pgupgrade"/></title> <itemizedlist> @@ -8580,7 +8580,7 @@ Add GUC and storage parameter to set the maximum size of GIN pending list. </sect4> <sect4> - <title><xref linkend="pgbench"></title> + <title><xref linkend="pgbench"/></title> <itemizedlist> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/release-9.6.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/release-9.6.sgml index 65df3113c2c..ce040f1a5ad 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/release-9.6.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/release-9.6.sgml @@ -12,7 +12,7 @@ <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.6.5. For information about new features in the 9.6 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-6">. + <xref linkend="release-9-6"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -28,7 +28,7 @@ <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.6.4, - see <xref linkend="release-9-6-4">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-6-4"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -591,7 +591,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [1317d1301] 2017-10-23 17:54:09 -0400 <para> This release contains a small number of fixes from 9.6.4. For information about new features in the 9.6 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-6">. + <xref linkend="release-9-6"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -603,7 +603,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [1317d1301] 2017-10-23 17:54:09 -0400 <para> However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.6.4, - see <xref linkend="release-9-6-4">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-6-4"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -870,7 +870,7 @@ Branch: REL9_5_STABLE [a784d5f21] 2017-08-09 12:06:14 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.6.3. For information about new features in the 9.6 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-6">. + <xref linkend="release-9-6"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -887,7 +887,7 @@ Branch: REL9_5_STABLE [a784d5f21] 2017-08-09 12:06:14 -0400 <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.6.3, - see <xref linkend="release-9-6-3">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-6-3"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1217,7 +1217,7 @@ Branch: REL9_3_STABLE [cc154d9a0] 2017-06-28 12:30:16 -0400 Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [5e7447132] 2017-06-28 12:30:16 -0400 --> <para> - Fix code for setting <xref linkend="guc-tcp-keepalives-idle"> on + Fix code for setting <xref linkend="guc-tcp-keepalives-idle"/> on Solaris (Tom Lane) </para> </listitem> @@ -1950,7 +1950,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [65beccae5] 2017-06-20 13:20:02 -0400 --> <para> Fix <application>pg_upgrade</application> to ensure that the ending WAL record - does not have <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"> = <literal>minimum</literal> + does not have <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"/> = <literal>minimum</literal> (Bruce Momjian) </para> @@ -2151,7 +2151,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [9c3f502b4] 2017-07-16 11:27:15 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.6.2. For information about new features in the 9.6 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-6">. + <xref linkend="release-9-6"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -2173,7 +2173,7 @@ Branch: REL9_4_STABLE [9c3f502b4] 2017-07-16 11:27:15 -0400 <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.6.2, - see <xref linkend="release-9-6-2">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-6-2"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2216,7 +2216,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [99cbb0bd9] 2017-05-08 07:24:28 -0700 By itself, this patch will only fix the behavior in newly initdb'd databases. If you wish to apply this change in an existing database, follow the corrected procedure shown in the changelog entry for - CVE-2017-7547, in <xref linkend="release-9-6-4">. + CVE-2017-7547, in <xref linkend="release-9-6-4"/>. </para> </listitem> @@ -3181,7 +3181,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [82e7d3dfd] 2017-05-07 11:57:41 -0400 will use the current and historical DST transition dates of the <literal>US/Eastern</literal> zone. If you don't want that, remove the <filename>posixrules</filename> file, or replace it with a copy of some - other zone file (see <xref linkend="datatype-timezones">). Note that + other zone file (see <xref linkend="datatype-timezones"/>). Note that due to caching, you may need to restart the server to get such changes to take effect. </para> @@ -3203,7 +3203,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [82e7d3dfd] 2017-05-07 11:57:41 -0400 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.6.1. For information about new features in the 9.6 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-6">. + <xref linkend="release-9-6"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -3221,7 +3221,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [82e7d3dfd] 2017-05-07 11:57:41 -0400 <para> Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 9.6.1, - see <xref linkend="release-9-6-1">. + see <xref linkend="release-9-6-1"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -3312,7 +3312,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [a00ac6299] 2016-12-08 14:19:25 -0500 </para> <para> - Previously, this was skipped when <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"> + Previously, this was skipped when <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"/> = <literal>minimal</literal>, but actually it's necessary even in that case to ensure that the unlogged table is properly reset to empty after a crash. @@ -3396,7 +3396,7 @@ Branch: REL9_6_STABLE [6c75fb6b3] 2016-12-17 02:25:47 +0900 --> <para> Disallow setting the <replaceable>num_sync</replaceable> field to zero in - <xref linkend="guc-synchronous-standby-names"> (Fujii Masao) + <xref linkend="guc-synchronous-standby-names"/> (Fujii Masao) </para> <para> @@ -3475,7 +3475,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [05975ab0a] 2016-11-23 13:45:56 -0500 <para> Previously, non-default settings - of <xref linkend="guc-default-tablespace"> could result in broken + of <xref linkend="guc-default-tablespace"/> could result in broken indexes. </para> </listitem> @@ -4620,7 +4620,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [ef878cc2c] 2017-01-30 11:41:09 -0500 <para> This release contains a variety of fixes from 9.6.0. For information about new features in the 9.6 major release, see - <xref linkend="release-9-6">. + <xref linkend="release-9-6"/>. </para> <sect2> @@ -4781,7 +4781,7 @@ Branch: REL9_2_STABLE [f17c26dbd] 2016-10-20 17:18:14 -0400 --> <para> Fix <command>EXPLAIN</command> to emit valid XML when - <xref linkend="guc-track-io-timing"> is on (Markus Winand) + <xref linkend="guc-track-io-timing"/> is on (Markus Winand) </para> <para> @@ -4899,7 +4899,7 @@ Branch: REL9_5_STABLE [7a2fa5774] 2016-10-24 09:38:28 -0300 </para> <para> - With <xref linkend="guc-track-commit-timestamp"> turned on, old + With <xref linkend="guc-track-commit-timestamp"/> turned on, old commit timestamps became inaccessible after a clean server restart. </para> </listitem> @@ -5275,8 +5275,8 @@ Branch: REL9_1_STABLE [22cf97635] 2016-10-19 17:57:06 -0400 <title>Migration to Version 9.6</title> <para> - A dump/restore using <xref linkend="app-pg-dumpall">, or use of <xref - linkend="pgupgrade">, is required for those wishing to migrate data + A dump/restore using <xref linkend="app-pg-dumpall"/>, or use of <xref + linkend="pgupgrade"/>, is required for those wishing to migrate data from any previous release. </para> @@ -5593,12 +5593,12 @@ and many others in the same vein <para> Parallel query execution is not (yet) enabled by default. To allow it, set the new configuration - parameter <xref linkend="guc-max-parallel-workers-per-gather"> to a + parameter <xref linkend="guc-max-parallel-workers-per-gather"/> to a value larger than zero. Additional control over use of parallelism is available through other new configuration parameters - <xref linkend="guc-force-parallel-mode">, - <xref linkend="guc-parallel-setup-cost">, <xref - linkend="guc-parallel-tuple-cost">, and + <xref linkend="guc-force-parallel-mode"/>, + <xref linkend="guc-parallel-setup-cost"/>, <xref + linkend="guc-parallel-tuple-cost"/>, and <literal>min_parallel_relation_size</literal>. </para> </listitem> @@ -5628,7 +5628,7 @@ and many others in the same vein --> <para> Allow <link linkend="gin"><acronym>GIN</acronym></link> index builds to - make effective use of <xref linkend="guc-maintenance-work-mem"> + make effective use of <xref linkend="guc-maintenance-work-mem"/> settings larger than 1 GB (Robert Abraham, Teodor Sigaev) </para> </listitem> @@ -5991,7 +5991,7 @@ and many others in the same vein time can thus cause considerable table bloat because space cannot be recycled. This feature allows setting a time-based limit, via the new configuration parameter - <xref linkend="guc-old-snapshot-threshold">, on how long an + <xref linkend="guc-old-snapshot-threshold"/>, on how long an <acronym>MVCC</acronym> snapshot is guaranteed to be valid. After that, dead tuples are candidates for removal. A transaction using an outdated snapshot will get an error if it attempts to read a page @@ -6094,10 +6094,10 @@ and many others in the same vein <para> The new configuration parameters <xref - linkend="guc-backend-flush-after">, <xref - linkend="guc-bgwriter-flush-after">, <xref - linkend="guc-checkpoint-flush-after">, and <xref - linkend="guc-wal-writer-flush-after"> control this behavior. + linkend="guc-backend-flush-after"/>, <xref + linkend="guc-bgwriter-flush-after"/>, <xref + linkend="guc-checkpoint-flush-after"/>, and <xref + linkend="guc-wal-writer-flush-after"/> control this behavior. </para> </listitem> @@ -6249,7 +6249,7 @@ and many others in the same vein 2016-08-17 [9b33c7e80] Disable update_process_title by default on Windows --> <para> - Disable <xref linkend="guc-update-process-title"> by default on + Disable <xref linkend="guc-update-process-title"/> by default on Windows (Takayuki Tsunakawa) </para> @@ -6497,7 +6497,7 @@ and many others in the same vein <para> This behavior is controlled by the new configuration parameter - <xref linkend="guc-idle-in-transaction-session-timeout">. It can + <xref linkend="guc-idle-in-transaction-session-timeout"/>. It can be useful to prevent forgotten transactions from holding locks or preventing vacuum cleanup for too long. </para> @@ -6509,7 +6509,7 @@ and many others in the same vein --> <para> Raise the maximum allowed value - of <xref linkend="guc-checkpoint-timeout"> to 24 hours (Simon Riggs) + of <xref linkend="guc-checkpoint-timeout"/> to 24 hours (Simon Riggs) </para> </listitem> @@ -6530,7 +6530,7 @@ and many others in the same vein 2015-09-07 [b1e1862a1] Coordinate log_line_prefix options 'm' and 'n' to share --> <para> - Add <xref linkend="guc-log-line-prefix"> option <literal>%n</literal> to + Add <xref linkend="guc-log-line-prefix"/> option <literal>%n</literal> to print the current time in Unix epoch form, with milliseconds (Tomas Vondra, Jeff Davis) </para> @@ -6542,8 +6542,8 @@ and many others in the same vein 2016-03-16 [fc201dfd9] Add syslog_split_messages parameter --> <para> - Add <xref linkend="guc-syslog-sequence-numbers"> and <xref - linkend="guc-syslog-split-messages"> configuration parameters + Add <xref linkend="guc-syslog-sequence-numbers"/> and <xref + linkend="guc-syslog-split-messages"/> configuration parameters to provide more control over the message format when logging to <systemitem>syslog</systemitem> (Peter Eisentraut) </para> @@ -6555,7 +6555,7 @@ and many others in the same vein --> <para> Merge the <literal>archive</literal> and <literal>hot_standby</literal> values - of the <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"> configuration parameter + of the <xref linkend="guc-wal-level"/> configuration parameter into a single new value <literal>replica</literal> (Peter Eisentraut) </para> @@ -6717,7 +6717,7 @@ XXX this is pending backpatch, may need to remove <para> The number of standby servers that must acknowledge a commit before it is considered complete is now configurable as part of - the <xref linkend="guc-synchronous-standby-names"> parameter. + the <xref linkend="guc-synchronous-standby-names"/> parameter. </para> </listitem> @@ -6727,7 +6727,7 @@ XXX this is pending backpatch, may need to remove --> <para> Add new setting <literal>remote_apply</literal> for configuration - parameter <xref linkend="guc-synchronous-commit"> (Thomas Munro) + parameter <xref linkend="guc-synchronous-commit"/> (Thomas Munro) </para> <para> @@ -7871,7 +7871,7 @@ This commit is also listed under psql and PL/pgSQL </itemizedlist> <sect4> - <title><xref linkend="app-psql"></title> + <title><xref linkend="app-psql"/></title> <itemizedlist> @@ -8073,7 +8073,7 @@ This commit is also listed under libpq and PL/pgSQL </sect4> <sect4> - <title><xref linkend="pgbench"></title> + <title><xref linkend="pgbench"/></title> <itemizedlist> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/release-old.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/release-old.sgml index e95e5cac24b..d55209d85b1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/release-old.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/release-old.sgml @@ -26,7 +26,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 7.3.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 7.3.13, - see <xref linkend="release-7-3-13">. + see <xref linkend="release-7-3-13"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -131,7 +131,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 7.3.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 7.3.13, - see <xref linkend="release-7-3-13">. + see <xref linkend="release-7-3-13"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -193,7 +193,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 7.3.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 7.3.13, - see <xref linkend="release-7-3-13">. + see <xref linkend="release-7-3-13"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -249,7 +249,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 7.3.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 7.3.13, - see <xref linkend="release-7-3-13">. + see <xref linkend="release-7-3-13"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -310,7 +310,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 7.3.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 7.3.13, - see <xref linkend="release-7-3-13">. + see <xref linkend="release-7-3-13"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -366,7 +366,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 7.3.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 7.3.13, - see <xref linkend="release-7-3-13">. + see <xref linkend="release-7-3-13"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -409,7 +409,7 @@ <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 7.3.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 7.3.13, - see <xref linkend="release-7-3-13">. + see <xref linkend="release-7-3-13"/>. </para> <para> @@ -500,7 +500,7 @@ Fuhr)</para></listitem> <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 7.3.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 7.3.13, - see <xref linkend="release-7-3-13">. + see <xref linkend="release-7-3-13"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -557,7 +557,7 @@ and <function>isinf</function> during configure (Tom)</para></listitem> <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 7.3.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 7.3.10, - see <xref linkend="release-7-3-10">. + see <xref linkend="release-7-3-10"/>. Also, you might need to <command>REINDEX</command> indexes on textual columns after updating, if you are affected by the locale or <application>plperl</application> issues described below. @@ -619,7 +619,7 @@ what's actually returned by the query (Joe)</para></listitem> <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 7.3.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 7.3.10, - see <xref linkend="release-7-3-10">. + see <xref linkend="release-7-3-10"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -666,7 +666,7 @@ table has been dropped</para></listitem> <para> A dump/restore is not required for those running 7.3.X. However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 7.3.10, - see <xref linkend="release-7-3-10">. + see <xref linkend="release-7-3-10"/>. </para> </sect2> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/replication-origins.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/replication-origins.sgml index 317ca9a1dfb..a03ce76e2ef 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/replication-origins.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/replication-origins.sgml @@ -83,7 +83,7 @@ replication and inefficiencies. Replication origins provide an optional mechanism to recognize and prevent that. When configured using the functions referenced in the previous paragraph, every change and transaction passed to - output plugin callbacks (see <xref linkend="logicaldecoding-output-plugin">) + output plugin callbacks (see <xref linkend="logicaldecoding-output-plugin"/>) generated by the session is tagged with the replication origin of the generating session. This allows treating them differently in the output plugin, e.g. ignoring all but locally-originating rows. Additionally diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/rowtypes.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/rowtypes.sgml index f80d44bc75c..3f24293175d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/rowtypes.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/rowtypes.sgml @@ -129,7 +129,7 @@ CREATE TABLE inventory_item ( <para> (These constants are actually only a special case of the generic type constants discussed in <xref - linkend="sql-syntax-constants-generic">. The constant is initially + linkend="sql-syntax-constants-generic"/>. The constant is initially treated as a string and passed to the composite-type input conversion routine. An explicit type specification might be necessary to tell which type to convert the constant to.) @@ -152,7 +152,7 @@ ROW('', 42, NULL) ('', 42, NULL) </programlisting> The <literal>ROW</literal> expression syntax is discussed in more detail in <xref - linkend="sql-syntax-row-constructors">. + linkend="sql-syntax-row-constructors"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -204,7 +204,7 @@ SELECT (my_func(...)).field FROM ... <para> The special field name <literal>*</literal> means <quote>all fields</quote>, as - further explained in <xref linkend="rowtypes-usage">. + further explained in <xref linkend="rowtypes-usage"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -384,7 +384,7 @@ SELECT * FROM inventory_item c ORDER BY ROW(c.*); </programlisting> All of these <literal>ORDER BY</literal> clauses specify the row's composite value, resulting in sorting the rows according to the rules described - in <xref linkend="composite-type-comparison">. However, + in <xref linkend="composite-type-comparison"/>. However, if <structname>inventory_item</structname> contained a column named <structfield>c</structfield>, the first case would be different from the others, as it would mean to sort by that column only. Given the column @@ -517,7 +517,7 @@ INSERT ... VALUES (E'("\\"\\\\")'); with a data type whose input routine also treated backslashes specially, <type>bytea</type> for example, we might need as many as eight backslashes in the command to get one backslash into the stored composite field.) - Dollar quoting (see <xref linkend="sql-syntax-dollar-quoting">) can be + Dollar quoting (see <xref linkend="sql-syntax-dollar-quoting"/>) can be used to avoid the need to double backslashes. </para> </note> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/rules.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/rules.sgml index 819f2a82946..2074fcca8ea 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/rules.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/rules.sgml @@ -29,8 +29,8 @@ execution. It is very powerful, and can be used for many things such as query language procedures, views, and versions. The theoretical foundations and the power of this rule system are - also discussed in <xref linkend="ston90b"> and <xref - linkend="ong90">. + also discussed in <xref linkend="ston90b"/> and <xref + linkend="ong90"/>. </para> <sect1 id="querytree"> @@ -172,7 +172,7 @@ to allow the executor to find the row to be deleted. (<acronym>CTID</acronym> is added when the result relation is an ordinary table. If it is a view, a whole-row variable is added instead, - as described in <xref linkend="rules-views-update">.) + as described in <xref linkend="rules-views-update"/>.) </para> <para> @@ -823,7 +823,7 @@ SELECT t1.a, t2.b, t1.ctid FROM t1, t2 WHERE t1.a = t2.a; the base relation in the appropriate way. Views that are <quote>simple enough</quote> for this are called <firstterm>automatically updatable</firstterm>. For detailed information on the kinds of view that can - be automatically updated, see <xref linkend="sql-createview">. + be automatically updated, see <xref linkend="sql-createview"/>. </para> <para> @@ -862,7 +862,7 @@ SELECT t1.a, t2.b, t1.ctid FROM t1, t2 WHERE t1.a = t2.a; <command>UPDATE</command>, and <command>DELETE</command> commands on a view. These rules will rewrite the command, typically into a command that updates one or more tables, rather than views. That is the topic - of <xref linkend="rules-update">. + of <xref linkend="rules-update"/>. </para> <para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/runtime.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/runtime.sgml index c8bc684c0e3..a2ebd3e21ca 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/runtime.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/runtime.sgml @@ -60,7 +60,7 @@ during initialization is called <literal>template1</literal>. As the name suggests, this will be used as a template for subsequently created databases; it should not be - used for actual work. (See <xref linkend="managing-databases"> for + used for actual work. (See <xref linkend="managing-databases"/> for information about creating new databases within a cluster.) </para> @@ -73,7 +73,7 @@ <filename>/usr/local/pgsql/data</filename> or <filename>/var/lib/pgsql/data</filename> are popular. To initialize a database cluster, use the command <xref - linkend="app-initdb">,<indexterm><primary>initdb</primary></indexterm> which is + linkend="app-initdb"/>,<indexterm><primary>initdb</primary></indexterm> which is installed with <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>. The desired file system location of your database cluster is indicated by the <option>-D</option> option, for example: @@ -95,14 +95,14 @@ <para> Alternatively, you can run <command>initdb</command> via - the <xref linkend="app-pg-ctl"> + the <xref linkend="app-pg-ctl"/> program<indexterm><primary>pg_ctl</primary></indexterm> like so: <screen> <prompt>$</prompt> <userinput>pg_ctl -D /usr/local/pgsql/data initdb</userinput> </screen> This may be more intuitive if you are using <command>pg_ctl</command> for starting and stopping the - server (see <xref linkend="server-start">), so + server (see <xref linkend="server-start"/>), so that <command>pg_ctl</command> would be the sole command you use for managing the database server instance. </para> @@ -158,7 +158,7 @@ postgres$ <userinput>initdb -D /usr/local/pgsql/data</userinput> <emphasis>before</emphasis> you start the server for the first time. (Other reasonable approaches include using <literal>peer</literal> authentication or file system permissions to restrict connections. See <xref - linkend="client-authentication"> for more information.) + linkend="client-authentication"/> for more information.) </para> <para> @@ -167,7 +167,7 @@ postgres$ <userinput>initdb -D /usr/local/pgsql/data</userinput> Normally, it will just take the locale settings in the environment and apply them to the initialized database. It is possible to specify a different locale for the database; more information about - that can be found in <xref linkend="locale">. The default sort order used + that can be found in <xref linkend="locale"/>. The default sort order used within the particular database cluster is set by <command>initdb</command>, and while you can create new databases using different sort order, the order used in the template databases that initdb @@ -180,7 +180,7 @@ postgres$ <userinput>initdb -D /usr/local/pgsql/data</userinput> <para> <command>initdb</command> also sets the default character set encoding for the database cluster. Normally this should be chosen to match the - locale setting. For details see <xref linkend="multibyte">. + locale setting. For details see <xref linkend="multibyte"/>. </para> <para> @@ -284,21 +284,21 @@ $ <userinput>postgres -D /usr/local/pgsql/data >logfile 2>&1 &</us It is important to store the server's <systemitem>stdout</systemitem> and <systemitem>stderr</systemitem> output somewhere, as shown above. It will help for auditing purposes and to diagnose problems. (See <xref - linkend="logfile-maintenance"> for a more thorough discussion of log + linkend="logfile-maintenance"/> for a more thorough discussion of log file handling.) </para> <para> The <command>postgres</command> program also takes a number of other command-line options. For more information, see the - <xref linkend="app-postgres"> reference page - and <xref linkend="runtime-config"> below. + <xref linkend="app-postgres"/> reference page + and <xref linkend="runtime-config"/> below. </para> <para> This shell syntax can get tedious quickly. Therefore the wrapper program - <xref linkend="app-pg-ctl"><indexterm><primary>pg_ctl</primary></indexterm> + <xref linkend="app-pg-ctl"/><indexterm><primary>pg_ctl</primary></indexterm> is provided to simplify some tasks. For example: <programlisting> pg_ctl start -l logfile @@ -494,7 +494,7 @@ DETAIL: Failed system call was shmget(key=5440001, size=4011376640, 03600). mean that you do not have System-V-style shared memory support configured into your kernel at all. As a temporary workaround, you can try starting the server with a smaller-than-normal number of - buffers (<xref linkend="guc-shared-buffers">). You will eventually want + buffers (<xref linkend="guc-shared-buffers"/>). You will eventually want to reconfigure your kernel to increase the allowed shared memory size. You might also see this message when trying to start multiple servers on the same machine, if their total space requested @@ -513,7 +513,7 @@ DETAIL: Failed system call was semget(5440126, 17, 03600). <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> wants to create. As above, you might be able to work around the problem by starting the server with a reduced number of allowed connections - (<xref linkend="guc-max-connections">), but you'll eventually want to + (<xref linkend="guc-max-connections"/>), but you'll eventually want to increase the kernel limit. </para> @@ -526,7 +526,7 @@ DETAIL: Failed system call was semget(5440126, 17, 03600). <para> Details about configuring <systemitem class="osname">System V</systemitem> - <acronym>IPC</acronym> facilities are given in <xref linkend="sysvipc">. + <acronym>IPC</acronym> facilities are given in <xref linkend="sysvipc"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -574,7 +574,7 @@ psql: could not connect to server: No such file or directory does <emphasis>not</emphasis> mean that the server got your connection request and rejected it. That case will produce a different message, as shown in <xref - linkend="client-authentication-problems">.) Other error messages + linkend="client-authentication-problems"/>.) Other error messages such as <computeroutput>Connection timed out</computeroutput> might indicate more fundamental problems, like lack of network connectivity. @@ -648,9 +648,9 @@ psql: could not connect to server: No such file or directory the server will refuse to start and should leave an instructive error message describing the problem and what to do about it. (See also <xref - linkend="server-start-failures">.) The relevant kernel + linkend="server-start-failures"/>.) The relevant kernel parameters are named consistently across different systems; <xref - linkend="sysvipc-parameters"> gives an overview. The methods to set + linkend="sysvipc-parameters"/> gives an overview. The methods to set them, however, vary. Suggestions for some platforms are given below. </para> @@ -756,9 +756,9 @@ psql: could not connect to server: No such file or directory <para> When using System V semaphores, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> uses one semaphore per allowed connection - (<xref linkend="guc-max-connections">), allowed autovacuum worker process - (<xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-max-workers">) and allowed background - process (<xref linkend="guc-max-worker-processes">), in sets of 16. + (<xref linkend="guc-max-connections"/>), allowed autovacuum worker process + (<xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-max-workers"/>) and allowed background + process (<xref linkend="guc-max-worker-processes"/>), in sets of 16. Each such set will also contain a 17th semaphore which contains a <quote>magic number</quote>, to detect collision with semaphore sets used by @@ -768,7 +768,7 @@ psql: could not connect to server: No such file or directory <varname>autovacuum_max_workers</varname> plus <varname>max_worker_processes</varname>, plus one extra for each 16 allowed connections plus workers (see the formula in <xref - linkend="sysvipc-parameters">). The parameter <varname>SEMMNI</varname> + linkend="sysvipc-parameters"/>). The parameter <varname>SEMMNI</varname> determines the limit on the number of semaphore sets that can exist on the system at one time. Hence this parameter must be at least <literal>ceil((max_connections + autovacuum_max_workers + max_worker_processes + 5) / 16)</literal>. @@ -800,9 +800,9 @@ psql: could not connect to server: No such file or directory <para> When using POSIX semaphores, the number of semaphores needed is the same as for System V, that is one semaphore per allowed connection - (<xref linkend="guc-max-connections">), allowed autovacuum worker process - (<xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-max-workers">) and allowed background - process (<xref linkend="guc-max-worker-processes">). + (<xref linkend="guc-max-connections"/>), allowed autovacuum worker process + (<xref linkend="guc-autovacuum-max-workers"/>) and allowed background + process (<xref linkend="guc-max-worker-processes"/>). On the platforms where this option is preferred, there is no specific kernel limit on the number of POSIX semaphores. </para> @@ -1321,7 +1321,7 @@ default:\ processes do so then the system-wide limit can easily be exceeded. If you find this happening, and you do not want to alter the system-wide limit, you can set <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>'s <xref - linkend="guc-max-files-per-process"> configuration parameter to + linkend="guc-max-files-per-process"/> configuration parameter to limit the consumption of open files. </para> </sect2> @@ -1465,7 +1465,7 @@ export PG_OOM_ADJUST_VALUE=0 <para> Using huge pages reduces overhead when using large contiguous chunks of memory, as <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> does, particularly when - using large values of <xref linkend="guc-shared-buffers">. To use this + using large values of <xref linkend="guc-shared-buffers"/>. To use this feature in <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> you need a kernel with <varname>CONFIG_HUGETLBFS=y</varname> and <varname>CONFIG_HUGETLB_PAGE=y</varname>. You will also have to adjust @@ -1517,7 +1517,7 @@ $ <userinput>grep Huge /proc/meminfo</userinput> The default behavior for huge pages in <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> is to use them when possible and to fall back to normal pages when failing. To enforce the use of huge - pages, you can set <xref linkend="guc-huge-pages"> + pages, you can set <xref linkend="guc-huge-pages"/> to <literal>on</literal> in <filename>postgresql.conf</filename>. Note that with this setting <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> will fail to start if not enough huge pages are available. @@ -1600,7 +1600,7 @@ $ <userinput>grep Huge /proc/meminfo</userinput> </para> <para> - The <xref linkend="app-pg-ctl"> program provides a convenient + The <xref linkend="app-pg-ctl"/> program provides a convenient interface for sending these signals to shut down the server. Alternatively, you can send the signal directly using <command>kill</command> on non-Windows systems. @@ -1629,7 +1629,7 @@ $ <userinput>kill -INT `head -1 /usr/local/pgsql/data/postmaster.pid`</userinput <para> To terminate an individual session while allowing other sessions to continue, use <function>pg_terminate_backend()</function> (see <xref - linkend="functions-admin-signal-table">) or send a + linkend="functions-admin-signal-table"/>) or send a <systemitem>SIGTERM</systemitem> signal to the child process associated with the session. </para> @@ -1680,7 +1680,7 @@ $ <userinput>kill -INT `head -1 /usr/local/pgsql/data/postmaster.pid`</userinput internal data storage format is subject to change, thus complicating upgrades. The traditional method for moving data to a new major version is to dump and reload the database, though this can be slow. A - faster method is <xref linkend="pgupgrade">. Replication methods are + faster method is <xref linkend="pgupgrade"/>. Replication methods are also available, as discussed below. </para> @@ -1688,7 +1688,7 @@ $ <userinput>kill -INT `head -1 /usr/local/pgsql/data/postmaster.pid`</userinput New major versions also typically introduce some user-visible incompatibilities, so application programming changes might be required. All user-visible changes are listed in the release notes (<xref - linkend="release">); pay particular attention to the section + linkend="release"/>); pay particular attention to the section labeled "Migration". If you are upgrading across several major versions, be sure to read the release notes for each intervening version. @@ -1794,7 +1794,7 @@ $ <userinput>kill -INT `head -1 /usr/local/pgsql/data/postmaster.pid`</userinput data would of course not be included. If necessary, edit the permissions in the file <filename>/usr/local/pgsql/data/pg_hba.conf</filename> (or equivalent) to disallow access from everyone except you. - See <xref linkend="client-authentication"> for additional information on + See <xref linkend="client-authentication"/> for additional information on access control. </para> @@ -1813,7 +1813,7 @@ $ <userinput>kill -INT `head -1 /usr/local/pgsql/data/postmaster.pid`</userinput <para> To make the backup, you can use the <application>pg_dumpall</application> command from the version you are currently running; see <xref - linkend="backup-dump-all"> for more details. For best + linkend="backup-dump-all"/> for more details. For best results, however, try to use the <application>pg_dumpall</application> command from <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> &version;, since this version contains bug fixes and improvements over older @@ -1839,7 +1839,7 @@ $ <userinput>kill -INT `head -1 /usr/local/pgsql/data/postmaster.pid`</userinput <screen> <userinput>/etc/rc.d/init.d/postgresql stop</userinput> </screen> - See <xref linkend="runtime"> for details about starting and + See <xref linkend="runtime"/> for details about starting and stopping the server. </para> </step> @@ -1863,7 +1863,7 @@ $ <userinput>kill -INT `head -1 /usr/local/pgsql/data/postmaster.pid`</userinput <step> <para> Install the new version of <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> as - outlined in <xref linkend="install-procedure">. + outlined in <xref linkend="install-procedure"/>. </para> </step> @@ -1923,7 +1923,7 @@ pg_dumpall -p 5432 | psql -d postgres -p 5433 <title>Upgrading Data via <application>pg_upgrade</application></title> <para> - The <xref linkend="pgupgrade"> module allows an installation to + The <xref linkend="pgupgrade"/> module allows an installation to be migrated in-place from one major <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> version to another. Upgrades can be performed in minutes, particularly with <option>--link</option> mode. It requires steps similar to @@ -1975,7 +1975,7 @@ pg_dumpall -p 5432 | psql -d postgres -p 5433 <para> One way to prevent spoofing of <literal>local</literal> connections is to use a Unix domain socket directory (<xref - linkend="guc-unix-socket-directories">) that has write permission only + linkend="guc-unix-socket-directories"/>) that has write permission only for a trusted local user. This prevents a malicious user from creating their own socket file in that directory. If you are concerned that some applications might still reference <filename>/tmp</filename> for the @@ -1997,11 +1997,11 @@ pg_dumpall -p 5432 | psql -d postgres -p 5433 SSL certificates and make sure that clients check the server's certificate. To do that, the server must be configured to accept only <literal>hostssl</literal> connections (<xref - linkend="auth-pg-hba-conf">) and have SSL key and certificate files - (<xref linkend="ssl-tcp">). The TCP client must connect using + linkend="auth-pg-hba-conf"/>) and have SSL key and certificate files + (<xref linkend="ssl-tcp"/>). The TCP client must connect using <literal>sslmode=verify-ca</literal> or <literal>verify-full</literal> and have the appropriate root certificate - file installed (<xref linkend="libq-ssl-certificates">). + file installed (<xref linkend="libq-ssl-certificates"/>). </para> </sect1> @@ -2042,7 +2042,7 @@ pg_dumpall -p 5432 | psql -d postgres -p 5433 <listitem> <para> - The <xref linkend="pgcrypto"> module allows certain fields to be + The <xref linkend="pgcrypto"/> module allows certain fields to be stored encrypted. This is useful if only some of the data is sensitive. The client supplies the decryption key and the data is decrypted @@ -2171,19 +2171,19 @@ pg_dumpall -p 5432 | psql -d postgres -p 5433 for increased security. This requires that <productname>OpenSSL</productname> is installed on both client and server systems and that support in <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> is - enabled at build time (see <xref linkend="installation">). + enabled at build time (see <xref linkend="installation"/>). </para> <para> With <acronym>SSL</acronym> support compiled in, the <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> server can be started with <acronym>SSL</acronym> enabled by setting the parameter - <xref linkend="guc-ssl"> to <literal>on</literal> in + <xref linkend="guc-ssl"/> to <literal>on</literal> in <filename>postgresql.conf</filename>. The server will listen for both normal and <acronym>SSL</acronym> connections on the same TCP port, and will negotiate with any connecting client on whether to use <acronym>SSL</acronym>. By default, this is at the client's option; see <xref - linkend="auth-pg-hba-conf"> about how to set up the server to require + linkend="auth-pg-hba-conf"/> about how to set up the server to require use of <acronym>SSL</acronym> for some or all connections. </para> @@ -2201,7 +2201,7 @@ pg_dumpall -p 5432 | psql -d postgres -p 5433 and authentication algorithms, of varying strength. While a list of ciphers can be specified in the <productname>OpenSSL</productname> configuration file, you can specify ciphers specifically for use by - the database server by modifying <xref linkend="guc-ssl-ciphers"> in + the database server by modifying <xref linkend="guc-ssl-ciphers"/> in <filename>postgresql.conf</filename>. </para> @@ -2221,8 +2221,8 @@ pg_dumpall -p 5432 | psql -d postgres -p 5433 and private key must exist. By default, these files are expected to be named <filename>server.crt</filename> and <filename>server.key</filename>, respectively, in the server's data directory, but other names and locations can be specified - using the configuration parameters <xref linkend="guc-ssl-cert-file"> - and <xref linkend="guc-ssl-key-file">. + using the configuration parameters <xref linkend="guc-ssl-cert-file"/> + and <xref linkend="guc-ssl-key-file"/>. </para> <para> @@ -2264,12 +2264,12 @@ pg_dumpall -p 5432 | psql -d postgres -p 5433 To require the client to supply a trusted certificate, place certificates of the certificate authorities (<acronym>CA</acronym>s) you trust in a file named <filename>root.crt</filename> in the data - directory, set the parameter <xref linkend="guc-ssl-ca-file"> in + directory, set the parameter <xref linkend="guc-ssl-ca-file"/> in <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> to <literal>root.crt</literal>, and add the authentication option <literal>clientcert=1</literal> to the appropriate <literal>hostssl</literal> line(s) in <filename>pg_hba.conf</filename>. A certificate will then be requested from the client during - SSL connection startup. (See <xref linkend="libpq-ssl"> for a + SSL connection startup. (See <xref linkend="libpq-ssl"/> for a description of how to set up certificates on the client.) The server will verify that the client's certificate is signed by one of the trusted certificate authorities. @@ -2280,7 +2280,7 @@ pg_dumpall -p 5432 | psql -d postgres -p 5433 <filename>root.crt</filename>, the file must also contain certificate chains to their root <acronym>CA</acronym>s. Certificate Revocation List (CRL) entries - are also checked if the parameter <xref linkend="guc-ssl-crl-file"> is set. + are also checked if the parameter <xref linkend="guc-ssl-crl-file"/> is set. <!-- If this URL changes replace it with a URL to www.archive.org. --> (See <ulink url="http://h71000.www7.hp.com/doc/83final/ba554_90007/ch04s02.html"></ulink> @@ -2308,7 +2308,7 @@ pg_dumpall -p 5432 | psql -d postgres -p 5433 If you are setting up client certificates, you may wish to use the <literal>cert</literal> authentication method, so that the certificates control user authentication as well as providing connection security. - See <xref linkend="auth-cert"> for details. (It is not necessary to + See <xref linkend="auth-cert"/> for details. (It is not necessary to specify <literal>clientcert=1</literal> explicitly when using the <literal>cert</literal> authentication method.) </para> @@ -2318,7 +2318,7 @@ pg_dumpall -p 5432 | psql -d postgres -p 5433 <title>SSL Server File Usage</title> <para> - <xref linkend="ssl-file-usage"> summarizes the files that are + <xref linkend="ssl-file-usage"/> summarizes the files that are relevant to the SSL setup on the server. (The shown file names are default names. The locally configured names could be different.) </para> @@ -2337,27 +2337,27 @@ pg_dumpall -p 5432 | psql -d postgres -p 5433 <tbody> <row> - <entry><xref linkend="guc-ssl-cert-file"> (<filename>$PGDATA/server.crt</filename>)</entry> + <entry><xref linkend="guc-ssl-cert-file"/> (<filename>$PGDATA/server.crt</filename>)</entry> <entry>server certificate</entry> <entry>sent to client to indicate server's identity</entry> </row> <row> - <entry><xref linkend="guc-ssl-key-file"> (<filename>$PGDATA/server.key</filename>)</entry> + <entry><xref linkend="guc-ssl-key-file"/> (<filename>$PGDATA/server.key</filename>)</entry> <entry>server private key</entry> <entry>proves server certificate was sent by the owner; does not indicate certificate owner is trustworthy</entry> </row> <row> - <entry><xref linkend="guc-ssl-ca-file"></entry> + <entry><xref linkend="guc-ssl-ca-file"/></entry> <entry>trusted certificate authorities</entry> <entry>checks that client certificate is signed by a trusted certificate authority</entry> </row> <row> - <entry><xref linkend="guc-ssl-crl-file"></entry> + <entry><xref linkend="guc-ssl-crl-file"/></entry> <entry>certificates revoked by certificate authorities</entry> <entry>client certificate must not be on this list</entry> </row> @@ -2532,7 +2532,7 @@ ssh -L 63333:db.foo.com:5432 joe@shell.foo.com <para> To specify a different event source name (see - <xref linkend="guc-event-source">), use the <literal>/n</literal> + <xref linkend="guc-event-source"/>), use the <literal>/n</literal> and <literal>/i</literal> options: <screen> <userinput>regsvr32 /n /i:<replaceable>event_source_name</replaceable> <replaceable>pgsql_library_directory</replaceable>/pgevent.dll</userinput> @@ -2550,7 +2550,7 @@ ssh -L 63333:db.foo.com:5432 joe@shell.foo.com <note> <para> To enable event logging in the database server, modify - <xref linkend="guc-log-destination"> to include + <xref linkend="guc-log-destination"/> to include <literal>eventlog</literal> in <filename>postgresql.conf</filename>. </para> </note> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/seg.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/seg.sgml index c7e9b5f4aff..d07329f5d17 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/seg.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/seg.sgml @@ -86,13 +86,13 @@ test=> select '6.25 .. 6.50'::seg as "pH"; Optional certainty indicators (<literal><</literal>, <literal>></literal> or <literal>~</literal>) can be stored as well. (Certainty indicators are ignored by all the built-in operators, however.) - <xref linkend="seg-repr-table"> gives an overview of allowed - representations; <xref linkend="seg-input-examples"> shows some + <xref linkend="seg-repr-table"/> gives an overview of allowed + representations; <xref linkend="seg-input-examples"/> shows some examples. </para> <para> - In <xref linkend="seg-repr-table">, <replaceable>x</replaceable>, <replaceable>y</replaceable>, and + In <xref linkend="seg-repr-table"/>, <replaceable>x</replaceable>, <replaceable>y</replaceable>, and <replaceable>delta</replaceable> denote floating-point numbers. <replaceable>x</replaceable> and <replaceable>y</replaceable>, but not <replaceable>delta</replaceable>, can be preceded by a certainty indicator. @@ -237,7 +237,7 @@ test=> select '6.25 .. 6.50'::seg as "pH"; <para> The <filename>seg</filename> module includes a GiST index operator class for <type>seg</type> values. - The operators supported by the GiST operator class are shown in <xref linkend="seg-gist-operators">. + The operators supported by the GiST operator class are shown in <xref linkend="seg-gist-operators"/>. </para> <table id="seg-gist-operators"> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/sepgsql.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/sepgsql.sgml index c6c89a389db..273efc6e271 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/sepgsql.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/sepgsql.sgml @@ -17,7 +17,7 @@ <para> The current implementation has significant limitations, and does not enforce mandatory access control for all actions. See - <xref linkend="sepgsql-limitations">. + <xref linkend="sepgsql-limitations"/>. </para> </warning> @@ -51,7 +51,7 @@ </para> <para> - The <xref linkend="sql-security-label"> statement allows assignment of + The <xref linkend="sql-security-label"/> statement allows assignment of a security label to a database object. </para> @@ -93,7 +93,7 @@ Policy from config file: targeted <para> To use this module, you must include <literal>sepgsql</literal> - in the <xref linkend="guc-shared-preload-libraries"> parameter in + in the <xref linkend="guc-shared-preload-libraries"/> parameter in <filename>postgresql.conf</filename>. The module will not function correctly if loaded in any other manner. Once the module is loaded, you should execute <filename>sepgsql.sql</filename> in each database. @@ -161,7 +161,7 @@ $ for DBNAME in template0 template1 postgres; do <para> First, set up <filename>sepgsql</filename> in a working database - according to the instructions in <xref linkend="sepgsql-installation">. + according to the instructions in <xref linkend="sepgsql-installation"/>. Note that the current operating system user must be able to connect to the database as superuser without password authentication. </para> @@ -215,7 +215,7 @@ unconfined_u:unconfined_r:unconfined_t:s0-s0:c0.c1023 </screen> <para> - See <xref linkend="sepgsql-resources"> for details on adjusting your + See <xref linkend="sepgsql-resources"/> for details on adjusting your working domain, if necessary. </para> @@ -448,7 +448,7 @@ UPDATE t1 SET x = 2, y = md5sum(y) WHERE z = 100; <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> - <xref linkend="sql-createdatabase"> additionally requires + <xref linkend="sql-createdatabase"/> additionally requires <literal>getattr</literal> permission for the source or template database. </para> </listitem> @@ -506,7 +506,7 @@ UPDATE t1 SET x = 2, y = md5sum(y) WHERE z = 100; </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Using <xref linkend="sql-security-label"> on an object additionally + Using <xref linkend="sql-security-label"/> on an object additionally requires <literal>relabelfrom</literal> permission for the object in conjunction with its old security label and <literal>relabelto</literal> permission for the object in conjunction with its new security label. @@ -641,7 +641,7 @@ ERROR: SELinux: security policy violation <sect3> <title>Miscellaneous</title> <para> - We reject the <xref linkend="sql-load"> command across the board, because + We reject the <xref linkend="sql-load"/> command across the board, because any module loaded could easily circumvent security policy enforcement. </para> @@ -651,7 +651,7 @@ ERROR: SELinux: security policy violation <sect2 id="sepgsql-functions"> <title>Sepgsql Functions</title> <para> - <xref linkend="sepgsql-functions-table"> shows the available functions. + <xref linkend="sepgsql-functions-table"/> shows the available functions. </para> <table id="sepgsql-functions-table"> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/sourcerepo.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/sourcerepo.sgml index b5618d7166b..8729a8450d3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/sourcerepo.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/sourcerepo.sgml @@ -22,7 +22,7 @@ <application>flex</application>, and <application>Perl</application>. These tools are not needed to build from a distribution tarball, because the files that these tools are used to build are included in the tarball. Other tool requirements - are the same as shown in <xref linkend="install-requirements">. + are the same as shown in <xref linkend="install-requirements"/>. </para> <sect1 id="git"> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/sources.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/sources.sgml index 4c777de16f7..8870ee938aa 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/sources.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/sources.sgml @@ -207,7 +207,7 @@ ereport(ERROR, <replaceable>n</replaceable> is the integer value that determines which plural form is needed, and the remaining arguments are formatted according to the selected format string. For more information see - <xref linkend="nls-guidelines">. + <xref linkend="nls-guidelines"/>. </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -234,7 +234,7 @@ ereport(ERROR, <function>errdetail_plural(const char *fmt_singular, const char *fmt_plural, unsigned long n, ...)</function> is like <function>errdetail</function>, but with support for various plural forms of the message. - For more information see <xref linkend="nls-guidelines">. + For more information see <xref linkend="nls-guidelines"/>. </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -255,7 +255,7 @@ ereport(ERROR, *fmt_plural, unsigned long n, ...)</function> is like <function>errdetail_log</function>, but with support for various plural forms of the message. - For more information see <xref linkend="nls-guidelines">. + For more information see <xref linkend="nls-guidelines"/>. </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -404,7 +404,7 @@ ereport(level, (errmsg_internal("format string", ...))); <para> Advice about writing good error messages can be found in - <xref linkend="error-style-guide">. + <xref linkend="error-style-guide"/>. </para> </sect1> @@ -853,7 +853,7 @@ BETTER: unrecognized node type: 42 <para> Keep in mind that error message texts need to be translated into other - languages. Follow the guidelines in <xref linkend="nls-guidelines"> + languages. Follow the guidelines in <xref linkend="nls-guidelines"/> to avoid making life difficult for translators. </para> </simplesect> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/spgist.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/spgist.sgml index c56a3544833..139c8ed8f74 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/spgist.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/spgist.sgml @@ -59,7 +59,7 @@ <para> The core <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> distribution includes the <acronym>SP-GiST</acronym> operator classes shown in - <xref linkend="spgist-builtin-opclasses-table">. + <xref linkend="spgist-builtin-opclasses-table"/>. </para> <table id="spgist-builtin-opclasses-table"> @@ -206,7 +206,7 @@ in a radix tree the node label could be the next character of the string value. (Alternatively, an operator class can omit the node labels, if it works with a fixed set of nodes for all inner tuples; - see <xref linkend="spgist-null-labels">.) + see <xref linkend="spgist-null-labels"/>.) Optionally, an inner tuple can have a <firstterm>prefix</firstterm> value that describes all its members. In a radix tree this could be the common prefix of the represented strings. The prefix value is not necessarily @@ -303,7 +303,7 @@ typedef struct spgConfigOut <structfield>longValuesOK</structfield> should be set true only when the <structfield>attType</structfield> is of variable length and the operator class is capable of segmenting long values by repeated suffixing - (see <xref linkend="spgist-limits">). + (see <xref linkend="spgist-limits"/>). </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -392,7 +392,7 @@ typedef struct spgChooseOut zero for the root level. <structfield>allTheSame</structfield> is true if the current inner tuple is marked as containing multiple equivalent nodes - (see <xref linkend="spgist-all-the-same">). + (see <xref linkend="spgist-all-the-same"/>). <structfield>hasPrefix</structfield> is true if the current inner tuple contains a prefix; if so, <structfield>prefixDatum</structfield> is its value. @@ -547,7 +547,7 @@ typedef struct spgPickSplitOut <literal>allTheSame</literal> to signify that this has happened. The <function>choose</function> and <function>inner_consistent</function> functions must take suitable care with such inner tuples. - See <xref linkend="spgist-all-the-same"> for more information. + See <xref linkend="spgist-all-the-same"/> for more information. </para> <para> @@ -557,7 +557,7 @@ typedef struct spgPickSplitOut value has been supplied. In this case the point of the operation is to strip off a prefix and produce a new, shorter leaf datum value. The call will be repeated until a leaf datum short enough to fit on - a page has been produced. See <xref linkend="spgist-limits"> for + a page has been produced. See <xref linkend="spgist-limits"/> for more information. </para> </listitem> @@ -638,7 +638,7 @@ typedef struct spgInnerConsistentOut <structfield>allTheSame</structfield> is true if the current inner tuple is marked <quote>all-the-same</quote>; in this case all the nodes have the same label (if any) and so either all or none of them match the query - (see <xref linkend="spgist-all-the-same">). + (see <xref linkend="spgist-all-the-same"/>). <structfield>hasPrefix</structfield> is true if the current inner tuple contains a prefix; if so, <structfield>prefixDatum</structfield> is its value. @@ -817,7 +817,7 @@ typedef struct spgLeafConsistentOut tuple <emphasis>must</emphasis> divide the set of leaf values into more than one node group. If the operator class's <function>picksplit</function> function fails to do that, the <acronym>SP-GiST</acronym> core resorts to - extraordinary measures described in <xref linkend="spgist-all-the-same">. + extraordinary measures described in <xref linkend="spgist-all-the-same"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -894,7 +894,7 @@ typedef struct spgLeafConsistentOut <para> The <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> source distribution includes several examples of index operator classes for <acronym>SP-GiST</acronym>, - as described in <xref linkend="spgist-builtin-opclasses-table">. Look + as described in <xref linkend="spgist-builtin-opclasses-table"/>. Look into <filename>src/backend/access/spgist/</filename> and <filename>src/backend/utils/adt/</filename> to see the code. </para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/spi.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/spi.sgml index e2b44c5fa1a..350f0863e92 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/spi.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/spi.sgml @@ -887,11 +887,11 @@ SPIPlanPtr SPI_prepare(const char * <parameter>command</parameter>, int <paramet force re-analysis and re-planning of the statement before using it whenever database objects used in the statement have undergone definitional (DDL) changes since the previous use of the prepared - statement. Also, if the value of <xref linkend="guc-search-path"> changes + statement. Also, if the value of <xref linkend="guc-search-path"/> changes from one use to the next, the statement will be re-parsed using the new <varname>search_path</varname>. (This latter behavior is new as of <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> 9.3.) See <xref - linkend="sql-prepare"> for more information about the behavior of prepared + linkend="sql-prepare"/> for more information about the behavior of prepared statements. </para> @@ -2308,7 +2308,7 @@ void SPI_scroll_cursor_fetch(Portal <parameter>portal</parameter>, FetchDirectio <title>Notes</title> <para> - See the SQL <xref linkend="sql-fetch"> command + See the SQL <xref linkend="sql-fetch"/> command for details of the interpretation of the <parameter>direction</parameter> and <parameter>count</parameter> parameters. @@ -2409,7 +2409,7 @@ void SPI_scroll_cursor_move(Portal <parameter>portal</parameter>, FetchDirection <title>Notes</title> <para> - See the SQL <xref linkend="sql-fetch"> command + See the SQL <xref linkend="sql-fetch"/> command for details of the interpretation of the <parameter>direction</parameter> and <parameter>count</parameter> parameters. @@ -4396,7 +4396,7 @@ INSERT INTO a SELECT * FROM a; that were processed by the command. You can find more complex examples for SPI in the source tree in <filename>src/test/regress/regress.c</filename> and in the - <xref linkend="contrib-spi"> module. + <xref linkend="contrib-spi"/> module. </para> <programlisting> @@ -4462,7 +4462,7 @@ execq(text *sql, int cnt) <para> This is how you declare the function after having compiled it into - a shared library (details are in <xref linkend="dfunc">.): + a shared library (details are in <xref linkend="dfunc"/>.): <programlisting> CREATE FUNCTION execq(text, integer) RETURNS int8 diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/standalone-install.xml b/doc/src/sgml/standalone-install.xml index 49d94c51873..62582effed2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/standalone-install.xml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/standalone-install.xml @@ -14,10 +14,10 @@ in the stand-alone version. <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using this source code distribution. </para> - <xi:include href="postgres.xml" xpointer="install-short" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude"/> - <xi:include href="postgres.xml" xpointer="install-requirements" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude"/> - <xi:include href="postgres.xml" xpointer="install-procedure" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude"/> - <xi:include href="postgres.xml" xpointer="install-post" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude"/> + <xi:include href="postgres.sgml" xpointer="install-short" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude"/> + <xi:include href="postgres.sgml" xpointer="install-requirements" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude"/> + <xi:include href="postgres.sgml" xpointer="install-procedure" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude"/> + <xi:include href="postgres.sgml" xpointer="install-post" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude"/> <sect1 id="install-getting-started"> <title>Getting Started</title> @@ -162,6 +162,6 @@ postgres$ <userinput>/usr/local/pgsql/bin/initdb -D /usr/local/pgsql/data</useri </para> </sect1> - <xi:include href="postgres.xml" xpointer="supported-platforms" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude"/> - <xi:include href="postgres.xml" xpointer="installation-platform-notes" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude"/> + <xi:include href="postgres.sgml" xpointer="supported-platforms" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude"/> + <xi:include href="postgres.sgml" xpointer="installation-platform-notes" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude"/> </article> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/start.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/start.sgml index 4a6f746d206..5b73557835b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/start.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/start.sgml @@ -29,7 +29,7 @@ <para> If you are installing <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> - yourself, then refer to <xref linkend="installation"> + yourself, then refer to <xref linkend="installation"/> for instructions on installation, and return to this guide when the installation is complete. Be sure to follow closely the section about setting up the appropriate environment @@ -194,7 +194,7 @@ createdb: could not connect to database postgres: FATAL: role "joe" does not ex administrator has not created a <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> user account for you. (<productname>PostgreSQL</productname> user accounts are distinct from operating system user accounts.) If you are the administrator, see - <xref linkend="user-manag"> for help creating accounts. You will need to + <xref linkend="user-manag"/> for help creating accounts. You will need to become the operating system user under which <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> was installed (usually <literal>postgres</literal>) to create the first user account. It could also be that you were assigned a @@ -268,7 +268,7 @@ createdb: database creation failed: ERROR: permission denied to create database <para> More about <command>createdb</command> and <command>dropdb</command> can - be found in <xref linkend="app-createdb"> and <xref linkend="app-dropdb"> + be found in <xref linkend="app-createdb"/> and <xref linkend="app-dropdb"/> respectively. </para> </sect1> @@ -308,7 +308,7 @@ createdb: database creation failed: ERROR: permission denied to create database <para> Writing a custom application, using one of the several available language bindings. These possibilities are discussed - further in <xref linkend="client-interfaces">. + further in <xref linkend="client-interfaces"/>. </para> </listitem> </itemizedlist> @@ -402,7 +402,7 @@ mydb=# command shell. (For more internal commands, type <literal>\?</literal> at the <command>psql</command> prompt.) The full capabilities of <command>psql</command> are documented in - <xref linkend="app-psql">. In this tutorial we will not use these + <xref linkend="app-psql"/>. In this tutorial we will not use these features explicitly, but you can use them yourself when it is helpful. </para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/storage.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/storage.sgml index 0f9bddf7ab8..128b19cbc98 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/storage.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/storage.sgml @@ -29,7 +29,7 @@ managed by different server instances, can exist on the same machine. <para> The <varname>PGDATA</varname> directory contains several subdirectories and control -files, as shown in <xref linkend="pgdata-contents-table">. In addition to +files, as shown in <xref linkend="pgdata-contents-table"/>. In addition to these required items, the cluster configuration files <filename>postgresql.conf</filename>, <filename>pg_hba.conf</filename>, and <filename>pg_ident.conf</filename> are traditionally stored in @@ -197,14 +197,14 @@ for temporary relations, the file name is of the form is the backend ID of the backend which created the file, and <replaceable>FFF</replaceable> is the filenode number. In either case, in addition to the main file (a/k/a main fork), each table and index has a <firstterm>free space map</firstterm> (see <xref -linkend="storage-fsm">), which stores information about free space available in +linkend="storage-fsm"/>), which stores information about free space available in the relation. The free space map is stored in a file named with the filenode number plus the suffix <literal>_fsm</literal>. Tables also have a <firstterm>visibility map</firstterm>, stored in a fork with the suffix <literal>_vm</literal>, to track which pages are known to have no dead tuples. The visibility map is -described further in <xref linkend="storage-vm">. Unlogged tables and indexes +described further in <xref linkend="storage-vm"/>. Unlogged tables and indexes have a third fork, known as the initialization fork, which is stored in a fork -with the suffix <literal>_init</literal> (see <xref linkend="storage-init">). +with the suffix <literal>_init</literal> (see <xref linkend="storage-init"/>). </para> <caution> @@ -240,12 +240,12 @@ associated <firstterm>TOAST</firstterm> table, which is used for out-of-line sto field values that are too large to keep in the table rows proper. <structname>pg_class</structname>.<structfield>reltoastrelid</structfield> links from a table to its <acronym>TOAST</acronym> table, if any. -See <xref linkend="storage-toast"> for more information. +See <xref linkend="storage-toast"/> for more information. </para> <para> The contents of tables and indexes are discussed further in -<xref linkend="storage-page-layout">. +<xref linkend="storage-page-layout"/>. </para> <para> @@ -335,7 +335,7 @@ actually consist of a four-byte length word and contents until after it's been <firstterm>detoasted</firstterm>. (This is normally done by invoking <function>PG_DETOAST_DATUM</function> before doing anything with an input value, but in some cases more efficient approaches are possible. -See <xref linkend="xtypes-toast"> for more detail.) +See <xref linkend="xtypes-toast"/> for more detail.) </para> <para> @@ -376,12 +376,12 @@ associated with, the table containing the <acronym>TOAST</acronym> pointer datum itself. These <firstterm>on-disk</firstterm> pointer datums are created by the <acronym>TOAST</acronym> management code (in <filename>access/heap/tuptoaster.c</filename>) when a tuple to be stored on disk is too large to be stored as-is. -Further details appear in <xref linkend="storage-toast-ondisk">. +Further details appear in <xref linkend="storage-toast-ondisk"/>. Alternatively, a <acronym>TOAST</acronym> pointer datum can contain a pointer to out-of-line data that appears elsewhere in memory. Such datums are necessarily short-lived, and will never appear on-disk, but they are very useful for avoiding copying and redundant processing of large data values. -Further details appear in <xref linkend="storage-toast-inmemory">. +Further details appear in <xref linkend="storage-toast-inmemory"/>. </para> <para> @@ -611,7 +611,7 @@ at the root. <para> See <filename>src/backend/storage/freespace/README</filename> for more details on how the <acronym>FSM</acronym> is structured, and how it's updated and searched. -The <xref linkend="pgfreespacemap"> module +The <xref linkend="pgfreespacemap"/> module can be used to examine the information stored in free space maps. </para> @@ -657,7 +657,7 @@ cleared by any data-modifying operations on a page. </para> <para> -The <xref linkend="pgvisibility"> module can be used to examine the +The <xref linkend="pgvisibility"/> module can be used to examine the information stored in the visibility map. </para> @@ -718,7 +718,7 @@ within the index, depending on the index access method. </para> <para> -<xref linkend="page-table"> shows the overall layout of a page. +<xref linkend="page-table"/> shows the overall layout of a page. There are five parts to each page. </para> @@ -774,9 +774,9 @@ data. Empty in ordinary tables.</entry> The first 24 bytes of each page consists of a page header (<structname>PageHeaderData</structname>). Its format is detailed in <xref - linkend="pageheaderdata-table">. The first field tracks the most + linkend="pageheaderdata-table"/>. The first field tracks the most recent WAL entry related to this page. The second field contains - the page checksum if <xref linkend="app-initdb-data-checksums"> are + the page checksum if <xref linkend="app-initdb-data-checksums"/> are enabled. Next is a 2-byte field containing flag bits. This is followed by three 2-byte integer fields (<structfield>pd_lower</structfield>, <structfield>pd_upper</structfield>, and @@ -918,7 +918,7 @@ data. Empty in ordinary tables.</entry> header (occupying 23 bytes on most machines), followed by an optional null bitmap, an optional object ID field, and the user data. The header is detailed - in <xref linkend="heaptupleheaderdata-table">. The actual user data + in <xref linkend="heaptupleheaderdata-table"/>. The actual user data (columns of the row) begins at the offset indicated by <structfield>t_hoff</structfield>, which must always be a multiple of the MAXALIGN distance for the platform. @@ -1032,7 +1032,7 @@ data. Empty in ordinary tables.</entry> <type>struct varlena</type>, which includes the total length of the stored value and some flag bits. Depending on the flags, the data can be either inline or in a <acronym>TOAST</acronym> table; - it might be compressed, too (see <xref linkend="storage-toast">). + it might be compressed, too (see <xref linkend="storage-toast"/>). </para> </sect1> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/syntax.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/syntax.sgml index e4012cc1820..a938a21334b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/syntax.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/syntax.sgml @@ -75,7 +75,7 @@ INSERT INTO MY_TABLE VALUES (3, 'hi there'); a <token>SET</token> token to appear in a certain position, and this particular variation of <command>INSERT</command> also requires a <token>VALUES</token> in order to be complete. The - precise syntax rules for each command are described in <xref linkend="reference">. + precise syntax rules for each command are described in <xref linkend="reference"/>. </para> <sect2 id="sql-syntax-identifiers"> @@ -109,7 +109,7 @@ INSERT INTO MY_TABLE VALUES (3, 'hi there'); same lexical structure, meaning that one cannot know whether a token is an identifier or a key word without knowing the language. A complete list of key words can be found in <xref - linkend="sql-keywords-appendix">. + linkend="sql-keywords-appendix"/>. </para> <para> @@ -353,7 +353,7 @@ SELECT 'foo' 'bar'; Within an escape string, a backslash character (<literal>\</literal>) begins a C-like <firstterm>backslash escape</firstterm> sequence, in which the combination of backslash and following character(s) represent a special byte - value, as shown in <xref linkend="sql-backslash-table">. + value, as shown in <xref linkend="sql-backslash-table"/>. </para> <table id="sql-backslash-table"> @@ -430,7 +430,7 @@ SELECT 'foo' 'bar'; valid characters in the server character set encoding. When the server encoding is UTF-8, then the Unicode escapes or the alternative Unicode escape syntax, explained - in <xref linkend="sql-syntax-strings-uescape">, should be used + in <xref linkend="sql-syntax-strings-uescape"/>, should be used instead. (The alternative would be doing the UTF-8 encoding by hand and writing out the bytes, which would be very cumbersome.) </para> @@ -451,7 +451,7 @@ SELECT 'foo' 'bar'; <caution> <para> If the configuration parameter - <xref linkend="guc-standard-conforming-strings"> is <literal>off</literal>, + <xref linkend="guc-standard-conforming-strings"/> is <literal>off</literal>, then <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> recognizes backslash escapes in both regular and escape string constants. However, as of <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> 9.1, the default is <literal>on</literal>, meaning @@ -466,8 +466,8 @@ SELECT 'foo' 'bar'; <para> In addition to <varname>standard_conforming_strings</varname>, the configuration - parameters <xref linkend="guc-escape-string-warning"> and - <xref linkend="guc-backslash-quote"> govern treatment of backslashes + parameters <xref linkend="guc-escape-string-warning"/> and + <xref linkend="guc-backslash-quote"/> govern treatment of backslashes in string constants. </para> </caution> @@ -539,7 +539,7 @@ U&'d!0061t!+000061' UESCAPE '!' <para> Also, the Unicode escape syntax for string constants only works when the configuration - parameter <xref linkend="guc-standard-conforming-strings"> is + parameter <xref linkend="guc-standard-conforming-strings"/> is turned on. This is because otherwise this syntax could confuse clients that parse the SQL statements to the point that it could lead to SQL injections and similar security issues. If the @@ -772,14 +772,14 @@ CAST ( '<replaceable>string</replaceable>' AS <replaceable>type</replaceable> ) <replaceable>typename</replaceable> ( '<replaceable>string</replaceable>' ) </synopsis> but not all type names can be used in this way; see <xref - linkend="sql-syntax-type-casts"> for details. + linkend="sql-syntax-type-casts"/> for details. </para> <para> The <literal>::</literal>, <literal>CAST()</literal>, and function-call syntaxes can also be used to specify run-time type conversions of arbitrary expressions, as discussed in <xref - linkend="sql-syntax-type-casts">. To avoid syntactic ambiguity, the + linkend="sql-syntax-type-casts"/>. To avoid syntactic ambiguity, the <literal><replaceable>type</replaceable> '<replaceable>string</replaceable>'</literal> syntax can only be used to specify the type of a simple literal constant. Another restriction on the @@ -885,7 +885,7 @@ CAST ( '<replaceable>string</replaceable>' AS <replaceable>type</replaceable> ) <listitem> <para> Brackets (<literal>[]</literal>) are used to select the elements - of an array. See <xref linkend="arrays"> for more information + of an array. See <xref linkend="arrays"/> for more information on arrays. </para> </listitem> @@ -909,7 +909,7 @@ CAST ( '<replaceable>string</replaceable>' AS <replaceable>type</replaceable> ) <para> The colon (<literal>:</literal>) is used to select <quote>slices</quote> from arrays. (See <xref - linkend="arrays">.) In certain SQL dialects (such as Embedded + linkend="arrays"/>.) In certain SQL dialects (such as Embedded SQL), the colon is used to prefix variable names. </para> </listitem> @@ -980,7 +980,7 @@ CAST ( '<replaceable>string</replaceable>' AS <replaceable>type</replaceable> ) </indexterm> <para> - <xref linkend="sql-precedence-table"> shows the precedence and + <xref linkend="sql-precedence-table"/> shows the precedence and associativity of the operators in <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>. Most operators have the same precedence and are left-associative. The precedence and associativity of the operators is hard-wired @@ -1126,7 +1126,7 @@ SELECT (5 !) - 6; SELECT 3 OPERATOR(pg_catalog.+) 4; </programlisting> the <literal>OPERATOR</literal> construct is taken to have the default precedence - shown in <xref linkend="sql-precedence-table"> for + shown in <xref linkend="sql-precedence-table"/> for <quote>any other operator</quote>. This is true no matter which specific operator appears inside <literal>OPERATOR()</literal>. </para> @@ -1148,7 +1148,7 @@ SELECT 3 OPERATOR(pg_catalog.+) 4; change behavior without any parsing error being reported. If you are concerned about whether these changes have silently broken something, you can test your application with the configuration - parameter <xref linkend="guc-operator-precedence-warning"> turned on + parameter <xref linkend="guc-operator-precedence-warning"/> turned on to see if any warnings are logged. </para> </note> @@ -1290,13 +1290,13 @@ SELECT 3 OPERATOR(pg_catalog.+) 4; be classified as an expression but do not follow any general syntax rules. These generally have the semantics of a function or operator and are explained in the appropriate location in <xref - linkend="functions">. An example is the <literal>IS NULL</literal> + linkend="functions"/>. An example is the <literal>IS NULL</literal> clause. </para> <para> We have already discussed constants in <xref - linkend="sql-syntax-constants">. The following sections discuss + linkend="sql-syntax-constants"/>. The following sections discuss the remaining options. </para> @@ -1319,7 +1319,7 @@ SELECT 3 OPERATOR(pg_catalog.+) 4; table (possibly qualified with a schema name), or an alias for a table defined by means of a <literal>FROM</literal> clause. The correlation name and separating dot can be omitted if the column name - is unique across all the tables being used in the current query. (See also <xref linkend="queries">.) + is unique across all the tables being used in the current query. (See also <xref linkend="queries"/>.) </para> </sect2> @@ -1402,7 +1402,7 @@ $1[10:42] </programlisting> The parentheses in the last example are required. - See <xref linkend="arrays"> for more about arrays. + See <xref linkend="arrays"/> for more about arrays. </para> </sect2> @@ -1455,7 +1455,7 @@ $1.somecolumn (compositecol).* </programlisting> This notation behaves differently depending on context; - see <xref linkend="rowtypes-usage"> for details. + see <xref linkend="rowtypes-usage"/> for details. </para> </sect2> @@ -1475,7 +1475,7 @@ $1.somecolumn <member><replaceable>expression</replaceable> <replaceable>operator</replaceable> (unary postfix operator)</member> </simplelist> where the <replaceable>operator</replaceable> token follows the syntax - rules of <xref linkend="sql-syntax-operators">, or is one of the + rules of <xref linkend="sql-syntax-operators"/>, or is one of the key words <token>AND</token>, <token>OR</token>, and <token>NOT</token>, or is a qualified operator name in the form: <synopsis> @@ -1483,7 +1483,7 @@ $1.somecolumn </synopsis> Which particular operators exist and whether they are unary or binary depends on what operators have been - defined by the system or the user. <xref linkend="functions"> + defined by the system or the user. <xref linkend="functions"/> describes the built-in operators. </para> </sect2> @@ -1514,13 +1514,13 @@ sqrt(2) </para> <para> - The list of built-in functions is in <xref linkend="functions">. + The list of built-in functions is in <xref linkend="functions"/>. Other functions can be added by the user. </para> <para> The arguments can optionally have names attached. - See <xref linkend="sql-syntax-calling-funcs"> for details. + See <xref linkend="sql-syntax-calling-funcs"/> for details. </para> <note> @@ -1532,7 +1532,7 @@ sqrt(2) interchangeable. This behavior is not SQL-standard but is provided in <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> because it allows use of functions to emulate <quote>computed fields</quote>. For more information see - <xref linkend="rowtypes-usage">. + <xref linkend="rowtypes-usage"/>. </para> </note> </sect2> @@ -1622,7 +1622,7 @@ sqrt(2) such an aggregate, the optional <replaceable>order_by_clause</replaceable> can be used to specify the desired ordering. The <replaceable>order_by_clause</replaceable> has the same syntax as for a query-level <literal>ORDER BY</literal> clause, as - described in <xref linkend="queries-order">, except that its expressions + described in <xref linkend="queries-order"/>, except that its expressions are always just expressions and cannot be output-column names or numbers. For example: <programlisting> @@ -1736,7 +1736,7 @@ FROM generate_series(1,10) AS s(i); <para> The predefined aggregate functions are described in <xref - linkend="functions-aggregate">. Other aggregate functions can be added + linkend="functions-aggregate"/>. Other aggregate functions can be added by the user. </para> @@ -1750,8 +1750,8 @@ FROM generate_series(1,10) AS s(i); <para> When an aggregate expression appears in a subquery (see - <xref linkend="sql-syntax-scalar-subqueries"> and - <xref linkend="functions-subquery">), the aggregate is normally + <xref linkend="sql-syntax-scalar-subqueries"/> and + <xref linkend="functions-subquery"/>), the aggregate is normally evaluated over the rows of the subquery. But an exception occurs if the aggregate's arguments (and <replaceable>filter_clause</replaceable> if any) contain only outer-level variables: @@ -1830,7 +1830,7 @@ UNBOUNDED FOLLOWING Alternatively, a full <replaceable>window_definition</replaceable> can be given within parentheses, using the same syntax as for defining a named window in the <literal>WINDOW</literal> clause; see the - <xref linkend="sql-select"> reference page for details. It's worth + <xref linkend="sql-select"/> reference page for details. It's worth pointing out that <literal>OVER wname</literal> is not exactly equivalent to <literal>OVER (wname ...)</literal>; the latter implies copying and modifying the window definition, and will be rejected if the referenced window @@ -1921,7 +1921,7 @@ UNBOUNDED FOLLOWING <para> The built-in window functions are described in <xref - linkend="functions-window-table">. Other window functions can be added by + linkend="functions-window-table"/>. Other window functions can be added by the user. Also, any built-in or user-defined general-purpose or statistical aggregate can be used as a window function. (Ordered-set and hypothetical-set aggregates cannot presently be used as window functions.) @@ -1944,9 +1944,9 @@ UNBOUNDED FOLLOWING <para> More information about window functions can be found in - <xref linkend="tutorial-window">, - <xref linkend="functions-window">, and - <xref linkend="queries-window">. + <xref linkend="tutorial-window"/>, + <xref linkend="functions-window"/>, and + <xref linkend="queries-window"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1984,7 +1984,7 @@ CAST ( <replaceable>expression</replaceable> AS <replaceable>type</replaceable> represents a run-time type conversion. The cast will succeed only if a suitable type conversion operation has been defined. Notice that this is subtly different from the use of casts with constants, as shown in - <xref linkend="sql-syntax-constants-generic">. A cast applied to an + <xref linkend="sql-syntax-constants-generic"/>. A cast applied to an unadorned string literal represents the initial assignment of a type to a literal constant value, and so it will succeed for any type (if the contents of the string literal are acceptable input syntax for the @@ -2028,7 +2028,7 @@ CAST ( <replaceable>expression</replaceable> AS <replaceable>type</replaceable> syntax</quote> is nothing more than a direct invocation of the underlying conversion function. Obviously, this is not something that a portable application should rely on. For further details see - <xref linkend="sql-createcast">. + <xref linkend="sql-createcast"/>. </para> </note> </sect2> @@ -2079,7 +2079,7 @@ SELECT * FROM tbl WHERE a > 'foo' COLLATE "C"; arguments, and an explicit <literal>COLLATE</literal> clause will override the collations of all other arguments. (Attaching non-matching <literal>COLLATE</literal> clauses to more than one argument, however, is an - error. For more details see <xref linkend="collation">.) + error. For more details see <xref linkend="collation"/>.) Thus, this gives the same result as the previous example: <programlisting> SELECT * FROM tbl WHERE a COLLATE "C" > 'foo'; @@ -2104,7 +2104,7 @@ SELECT * FROM tbl WHERE (a > 'foo') COLLATE "C"; <para> A scalar subquery is an ordinary <command>SELECT</command> query in parentheses that returns exactly one - row with one column. (See <xref linkend="queries"> for information about writing queries.) + row with one column. (See <xref linkend="queries"/> for information about writing queries.) The <command>SELECT</command> query is executed and the single returned value is used in the surrounding value expression. It is an error to use a query that @@ -2113,7 +2113,7 @@ SELECT * FROM tbl WHERE (a > 'foo') COLLATE "C"; there is no error; the scalar result is taken to be null.) The subquery can refer to variables from the surrounding query, which will act as constants during any one evaluation of the subquery. - See also <xref linkend="functions-subquery"> for other expressions involving subqueries. + See also <xref linkend="functions-subquery"/> for other expressions involving subqueries. </para> <para> @@ -2156,7 +2156,7 @@ SELECT ARRAY[1,2,3+4]; By default, the array element type is the common type of the member expressions, determined using the same rules as for <literal>UNION</literal> or - <literal>CASE</literal> constructs (see <xref linkend="typeconv-union-case">). + <literal>CASE</literal> constructs (see <xref linkend="typeconv-union-case"/>). You can override this by explicitly casting the array constructor to the desired type, for example: <programlisting> @@ -2168,7 +2168,7 @@ SELECT ARRAY[1,2,22.7]::integer[]; </programlisting> This has the same effect as casting each expression to the array element type individually. - For more on casting, see <xref linkend="sql-syntax-type-casts">. + For more on casting, see <xref linkend="sql-syntax-type-casts"/>. </para> <para> @@ -2259,7 +2259,7 @@ SELECT ARRAY(SELECT ARRAY[i, i*2] FROM generate_series(1,5) AS a(i)); <para> The subscripts of an array value built with <literal>ARRAY</literal> always begin with one. For more information about arrays, see - <xref linkend="arrays">. + <xref linkend="arrays"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2300,7 +2300,7 @@ SELECT ROW(1,2.5,'this is a test'); <replaceable>rowvalue</replaceable><literal>.*</literal>, which will be expanded to a list of the elements of the row value, just as occurs when the <literal>.*</literal> syntax is used at the top level - of a <command>SELECT</command> list (see <xref linkend="rowtypes-usage">). + of a <command>SELECT</command> list (see <xref linkend="rowtypes-usage"/>). For example, if table <literal>t</literal> has columns <literal>f1</literal> and <literal>f2</literal>, these are the same: <programlisting> @@ -2372,9 +2372,9 @@ SELECT ROW(1,2.5,'this is a test') = ROW(1, 3, 'not the same'); SELECT ROW(table.*) IS NULL FROM table; -- detect all-null rows </programlisting> - For more detail see <xref linkend="functions-comparisons">. + For more detail see <xref linkend="functions-comparisons"/>. Row constructors can also be used in connection with subqueries, - as discussed in <xref linkend="functions-subquery">. + as discussed in <xref linkend="functions-subquery"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -2422,7 +2422,7 @@ SELECT somefunc() OR true; <para> When it is essential to force evaluation order, a <literal>CASE</literal> - construct (see <xref linkend="functions-conditional">) can be + construct (see <xref linkend="functions-conditional"/>) can be used. For example, this is an untrustworthy way of trying to avoid division by zero in a <literal>WHERE</literal> clause: <programlisting> @@ -2442,7 +2442,7 @@ SELECT ... WHERE CASE WHEN x > 0 THEN y/x > 1.5 ELSE false END; <literal>CASE</literal> is not a cure-all for such issues, however. One limitation of the technique illustrated above is that it does not prevent early evaluation of constant subexpressions. - As described in <xref linkend="xfunc-volatility">, functions and + As described in <xref linkend="xfunc-volatility"/>, functions and operators marked <literal>IMMUTABLE</literal> can be evaluated when the query is planned rather than when it is executed. Thus for example <programlisting> @@ -2547,7 +2547,7 @@ LANGUAGE SQL IMMUTABLE STRICT; <literal>b</literal> inputs will be concatenated, and forced to either upper or lower case depending on the <literal>uppercase</literal> parameter. The remaining details of this function - definition are not important here (see <xref linkend="extend"> for + definition are not important here (see <xref linkend="extend"/> for more information). </para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/tablefunc.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/tablefunc.sgml index 6f1d3df34df..007e9c62f56 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/tablefunc.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/tablefunc.sgml @@ -18,7 +18,7 @@ <title>Functions Provided</title> <para> - <xref linkend="tablefunc-functions"> shows the functions provided + <xref linkend="tablefunc-functions"/> shows the functions provided by the <filename>tablefunc</filename> module. </para> @@ -646,7 +646,7 @@ connectby(text relname, text keyid_fld, text parent_keyid_fld </para> <para> - <xref linkend="tablefunc-connectby-parameters"> explains the + <xref linkend="tablefunc-connectby-parameters"/> explains the parameters. </para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/tablesample-method.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/tablesample-method.sgml index 9ac28ceb4c3..b84b7ba8855 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/tablesample-method.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/tablesample-method.sgml @@ -33,7 +33,7 @@ method_name(internal) RETURNS tsm_handler type <type>TsmRoutine</type>, which contains pointers to support functions for the sampling method. These support functions are plain C functions and are not visible or callable at the SQL level. The support functions are - described in <xref linkend="tablesample-support-functions">. + described in <xref linkend="tablesample-support-functions"/>. </para> <para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/textsearch.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/textsearch.sgml index 7b4912dd5e7..4dc52ec9831 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/textsearch.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/textsearch.sgml @@ -160,12 +160,12 @@ <para> A data type <type>tsvector</type> is provided for storing preprocessed documents, along with a type <type>tsquery</type> for representing processed - queries (<xref linkend="datatype-textsearch">). There are many + queries (<xref linkend="datatype-textsearch"/>). There are many functions and operators available for these data types - (<xref linkend="functions-textsearch">), the most important of which is + (<xref linkend="functions-textsearch"/>), the most important of which is the match operator <literal>@@</literal>, which we introduce in - <xref linkend="textsearch-matching">. Full text searches can be accelerated - using indexes (<xref linkend="textsearch-indexes">). + <xref linkend="textsearch-matching"/>. Full text searches can be accelerated + using indexes (<xref linkend="textsearch-indexes"/>). </para> @@ -264,7 +264,7 @@ SELECT 'fat & cow'::tsquery @@ 'a fat cat sat on a mat and ate a fat rat'::t text, any more than a <type>tsvector</type> is. A <type>tsquery</type> contains search terms, which must be already-normalized lexemes, and may combine multiple terms using AND, OR, NOT, and FOLLOWED BY operators. - (For syntax details see <xref linkend="datatype-tsquery">.) There are + (For syntax details see <xref linkend="datatype-tsquery"/>.) There are functions <function>to_tsquery</function>, <function>plainto_tsquery</function>, and <function>phraseto_tsquery</function> that are helpful in converting user-written text into a proper @@ -420,7 +420,7 @@ SELECT phraseto_tsquery('the cats ate the rats'); <para> During installation an appropriate configuration is selected and - <xref linkend="guc-default-text-search-config"> is set accordingly + <xref linkend="guc-default-text-search-config"/> is set accordingly in <filename>postgresql.conf</filename>. If you are using the same text search configuration for the entire cluster you can use the value in <filename>postgresql.conf</filename>. To use different configurations @@ -530,7 +530,7 @@ WHERE to_tsvector(body) @@ to_tsquery('friend'); </programlisting> This query will use the configuration set by <xref - linkend="guc-default-text-search-config">. + linkend="guc-default-text-search-config"/>. </para> <para> @@ -565,7 +565,7 @@ LIMIT 10; <para> We can create a <acronym>GIN</acronym> index (<xref - linkend="textsearch-indexes">) to speed up text searches: + linkend="textsearch-indexes"/>) to speed up text searches: <programlisting> CREATE INDEX pgweb_idx ON pgweb USING GIN (to_tsvector('english', body)); @@ -573,9 +573,9 @@ CREATE INDEX pgweb_idx ON pgweb USING GIN (to_tsvector('english', body)); Notice that the 2-argument version of <function>to_tsvector</function> is used. Only text search functions that specify a configuration name can - be used in expression indexes (<xref linkend="indexes-expressional">). + be used in expression indexes (<xref linkend="indexes-expressional"/>). This is because the index contents must be unaffected by <xref - linkend="guc-default-text-search-config">. If they were affected, the + linkend="guc-default-text-search-config"/>. If they were affected, the index contents might be inconsistent because different entries could contain <type>tsvector</type>s that were created with different text search configurations, and there would be no way to guess which was which. It @@ -653,7 +653,7 @@ LIMIT 10; representation, it is necessary to create a trigger to keep the <type>tsvector</type> column current anytime <literal>title</literal> or <literal>body</literal> changes. - <xref linkend="textsearch-update-triggers"> explains how to do that. + <xref linkend="textsearch-update-triggers"/> explains how to do that. </para> <para> @@ -665,7 +665,7 @@ LIMIT 10; searches will be faster, since it will not be necessary to redo the <function>to_tsvector</function> calls to verify index matches. (This is more important when using a GiST index than a GIN index; see <xref - linkend="textsearch-indexes">.) The expression-index approach is + linkend="textsearch-indexes"/>.) The expression-index approach is simpler to set up, however, and it requires less disk space since the <type>tsvector</type> representation is not stored explicitly. </para> @@ -732,14 +732,14 @@ SELECT to_tsvector('english', 'a fat cat sat on a mat - it ate a fat rats'); The <function>to_tsvector</function> function internally calls a parser which breaks the document text into tokens and assigns a type to each token. For each token, a list of - dictionaries (<xref linkend="textsearch-dictionaries">) is consulted, + dictionaries (<xref linkend="textsearch-dictionaries"/>) is consulted, where the list can vary depending on the token type. The first dictionary that <firstterm>recognizes</firstterm> the token emits one or more normalized <firstterm>lexemes</firstterm> to represent the token. For example, <literal>rats</literal> became <literal>rat</literal> because one of the dictionaries recognized that the word <literal>rats</literal> is a plural form of <literal>rat</literal>. Some words are recognized as - <firstterm>stop words</firstterm> (<xref linkend="textsearch-stopwords">), which + <firstterm>stop words</firstterm> (<xref linkend="textsearch-stopwords"/>), which causes them to be ignored since they occur too frequently to be useful in searching. In our example these are <literal>a</literal>, <literal>on</literal>, and <literal>it</literal>. @@ -749,7 +749,7 @@ SELECT to_tsvector('english', 'a fat cat sat on a mat - it ate a fat rats'); (<literal>Space symbols</literal>), meaning space tokens will never be indexed. The choices of parser, dictionaries and which types of tokens to index are determined by the selected text search configuration (<xref - linkend="textsearch-configuration">). It is possible to have + linkend="textsearch-configuration"/>). It is possible to have many different configurations in the same database, and predefined configurations are available for various languages. In our example we used the default configuration <literal>english</literal> for the @@ -785,7 +785,7 @@ UPDATE tt SET ti = of each lexeme in the finished <type>tsvector</type>, and then merged the labeled <type>tsvector</type> values using the <type>tsvector</type> concatenation operator <literal>||</literal>. (<xref - linkend="textsearch-manipulate-tsvector"> gives details about these + linkend="textsearch-manipulate-tsvector"/> gives details about these operations.) </para> @@ -823,7 +823,7 @@ to_tsquery(<optional> <replaceable class="parameter">config</replaceable> <type> using parentheses. In other words, the input to <function>to_tsquery</function> must already follow the general rules for <type>tsquery</type> input, as described in <xref - linkend="datatype-tsquery">. The difference is that while basic + linkend="datatype-tsquery"/>. The difference is that while basic <type>tsquery</type> input takes the tokens at face value, <function>to_tsquery</function> normalizes each token into a lexeme using the specified or default configuration, and discards any tokens that are @@ -1030,7 +1030,7 @@ SELECT phraseto_tsquery('english', 'The Fat & Rats:C'); its calculation. Therefore, it ignores any <quote>stripped</quote> lexemes in the <type>tsvector</type>. If there are no unstripped lexemes in the input, the result will be zero. (See <xref - linkend="textsearch-manipulate-tsvector"> for more information + linkend="textsearch-manipulate-tsvector"/> for more information about the <function>strip</function> function and positional information in <type>tsvector</type>s.) </para> @@ -1333,7 +1333,7 @@ query.', <title>Manipulating Documents</title> <para> - <xref linkend="textsearch-parsing-documents"> showed how raw textual + <xref linkend="textsearch-parsing-documents"/> showed how raw textual documents can be converted into <type>tsvector</type> values. <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> also provides functions and operators that can be used to manipulate documents that are already @@ -1455,7 +1455,7 @@ query.', <para> A full list of <type>tsvector</type>-related functions is available - in <xref linkend="textsearch-functions-table">. + in <xref linkend="textsearch-functions-table"/>. </para> </sect2> @@ -1464,7 +1464,7 @@ query.', <title>Manipulating Queries</title> <para> - <xref linkend="textsearch-parsing-queries"> showed how raw textual + <xref linkend="textsearch-parsing-queries"/> showed how raw textual queries can be converted into <type>tsquery</type> values. <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> also provides functions and operators that can be used to manipulate queries that are already @@ -1651,7 +1651,7 @@ SELECT querytree(to_tsquery('!defined')); (e.g., <literal>new york</literal>, <literal>big apple</literal>, <literal>nyc</literal>, <literal>gotham</literal>) or narrow the search to direct the user to some hot topic. There is some overlap in functionality between this feature - and thesaurus dictionaries (<xref linkend="textsearch-thesaurus">). + and thesaurus dictionaries (<xref linkend="textsearch-thesaurus"/>). However, you can modify a set of rewrite rules on-the-fly without reindexing, whereas updating a thesaurus requires reindexing to be effective. @@ -1962,7 +1962,7 @@ LIMIT 10; <para> The built-in parser is named <literal>pg_catalog.default</literal>. - It recognizes 23 token types, shown in <xref linkend="textsearch-default-parser">. + It recognizes 23 token types, shown in <xref linkend="textsearch-default-parser"/>. </para> <table id="textsearch-default-parser"> @@ -2295,7 +2295,7 @@ ALTER TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION astro_en end where it'd be useless. Filtering dictionaries are useful to partially normalize words to simplify the task of later dictionaries. For example, a filtering dictionary could be used to remove accents from accented - letters, as is done by the <xref linkend="unaccent"> module. + letters, as is done by the <xref linkend="unaccent"/> module. </para> <sect2 id="textsearch-stopwords"> @@ -2453,7 +2453,7 @@ SELECT ts_lexize('public.simple_dict','The'); <para> This dictionary template is used to create dictionaries that replace a word with a synonym. Phrases are not supported (use the thesaurus - template (<xref linkend="textsearch-thesaurus">) for that). A synonym + template (<xref linkend="textsearch-thesaurus"/>) for that). A synonym dictionary can be used to overcome linguistic problems, for example, to prevent an English stemmer dictionary from reducing the word <quote>Paris</quote> to <quote>pari</quote>. It is enough to have a <literal>Paris paris</literal> line in the @@ -2511,7 +2511,7 @@ SELECT * FROM ts_debug('english', 'Paris'); <function>to_tsvector()</function>, but when it is used in <function>to_tsquery()</function>, the result will be a query item with the prefix match marker (see - <xref linkend="textsearch-parsing-queries">). + <xref linkend="textsearch-parsing-queries"/>). For example, suppose we have these entries in <filename>$SHAREDIR/tsearch_data/synonym_sample.syn</filename>: <programlisting> @@ -3042,7 +3042,7 @@ CREATE TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY english_stem ( <function>to_tsvector</function> or <function>to_tsquery</function> needs a text search configuration to perform its processing. The configuration parameter - <xref linkend="guc-default-text-search-config"> + <xref linkend="guc-default-text-search-config"/> specifies the name of the default configuration, which is the one used by text search functions if an explicit configuration parameter is omitted. @@ -3055,7 +3055,7 @@ CREATE TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY english_stem ( you can create custom configurations easily. To facilitate management of text search objects, a set of <acronym>SQL</acronym> commands is available, and there are several <application>psql</application> commands that display information - about text search objects (<xref linkend="textsearch-psql">). + about text search objects (<xref linkend="textsearch-psql"/>). </para> <para> @@ -3324,7 +3324,7 @@ SELECT * FROM ts_debug('public.english','The Brightest supernovaes'); <para> The word <literal>The</literal> was recognized by the <literal>english_ispell</literal> dictionary as a stop word (<xref - linkend="textsearch-stopwords">) and will not be indexed. + linkend="textsearch-stopwords"/>) and will not be indexed. The spaces are discarded too, since the configuration provides no dictionaries at all for them. </para> @@ -3604,7 +3604,7 @@ SELECT plainto_tsquery('supernovae stars'); <para> Note that <acronym>GIN</acronym> index build time can often be improved - by increasing <xref linkend="guc-maintenance-work-mem">, while + by increasing <xref linkend="guc-maintenance-work-mem"/>, while <acronym>GiST</acronym> index build time is not sensitive to that parameter. </para> @@ -3614,7 +3614,7 @@ SELECT plainto_tsquery('supernovae stars'); allows the implementation of very fast searches with online update. Partitioning can be done at the database level using table inheritance, or by distributing documents over - servers and collecting search results using the <xref linkend="dblink"> + servers and collecting search results using the <xref linkend="dblink"/> module. The latter is possible because ranking functions use only local information. </para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/trigger.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/trigger.sgml index b0e160acf69..bf5d3f90888 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/trigger.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/trigger.sgml @@ -11,10 +11,10 @@ This chapter provides general information about writing trigger functions. Trigger functions can be written in most of the available procedural languages, including - <application>PL/pgSQL</application> (<xref linkend="plpgsql">), - <application>PL/Tcl</application> (<xref linkend="pltcl">), - <application>PL/Perl</application> (<xref linkend="plperl">), and - <application>PL/Python</application> (<xref linkend="plpython">). + <application>PL/pgSQL</application> (<xref linkend="plpgsql"/>), + <application>PL/Tcl</application> (<xref linkend="pltcl"/>), + <application>PL/Perl</application> (<xref linkend="plperl"/>), and + <application>PL/Python</application> (<xref linkend="plpython"/>). After reading this chapter, you should consult the chapter for your favorite procedural language to find out the language-specific details of writing a trigger in it. @@ -76,7 +76,7 @@ <para> Once a suitable trigger function has been created, the trigger is established with - <xref linkend="sql-createtrigger">. + <xref linkend="sql-createtrigger"/>. The same trigger function can be used for multiple triggers. </para> @@ -397,8 +397,8 @@ <para> Further information about data visibility rules can be found in - <xref linkend="spi-visibility">. The example in <xref - linkend="trigger-example"> contains a demonstration of these rules. + <xref linkend="spi-visibility"/>. The example in <xref + linkend="trigger-example"/> contains a demonstration of these rules. </para> </sect1> @@ -715,7 +715,7 @@ typedef struct Trigger <para> To allow queries issued through SPI to reference transition tables, see - <xref linkend="spi-spi-register-trigger-data">. + <xref linkend="spi-spi-register-trigger-data"/>. </para> <para> @@ -835,7 +835,7 @@ trigf(PG_FUNCTION_ARGS) <para> After you have compiled the source code (see <xref - linkend="dfunc">), declare the function and the triggers: + linkend="dfunc"/>), declare the function and the triggers: <programlisting> CREATE FUNCTION trigf() RETURNS trigger AS '<replaceable>filename</replaceable>' @@ -921,7 +921,7 @@ DELETE 2 <para> There are more complex examples in <filename>src/test/regress/regress.c</filename> and - in <xref linkend="contrib-spi">. + in <xref linkend="contrib-spi"/>. </para> </sect1> </chapter> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/tsm-system-rows.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/tsm-system-rows.sgml index 8504ee1281e..3dcd948ff86 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/tsm-system-rows.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/tsm-system-rows.sgml @@ -10,7 +10,7 @@ <para> The <filename>tsm_system_rows</filename> module provides the table sampling method <literal>SYSTEM_ROWS</literal>, which can be used in - the <literal>TABLESAMPLE</literal> clause of a <xref linkend="sql-select"> + the <literal>TABLESAMPLE</literal> clause of a <xref linkend="sql-select"/> command. </para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/tsm-system-time.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/tsm-system-time.sgml index 525292bb7c5..fd8e9995443 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/tsm-system-time.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/tsm-system-time.sgml @@ -10,7 +10,7 @@ <para> The <filename>tsm_system_time</filename> module provides the table sampling method <literal>SYSTEM_TIME</literal>, which can be used in - the <literal>TABLESAMPLE</literal> clause of a <xref linkend="sql-select"> + the <literal>TABLESAMPLE</literal> clause of a <xref linkend="sql-select"/> command. </para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/typeconv.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/typeconv.sgml index 5c99e3adaf1..cd7de8fe3fa 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/typeconv.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/typeconv.sgml @@ -26,7 +26,7 @@ can be tailored by using <emphasis>explicit</emphasis> type conversion. <para> This chapter introduces the <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> type conversion mechanisms and conventions. -Refer to the relevant sections in <xref linkend="datatype"> and <xref linkend="functions"> +Refer to the relevant sections in <xref linkend="datatype"/> and <xref linkend="functions"/> for more information on specific data types and allowed functions and operators. </para> @@ -139,7 +139,7 @@ and for the <function>GREATEST</function> and <function>LEAST</function> functio The system catalogs store information about which conversions, or <firstterm>casts</firstterm>, exist between which data types, and how to perform those conversions. Additional casts can be added by the user -with the <xref linkend="sql-createcast"> +with the <xref linkend="sql-createcast"/> command. (This is usually done in conjunction with defining new data types. The set of casts between built-in types has been carefully crafted and is best not @@ -158,7 +158,7 @@ Data types are divided into several basic <firstterm>type categories</firstterm>, including <type>boolean</type>, <type>numeric</type>, <type>string</type>, <type>bitstring</type>, <type>datetime</type>, <type>timespan</type>, <type>geometric</type>, <type>network</type>, and -user-defined. (For a list see <xref linkend="catalog-typcategory-table">; +user-defined. (For a list see <xref linkend="catalog-typcategory-table"/>; but note it is also possible to create custom type categories.) Within each category there can be one or more <firstterm>preferred types</firstterm>, which are preferred when there is a choice of possible types. With careful selection @@ -213,7 +213,7 @@ should use this new function and no longer do implicit conversion to use the old Note that this procedure is indirectly affected by the precedence of the operators involved, since that will determine which sub-expressions are taken to be the inputs of which operators. - See <xref linkend="sql-precedence"> for more information. + See <xref linkend="sql-precedence"/> for more information. </para> <procedure> @@ -225,7 +225,7 @@ Select the operators to be considered from the <classname>pg_operator</classname> system catalog. If a non-schema-qualified operator name was used (the usual case), the operators considered are those with the matching name and argument count that are -visible in the current search path (see <xref linkend="ddl-schemas-path">). +visible in the current search path (see <xref linkend="ddl-schemas-path"/>). If a qualified operator name was given, only operators in the specified schema are considered. </para> @@ -490,9 +490,9 @@ could possibly accept an integer array on the left-hand side are array inclusion (<type>anyarray</type> <literal><@</literal> <type>anyarray</type>) and range inclusion (<type>anyelement</type> <literal><@</literal> <type>anyrange</type>). Since none of these polymorphic pseudo-types (see <xref -linkend="datatype-pseudo">) are considered preferred, the parser cannot +linkend="datatype-pseudo"/>) are considered preferred, the parser cannot resolve the ambiguity on that basis. -However, <xref linkend="op-resol-last-unknown"> tells +However, <xref linkend="op-resol-last-unknown"/> tells it to assume that the unknown-type literal is of the same type as the other input, that is, integer array. Now only one of the two operators can match, so array inclusion is selected. (Had range inclusion been selected, we would @@ -519,10 +519,10 @@ SELECT * FROM mytable WHERE val = 'foo'; </screen> This query will not use the custom operator. The parser will first see if there is a <type>mytext</type> <literal>=</literal> <type>mytext</type> operator -(<xref linkend="op-resol-exact-unknown">), which there is not; +(<xref linkend="op-resol-exact-unknown"/>), which there is not; then it will consider the domain's base type <type>text</type>, and see if there is a <type>text</type> <literal>=</literal> <type>text</type> operator -(<xref linkend="op-resol-exact-domain">), which there is; +(<xref linkend="op-resol-exact-domain"/>), which there is; so it resolves the <type>unknown</type>-type literal as <type>text</type> and uses the <type>text</type> <literal>=</literal> <type>text</type> operator. The only way to get the custom operator to be used is to explicitly cast @@ -564,7 +564,7 @@ Select the functions to be considered from the <classname>pg_proc</classname> system catalog. If a non-schema-qualified function name was used, the functions considered are those with the matching name and argument count that are -visible in the current search path (see <xref linkend="ddl-schemas-path">). +visible in the current search path (see <xref linkend="ddl-schemas-path"/>). If a qualified function name was given, only functions in the specified schema are considered. </para> @@ -633,7 +633,7 @@ the function call is treated as a form of <literal>CAST</literal> specification. in cases where there is not an actual cast function. If there is a cast function, it is conventionally named after its output type, and so there is no need to have a special case. See - <xref linkend="sql-createcast"> + <xref linkend="sql-createcast"/> for additional commentary. </para> </footnote> @@ -846,7 +846,7 @@ Check for an exact match with the target. <para> Otherwise, try to convert the expression to the target type. This is possible if an <firstterm>assignment cast</firstterm> between the two types is registered in the -<structname>pg_cast</structname> catalog (see <xref linkend="sql-createcast">). +<structname>pg_cast</structname> catalog (see <xref linkend="sql-createcast"/>). Alternatively, if the expression is an unknown-type literal, the contents of the literal string will be fed to the input conversion routine for the target type. diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/user-manag.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/user-manag.sgml index 94fcdf98298..ae15efed957 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/user-manag.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/user-manag.sgml @@ -24,7 +24,7 @@ <para> This chapter describes how to create and manage roles. More information about the effects of role privileges on various - database objects can be found in <xref linkend="ddl-priv">. + database objects can be found in <xref linkend="ddl-priv"/>. </para> <sect1 id="database-roles"> @@ -52,7 +52,7 @@ maintain a correspondence, but this is not required. Database roles are global across a database cluster installation (and not per individual database). To create a role use the <xref - linkend="sql-createrole"> SQL command: + linkend="sql-createrole"/> SQL command: <synopsis> CREATE ROLE <replaceable>name</replaceable>; </synopsis> @@ -61,7 +61,7 @@ CREATE ROLE <replaceable>name</replaceable>; double-quoted. (In practice, you will usually want to add additional options, such as <literal>LOGIN</literal>, to the command. More details appear below.) To remove an existing role, use the analogous - <xref linkend="sql-droprole"> command: + <xref linkend="sql-droprole"/> command: <synopsis> DROP ROLE <replaceable>name</replaceable>; </synopsis> @@ -76,8 +76,8 @@ DROP ROLE <replaceable>name</replaceable>; </indexterm> <para> - For convenience, the programs <xref linkend="app-createuser"> - and <xref linkend="app-dropuser"> are provided as wrappers + For convenience, the programs <xref linkend="app-createuser"/> + and <xref linkend="app-dropuser"/> are provided as wrappers around these SQL commands that can be called from the shell command line: <synopsis> @@ -92,7 +92,7 @@ dropuser <replaceable>name</replaceable> <synopsis> SELECT rolname FROM pg_roles; </synopsis> - The <xref linkend="app-psql"> program's <literal>\du</literal> meta-command + The <xref linkend="app-psql"/> program's <literal>\du</literal> meta-command is also useful for listing the existing roles. </para> @@ -126,7 +126,7 @@ SELECT rolname FROM pg_roles; <para> The set of database roles a given client connection can connect as is determined by the client authentication setup, as explained in - <xref linkend="client-authentication">. (Thus, a client is not + <xref linkend="client-authentication"/>. (Thus, a client is not limited to connect as the role matching its operating system user, just as a person's login name need not match his or her real name.) Since the role @@ -240,8 +240,8 @@ CREATE USER <replaceable>name</replaceable>; A role's attributes can be modified after creation with <command>ALTER ROLE</command>.<indexterm><primary>ALTER ROLE</primary></indexterm> - See the reference pages for the <xref linkend="sql-createrole"> - and <xref linkend="sql-alterrole"> commands for details. + See the reference pages for the <xref linkend="sql-createrole"/> + and <xref linkend="sql-alterrole"/> commands for details. </para> <tip> @@ -257,7 +257,7 @@ CREATE USER <replaceable>name</replaceable>; <para> A role can also have role-specific defaults for many of the run-time configuration settings described in <xref - linkend="runtime-config">. For example, if for some reason you + linkend="runtime-config"/>. For example, if for some reason you want to disable index scans (hint: not a good idea) anytime you connect, you can use: <programlisting> @@ -303,8 +303,8 @@ CREATE ROLE <replaceable>name</replaceable>; <para> Once the group role exists, you can add and remove members using the - <xref linkend="sql-grant"> and - <xref linkend="sql-revoke"> commands: + <xref linkend="sql-grant"/> and + <xref linkend="sql-revoke"/> commands: <synopsis> GRANT <replaceable>group_role</replaceable> TO <replaceable>role1</replaceable>, ... ; REVOKE <replaceable>group_role</replaceable> FROM <replaceable>role1</replaceable>, ... ; @@ -319,7 +319,7 @@ REVOKE <replaceable>group_role</replaceable> FROM <replaceable>role1</replaceabl <para> The members of a group role can use the privileges of the role in two ways. First, every member of a group can explicitly do - <xref linkend="sql-set-role"> to + <xref linkend="sql-set-role"/> to temporarily <quote>become</quote> the group role. In this state, the database session has access to the privileges of the group role rather than the original login role, and any database objects created are @@ -403,7 +403,7 @@ RESET ROLE; <para> To destroy a group role, use <xref - linkend="sql-droprole">: + linkend="sql-droprole"/>: <synopsis> DROP ROLE <replaceable>name</replaceable>; </synopsis> @@ -418,7 +418,7 @@ DROP ROLE <replaceable>name</replaceable>; <para> Because roles can own database objects and can hold privileges to access other objects, dropping a role is often not just a matter of a - quick <xref linkend="sql-droprole">. Any objects owned by the role must + quick <xref linkend="sql-droprole"/>. Any objects owned by the role must first be dropped or reassigned to other owners; and any permissions granted to the role must be revoked. </para> @@ -429,7 +429,7 @@ DROP ROLE <replaceable>name</replaceable>; <programlisting> ALTER TABLE bobs_table OWNER TO alice; </programlisting> - Alternatively, the <xref linkend="sql-reassign-owned"> command can be + Alternatively, the <xref linkend="sql-reassign-owned"/> command can be used to reassign ownership of all objects owned by the role-to-be-dropped to a single other role. Because <command>REASSIGN OWNED</command> cannot access objects in other databases, it is necessary to run it in each database @@ -442,7 +442,7 @@ ALTER TABLE bobs_table OWNER TO alice; <para> Once any valuable objects have been transferred to new owners, any remaining objects owned by the role-to-be-dropped can be dropped with - the <xref linkend="sql-drop-owned"> command. Again, this command cannot + the <xref linkend="sql-drop-owned"/> command. Again, this command cannot access objects in other databases, so it is necessary to run it in each database that contains objects owned by the role. Also, <command>DROP OWNED</command> will not drop entire databases or tablespaces, so it is @@ -499,7 +499,7 @@ DROP ROLE doomed_role; </para> <para> - The default roles are described in <xref linkend="default-roles-table">. + The default roles are described in <xref linkend="default-roles-table"/>. Note that the specific permissions for each of the default roles may change in the future as additional capabilities are added. Administrators should monitor the release notes for changes. diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/uuid-ossp.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/uuid-ossp.sgml index b1c1cd6f0af..b3b816c3725 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/uuid-ossp.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/uuid-ossp.sgml @@ -17,7 +17,7 @@ <title><literal>uuid-ossp</literal> Functions</title> <para> - <xref linkend="uuid-ossp-functions"> shows the functions available to + <xref linkend="uuid-ossp-functions"/> shows the functions available to generate UUIDs. The relevant standards ITU-T Rec. X.667, ISO/IEC 9834-8:2005, and RFC 4122 specify four algorithms for generating UUIDs, identified by the @@ -64,7 +64,7 @@ This function generates a version 3 UUID in the given namespace using the specified input name. The namespace should be one of the special constants produced by the <function>uuid_ns_*()</function> functions shown - in <xref linkend="uuid-ossp-constants">. (It could be any UUID in theory.) The name is an identifier + in <xref linkend="uuid-ossp-constants"/>. (It could be any UUID in theory.) The name is an identifier in the selected namespace. </para> @@ -186,7 +186,7 @@ SELECT uuid_generate_v3(uuid_ns_url(), 'http://www.postgresql.org'); <para> If you only need randomly-generated (version 4) UUIDs, consider using the <function>gen_random_uuid()</function> function - from the <xref linkend="pgcrypto"> module instead. + from the <xref linkend="pgcrypto"/> module instead. </para> </note> </sect2> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/vacuumlo.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/vacuumlo.sgml index 190ed9880bc..0b4dfc2b17a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/vacuumlo.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/vacuumlo.sgml @@ -37,7 +37,7 @@ <para> If you use this, you may also be interested in the <function>lo_manage</function> - trigger in the <xref linkend="lo"> module. + trigger in the <xref linkend="lo"/> module. <function>lo_manage</function> is useful to try to avoid creating orphaned LOs in the first place. </para> @@ -61,7 +61,7 @@ Remove no more than <replaceable>limit</replaceable> large objects per transaction (default 1000). Since the server acquires a lock per LO removed, removing too many LOs in one transaction risks exceeding - <xref linkend="guc-max-locks-per-transaction">. Set the limit to + <xref linkend="guc-max-locks-per-transaction"/>. Set the limit to zero if you want all removals done in a single transaction. </para> </listitem> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/wal.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/wal.sgml index f9febe916f2..f4bc2d4161e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/wal.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/wal.sgml @@ -35,7 +35,7 @@ frequently requested disk blocks and combines disk writes. Fortunately, all operating systems give applications a way to force writes from the buffer cache to disk, and <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> uses those - features. (See the <xref linkend="guc-wal-sync-method"> parameter + features. (See the <xref linkend="guc-wal-sync-method"/> parameter to adjust how this is done.) </para> @@ -133,7 +133,7 @@ (<acronym>BBU</acronym>) disk controllers. In such setups, the synchronize command forces all data from the controller cache to the disks, eliminating much of the benefit of the BBU. You can run the - <xref linkend="pgtestfsync"> program to see + <xref linkend="pgtestfsync"/> program to see if you are affected. If you are affected, the performance benefits of the BBU can be regained by turning off write barriers in the file system or reconfiguring the disk controller, if that is @@ -174,7 +174,7 @@ restore partially-written pages from WAL. If you have file-system software that prevents partial page writes (e.g., ZFS), you can turn off this page imaging by turning off the <xref - linkend="guc-full-page-writes"> parameter. Battery-Backed Unit + linkend="guc-full-page-writes"/> parameter. Battery-Backed Unit (BBU) disk controllers do not prevent partial page writes unless they guarantee that data is written to the BBU as full (8kB) pages. </para> @@ -290,7 +290,7 @@ <para> <acronym>WAL</acronym> also makes it possible to support on-line backup and point-in-time recovery, as described in <xref - linkend="continuous-archiving">. By archiving the WAL data we can support + linkend="continuous-archiving"/>. By archiving the WAL data we can support reverting to any time instant covered by the available WAL data: we simply install a prior physical backup of the database, and replay the WAL log just as far as the desired time. What's more, @@ -367,7 +367,7 @@ transactions running concurrently. This allows flexible trade-offs between performance and certainty of transaction durability. The commit mode is controlled by the user-settable parameter - <xref linkend="guc-synchronous-commit">, which can be changed in any of + <xref linkend="guc-synchronous-commit"/>, which can be changed in any of the ways that a configuration parameter can be set. The mode used for any one transaction depends on the value of <varname>synchronous_commit</varname> when transaction commit begins. @@ -390,7 +390,7 @@ The duration of the risk window is limited because a background process (the <quote>WAL writer</quote>) flushes unwritten <acronym>WAL</acronym> records to disk - every <xref linkend="guc-wal-writer-delay"> milliseconds. + every <xref linkend="guc-wal-writer-delay"/> milliseconds. The actual maximum duration of the risk window is three times <varname>wal_writer_delay</varname> because the WAL writer is designed to favor writing whole pages at a time during busy periods. @@ -405,7 +405,7 @@ <para> Asynchronous commit provides behavior different from setting - <xref linkend="guc-fsync"> = off. + <xref linkend="guc-fsync"/> = off. <varname>fsync</varname> is a server-wide setting that will alter the behavior of all transactions. It disables all logic within <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> that attempts to synchronize @@ -419,7 +419,7 @@ </para> <para> - <xref linkend="guc-commit-delay"> also sounds very similar to + <xref linkend="guc-commit-delay"/> also sounds very similar to asynchronous commit, but it is actually a synchronous commit method (in fact, <varname>commit_delay</varname> is ignored during an asynchronous commit). <varname>commit_delay</varname> causes a delay @@ -439,7 +439,7 @@ <para> There are several <acronym>WAL</acronym>-related configuration parameters that affect database performance. This section explains their use. - Consult <xref linkend="runtime-config"> for general information about + Consult <xref linkend="runtime-config"/> for general information about setting server configuration parameters. </para> @@ -472,15 +472,15 @@ <para> The server's checkpointer process automatically performs a checkpoint every so often. A checkpoint is begun every <xref - linkend="guc-checkpoint-timeout"> seconds, or if - <xref linkend="guc-max-wal-size"> is about to be exceeded, + linkend="guc-checkpoint-timeout"/> seconds, or if + <xref linkend="guc-max-wal-size"/> is about to be exceeded, whichever comes first. The default settings are 5 minutes and 1 GB, respectively. If no WAL has been written since the previous checkpoint, new checkpoints will be skipped even if <varname>checkpoint_timeout</varname> has passed. (If WAL archiving is being used and you want to put a lower limit on how often files are archived in order to bound potential data loss, you should - adjust the <xref linkend="guc-archive-timeout"> parameter rather than the + adjust the <xref linkend="guc-archive-timeout"/> parameter rather than the checkpoint parameters.) It is also possible to force a checkpoint by using the SQL command <command>CHECKPOINT</command>. @@ -492,7 +492,7 @@ more often. This allows faster after-crash recovery, since less work will need to be redone. However, one must balance this against the increased cost of flushing dirty data pages more often. If - <xref linkend="guc-full-page-writes"> is set (as is the default), there is + <xref linkend="guc-full-page-writes"/> is set (as is the default), there is another factor to consider. To ensure data page consistency, the first modification of a data page after each checkpoint results in logging the entire page content. In that case, @@ -507,7 +507,7 @@ extra subsequent WAL traffic as discussed above. It is therefore wise to set the checkpointing parameters high enough so that checkpoints don't happen too often. As a simple sanity check on your checkpointing - parameters, you can set the <xref linkend="guc-checkpoint-warning"> + parameters, you can set the <xref linkend="guc-checkpoint-warning"/> parameter. If checkpoints happen closer together than <varname>checkpoint_warning</varname> seconds, a message will be output to the server log recommending increasing @@ -523,7 +523,7 @@ To avoid flooding the I/O system with a burst of page writes, writing dirty buffers during a checkpoint is spread over a period of time. That period is controlled by - <xref linkend="guc-checkpoint-completion-target">, which is + <xref linkend="guc-checkpoint-completion-target"/>, which is given as a fraction of the checkpoint interval. The I/O rate is adjusted so that the checkpoint finishes when the given fraction of @@ -546,14 +546,14 @@ </para> <para> - On Linux and POSIX platforms <xref linkend="guc-checkpoint-flush-after"> + On Linux and POSIX platforms <xref linkend="guc-checkpoint-flush-after"/> allows to force the OS that pages written by the checkpoint should be flushed to disk after a configurable number of bytes. Otherwise, these pages may be kept in the OS's page cache, inducing a stall when <literal>fsync</literal> is issued at the end of a checkpoint. This setting will often help to reduce transaction latency, but it also can an adverse effect on performance; particularly for workloads that are bigger than - <xref linkend="guc-shared-buffers">, but smaller than the OS's page cache. + <xref linkend="guc-shared-buffers"/>, but smaller than the OS's page cache. </para> <para> @@ -578,14 +578,14 @@ <para> Independently of <varname>max_wal_size</varname>, - <xref linkend="guc-wal-keep-segments"> + 1 most recent WAL files are + <xref linkend="guc-wal-keep-segments"/> + 1 most recent WAL files are kept at all times. Also, if WAL archiving is used, old segments can not be removed or recycled until they are archived. If WAL archiving cannot keep up with the pace that WAL is generated, or if <varname>archive_command</varname> fails repeatedly, old WAL files will accumulate in <filename>pg_wal</filename> until the situation is resolved. A slow or failed standby server that uses a replication slot will have the same effect (see - <xref linkend="streaming-replication-slots">). + <xref linkend="streaming-replication-slots"/>). </para> <para> @@ -629,21 +629,21 @@ not occur often enough to prevent <function>XLogInsertRecord</function> from having to do writes. On such systems one should increase the number of <acronym>WAL</acronym> buffers by - modifying the <xref linkend="guc-wal-buffers"> parameter. When - <xref linkend="guc-full-page-writes"> is set and the system is very busy, + modifying the <xref linkend="guc-wal-buffers"/> parameter. When + <xref linkend="guc-full-page-writes"/> is set and the system is very busy, setting <varname>wal_buffers</varname> higher will help smooth response times during the period immediately following each checkpoint. </para> <para> - The <xref linkend="guc-commit-delay"> parameter defines for how many + The <xref linkend="guc-commit-delay"/> parameter defines for how many microseconds a group commit leader process will sleep after acquiring a lock within <function>XLogFlush</function>, while group commit followers queue up behind the leader. This delay allows other server processes to add their commit records to the WAL buffers so that all of them will be flushed by the leader's eventual sync operation. No sleep - will occur if <xref linkend="guc-fsync"> is not enabled, or if fewer - than <xref linkend="guc-commit-siblings"> other sessions are currently + will occur if <xref linkend="guc-fsync"/> is not enabled, or if fewer + than <xref linkend="guc-commit-siblings"/> other sessions are currently in active transactions; this avoids sleeping when it's unlikely that any other session will commit soon. Note that on some platforms, the resolution of a sleep request is ten milliseconds, so that any nonzero @@ -661,7 +661,7 @@ be chosen intelligently. The higher that cost is, the more effective <varname>commit_delay</varname> is expected to be in increasing transaction throughput, up to a point. The <xref - linkend="pgtestfsync"> program can be used to measure the average time + linkend="pgtestfsync"/> program can be used to measure the average time in microseconds that a single WAL flush operation takes. A value of half of the average time the program reports it takes to flush after a single 8kB write operation is often the most effective setting for @@ -698,7 +698,7 @@ </para> <para> - The <xref linkend="guc-wal-sync-method"> parameter determines how + The <xref linkend="guc-wal-sync-method"/> parameter determines how <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> will ask the kernel to force <acronym>WAL</acronym> updates out to disk. All the options should be the same in terms of reliability, with @@ -706,13 +706,13 @@ force a flush of the disk cache even when other options do not do so. However, it's quite platform-specific which one will be the fastest. You can test the speeds of different options using the <xref - linkend="pgtestfsync"> program. + linkend="pgtestfsync"/> program. Note that this parameter is irrelevant if <varname>fsync</varname> has been turned off. </para> <para> - Enabling the <xref linkend="guc-wal-debug"> configuration parameter + Enabling the <xref linkend="guc-wal-debug"/> configuration parameter (provided that <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> has been compiled with support for it) will result in each <function>XLogInsertRecord</function> and <function>XLogFlush</function> @@ -733,7 +733,7 @@ required from the administrator except ensuring that the disk-space requirements for the <acronym>WAL</acronym> logs are met, and that any necessary tuning is done (see <xref - linkend="wal-configuration">). + linkend="wal-configuration"/>). </para> <para> @@ -781,7 +781,7 @@ irrecoverable data corruption. Administrators should try to ensure that disks holding <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>'s <acronym>WAL</acronym> log files do not make such false reports. - (See <xref linkend="wal-reliability">.) + (See <xref linkend="wal-reliability"/>.) </para> <para> @@ -793,7 +793,7 @@ scanning forward from the log location indicated in the checkpoint record. Because the entire content of data pages is saved in the log on the first page modification after a checkpoint (assuming - <xref linkend="guc-full-page-writes"> is not disabled), all pages + <xref linkend="guc-full-page-writes"/> is not disabled), all pages changed since the checkpoint will be restored to a consistent state. </para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/xaggr.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/xaggr.sgml index f99dbb6510e..1514e5c388e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/xaggr.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/xaggr.sgml @@ -141,7 +141,7 @@ CREATE AGGREGATE avg (float8) <para> For further details see the - <xref linkend="sql-createaggregate"> + <xref linkend="sql-createaggregate"/> command. </para> @@ -161,8 +161,8 @@ CREATE AGGREGATE avg (float8) Aggregate functions can optionally support <firstterm>moving-aggregate mode</firstterm>, which allows substantially faster execution of aggregate functions within windows with moving frame starting points. - (See <xref linkend="tutorial-window"> - and <xref linkend="syntax-window-functions"> for information about use of + (See <xref linkend="tutorial-window"/> + and <xref linkend="syntax-window-functions"/> for information about use of aggregate functions as window functions.) The basic idea is that in addition to a normal <quote>forward</quote> transition function, the aggregate provides an <firstterm>inverse @@ -290,7 +290,7 @@ FROM (VALUES (1, 1.0e20::float8), Aggregate functions can use polymorphic state transition functions or final functions, so that the same functions can be used to implement multiple aggregates. - See <xref linkend="extend-types-polymorphic"> + See <xref linkend="extend-types-polymorphic"/> for an explanation of polymorphic functions. Going a step further, the aggregate function itself can be specified with polymorphic input type(s) and state type, allowing a single @@ -384,7 +384,7 @@ CREATE AGGREGATE array_agg (anynonarray) An aggregate function can be made to accept a varying number of arguments by declaring its last argument as a <literal>VARIADIC</literal> array, in much the same fashion as for regular functions; see - <xref linkend="xfunc-sql-variadic-functions">. The aggregate's transition + <xref linkend="xfunc-sql-variadic-functions"/>. The aggregate's transition function(s) must have the same array type as their last argument. The transition function(s) typically would also be marked <literal>VARIADIC</literal>, but this is not strictly required. @@ -393,7 +393,7 @@ CREATE AGGREGATE array_agg (anynonarray) <note> <para> Variadic aggregates are easily misused in connection with - the <literal>ORDER BY</literal> option (see <xref linkend="syntax-aggregates">), + the <literal>ORDER BY</literal> option (see <xref linkend="syntax-aggregates"/>), since the parser cannot tell whether the wrong number of actual arguments have been given in such a combination. Keep in mind that everything to the right of <literal>ORDER BY</literal> is a sort key, not an argument to the @@ -490,7 +490,7 @@ SELECT percentile_disc(0.5) WITHIN GROUP (ORDER BY income) FROM households; Also, because the final function performs the sort, it is not possible to continue adding input rows by executing the transition function again later. This means the final function is not <literal>READ_ONLY</literal>; - it must be declared in <xref linkend="sql-createaggregate"> + it must be declared in <xref linkend="sql-createaggregate"/> as <literal>READ_WRITE</literal>, or as <literal>SHARABLE</literal> if it's possible for additional final-function calls to make use of the already-sorted state. @@ -636,7 +636,7 @@ if (AggCheckCallContext(fcinfo, NULL)) (While aggregate transition functions are always allowed to modify the transition value in-place, aggregate final functions are generally discouraged from doing so; if they do so, the behavior must be declared - when creating the aggregate. See <xref linkend="sql-createaggregate"> + when creating the aggregate. See <xref linkend="sql-createaggregate"/> for more detail.) </para> @@ -644,7 +644,7 @@ if (AggCheckCallContext(fcinfo, NULL)) The second argument of <function>AggCheckCallContext</function> can be used to retrieve the memory context in which aggregate state values are being kept. This is useful for transition functions that wish to use <quote>expanded</quote> - objects (see <xref linkend="xtypes-toast">) as their state values. + objects (see <xref linkend="xtypes-toast"/>) as their state values. On first call, the transition function should return an expanded object whose memory context is a child of the aggregate state context, and then keep returning the same expanded object on subsequent calls. See diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/xfunc.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/xfunc.sgml index 9bdb72cd989..508ee7a96c0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/xfunc.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/xfunc.sgml @@ -16,24 +16,24 @@ <listitem> <para> query language functions (functions written in - <acronym>SQL</acronym>) (<xref linkend="xfunc-sql">) + <acronym>SQL</acronym>) (<xref linkend="xfunc-sql"/>) </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> procedural language functions (functions written in, for example, <application>PL/pgSQL</application> or <application>PL/Tcl</application>) - (<xref linkend="xfunc-pl">) + (<xref linkend="xfunc-pl"/>) </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - internal functions (<xref linkend="xfunc-internal">) + internal functions (<xref linkend="xfunc-internal"/>) </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - C-language functions (<xref linkend="xfunc-c">) + C-language functions (<xref linkend="xfunc-c"/>) </para> </listitem> </itemizedlist> @@ -63,7 +63,7 @@ <para> Throughout this chapter, it can be useful to look at the reference - page of the <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"> command to + page of the <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"/> command to understand the examples better. Some examples from this chapter can be found in <filename>funcs.sql</filename> and <filename>funcs.c</filename> in the <filename>src/tutorial</filename> @@ -162,11 +162,11 @@ SELECT clean_emp(); The syntax of the <command>CREATE FUNCTION</command> command requires the function body to be written as a string constant. It is usually most convenient to use dollar quoting (see <xref - linkend="sql-syntax-dollar-quoting">) for the string constant. + linkend="sql-syntax-dollar-quoting"/>) for the string constant. If you choose to use regular single-quoted string constant syntax, you must double single quote marks (<literal>'</literal>) and backslashes (<literal>\</literal>) (assuming escape string syntax) in the body of - the function (see <xref linkend="sql-syntax-strings">). + the function (see <xref linkend="sql-syntax-strings"/>). </para> <sect2 id="xfunc-sql-function-arguments"> @@ -430,7 +430,7 @@ SELECT name, double_salary(emp) AS dream WHERE emp.cubicle ~= point '(2,1)'; </screen> but this usage is deprecated since it's easy to get confused. - (See <xref linkend="rowtypes-usage"> for details about these + (See <xref linkend="rowtypes-usage"/> for details about these two notations for the composite value of a table row.) </para> @@ -536,7 +536,7 @@ SELECT * FROM new_emp(); </screen> The second way is described more fully in <xref - linkend="xfunc-sql-table-functions">. + linkend="xfunc-sql-table-functions"/>. </para> <para> @@ -574,7 +574,7 @@ SELECT name(new_emp()); None </screen> - As explained in <xref linkend="rowtypes-usage">, the field notation and + As explained in <xref linkend="rowtypes-usage"/>, the field notation and functional notation are equivalent. </para> @@ -621,7 +621,7 @@ SELECT add_em(3,7); </screen> This is not essentially different from the version of <literal>add_em</literal> - shown in <xref linkend="xfunc-sql-base-functions">. The real value of + shown in <xref linkend="xfunc-sql-base-functions"/>. The real value of output parameters is that they provide a convenient way of defining functions that return several columns. For example, @@ -762,7 +762,7 @@ SELECT mleast(VARIADIC ARRAY[]::numeric[]); The array element parameters generated from a variadic parameter are treated as not having any names of their own. This means it is not possible to call a variadic function using named arguments (<xref - linkend="sql-syntax-calling-funcs">), except when you specify + linkend="sql-syntax-calling-funcs"/>), except when you specify <literal>VARIADIC</literal>. For example, this will work: <screen> @@ -950,7 +950,7 @@ SELECT * FROM sum_n_product_with_tab(10); set-returning function multiple times, with the parameters for each invocation coming from successive rows of a table or subquery. The preferred way to do this is to use the <literal>LATERAL</literal> key word, - which is described in <xref linkend="queries-lateral">. + which is described in <xref linkend="queries-lateral"/>. Here is an example using a set-returning function to enumerate elements of a tree structure: @@ -1197,7 +1197,7 @@ $$ LANGUAGE SQL; return the polymorphic types <type>anyelement</type>, <type>anyarray</type>, <type>anynonarray</type>, <type>anyenum</type>, and <type>anyrange</type>. See <xref - linkend="extend-types-polymorphic"> for a more detailed + linkend="extend-types-polymorphic"/> for a more detailed explanation of polymorphic functions. Here is a polymorphic function <function>make_array</function> that builds up an array from two arbitrary data type elements: @@ -1311,7 +1311,7 @@ SELECT concat_values('|', 1, 4, 2); When a SQL function has one or more parameters of collatable data types, a collation is identified for each function call depending on the collations assigned to the actual arguments, as described in <xref - linkend="collation">. If a collation is successfully identified + linkend="collation"/>. If a collation is successfully identified (i.e., there are no conflicts of implicit collations among the arguments) then all the collatable parameters are treated as having that collation implicitly. This will affect the behavior of collation-sensitive @@ -1384,7 +1384,7 @@ CREATE FUNCTION test(smallint, double precision) RETURNS ... it is not immediately clear which function would be called with some trivial input like <literal>test(1, 1.5)</literal>. The currently implemented resolution rules are described in - <xref linkend="typeconv">, but it is unwise to design a system that subtly + <xref linkend="typeconv"/>, but it is unwise to design a system that subtly relies on this behavior. </para> @@ -1457,7 +1457,7 @@ CREATE FUNCTION test(int, int) RETURNS int Every function has a <firstterm>volatility</firstterm> classification, with the possibilities being <literal>VOLATILE</literal>, <literal>STABLE</literal>, or <literal>IMMUTABLE</literal>. <literal>VOLATILE</literal> is the default if the - <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"> + <xref linkend="sql-createfunction"/> command does not specify a category. The volatility category is a promise to the optimizer about the behavior of the function: @@ -1539,7 +1539,7 @@ CREATE FUNCTION test(int, int) RETURNS int been made by the SQL command that is calling the function. A <literal>VOLATILE</literal> function will see such changes, a <literal>STABLE</literal> or <literal>IMMUTABLE</literal> function will not. This behavior is implemented - using the snapshotting behavior of MVCC (see <xref linkend="mvcc">): + using the snapshotting behavior of MVCC (see <xref linkend="mvcc"/>): <literal>STABLE</literal> and <literal>IMMUTABLE</literal> functions use a snapshot established as of the start of the calling query, whereas <literal>VOLATILE</literal> functions obtain a fresh snapshot at the start of @@ -1577,7 +1577,7 @@ CREATE FUNCTION test(int, int) RETURNS int A common error is to label a function <literal>IMMUTABLE</literal> when its results depend on a configuration parameter. For example, a function that manipulates timestamps might well have results that depend on the - <xref linkend="guc-timezone"> setting. For safety, such functions should + <xref linkend="guc-timezone"/> setting. For safety, such functions should be labeled <literal>STABLE</literal> instead. </para> @@ -1606,7 +1606,7 @@ CREATE FUNCTION test(int, int) RETURNS int Procedural languages aren't built into the <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> server; they are offered by loadable modules. - See <xref linkend="xplang"> and following chapters for more + See <xref linkend="xplang"/> and following chapters for more information. </para> </sect1> @@ -1630,7 +1630,7 @@ CREATE FUNCTION test(int, int) RETURNS int <para> Normally, all internal functions present in the server are declared during the initialization of the database cluster - (see <xref linkend="creating-cluster">), + (see <xref linkend="creating-cluster"/>), but a user could use <command>CREATE FUNCTION</command> to create additional alias names for an internal function. Internal functions are declared in <command>CREATE FUNCTION</command> @@ -1726,7 +1726,7 @@ CREATE FUNCTION square_root(double precision) RETURNS double precision <para> If the name does not contain a directory part, the file is searched for in the path specified by the configuration variable - <xref linkend="guc-dynamic-library-path">.<indexterm><primary>dynamic_library_path</primary></indexterm> + <xref linkend="guc-dynamic-library-path"/>.<indexterm><primary>dynamic_library_path</primary></indexterm> </para> </listitem> @@ -1775,7 +1775,7 @@ CREATE FUNCTION square_root(double precision) RETURNS double precision <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> will not compile a C function automatically. The object file must be compiled before it is referenced in a <command>CREATE - FUNCTION</command> command. See <xref linkend="dfunc"> for additional + FUNCTION</command> command. See <xref linkend="dfunc"/> for additional information. </para> </note> @@ -1899,7 +1899,7 @@ typedef int int4; means <replaceable>XX</replaceable> <emphasis>bits</emphasis>. Note therefore also that the C type <type>int8</type> is 1 byte in size. The SQL type <type>int8</type> is called <type>int64</type> in C. See also - <xref linkend="xfunc-c-type-table">.) + <xref linkend="xfunc-c-type-table"/>.) </para> <para> @@ -1952,7 +1952,7 @@ typedef struct value. If you do so you are likely to corrupt on-disk data, since the pointer you are given might point directly into a disk buffer. The sole exception to this rule is explained in - <xref linkend="xaggr">. + <xref linkend="xaggr"/>. </para> </warning> @@ -1998,7 +1998,7 @@ memcpy(destination->data, buffer, 40); </para> <para> - <xref linkend="xfunc-c-type-table"> specifies which C type + <xref linkend="xfunc-c-type-table"/> specifies which C type corresponds to which SQL type when writing a C-language function that uses a built-in type of <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>. The <quote>Defined In</quote> column gives the header file that @@ -2433,10 +2433,10 @@ CREATE FUNCTION concat_text(text, text) RETURNS text <para> Finally, the version-1 function call conventions make it possible - to return set results (<xref linkend="xfunc-c-return-set">) and - implement trigger functions (<xref linkend="triggers">) and + to return set results (<xref linkend="xfunc-c-return-set"/>) and + implement trigger functions (<xref linkend="triggers"/>) and procedural-language call handlers (<xref - linkend="plhandler">). For more details + linkend="plhandler"/>). For more details see <filename>src/backend/utils/fmgr/README</filename> in the source distribution. </para> @@ -2477,7 +2477,7 @@ CREATE FUNCTION concat_text(text, text) RETURNS text <para> Compiling and linking your code so that it can be dynamically loaded into <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> always - requires special flags. See <xref linkend="dfunc"> for a + requires special flags. See <xref linkend="dfunc"/> for a detailed explanation of how to do it for your particular operating system. </para> @@ -2486,7 +2486,7 @@ CREATE FUNCTION concat_text(text, text) RETURNS text <listitem> <para> Remember to define a <quote>magic block</quote> for your shared library, - as described in <xref linkend="xfunc-c-dynload">. + as described in <xref linkend="xfunc-c-dynload"/>. </para> </listitem> @@ -3122,7 +3122,7 @@ CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION retcomposite(IN integer, IN integer, return the polymorphic types <type>anyelement</type>, <type>anyarray</type>, <type>anynonarray</type>, <type>anyenum</type>, and <type>anyrange</type>. - See <xref linkend="extend-types-polymorphic"> for a more detailed explanation + See <xref linkend="extend-types-polymorphic"/> for a more detailed explanation of polymorphic functions. When function arguments or return types are defined as polymorphic types, the function author cannot know in advance what data type it will be called with, or @@ -3268,7 +3268,7 @@ CREATE FUNCTION make_array(anyelement) RETURNS anyarray Add-ins can reserve LWLocks and an allocation of shared memory on server startup. The add-in's shared library must be preloaded by specifying it in - <xref linkend="guc-shared-preload-libraries"><indexterm><primary>shared_preload_libraries</primary></indexterm>. + <xref linkend="guc-shared-preload-libraries"/><indexterm><primary>shared_preload_libraries</primary></indexterm>. Shared memory is reserved by calling: <programlisting> void RequestAddinShmemSpace(int size) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/xindex.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/xindex.sgml index dce68dd4ac3..2b4298065cd 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/xindex.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/xindex.sgml @@ -36,7 +36,7 @@ described in <classname>pg_am</classname>. It is possible to add a new index access method by writing the necessary code and then creating a row in <classname>pg_am</classname> — but that is - beyond the scope of this chapter (see <xref linkend="indexam">). + beyond the scope of this chapter (see <xref linkend="indexam"/>). </para> <para> @@ -101,7 +101,7 @@ <para> The B-tree index method defines five strategies, shown in <xref - linkend="xindex-btree-strat-table">. + linkend="xindex-btree-strat-table"/>. </para> <table tocentry="1" id="xindex-btree-strat-table"> @@ -140,7 +140,7 @@ <para> Hash indexes support only equality comparisons, and so they use only one - strategy, shown in <xref linkend="xindex-hash-strat-table">. + strategy, shown in <xref linkend="xindex-hash-strat-table"/>. </para> <table tocentry="1" id="xindex-hash-strat-table"> @@ -168,7 +168,7 @@ however it likes. As an example, several of the built-in GiST index operator classes index two-dimensional geometric objects, providing the <quote>R-tree</quote> strategies shown in - <xref linkend="xindex-rtree-strat-table">. Four of these are true + <xref linkend="xindex-rtree-strat-table"/>. Four of these are true two-dimensional tests (overlaps, same, contains, contained by); four of them consider only the X direction; and the other four provide the same tests in the Y direction. @@ -242,7 +242,7 @@ class interpret the strategy numbers according to the operator class's definition. As an example, the strategy numbers used by the built-in operator classes for points are shown in <xref - linkend="xindex-spgist-point-strat-table">. + linkend="xindex-spgist-point-strat-table"/>. </para> <table tocentry="1" id="xindex-spgist-point-strat-table"> @@ -289,7 +289,7 @@ each operator class interpret the strategy numbers according to the operator class's definition. As an example, the strategy numbers used by the built-in operator class for arrays are shown in - <xref linkend="xindex-gin-array-strat-table">. + <xref linkend="xindex-gin-array-strat-table"/>. </para> <table tocentry="1" id="xindex-gin-array-strat-table"> @@ -328,7 +328,7 @@ of each operator class interpret the strategy numbers according to the operator class's definition. As an example, the strategy numbers used by the built-in <literal>Minmax</literal> operator classes are shown in - <xref linkend="xindex-brin-minmax-strat-table">. + <xref linkend="xindex-brin-minmax-strat-table"/>. </para> <table tocentry="1" id="xindex-brin-minmax-strat-table"> @@ -372,7 +372,7 @@ level of a <literal>WHERE</literal> clause to be used with an index. (Some index access methods also support <firstterm>ordering operators</firstterm>, which typically don't return Boolean values; that feature is discussed - in <xref linkend="xindex-ordering-ops">.) + in <xref linkend="xindex-ordering-ops"/>.) </para> </sect2> @@ -403,7 +403,7 @@ <para> B-trees require a single support function, and allow a second one to be supplied at the operator class author's option, as shown in <xref - linkend="xindex-btree-support-table">. + linkend="xindex-btree-support-table"/>. </para> <table tocentry="1" id="xindex-btree-support-table"> @@ -438,7 +438,7 @@ <para> Hash indexes require one support function, and allow a second one to be supplied at the operator class author's option, as shown in <xref - linkend="xindex-hash-support-table">. + linkend="xindex-hash-support-table"/>. </para> <table tocentry="1" id="xindex-hash-support-table"> @@ -469,8 +469,8 @@ <para> GiST indexes have nine support functions, two of which are optional, - as shown in <xref linkend="xindex-gist-support-table">. - (For more information see <xref linkend="gist">.) + as shown in <xref linkend="xindex-gist-support-table"/>. + (For more information see <xref linkend="gist"/>.) </para> <table tocentry="1" id="xindex-gist-support-table"> @@ -541,8 +541,8 @@ <para> SP-GiST indexes require five support functions, as - shown in <xref linkend="xindex-spgist-support-table">. - (For more information see <xref linkend="spgist">.) + shown in <xref linkend="xindex-spgist-support-table"/>. + (For more information see <xref linkend="spgist"/>.) </para> <table tocentry="1" id="xindex-spgist-support-table"> @@ -589,8 +589,8 @@ <para> GIN indexes have six support functions, three of which are optional, - as shown in <xref linkend="xindex-gin-support-table">. - (For more information see <xref linkend="gin">.) + as shown in <xref linkend="xindex-gin-support-table"/>. + (For more information see <xref linkend="gin"/>.) </para> <table tocentry="1" id="xindex-gin-support-table"> @@ -655,9 +655,9 @@ <para> BRIN indexes have four basic support functions, as shown in - <xref linkend="xindex-brin-support-table">; those basic functions + <xref linkend="xindex-brin-support-table"/>; those basic functions may require additional support functions to be provided. - (For more information see <xref linkend="brin-extensibility">.) + (For more information see <xref linkend="brin-extensibility"/>.) </para> <table tocentry="1" id="xindex-brin-support-table"> @@ -726,7 +726,7 @@ operators that sort complex numbers in absolute value order, so we choose the name <literal>complex_abs_ops</literal>. First, we need a set of operators. The procedure for defining operators was - discussed in <xref linkend="xoper">. For an operator class on + discussed in <xref linkend="xoper"/>. For an operator class on B-trees, the operators we require are: <itemizedlist spacing="compact"> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/xml2.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/xml2.sgml index 35e1ccb7a19..0a0f13d02d6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/xml2.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/xml2.sgml @@ -34,7 +34,7 @@ <title>Description of Functions</title> <para> - <xref linkend="xml2-functions-table"> shows the functions provided by this module. + <xref linkend="xml2-functions-table"/> shows the functions provided by this module. These functions provide straightforward XML parsing and XPath queries. All arguments are of type <type>text</type>, so for brevity that is not shown. </para> @@ -211,7 +211,7 @@ xpath_table(text key, text document, text relation, text xpaths, text criteria) table. The primary key field from the original document table is returned as the first column of the result so that the result set can readily be used in joins. The parameters are described in - <xref linkend="xml2-xpath-table-parameters">. + <xref linkend="xml2-xpath-table-parameters"/>. </para> <table id="xml2-xpath-table-parameters"> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/xoper.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/xoper.sgml index 4b0716951ab..2aa7cf9b642 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/xoper.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/xoper.sgml @@ -32,7 +32,7 @@ <para> Here is an example of creating an operator for adding two complex numbers. We assume we've already created the definition of type - <type>complex</type> (see <xref linkend="xtypes">). First we need a + <type>complex</type> (see <xref linkend="xtypes"/>). First we need a function that does the work, then we can define the operator: <programlisting> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/xplang.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/xplang.sgml index 60d0cc61908..4b52210459d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/xplang.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/xplang.sgml @@ -27,15 +27,15 @@ <para> There are currently four procedural languages available in the standard <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> distribution: - <application>PL/pgSQL</application> (<xref linkend="plpgsql">), - <application>PL/Tcl</application> (<xref linkend="pltcl">), - <application>PL/Perl</application> (<xref linkend="plperl">), and - <application>PL/Python</application> (<xref linkend="plpython">). + <application>PL/pgSQL</application> (<xref linkend="plpgsql"/>), + <application>PL/Tcl</application> (<xref linkend="pltcl"/>), + <application>PL/Perl</application> (<xref linkend="plperl"/>), and + <application>PL/Python</application> (<xref linkend="plpython"/>). There are additional procedural languages available that are not - included in the core distribution. <xref linkend="external-projects"> + included in the core distribution. <xref linkend="external-projects"/> has information about finding them. In addition other languages can be defined by users; the basics of developing a new procedural - language are covered in <xref linkend="plhandler">. + language are covered in <xref linkend="plhandler"/>. </para> <sect1 id="xplang-install"> @@ -79,7 +79,7 @@ The shared object for the language handler must be compiled and installed into an appropriate library directory. This works in the same way as building and installing modules with regular user-defined C - functions does; see <xref linkend="dfunc">. Often, the language + functions does; see <xref linkend="dfunc"/>. Often, the language handler will depend on an external library that provides the actual programming language engine; if so, that must be installed as well. </para> @@ -105,7 +105,7 @@ CREATE FUNCTION <replaceable>handler_function_name</replaceable>() <para> Optionally, the language handler can provide an <quote>inline</quote> handler function that executes anonymous code blocks - (<xref linkend="sql-do"> commands) + (<xref linkend="sql-do"/> commands) written in this language. If an inline handler function is provided by the language, declare it with a command like <synopsis> @@ -165,7 +165,7 @@ CREATE <optional>TRUSTED</optional> <optional>PROCEDURAL</optional> LANGUAGE <re </procedure> <para> - <xref linkend="xplang-install-example"> shows how the manual + <xref linkend="xplang-install-example"/> shows how the manual installation procedure would work with the language <application>PL/Perl</application>. </para> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/xtypes.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/xtypes.sgml index 2f90c1d42c9..29747a0873e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/xtypes.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/xtypes.sgml @@ -9,7 +9,7 @@ </indexterm> <para> - As described in <xref linkend="extend-type-system">, + As described in <xref linkend="extend-type-system"/>, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> can be extended to support new data types. This section describes how to define new base types, which are data types defined below the level of the <acronym>SQL</acronym> @@ -246,7 +246,7 @@ CREATE TYPE complex ( <para> For further details see the description of the - <xref linkend="sql-createtype"> command. + <xref linkend="sql-createtype"/> command. </para> <sect2 id="xtypes-toast"> @@ -259,7 +259,7 @@ CREATE TYPE complex ( <para> If the values of your data type vary in size (in internal form), it's usually desirable to make the data type <acronym>TOAST</acronym>-able (see <xref - linkend="storage-toast">). You should do this even if the values are always + linkend="storage-toast"/>). You should do this even if the values are always too small to be compressed or stored externally, because <acronym>TOAST</acronym> can save space on small data too, by reducing header overhead. |